Arab Human Development 2004

Published on March 2017 | Categories: Documents | Downloads: 28 | Comments: 0 | Views: 1553
of 265
Download PDF   Embed   Report

Comments

Content


The Arab world finds itself at a historical crossroads. Caught between oppression at home
and violation from abroad, Arabs are increasingly excluded from determining their own
future.
Freedom in its comprehensive sense, incorporates not only civil and political freedoms
(in other words, liberation from oppression), but also the liberation from all factors that are
inconsistent with human dignity. To be sustained and guaranteed, freedom requires a system
of good governance that rests upon effective popular representation and is accountable to the
people, and that upholds the rule of law and ensures that an independent judiciary applies the
law impartially.
The report describes free societies, in their normative dimension, as fundamental contrasts
with present-day Arab countries. The enormous gap that separates today’s reality and what
many in the region hope for, is a source of widespread frustration and despair among Arabs
about their countries’ prospects for a peaceful transition to societies enjoying freedom and
good governance. Moreover, persisting tendencies in Arab social structures could well lead to
spiralling social, economic, and political crises. Each further stage of crisis would impose itself
as a new reality, producing injustices eventually beyond control.
The Arab world is at a decisive point that does not admit compromise or complacency.
If the Arab people are to have true societies of freedom and good governance, they will
need to be socially innovative. Their challenge is to create a viable mode of transition from
a situation where liberty is curtailed and oppression the rule, to one of freedom and good
governance that minimises social upheaval and human costs, to the fullest extent possible.
History will judge this a transcendent achievement through which the region finally attained
its well-deserved freedom.
A
R
A
B

H
U
M
A
N

D
E
V
E
L
O
P
M
E
N
T

R
E
P
O
R
T

2
0
0
4
UNITED NATIONS DEVELOPMENT PROGRAMME
ARAB FUND FOR ECONOMIC AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT
ARAB GULF PROGRAMME FOR UNITED NATIONS DEVELOPMENT ORGANIZATIONS
ARAB HUMAN
DEVELOPMENT
REPORT 2004
Towards Freedom in the Arab World
Assigned Sales number: E.04.III.B.5
ISBN: 92-1-126165-1
REGIONAL BUREAU FOR ARAB STATES
THE ARAB HUMAN
DEVELOPMENT
REPORT 2004
Towards Freedom in the Arab World
UNITED NATIONS DEVELOPMENT PROGRAMME
ARAB FUND FOR ECONOMIC AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT
ARAB GULF PROGRAMME FOR UNITED NATIONS DEVELOPMENT ORGANIZATIONS
Copyright © 2005
By the United Nations Development Programme,
Regional Bureau for Arab States (RBAS),
1 UN Plaza, New York, New York, 10017, USA
Image on cover of cast copper statue head from Nineveh, copyright Hirmer Fotoarchiv München
All rights reserved. No part of this publication maybe reproduced,
stored in a retrieval system or transmitted in any form or by any means,
electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise,
without prior permission of UNDP / RBAS
Available through:
United Nations Publications
Room DC2-853
New York, NY 10017
USA
Telephone: 212 963 8302 and 800 253 9646 (From the United States)
Email: [email protected]
Web: www.un.org/Publications
Web: www.undp.org/rbas
Cover Design:
Walid Gadow
Layout and Production: SYNTAX, Amman, Jordan
Printed at: National Press, Amman, Jordan
ISBN: 92-1-126165-1
Printed in the Hashemite Kingdom of Jordan
The analysis and policy recommendations of this Report do not necessarily reflect the views of the United Nations
Development Programme, its Executive Board or its Member States. The Report is the work of an independent
team of authors sponsored by the Regional Bureau for Arab States.
This work was originally published in Arabic. In any cases of discrepancies, the original language shall govern.
I
The first two Arab Human Development
Reports published by the United Nations
Development Programme and written by an
independent group of Arab scholars, poli-
cymakers and practitioners have, rightly,
become landmarks in the broader debate and
discussion over the future of the region. The
key diagnosis of the first report that the Arab
world is suffering three fundamental deficits
– in political rights, in women’s rights and in
knowledge – that have, together, held back
human development across the region has
now become widely accepted. The second
report then spelled out in compelling detail
the first of these deficits, analyzing where
Arab knowledge production and dissemina-
tion systems were falling short and articulat-
ing why Arab states need to turn outwards
and engage with the outside world to make
learning and research key drivers of social and
economic innovation in the future.
Those two reports succeeded more spec-
tacularly than we could have imagined in the
scale of their impact. They were the talk of
coffee shops and cabinets, boardrooms and
world TV talk shows. More broadly, they
were a media and publishing phenomenon,
stimulating formal debate from the G8 sum-
mit at Sea Island, Georgia, to civil society
meetings in Sana’a and Alexandria among
many other gatherings. Above all, in a region
where disagreement, sometimes violent, has
been too often the norm of political discourse,
longtime opponents found a lot to agree about
in them. And that has been the real power
of the Reports: starting to build a consensus
around reform.
This report, the third in the series, seeks
to focus on the thorny issues of freedom, good
governance and political reform. Drawing on
a mixture of survey data and other research
it seeks to map out the challenges and con-
straints to moving forward on a path of demo-
cratic progress. In two key ways, however, the
report has been more difficult to prepare than
its predecessors. First has been the limitation
of the data. One of the central sources of infor-
mation was a specially designed survey to map
out public attitudes to key aspects of reform.
Regrettably several countries declined permis-
sion for the survey to be carried out, resulting
in only a partial snapshot. Though most of the
analysis in the report is not dependent on the
survey this shortcoming inevitably hampered
analysis of public attitudes and perceptions in
the region.
A second problem has been the exception-
ally rapid pace of events in the region itself.
This is not in itself new – the first two reports
were prepared in the shadow of continued
violence in the occupied Palestinian Territory
and then the invasion of Iraq, both of which
have had broad repercussions throughout the
Arab world. However, given the central con-
viction of the authors across all the reports
that lasting and sustainable reform in the Arab
world needs to come from within, the intensi-
fication of both conflicts over the past year and
the fierce reactions they have provoked across
the region have led to a deep concern on the
part of the authors that the broad agenda of
reform, and enhanced human development,
was being retarded rather than accelerated.
At the same time, as a result of the high
visibility of the reports, the very process of
writing this AHDR has been a source of sig-
nificant public, and, unfortunately, highly
politicized and often inaccurate speculation.
While reflecting the tremendous difficulty of
writing a neutral, fact-based report in such an
environment, this has inevitably created some
tensions for UNDP given its fundamental
character as a development rather than politi-
cal institution. As a result, while the process
has clearly demonstrated the need for a neu-
tral, international platform of the kind UNDP
Foreword by the Administrator, UNDP
II
is able to provide, it has also shown the limita-
tions of such an approach and the need for
a longer-term formula that would, in time,
allow for wider ownership and institutional-
ization of the Reports as a representative voice
of Arab civil society - a report written in the
region and owned by the region.
In this context, as we have made clear since
launching this initiative and other discussions
of this kind, the AHDRs are, deliberately, not
formal UN or UNDP documents and do not
reflect the official views of either organization.
Rather, they have been intended to stimulate
and inform a dynamic, new public discourse
across the Arab world and beyond. In the case
of this year’s report, however, I feel it neces-
sary to state that some of the views expressed
by the authors are not shared by UNDP or the
UN. Nevertheless, the very strength of this
report and the success of its predecessors has
depended on their being seen as an authentic
reflection of views and analysis of many of the
most thoughtful, reform-minded intellectual
figures in the Arab region. In that sense, this
report clearly reflects a very real anger and
concern felt across the region that needs to
be urgently addressed if we are to reach our
shared goal of helping to build a peaceful,
democratic region able to meet the needs and
aspirations of its citizens.
Mark Malloch Brown.
Administrator, UNDP
III III
The Arab Human Development Reports con-
tinue to examine the factors that prevent
an Arab renaissance from taking off, and to
search for those that could empower it to
advance and progress. In this third install-
ment in the series, the Report focuses on the
issue of freedom in the Arab world and its
relationship to good governance and human
development.
The road to AHDR 3 has been long, event-
ful and lined with several obstacles. No sub-
ject excites stronger feelings in the region than
that of freedom, whether among those denied
it or among those who violate and confiscate
it. No public discourse on any issue is more
watchfully invigilated by the authorities, or
more tightly encircled by penalties that push
some to exercise self-censorship, in speech
and thought, wherever the discussion relates
to freedom. The difficulties are magnified
when the definition of freedom is expanded,
as in the case of this Report, to include the
freedom of society and nations where liberty
is confronted by powers intolerant of dissent,
diversity and independent thinking.
Those in our region who demand freedom,
and who struggle for it, may be in the major-
ity; however, those who stifle it are stronger,
more powerful and have better means. They
not only possess the means to oppress, mar-
ginalize and impoverish, but they also control
key forums and are able to recruit those adept
at twisting various texts to perpetuate their in-
terests and at bending intellectual norms and
theories in order to prohibit freedom and per-
mit its confiscation.
There were those who genuinely feared
that the Report might be used to serve the in-
terests of powers willing to transform causes
honourable in their intent, design and aims
into goods in political bargains. The Report
team, however, felt that the best way forward
was not to turn a blind eye to reality, but to
show that Arabs can recognize and overcome
their own weaknesses. Self-reform originat-
ing in balanced self-criticism is the only vi-
able path towards a robust and independent
region.
Despite such difficulties, or perhaps be-
cause of them, the authors remained con-
vinced that their vision of this Report, in all
essentials, was correct. They studied the
scene of freedom in different theatres in the
Arab world, and found them deficient in some
areas and seriously deficient in others, such as
political and civil liberties. Generalized viola-
tions, moreover, become harsher when they
concern those religious or ethnic groups that
are excluded from citizenship or rights. While
some foreign factors including occupation
which usurps the roots of freedom, helped to
establish a climate of oppression in some Arab
countries, there are legal, economic and politi-
cal structures within Arab societies that con-
tinue to prevent Arabs from enjoying rights
and freedoms that were enshrined in their
values, culture and religion well before the
promulgation of the International Declaration
of Human Rights. Sadly, what Arab constitu-
tions grant, Arab laws frequently curtail. And
what laws render legal, actual practice often
violates. People are thus besieged in their own
country, their takeoff is held back, their devel-
opment is blocked, and their nation is weak-
ened.
There are, however, enlightened contem-
porary movements working for a transforma-
tion to societies where human rights reign
supreme, freedoms flourish and the rule of law
strikes deep roots. In the past year the Arab
world witnessed unprecedented initiatives
aimed at changing the status quo. Some, such
as the resolutions of the Arab Summit, were
formal while many others came from civil and
political society. The report also notes a num-
ber of positive developments particularly in
Foreword by the Regional Director, UNDP
Regional Bureau for Arab States
IV
the field of education and the empowerment
of women.
As part of its now-customary method, the
Report does not stop at diagnosing obstacles to
rights and freedoms. It outlines a broad-based
strategic vision of how to rationalize efforts to
strengthen freedom in the Arab world and to
reinforce the pillars of good governance.
This vision focuses on widening the politi-
cal space in order to move societies towards
the peaceful alternation of power and on cre-
ating a strong legal and institutional structure
in support of freedom, The first step in this
direction is to launch the key freedoms of
opinion, expression and organization, to put
an end to all forms of discrimination against
social groups, to abolish emergency rules and
to ensure the independence and fairness of the
justice system.
No matter how hard I try, I will not be
able to do justice to the collective effort that
this Report represents. But like any human
endeavour, however true and worthwhile, this
effort remains open to refinement and correc-
tion. The authors do not claim to have arrived
at any form of final truth about the state of
freedom and governance in the region. Their
goal has been to promote, within the limita-
tions of this sensitive arena, as thorough and
objective a discussion on the challenges fac-
ing Arab societies and the means to overcome
them.
It is especially important to make the issue
of freedom the subject of a constructive de-
bate in our societies. Important and urgent,
for freedom is not only the most instrumen-
tal of enabling human rights anywhere in the
world, but in our region, it is also, increas-
ingly, the most fragile.
Lastly, I hope that readers will excuse us
if, because of the delay in issuing this Report,
they find that some events reported in Part
I have been outpaced by fast-moving devel-
opments in the region. Hopefully, the next
report in the series, on the empowerment of
Arab women, will be an opportunity to make
amends.
I wish to express my sincere thanks to
those Arab states that allowed the Report
team to carry out our field survey on free-
dom, which raised the standard of this aspect
of our research: I salute here Algeria, Jordan,
Lebanon, Morocco and Palestine.
I am especially grateful to all who partici-
pated in the preparation, review, translation
and editing of AHDR3. I would like also to
express my sincere thanks to a number of Arab
intellectuals, whose joint concern for Arab ad-
vancement prompted them to make enriching
contributions to the Report. My gratitude also
goes to the Core Team for its innovative ef-
forts and to its leader, Dr. Nader Fergany for
his distinctive work and persistent follow-up
through all its stages. I owe a sincere vote of
thanks to the Advisory Board for its expert di-
rection and informed advice, which - as usual
- added depth and originality to the Report.
I am particularly grateful to Mr. Mark
Malloch Brown, the Administrator of the
United Nations Development Programme
(UNDP), for his courageous decision to allow
a publication attended by obvious political
risks to appear bearing the emblem of the or-
ganization. In upholding the authors’ right to
an uncensored international platform while
reserving his right to disagree with them on
some matters, he has provided an immaculate
example of what free expression truly means.
I would also like to thank my colleagues in the
Regional Bureau for Arab States, and in par-
ticular Mr. Zahir Jamal, Chief of the Regional
Programme Division, for their dedication,
hard work, and untiring support to the pro-
duction of the Report series. Finally, I would
like to express my great appreciation of our
enduring partnership with the Arab Fund for
Economic and Social Development. It is also
a great pleasure to welcome to the series our
new regional partner, AGFUND, and to ex-
tend my warm appreciation to its President,
His Royal Highness, Prince Talal Bin Abdul
Aziz, for his vision in electing to co-sponsor
these efforts on behalf of the Arab peoples.
Rima Khalaf Hunaidi
Assistant Secretary General and Assistant Administrator, Regional Director,
Regional Bureau for Arab States, United Nations Development Programme
V
The first Arab Human Development Report
diagnosed the crisis facing human develop-
ment in the Arab world and highlighted key
deficits in the fields of knowledge acquisi-
tion, freedom and women’s empowerment.
The Second Report elaborated in details the
issues of knowledge and the establishment of
a strategic vision to develop it. Both reports
were highly appreciated at the Arab and inter-
national levels, for their contribution to the
revival of a deep and constructive dialogue
with a vision to develop and advance our
Arab society.
The Report at hand is the third in this series
of Human Development Reports. It addresses
the issue of freedom from several perspec-
tives, its dimensions, intellectual foundations,
legal and political structures, its regional and
international and the future vision.
Effective participation and positive action
at all economic and social spheres is known
to increase people’s capabilities and poten-
tials. Exercising freedom within institutional
frameworks and good governance is the most
catalytic factor for achieving these capabili-
ties and potentials. Therefore, the goal of this
report, in our opinion, is to review elements
of Governance, as one of the pillars of reform
that will result in achieving progress in every
respect.
The basis and programs of reforming the
institutional structure and good governance
must come from within and in harmony with
the history and heritage of each country.
These reforms must affect all social struc-
tures starting from the individual, the family
to the social groups that constitute the whole
national society. Several country level experi-
ences demonstrate that success was achieved
only when commitments to the principles of
development extend to include the whole of
society.
Emphasizing the rule of law, enhancement
of freedom, independence of the judiciary,
equal opportunities, at all levels, will enhance
the prospects of successful development in the
Arab states. This will be an essential factor to
accelerate the regions integration in the global
trends of political, economic, human and cul-
tural development.
Although this report may not necessar-
ily represent the views of the Arab Fund for
Economic and Social Development, it de-
cided to participate with the United Nations
Development Program in issuing this report
out of a sense of conviction in the importance
of free dialogue in building societies, and to-
wards achieving economic and social advance-
ment.
Despite the serious obstacles and chal-
lenges that are facing Arab development at
the present time, this air of pessimism should
not dominate our minds and visions for the fu-
ture. The Arab states nonetheless have made
important economic and social achievements
during the past few decades. In this regard,
one should also recall the dark periods of co-
lonialism, poor economic, financial and social
situations in which the countries of the region
were at the eve of independence.
We have great confidence in the ability of
the Arab states to enhance their progress in
confronting the major challenges facing their
citizens. We may differ in the methodologies
and visions, but we should never differ over
the fact that serious efforts towards more
openness, freedom and physical and human
development is the key to progress in all so-
cieties.
Finally, I extend my sincere thanks and
Foreword by the Director General and Chairman
The Arab Fund for Economic and Social
Development
VI VI
appreciation to all those who participated in
the preparation, discussion, revision and is-
suance of this report in the form that we see
it today. I would like also to express my high-
est appreciation and consideration to the
United Nations Development Programme
for sponsoring this distinguished effort and
to the Arab Gulf Programme for the United
Nations Development Organizations
(AGFUND) for its contribution to this seri-
ous work.
We pray to Allah to guide to the right
actions and lead us greater success.
Abdel Latif Youseff El Hamed
Director General / Chairman of the Board of Directors
Arab Fund for Economic and Social Development
VII
The transparency we believe in and subscribe
to prompts me to admit a sense of ten-
sion when we agreed to contribute to the
funding of this edition of the Arab Human
Development Report. This conflict was in no
way personal in nature. For the content of
the Report and its pivotal theme – Freedom
and Good Governance – are core issues that
have been of great interest to us for decades
at the personal, institutional and public levels.
The positive momentum caused by the First
and the Second reports led us to contribute
to the launch of the third, which gives an
in-depth analysis of the call for freedom and
the indispensable governance institutions and
strengthens their significance in our societies.
The conflict stems mainly from differ-
ences between longtime convictions on the
one hand, and the attitudes, whether favor-
able or guarded, toward the Report’s con-
tent, its rigorous scientific methodology and
statistical data on the other. What we and all
sincere people hope for is that such conflict
be resolved in a manner consistent with the
spirit of transparency and self-criticism. Since
we have rejected all the pressures exercised
from all directions to obstruct the launch of
this Report, we should at least avoid making
similar mistakes. As the conventional wisdom
says, “it is greatly disgraceful and discreditable
if you advise against a particular conduct and
allow yourself to do it all the same!” Although
we do not agree with some of the items in this
Report and have our own views about them,
we would still support its launch in order not
to lock away the other point of view.
The comprehensive first Arab Human de-
velopment Report came to the conclusion that
three fundamental deficits stand in the way
of Arab development in the Arab countries;
in the areas of knowledge, freedom and good
governance, and enabling women. The second
report dealt in some detail with the various di-
mensions of the first issue, i. e. the acquisition,
reproduction and dissemination of knowledge.
The third report comes in the same scientific
context, taking the question of consolidating
freedom and safeguarding it by good govern-
ment as a pivotal theme for thoughtful inves-
tigation and prudent and perceptive analysis.
The Report examines the status of freedom
and rights in our Arab homeland, and scruti-
nizes its institutional structures in the legisla-
tive, legal and political areas in their national,
regional and international frameworks. It also
suggests guidelines for a strategic vision for
desired and possible alternative prospects for
freedom and governance in the Arab states.
Freedom, and its various facets and mani-
festations, and the ways in which it could be
protected and strengthened by good gover-
nance, represents one of the motives that en-
couraged us, decades ago, to put in our modest
share and contribution to bring about reform
in the Arab World. Our mission has centered
on providing support to sustainable human
development efforts, targeting the neediest
groups in the developing countries, including
the Arab region. Our support efforts have
covered a wide range of deprived communi-
ties, particularly women and children, in co-
operation with the international development
organizations, local associations and other in-
stitutions active in the field of human develop-
ment. These efforts, we hope, have left their
impact on the quality of life of tens of thou-
sands of people in disadvantaged segments of
society, and helped save them from dire need,
severe disease and dismal ignorance.
One of our prime concerns has been the
promotion of serious studies that shore up the
development process and examine both the
Foreword by HRH The President of the Arab
Gulf Programme for United Nations Development
Organizations (AGFUND)
VIII
incentives and the obstacles in its way. We
therefore believe that the successful launch-
ing of the third issue of the Arab Human
Development Report series tones with
and complements our call for bridging the
gaps in strategic studies in the Arab region.
Sustaining this venture poses great chal-
lenges and requires resolute determination
and unshakable will.
We have often stated and on various oc-
casions that human rights go hand in hand
with human dignity, and that citizenship
remains incomplete unless it is enhanced
by human rights. We have furthermore
stressed that democracy is an essential com-
ponent of the human heritage, and an indis-
pensable mechanism for reform. No serious
dialogue could be initiated and maintained
and brought to fruition outside an envi-
ronment of political, economic and social
reform, and without democratic practices
and cultural open-mindedness. We have
also emphasized that rational dialogue and
debate inside and amongst us is an essential
prerequisite for a credible dialogue with the
outside world.
The authors of this Report who repre-
sent a team of competent scholars and in-
tellectuals from all over the Arab World,
recognize that the way out of the grim sta-
tus quo towards a peaceful entry into the
gates of freedom and good governance is
an arduous, protracted process that cannot
be accomplished overnight. However, we
are fully aware of the consequences of any
delay or obstruction of the desired reform,
and any attempt to substitute this process
by cosmetic touches that do not touch upon
the essence of the pressing issues, and do
not respond to the grave challenges at hand.
The result will extend yet another invitation
to foreign forces and schemes bent on exer-
cising further control of the resources and
destinies of people in the Arab World.
Much like its predecessors, this Report
will perhaps stimulate debate with a view to
evolving development and reform visions.
The need for such strategy is all the more
pressing now if the Arab World wishes to
join the development-oriented efforts and,
specifically, move closer to the Millennium
Development Goals in order to fulfill the as-
pirations of our societies. The first step is to
draw up strategies based on a rigorous anal-
ysis of the situation and guided by science,
knowledge and good governance, through
support generated by local, regional and
international partnerships. The Arab world
must also embark on bold reforms in the
main pillars of the state on the basis of
transparency, accountability and sound and
proper policies.
We have great expectations of the grow-
ing, confident and forward-moving forces of
change in Arab life. High hopes for a better
future are also pinned on the enlightened
initiatives and trends that are unfolding and
emerging among officials and reformers in
government institutions in our contempo-
rary societies, and among civil society activ-
ist alike.
Talal Bin Abdul Aziz
President
The Arab Gulf Programme for United Nations
Development Organizations AGFUND
IX
Report Team
Advisory Board
Rima Khalaf Hunaidi (Chair), Ahmed Kamal Aboulmagd,
Farida Allaghi, Nabil Alnawwab (Economic and Social
Commission for Western Asia), Mustafa Omar Attir, (the
late) Mervat Badawi* (Arab Fund for Economic and Social
Development), Mustafa Barghouthi, Farida Bennani,
Mohamed Cherfi, (the late) Mamdouh Edwan**, Munira
Fakhro, Ziad Fariz, Mohammed Fayek, Burhan Ghalioun,
Fahmy Howeidy, Nasser Kahtani (Arab Gulf Programme
for United Nations Development Organizations), Taher
H. Kanaan, Atif Kubursi, Clovis Maksoud, Amin Medani,
Abdelouahab Rezig, Ghassan Tuéni.
Core Team
Nader Fergany (Leader), Abdelwahab El-Affendi, Mohamed
Nour Farahat, Marie Rose Zalzal.
Contributing Authors
Marie-Thérèse Abdel-Messih, Ali Abdel Gadir Ali, Mustapha
K. Al Sayyid, Abdallah Al Ashaal, Amna Rashed Al-Hamdan,
Habib Al-Jenhani, Majid A. Al-Moneef, Nabil Alnawwab,
Siham Abdulrahman Alsuwaigh, Mohsen Awad, Azmi
Bishara, Hafidha Chekir, Georges Corm, Abdelwahab El-
Affendi, Jalila El Ati, Mohamed Mahmoud El-Imam, Khalida
Sa’id Esber, Mohamed Nour Farahat, Rafia Obaid Ghubash,
Abdelaziz Guessous, Salah El-Deen Hafez, Mustafa S. Hijazi,
Fahmi Jadaan, Taher H. Kanaan, Abdalla Khalil, Mohammad
Abdalla Khalil, Atif Kubursi, Jonathan Kuttab, Amina
Lemrini, Maryam Sultan Lootah, Mohammed Malki,
Khadija Marouazi, A.Hussain Shaban, Alla Eldin Shalaby,
Marie Rose Zalzal.
Readers Group
(Arabic)
Khalid Abdalla, Farid Abdelkhalek, Kamal Abdellatif,
Madawi Al-Rasheed, Abdulkarim El-Eryani, Haytham
Manna, Mohamed Sid-Ahmed, Naila Silini.
(English)
Ziad Hafez, Michael Hudson, Santosh Mehrotra, Omar
Noman, Mary Rose Oakar, Marina Ottaway, John M. Page,
Alan Richards, Ngaire Woods.
UNDP RBAS / UNOPS
Uzma Ahmed, Dena Assaf, Moez Doraid (Report
Coordinator), Jacqueline Estevez-Camejo, Melissa Esteva,
Ghaith Fariz (Report Coordinator), Oscar Fernandez-
Taranco, Jacqueline Ghazal, Randa Jamal, Zahir Jamal, Mary
Jreidini, Azza M. Karam, Madi Musa, Maen Nsour, Win Min
Nu, William Orme, Ahmad Ragab, Gillman Rebello, Nadine
Shamounki, Amal Tillawi.
Editorial Team
Arabic Version: Fayiz Suyyagh
English Version: Barbara Brewka, Zahir Jamal
Implementation of the freedom survery
- Middle East Marketing and Research Consultants
(MEMRC) / Amman, Jordan (Coordination + Questionnaire
Design & Unifying Data Files).
- Societe D’etude De Realisation De Consultants (SEREC)/
Casablanca , Morocco.
- Jerusalem Media and Communication Center (JMCC) /
East Jerusalem, Palestine.
- Statistics Lebanon Ltd. / Beirut, Lebanon.
- Cabinet Tiers – Consult / Alger.
Statistical tables on human development in Arab
countries
Mohamad Baquer
Translation Team
June Ray (Coordinator), Sara Ansah, Marilyn Booth,
Humphrey Davies, Shohrat el-A’alem, Bruce Inksetter,
Nehad Salem.
Cover Design
Designer: Walid Gadow,
Calligraphy and Graphics: Mamoun Sakkal.
Technical Consultant for Design and Printing
Hassan Shahin
* Mervat Badawi: Exceptional lady who bestowed profound knowledge and care on the Arab Human Development Report since its incep-
tion but departed our world when this report was about to appear.
** Mamdouh Edwan: Distinguished Arab poet who has not been dettered by terminal illness from actively participating in the delibera-
tions of the AHDR 3 Advisory group.
X
Contents
Foreword by the Administrator, UNDP
Foreword by the Regional Director, UNDP/Regional Bureau for Arab States
Foreword by the Director General and Chairman, Board of Directors, Arab Fund for Economic and Social Development
Foreword by HRH The President of the Arab Gulf Programme for United Nations Development Organizations (AGFUND)
PREFACE 1
THIS REPORT 1
Introduction 1
Freedom and Human Development 1
The Main Conclusions of the First and Second Arab Human Development Reports 3
Contents of this Report 3
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY 5
Introduction 5
Changes In Human Development Since The Launch Of AHDR 2003 5
Calls For Reform Intensify 5
A Constraining Regional and International Environment 6
Israeli occupation of Palestine continues to impede human development and freedom 6
The impact of the occupation of Iraq on human development 7
Addressing The Three Deficits: Progress and Reversals 7
The State Of Freedom And Good Governance 8
The State Of Freedoms and Rights 8
Civil and Political Freedoms: From Deficient to Seriously Deficient 9
The denial of individuals’ fundamental freedoms 9
Exclusion from citizenship 10
Abusing minority rights 10
Women doubly excluded 10
Unmet Economic and Social Rights 10
How Far Do Arabs Believe That They Enjoy Freedom? 11
Structures Impeding Freedom 11
Region-Specific Problematic Issues 12
The contradiction between freedom in Arab countries and narrow global interests 12
Freedom shorn of effective advocates 12
Appropriating religion to perpetuate tyranny 12
“The trap of the one-off election” 12
Specificity as a pretext for slighting human rights 13
The Legal Architecture 13
Constitutions granting rights and laws confiscating them 13
And constitutions flatly violating rights 14
The Political Architecture 15
The “black-hole” State 15
The crisis of legitimacy 16
I
III
V
VII
XI
Repression and political impoverishment 16
The vicious circle of repression and corruption 17
Societal Structures 17
The chain that stifles individual freedom 17
A mode of production that strengthens authoritarian governance 18
A longing for freedom and justice in popular culture 18
An Inhospitable Global and Regional Environment For Freedom 18
A Strategic Vision: Alternative Futures For Freedom And Governance In Arab Countries 19
Alternative Scenarios 19
The impending disaster scenario 19
The “Izdihar” alternative 19
The “Half Way House” scenario: the accommodation of external reform 20
Reforming Arab Societal Structures to Guarantee Freedom 20
Internal reform 20
Changes at the pan-Arab level 21
Governance at the global level 21
Achieving Peaceful Political Alternation in Arab Countries 22
Epilogue: the furthest lotus tree 22
PART I
CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003 25
Introduction 25
Arab Initiatives To Promote Region-wide Reform 25
Official Arab Reform Efforts 25
Formal initiatives 25
Civil Society Reform Initiatives 26
The Struggle Waged By Civil and Political Forces in The Arab World 26
Freedom and respect for human rights 26
Stronger grass-roots participation 27
Towards political reform 27
Towards peace 28
External Attempts At Change: The Broader Middle East Initiative 29
The Regional and International Context 29
Israeli Occupation of Palestine Continues to Constrain Human Development and Freedom 30
Violations of the right to life 30
Violations of human rights and individual and collective freedoms 31
Social and economic losses 31
The separation wall undermines human development 32
Looking to the Future 33
The Impact of the occupation of Iraq on Human Development 33
Absence of security and violations of the right to life 33
The right to freedom 34
Mis-treatment of prisoners of war and detainees 34
Dismantling the Iraqi State structure 35
Looking to the future 35
XII
The escalation of terrorism 35
Addressing the Three Deficits: Gains and Setbacks 36
Knowledge Acquisition 36
Freedom and Governance 38
Signs of political openness 38
Indications of a regression in popular participation 39
Freedoms constrained 39
Freedom of civil society organizations 40
Restrictions on the media 40
Rights of subgroups: Darfur 41
Protest by intellectuals 41
The Empowerment of Women 41
Conclusion 43
PART II - REINFORCING FREEDOM AND ESTABLISHING GOOD GOVERNANCE 45
Section 1: Analytical Framework: Freedom, Good Governance and Human Development 45
CHAPTER ONE
THE INTELLECTUAL BASIS AND CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND GOOD GOVERNANCE 47
Introduction 47
Freedom in Western Liberal Thought: From Individual Freedom to Human Development 47
The Primacy of Individual Liberties 47
Individual Freedom and Societal Regulation 48
The essence of democracy and democratic transition 48
Problematic Issues of Freedom: Liberalism and Democracy, Attributes of Majority Rule 49
The danger of tyranny of the majority 49
Tension between Freedom and Democracy? Or Democracy without Freedom? 50
Freedom and the Other Ultimate Human Goals 50
Freedom as Human Development: Reconciling Individual Freedom with Institutional Arrangements 51
Corporate governance and human development 52
Freedom in Arab Culture 53
Freedom in Arab History 53
Religious Freedom 53
Political Freedom 54
Social Freedom 54
Economic Freedom 54
Freedom in the Modern Context 54
From Freedom to Emancipation 55
Freedom From an Islamic Perspective 56
Freedom and Liberation 58
The Rights of Freedom 59
The Arab Renaissance and the Challenge of Freedom 60
The concept of freedom and good governance in this Report 61
XIII
CHAPTER TWO
FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES AT THE BEGINNING OF THE THIRD MILLENNIUM:
SOME PROBLEMATIC ISSUES. 65
Introduction 65
The Tension Between Freedom and Democratic Institutions in the Arab World 65
The Contradiction Between Freedom in Arab Countries and the Interests of Dominant Global Powers 65
The Crisis of Democracy After September 11 67
Freedom Bereft of Organized Support 67
“Oriental Despotism” and the Arab Societal Context 68
Democracy and Religion 68
Democracy and Islam: Potential for Harmony 69
Democracy and the Arab Region: The Trap of the One-off Election 71
Freedom and Human Rights 71
The Importance of the Human Rights System 71
International Human Rights Law 72
The Applicability of International Human Rights Law to Arab Countries 74
The Challenge of Peaceful Transition to a Society of Freedom and Good Governance in the Arab Countries 77
PART II, Section 2: The State of Freedom and Governance in Arab Countries
79
CHAPTER THREE
THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS 81
Introduction 81
81
Freedoms and Human Rights 81
Structural Constraints on Freedom 82
Flawed structure of Arab nation-states 82
Political constraints on the authority of the human rights system 82
The crisis of citizenship 83
National Freedom 83
Civil and Political Freedoms in Arab States 84
Freedom of opinion, expression and creativity 84
Stifling creativity 85
Freedom of association: civil society institutions 87
Freedom to form political parties 87
Freedom to form associations and surveillance of their activities 87
Trade unions and professional associations 88
The right to participation: 88
Individual Freedoms 89
Freedom of opinion and belief 89
Freedom of privacy and personal life 89
XIV
Denial of Fundamental Individual Freedoms 90
Violation of basic rights 90
The right to life 90
The right to liberty and personal safety 90
The right to a fair and impartial trial 91
Exclusion from citizenship 91
Deprivation of citizenship 91
Abusing the rights of minority groups. 91
Women doubly excluded 92
Social and Economic Rights 93
The Right to Lead a Long, Healthy Life 94
The right to food and adequate nutrition: 94
The right to a healthy life 95
Physical health 95
Psychological health 96
The right to acquire knowledge 96
The quality of education and health services in Arab countries 96
Perceived Enjoyment of Freedom in Contemporary Arab Opinion, Freedom Survey 2003 97
The Perception of Freedom Among Contemporary Arabs 97
Extent of Enjoyment of Freedom at the Time of the Survey (2003) 100
Perceived Change in the Enjoyment of Freedom in Contemporary Arab Opinion 100
PART II, Section 3: The Societal Context Of Freedom And Governance 105
CHAPTER FOUR
THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE 107
Introduction 107
The Institutional Architecture of Freedom and Governance 107
Arab States and International Human Rights Standards 107
Legislative Regulation of Freedoms in Arab Constitutions 109
Law and Justice, Public Order and National Security as Excuses to Limit Freedom 109
Overview of Arab Constitutions 109
Freedom of Opinion and Expression 109
Freedom to Form Associations and Freedom of Peaceful Assembly 110
Freedom to Form Political Parties 110
The Human Right to Litigation and the Principle of the Independence of the Judiciary 111
The international perspective and the Arab constitutional reality 111
The legal profession and public freedoms 113
Right of Nationality 114
Personal Rights 114
Constitutional Violations of Human Rights 115
Legislative Restrictions on Human Rights in Arab Legislation 116
Legislative Restrictions on the Right of Peaceful Assembly 116
XV
Legislative Restrictions on the Right of Political Organization 117
Legislative Restrictions on Freedom to form Associations 118
Restrictions on Freedom of Opinion, Expression and the Press in Arab Legislation 118
Pre-censorship and suspension by administrative decision 119
Curtailment of freedom on the pretext of security 119
Denying the right to obtain information 119
Harsher conditions for newspaper publication 120
Legal Restrictions on Public Freedoms During a State of Emergency 120
Legislative Regulation of the Role of the Judiciary in Protecting Human Rights and Freedoms 121
Independence of the judiciary (legislative regulation and practice) 121
Exceptional courts 123
The Impact of Authoritarian Power Relations on Freedom and Human Rights 123
CHAPTER FIVE
THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE 125
Introduction 125
The Crisis of Governance in Arab Countries 125
Characteristics of Authoritarian Governance 125
The “black-hole” State 126
Extra-judicial Controls 127
Tracing the Flaw 128
The Crisis of Legitimacy 129
Repression and Political Impoverishment 131
Weakening of Political Parties 131
The Marginalization of Civil Society 132
The status of Arab civil society 132
The State of Corporate Governance in the Arab World 133
Transparency 133
Accountability 134
Inclusiveness 134
Corporate governance and Arab stock markets 135
The vicious Circle of Repression and Corruption 135
Contours of Corruption in Arab Countries 137
Petty Corruption 137
The Arab Countries in the Global Context of Governance, 2002 138
The Debate on How to Reform 140
The Discourse on Reform 141
Change from the top or at grass-roots? 141
External versus internal 141
The Optimum Choice 142
Bridging the gap between political forces 143
XVI
CHAPTER SIX
ARAB SOCIETAL STRUCTURES AND THE REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL ENVIRONMENTS 145
Introduction 145
Societal Structures 145
The Chain that Stifles Individual Freedom 145
Clannism (al-‘asabiya) in Arab Society—the Authoritarian Paternalist System and the Family 145
Education 147
Freedom in the content of education in three Maghreb countries 148
The World of Work 149
The Political Realm 150
Poverty and the class structure 150
Is this stranglehold eternal? 151
A Mode Of Production that Reinforces Authoritarianism 151
The Longing For Freedom and Justice in Popular Culture 153
The Global and Regional Context 154
Globalization and Freedom 154
Governance at the Global Level 155
The Impact of the “War on Terror” on Freedom 156
Governance at the Regional Level 157
PART II, Section 4: Towards Reinforcing Freedom and Establishing Good Governance in the Arab Countries 161
CHAPTER SEVEN
A STRATEGIC VISION OF FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES – ALTERNATIVE FUTURES 163
Introduction 163
Grounds for Peaceful and Deep Political Alteration, Alternative Futures 163
Reasons for Change 163
Alternative Arab Futures 164
The impending disaster scenario: maintaining the ‘Status Quo’ 164
The ideal scenario: the “Izdihar” alternative 164
The “Half Way House” scenario: the accommodation of external reform 165
How to Deal with Reform Initiatives from Outside? 165
Universal Features and Aims of the Desired System of Governance 166
Reforming Arab Societal Structures to Guarantee Freedom: 166
The Internal Challenge 166
Enhancing the legal and institutional foundations that underpin freedom 166
Adherence to international human rights law 167
Binding the ruling authority to the rule of law 167
Guaranteeing freedoms and rights at the heart of the constitution 167
Strengthening civil and political rights in law 168
Guaranteeing the independence of the judiciary 169
Abolishing the state of emergency. 169
Guarantees for personal freedom 169
Ending discrimination against societal groups 170
XVII
The Political Architecture 170
Problematic issues in guaranteeing sound democratic arrangements 170
Code of Conduct for Societal Forces on the Path to Reform 171
Obligations of the State: 171
Obligations of the political élites: 171
Obligations of civil society: 171
Parliamentary representation: 172
Reforming Arab Institutional Performance 172
Correcting the Arab Development Trajectory 173
The Reform of Corporate Governance 173
At the Pan-Arab level 174
Liberation from Occupation 175
Governance at the Global Level 176
A Role for the UN and Other International Agencies 177
Achieving Peaceful Political Alternation in Arab Countries in Order to Build Freedom and Good Governance: the ‘Izdihar’ Scenario. 177
Act 1: Liberation of Civil Society, Laying the Foundation for Comprehensive Legal and Political Reform 178
Epilogue: the Furthest Lotus Tree 179
REFERENCES
181
ANNEX 1: MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
191
ANNEX 2: SELECTED DOCUMENTS
215
ANNEX 3: LIST OF BACKGROUND PAPERS
233
ANNEX 4: STATISTICAL TABLES ON HUMAN DEVELOPMENT IN THE ARAB COUNTRIES
234
LIST OF BOXES
P1 Freedom and good governance: an historical legacy 2
1 Declaration on the Process of Reform and Modernisation in the Arab World (excerpts) 26
2 The Arab people’s views on the importance of the Palestinian question 30
3 Unnoticed Losses 31
4 World Bank President Finds Israel’s Conduct Shameful 31
5 By Law, This Wall Should Come Down - Findings of the International Court of Justice (ICJ). 32
6 Israel’s Restrictions on Churches in the Holy Land 33
7 Conclusion of the Taguba Report 35
8 Quality Assessment of Primary and Middle Education in Mathematics and Science (TIMSS 2003) in
the Arab World RAB01/005/A/01/31 36
9 “Development” of the University of the United Arab Emirates 36
10 An Assessment of Business Administration Programmes in Arab Universities 37
11 The Moroccan Family Code 42
1-1 Natural Human Rights 47
1-2 Freedom of opinion as a sacred right 48
XVIII
1-3 Ahmed Kamal Aboulmagd: The principle of equality 51
1-4 Al Kawakibi: Freedom and Dignity 55
1-5 Naseef Nassar: The Reconstruction of Liberalism 60
1-6 Freedom for its own sake 61
1-7 The Charter of Medina 62
1-8 Setting the deviant ruler straight 63
1-9 Al-Kawakibi: Importance of holding the ruling authority accountable 63
1-10 Corporate governance 63
1-11 Taha Hussein: Freedom and Independence 64
2-1 The Reasons behind the Failure of Democracy in Arab Countries: Perceptions of a Western Scholar 66
2-2 Abdallah al-Arawy: Freedom and Liberalism in the Arab Context 67
2-3 Ibn al-Qayim al-Jawziya: On welfare 69
2-4 Imam Muhammad Abdu: The Legitimacy of Elections 70
2-5 Ayatollah al-Mohaqiq al-Naeeny: An Opinion Concerning Conditionality or Constitutionality 70
2-6 Boasting about human rights while destroying them 71
2-7 Declaration on the Right to Development Adopted by General Assembly Resolution 41/128 of 4 December 1986(excerpts) 71
2-8 Muhammad Shahrour: A Word About Freedom 73
2-9 The Pact of the Virtuous (Hilf al-fudul) 74
2-10 Human rights: universality and specificity 74
2-11 The Contribution of Arab States to the Universal Declaration of Human Rights and the Two International Covenants 75
2-12 Haytham Manna’a: The Books of Tribulations 76
2-13 Freedom and Emancipation 77
2-14 Timing the call for freedom 77
3-1 Ali Ibn Al Hussein: The Epistle on Rights 81
3-2 Marwan al-Barghouti (from his prison cell): I will overcome the cell and the occupiers 84
3-3 Al-Manfaluti: The value of freedom that has been stolen 86
3-4 Khalida Said: Creativity - Between Consciousness and Dreams 87
3-5 Declaration on the Right and Responsibility of Individuals, Groups and Organs of Society to Promote and Protect
Universally Recognized Human Rights and Fundamental Freedoms, 1999 (excerpts) 89
3-6 Freedom Survey, Arab Human Development Report 98
4-1 The right to form political parties 110
4-2 Constitutional restrictions on rights 115
4-3 Restrictions on the rights to assembly and association 117
5-1 Muhammad Al-Charfi: Arab democracy - form without substance 130
5-2 Capital market legal reforms 135
5-3 Moncef Al-Marzouqi: Giving democracy every chance 142
6-1 Education and Human Rights in Arab Countries 147
6-2 Educational Development in Tunisia 150
6-3 Omar ibn Abd al-Aziz: Justice and the law, not the sword and the whip 150
6-4 Counsellor Yahya al-Rifai: Justice Above Might 156
6-5 The UN Special Rapporteur on Terrorism and Human Rights: The Root Causes of Terrorism 157
6-6 Adib al-Jadir: Hussein Jamil, An Iraqi Arab Activist Who Pursued Freedom 160
7-1 Mahdi Bunduq, Post-Bourgeois Society 166
7-2 Perpetuating power in the name of democracy and the people 167
7-3 Ten Principles for a Constitution of Freedom and Good Governance 168
7-4 The Supreme Constitutional Court in Egypt 168
7-5 Recommended Good Governance Institutions at the Pan-Arab Level 175
7-6 Excerpts from the Address by the UN Secretary General, Kofi Annan, at the Opening Session of the General Assembly,
New York, 21 September 2004. 176
7-7 Guaranteeing freedom for civil society 178
XIX
LIST OF FIGURES
3-1 Percentage agreeing that women should have equal rights, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 93
3-2 Estimate of the extent of deprivation of human capabilities, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 94
3-3 Years of life expectancy lost to disease, by gender, Arab countries and comparator countries, 2002 95
3-4 Extent of satisfaction with the level and cost of education and health services by sector (public/private), five Arab countries,
Freedom Survey, 2003 97
3-5a Percentage of interviewees considering the elements of freedom part of their concept of freedom (%) Average of five
Arab countries (weighted by population), Freedom Survey, 2003
98
3-5b Percentage of interviewees considering the elements of freedom constituents of their concept of freedom Five Arab countries,
Freedom Survey, 2003 99
3-6a Extent of enjoyment of the elements of freedom (%), average of five Arab countries (weighted by population), Freedom Survey, 2003 100
3-6b Extent of enjoyment of the elements of freedom (%), average of five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 101
3-7a Perceived change in the enjoyment of elements of freedom (net %) during the five years preceding the survey, average of five
Arab countries (weighted by population), Freedom Survey, 2003 102
3-7b Perceived change in the enjoyment of elements of freedom (net %) during the five years preceding the survey, average of five
Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 103
4-1 Extent of willingness to go to court, Five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 122
5-1 Perceived absence of government accountability and lack of freedom of opinion and expression, five Arab countries,
Freedom Survey, 2003 128
5-2 Extent of confidence in political institutions, five Arab countries 132
5-3 Corruption Perception Index, World and Arab Countries, 2003 136
5-4 Areas in which corruption is perceived to be widespread, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 137
5-5 Extent to which different societal groups are believed to be involved in the spread of corruption, five Arab countries,
Freedom Survey, 2003 137
5-6 Knowledge of acts of bribery or "favouritism" (wasta*) during the 12 months preceding the survey, five Arab countries,
Freedom Survey, 2003 138
5-7 Reason for paying a bribe or using wasta during the 12 months preceding the survey, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 139
5-8 The best way to obtain a favour or to avoid a penalty, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 139
5-9 Voice and accountability, the Arab region compared to other world regions, 2002 140
5-10 Political stability, the Arab region compared to other world regions, 2002 140
5-11 Government effectiveness, the Arab region compared to other world regions, 2002 140
5-12 The rule of law, the Arab region compared to other world regions, 2002 141
5-13 Control of corruption, the Arab region compared to other world regions, 2002 141
6-1 The share of taxes in public revenues and the share of income taxes in total tax revenues (%), Arab countries, 1992-2002 153
6-2 Credibility of the Arab League and the United Nations: Estimates by five Arab states and comparator countries 158
6-3 Extent of satisfaction with the current level of Arab cooperation, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 160
7-1 Extent of dissatisfaction over the presence of foreign military bases, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 164
7-2 Preferred forms of stronger Arab cooperation, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 174
7-3 Perception of just solutions to the Palestinian question, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 175
LIST OF TABLES
4-1 Status of Ratifications of the Principal International Human Rights Treaties, January 2005 108
XX
PREFACE
This Report
THIS REPORT 1
Introduction
The first Arab Human Development Report
(AHDR 2002) provided a comprehensive,
first hand overview of the situation in the
Arab region from the perspective of human
development. Its goal was to provide an
objective analysis based on serious self-
criticism and aimed at assuring freedom and
dignity for all Arabs
1
. The Report diagnosed
three cardinal deficits impeding human de-
velopment in Arab countries: in knowledge
acquisition, freedom and good governance,
and women’s empowerment. As a broad
overview, that first Report did not explore
these deficits in depth. Rather, it made the
case for an extended analysis of each in order
to promote a discussion about how to over-
come them.
Accordingly, the second Report analysed
the knowledge acquisition deficit in the Arab
world in some depth, ending with a strategic
vision for establishing a knowledge society in
the region.
Continuing such extended treatment, this
third Report provides a thorough examination
of the deficit of freedom and good govern-
ance, a topic that dominates current discourse
within the region and abroad. It is hoped that
this detailed analysis will stimulate a dialogue
in Arab societies on how to expand freedom
and establish good governance. A serious and
objective debate around the substance of this
Report would pave the way for a process of
social innovation leading to a genuine project
for an Arab renaissance.
The first two Reports prompted a wide
public response, for and against their find-
ings, both inside and outside the Arab world,
which underlined the sharp relevance of the
issues raised, and the importance of addressing
them at this critical period in the course of the
region.
Unfortunately, as with other Arab reform
initiatives, some forces outside the Arab world
have used these Reports for their own pur-
poses. This has led some Arabs to call for a halt
to self-criticism in order to avoid giving others a
pretext for interfering in Arab affairs. This call,
however, rests on flawed logic. It assumes that
others have sought to interfere in the region’s
affairs in response to such self-criticism by
Arabs and not because of their own interests.
These interests and ambitions have turned
into interventions for two reasons. The first is
active: it reflects the considerable capabilities
that foreign powers can muster to pursue their
own ends. The second is passive: it relates to
the weakness of the region, which makes it an
easy target for outside intervention.
The only way for Arabs to deal with the
ambitions of others is to recognize and over-
come their own weaknesses and thus grow
strong enough to prevent foreign objectives
from taking hold. Self-reform originating in
balanced self-criticism is the only viable way
forward towards a robust and independent
region. All committed actors in Arab socie-
ties should be able to rise to the occasion of
their historic mission, which is to stimulate a
renaissance movement. They can best do so
by diagnosing the present regional situation
in human development terms and proposing
ways forward.
FREEDOM AND HUMAN
DEVELOPMENT
Human development is most profoundly seen
as a process of expanding “the range of human
1
The term “Arab” is used in this report to denote all citizens of Arab countries inclusively.
A serious and
objective debate
around the substance
of this Report would
pave the way for
a process of social
innovation.
Self-reform originating
in balanced self-
criticism is the only
viable way forward
towards a robust and
independent region.
2 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
choice”. If human development means increas-
ing people’s choices, then people must have
the freedom to choose among alternatives.
This becomes an absolute priority. Freedom
is pivotal in human development. Indeed, re-
cent theoretical writings on this subject see de-
velopment as synonymous with freedom (Sen
1999).
Thus, in human development terms,
simply by virtue of belonging to humankind,
people have an a priori right to a dignified life,
materially and morally or spiritually, in body,
self and soul. From this starting point two key
conclusions follow:
• First: Human development is incompatible
with any type of discrimination against any
groups of human beings whether defined by
gender, social origin, creed or colour.
• Second: In human development, the con-
cept of well-being is not limited to material
comfort. It includes the non-physical, non-
material aspects of a dignified human life: free-
dom, knowledge, aesthetic pleasure, human
dignity and self-fulfilment. These broader aims
can only be achieved through the individual’s
effective participation in all endeavours of so-
ciety.
Human entitlements, in principle, are in-
finite, and they develop and change continu-
ously in accord with human advancement. At
any level of development, though, the three
basic human entitlements, according to the
global Human Development Report, are: “to
lead a long and healthy life, to acquire knowl-
edge, and to have access to resources needed
for a decent standard of living”. Yet, human
development does not end at this minimal level
of entitlements. Rather, it goes beyond this
minimum to encompass other additional en-
titlements, ranging from “political, economic,
and social freedom to opportunities for being
creative and productive, and enjoying self-re-
spect and guaranteed human rights” (Human
Development Report 1990).
The process of human development is
founded on two principal axes. The first relates
to building those human capabilities that make
it possible to achieve a higher level of human
welfare. These capabilities comprise, first and
foremost, the ability of all people to enjoy a
long and healthy life and to acquire knowledge
and freedom without discrimination. The sec-
ond axis relates to the efficient and appropriate
utilization of human capabilities in all spheres
of human endeavour, including production,
and through people’s active participation in
civil society and politics. The effective devel-
opment and use of human capabilities enlarges
people’s choices and enables them to enjoy
freedom in its comprehensive sense.
Thus, human development in the full sense
that we have adopted, is not merely about
developing “human resources,” neither is it
a “development,” tout court, of human be-
ings, nor is it a matter solely of striving to fulfil
the basic needs of people. It is much more a
humanist and humanitarian blueprint for the
comprehensive, total, and mutually reinforcing
development, of people and social institu-
tions, that aims to realize higher human goals
and aspirations: freedom, justice, and human
dignity.
Narrower definitions of development,
whether limited to ‘economic development’
or to a restricted sense of human development,
lack the rich possibilities of this fuller concept.
In human development thinking, a wealthy
person is not considered to enjoy an advanced
state of well-being so long as that person is
prevented from exercising freedom. Likewise,
history, ancient and contemporary, teaches us
that societies barred from experiencing free-
BOX P1
Freedom and good governance: an historical legacy
“Since when have you compelled people to enslavement, when their mothers birthed
them free?
2

Omar bin al-Khattab
“If the king has treated the people unjustly
We refuse to condone humiliation among us”
Amr bin Kulthum
“The tyrant is the enemy of rights and of freedom; indeed their executioner. Right is
the father of humanity and freedom their mother.”
Abdel-Rahman al-Kawakibi
2
In this saying, Khalifat Omar is addressing the son of his Wali (representative ruler) in Egypt. Of particular note is that the adversary referred to in
the text had a different religion from the Khalifat himself…the adversary was a Christian Coptic. This conflict ended with the Khalifat Omar inflicting
severe punishment on the son of his Wali in Egypt.
Freedom is pivotal in
human development.
The effective
development and use
of human capabilities
enlarges people’s
choices and enables
them to enjoy freedom
in its comprehensive
sense.
3 THIS REPORT
dom are unable to preserve whatever economic
and other gains they may make in a more nar-
row definition of development; and thus, they
cannot attain the higher rungs on the ladder of
human advancement.
THE MAIN CONCLUSIONS OF THE
FIRST AND SECOND ARAB HUMAN
DEVELOPMENT REPORTS
The first AHDR (2002) concluded that “al-
though Arab countries have made significant
strides in more than one area of human devel-
opment in the last three decades...the predomi-
nant characteristic of the current Arab reality
seems to be the existence of deeply rooted
shortcomings in the Arab institutional struc-
ture [which] are an obstacle to building human
development.” As noted earlier, the Report
summarized these shortcomings as three defi-
cits relating to knowledge acquisition, freedom
and good governance and the empowerment of
women. Taking into account these deficit areas
in an alternative human development index,
reduces the ranking of the Arab countries on
the standard index. This new view underlined
that the challenge of building human develop-
ment, for most Arabs, is still very serious.
The first AHDR also affirmed that the
Israeli occupation of Palestinian land is one
of the most significant impediments to human
development in Arab countries, in that it con-
stitutes an obvious threat to security and peace
across the region. Occupation has also given
Arab regimes a pretext for postponing internal
reform and has embarrassed Arab reform-
ists by making the confrontation of external
threats to the region a higher priority than
internal reforms.
The second AHDR (2003) reviewed the
most important global, regional and country-
level developments after the completion of the
first Report. It concluded that challenges to
Arab human development remained grave. In-
deed, it saw unfavourable developments at the
regional and global levels as intensifying the
challenge - or the threat - to human develop-
ment notably in the realm of freedoms. These
developments included the deteriorating state
of civil and political freedoms for Arabs and
Muslims in the West following the events of
September 11 and the consequent clampdown
on freedoms in Arab countries; Israel’s re-inva-
sion of Palestinian cities, causing destruction
and human suffering; and the invasion and
occupation of Iraq by the US-led Coalition.
Looking into the state of knowledge acqui-
sition at the beginning of the 21st century, the
second Report concluded that the dissemina-
tion and production of knowledge in Arab
countries remain weak despite the presence of
significant Arab human capital. It noted that,
under different circumstances, such capital
would constitute a strong foundation for a
knowledge renaissance.
The Report culminated in a strategic vision
for establishing a knowledge society in Arab
countries organized around five pillars:
1. Guaranteeing the key freedoms of opinion,
expression and association, safeguarded by
good governance.
2. Disseminating high quality education for
all, particularly through higher education,
learning in early childhood, continuous educa-
tion and life-long learning.
3. Embedding and ingraining science in
society, building and broadening the capacity
for research and development across societal
activities and catching up with the “informa-
tion age”.
4. Shifting Arab socio-economic structures
rapidly towards knowledge-based production.
5. Developing an authentic, broadminded
and enlightened Arab knowledge model based
on:
Returning to pure religion, free from po-
litical exploitation, and centred on ijtihad
(independent interpretive scholarship); ad-
vancing the Arabic language; reclaiming the
positive achievements of Arab heritage; en-
riching, supporting and celebrating cultural
diversity in the region; and opening up to
other cultures.
CONTENTS OF THIS REPORT
The Arab development crisis has widened,
deepened and grown more complex to a de-
gree that demands the full engagement of all
Arab citizens in true reform in order to spear-
head a human renaissance in the region. The
strategic vision for establishing the “knowl-
The Israeli occupation
of Palestinian
land is one of the
most significant
impediments to
human development
in Arab countries.
Occupation has also
given Arab regimes a
pretext for postponing
internal reform.

4 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
edge society” in the Arab states clearly showed
that required reforms extend to the current
socio-economic structure and, critically, to the
political context at the national, regional and
international levels. It indicated that partial re-
forms can not work in the absence of an appro-
priately positive social environment; however,
in the present situation, this kind of reform is
no longer effective or even possible. Vested
interests can no longer be allowed to delay or
slow down comprehensive societal reform in
Arab countries.
Of all the impediments to an Arab renais-
sance, political restrictions on human develop-
ment are the most stubborn. For that reason,
this Report focuses on the acute deficit of free-
dom and good governance in the Arab world.
As is now the practice in this series, the
Report opens by recounting events at the
national, regional and global levels that have
affected the overall course of human develop-
ment in the Arab world during the period in
review. This opening section (Part I) is fol-
lowed by an in-depth analysis (Part II) of the
main subject.
The Report complements the first two in
the series and does not aim to go over ground
previously covered.
Part II commences with an analytical
framework that sets forth the concept and
definition of freedom and good governance,
focusing on both Western and Arab culture
(Chapter 1). It then discusses some key
problematic issues undermining freedom and
governance in Arab countries at the start of the
third millennium (Chapter 2).
Applying its analytical framework and its
definition of freedom, the Report next looks
at the state of freedoms and economic and
social rights in Arab countries and evaluates
how far they are enjoyed in practice (Chapter
3). It continues by analysing the factors that
determine the extent to which Arabs enjoy
freedoms and rights starting with the impact
of institutional, legal and political structures
(Chapters 4 and 5).
The Report then examines the impact of
societal structures on freedom and governance
in Arab countries. Since external events have
increasing and palpable impacts on freedom in
the region, the Report subsequently discusses
the global and regional environment and its
relationship to the main theme (Chapter 6).
Drawing on previous chapters, the Report
concludes by offering an analytical overview
of alternative prospects for freedom and good
governance in Arab countries. The objective is
to stimulate a broad discussion on action for
enhancing and protecting freedom in the re-
gion through good governance (Chapter 7). Of all the impediments
to an Arab
renaissance, political
restrictions on human
development are the
most stubborn.
External events
have increasing and
palpable impacts on
freedom in the region.
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY 5
Introduction
This Report, the third in the Arab Human
Development Report (AHDR) series, sets
out to provoke a spirited, considered de-
bate among all dynamic societal forces in
the Arab region to prepare the way for an
Arab renaissance. It provides a thorough ex-
amination of the deficit of freedom and good
governance, a topic that dominates current
discourse within the region and abroad.
The Arab development crisis has wid-
ened, deepened and grown more complex to
a degree that demands the full engagement
of all Arab citizens in comprehensive reform
in order to spearhead a human renaissance
in the region. Partial reforms, no matter
how varied, are no longer effective or even
possible; perhaps they never were, since
reform requires a responsive and supportive
social environment. Comprehensive societal
reform in Arab countries can no longer be
delayed or slowed down on account of vested
interests.
Of all the impediments to an Arab renais-
sance, political restrictions on human devel-
opment are the most stubborn. This Report
therefore focuses on the acute deficit of free-
dom and good governance.
CHANGES IN HUMAN
DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE
LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003
In line with the methodology established in
this series, the Report opens by recounting
some of the events at the country, regional and
global levels that most influenced the overall
course of human development in the region
during this period.
CALLS FOR REFORM INTENSIFY
Since the publication of AHDR 2003, Arab
governments and civil society organisations
have proposed various reform initiatives to
address some of the challenges facing the Arab
world. The most significant official initiative
was the “Declaration on the Process of Re-
form and Modernisation” issued by the Arab
Summit held in May 2004. The Declaration
called for the continuation and intensification
of political, economic, social and educational
change initiatives that reflect the will and aspi-
rations of Arabs.
The Declaration specifically called for ac-
tion “to deepen the foundations of democracy
and consultation, and to broaden participation
in political life and decision-making, in tandem
with the rule of law, equality among citizens,
respect for human rights, freedom of expres-
sion and … safeguards for the independence
of the judiciary”.
Civil society organisations also spear-
headed several reform initiatives as this Re-
port was being prepared. Amongst the most
significant of these are the “Sana’a Declara-
tion”, emerging from the Regional Conference
on Democracy, Human Rights and the Role
of the International Criminal Court (Sana’a,
January 2004), and “The Alexandria Charter”,
the result of a conference of Arab civil society
organisations entitled “Arab Reform Issues:
Vision and Implementation” (Alexandria,
March 2004).
Independent political and civil forces in
the Arab world also stepped up their struggle
Partial reforms are no
longer effective.
Of all the impediments
to an Arab
renaissance, political
restrictions on human
development are the
most stubborn.
Freedom and good governance: an
historical legacy
“Since when have you compelled people to enslave-
ment, when their mothers birthed them free?”
Omar bin al-Khattab
6 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
for political reform in Arab countries, resulting
in some notable successes. In Morocco, human
rights and political organizations persuaded
the Government to acknowledge earlier viola-
tions, in particular relating to the disappear-
ances of political opponents, and to begin to
address the issue.
In Bahrain, the National Committee for
Martyrs and Torture Victims began demanding
compensation for the families of those killed
and tortured by the security forces. It also
called for those responsible for human rights
violations in Bahrain to be brought to justice.
In Syria, civil society organizations asked
for the state of emergency to be lifted and
freedoms expanded. In Egypt, the Muslim
Brotherhood announced an initiative for gen-
eral reform.
At the beginning of 2004, Saudi Arabia
witnessed an unprecedented number of civil
initiatives, distinctive insofar as they were rela-
tively acceptable to the government. A number
of petitions and documents were addressed to
the Crown Prince, some of which contained
the demands of minority groups, such as the
Shias, for religious freedom, civil rights, and
equality among citizens. Others criticized acts
of violence and called for political openness as
a means out of the present crisis. Still other de-
mands centred on improvements in the status
of women, including guarantees of their full
participation in public life. One petition called
for a constitutional monarchy and fundamental
political reforms, including elections, control
of public funds and reform of the judiciary.
In Palestine, civil society organizations
were active in many areas, from resisting occu-
pation and defending human rights to assisting
in relief and humanitarian aid operations and
calling for reform.
This period also witnessed external at-
tempts to encourage reform, beginning with
the “Greater Middle East Initiative”, which
the US Administration presented to the G8
countries. After Arabs and some European
countries expressed reservations on its first
draft, the US put forward an amended project
called the “Broader Middle East Initiative”,
with more limited objectives. It was adopted at
the G8 summit in June 2004.
Reform initiatives, both those originating
in and outside the region, were launched in an
international and regional context that ham-
pered progress, as illustrated in the following:
A CONSTRAINING REGIONAL AND
INTERNATIONAL ENVIRONMENT
The continued occupation of the Palestinian
territories by Israel, the US-led occupation of
Iraq and the escalation of terrorism adversely
influenced Arab human development.
Israeli occupation of Palestine continues to
impede human development and freedom
Israel continued its violation of the Palestin-
ians’ right to life through direct assassina-
tions of Palestinian leaders and the killing of
civilians during raids and incursions into, and
re-occupation of cities and villages in the West
Bank and Gaza. Between May 2003 and June
2004, and as a result of repeated invasion and
bombing, a total of 768 Palestinians were killed
and 4,064 injured. 22.7 per cent of Palestinians
killed during that period were children under
18.
In the past year, Israel has continued its vi-
olations of individual and collective freedoms
of Palestinians. This is evident in the many
forms of collective punishment, including
arbitrary arrest and detention, and repeated
restrictive closures.
Israel also continued its policy of demoli-
tions, destroying property and land. Its incur-
sion into Rafah in May 2004 alone left some
4,000 Palestinians homeless after the Israeli
army demolished their homes.
Palestinians have therefore sustained enor-
mous social and economic losses. Currently
58.1% of the population subsists below the
poverty line.
Reform initiatives,
both those originating
in and outside the
region, were launched
in an international and
regional context that
hampered progress.
Palestinians have
sustained enormous
social and economic
losses. Some 58 per
cent of the population
subsists below the
poverty line.
World Bank President: The shame of Israel’s demolition of homes
“Israel’s military operations which demolish thousands of homes in Rafah are reckless,
and leaves tens of thousands of people without a roof over their heads ….As a Jew, I am
ashamed of this kind of treatment of people”.
The Wall violates international law: International Court of
Justice (ICJ).
“The construction of the wall being built by Israel, the occupying Power, in the Occu-
pied Palestinian Territory, including in and around East Jerusalem, and its associated
régime, are contrary to international law.
7 EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
Israel continued constructing the separa-
tion wall, which does not follow the boundary
between the Occupied Palestinian territories
and Israel but incorporates Palestinian land.
The International Court of Justice, in response
to a General Assembly request, issued a deci-
sive advisory opinion on July 9, 2004 on the
legal consequences of constructing the Wall.
The Court ruled that the Wall violates interna-
tional law, declared that it should be removed
and called on Israel to compensate Palestinians
harmed by the structure.
The impact of the occupation of Iraq on
human development
As a result of the invasion of their country, the
Iraqi people have emerged from the grip of a
despotic regime that violated their basic rights
and freedoms, only to fall under a foreign oc-
cupation that increased human suffering.
A scientific study estimated the number of
deaths associated with the invasion and the ac-
companying violence at around 100,000 Iraqis.
As the occupying powers proved unable to
meet their obligations under the Geneva Con-
ventions to protect citizens, Iraq witnessed an
unprecedented loss of internal security, with
killings and acts of terrorism in most parts of
the country, including attacks against Iraqi and
foreign civilians, international organizations
and humanitarian organizations.
Women suffered the most. They were, and
still remain, at risk of abduction and rape by
professional gangs. In some cases, coalition
soldiers reportedly also sexually abused female
prisoners.
Thousands of Iraqis were imprisoned and
tortured. Prisoners, mostly civilians, were
subjected to inhumane and immoral treatment
in Abu Ghraib and other occupation prisons.
Such mistreatment is a clear breach of the Ge-
neva Conventions.
The occupation forces struggled to restore
basic facilities but were unable to bring elec-
tricity, water and telephone services back to
their pre-war levels. A US report showed that,
by the end of October 2004, the occupation
authority had spent only US$ 1.3 billion on
reconstruction out of the US$ 18.4 billion al-
located for this purpose by the US Congress,
i.e. less than 7 per cent.
ADDRESSING THE THREE
DEFICITS: PROGRESS AND
REVERSALS
During the period in review, some Arab coun-
tries took steps to deal with their capability
gaps in freedom, the empowerment of women
and knowledge. However, progress was une-
ven, particularly in the area of freedoms where
many countries experienced setbacks.
There were a number of positive develop-
ments in education, the most important of
which was increased attention to quality issues
at the different levels of the education system.
Nine Arab states have participated in an inter-
national study designed to evaluate the quality
of basic education in science and mathematics.
Also, the Union of Arab Universities has taken
a decision to set up an independent institute
tasked with evaluating the quality of higher
education.
Moving towards good governance, some
Arab governments have begun to open them-
selves cautiously and selectively to opposition
forces and have started expanding the public
sphere. Nevertheless, there are indications
of a regression in popular participation, and
human rights violations have continued.
Civil society organizations and the media
continued to suffer increasing restrictions.
According to a 2004 international report, the
Middle East was the region that enjoyed the
least press freedom during the previous year.
Several journalists were killed, particularly at
the hands of occupying forces. As many as 14
journalists were killed during 2003 - 12 in Iraq,
of which 5 were killed by US-led occupation
forces. Two correspondents were killed by the
Israeli occupation forces in Palestine.
In Darfur, violations of minority rights
continued. Conflict and human suffering in-
creased, despite the cease-fire agreement and
the interventions of the international com-
munity.
On the empowerment of women, Morocco
achieved a distinctive success with a new fam-
ily law that met the demands of the women’s
movement to safeguard women’s rights, no-
tably with respect to marriage, divorce and
childcare. Women have continued to rise to
senior executive positions in Arab countries,
A scientific study
estimated the
number of deaths
associated with the
invasion (of Iraq), and
the accompanying
violence, at around
100,000 Iraqis.
Some governments
took steps to deal
with their capability
gaps in freedom,
the empowerment
of women and
knowledge. However,
progress was uneven.
8 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
and there is steadily broader scope for partici-
pation by women in legislative assemblies.
Yet careful scrutiny of developments in
this period indicates that, overall, there has
been no significant easing of the human de-
velopment crisis in the Arab region. Certainly,
incipient reforms are taking place in more than
one of the priority areas identified in this Re-
port, but for the most part those reforms have
been embryonic and fragmentary. Some gains
are undoubtedly real and promising, but they
do not add up to a serious effort to dispel the
prevailing environment of repression.
THE STATE OF FREEDOM AND
GOOD GOVERNANCE
No Arab thinker today doubts that freedom
is a vital and necessary condition, though not
the only one, for a new Arab renaissance, or
that the Arab world’s capacity to face up to
its internal and external challenges, depends
on ending tyranny and securing fundamental
rights and freedoms.
The scope of the concept of freedom
ranges between two poles. The first is a narrow
definition that restricts freedom to civil and
political rights and freedoms. The second is
comprehensive, and has been adopted in this
Report. This comprehensive definition incor-
porates not only civil and political freedoms,
including freedom from oppression, but also
the liberation of the individual from all factors
that are inconsistent with human dignity, such
as hunger, disease, ignorance, poverty, and
fear.
Freedom, however, is one of those supe-
rior human culmination outcomes that must
be guaranteed, sustained and promoted by ef-
fective societal structures and processes. These
societal guarantees are summed up in the order
of good governance that:
• Safeguards freedom to ensure the expan-
sion of people’s choices (the core of human
development)
• Rests upon effective popular participation
and full representation of the public at large.
• Is buttressed by first-rate institutions (in
contrast to the tyranny of the individual),
which operate efficiently and with complete
transparency. These institutions are subject
to effective accountability among themselves,
protected by the government’s separation of
powers, and by a balance among those powers;
they are also directly accountable to the popu-
lace through popular selection processes that
are regular, free, and scrupulously fair.
• Ensures that the rule of law is supreme;
and the law itself is fair, protective of freedom,
and applies equally to all;
• Sees that an efficient, fair and strictly inde-
pendent judiciary upholds application of the
law and the executive branch duly implements
judicial rulings.
The individual is free only in a free society
within a free nation.
With this model as its yardstick, AHDR
2004 asks: what is the status of freedom and
governance in the Arab countries?
THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND
RIGHTS
Despite variations from country to country,
rights and freedoms enjoyed in the Arab
world remain poor. Even disregarding foreign
intervention, freedoms in Arab countries are
threatened by two kinds of power: that of
undemocratic regimes, and that of tradition
and tribalism, sometimes under the cover of
In human rights terms, the understanding of
freedom in this Report covers all realms of human
rights: economic, social, cultural and environmen-
tal rights as well as civil and political rights.
Al-Kawakibi: Importance of holding
the ruling authority accountable
In sum, we have said that government, of any sort,
is not absolved of being described as oppressive
as long as it escapes rigorous oversight and is not
made to answer for its actions without fail.
Taha Hussein: Freedom and
Independence
We want to be free people in our country, free of
foreigners such that they cannot oppress us or treat
us unjustly; and free with respect to ourselves, such
that no one of us can oppress or treat another un-
justly.
For the most part,
reforms have been
embryonic and
fragmentary.
Freedom …must be
guaranteed, sustained
and promoted by
effective societal
structures and
processes.
9 EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
religion. These twin forces have combined to
curtail freedoms and fundamental rights and
have weakened the good citizen’s strength and
ability to advance.
CIVIL AND POLITICAL FREEDOMS:
FROM DEFICIENT TO SERIOUSLY
DEFICIENT
With limited exceptions in some countries and
certain areas, freedoms, particularly those of
opinion, expression and creativity, are under
pressure in most Arab countries.
During the three-year period 2001-2003,
journalists were repeatedly targeted for pros-
ecution on the grounds of opinions they had
expressed. Some of them were physically at-
tacked or held and given harsh sentences.
Early in 2003, Arab Ministers of the Interior
agreed to an anti-terrorism strategy, leading to
further restrictions on freedom of opinion and
expression and other human rights.
Violations of freedom of opinion and ex-
pression have included attacks on outspoken
political activists and human rights advocates.
The curtailment of freedom of opinion and
expression, in the form of officially imposed
censorship, extends also to literary and artistic
creativity. Some Arab states have gone as far as
to ban circulation of some of the most treas-
ured works in the Arab literary heritage, such
as The Prophet, by Gibran Kahlil Gibran, and
A Thousand and One Nights.
The freedom to form associations is often
violated by denying organisations permission
to operate, or by dissolving existing ones. Most
restrictions have been directed against grass-
roots human rights organizations.
With a few exceptions, some of which are
cosmetic, free presidential elections involv-
ing more than one candidate do not occur in
Arab countries. In only three Arab countries
(Algeria, Sudan and Yemen), and in a fourth
under occupation (Palestine), are presidents
elected through direct elections with more
than one candidate and with presidential term
limits. Syria and Egypt depend on referendums
where the president is nominated by the par-
liament, after which a national referendum is
held. In presidential referenda the outcome
varies between an absolutely majority and total
unanimity.
Totally or partially elected parliaments now
exist in all Arab countries except Saudi Arabia
and the United Arab Emirates. However, the
right to political participation has often been
little more than a ritual, representing a purely
formal application of a constitutional entitle-
ment. In most cases, elections have resulted in
misrepresenting the will of the electorate and in
low levels of representation for the opposition.
Hence, elections have not played their desig-
nated role as a participatory tool for the peace-
ful alternation of power. These elections have
generally reproduced the same ruling elites.
Personal life is also violated in some Arab
countries. Political authorities sometimes
breach the inviolability of the home at any
hour, monitoring private correspondence and
tapping telephones. Dominant social groups
can similarly usurp the personal freedom of
citizens in the name of norms and traditions.
The denial of individuals’ fundamental
freedoms
Some Arab governments also violate the right
to life extra-legally and extra-judicially. Human
rights organizations have observed that official
reports on killings tend to be short on facts. In
most Arab states, the names of the victims are
not mentioned, and no public investigation is
conducted.
Extremist groups which perpetrate assas-
sinations and bombings and espouse the use
of violence also violate the right to life. Armed
confrontations between security forces and
armed groups result in civilian casualties that
can outnumber victims in the ranks of the
combatants.
Al-Manfaluti: The value of freedom
that has been stolen
Man lives in two prisons, the prison of his own soul
and the prison of his government, from cradle to
grave.
A man who stretches out his hands to ask for
freedom is not begging; he is seeking a right that
has been stolen from him by human greed. If he
obtains it, it will not be as a favour from anyone,
and he will not be beholden to anyone.
Violations of freedom
of opinion and
expression have
included attacks on
outspoken political
activists and human
rights advocates.
Official reports on
killings tend to be
short on facts.
10 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
With the advent of the global “war on ter-
ror”, there have been unprecedented numbers
of arrests. Legal safeguards have been violated,
and people have been deprived of their liberty
and, in many instances, tortured and ill-treated
in prisons, camps and detention centres where
their personal safety is uncertain. Perhaps one
of the greatest menaces facing any Arab citizen
is the frequent disappearance of suspects in
detention.
Safeguards surrounding the right to a fair
trial are also being eroded. In several Arab
countries, civilians are being referred for trial
to military courts or other exceptional tribu-
nals such as the emergency, state security, and
special courts, as well as martial law tribunals.
Exclusion from citizenship
The withdrawal of nationality from an Arab
citizen, as permitted under certain legislation
through an administrative decision by a gov-
ernment official of less than ministerial rank, is
one the most extreme forms of exclusion from
citizenship.
Abusing minority rights
Violations of human rights in Arab countries
are more pronounced when cultural, religious
or ethnic dimensions are present. In areas of
protracted conflict in Iraq and the Sudan,
minority groups have suffered overt or covert
persecution.
This kind of double subjugation affects
a number of other social groups, notably
bidun and naturalized citizens in Arab Gulf
countries. The former, being stateless, have
nowhere to go and are regarded as foreign-
ers, while the latter are treated as second-class
citizens; they are denied the right to stand for
election to representative bodies or to vote.
“Card holders” in the border areas of Saudi
Arabia, Kurds deprived of citizenship follow-
ing the 1962 census in Syria, and “akhdam” in
Yemen encounter much the same treatment.
Migrant workers in oil-producing Arab
states, including Arab workers, suffer certain
forms of discrimination according to interna-
tional standards. The most notorious cases
stem from the “guarantor system” and the
abuse of domestic servants, chiefly women.
Socio-economic and military circumstances
are creating bizarre situations in Mauritania
and the Sudan. In the former, members of
the group known as “haratin” (emancipated
slaves) are not much better off than when
they were slaves. In the Sudan, different tribes
involved in the military conflict have abducted
one other’s women and children; here again,
the victims’ condition is tantamount to slavery.
Women doubly excluded
In general, women suffer from inequality with
men and are vulnerable to discrimination, both
at law and in practice.
Despite laudable efforts to promote the
status of women, success remains limited.
Greater progress is required in women’s politi-
cal participation, in changes to personal status
laws, in the integration of women in develop-
ment, and in the right of a woman married to a
foreign husband to transmit her citizenship to
her children. The inability of existing legisla-
tion to protect women from domestic violence
or violence on the part of the state and society
is another deficit area. Violence against women
peaks in areas of armed conflict, especially in
the Sudan, Somalia and Iraq.
UNMET ECONOMIC AND SOCIAL
RIGHTS
Results of a study of 15 Arab countries found
that 32 million people suffer from malnutri-
tion. This figure represents nearly 12 per cent
of the total population of the countries con-
cerned, In the 1990s, the absolute numbers of
those suffering malnutrition in the Arab world
increased by more than six million. The worst
results were observed in Iraq and Somalia.
However, physical illness still takes years
off the life of the ordinary Arab. When years
of illness are deducted from the estimate of life
expectancy at birth, average healthy Arab life
expectancy falls by ten years or more.
The spread of education is restricted by the
prevalence of unacceptable rates of illiteracy
(about one third of Arab men and half of Arab
women in 2002) and the denial of the basic
right to education of some Arab children – low
as this percentage may be. The value of educa-
With the advent of
the global "war on
terror", there have
been unprecedented
numbers of arrests.
Despite laudable
efforts to promote
the status of women,
success remains
limited.
11 EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
tion is also diluted by its low quality and the
resulting failure to instil the basic capabilities
of self-learning, critical analysis and innovation
among those educated.
HOW FAR DO ARABS BELIEVE
THAT THEY ENJOY FREEDOM?
The report team, in collaboration with repu-
table polling institutions, designed and con-
ducted a field survey on what Arabs believe are
the most important components of freedom.
The study also explored the extent to which
Arabs thought that they enjoyed those compo-
nents of freedom in their own countries. The
survey covered five Arab countries (Algeria,
Jordan, Palestine, Lebanon, and Morocco)
that represent about one quarter of the Arab
population.
Interviewees in all five countries indicated
that, in their view, the level of enjoyment of
individual freedoms was comparatively high,
whereas the enjoyment of ‘public’ freedoms
was relatively low, especially regarding good
governance.
For most interviewees, freedom of move-
ment, marriage and ownership of property,
and the freedom of ‘minorities’ to practice
their own culture, topped the list of freedoms
enjoyed in their countries. The existence of
effective political opposition, an independent
media and judiciary, transparent and account-
able governance, and successful anti-corrup-
tion measures were put at the low end of the
scale of enjoyment.
Asked how far they had seen an improve-
ment or deterioration in the enjoyment of
the elements of freedom during the five years
before the survey, interviewees singled out
individual freedoms in gender equality and
marriage, freedom of thought, freedom from
ignorance and disease, freedom of ‘minori-
ties’ to practice own culture, and freedom of
civil and co-operative organisations as areas
of greatest improvement. The greatest dete-
riorations were thought to have occurred in
the areas of corruption, lack of transparency
and accountability in governance, lack of in-
dependence of the judiciary, inequality before
the law and mounting poverty.
STRUCTURES IMPEDING
FREEDOM
Why, do Arabs enjoy so little freedom? What
has led Arab democratic institutions (where
they exist) to become stripped of their original
purpose to uphold freedom?
Some analysts seek answers in the fraught
and ambiguous relationship between “East”
and “West,” portrayed as a stark split. The
first pole is usually associated with “despot-
ism” as a supposedly inherent characteristic
of “the East” and “Eastern” civilization, while
the second is linked to freedom, purportedly a
fundamental quality of “Western” civilization.
A few have claimed that Arabs and Muslims
are not capable of being democrats, for the
very reason of being Arab (“the Arab mind”)
or Muslims. However, a recent research effort,
the World Values Survey (WVS), has exposed
the falseness of these claims by demonstrating
that there is a rational and understandable
thirst among Arabs to be rid of despots and
to enjoy democratic governance. Among the
nine regions surveyed by the WVS, which in-
cluded the advanced Western countries, Arab
countries topped the list of those agreeing that
“democracy is better that any other form of
governance”. A substantially high percentage
also rejected authoritarian rule (defined as
a strong ruler who disregards parliament or
elections).
Undoubtedly, the real flaw behind the fail-
ure of democracy in several Arab countries is
not cultural in origin. It lies in the convergence
of political, social and economic structures that
have suppressed or eliminated organized social
and political actors capable of turning the crisis
of authoritarian and totalitarian regimes to their
advantage. The elimination of such forces has
sapped the democratic movement of any real
forward momentum. In addition, there are re-
gion-specific complexities that have deepened
the crisis, the most significant of which are:
What has led Arab
democratic institutions
(where they exist) to
become stripped of
their original purpose
to uphold freedom?
The real flaw
behind the failure of
democracy in several
Arab countries is not
cultural in origin.
12 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
REGION-SPECIFIC PROBLEMATIC
ISSUES
The Contradiction Between Freedom
In Arab Countries And Narrow Global
Interests
In the first half of the twentieth century, two
factors emerged which were fated to have a far-
reaching impact on the attitudes of the major
powers towards freedom in the Arab region:
the discovery of oil and the establishment of
the state of Israel. The existence of large re-
serves of oil in the region and the dominant
role of oil in the advanced economies, made
continued supplies at reasonable prices the
chief concern of global powers. Additionally,
as vested interests in Israel grew, some global
powers, especially the US, increasingly took
any Arab country’s attitude toward Israel and
its practices as one of the most important yard-
sticks by which to judge that country.
Consequently, major world powers tended
to gloss over human rights violations in their
Arab client states so long as the countries con-
cerned did not threaten these interests. Thus
indulged, the Arab despots of the day ruled
oppressively, restricting prospects of their
countries’ transition to democracy.
The events of September 11 have added a
more recent dimension to this tension after the
US Administration moved to curtail civil and
political rights, especially those of Arabs and
Muslims, in the fight against “terrorism” as it
defined the term. The fact that some Western
countries, which Arab reformers had long held
up as models of freedom and democracy, have
taken steps widely perceived to be discrimina-
tory and repressive, has weakened the position
of those reformers calling for Arab govern-
ments undertaking similar actions to change
their course.
Freedom shorn of effective advocates
The cause of Arab freedom has suffered in
the absence of effective, broad-based politi-
cal movements capable of rallying people to
the struggle. Popular political forces, such as
the Arab nationalist and, later on, the Islam-
ist movements, did not make comprehensive
freedom their priority. When they did turn to
the question, their more limited goal, under-
standably, was national freedom, which they
made their public rallying point in the strug-
gle against colonial powers at the regional and
global levels.
Appropriating religion to perpetuate
tyranny
The dominant trend in Islamic jurisprudence
supports freedom. Enlightened Islamic inter-
pretations find that the tools of democracy
- when used properly – offer one possible prac-
tical arrangement for applying the principle of
consultation (al-shura). The fundamental prin-
ciples in Islam which dictate good governance,
include the realization of justice and equality,
the assurance of public freedoms, the right of
the nation to appoint and dismiss rulers, and
guarantees of all public and private rights for
non-Muslims and Muslims alike
Notwithstanding these key theological and
philosophical interpretations, political forces,
in power and in opposition, have selectively
appropriated Islam to support and perpetuate
their oppressive rule.
“The trap of the one-off election”
This phrase refers to a ploy used by Arab re-
gimes in Islamic societies to keep those ap-
prehensive about the accession to power of
Islamist groups on their side. It is also cited to
justify foreign interference to prop up authori-
tarian Arab regimes. Essentially, it is contended
that opening up the public sphere to all societal
forces - among the most active of which is the
Islamic movement - will end with these forces
assuming power, followed by oppression, such
that democratic competition becomes history
after the one and only election.
Ayatollah al-Mohaqiq al-Naeeny: An Opinion Concerning
Conditionality or Constitutionality
The conduct of the ruler is bounded
by the limitations of his prerogatives …
it is conditioned not to exceed them, the
people are his partners in all that con-
cerns the destiny of the country to which
they all belong on an equal footing.
Those in charge are but loyal trust bear-
ers of the people, not owners nor serv-
ants. Like other trust bearers, they are
responsible to each and every individual
of the nation, they are accountable for
any trespass they commit, and every sin-
gle person has the right to question and
to object in an environment of security
and freedom, without being bound by
the Sultan’s will or preferences.
Thus indulged, the
Arab despots of the
day ruled oppressively,
restricting their
countries’ prospects
of transition to
democracy.
Political rulers,
in power and
in opposition,
have selectively
appropriated Islam
to support and
perpetuate their
oppressive rule.
13 EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
Specificity as a pretext for slighting human
rights
In contemporary jurisprudence, human rights
constitute the collection of rights incorpo-
rated in international agreements and treaties
that guarantee all people, irrespective of their
nationality, ethnicity, language, sex, religion,
ideology and abilities, the fundamental rights
to which they are entitled by virtue of being
human. However, in Arab countries the issue
of ‘specificity’ is frequently raised to weaken
international human rights law.
In spite of the existence of several interpre-
tive texts which assert the congruence between
international human rights law and Islamic law
(Shari’a), traditional interpretations of Shari’a
that stress differences between the two, are
used to argue that international human rights
laws are not applicable in Arab countries.
THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE
Two sets of discrepancies commonly mar Arab
legislation concerned with different levels of
freedom and human rights. The first set reflects
a gap between international norms and na-
tional constitutions, and one between national
constitutions and national laws. The second set
reflects a breach between international norms,
national constitutions, and national laws on the
one side, and actual practice on the other.
Constitutions granting rights and laws
confiscating them
Freedom of thought, opinion and associa-
tion: Many Arab constitutions contain special
provisions on freedom of thought, opinion, and
belief, and freedom of peaceful assembly, asso-
ciation and affiliation. However, the constitu-
tion may also stipulate numerous restrictions
on the right of association under the pretext
of safeguarding national security or national
unity. Political parties are permitted in 14
Arab countries. Libya and the member states
of the Gulf Cooperation Council (Saudi Ara-
bia, the United Arab Emirates, Qatar, Bahrain,
Kuwait and Oman) prohibit the formation of
political parties.
Arab constitutions assign the regulation
of rights and freedoms to ordinary legislation,
which tends to restrict the right in the guise of
regulation. As a result, many constitutional
texts addressing rights and freedoms, whatever
their own shortcomings may be, lose much of
their worth, turning into an empty facade for
the benefit of the international community.
Examples include provisions that prohibit
or restrict the exercise of the right to strike,
demonstrate, hold mass gatherings or assemble
peacefully.
In countries whose constitutions prescribe
the multiparty system, there are legislative
restrictions limiting the right to form politi-
cal parties, requiring prior authorization from
predominantly governmental committees.
Other laws contain conditions concerning
party activity, allowing the state to dissolve
a party whenever it considers the conditions
have been breached.
Moreover, both the establishment of civil
associations and their activities are heavily
circumscribed and subject to rigorous control
in Arab countries, with a few exceptions in
dealing with civil society more liberally, as in
Morocco and Lebanon.
Press freedom in 11 Arab countries can
be blocked or curtailed by regulations that
permit prior or post-printing censorship. Laws
impose restrictions on the right to publish
newspapers by requiring a licence whose with-
drawal, or threat of withdrawal, is used by the
executive to deter newspapers from crossing
set boundaries of freedom of expression. Jour-
nalists’ right to obtain information and news is
assured in law in only five Arab states: Algeria,
Egypt, Jordan, the Sudan and Yemen.
When regulating freedom of opinion and
expression, including the media and mass com-
munications, the Arab legislator prioritizes
what s/he perceives as security and public in-
terest considerations above freedom, diversity
Restrictions on the rights to assembly and association
The holding or organization of a public meeting is not permitted without previously
obtaining a permit for that purpose from the Governor in whose area of authority the
meeting will take place, and all public meetings that are held without a permit will be
prevented and dispersed.
(Article 4, Decree Law concerning the holding of public meetings and assemblies, Kuwait)
Press freedom in 11
Arab countries can be
blocked or curtailed
by regulations that
permit prior or post-
printing censorship.
Arab constitutions
assign the regulation
of rights and freedoms
to ordinary legislation,
which tends to restrict
the right in the guise
of regulation.
14 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
and respect for human rights. The result is that
Arab legislation is armed with provisions that
regard newspaper publication, audio-visual
broadcasting and free expression in general as
dangerous activities warranting a panoply of
bans, restrictions and deterrent sanctions.
The human right to litigation: Arab con-
stitutions take a consistent line on upholding
the independence and inviolability of the judi-
ciary. But most maintain the executive pres-
ence within the judiciary and its institutions.
Hence, not only are judgements delivered and
enforced in the name of the head of state, but
the latter is also vested with the right to preside
over the constitutional bodies that oversee the
judiciary. This can often nullify other constitu-
tional provisions.
While many Arab constitutions stipulate
safeguards for fair trial in criminal laws and
trial systems, scholars and human rights ac-
tivists frequently note a disparity - usually for
political reasons - between such guarantees on
paper and reality.
Consequently, independence of the judici-
ary as an institution, and of judges as individu-
als, is jeopardized. Ideological and autocratic
regimes frequently interfere, in the name
of “protecting the ideological foundations”
of their authoritarian regimes. In addition,
where the executive controls the finances,
and intervenes in the appointment, transfer
and dismissal of judges, judicial independence
suffers. Material and moral temptations for un-
derpaid and unprotected judges are sometimes
a factor as well. Many are sometimes fearful in
delivering their judgements, particularly when
the State has a direct or indirect interest in the
case in question.
Justice and the right to litigation are also
obstructed by the vast case-load in the courts
of some Arab countries and consequent delays
in hearings and justice delivered. The absence
of an authority capable of enforcing the law
fairly and promptly can encourage recourse to
violence and individual reprisals, and deter the
public from resorting to courts for solutions.
Right of nationality: Nationality gives a
person the legal status that confers rights and
duties and helps her/him to acquire full citizen-
ship. There is a noticeable difference between
the constitutional status of this right and the
situation of those who benefit from it in Arab
countries; some constitutions remain silent on
the subject, while others refer the matter of its
regulation to the law, as in Egypt, Lebanon,
Jordan, Saudi Arabia and Algeria. Still other
constitutions allow for its forfeiture and pro-
vide for the conditions required, as in Qatar,
Oman, the United Arab Emirates and Kuwait.
In some Arab countries, a new trend is
emerging of granting nationality to the chil-
dren of a mother bearing the nationality of the
state. This is commendable, as it recognizes
the principle of equality between mother and
father in securing the nationality of their chil-
dren and ends the misery that arises from the
state denying nationality to the children where
the mother is married to a foreign national.
And constitutions flatly violating rights
A number of Arab constitutions contain pro-
visions that conflict with international human
rights principles by assuming an ideological or
religious character that removes public rights
and freedoms or permits their removal. An
example is the amendment introduced by the
Yemeni legislators to an article which originally
provided that “there shall be no crime and no
punishment other than as stipulated by law.”
The amendment states that “there shall be no
crime and no punishment other than on the
basis of a provision of religious law (Shari’a)
or law.”
Taking the provisions of Shari’a as a source
of legislation is not itself a violation of human
rights. The objection is that, in Arab countries
that do so, the discourse is directed to the
judge, instead of the legislator. Investing dis-
cretionary powers in the judge to interpret the
Shari’a text and to choose among the multiple
opinions of jurisprudence entails a lack of legal
precision. In order to harmonise Shari’a with
the law, the constitutions of those states which
adopt it must therefore stipulate the principle
that there is no crime or punishment other
than that prescribed by law.
The constitutional violation of human
rights may assume a confessional shape, as il-
lustrated in the Lebanese law, which provides
that parliamentary seats in the Council of
Deputies shall be divided on a religious and
Justice and the right
to litigation are
obstructed by the vast
increase in the number
of court cases in some
Arab countries and
consequent delays in
hearings and justice
delivered.
A number of Arab
constitutions contain
provisions that conflict
with international
human rights
principles.
15 EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
confessional basis.
Constitutional violations of human rights
can also take the form of an ideological bias,
which excludes differing opinions or political
affiliations. For example, the Syrian Constitu-
tion affirms the Ba’th party as the leadership of
society and the state, meaning that the multi-
party system has no constitutional legality.
One of the most serious legislative viola-
tions of human rights in the Arab world occurs
where the Arab legislator permits the executive
to declare a state of emergency and abuse all
safeguards for individual rights and liberties.
In some Arab countries, the state of emergency
has become permanent and ongoing, with
none of the dangers to warrant it. What was
the exception has now become the rule (e.g. in
Egypt, Syria and the Sudan). Emergency Laws
(or rules of martial law), strip the citizen of
many constitutional rights, such as inviolability
of the home, personal liberty, freedom of opin-
ion, expression and the press, confidentiality
of correspondence, rights of movement and
assembly. They remove key legislative powers
from the elected parliament and transfer them
to the executive or military governor (emer-
gency authority).
THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
It may at first seem difficult to talk about the
common features of governance in the Arab
world owing to the wide diversity of its re-
gimes, ranging from absolute monarchies to
revolutionary republics and radical Islamic
states. Closer scrutiny, however, reveals an in-
teresting affinity in the architecture and meth-
ods of Arab systems of governance.
The “black-hole” State
The modern Arab state, in the political sense,
runs close to this astronomical model, whereby
the executive apparatus resembles a “black
hole” which converts its surrounding social
environment into a setting in which nothing
moves and from which nothing escapes.
This increasing centralization of the execu-
tive is guaranteed in the constitutional texts of
certain states, which vest wide powers in the
head of state. The latter becomes the supreme
leader of the executive, the council of minis-
ters, the armed forces, the judiciary and public
services.
In addition to the absolute powers of the
executive body, there are additional mecha-
nisms that increase the concentration of power
in its hands. For example, the so-called ruling
parties (where they exist) are, in reality, sim-
ply institutions attached to the executive, since
party officials (or electoral candidates) are des-
ignated by the president, who is also regarded
as the party leader. In practice, this means that
parliament is a bureaucratic adjunct of the
executive that does not represent the people
whose mistrust in it continues to grow.
Furthermore, the executive uses the ordi-
nary and exceptional judiciary to eliminate and
tame opponents, rivals and even supporters
who step out of line. This is linked with what is
known as “unspoken corruption” where close
supporters are allowed to exploit their posi-
tions for unlawful gain, while “enforcement
of the law” against them remains a weapon to
ensure their continuing and total loyalty.
The key support buttressing the power
of the executive is the intelligence apparatus,
which is not responsible to the legislature or to
public opinion, but is directly under the control
of the president or king and possesses powers
greater than those of any other organ. The se-
curity apparatus has substantial resources and
intervenes in all the powers of the executive,
particularly in regard to appointment decisions
and the legal regulation of associations, to the
point where the modern-day Arab state is fre-
quently dubbed “the intelligence state”
Arab states vary in their embodiment of
these general traits, particularly in the margin
of freedom that is considered unthreatening.
The confusion between religion and state is no-
where more clearly demonstrated than in the Su-
danese Constitution, which provides that God, the
Creator of humankind, holds supremacy over the
State, without specifying the meaning of suprem-
acy. Governance practices apparently sanctioned
by God are likely to be immune to criticism and
opposition.
In some Arab
countries, the state
of emergency has
become permanent
and ongoing, with
none of the dangers to
warrant it.
The executive
apparatus resembles
a “black hole”
which converts its
surrounding social
environment into
a setting in which
nothing moves and
from which nothing
escapes.
16 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
However, what they have in common is that
power is concentrated at the tip of the execu-
tive pyramid and that the margin of freedom
permitted (which can swiftly be reduced) has
no effect on the state’s firm and absolute grip
on power.
The crisis of legitimacy
Without the majority of people behind them,
most Arab regimes resorted to other sources of
legitimacy: traditional (religious/tribal), revo-
lutionary (nationalist/liberation), or patriar-
chal, claiming authority based on the wisdom
of the ‘family head’. However, the failure to
tackle major issues such as the question of Pal-
estine, pan-Arab cooperation, foreign interven-
tion, the advancement of human development
and popular representation, drove Arab states
into a crisis of legitimacy. Hence, in address-
ing the masses, the regimes resorted to a new
tactic: they linked legitimacy to achievements,
actual or promised, in specific areas such as the
economy, peace, prosperity, stability, or safe-
guarding values and traditions. Sometimes the
mere preservation of the state entity in the face
of external threats was considered an achieve-
ment sufficient to confer legitimacy.
Some regimes now bolster their legitimacy
by adopting a simplified and efficient formula
to justify their continuation in power. They
style themselves as the lesser of two evils, or the
last line of defence against fundamentalist tyr-
anny or, even more dramatically, against chaos
and the collapse of the state. This formula is
what some have dubbed “the legitimacy of
blackmail”.
The “legitimacy of blackmail” has been
eroded by the growing realization that the
absence of any effective alternative is itself
one of the outcomes of the policies that block
all avenues for political and civil activity, and
so prevent other alternatives from material-
izing. Hence, the survival of “the black-hole
State” has become more dependent on control
and propaganda; on marginalizing the elites
through scare-and-promise tactics; on strik-
ing bargains with dominant global or regional
powers; and on mutually supportive regional
blocs to reinforce the status of the ruling elites
against emerging forces.
Repression and political impoverishment
The Arab political scene today is quite var-
ied. Some states categorically prohibit any
political organization. Other states allow con-
ditional political pluralism and, as a rule, ban
the strongest and most important opposition
party, while favouring the party established by
the ruling authority. States which allow party
activity nonetheless try to trip up the opposi-
tion parties, by depriving them of resources
and media coverage, controlling nomination
and election procedures, using the judiciary,
the army and security services to curtail their
activities, hounding their leaders and activists
and tampering with election polls.
In addition to official repression, opposi-
tion parties suffer from internal problems
that are no less serious. Despite theoretical
references to democracy in their charters, their
practices show that the influential political élite
holds sway in most of these parties, resulting in
immovable leaders who, with rare exceptions,
only leave their posts when they die, casting
doubt on their claims to modernity and de-
mocracy.
Beyond that, there is an acute “sectarian
split” in the political community between the
Islamic parties on the one hand and the liberal
and nationalist secular parties on the other (as
well as other sectarian divisions along doctrinal,
ethnic, tribal and regional lines). As a result of
this sectarian fragmentation some parties and
political forces have preferred to co-operate
with undemocratic governments rather than
work with their rivals to lay the groundwork
for a democratic rule open to all.
Restrictions on opposition parties have
led to the marginalization of some parties and
hastened their demise, and generated a lack of
confidence in the political process as a whole.
This contraction has pushed some towards
clandestine political activities adopting violent
and terrorist means, and others into political
Muhammad Al-Charfi: Arab
democracy - form without substance
A citizen no longer has any guaranteed right un-
less s/he wishes to cheer the ruler, voice gratitude
for his accomplishments and extol his qualities and
wisdom.
The absence of any
effective (political)
alternative is itself one
of the outcomes of
policies that block all
avenues for political
and civil activity.
Opposition parties
suffer from internal
problems that are no
less serious.
17 EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
passivity. Constraints on political space have
led some activists and scholars to rely on civil
society organizations, especially trade unions
and professional organizations, on the grounds
that they are better equipped than Arab politi-
cal parties to lead Arab society towards devel-
opment and democracy.
Yet, civil society faces the same problems
as the political community vis-à-vis the author-
ities who seek to control civil organizations,
directly or indirectly, by using a dual strategy
of containment and repression. In addition,
many CSOs become extensions of political
parties, which use them as fronts through
which to expand their political influence at the
popular level. This, in turn, limits the CSOs’
initiative and independence of action. Conse-
quently, civil society organizations have not
been significant actors in resolving the existing
political crisis, as they too have been caught up
in its vortex.
The vicious circle of repression and
corruption
Economic corruption is the natural result of
political corruption. In some countries cor-
ruption may be characterised as “structural”
because personal abuse of public office and
misuse of public finances are considered nor-
mal according to prevailing custom (such as
obtaining commissions for government deals).
It also takes the form of “petty corruption”
in some countries. Petty corruption refers to
situations where Arab citizens have to rely on
personal contacts (wasta) or pay a bribe to ob-
tain services that are legitimate and to which
they are entitled, or to avert a punishment by
the authorities. If ending corruption entails,
among other measures, deep economic reform,
active laws and mechanisms of accountability,
and transparent governance, “structural cor-
ruption” can be overcome only by radical re-
form of the political architecture.
SOCIETAL STRUCTURES
The chain that stifles individual freedom
The crisis in political structures is reflected
in Arab societal structures that consist of em-
bedded links in an interconnected chain con-
stricting freedom. Starting with the child’s
upbringing within the family, passing through
educational institutions, the world of work,
and societal formation, and ending with poli-
tics - both internal and external - each link in
the chain takes its portion of freedom from the
individual and delivers her or him to the next,
which, in turn, steals a further share.
In varying degrees, the family, the primary
unit of Arab society, is based on clannism,
which implants submission, and is considered
the enemy of personal independence, intellec-
tual daring, and the flowering of a unique and
authentic human entity.
Clannism flourishes, and its negative im-
pact on freedom and society becomes stronger,
wherever civil or political institutions that pro-
tect rights and freedoms are weak or absent.
Without institutional supports, individuals are
driven to seek refuge in narrowly based loyal-
ties that provide security and protection, thus
further aggravating the phenomenon. Tribal
allegiances also develop when the judiciary is
ineffective or the executive authority is reluc-
tant to implement its rulings, circumstances
that make citizens unsure of their ability to
realize their rights without the allegiances of
the clan.
Once children enter school, they find an
educational institution, curricula, teaching
and evaluation methods which tend to rely on
dictation and instil submissiveness. This learn-
ing environment does not permit free dialogue
and active exploration and consequently does
not open the doors to freedom of thought
and criticism. On the contrary, it weakens the
capacity to hold opposing viewpoints and to
think outside the box. Its societal function is
the reproduction of control in Arab societies.
For all its deficiencies and flaws, education,
particularly at the higher levels, remains a vital
source of knowledge, enlightenment and leav-
ening for the forces of change.
Even so, outside the academy, the world
remains harsh on the young. After a student
graduates, and when fate or chance ends the
period of unemployment, s/he steps onto the
lowest rung of a rigid, restrictive hierarchy,
especially if the job is with the civil service.
The chain constricting freedom completes
Many civil society
organizations have
become extensions of
political parties, which
use them as fronts.
Each link in the chain
takes its portion of
freedom from the
individual and delivers
her or him to the next,
which, in turn, steals a
further share.
18 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
its circle in the political realm, squeezing Arab
public life into a small and constricted space.
The limited dimensions of this space do not
enable civil society institutions to provide ef-
fective group protection to citizens who are
vulnerable to oppression as individuals. Such
weakness affords oppressive powers, both at
home and from abroad, free sway to suppress
individual freedoms.
As they tighten and grow, the constrictions
of the chain on freedom, in time, become inter-
nal constraints on the self. Suppression leads
individuals to become their own censors and to
contain every urge to speak or act. This com-
plicated process has led Arab citizens, includ-
ing some among the intelligentsia, to a state of
submission fed by fear and marked by denial of
their subjugation. Yet - even among segments
once considered pillars of the restrictive status
quo - there are signs that this state of affairs
cannot continue and that the human urge to
claim freedom will re-surface in society.
A mode of production that strengthens
authoritarian governance
The rentier mode of production opens cracks
in the fundamental relationship between citi-
zens as a source of public tax revenue and
government. Where a government relies on
financing from the tax base represented by
its citizens, it is subject to questioning about
how it allocates state resources. In a rentier
mode of production, however, the government
can act as a generous provider that demands
no taxes or duties in return. This hand that
gives can also take away, and the government
is therefore entitled to require loyalty from its
citizens invoking the mentality of the clan.
A longing for freedom and justice in
popular culture
There is no stronger indication of the thirst
for freedom and justice in the Arab conscience
than the way these concepts recur in a popular
culture rich in depictions of struggles against
oppression and injustice.
The greatest literary manifestations of that
tradition are glowing examples of the eleva-
tion of the “dream of freedom”. The siras (life
stories) profoundly expressed popular anger
against injustice, oppression and, tyranny in
the Arab dark ages of disintegration and weak-
ness. In calling for unity and liberation of the
land, in voicing the dream of a better world,
in nourishing the popular spirit by creating
popular or epic heroes capable of overcoming
adversity, they lifted people’s souls and minds
above their trials.
Popular aspirations for freedom are abun-
dant as well in the myriad folk songs and po-
etry of the Arab world.
AN INHOSPITABLE GLOBAL AND
REGIONAL ENVIRONMENT FOR
FREEDOM
It is not possible to understand the problem
of freedom in Arab society without also con-
sidering the effects of regional factors and of
influences coming from outside the region,
particularly those related to globalization and
global governance.
Globalization has the potential to but-
tress the freedom of the individual as a result
of minimising the State’s capacity to repress
people, particularly their ideas and aspirations.
It can also, expand people’s opportunities to
acquire knowledge and broaden their horizons
by facilitating communication and the circula-
tion of ideas.
In particular, globalization can support
freedom by strengthening civil society through
wider networking among its actors, using
modern information and communication tech-
nology. Yet globalization also entails the selec-
tive restriction of certain liberties world-wide
through restrictions of vital knowledge flows
and on the free movement of people.
With globalization, the State lost part of
its sovereignty to international actors, such as
trans-national corporations and international
organizations, notably in the areas of eco-
nomic activity. It has thus become critical to
strengthen global governance, as embodied in
the United Nations. However, this has yet to
come about. The advent of a uni-polar world
has resulted at times in the weakening and mar-
ginalization of the world organization. This has
had adverse consequences for freedom in the
Arab world. The US’s repeated use, or threat
of veto, has limited the effectiveness of the Se-
The rentier mode
of production
opens cracks in
the fundamental
relationship between
citizens as sources of
public tax revenue and
government.
It has become
critical to strengthen
global governance
as embodied in the
United Nations.
19 EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
curity Council in establishing peace in the re-
gion. Such marginalization has been among the
factors contributing to continuing or increased
human suffering and to the creation of new
facts on the ground, such as the establishment
of new settlements by Israel in the Occupied
Territories and the construction of the separa-
tion wall that incorporates additional Palestin-
ian land, all of which militate against a just and
lasting peace. This has pushed many people
in the region to lose hope of obtaining justice
from global governance and could exacerbate a
tendency towards extremism.
The “war on terror” has also cut into many
Arab freedoms. Western leaders have strongly
asserted their support for freedom and democ-
racy as the best long-term solution to terror-
ism; in practice many have also understandably
sought to tighten their own security legislation.
An unfortunate by-product in some countries
has been that Arabs are increasingly the victims
of stereotyping, disproportionately harassed or
detained without cause under new restrictions.
At the same time, in the Arab world, several
Governments have cited fear of terrorism as
justification for steps to impose even tighter
restrictions on their citizens.
At the regional level, current institutional
arrangements for regional co-ordination have
failed to give substantive support to Arab de-
velopment, and to maintain security and peace
in the Arab world.
A STRATEGIC VISION:
ALTERNATIVE FUTURES FOR
FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN
ARAB COUNTRIES
Modernization in Arab countries has yielded
notable achievements, especially in combating
morbidity and mortality, building infrastruc-
ture, the quantitative expansion of education
and in increasing the integration of women in
society. Yet by 21st century standards, Arab
countries have not met the Arab people’s
aspirations for development, security and lib-
eration despite variations between one country
and another in that respect. Indeed, there is a
near-complete consensus that there is a seri-
ous failing in the Arab world, and that this is
located specifically in the political sphere.
ALTERNATIVE SCENARIOS
Since present-day regimes have not achieved
fundamental reforms from within through
which they could correct their course and
improve hopes for a better future, Arabs an-
ticipate a number of future scenarios, some
of which are catastrophic, while others are
hopeful.
The Impending Disaster Scenario
If the repressive situation in Arab countries
today continues, intensified societal conflict is
likely to follow. In the absence of peaceful and
effective mechanisms to address injustice and
achieve political alternation, some might be
tempted to embrace violent protest, with the
risk of internal disorder.
This could lead to chaotic upheavals that
might force a transfer of power in Arab coun-
tries, but such a transfer could well involve
armed violence and human losses that, how-
ever small, would be unacceptable. Nor would
a transfer of power through violence guarantee
that successor governance regimes would be
any more desirable.
The “Izdihar” Alternative
Disaster can be averted. The alternative is to
pursue an historic, peaceful and deep process
of negotiated political alternation adopted
by all pro-reform segments of Arab society,
Counsellor Yahya al-Rifai: Justice Above Might
There are two, and only two, ways of
settling disputes: with the bludgeon of
force or the justice of law, there is no
third possibility. With force, a person’s
life, honour and property are never safe;
he lives like a wild animal, hunting his
prey without ever being sure that he will
be able to keep any of it, never planting
a crop because the harvest will go to the
strongest, never building a house because
there is no certainty that he will be able
to live in it, and, indeed, afraid to settle
anywhere.
The UN Special Rapporteur on Terrorism and Human Rights:
The Root Causes of Terrorism
Some of the actions undertaken in the
cause of the global war against terrorism
have been the cause of consternation also
for the highest officials in the UN system.
For instance, the UN Secretary-General
has pleaded on a number of occasions for
States to uphold all human rights, stress-
ing that greater respect for human rights,
not their curtailment, is the best means of
preventing terrorism.
By 21st century
standards, Arab
countries have not
met the Arab peoples’
aspirations for
development, security
and liberation.
Disaster can be
averted.
20 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
whether in power or not, on all fronts and by
all democratic means, to guarantee rights and
freedoms. The desired outcome is a redistribu-
tion of power within Arab societies, restoring
sovereignty to its rightful owners, the vast ma-
jority of people in the Arab world. The process
would also establish good governance as a solid
foundation for a human renaissance.
The “Half Way House” Scenario: the
Accommodation of External Reform
Realistically, a third alternative may well lie
in between these two scenarios in the form of
a programme endorsed by external forces that
would induce a series of internal reforms in
Arab countries.
This third or “half way” alternative, falls
short of the “ideal” (izdihar) scenario. Meas-
ures imposed from outside according to the
vision of foreign powers are not necessarily
consistent with the concepts of freedom and
good governance, particularly those relating to
liberation, self-determination and independ-
ence.
The challenge facing the advocates of an
Arab renaissance is how to harness this alter-
native such that it enhances internal reform
initiatives while the impact of its most critical
defects is minimised.
Under all circumstances, co-operation with
external non-governmental and governmental
actors can be rewarding if all parties respect
key principles:
• freedom for all and complete adherence to
international human rights law, in particular
the right to national liberation
• absolute respect for the tenet that Arabs
should find their own way to freedom and
good governance through innovation by Arab
social forces, without pressure to adopt ready-
made models
• inclusion of all societal forces in Arab
countries in a system of good governance to
ensure popular representation
·• full respect for the outcomes freely chosen
by the people
• dealing with Arabs in a partnership of
equals free from patronage.
REFORMING ARAB SOCIETAL
STRUCTURES TO GUARANTEE
FREEDOM
Establishing a society of freedom and good
governance requires comprehensive reform of
governance at three interactive levels: internal,
regional and global.
Internal Reform
Internal reform requires a structural reform
of the state, civil society and the private sector
to enhance the principles of sound adminis-
tration. Also required is a correction of the
region’s present development trajectory by
moving from rent-based economies to more
diversified production systems, and thor-
oughgoing political reform. The latter should
consist of:
The reform of practices: immediate action
must be taken to address three priorities:
• Abolishing the state of emergency.
• Ending all forms of discrimination against
any minority group.
• Guaranteeing the independence of the
judiciary.
Legislative reform: There is a compelling
need to modernize Arab legal systems, to make
them compatible with international human
rights standards and effective in protecting
human rights and freedoms in practice. Con-
stitutions need to be reformed to end the per-
manency of political power and to hold ruling
authorities responsible for their actions before
the judiciary and elected representational bod-
ies. Political pluralism should be guaranteed
by an effective system based on the principle
of equality.
It is equally critical that Arab constitu-
tions must guarantee fundamental rights and
freedoms. The constitution should clearly pro-
vide that it is unlawful to enact any legislation
that restricts rights and freedoms.
It is equally critical to reform laws regulat-
ing political rights, such that they affirm the
principle of equality, and ensure that the prin-
ciples of citizenship and equality apply to all
constituent elements of national society.
Legislation must guarantee that citizens are
free to set up civil society organizations and to
The desired outcome
is a redistribution of
power within Arab
societies.
Establishing a society
of freedom and good
governance requires
comprehensive reform
of governance at three
interactive levels:
internal, regional and
global.
21 EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
enact parties, as well as to protect the right of
parties to carry out peaceful political activities.
Also necessary is a reform of Arab laws to en-
sure the protection of personal freedoms, the
prevention of illegal arrest, torture, administra-
tive detention and disappearances.
Political reform: The way to achieve good
governance in the Arab region is through fun-
damental reform of its political architecture.
This means, in particular, ending the execu-
tive’s monopoly of power, and the marginali-
zation of other state organs, which obstructs
the free and healthy development of society’s
capabilities and potential. In some countries,
this requires a clear distinction in both law and
practice between the state apparatus and the
party in power, so that the party concerned
does not enjoy the prerogative of using state
services to strengthen its presence, in breach of
the principle of equality before the law.
The achievement of these desired reforms
confers duties and responsibilities on the state
and all societal forces.
The obligations of the State include allow-
ing freedom of expression and organization,
starting a direct dialogue with all active forces
in society, safeguarding the independence and
integrity of governance institutions, as well as
carrying out comprehensive structural and
functional reform of the security services.
All service branches must obey the law, and
should be at the service of the people and the
nation, and not the ruler, party, sect or tribe.
The élites of political society need to
develop a constructive discourse and reject
policies of exclusion. They must also strive to
find common ground among political forces
and create a new mould for the political scene,
clearly distinct from past trends of polariza-
tion and fragmentation, which could seriously
hamper genuine democratic transformation
in the Arab region. In addition, the political
élites must demonstrate adherence to their
own principles, seeking democratic solutions
to settle differences.
Civil society has its obligations as well.
They include developing appropriate meth-
odologies and conceptual frameworks to adapt
civil and human rights work to the local Arab
environment; reaching out to include the wid-
est possible social spectrum; securing their
own independence; and creating networks
of associations and organizations with similar
goals.
In terms of parliamentary representation,
it is essential to establish the principle of total
equality among citizens and provide safe-
guards against disqualifying candidates from
parliamentary representation on any basis.
Also required is the adoption of affirmative
action policies targeting marginalized groups.
These include allocating a quota of posts in
government and the legislature for minorities,
and for women while maintaining the principle
of competition within quotas. It remains neces-
sary to establish ethics committees for fairness
in parliaments to prevent deputies from abus-
ing their political standing.
Changes at the Pan-Arab level
Establishing good governance at the pan-Arab
level entails transforming the ineffective re-
gional set-up of the present day into a variety of
structural arrangements aiming at integration.
It is suggested that regional mechanisms
are set up to settle disputes and support pre-
ventive diplomacy between states. It has be-
come necessary for Arab countries to conclude
a new Arab Human Rights Convention, fully
conforming to the human rights system. The
convention should provide the mechanisms
necessary to stop violations at the country and
pan-Arab levels. Perhaps the most important
of these would be an Arab Council of Human
Rights and an Arab Court of Human Rights,
which would allow individuals to bring action
directly against their own governments.
Governance at the Global level
The global system will need to be reformed
Perpetuating power in the name of democracy and the people
Article 77 of the Egyptian Constitution
of 1971 limits the maximum term in of-
fice of the President of the Republic to
two consecutive terms.
Towards the end of President Sadat’s
second term of office, this constitutional
provision was amended, on 30 April
1980, to permit the President of the Re-
public to be re-elected for further terms
of office with no upper limit prescribed.
The stated reason for the amendment
was that the President’s term “began be-
fore the Constitution was promulgated,
and in accordance with article 190 and
article 77, his term of office concludes in
November 1983. This outcome, resulting
from the application of this provision, is
not consistent with the democratic prin-
ciples which our society safeguards.”
The elites of political
society need to
develop a constructive
discourse and reject
policies of exclusion.
Establishing good
governance at the
pan-Arab level entails
transforming the
ineffective regional
set-up of the present
day into structural
arrangements aiming
at integration.
22 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
to provide effective and peaceful channels for
settling disputes and a framework of fair rules
that are subscribed to, and implemented by all.
The system has to uphold the rule of law on the
strong and the weak alike. This would require
the development of an international instrument
that can serve as an unbiased arbitrator, and
provide peace, security and advancement for
all humankind on a strong human rights basis,
as well as on justice and prosperity for all.
The UN’s credibility, which would be en-
hanced through its development, can enable it
to play a crucial role in the process of transfor-
mation towards good governance and freedom
in Arab countries. The organization can ensure
the completion of initial legal reforms assuring
civil society organizations the freedom to exist
and operate; and guarantee that conditions are
met for holding free and fair elections.
ACHIEVING PEACEFUL POLITICAL
ALTERNATION IN ARAB
COUNTRIES
The sequence of events leading to a transfor-
mation of the present political context passes
through several stages. Vision dims the further
one peers into the future, and prospects for
alternatives multiply. In this light, the first act
of this transformation is so crucial that it rep-
resents, in our view, the yardstick by which to
judge the seriousness of governance reform in
Arab countries.
The reform required in Arab countries
will be marked by the total respect of the key
freedoms of opinion, expression and asso-
ciation in Arab countries and the ending of all
types of marginalization of, and discrimination
against social groups. It will eliminate all types
of extra-legal arrangements such as emergency
laws and exceptional courts. It will lay down
foundations for the principles of transparency
and disclosure in all organizations throughout
Arab society.
As such, this act requires an initial far-
reaching legal and organizational reform the
crux of which is the guarantee of key freedoms
and independence of the judiciary and changes
that bind ruling authorities to the law and se-
curity forces to their original mandate in pro-
tecting the security of citizens and the nation
The climate of freedom created by un-
leashing these key freedoms can be expected
to secure the remaining conditions for sys-
temic change: high quality institutions within
civil and political societies at the national and
regional levels; and a political, legal and social
basis for subsequent acts in the “izdihar” sce-
nario to unfold.
Epilogue: the furthest lotus tree
Formidable obstacles stand in the way of a so-
ciety of freedom and good governance in Arab
countries. And this is an undeniable truth. But
at the end of this difficult journey, there lies
a noble goal, worthy of the hardships endured
by those who seek it.
The time has come to make up for the
missed opportunities of the past. It is to be
hoped that the Arab people will not again fail
to take the historic road leading it to its appro-
priate place in a better, fairer and freer world,
one that it will have contributed to bring into
being, and in whose benefits it will share.
Address by the UN Secretary General,
Opening Session of the General Assembly, New York, 21
September 2004
All states – strong and weak, big and
small – need a framework of fair rules,
which each can be confident that others
will obey…yet this framework is riddled
with gaps and weaknesses. Too often
it is applied selectively, and enforced
arbitrarily. It lacks the teeth that turn
a body of laws into an effective legal
system…Those who seek to bestow le-
gitimacy must themselves embody it; and
those who invoke international law must
themselves submit to it.
The (global) system
has to uphold the rule
of law on the strong
and weak alike.
23
Part I
Changes in Human Development Since
the Launch of AHDR 2003
PART I
Changes in Human Development
Since the Launch of AHDR 2003
CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003 25
Introduction
This opening section of the Report reviews
changes influencing human development in
the Arab world dating from the completion
of the second AHDR up to mid-2004. These
changes are reflected in certain national,
regional and international developments
that, in the view of the Report team, had the
greatest impact, for good or ill, on countries
of the region. Readers may thus be able to
form an overall view of the human develop-
ment situation in Arab countries.
Prospects for human development in the
Arab world have been affected by domestic
and international attempts at promoting
reform; they have also been influenced by
developments at the regional and international
level. Many of these trends have had a negative
impact on Arab human development.
ARAB INITIATIVES TO PROMOTE
REGION-WIDE REFORM
OFFICIAL ARAB REFORM EFFORTS
Since the publication of AHDR 2003, Arab
governments and civil society organisations
have undertaken a variety of reform initiatives
to address some shortcomings in the Arab
world.
Formal initiatives
The “Charter for Reform of the Arab
Situation”, proposed by the Crown Prince of
Saudi Arabia, was the first in a series of such
internal reform initiatives. The draft Charter
was to have been submitted to the summit
conference held just before the invasion of
Iraq in 2003, but under the circumstances it
was postponed to the next meeting.
Calls for the reform of the League of Arab
States grew more insistent through this period.
The Government of Yemen put forward a draft
document entitled “Development of the Joint
Arab Action Mechanism”. The Government of
Egypt also tabled an initiative aimed at “devel-
oping the League of Arab States and activating
the Joint Arab Action mechanism”.
Against the backdrop of a rising tide of
reform initiatives from outside the region,
these various initiatives coalesced into a single
joint draft document that has been adopted by
the Governments of Egypt, Saudi Arabia and
Syria. The text was laid before the meeting
of Arab Ministers for Foreign Affairs held in
Cairo early in March 2004.
At the same time, the Secretary-General of
the League of Arab States unveiled a draft pro-
posal for reforming the League and putting the
Joint Arab Action mechanism into effect. The
proposal contained nine main annexes. They
dealt respectively with: the establishment of an
Arab Parliament, the establishment of an Arab
Security Council, the basic statute of an Arab
Court of Justice, strengthening joint Arab eco-
nomic action, development of the Economic
and Social Council, the establishment of an
Arab Investment and Development Bank,
a procedure for the adoption of resolutions
within the League, a mechanism for monitor-
ing the implementation of resolutions, and the
establishment of a High Council for Arab Cul-
ture (Al-Ahram, in Arabic, Cairo, 2 March),
(selected documents, Annex 2).
On 24 May 2004, the Arab summit was
finally held in Tunis. While almost half the
Arab leaders were absent and though the
meeting faced other difficulties, it produced a
“Pledge of Accord and Solidarity”, which was
initialled by Ministers for Foreign Affairs. The
Calls for the reform of
the Arab League grew
more insistent in this
period.
Prospects for human
development in the
Arab world have been
affected by domestic
and international
attempts at promoting
reform.
26 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
summit also issued a “Declaration on the Proc-
ess of Reform and Modernisation”. Although
it included many constructive positions, the
document, in the view of this Report, did not
venture sufficiently into the essence of freedom
and good governance.
These various declarations were also short
on details concerning the effective implemen-
tation of principles adopted. The substance of
the reform of Joint Arab Action mechanisms
was postponed to the Algiers summit, which is
scheduled for 2005.
CIVIL SOCIETY REFORM
INITIATIVES
Civil society organisations were spearheading
several reform initiatives as this Report was
being prepared.
The Regional Conference on Democracy,
Human Rights and the Role of the Interna-
tional Criminal Court (Sana’a, January 2004)
resulted in “ The Sana’a Declaration”.
In March 2004, a conference of Arab civil
society organisations was held at the Bibli-
otheca Alexandrina on “Arab Reform Issues:
Vision and Implementation”. The President of
the Republic of Egypt inaugurated the confer-
ence and the participants issued “The Alexan-
dria Charter”.
On 1-3 June 2004 the “Arab Regional Con-
ference on Education for All” took place and
issued “The Arab Vision for the Future”.
In December 2003 an Arab Business
Council Meeting was organized in Aqaba,
which called for reform.
Excerpts from some of these documents
can be found in Annex 2.
THE STRUGGLE WAGED BY CIVIL
AND POLITICAL FORCES IN THE
ARAB WORLD
Despite the many hurdles in their way, inde-
pendent political and civil forces in the Arab
world are taking firm steps to pursue politi-
cal reform in Arab countries. Their efforts in
individual countries contribute to the broader
reform movement in the region.
Freedom and respect for human rights
In Morocco, where civil activity has been
vigorous for years, human rights and political
organizations persuaded the Government to
acknowledge earlier violations, in particular
relating to the disappearances of political
opponents, and to take steps to address the
issue. Civil society movements achieved per-
haps their greatest triumph in January 2004,
BOX 1
Declaration on the Process of Reform and Modernisation
in the Arab World (excerpts)
Continuation and intensification of ef-
forts in pursuit of the political, economic,
social and educational reform process
with a view to the progress of Arab socie-
ties stemming from their own free will,
consistent with their cultural, religious
and civilizational values and concepts
and the circumstances and potential of
each State:
• Action to deepen the foundations
of democracy and consultation, and to
broaden participation in political life
and decision-making, in the context of
the rule of law, equality among citizens,
respect for human rights and freedom
of expression in accordance with the
provisions of the various relevant inter-
national conventions and charters and
the Arab Charter for Human Rights,
and safeguards for the independence of
the judiciary, with a view to strengthen-
ing the roles played by all components
of society, including non-governmental
organisations, and participation by all
social groups, men and women alike, in
public life, as a means of ensuring that
the elements of citizenship are solidly
grounded in the Arab world.
• Action to ensure the welfare of chil-
dren and young persons, and continued
action to enhance the role played by
women in Arab society, strengthen their
rights and promote their status, with
a view to enabling them to contribute
more effectively to the comprehensive
development process through fuller
participation in various areas of political,
economic, social and cultural life.
• Preparation of a comprehensive Arab
economic, social and human develop-
ment strategy aimed at establishing the
concepts of good governance, addressing
the phenomena of poverty, illiteracy and
environmental protection, creating jobs
and providing health care in the Arab
world.
• Action to modernize the social
structure of our States, upgrade their
education systems and develop data
bases incorporating scientific, technical
and technological progress in the world,
thereby enabling our societies to cope
with the demands of the spirit of the age
while still retaining our identity and con-
tinuing to respect our basic traditions.
• Greater efforts to enlist the interna-
tional community in the task of achieving
a just, comprehensive and lasting settle-
ment of the Arab-Israeli conflict, in ac-
cordance with the Arab peace initiative
and the relevant UN resolutions, with a
view to:
- the establishment of an independent
Palestinian State in its homeland, having
East Jerusalem as its capital,
- Israel’s withdrawal from all the oc-
cupied Arab territories to the borders of
4 June 1967, including withdrawal from
the occupied Syrian Golan and the Shaba
Farms of Lebanon,
- the realization of a just, agreed
solution to the issue of the Palestinian
refugees pursuant to General Assembly
resolution 194, one that excludes all
forms of Palestinian resettlement that
are incompatible with the distinctive
situations of the Arab host countries
- and affirms that the commitment
to peace is a strategic choice entailing
a corresponding Israeli commitment to
faithful implementation of the relevant
UN resolutions,
- the convening of a UN conference
aimed at ridding the Middle East region,
including Israel, of weapons of mass
destruction, thereby bringing about
security and stability in the region, elimi-
nating tension and distrust, and orienting
the energies of the States of the region
toward comprehensive development and
a more secure and prosperous future for
their peoples.
Source: Al-Ahram, Cairo, in Arabic, 24 May 2004
27 CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003
when the Family Code (Personal Status Act),
which met many of the demands of women’s
movements, was approved by parliamentary
consensus.
In Bahrain, the National Committee for
Martyrs and Torture Victims began demand-
ing compensation for the families of those
killed and tortured by the security forces. It
also called for those responsible for human
rights violations in Bahrain to be brought to
justice. This Committee has managed to col-
lect signatures from 33,000 citizens (Bahrain
has a population of 400,000) on a petition
demanding the repeal of Decree-Law No. 56,
according to which court proceedings cannot
be brought against anyone responsible for pre-
vious wide-scale human rights violations.
In Tunisia, organizations that the Govern-
ment does not recognize, or which face har-
assment or squeezes on funding, nonetheless
waged active campaigns. One in particular
included seeking a general legislative amnesty
for political prisoners. Similarly, students acted
in solidarity with political detainees on hunger
strike for improved conditions by organizing
their own hunger strikes and sit-ins, which
were forcibly broken up by security forces.
Some student leaders were also expelled from
university by the authorities.
In Egypt, Algeria and the Sudan civil society
forces and political parties, including banned
groups, use what margins of media freedom are
available to fight corruption and human rights
violations and to call for democracy. Long-
established trade union and professional as-
sociations continued their defence of freedoms,
incurring official harassment; in Egypt, some
were placed under surveillance, and attempts
were made to incapacitate them or impose
government controls. Civil society institutions
organized a variety of initiatives, in particular
demonstrations against the war in Iraq and in
solidarity with the intifada in Palestine. The au-
thorities, however, repressed these initiatives.
In Syria, where a state of emergency is still
in effect, dozens of members of associations
and organizations assembled in March 2004
in front of the Parliament building on the
41st anniversary of the accession to power of
the ruling Ba’th party. They demanded that
the state of emergency be lifted and freedoms
expanded. Their peaceful demands however,
met with a strong response from the authori-
ties, which broke up the demonstration and
arrested 30 demonstrators. At the beginning
of the year, approximately 700 Syrian intel-
lectuals and activists signed a note to demand
greater freedoms and the introduction of po-
litical reforms. A group of opposition parties
and human rights associations also launched
a political reconciliation initiative based on a
draft national charter establishing freedom of
political action for all.
Stronger grass-roots participation
In all Arab countries that permit party activ-
ity, political parties continued their efforts to
strengthen grass-roots participation in parlia-
mentary and presidential elections. Such ef-
forts were conducted in the face of numerous
official obstacles; in Egypt, for example, the
Muslim Brothers organization was refused offi-
cial permission to constitute itself as a political
party, and its members were denied the oppor-
tunity to run for election. Activists were de-
tained and voters were restricted. Despite such
difficulties, the Muslim Brothers announced
an initiative for general reform in Egypt.
In Mauritania, the most prominent candi-
dates for the presidency were arrested and in
Algeria one candidate was forbidden to stand
for election. In Morocco, some new parties
such as the Justice and Development Party,
which has moderate Islamist leanings, success-
fully acquired the legal right to operate openly
and won the second largest number of votes in
the parliamentary elections.
Towards political reform
In countries where party activity is not officially
recognized, political movements continued to
press for reform. In Kuwait, political move-
ments and civil society organizations stepped
up their calls for political change. Newspapers,
which enjoy relatively greater freedom in that
country, are a basic forum for the expression
of civil and political demands. A campaign was
led against a Government proposal to tighten
the provisions of the Press and Publications
Act and demands increased for amending the
Assembly Act, under which it is a criminal of-
Civil society forces
and political parties…
use what margins
of media freedom
are available to fight
corruption and human
rights violations and
to call for democracy.
Political parties
continued their
efforts to strengthen
grassroots
participation in
parliamentary
and presidential
elections…in the
face of numerous
obstacles.
28 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
fence to convene a group of over 20 persons
to discuss any subject. Political forces and
civil society institutions continued to call for
the rights of women to stand as candidates
and vote, as well as for reducing the voting age
to 18 years. They also campaigned for the par-
ticipation by members of the military forces in
elections and for measures to address the situ-
ation of the stateless Bidun and enable them
to study, receive medical treatment, marry,
relocate, travel and work. The Kuwait parlia-
ment is regarded as an important platform for
expressing grassroots demands, monitoring
the government and questioning government
officials.
At the beginning of 2004, Saudi Arabia
witnessed an unprecedented number of civil
initiatives that were distinctive insofar as they
were relatively acceptable to the government.
The year began with a symposium, convened in
London by a liberal opposition group, which
called for the swift introduction of political
and legal reforms.
In January 2003, 104 activists from differ-
ent regions and with differing intellectual and
confessional approaches signed a document,
addressed to the Crown Prince and entitled
“A vision for the present and future of the
homeland”. This was followed in April by the
presentation of another document, “Partners
in the homeland”, signed by 450 Shi’ites (men
and women). It contained their demands for
religious freedoms and civil rights, includ-
ing measures to tackle discrimination against
them.
In June, followers of the Ismaili sect in
Najran presented a manifesto entitled “The
homeland for all and all for the homeland”
to the Crown Prince. The document called
for equality among citizens and an end to
discrimination against Ismailis. This was fol-
lowed in September 2003 by the submission of
a petition entitled “Defence of the homeland”,
which criticized acts of violence and called for
political openness as a solution to the prevail-
ing crises. Over 100 people, mainly liberals
and a number of Islamists from different re-
gions of the Kingdom, signed the text.
In December 2003, a petition signed by
300 women and calling for improvements in
the status of women, including guarantees
of their full participation in public life was
submitted. Another petition, “Constitutional
reform first”, was signed by 116 national per-
sonalities, both Shi’ite and Sunni, most of them
with religious leanings. The petition called for a
constitutional monarchy and fundamental po-
litical reforms, including elections, control of
public funds and reform and independence of
the judiciary. In January 2004, after the second
round of national dialogue in the holy city of
Mecca, the official statement, “All for reform”,
was declared and signed by some 900 people,
mainly liberals, from throughout the King-
dom. The Crown Prince met with a number
of delegations to discuss their declarations and
proposals. Such progress, however, suffered a
setback after the authorities detained a group
of reform leaders at the end of March 2004.
In Libya, civil and political movements
continue to call for reform through the op-
position abroad. At the beginning of 2004,
a human rights organization (Watch) was
established in London, which is also a base
for various Internet publications that monitor
developments in Libya.
Towards peace
In countries experiencing civil war, such as
Somalia and the Sudan, civil society organi-
sations operating under international and re-
gional sponsorship remain pivotal in driving
the peace efforts under way in Kenya. (These
efforts have been proceeding for over a year in
the case of Somalia and for over 10 years in the
case of the Sudan). Significant breakthroughs
were achieved in this period. Such organiza-
tions have strived to contribute to peace efforts
by holding symposiums and workshops, by
meeting with and pressuring the leaderships
concerned and by expressing through the
media and demonstrations their desire to
see an urgent end to the state of war. Relief
organisations have also started to draw up
plans for dealing with the post-war situation,
in particular reconstruction, the settlement of
displaced persons and migrants and the deliv-
ery of immediate services to those in need.
In Palestine, civil society organizations are
active in many areas, from resisting occupa-
tion and defending human rights to assisting
Saudi Arabia
witnessed an
unprecedented
number of civil
initiatives.
The Kuwait parliament
is regarded as an
important platform for
expressing grassroots
demands, monitoring
the government
and questioning
government officials.
29 CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003
in relief and humanitarian aid operations and
calling for reform.
To conclude, various networks are now
springing up in order to promote the different
causes pursued by Arab civil organizations, cre-
ating links among them and reaping the benefit
of their joint resources. Such activities include
meetings, such as the Alexandria Conference,
which advocated speedy political reform in all
Arab countries. In addition, Internet networks
and Arab media establishments, including sat-
ellite channels and newspapers in the Arab di-
aspora, now offer wide opportunities for Arab
political and civil forces to communicate with
one another, publicise their activities and open
the way to joint initiatives.
These developments underscore the vital-
ity of civil and political life, energies all the
more remarkable because, given the frequent
hostility of the authorities, often the simplest
public activism, such as providing services to
disaster victims or the families of political pris-
oners, or even undertaking garbage collection,
entails risks.
EXTERNAL ATTEMPTS AT
CHANGE: THE BROADER MIDDLE
EAST INITIATIVE
The US Administration presented to the G8
countries a reform project in the region. The
project, initially called “The Greater Middle
East Initiative”, included a call to reshape the
Middle East through economic and social re-
forms that preserve the security interests of
the US and its allies in the region. The initia-
tive called for promoting democracy and good
governance, the establishment of a knowledge
society and the enhancement of economic op-
portunities.
After the document was leaked to the news-
paper Al-Hayat and its contents published on
February 13, 2004, the initiative encountered
strong criticism in Arab circles. Its critics said
that the initiative did not acknowledge the role
of Israeli occupation in impeding freedom and
development in the region, and that it was
drafted without consulting the Arab world.
Moreover, they maintained that it gave Arabs no
significant role in deciding their future course.
After reservations on the first draft by
Arabs and some European countries the US
embarked on consultations with its European
allies and some Arab leaders. The result was
put forward in an amended project called
the “Broader Middle East Initiative”, which
proposed more limited objectives. It was
adopted at the G8 summit in June 2004. Re-
sponding to Arab requests, the new initiative
acknowledged the importance of resolving the
Arab-Israeli conflict and of returning security
and peace to Iraq. At the same time, it was
reiterated that conflict should not stand in the
way of reforms.
The cornerstone of this initiative is the
“Future Forum”, a consultative mechanism of
interested nations under which ministers from
both sides meet. Parallel forums for business-
men and NGOs were also to be established.
Through these mechanisms, consultations are
to be conducted around political reform (mov-
ing towards democracy, the rule of law and
respect for freedoms and human rights); social
and cultural reform (reform and development
of education and respect for women’s rights
and the rights of expression); and economic
reform (enhancement of trade and investment
opportunities, financial resource mobilization
and eradicating corruption).
Although the modified initiative acknowl-
edges that reform should come from within
Arab societies and meet the Arab people’s
aspirations, there remain questions around the
effectiveness of its recommendations especially
since the ceiling of such recommendations has
been lowered and they have been incorporated
into existing projects that have not achieved
notable results.
Reform initiatives of the kind cited in this
section, both those originating in and outside
the region, were launched in an international
and regional context that often held up progress.
As the next section illustrates, that context also
affected human development negatively.
THE REGIONAL AND
INTERNATIONAL CONTEXT
The continued occupation of the Palestinian
territories by Israel, the US-led occupation of
Iraq and the escalation of terrorism had an ad-
verse influence on prospects for Arab human
Various networks
are now springing
up to promote the
different causes
pursued by Arab civil
organizations.
The simplest public
activism…entails
risks.
30 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
development.
The international human rights system
condemns foreign occupation as a violation of a
people’s right to freedom. Freedom lies at the
heart of the concept of human development.
Occupation is the negation of freedom and the
right to self-determination, and thus obstructs
human development. This can be seen particu-
larly in Palestine where occupation has given
rise to significant violations of fundamental
human rights, while eroding people’s essential
capabilities, frustrating the efficient use of
those capabilities and cutting short many op-
portunities for human development.
The practices of occupation forces, par-
ticularly in Palestine, amounted to human
development reversals for Arabs as the region
experienced setbacks because opportunities
for peace and security were not grasped.
Such practices sapped the struggle for free-
dom and good governance in Arab countries
in several ways. They provided Arab regimes
with pretexts to halt or postpone the process of
democratization, citing external threats. They
forced Arab reformers to focus their struggle
on resisting occupation, leaving less space on
their agendas for democratic reforms. And
they strengthened extremist groups as violent
as the occupiers, hence further narrowing
opportunities to achieve greater freedom in
the Arab public sphere and stifling emerging
reform initiatives.
ISRAELI OCCUPATION OF
PALESTINE CONTINUES
TO CONSTRAIN HUMAN
DEVELOPMENT AND FREEDOM
The protracted conflict in the occupied
Palestinian territories has resulted in escalat-
ing human and economic losses to both sides,
albeit disproportionately. However, since the
scope of this Report is confined to Arab human
development, this section naturally focuses on
the impact of occupation on Arab develop-
ment.
In the period under review, the UN Com-
mission on Human Rights (Round 60, March
2004, Annex 2) condemned Israel’s occupa-
tion of Palestine as a crime against humanity
and a flagrant violation of human rights. The
occupation resulted in the following:
Violations of the right to life
In 2003 and in early 2004, Israeli forces
stepped up their raids and incursions into, and
re-occupation of cities and villages in the West
Bank and Gaza, inflicting significant human
and material devastation.
Between May 2003 and end-June 2004, a
total of 768 Palestinians were killed and 4,064
injured (Palestinian Red Crescent Society web-
site, www.palestinercs.org, September 2004).
22.7 per cent of Palestinians killed during
that period were children under 18 (B’Tselem
website, www.btselem.org, September 2004).
In the same period 189 Israelis were killed,
8.9 per cent of them children. The majority
of Israeli civilians were killed when Palestin-
ians blew themselves up in crowded locations
inside Israel. It goes without saying that any
loss of innocent life is unconscionable and un-
acceptable.
Actions of the Israeli Occupation army
against civilians, particularly in Rafah, received
widespread condemnation. The Security
Council condemned the Israeli operations (SC
resolution 1544, 19 May 2004) with 14 out of
15 members voting in favour and the US ab-
staining. Israeli citizens also protested against
BOX 2
The Arab people’s views on the importance of the
Palestinian question
A field study into Arab values, beliefs
and concerns found that among issues
that people in seven Arab countries
considered of the greatest importance in
the region, the Palestinian question was
rated at between 69% and 97%. Four
countries (Jordan, Egypt, Morocco and
Saudi Arabia) said that it was among the
top four priority issues. Both Morocco
and Saudi Arabia said it was the most
important issue.
(Source: Zogby, 2002, 34)
1
For example, Avraham Burg, the former Speaker of the Knesset and current Member representing the Labour Party: “Israel’s Failed Society Collapses,
Zionism’s End?”, International Herald Tribune, Washington DC, September 2003.
Keren Yedaya, film director, on the occasion of receiving the Camera d’Or at the 2004 Cannes Film Festival: “I come from Israel and we are re-
sponsible for the slavery of three million Palestinians. Please, there are many people in Israel who are fighting this occupation. Help them. Help the
Palestinians,” (Agence France Presse, 1 June 2004).
Occupation is the
negation of freedom
and the right to self-
determination.
The protracted conflict
in the occupied
Palestinian territories
has resulted in
escalating human
and economic losses
to both sides, albeit
disproportionately.
31 CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003
these actions
1
while some members of the
Israeli Army refused to serve in the Occupied
Territories and to wear their military medals.
2
Between September 2000 and September
2003, assassination operations by Israel esca-
lated causing the deaths of 328 Palestinians.
Targeting Palestinian leaders, Israel assas-
sinated Dr. Abdel Aziz al-Rantissi (April 17,
2004) after killing Sheikh Ahmed Yassin,
the spiritual leader of the Islamic Resistance
Movement (Hamas) on 21 March 2004. Al-
though the US used its veto to prevent the UN
Security Council from condemning Israel for
the assassination of Sheikh Yassin, the act was
widely criticized around the world. It was also
condemned by elements of Israeli society.
Violations of human rights and individual
and collective freedoms
In the past year, this pattern has intensified
reflected in collective punishment, including
arbitrary arrest and detention, and repeated
restrictive closures. Figures issued by the
Palestinian Ministry of Detainees and Ex-
Prisoners (July 8, 2004) indicate that 7,400
Palestinians were imprisoned in Israeli jails
and camps at the end of June 2004. 470 of
those incarcerated were children, of whom 206
spent their 18th birthday in prison. (Source:
International Press Centre, July 2004).
Checkpoints and curfews have continued
to restrict the free movement of people, serv-
ices and goods within, to and from Palestine.
At the beginning of 2004, an estimated 734
checkpoints were dividing Palestinian territo-
ries into enclaves. This forced fragmentation
has precipitated a large-scale humanitarian cri-
sis and adversely affected Palestinian economic
and social rights.
Israel continued its policy of demolitions,
destroying property and land.
3
More than
12,000 homes have been either demolished or
damaged in the West Bank since 2000. Between
September 2000 and through September 2004,
more than 24,000 Palestinians living in the
Gaza strip have been made homeless by Israeli
house demolitions. In the first nine months of
2004, the Israeli Defence Forces demolished on
average 120 residential buildings each month -
or four each day.
4
Israel’s incursion into Rafah
in May 2004 alone left some 4,000 Palestinians
homeless after the Israeli army destroyed their
homes supposedly to prevent arms smuggling
through tunnels.
Social and economic losses
Nutrition and health conditions have dete-
riorated in the Occupied Territories since
September 2000. The number of anaemic
children aged 6-59 months has increased to
37.9%
5
. Palestinian women have been most
severely affected with 48% of women aged 15-
49 suffering from anaemia.
6
Post-natal health
care has also decreased while child birth rates
2
“It is an organization that doesn’t hesitate to drop bombs on the most densely populated areas in the world.” Captain Alon, expressing his embar-
rassment over belonging to the Israeli Armed Forces, Newsweek.
3
Amnesty international declared that the repeated practice by the Israeli army of deliberate and wanton destruction of houses and civilian property
was a grave violation of international human rights, notably of Articles 33 and 53 of the 4th Geneva Convention, and constituted a “war crime.”
(Press Release 13 October 2003).
4
Office for the Coordination of Humanitarian affairs. occupied Palestinian territory. Humanitarian Information Fact Sheet January 2005. www.
Humanitarianinfo.org/opt/OCHA
5
UNICEF, At a glance: occupied Palestinian territory.www.unicef.org/infobycountry/opt_1535.html.
6
UNDP: Millennium Development Goals Report - Palestine.2002
BOX 4
World Bank President Finds Israel’s Conduct Shameful
“Israel’s military operations pertaining to
the demolitions of thousands of homes
in Rafah are reckless, and leaves tens of
thousands of people without a roof over
their heads ….As a Jew, I am ashamed of
this kind of treatment of people”.
Source: World Bank Blasts Israel in Wake of Gaza Operations, David Lipkin quoting James D. Wolfensohn, Maariv
International, 17 May 2004
BOX 3
Unnoticed Losses
Testimony of Peter Hansen, Commis-
sioner-General of UNRWA
“It is the unfortunate lot of the Palestin-
ians that the loss of their homes to the
maws of Israeli military bulldozers or
powerful explosive charges is now so
commonplace that it fails to make the
grade as news. After all, something that
happens every day, usually more than
once a day, eventually stops being news.
But it doesn’t stop being terrifying.
Source: International Herald Tribune, 23 June 2003
Israel has demolished
4,000 Palestinian
homes in the past
three years.
Forced fragmentation
has precipitated
a large-scale
humanitarian crisis (in
Palestine).
32 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
at hospitals have decreased to 67%.
7
In 46 re-
corded cases, pregnant women who were held
up at checkpoints were unable to reach a hos-
pital in time and had to give birth on the spot.
More than half the infants born under these
conditions (27 of them) died during delivery.
8
UNICEF notes that at the start of the
school year 2002/2003, over 226,000 children
and 9,300 teachers were unable to reach their
schools. 580 schools have been closed as a re-
sult of Israeli curfews, checkpoints and restric-
tions on movement.
9

The Palestinian economy has been debili-
tated resulting in increased poverty and unem-
ployment. Currently 58.1% of the population
subsists below the poverty line and unemploy-
ment is estimated to be 28.6% (UN/OCHA).
10

Hesitating to carry out necessary insti-
tutional reforms and without the means to
govern effectively at its disposal, the Palestin-
ian National Authority proved unable to cope
with meeting people’s needs.
The separation wall undermines human
development
Israel continued constructing the separation
wall, which does not follow the boundary be-
tween the occupied territories and Israel but
incorporates Palestinian land. The Wall is thus
twice as long as the old boundary and represents
an expansionist move by Israel. The building
of the wall was condemned in a UN General
Assembly resolution adopted in October 2003
by 144 votes (UN General Assembly Resolution
ES-10/13). The Secretary-General also issued
a statement on 28 November 2003 describing
Israel’s action as contrary to international law.
The International Court of Justice, in
response to a General Assembly request, also
issued a decisive advisory opinion on July 9,
2004 on the legal consequences of construct-
ing the Wall. The Court ruled (by a substantial
majority of 14 to 1) that the Wall violates
international law, declared that it should be
removed and called on Israel to compensate
Palestinians harmed by the structure.
11

Subsequently, on July 20, the United Na-
tions General Assembly approved the Court’s
findings by a substantial majority of 165-6, with
15 abstentions. However, Israel announced
that it would proceed with the construction
of the Wall.
The first section of the Wall has been built.
Completion of the three planned phases will
result in the loss of 43.5% of Palestinian land
to the Israeli side of the Wall (Palestinian sub-
mission to the International Court of Justice,
88-89, in Arabic), as well as the “balkanisa-
7
ibid
8
ibid
9
UNICEF, At a glance: occupied Palestinian territory.www.unicef.org/infobycountry/opt_reallives.html
10
Office for the Coordination of Humanitarian affairs. occupied Palestinian territory. Humanitarian Information Fact Sheet January 2005. www.
Humanitarianinfo.org/opt/OCHA
11
International Court of Justice, Legal Consequences of the Construction of a Wall in the Occupied Palestinian Territory, Summary of the Advisory
Opinion of 9 July 2004.
BOX 5
By Law, This Wall Should Come Down - Findings of the
International Court of Justice (ICJ).
The International Court of Justice found,
by 14 votes to 1, that:
“The construction of the wall being
built by Israel, the occupying Power,
in the Occupied Palestinian Territory,
including in and around East Jerusalem,
and its associated régime, are contrary to
international law;”
By 14 votes to 1, the Court stated
that:
“Israel is under an obligation to
terminate its breaches of international
law; it is under an obligation to cease
forthwith the works of construction of
the wall being built in the Occupied
Palestinian Territory, including in and
around East Jerusalem, to dismantle
forthwith the structure therein situated,
and to repeal or render ineffective forth-
with all legislative and regulatory acts
relating thereto;”
By 14 votes to 1, the Court further
ruled that:
“Israel is under an obligation to
make reparation for all damage caused
by the construction of the wall...;”
On matters of human rights, the ICJ
was of the opinion that: “the construc-
tion of the wall and its associated régime
impede the liberty of movement of the
inhabitants of the Occupied Palestinian
Territory (with the exception of Israeli
citizens and those assimilated thereto)
as guaranteed under Article 12, para-
graph 1, of the International Covenant
on Civil and Political Rights. They also
impede the exercise by the persons con-
cerned of the right to work, to health, to
education and to an adequate standard of
living as proclaimed in the International
Covenant on Economic, Social and Cul-
tural Rights and in the United Nations
Convention on the Rights of the Child.”
In reaching its conclusions, the ICJ
considered and set aside Israel’s conten-
tion that construction of the wall was
an act of self-defence and moreover re-
jected its claim that the structure was an
unavoidable necessity: “The Court is not
convinced that the construction of the
wall along the route chosen was the only
means to safeguard the interests of Israel
against the peril which it has invoked as
justification for that construction.”
The Court concluded, 14 to 1, by
urging that: “the United Nations, and
especially the General Assembly and the
Security Council, should consider what
further action is required to bring to an
end the illegal situation resulting from
the construction of the wall and the as-
sociated regime.”
Source: International Court of Justice, Legal Consequences of the Construction of a Wall in the Occupied Palestinian
Territory, Advisory Opinion of 9 July 2004.
Pregnant women
who were held up
at checkpoints were
unable to reach a
hospital in time and
had to give birth on
the spot.
33 CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003
tion” of the remaining Palestinian territories.
When finished the Wall will divide the West
Bank into cantons in three separated areas
where life in some pockets will be extremely
difficult. As box 6 illustrates, the Wall is also
slicing through religious facilities and blocking
pilgrimage routes, hampering people’s right to
practice their faith.
Looking to the Future
From a human development perspective,
only the end of Israel’s occupation of territo-
ries occupied in 1967 and the restoration of
Palestinians’ rights, formost among which is
the right to self-determination, will bring about
that lasting peace the absence of which so far
has contributed to frustrating human develop-
ment in the region.
THE IMPACT OF THE
OCCUPATION OF IRAQ ON HUMAN
DEVELOPMENT
As a result of the invasion of their country, the
Iraqi people have emerged from the grip of a
despotic regime that violated their basic rights
and freedoms, only to fall under a foreign oc-
cupation that increased human suffering in the
following ways:
Absence of security and violations of the
right to life
Under occupation, the security of Iraqi citi-
zens deteriorated, and their lives came under
further threat. The end of major combat op-
erations in May 2003 did not signal an end
to the killing of Iraqi civilians. According to
Amnesty International, at least 10,000 people
were killed
12
between the start of the mili-
tary intervention and March 2004. (Amnesty
International, 18 March, 2004).
The largest number of victims fell during
search-and-arrest operations, as a result of
shootings at demonstrators, or at road-blocks
and checkpoints and through the shelling of
residential areas.
The occupying powers failed to meet their
obligations under the Geneva Conventions to
provide security to citizens. Iraq witnessed an
unprecedented loss of internal security, with
killings and acts of terrorism in most parts of
the country, including a series of explosions
during the religious celebrations of Ashoura
and targeting some churches in Iraq, possibly
intended to trigger ethnic and religious strife
in the country. There were also attacks on re-
ligious leaders and imams of mosques. Other
victims have included a number of nuclear
scientists, outstanding scientific experts, uni-
versity professors, judges, doctors and others
of notable achievement in the arts and litera-
ture (Arab Organization for Human Rights).
A survey conducted by a British organization
showed that three-quarters of Iraqis in the
Middle and the South do not feel safe (Oxford
Research International, 2004).
13
International organizations were not
12
An updated estimate of Iraqi casualties since the 2003 invasion, published after this Part was completed, puts the figures much higher. The study
is based on a cluster sample survey covering Iraqi governorates, where the numbers, causes and circumstances of death were compared during the
period of 14.6 months before the invasion, and 17.8 months after it. The study concluded that the death toll associated with the invasion and the
violence accompanying occupation is about 100,000 Iraqis. See Roberts, L. et al.,”Mortality before and after the 2003 invasion of Iraq: cluster sample
survey”, The Lancet, vol. 364, pages 1857-1864, November 20,2004.
13
Oxford Research International, National Surveys of Iraq, Oxford, 2004.
BOX 6
Israel’s Restrictions on Churches in the Holy Land
Christian churches in the Holy Land are
facing an unprecedented crisis that some
say is jeopardizing their future, including
their capacity to maintain the faith’s holy
sites and charitable institutions and to
educate clergy.
The Israeli government has failed
to renew visas or residence permits for
hundreds of religious workers, and has
begun sending tax bills to charitable
groups that have long had tax-exempt
status, some since the Ottoman Empire.
At the same time the separation wall
being built in Jerusalem and on the West
Bank is slicing through religious facilities,
in some cases taking land and blocking
pilgrimage routes.
“All indications point to the fact
that the church is slowly but surely being
strangled,” said an official at the Latin
Patriarchate.
“The most difficult situation in liv-
ing memory for the Church in the Holy
Land”, according to Bishop Wilton
Gregory, president of the US Conference
of Catholic Bishops in a letter he sent to
President Bush.
“In the Catholic world there is a
growing view that Israel has deliberately
framed a policy to hurt the Church”,
the Rev. David Jaeger, representative of
the Holy See told the Israeli newspaper
Ha’aretz.
“It’s hard to accept that it’s a purely
bureaucratic problem…renewing a visa
used to take only half a day. They even
are threatening to expel a sister who is
92 years old and has lived here for more
than 50 years, and another who is 82”,
stated the Rev. Robert Fortin, a Catholic
official.
Source: Christian Science Monitor, 4 May 2004.
The Iraqi people have
emerged from the
grip of a despotic
regime that violated
their basic rights
only to fall under a
foreign occupation
that increased human
suffering.
34 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
spared. The explosion at UN headquarters in
Baghdad on 19 August 2003 killed 22 people
including the Special Representative of the
UN Secretary-General, Sergio Vieira de Mello.
Another explosion took place at the Interna-
tional Committee of the Red Cross (ICRC)
central office in Baghdad on 27 November
2003. A number of Arab and foreign civilians
also fell prey to terrorist attacks, some savagely
beheaded.
The right to freedom
Thousands of Iraqis have been imprisoned
since the occupation began. The BBC reported
on April 2004 that, according to the United
Kingdom authorities, US and UK forces
were holding more than 5,300 Iraqi prison-
ers. A large proportion of detainees were
civilians who were arrested in the course of
search operations and raids. As a rule, these
persons were not told what the charges against
them were, and were not held under any par-
ticular provision of the law. An ICRC report
revealed, on the basis of information obtained
from Coalition intelligence officials, that 70%
– 90% of these detainees had been arrested in
error in the course of night raids (ICRC report,
February 2004).
The spread of chaos in the country also
undermined Iraqis’ security and freedom.
Abductions and disappearances became com-
monplace. Some incidents involved kidnap-
pings for ransom, others were acts of revenge,
but the worst concerned political operations
aimed at killing or removing intellectuals and
scientists (Arab Human Rights Organisation).
Women suffered the most. They were, and
still remain, at risk of abduction and rape by
professional gangs. In a permanent state of
fear, they avoided leaving their homes and
families were reluctant to send their daugh-
ters to school (ibid.). In some cases, coalition
soldiers also sexually abused female prisoners
(Taguba Report).
Nonetheless, the situation did not prevent
the revival of civil society. Numerous civil so-
ciety institutions and more than 200 political
parties representing a variety of orientations
had been established, and 38 newspapers
were in circulation by end-2003. Despite
this broader scope for freedom of the media,
efforts to suppress views opposed to the oc-
cupation continued. Examples included a two-
week ban by the Governing Council on the
Al-Arabiyya and Al-Jazeera networks, and an
order by the US-led authorities in March 2004
closing Al-Hawzah, the newspaper of the Shi-
ite leader, Muqtada al-Sadr (news.bbc.co.uk).
The interim Iraqi government has since lifted
the ban on Al-Arabiya and Al-Hawza but not
on Al-Jazeera.
Mis-treatment of prisoners of war and
detainees
Towards the end of April 2004 the media pub-
lished photographs depicting the inhumane
and immoral treatment of Iraqi prisoners in
the Abu Ghraib Prison under the US military.
Many victims were civilians not charged with
any offence. The exposé was shortly followed
by reports of abuses by British troops. Such
mistreatment is a clear breach of the Geneva
Conventions. While the American-British
Coalition leaders condemned the violations,
they also claimed initially that they were iso-
lated individual cases rather than the result of a
deliberate policy or of a systemic problem.
However, Amnesty International reported
that these were not isolated cases and that it
had received numerous similar reports of tor-
ture and other ill-treatment of Iraqi prisoners
by Coalition forces. The organization called for
an independent and impartial investigation of
these incidents (30 April 2004). An internal US
army investigation report prepared by Major-
General Antonio Taguba, in February 2004,
which was leaked to the media, stated that such
violations were part of an established, system-
atic pattern (The Antonio Taguba Report, The
New Yorker, 4 April 2004). The International
Committee of the Red Cross disclosed that it
had reached similar conclusions and had made
them available to the Coalition Forces. The
ICRC noted that since the beginning of the
conflict, it had “regularly brought its concerns
to the attention of the Coalition Forces…[but]
allegations of ill-treatment continued…and
thus suggested that the use of ill-treatment
…went beyond exceptional cases and might be
considered as a practice tolerated by the Coali-
tion Forces” (ICRC report, February 2004).
Women suffered the
most.
Many victims were
civilians not charged
with any offence.
35 CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003
The revelation that crimes of torture were
being committed in Iraqi prisons brought wide
condemnation internationally and from within
the US itself. Voices in the American media
demanded that those responsible be called
to account. The American Congress opened
a series of investigations into the matter. It is
noteworthy that the US media were the first to
broadcast the photographs of violations in Abu
Ghraib Prison.
Dismantling the Iraqi State structure
The dismantling of the structure of the State
of Iraq, which was more than 80 years old, was
one of the negative results of the occupation.
The first signals of this policy came when
Coalition forces stood by as governmental
institutions (with some exceptions including
the Ministry of Petroleum) were looted and
destroyed, followed by the disbanding of the
Iraqi Army. The destruction of the infrastruc-
ture, material resources and documents of the
various Ministries was accompanied by the
disruption of functional structures in the ob-
scure situation created by “de-Ba’thification”
operations.
After dismantling the old state, the US-led
authorities made little progress in building a
new one. Despite the optimistic reports pub-
lished by the Occupation forces and the US
Administration their performance continued
to be deficient. The occupation forces strug-
gled to bring various services, such as electric-
ity, water and telephones, back to their pre-war
levels. As of end - October, 2004, out of the
US$ 18.4 billion appropriated for Iraq’s re-
construction by the US Congress, an estimated
US$ 1.3 billion had been spent - only about 7
percent.
14
Looking to the future
By midyear, with the help of the Special
Adviser of the UN Secretary General, an
interim Government had been appointed in
preparation for holding elections and drafting
a permanent constitution. Under an annex to
the Law on the Administration of the Iraqi
State, the interim Government is prohibited
from undertaking any actions that will affect
the future of Iraq after the specified interim
period. The formal transfer of power to the in-
terim government took place on 28 June 2004.
Iraq’s future is still beset by dangers. From
the standpoint of human development, free-
dom and good governance, it is difficult to see
how lasting benefits can accrue from the grave
events that have occurred in the country and
the massive damage it has sustained after inva-
sion and occupation, unless its territorial integ-
rity is preserved and sovereignty fully resides
with the Iraqi people under a system of good
governance, and unless Iraq is unified on a firm
basis of common citizenship and freedom.
THE ESCALATION OF TERRORISM
Arab countries have been subjected to
a number of serious terrorist attacks, most
notably bombings in Saudi Arabia, Morocco
and Iraq. Attacks have also occurred in major
neighbouring states: in Turkey, whose Prime
Minister took a strong position in support of
Arab human rights (May 2004), condemning
violations, and in Spain, which can play an
important role as a natural bridge linking Arab
countries with Europe.
These are crimes that constitute flagrant,
indiscriminate violations of the human rights
of their victims, including such fundamental
rights as the right to life and to physical and
psychological health. These unacceptable acts
affect children, women and old people who are
innocent by any decent human standards, or
any religious teaching.
In addition to the gross human costs, these
events have undoubtedly undermined human
welfare and economic activity especially in
those Arab countries that depend on tourism
BOX 7
Conclusion of the Taguba Report
Several US Army Soldiers have commit-
ted egregious acts and grave breaches of
international law at Abu Ghraib/BCCF
and Camp Bucca, Iraq. Furthermore,
key senior leaders failed to comply with
established regulations, policies, and
command directives in preventing de-
tainee abuses at Abu Ghraib (BCCF) and
at Camp Bucca during the period August
2003 to February 2004.
Source: Report by Major-General Taguba, p 50
14
Third Quarterly Report to Congress: Appendix J, US Department of Defence Status Report on Iraq, October 30,2004, cited in “Progress or Peril
-Measuring Iraq’s Reconstruction”, Centre for Strategic and International Studies, December, 2004.
After dismantling the
old state, the US-led
authorities made little
progress in building a
new one.
These unacceptable
acts (of terrorism)
affect children,
women and old
people who are
innocent by any
decent human
standards or any
religious teaching.
36 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
and foreign investment. They have also had
negative impacts on internal stability in the
region, on neighbouring countries and on the
world as a whole.
ADDRESSING THE THREE
DEFICITS: GAINS AND SETBACKS
During the period in review some Arab coun-
tries took steps to deal with their capability
gaps in knowledge acquisition, freedom and
good governance and women’s empowerment,
the three cardinal deficits of the region identi-
fied in the first AHDR. However, progress
was uneven in the area of freedoms particu-
larly, where many countries experienced set-
backs. The following section reviews these
developments.
KNOWLEDGE ACQUISITION
There were a number of positive developments
in the field of education, the most important of
which was increased attention to quality issues
at the different levels of education.
In an unprecedented development, 9 Arab
states have now participated in an international
study designed to evaluate students’ perform-
ance in science and mathematics in basic educa-
tion. UNDP’s Regional Bureau for Arab States
is enabling five of these countries to participate
in the study. At the tertiary level, the Union of
Arab Universities, targeting the advancement
of higher education establishments, decided to
set up an independent institution to evaluate
the quality of higher education, in cooperation
with the Regional Bureau for Arab States,
The Regional Bureau for Arab States plans
to extend its programmes for assessing of the
quality of higher education in Arab countries
to two new fields, namely law and education.
In Egypt, the Ministry of Education is co-
operating with UNICEF, civil associations and
teachers to draw on local and international ex-
perience to set down national standards for ex-
cellence. The project covers various aspects of
the educational process (efficacy of the teacher
and school, societal participation, education
outputs, etc) at all stages of pre-university edu-
cation. This is a major step towards improving
the quality of education, and has attracted
international interest with a view to replicating
the example in the rest of the region.
In Bahrain, a National Conference on Edu-
cation was held in 2003 to produce a compre-
hensive approach to unifying secondary-level
Progress was uneven
in the area of
freedoms particularly.
BOX 9
“Development” of the University of the United Arab Emirates
The University of the United Arab
Emirates—its Faculty of Humanities
in particular—has undergone a radical
restructuring in the course of the past
year, with departments being abolished
and new fields of specialisation added.
The Departments of Islamic Studies,
English Language and Literature and
French Language and Literature have
been merged into a single programme,
the Departments of Political Science and
Geography have been merged into a Po-
litical Science, Government and Cultural
Studies Unit, and the Departments of
Arabic Language and Literature, His-
tory and Heritage have been combined.
Furthermore, the language of instruction
has been changed from Arabic to English
(although in the case of a very few sub-
jects, faculty members may be allowed
to give their courses in Arabic, provided
they are able to show adequate cause why
that is necessary).
Certainly proficiency in English or
other foreign languages is essential, as are
computer skills; educational plans and
programmes must, of course, take labour
market requirements into account. But
this should not lead to neglecting the
Arabic language altogether, or discard-
ing some fields of specialisation on the
grounds that there is no market demand
for them. Human knowledge is multi-
faceted; its various aspects interact with
each other, and all of them contribute to
the expansion of people’s mental hori-
zons, flexibility, creativity, and ability to
contribute effectively to their society’s
development.
BOX 8
Quality Assessment of Primary and Middle Education in
Mathematics and Science (TIMSS 2003) in the Arab World
RAB01/005/A/01/31
In the context of monitoring the quality
of education and improvement of educa-
tional achievement, nine Arab countries
participated in the project entitled:
Trends in International Mathematics
and Science Study (TIMSS 2003); these
countries included Jordan, Bahrain,
Tunis, Syria, Palestine, Lebanon, Egypt,
Morocco and Yemen.
The United Nations Development
Programme supported the participation
of Syria, Palestine, Lebanon, Egypt and
Yemen, in addition to the provision of
coordination work amongst all Arab
participants.
TIMSS 2003 is considered the larg-
est international comparative and assess-
ment study aimed at measuring fourth
and eighth grade student achievement in
Mathematics and Science in almost fifty
countries. The 'Study' had also compiled
extensive data relevant to the changes af-
fecting student, teacher and school, with
regards to their achievement in the afore
mentioned disciplines.
The average performance in math-
ematics, for the participating eighth
grade Arab students reached 392 in com-
parison to a 467 international average
scale score. Whereas the average Arab
student performance in science reached
416 in comparison to a 474 international
average scale score.
It is noteworthy to mention that
Lebanon ranked first in mathematics
among the participating Arab countries,
achieving an average scale score of 433;
this being lower than the international
average scale score in Mathematics. On
the other hand, Jordan outperformed
Arab participating countries in science
achieving an average scale score of 475;
only one score higher than the interna-
tional average scale score.
These results indicate a need for
undertaking serious developmental ef-
forts in the Arab countries to improve
the level of student achievement in math-
ematics and science, instruments for de-
velopment and progress in this era.
37 CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003
BOX 10
An Assessment of Business Administration Programmes in Arab Universities
A second cycle of academic reviews, focused
on the evaluation of the quality of Business
Administration education, was completed
this spring by the Regional Bureau for Arab
States, as part of its ongoing project for en-
hancing the quality of education in Arab uni-
versities. The year-long process was carried
out with the participation of 17 Arab univer-
sities (14 public, 3 private) from 11 countries
(Algeria, Bahrain, Egypt, Jordan, Lebanon,
Morocco, Oman, Palestine, Sudan, Syria and
Yemen). The first review cycle was completed
last spring and resulted in the evaluation of
Computer Science programmes in 15 Arab
universities (AHDR 2003, 57).
The new reviews were completed on
schedule for all participating programmes
with the exception of that at Al-Azhar Uni-
versity, Gaza. This was because the external
review team was unable to enter the city after
the occupation army suddenly closed off its
entry. As in the first cycle, the review was
carried out in three stages (training, inter-
nal evaluation and external evaluation and
reporting).
The results show that the academic stand-
ards of only two of the 16 programmes were
judged to be “Good”, that four were found
to be “Unsatisfactory” and the remaining ten
“Satisfactory”. The reviews also showed that
the internal mechanisms for quality assurance
and enhancement were “Unsatisfactory” in 6
of the programmes, “Satisfactory” in 9 and
“Good” in one. All this indicates that, in
general, the universities need to raise per-
formance in order to achieve the levels of
excellence that are normally expected from
modern universities.
The picture looks somewhat better
with regard to two of three aspects that
characterise the learning opportunities that
the programmes provide to their students,
namely, Methods of Learning & Teaching
and Student Progression: one fourth of the
programmes were graded as “Good” in
each case. But in respect of the third aspect
within the same category, which is concerned
with the standards of learning resources and
facilities, only one programme was graded
as “Good”, six as “Unsatisfactory” and the
remaining 9 as “Satisfactory”. These ratings
substantiate the reviewers’ general conclusion
that, while academic staff were, in the major-
ity of cases, well qualified academically and
diligent in performing their duties, the stand-
ards of learning resources available, including
the numbers of available academic staff, were
unsatisfactory in many cases and below the
levels required for achieving excellence, in
most of them.
Detailed analyses of the various strengths
and weaknesses identified by the reviewers
under each aspect of review and programme
are presented in a final review report sent, in
confidence, to each university.
The picture is further illustrated by a
number of derived indicators that quantify
some of the detailed aspects of each review.
Thus, with regard to learning resources,
the number of available academic staff was
not found to be “Good” in any of the pro-
grammes. Library, Internet and PC facilities
were “Good” in about one fourth of the cases
but “Unsatisfactory” in about half, a high
ratio by any standards. The indicators also
reveal major weaknesses with regard to the
following specific academic aspects of the
programmes
• Practical inputs to the curriculum and
work placement experiences
• Support for independent learning and
internship programmes
• Promotion of critical modes of thinking as
opposed to didactic methods of teaching.
• Effective use of the “graduation project”
• Internal and external moderation of ex-
aminations and other student assessments
The review results clearly show that the
situation varies between universities. A small
minority of the participating group seems
to have reached a good level of develop-
ment while a larger group is moving in that
direction. This is evidenced by a number of
emerging good practices that were noted with
satisfaction. These include: breadth of cur-
riculum coverage, enhanced practical inputs
to teaching, improved methods of student
assessment, increased focus on graduation
projects. Moreover, the reviewers strongly
commended what they identified as a clear
determination by the majority of participating
universities and academics to meet the chal-
lenges of academic evaluation and to make
full use of its outcomes to raise the quality of
their programmes.
How Participating Universities Fared on Key Indicators of Quality
Source: Isam Naqib, Project director
38 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
academic programmes in order to bring them
into line with the needs and requirements of
society, while responding to the demands of
the contemporary age. A related goal is to up-
grade students’ skills and capacities.
Kuwait is implementing a special pro-
gramme to deal with why pupils drop out of,
or fail at school and to develop assessment and
evaluation methodologies.
Tunisia announced an initiative for ad-
dressing the causes of various forms of student
failure and for achieving higher progress and
success rates.
FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE
Signs of political openness
Some Arab governments have begun to open
themselves cautiously and selectively to oppo-
sition forces and have started expanding the
public sphere:
In Egypt, at the closing meeting of the first
annual conference of the ruling party on 28
September 2003, the President of the Republic
announced a number of democratic reforms
that had been submitted by the party’s Policy
Committee. The reforms include the abolition
of some military decrees promulgated under
the Emergency Law
15
, more freedom for politi-
cal parties and trade unions, and safeguards for
women’s rights (including the right to transmit
their nationality to their children). The rul-
ing National Democratic Party called upon
licensed opposition parties to engage in dia-
logue on political reform.
In the autumn of 2003 the Egyptian Gov-
ernment released approximately 1,000 detain-
ees from the Islamist movement.
President Mubarak, addressing the Gen-
eral Conference of Egyptian Journalists in
February 2004, announced a move towards
abolishing imprisonment as a punishment for
publication-related offences.
16
The Egyptian Parliament passed a law in
June 2003 to abolish state security courts, and
in January 2004 the formation of the National
Council for Human Rights was announced.
In Oman, legislative elections took place
in October 2003. 509 candidates competed
for 83 seats. Fifteen of them were women. The
right to vote was extended to those 21 years
of age and above. As a result, the number of
citizens eligible to vote rose to 822,000 com-
pared to 114,000 in the year 2000 elections.
262,000 citizens registered as voters, of whom
95,000 were women. 74% of registered vot-
ers actually participated and voted in the elec-
tions. Two women who were members of the
previous consultative council won seats in the
election.
In Saudi Arabia, the intention to conduct
municipal elections at the end of 2004 was an-
nounced and a journalists’ association and a
national commission for human rights were es-
tablished. Scenes from sessions of the country’s
Consultative Council were shown on television
for the first time. The founding of the “King
Abd Al-Aziz Centre for National Dialogue”
was also announced.
In Qatar, a new Constitution to take effect
in June 2005 was promulgated after a referen-
dum, and the country’s first National Commit-
tee on Human Rights was established.
In Bahrain, a new Charter for “political”
associations was issued.
In Syria, the leadership of the ruling Ba’th
Party called for the separation of the executive
power and the Party. For the first time, an in-
dividual who was not a member of the Party
leadership was elected as Speaker of the Peo-
ple’s Assembly.
In Morocco, the legal system was qualita-
tively enhanced by the addition of freedom-
friendly provisions in the fields of: labour, the
family, electoral arrangements and the media.
The King granted an amnesty to more than
1,000 detainees. A “Justice and Reconcilia-
tion” commission was established with a man-
date to heal the wounds of Moroccan society as
a result of human rights violations in the past
15
But not an end to the state of emergency itself.
16
The next day, however, an opposition journalist reported that his case had been referred to the jurisdiction of the criminal courts under the provi-
sions of the law prescribing imprisonment for journalists. It subsequently appeared that sentences of imprisonment had not been abolished alto-
gether: the President of the People’s Assembly announced that they would continue to be imposed in cases of “crimes” involving disrespect for the
President of the Republic, military matters, espionage, and slander.
Some Arab
governments have
begun to open
themselves cautiously
and selectively to
opposition forces.
39 CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003
and 4,500 victims were given compensation.
The “Special Court of Justice” was abolished.
In Algeria, house arrest on the leader of
the Islamic Salvation Front was lifted. He and
his Deputy remain unable to exercise political
and civil rights. In the April 2004 presidential
elections the incumbent in office contested five
other candidates for the first time, and was
elected by an overwhelming majority.
Indications of a regression in popular
participation
In one Arab country, fewer men and women
stood as candidates for election to the National
Assembly.
In another, a low turnout marred the
local elections in September 2003. Only 5%
of the candidates were women, even though
35 women had won seats in the Parliamentary
elections held approximately two years earlier.
In a third, 15 members of the People’s As-
sembly were found ineligible to take their seats
for having evaded their compulsory military
service. In the view of some legal experts, by-
elections that had been held in contravention
of a Supreme Administrative Court ruling
raised questions about the eligibility, not only
of the winning candidates, but of the entire
Assembly.
Freedoms Constrained
Obvious human rights violations have contin-
ued, notably in cases involving human rights
activists in Arab countries. We have space here
to mention only a few examples:
In one Arab country, the authorities de-
tained 30 people demonstrating in support of
abolishing the State of Emergency. Many peo-
ple were detained for political reasons, among
them at least 20 Kurds who were arrested dur-
ing a peaceful demonstration after their return
from exile. Hundreds of political prisoners,
notably Islamists, are still in jail including
prisoners of conscience while others, including
some non-nationals, are missing.
In another country, on World Press Free-
dom Day 2003, the National Committee for
the Defence of Freedom of Expression issued
a statement condemning what it termed the
muzzling of freedom of expression, the tyranny
of uniformity of thought, the difficulties of
journalists in gaining access to sources of infor-
mation and the harassment they experienced
while seeking to exercise their right to free
speech. In addition, a number of human rights
activists and prisoners of conscience embarked
on a hunger strike in protest against harsh and
degrading treatment by the authorities and the
torturing of inmates in prison.
Human rights activists continue to report
cases of torture and mistreatment at detention
centres (including Ministries of the Interior).
Since February 2004, 20 cases of detention
have been recorded in the south of the country.
The detainees were accused of surfing Islamic
sites on the Internet. They were held at the
Ministry of the Interior and prevented from
contacting any one outside.
Defenders of human rights are frequently
victims of harassment and threats. They share
this with ex-political prisoners some of whom
are not allowed to work or to obtain a health
insurance card.
There are continuous accusations of tor-
ture and reports of unhealthy and inhumane
circumstances in prisons. An Islamist died on
March 22 after he was denied medical atten-
tion.
In a third country the People’s Assembly
decided in February 2003 that the emergency
laws should remain in force for a further pe-
riod of three years beginning in June of the
same year. In 2003, the Islamic Research
Council recommended that a book entitled
Al-Khitab wa al-Ta’wil [preaching and inter-
pretation] could not be sold in the country, on
the grounds that it attacked “two fundamental
tenets of the Islamic faith”, namely the unity of
God and preservation of the Qur’an. The book
in question, which had been published in an-
other Arab state, contains a prominent think-
er’s doctoral dissertation. In 2004, a novel by
a famous writer, first printed 20 years ago, was
recommended for confiscation.
A district regional Public Prosecution
Office ordered the detention of the 51 year-
old manager of a local contracting firm, with
no history of political activism, on charges of
“inciting hatred and disrespect for the Gov-
ernment”. The man, who was released soon
Human rights activists
continue to report
cases of torture and
mistreatment at
detention centres.
Obvious human
rights violations have
continued, notably in
cases involving human
rights activists in Arab
countries.
40 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
afterwards, had confessed to scrawling the
words “No to rule by inheritance” on walls.
While approximately 1,000 Islamists accused
in the “Islamic Jihad” case have been released,
a number of others remain behind bars even
though they have served their sentences. Some
of them are either seriously or chronically ill.
In one Mashriq country, 15 women were
reported killed by family members in honour
crimes. Meanwhile, political cases continue
to be seen by the state security court whose
laws are not in harmony with international
standards.
In one Gulf country, authorities booked
24 citizens on criminal charges for collecting
signatures on a political letter calling for con-
stitutional changes that give wider authority to
the elected parliament. The jailed are accused
of “calling for changes in the political regime,
inciting hatred and attempting to threaten na-
tional security”. Three were released without
being formally charged. In other cases, some
journalists received prison sentences because
they were connected with articles published in
the foreign press.
In one Arab North African country, in
July 2003, the National Union of Journalists
launched a campaign against the imprisonment
of journalists sentenced under the Anti-Terror-
ism Law and called for the release of all those
detained.
In another Gulf country, a number of
writers and intellectuals calling for reform
were detained, apparently in a deliberately
demeaning manner (a university professor
was handcuffed in front of his students at the
university) and some were forbidden to travel
abroad. A journalist who criticized the arrests
was himself detained.
In a country under occupation, a state of
emergency was decreed and an emergency
Government formed in October 2003.
In another Arab North African country,
the former Prime Minister and Secretary of
the former governing party was placed under
house arrest.
Freedom of civil society organizations
In one country, several months after the new
Law on Associations had come into force, civil
society leaders complained of the arbitrary be-
haviour of the administrative body established
under that law in refusing to approve new
grassroots institutions. It had, for example,
turned down an application from a centre for
housing rights, claiming that the application
contravened article 11 of the law. That article
provides that “the establishment of secret as-
sociations, or associations the aims of which
include the formation of military or paramili-
tary organizations or which present a threat
to national unity, public order or morality or
advocate discrimination among citizens, shall
be prohibited.”
Early in 2004, Organizations working in
the area of human rights protested the arbi-
trary handling of the issue of foreign funding
for Egyptian associations by the Ministry
responsible for administering the Law on As-
sociations.
In another country, the authorities pro-
ceeded to restrict voluntary and charitable
work, in particular the collection of donations,
influenced by the US Administration.
Restrictions on the media
According to the 2004 report published by
Reporters sans frontières, the Middle East was
the region that enjoyed the least press freedom
in the world that year, with few independent
media outlets. In a number of countries corre-
spondents exercised strict self-censorship. The
report added that the war in Iraq and the con-
tinuing Israeli/Palestinian conflict had placed
both the freedom and safety of the media at
risk. As many as 14 journalists were killed dur-
ing 2003, 12 in Iraq, five of them at the hands
of US-led occupation forces. Two correspond-
ent were killed by the Israeli occupation forces
in Palestine.
Foreign agencies have also participated
in restricting Arab media freedoms. In Spain,
a reporter for Al-Jazeera, Taysir Alouni, was
charged by the government with being an al-
Qa’ida member and arrested. The US Admin-
istration expressed dissatisfaction with Arab
satellite TV channels, particularly Al-Jazeera,
and informed the Qatari government of its
views.
Some journalists
received prison
sentences because
they were connected
with articles published
in the foreign press.
(In 2004), the Middle
East was the region
that enjoyed the least
press freedom in the
world.
Foreign agencies
have also participated
in restricting media
freedoms in the Arab
world.
41 CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003
Rights of subgroups: Darfur
In Darfur, western Sudan, thousands of civil-
ians were killed or injured, and women sub-
jected to rape, in attacks by the Janjaweed
militia, reportedly with government support.
Entire villages were laid waste, including
through indiscriminate aerial bombing, forc-
ing hundreds of thousands to abandon their
homes and livelihoods, with around 120,000
fleeing to Chad (Amnesty International web-
site, 29 June 2004). Though a ceasefire agree-
ment was signed in April 2004, it continues to
be violated by both the Government and the
rebels, with the humanitarian toll continuing
to mount.
In July 2004, the Security Council passed
a resolution (Resolution 1556 of 30 July 2004)
calling on the Government of Sudan to, inter
alia, fulfil its commitments regarding: the
facilitation of humanitarian access and as-
sistance; the advancement of an independent
investigation with the UN on violations of
human rights and international humanitarian
law; the establishment of credible security
conditions for the protection of civilians; the
resumption of political talks with the dissident
groups; the disarmament of the Janjaweed mi-
litias; and the prosecution of Janjaweed leaders
and their associates who have incited and car-
ried out human rights violations. The resolu-
tion also urged the rebel groups to respect
the cease-fire, end the violence immediately,
engage in peace talks without preconditions
and act in a positive and constructive manner
to end the conflict. Finally, it called on the
international community to support the efforts
of the African Union (AU) for the deployment
of international monitors and to provide addi-
tional assistance to mitigate the humanitarian
catastrophe.
The Government has fulfilled its com-
mitment to provide unimpeded access to the
humanitarian community, which has allowed
the latter to increase its level of assistance,
and it has deployed additional security forces
in camps for the protection of internally dis-
placed persons. But at the time of writing,
the Government had not fully complied with
the requirement of disarming the militias.
Furthermore it had taken minimal steps to
prosecute the perpetrators of humanitarian
law violations.
As these latter violations continued, con-
flict and human suffering increased despite the
cease-fire agreement and the interventions of
the international community. There remains
an urgent need to stop the inflow of arms to the
region and to arrive at a political solution to the
problem. A massive aid effort is also required
to assist the refugees in Chad and over one mil-
lion internally displaced people within Darfur.
Protest by intellectuals
In one Arab country, a hotly contested election
for seats on the executive of the journalists’
union ended with the defeat of the govern-
ment-sponsored candidate, for the first time
in many years, and victory for an opposition
candidate. This outcome was widely seen as
an important development in the struggle for
control of one of the country’s leading profes-
sional associations.
At the Arab Novelists’ Assembly organ-
ized by the Ministry of Culture, the novelist
Sonallah Ibrahim refused to accept the Novel-
ist of the Year award on the grounds that the
Government offering it “did not have, in my
view, the credibility to do so.” He read a state-
ment listing his reasons for declining the award
and spoke of the deteriorating Arab situation.
Ibrahim’s gesture was widely acclaimed in the
Arab world, although some criticised it, argu-
ing that literature should not be mixed up with
politics.
In January 2004, another Arab writer
Ahmed Bouzfour, followed Ibrahim’s exam-
ple by turning down an award offered by the
Government, citing various political, economic
and cultural reasons. This gesture (Bouzfour’s
“sigh” [zefrat Bouzfour], as some called it) was
another expression of the growing dissatisfac-
tion among Arab intellectuals about the state
of human rights.
THE EMPOWERMENT OF WOMEN
In Morocco, the governing authorities intro-
duced wide-ranging reforms of the family law
in response to demands by the women’s move-
ment to safeguard women’s rights, notably with
Conflict and human
suffering increased
(in Darfur) despite the
cease-fire agreement
and interventions
of the international
community.
42 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
respect to marriage, divorce and childcare.
One of the most important provisions of
the new family code is that it regards women as
partners of men in matters relating to the care
of the family and associated responsibilities. It
also recognizes that they shall not be subject to
guardianship upon reaching the age of major-
ity, which the Code sets at the age of 18 years.
Eighteen years is also made the minimum
lawful age of marriage, and women are free
to marry at their own discretion, the permis-
sion of a male family member no longer being
required. In addition, under the revised Code,
husband and wife may conclude an agreement,
distinct from their marriage contract, concern-
ing the management and disposal of assets
acquired during the marriage.
Women have continued to rise to senior
executive positions in Arab countries, and
there is steadily broader scope for participa-
tion by women in legislative assemblies.
In Kuwait the government referred a draft
law to the National Assembly, which would
grant women their political rights, including
the right to vote and stand as candidates in
elections. This was the second time the govern-
ment had taken such a move, as the Assembly
had rejected a similar draft law in 1999.
In Jordan, six women from outside the
capital won seats reserved for women at the
parliamentary elections held in mid-2003, in
the first application of a quota for women in
elections of this kind. For the first time, the
Cabinet formed early in 2003 included three
women Ministers.
In Oman, a woman was appointed Minister
of Higher Education, a first in that country. In
yet another first, women were allowed to vote
in the Shura council elections.
Saudi Arabia announced its own ground-
breaking first: in a new move, women will be
appointed to the police force under the Minis-
try of the Interior. 300 prominent citizens, 50
of them women, signed a petition to the Crown
Prince requesting political and social reforms
“for the sake of the nation”. A women’s as-
sociation presented a petition asking for the
reform of women’s position in society and for
guarantees for their full participation in public
life.
In Mauritania, Aisha Bint Jeddane became
the first woman ever to stand as a candidate
(albeit unsuccessfully) for the position of Presi-
dent of the Republic.
In Algeria, Ms. Hanoune ran for the Presi-
dency of the Republic. Ms. Burkan was pro-
moted to the post of President of the Council
of State, and Ms. Zermouni was appointed
Governor of the province of Tibeze.
In Lebanon, Naila Mouawad offered
herself as a candidate for President of the
Republic.
In Bahrain, a woman was appointed Min-
ister of Health.
In Tunisia, a woman was appointed Gover-
nor of the province of Zaghouane.
In Egypt, a woman was appointed, for the
first time, as Mayor of the city of Al-Maragha,
in the Sohag Governorate in Upper Egypt,
long regarded as one of the most conserva-
tive parts of the country. The Minister of the
Interior announced that Egyptian women
married to non-Egyptians now had the right to
transmit Egyptian nationality to their children.
The Ministry of the Interior has already started
to receive applications for recognition of the
Egyptian citizenship of children of Egyptian
women married to non-Egyptian men.
However, as a reflection of deeply rooted
BOX 11
The Moroccan Family Code
• Equality
Husband and wife share responsibility
for their family; a wife is no longer legally
required to obey her husband; a woman
who is of age is her own guardian, instead
of being subject to the guardianship of a
male family member, and she may exer-
cise her guardianship freely and inde-
pendently; the minimum age of marriage
is 18 years for both men and women.
• Divorce
Both men and women possess the right
of divorce, and may exercise that right
under the supervision of a judge. The
principle of divorce by mutual agree-
ment is accepted.
• Polygamy
Polygamy requires a judge’s authoriza-
tion and is subject to stringent legal
conditions that make it almost impos-
sible in practice; a woman has the right
to stipulate in her marriage contract that
her husband shall not take other wives; in
the absence of such a stipulation, the first
wife must be informed of her husband’s
intent to take another wife, and the pro-
spective second wife must be informed
that her intended husband already has a
wife. Furthermore, taking a second wife
is grounds for divorce for the first wife.
• Enforcement of the law
The Family Code assigns a fundamental
supporting role to the judiciary in enforc-
ing the law. Inter alia, it states that the
Public Prosecutor shall be a party to all
legal actions in connection with the pro-
visions of the Code.
• Rights of children
A woman is given the possibility of re-
taining custody of her children, even in
the event of her remarrying or moving
away from the area where her husband
lives. The code also protects a child’s
right to acknowledgement of paternity
in cases where the marriage has not been
officially registered.
Women have
continued to rise
to senior executive
positions in Arab
countries.
43 CHANGES IN HUMAN DEVELOPMENT SINCE THE LAUNCH OF AHDR 2003
social factors, women continue to be sparsely
represented in the Parliaments of those Arab
Gulf countries that allow women to stand as
candidates and to vote.
In general, women’s accession to high
levels of government, though moving in the
right direction, will remain inadequate so long
as the vast majority of women are not allowed
to develop their capabilities and use them in
various fields.
CONCLUSION
Careful scrutiny of developments in this period
indicates that there has been no significant eas-
ing of the human development crisis in the
Arab region. Serious human rights violations
continue.
Unquestionably, incipient reforms are tak-
ing place in more than one of the priority areas
identified in this Report, but for the most part
those reforms have been embryonic and frag-
mentary. There is no dispute that some are real
and promising but they do not add up to a seri-
ous effort to dispel the prevailing environment
of repression. Some measures may have been
merely cosmetic and superficial with the effect
of delaying the advent of meaningful in-depth
reform. This is the case especially with respect
to good governance.
Finally, the human development crisis in
the Arab world has become more acute with
respect to self-determination especially with
the prospects for a just peace in Palestine re-
ceding. As a result, the Arab people still risk
being oppressed at home and violated from
abroad.
The critical situation of the Arab region
today is complex because of the interplay of
internal and external factors. The Arab future
is overshadowed by the gravity of possible
developments.
Yet this series of Reports has repeatedly
emphasized that hope abounds in those dy-
namic social forces in Arab countries that seek
a human renaissance in the region. Mobiliz-
ing their potential in thought and deed can
break through the thickening clouds gathering
around their future.
There has been no
significant easing
of the human
development crisis in
the Arab region.
45
Part II
Reinforcing Freedom and Establishing
Good Governance
Section 1: Analytical Framework:
Freedom, Good Governance and Human
Development
This section presents the analytical framework for Part II of the report,
devoted to freedom and governance. The section starts with a brief sur-
vey of the intellectual basis of the topic that ends in the report’s defini-
tion of freedom and good governance, and then turns to a discussion
of some of the problematic issues of freedom and governance in Arab
countries at present.
CHAPTER ONE
The Intellectual Basis and
Concept of Freedom and Good
Governance
THE INTELLECTUAL BASIS AND CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND GOOD GOVERNANCE 47
Introduction
This chapter presents the analytical frame-
work underpinning the Report’s analysis of
freedom and good governance.
The chapter starts by summarizing key
postulates of freedom in Western thought.
It traces how thinking shifted from stressing
the primacy of individual freedom to under-
lining the harmonization of individual free-
dom with collective societal arrangements
in order to reconcile individual freedom
with other higher human goals. The latter
formulation is close to the Report’s concept
of human development. The chapter next
examines the place of freedom in Arabic
culture, indicating its presence in various
schools of thought. Drawing on the features
of freedom in both Arabic and Western
thinking, the chapter sets out the concept of
freedom adopted in the Report and the ele-
ments of good governance guaranteeing its
realization. This exposition frames the main
discussion.
FREEDOM IN WESTERN LIBERAL
THOUGHT: FROM INDIVIDUAL
FREEDOM TO HUMAN
DEVELOPMENT
THE PRIMACY OF INDIVIDUAL
LIBERTIES
In Western thought, the Utilitarian philoso-
phers, in particular, searched for a form of
government capable of ensuring that those
who hold power would not crush or endan-
ger the liberty of those they governed. The
solution upon which James Mill settled was
“representative government,” in which the
interests of government and people would be-
come congruent through a mechanism of rep-
resentation by proxy: representatives would be
accountable to the people through elections.
Thus, the government would be an instrument
for securing liberty rather than a source of op-
pression.
Accordingly, principles of “democracy”
were developed, as a means to safeguard the
freedom of the majority from oppression by
any dominant minority, whether the latter’s
source of power was might or wealth. The fun-
damental principle at issue here is “democratic
legitimacy,” which denotes that the source of
societal authority is the will of the majority.
For John Stuart Mill, the goal of freedom
is “pursuing our own good in our own way,”
and this is the most important component of
“happiness or human well-being.” On this
basis, he believed that happiness would ac-
crue only to “someone who was capable of
choosing an independent path and who had
the public sphere available in which to exercise
that capacity,” through possessing “faculties of
critical judgment and free choice.” And thus
the democracy that ensures liberty is the most
fertile soil for social progress, and also for pur-
suing the aim of individual happiness.
However, Mill was not confident that
democratic society would of its own accord
safeguard the freedom of individuals and mi-
norities. Moreover, fearful that the democratic
process would subject all aspects of life to
control by the ruling authority, thereby insti-
tuting “tyranny of the majority,” he inquired
BOX 1-1
Natural Human Rights
“The end in view of every political asso-
ciation is the preservation of the natural
and imprescriptible rights of man. These
rights are liberty, property, security and
resistance to oppression.”
Article II, French Declaration of the Rights of Man and The Citizen, August, 1789 ( in French ).
The democracy that
ensures liberty is the
most fertile soil for
social progress.
The source of societal
authority is the will of
the majority.
48 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
into what properties were common to activities
that would qualify for exemption from govern-
ment control. His fears were not confined to
the regulatory actions of government. They
extended to “the government of popular opin-
ion,” or unofficial forms of coercion to which
those who hold unpopular beliefs or practice
unorthodox actions are subjected.
According to Mill, we have the right to
discuss, to disagree, to attack, to reject, or even
to forcefully condemn an opinion. But we have
absolutely no right to obstruct or suppress that
opinion, because to do so will destroy “the thin
along with the fat” in equal measure. Indeed,
to do so constitutes nothing less than collec-
tive suicide, both intellectual and moral. For
without the right and ability to protest, there
can be no justice and no end worth striving
for. Without complete freedom of opinion and
debate, the truth cannot emerge.
And so, in his view, even if we find our
selves facing no actual opposition, we should
devise arguments against ourselves simply in
order to remain in a state of “intellectual fit-
ness.”
Thus Mill poses a very strong connec-
tion between freedom, especially freedom of
thought and debate, creative expression, in-
novation, and human progress. For him the
primary engine of progress is the coupling of
“freedom and variety,” which leads in turn to
individuality and originality. This combination
forestalls the mediocrity that necessarily arises
when people remain in a state of conformity
and compliance. And he made no exception
for the issue of freedom itself. In the introduc-
tion to On Liberty, he proposes that issues of
liberty must be presented anew to humanity
whenever human conditions change.
Thus it is that we present here our recon-
sideration of freedom with regard to the Arab
world at the start of the third millennium.
Mill considered only two justifications for
restricting individual liberty valid: to prevent
the individual from harming others, and to
prevent the individual from violating an obliga-
tion toward others, whether by a certain act or
through inaction. In relation to the individual,
her/his independence is absolute, since “over
himself, over his own body and mind, the indi-
vidual is sovereign” and “the individual is not
accountable to society for his actions in so far
as these concern the interests of no person but
himself”. The only exception would be a case
of verified, and not merely possible, danger.
INDIVIDUAL FREEDOM AND
SOCIETAL REGULATION
Safeguarding liberty, however, does not mean
opposing societal organization per se; after all,
such organization constitutes one of human-
kind’s most important means of progress. But
it certainly implies taking a determined stance
against all forms of elite, monopolistic or co-
ercive organization, all of which inhibit new
discoveries and innovation. Thus, as long as
it is based on voluntary participation in an at-
mosphere of freedom, the social order remains
beneficial and effective (Hayek, 1978, 37).
Moreover, democratic rule is able to estab-
lish institutional guarantees to forestall flawed
decisions arising from a democratic majority. A
theoretical position evolved that some institu-
tional arrangements can actively enable indi-
viduals to use their capabilities for the sake of
progress, while minimizing any harm resulting
from organizational restrictions. That position
entails imposing restrictions on the decisions
of the majority to prevent legislation that is un-
acceptable in principle.
1
Equally, it allows for
courts and ombudsmen who have the authority
to criticize or rectify such decisions.
The Essence of Democracy and Democratic
Transition
Democracy, in essence, is a system for manag-
ing conflict that allows free competition over
BOX 1-2
Freedom of opinion as a sacred right
If all mankind minus one were of one
opinion, and only one person were of the
contrary opinion, mankind would be no
more justified in silencing that one per-
son than he, if he had the power, would
be justified in silencing mankind.
Source: Mill, 1978, 16
1
For example, the US Constitution includes a ‘Bill of Rights’ that defines activities that the government or Congress must not regulate. The First
Amendment stipulates that Congress will not pass any legislation that restricts freedom of expression, at the federal level.
Without complete
freedom of opinion
and debate, the truth
cannot emerge.
Issues of liberty must
be presented anew to
humanity whenever
human conditions
change.
49 THE INTELLECTUAL BASIS AND CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND GOOD GOVERNANCE
the values and goals that citizens care to pre-
serve. On this basis, as long as there is a group
that does not resort to violence, and does not
transgress the rights of other citizens, it is ac-
corded freedom to work to promote its inter-
ests in both civil and political society. This, in
brief, constitutes the core of democratic insti-
tutional arrangements (Stepan, 2001, 216).
In the theory of democratic transition, elec-
tions - free and competitive - occupy a central
position. In large societies, there are additional
institutional arrangements charged with for-
mulating preferences, expressing them, and
making sure that they are taken into account
in suitable fashion in the governance process
(Dahl, 1971).
The recommended institutional guarantees
(ibid) include the following seven elements:
• Freedom of expression
• The right to vote
• Freedom to establish and join organizations
• Eligibility for public office
• The right of political leaders to compete
for support and votes
• Availability of alternative sources of infor-
mation
• Policy-making institutions based on voting
in free and fair elections and other means by
which the people express their preferences.
Other theorists find these guarantees, if
necessary, not sufficient (Linz and Stepan,
1996). In their view, political society must be
protected in the form of a democratic con-
stitution that respects fundamental freedoms
including the rights of minorities. They also
stipulate that the elected government govern
democratically according to the constitution;
that it adheres to the law and to a system
composed of institutions, both horizontal and
vertical, that guarantee accountability.
Implicit in the guarantees mentioned
above is a strong and viable civil society, able
to be critical, to check the State and to generate
alternative policies. In order for these alterna-
tives to be formulated properly and be viable,
the relationships between political society, es-
pecially political parties, and with civil society
must be absolutely free from control.
PROBLEMATIC ISSUES OF
FREEDOM: LIBERALISM AND
DEMOCRACY, ATTRIBUTES OF
MAJORITY RULE
It is often acknowledged in Western liberal
ideology that democracy can harbour flaws.
If democracy can restrict liberty, then society
cannot be considered free unless two related
conditions are simultaneously present:
First, there can be no absolute powers,
such that everyone has the right to reject inhu-
man behaviour.
Second, there must be a firmly established
sphere of rights and freedoms within which a
person’s humanity cannot be violated. (Berlin
1969, 165)
In principle, therefore, democracy is an
instrument and not an end in itself. It is judged
by what it succeeds in realizing, the goal that
it was instituted to accomplish, and which is
summed up in “liberty, and the courage and
industry which liberty begets” (17th century
commentator John Culpepper, quoted in
Hayek, 1978, 107).
The danger of tyranny of the majority
Those who give first and absolute priority
to democracy, as a formal structure and as a
value, have argued that the greatest possible
number of issues must be decided according
to majority opinion. For them, popular sover-
eignty signifies the unlimited authority of the
majority, an authority that need not be subject
to control in any way.
However, purist supporters of liberty
believe it is essential to set limits on matters de-
cided by majority rule. Indeed, they consider
that the authority of any temporary majority
should be restricted as regards principles that
will prevail over the longer term. That is, the
decisions of the majority express the wishes of
the people -- as the majority -- at a particular
time, but cannot determine what would be in
their best interest if they had more knowledge
at their disposal (as generally happens with the
passage of time). Furthermore the decisions of
the majority do not in fact come from absolute
wisdom. They are usually the outcome of ne-
gotiations and compromises that might not sat-
Political society must
be protected in the
form of a democratic
constitution that
respects fundamental
freedoms, including
the rights of
minorities.
Democracy can
harbour flaws.
50 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
isfy anyone completely. In fact, such decisions
might well be of less value than one taken by
the wisest members of society after canvassing
all opinions.
What is certain is that there is no moral
justification for granting privileges to members
of any majority that will distinguish them from,
and give them advantages over, those not be-
longing to that majority. Indeed, progress may
be epitomized by the majority’s persuasion to
a minority view.
And so the success of society in guarantee-
ing and protecting liberty —including safe-
guarding it from the tyranny of the majority
— depends on the existence of a public sphere
that is both extensive and independent of the
control of the majority, in which individuals’
opinions are formed and expressed. Hence
there is an organic link between freedom, in its
comprehensive sense, and the key freedoms of
opinion, expression, and association. Freedom
of opinion guarantees that a person can form
a position on societal issues, while freedom
of expression permits that person to express
those positions and thereby stimulate and
inform discussion. Finally, freedom of associa-
tion guarantees that people can organize them-
selves through, and in, institutions that adopt
positions on issues and actively promote them
in society’s public sphere.
What is undeniable, in any case, is that the
benefits of democracy — indeed, of freedom
itself — can be confirmed only in the long
term.
Tension between Freedom and
Democracy? Or Democracy without
Freedom?
As noted, liberal democracy harbours po-
tential flaws. Perhaps the most important of
these, from the perspective of freedom, is
that “democratic” arrangements can coexist
with basic violations of freedom in its compre-
hensive sense. It is possible, for example, for
poverty (however it is understood) to spread in
a context of political democracy and without
violation of property rights. Even as Sen insists
that no widespread famine has occurred under
democratic rule, he observes that consider-
able famines have indeed occurred in contexts
where civil and political rights, including prop-
erty rights, were respected (Sen, 1999, 16, 66).
What is more serious is a situation where
democratic regulation coexists with extensive
violation of freedom in the narrow sense,
that is, civil and political rights. In the con-
temporary world, moreover, this disjunction
exists not only in developing countries where
freedom and democracy are newcomers (and
where elected governments may impose re-
strictions on the freedom of other sectors of
society such as the judiciary, local communities
the media, civil society organizations) but even
in countries with a long tradition of freedom
and democracy, as in the industrialized West.
Some contemporary writers even argue the ne-
cessity of distinguishing between freedom and
democracy. If we compare the two, they argue,
we may find an excess of the second – de-
mocracy - and a deficit in the first - freedom.
Indeed, “democracy” can be used to legislate
restrictions on freedom (Zakaria, 2003). In
other words, freedom leads to democracy (as
in the case of the UK and the US where the
enjoyment of freedom preceded the establish-
ment of democracy in the 19th century), but
the opposite is not necessarily true.
FREEDOM AND THE OTHER
ULTIMATE HUMAN GOALS
Freedom is not the only supreme human goal.
Freedom is not justice, equality or beauty, for
example. Freedom might even be in conflict
with other supreme human goals: some think-
ers argue that it is a contradiction in terms to
speak of perfect or complete human achieve-
ment. This means that a superior and enriching
human existence might sometimes require pre-
ferring one value over another, or reconciling
freedom with other ultimate human goals.
This possible clash among ultimate goals is
one of the basic reasons for the insistence on
the high value of the freedom to choose. If it
were possible in a good society to realize all the
ultimate human goals in concert, the agony of
choosing between alternatives would vanish.
Freedom is not a blessing that comes
without costs: freedom and responsibility
go together. Freedom does not only imply
the individual’s enjoyment of opportunities,
nor does it require simply that the individual
There is an organic
link between freedom,
in its comprehensive
sense, and the key
freedoms of opinion,
expression and
association.
“Democracy” can
be used to legislate
restrictions on
freedom.
51 THE INTELLECTUAL BASIS AND CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND GOOD GOVERNANCE
shoulder the burden of choice. It also implies
bearing the consequences of one’s decisions;
thus, to withdraw from responsibility means,
in reality, to surrender freedom.
Equality before the law and with regard to
prevailing norms of conduct is the sole type
of equality to be guaranteed for preserving
freedom. For freedom may ultimately entail
the negation of equality in numerous spheres.
While justice demands certain conditions or
opportunities for people, which the govern-
ment defines for all equally, it is possible that
conditions of freedom will produce a minimum
of equality in terms of results. Equality before
the law and equality of opportunity can coexist
with various forms of human hardship, such as
hunger, disease, or poverty.
FREEDOM AS HUMAN
DEVELOPMENT: RECONCILING
INDIVIDUAL FREEDOM WITH
INSTITUTIONAL ARRANGEMENTS
The notion of integrating individual liberty
with societal organization in the service of
human progress attains maturity in Amartya
Sen’s writings on human development, culmi-
nating in Development as Freedom (1999).
For Sen, development consists of the “removal
of unfreedom,” or expansion of the scope of
human freedom.
Sen observes that societal institutions play
an essential role in securing or delimiting the
liberty of individuals, considering them as
active agents and not as passive recipients of
benefits (ibid., Introduction).
Many kinds of societal institutions play
significant roles in this respect: (free) markets,
government administration, legislatures, politi-
cal parties, the justice system, nongovernmen-
tal organizations, and mass media. All of these
share in the process of development precisely
through their impact in strengthening and
safeguarding individual freedom.
Sen outlines five types of instrumental
freedoms: political freedoms, economic fa-
cilities, social opportunities, transparency
guarantees, and protective security. These
complement each other, in addition to making
it possible for people to build human capa-
bilities and to utilize them to realize the kind of
life they desire. While Sen emphasizes that civil
and political freedoms are desirable for their
own sake, he stresses that when it comes to eco-
nomic facilities, income and wealth are not to
be sought for their own sake but for the extent
to which they make possible the freedom to
live our lives according to our desires. People
who enjoy economic facilities but are deprived
BOX 1-3
Ahmed Kamal Aboulmagd: The principle of equality
The principle of equality is one of
those principles that hardly need to be
explicitly mentioned in a contemporary
constitution. Constitutional courts and
administrative courts have deemed it
to be one of a number of “general legal
principles” which, in the words of the
Council of State, “are firmly established
in the general conscience and do not
need to be spelled out”.
When the principle first appeared
in law and judicial practice in Europe,
equality had to do with two fundamen-
tal matters, both of them related to the
history of conflict between kings and
peoples since the Middle Ages:
(1) Equality as it applied to financial
burdens (taxes);
(2) Equality as it applied to judicial
practice.
Most modern constitutions use the
expression “citizens are equal before
the law” or “equal under the law”. Both
phrases encompass all forms of equality,
and are never restricted to the concept of
equality as it applies to judicial practice.
Most constitutions, after stating that
citizens are equal before (or under) the
law, add one or both of the two following
clauses:
• A clause specifying that citizens “are
not subject to any discrimination based
on colour, race or creed”;
• A clause enunciating another prin-
ciple that supplements the concept of
equality, namely the principle of equality
of opportunity.
The meaning of all these provisions
is that the legislative power is debarred
from enacting any law containing any-
thing in its substantive text that is incon-
sistent with the principle of equality in
terms of discrimination based on colour,
creed or sex (gender).
In this framework, regardless of the
wording of these various legal formula-
tions in constitutional texts, legal theory
and judicial practice have unanimously
agreed that equality means the uniform
application of the law in dealing with per-
sons in comparable legal situations, and
that differential treatment of such per-
sons constitutes unlawful discrimination
that is prohibited under the constitution.
On the other hand, where differential
treatment is based on objective or real
factors reflecting differences in the legal
situations of the persons concerned, it
does not constitute unlawful discrimina-
tion, but rather a legitimate recognition
of different categories or divisions.
There is a very fine line between
unlawful discrimination and legitimate
recognition of differences, and the task
of determining where that line should be
drawn is one of the most delicate issues
arising in judicial practice. The standard
that has come to be applied, especially by
constitutional courts, is that differential
treatment is deemed to be discrimina-
tion and unlawful under the constitution
where there is no logical causal link be-
tween the discrimination and the result
to which it leads, as in the case of a law
prescribing lower wages for a woman
worker than for a male worker doing ex-
actly the same kind of work. In contrast,
where there is a causal link between the
differential treatment and the result, the
law is not discriminating, but making a
legitimate distinction. For example, the
Civil Service Law may provide that every
year worked by an employee assigned to
a remote area shall count as two years for
seniority purposes.
There is another important and
equally delicate question, and that is
the distinction in judicial practice be-
tween what are sometimes referred to as
“positive discrimination” and “negative
discrimination”. Positive discrimina-
tion is acceptable as an interim measure,
where the goal is to correct the cumula-
tive effects of past negative discrimina-
tion, as, for example, in hiring quotas
for women or black persons (as in the
United States).
Development consists
of the “removal of
unfreedom”.
52 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
of civil and political freedoms are being denied
the essential freedom to choose the kind of life
they want, to participate in shaping crucial so-
cietal decisions that impact on their well-being
now and in the future (ibid, 16).
The ability to exercise basic political rights
also secures respect for social and economic
rights, and so the construction and strength-
ening of a democratic system of governance
is considered a linchpin of the development
process. The availability of social opportuni-
ties, especially in education and health care,
has a direct role in strengthening human capa-
bilities and enhancing the quality of life.
Sen distinguishes between the opportuni-
ties that freedom affords and the processes
that allow freedom. Both, however, constitute
legitimate subjects in studying freedom and
working to promote it. To him, to understand
development as freedom, means recognizing
the importance of the processes and proce-
dures that should be respected, and not re-
stricting one’s attention to ends and goals.
Thus, in concert with the numerous and
interrelated freedoms there is a need for many
societal institutions that intersect with the proc-
esses of supporting and strengthening freedom,
such as those for democratic regulation, legal
mechanisms, provision of educational services
and health care, and means of communication
between people and institutions.
Ultimately, Sen finds that the organizing
principle for development - as freedom - is the
indefatigable attempt to enhance individual
freedoms and the social commitment to pre-
serve them. These take form in, and develop
through, societal institutions and processes
that lead to and nurture these freedoms (Sen,
1999, 298).
It is precisely in the area of economics that
this connection between individual freedom
and institutional arrangements for serving
the public interest carries us from the level
of micro-economic analysis to that of political
economy. The former concerns economic con-
duct at the level of the economic unit (the indi-
vidual or the enterprise). The latter focuses on
collective conduct in such areas as the alloca-
tion of resources, the distribution of economic
surpluses among different social groups and
the use of wealth at the level of society, par-
ticularly in consumption and investment. This
underscores the need for economically rational
societal institutions that protect freedom in the
sense adopted here, in addition to guarantees
of property rights and free economic activ-
ity at the individual level. Rational economic
activity on this level is achieved by mobilizing
resources, by encouraging investment in pro-
ductive fields and by systematically enhancing
productivity. The latter in turn necessitates
efficiency to protect competitiveness, combat
monopoly and ensure justice in the distribu-
tion of the economic surplus among societal
groups.
Corporate governance and human
development
In the context of enhancing the private sector’s
contribution to human development, corporate
governance is a key dimension of responsible
economic management. One broad definition
of corporate governance refers to “the private
and public institutions, including laws, regula-
tions and accepted business practices, which
together govern the relationship, in a market
economy, between corporate managers and
entrepreneurs (“corporate insiders”) on one
hand, and those who invest resources in cor-
porations, on the other. Investors can include
suppliers of equity finance (shareholders),
suppliers of debt finance (creditors), suppliers
of relatively firm-specific human capital (em-
ployers) and suppliers of other tangible and
intangible assets that corporations may use to
operate and grow”
2
.
Good corporate governance ensures that
the operations of firms, businesses and markets
are transparent, accountable and inclusively
responsive to the interests of all stakeholders.
These principles matter for development be-
cause they can contribute greatly to achieving
sustained productivity growth in developing
countries, in addition to improving the ef-
ficiency of economic performance. Moreover,
by increasing corporate social responsibility,
corporate governance treats stakeholders
within and outside firms and businesses in an
2
C. Oman, “Corporate Governance and National Development”, OECD Development Centre, Technical papers No.180, September 2001
The ability to exercise
basic political rights
also secures respect
for social and
economic rights.
Corporate governance
is a key dimension of
responsible economic
management.
53 THE INTELLECTUAL BASIS AND CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND GOOD GOVERNANCE
equitable and socially responsive way. Apply-
ing corporate governance principles empowers
stakeholders and enables them to understand
and take part in business management deci-
sions as a result of their increased access to
information and the greater transparency and
accountability of owners and managers.
In order for societies to experience these
benefits, sound frameworks and institutions
need to be in place to provide guidelines,
checks and balances within the system and en-
sure that firms, businesses and markets observe
the principles of good corporate governance.
In particular, a regulatory framework for the
efficient, accountable and inclusive manage-
ment of resources is necessary for spurring
development of the Arab region.
FREEDOM IN ARAB CULTURE
FREEDOM IN ARAB HISTORY
Arab Islamic history provides both actual and
practical experience of particular significance
in the matter of freedom and its opposite,
coercion. The fields of jurisprudence, eth-
ics, logic and scholastic theology (kalam),
the philosophy of Sufism and the open social
space claimed by nomads and tribes, strongly
indicate the presence of the concept of free-
dom in the Arab Islamic historical experience.
Jurisprudence links the validity of acts to free-
dom. Ethics and theology link legal obligation
to responsibility, to individual free will and
to human choice with regard to divine will.
There were however, differences in how this
relation was perceived, as demonstrated by the
dialectics of the ‘Jabriya’, the ‘Qadariyya’, the
Mu’tazila and the Asha’ira. The nomadic way
of life was a symbol of “breaking free from
all contrived fetters”, of “unimpeded life”,
of “space for living” and “space for action”.
Sufism is a personal, spiritual experience
where the Sufi breaks away from external
constraints and pressures – nature, society, the
State and legislation - and experiences absolute
freedom outside the realm of natural and man-
made laws, away from oppression and slavery
(Abdullah al-Arawy, in Arabic, 1993, 15-22).
Where political freedom is concerned,
early Arab history witnessed the upsurge of the
“Umayyad coercive ideology” that attempted
to exploit religion for overt political purposes.
The Umayyad caliphs encouraged the pre-des-
tination doctrine view that human actions are
pre-ordained in order to claim that the many
injustices for which they were responsible were
fated acts ordained by God under their rule in
the name of God. This ideology gave rise to the
contrary position espoused by Hassan al-Basri
and his school and the new enlightenment dis-
course. They advocated a discourse, supported
by both text and reason, affirming that people
do have a choice and are responsible for their
actions. The Mu’tazila bolstered that current
of enlightenment by giving the ontological
concept of freedom an open political dimen-
sion. By so doing they greatly contributed to
refuting the claims of the ideology of coercion
and helped to place political freedom in Arab
religious political thought on solid foundations
(al-Habib al-Jenhani, background paper for
this Report).
In general, expressions of freedom surface
visibly across Arab history in all core domains:
religion, politics, society and economics. These
expressions were sometimes peaceful and
sometimes not.
Religious Freedom
The religious “text” itself stresses that “there
is no compulsion in religion” (Al-Baqara:
256), that “You have your religion and I have
mine” (Al-Kafiroun: 6), thus allowing the
free practice of religion and belief in the land
of Revelation, particularly among the Jews,
Christians and Sabians. If certain practices in
jurisprudence and the political arena have not
always followed such guidance, that is only one
illustration of the difference between original
‘thinking’ and principle, i.e. the Revelation,
and actual historical practice. Yet the scope
of “religious freedom” developed considerably
under both the Umayyads and the Abbasids.
In literary and cultural circles, debate on reli-
gion and articles of faith between Muslims and
Christians was free and rich, and it extended
to other creeds and schools of thought. It is
difficult to speak of persecution on the basis of
religion or articles of faith, as such, since such
Expressions of
freedom surface
visibly across Arab
history in all core
domains: religion,
politics, ethics and
economics.
The religious “text”
itself stresses
that “there is no
compulsion in
religion”.
54 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
cases
3
generally concealed a political element.
However, members of some sects did not
hesitate to accuse those of others, or sometimes
their own kind, of heresy if they disagreed with
them. Such attitudes undoubtedly cast their
shadow on the state and fate of freedom.
Political Freedom
Opponents of the status quo exercised a form
of political freedom by rejecting the principle
of “obedience” to those in charge. Instead,
they championed the text: “No obedience is
owed to any creature if it means disobedi-
ence of the Creator”, a position which can
be enforced by several means: counselling,
criticism, secret action, concealment of one’s
true creed, disobedience, struggle, and rebel-
lion. The examples are many: The revolt of
Al Qura’ (the Readers), al-Fitna al-Kubra (the
Great Sedition), the Khawarij movement, the
movements of Al Zinj and of the Qaramita,
the secret activities of Ikhwan al- Safa and the
Abbasid coup d’état. Thanks to early propo-
nents of freedom, tyrants and totalitarians who
established themselves as “the shadow of God
and His rule on earth” did not entirely succeed
in forcing people to subscribe to the school of
thought of the “Sultan’s jurists” who claimed
that “a century of injustice is better than one
hour of chaos”.
Social Freedom
The historic period of the great Arab ren-
aissance witnessed obvious manifestations
of moral, social and cultural freedom not-
withstanding the stipulations of Islamic law
regulating both moral and social conduct in
Arab-Islamic regions and constraints imposed
by Arab custom and tradition. In fact the 3rd
and 4th Hijra centuries (9th and 10th centuries
AD) represent ‘the age of liberalism’ of the
time, evidenced by the cultural content and
daily moral practices where “freedom often
expressed itself in forms incompatible with
‘traditional’ rules”.
Economic Freedom
Freedom in the economic realm manifested it-
self through the recognition of property rights,
free trade and profit-making, sometimes on
the basis of a “text”, and sometimes driven by
the very logic of economic and daily activities.
Economic activities in Arab Islamic history re-
flect a “capitalist” economic pattern, i.e. a pat-
tern of freedom despite certain challenges and
constraints. This was solidified by the expan-
sion of the Islamic state to include vast territo-
ries whose prosperous economic relations were
firmly based on the rule of freedom. This rule
was evident in the Islamic jurisprudence’s per-
ception of the legal organization of economic
transaction which is built on free consent and
free acceptance and also on putting a condition
that the contractual will should not be affected
by any of the drawbacks of an unfree will.
FREEDOM IN THE MODERN
CONTEXT
Freedom in the modern sense of the word
was introduced into Arab culture after con-
tact developed between modern Arabs and
Europe, particularly France. The Egyptian
scholar Rifaa al-Tahtawi (1801-1873) was the
first to refer to the idea of freedom (Liberté)
and to connect it with “justice and equity” in
the Islamic heritage. He considered freedom a
condition sine qua non for the progress and
civilization of the nation (Rifaa al-Tahtawi, in
Arabic, 1840, 73, 74, 80; Rifaa al-Tahtawi, in
Arabic, 1872, 8, 127). His Moroccan contem-
porary, Ahmed bin Khalid al-Nasseri (1835-
1897), however, declared that “the notion of
freedom invented by the ferenja (foreigners or
French) is, undoubtedly, the work of heretics.
It requires disregard of the rights of God, the
rights of parents and even the rights of human-
ity” (Ahmed bin Khalid al-Nasseri, in Arabic,
1956, 9, 114). Khayr al-Din al-Tounsi (1825-
1889), associated freedom with a number of re-
lated rights and referred to personal freedom,
political freedom and citizens’ participation in
managing the affairs of the State as well as free-
dom of the press. Thus he upheld freedom of
3
E.g. Al Jahm Bin Safwan, Mebed al-Jahny, Ghilan al-Dimashqi, Al Hallaj, Malik bin Anas, Ahmed bin Nasr al-Khuzra’i, “testing of belief in the
Revelation of the Qur’an” and Sahrawardy, who was killed.
Opponents of the
status quo exercised
a form of political
freedom by rejecting
the principle of
“obedience” to those
in charge.
Freedom in the
modern sense of the
word was introduced
into Arab culture after
contact developed
between modern
Arabs and Europe.
55 THE INTELLECTUAL BASIS AND CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND GOOD GOVERNANCE
opinion and expression, which he considered
the equivalent of the Islamic principle of “en-
joining what is right and forbidding wrong”.
All these thinkers echoed the call for
freedom in different contexts: whether in
connection with Ottoman tyranny, and in its
aftermath, the European colonization of Arab
countries; or with the pressures of a history of
prejudices and traditions. Elsewhere, freedom
is related to its determining role in achieving
European progress. The tyrannical nature of
the Ottoman regime and the desire for free-
dom prompted Abdel Rahman al-Kawakibi’s
masterpiece: Tabai al-Istibdad (The Nature
of Tyranny). The European “liberal example”
inspired the pioneers of free social thinking, as
reflected in Qassim Amin’s great work, Tahrir
al Mar’a (The Emancipation of Women), as
well as in other works which followed in his
footsteps. These include the writings of Bahet-
hat al-Badiya (1886-1918), Tahir al-Haddad
(1899-1935) and Nazira Zein al-Din. This
same example gave birth to the liberal trend
articulated by the Egyptian pioneer, Ahmed
Lutfi al-Sayyid, who became the acknowledged
leader of all liberals. The following sentence is a
clear expression of his ideas: “Our spirits were
created free, God having imbued them with
the nature of freedom. Indeed our freedom
is us, our very selves and the essence of our
selves, it is what gives significance to a human
being as being human. Our freedom is our very
being and our being is our freedom”(Mabadi fi
a- Siyasa wa a- Adab wa al-Ijtima [Principles in
Politics, Literature and Sociology], in Arabic,
138; also Youssef Salama, Ishkaliyet al-Hurriya
[Problematics of Freedom] in Arabic, 661).
Throughout the 20
th
century, freedom in
Arab culture represents a strong desire, a vital
need, a major demand and a powerful slogan
promoted, most notably, by the proponents
of “free thought” as well those of “national
independence”. The call for freedom seemed
to represent a break with the past among the
individuals, groups and parties that sought it;
it was an aim to be pursued for the sake of life
itself and for the future.
FROM FREEDOM TO
EMANCIPATION
In the middle of the last century an overwhelm-
ing wave of interest in the philosophy of free-
dom inspired by existentialism swept the Arab
cultural scene. The matter went beyond the
mere study and emulation of existentialism for
some Arab intellectuals, like Abdul Rahman
Badawi, Zakariya Ibrahim and Mutaa’ Safdi.
This does not mean that there were no other re-
markable works, nor does it underestimate the
impact on the young generation of the transla-
tion into Arabic of Jean-Paul Sartre’s plays and
Simone de Beauvoir’s works. However, one of
the most important works that have appeared
was the book by the Moroccan philosopher
Mohammed Aziz al-Habbabi, entitled “Liberté
ou Libération”. The innovation introduced
by al-Habbabi was what he termed ‘realistic
personalism’, which he later described in an
outstanding work first published in French in
1967: “Le Personnalisme Musulman” (Muslim
Personalism) translated into Arabic under the
same title in 1969.
Comparing philosophies inspired by exis-
tentialism with those by ‘realistic personalism’
reveals a progression in the concept of freedom
that can be summed up in the phrase “from
freedom to emancipation”. This was a move
from freedom as a psychological, spiritual,
metaphysical experience and total independ-
ence of the self, to a “militant, practical and
social experience which, in the outside world,
in society, is embodied in emancipation from
natural constraints and from all kinds of op-
BOX 1-4
Al Kawakibi: Freedom and Dignity
If you know that you were created free
to die with dignity, strive to live a pleas-
ant life every single day, a life in which
every one of you can be an independent
sultan ruling his own affairs, subject to
no authority but the law, his people’s
faithful associate, he sharing with them
and they with him both in good fortune
and in adversity; a devoted son of his
country, begrudging it neither thought
nor time nor money; loving humanity,
working to ensure that the best of the
people is the one who is most beneficial
to them; knowing that life is toil, and that
the disease of toil is despair; and that life
is hope, and that the disease of hope is
doubt; having understood that, to God,
judgement and fate are what He knows
and what He does, while to man they are
effort and toil; knowing with certainty
that every footprint on the face of the
earth has been placed there by one of his
fellow men; not imagining within himself
any incapacity, and expecting nothing
but good; and the ultimate good is for
him to live free or die.
Source: Abdel Rahman al Kawakibi, 1984, 126).
Throughout the 20th
century, freedom
in Arab culture
represents a strong
desire, a vital need,
a major demand and a
powerful slogan.
56 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
pression, deprivation and exploitation. It is
embodied in “real freedoms”, social, economic
and political (Mohammed Aziz al-Habbabi, in
Arabic, 1972, 68, 90-91, 185-186). This devel-
opment gave rise to related societal and civili-
zational orientations, such as are expressed by
the nationalist thinker, Constantine Zurreq,
and a group of social-minded intellectuals
inspired by Marxism, the most outstanding
of whom are Mahmoud Amin al-Alam, Samir
Amin, Abdallah al-Arawy, Mahdi Aamil, Elias
Murqus and Al-Tayyib Tizini.
Constantine Zurreq linked the question
of freedom to that of “civilizational potential”
or “civilization”, which, he believed, distin-
guishes nations in terms of their progress or
backwardness. He thought that the back-
wardness suffered by the Arabs in modern
times was due to their weak and unbalanced
standards of civilization. To overcome both the
imbalance and the weakness, basic conditions
for civilization must be guaranteed, for they
alone can ensure progress. Zurreq believes that
the eight most important yardsticks for de-
termining the degree of civilization in a given
society are: technical know-how, accumulated
scientific knowledge, moral values, artistic and
literary creativity, freedom of thought, the ex-
tent to which skills and values are to be found
throughout society, the prevailing systems,
institutions and traditions with the freedoms
and rights they contain, and the persons whose
lives and activities reflect those skills and values
(Constantine Zurreq, in Arabic, 1981, 278). He
gathered his arguments under two main head-
ings: creativity and emancipation. Freedom of
thought was the condition sine qua non for
creativity and all else depended on it. Eman-
cipation was the other facet of civilization and
embodied the degree of a person’s liberation
from nature; from the illusions and desires of
the self; and from other people, be they ex-
ploiting groups or classes or the hegemony of
other societies (ibid. 279-281).
Emancipation also figures in the Marxist
view of the freedom question. In their view,
in the final analysis, the aim is to be liberated
from man’s arbitrariness, from the domination
of nature, from exploitation by capitalism,
from the power of private property, from pov-
erty and conflict This view postpones the reali-
zation of freedom until such time that both the
individual and society are socially, economi-
cally and politically liberated. For them “full
individual freedom can only be realized when
all its objective conditions become a reality in
a free society” (Abdullah al-Arawy, in Arabic,
1993, 76). This can only be achieved through a
comprehensive Arab liberation movement dis-
tant from the Arab bourgeoisie and prevalent
colonial conditions (Mahdi Aamil).
FREEDOM FROM AN ISLAMIC
PERSPECTIVE
At first glance, it would appear that contem-
porary Islamic thought is not particularly
concerned with the question of freedom in its
practical sense, concentrating, essentially, on
the old question of whether human actions are
the doing of God or man. However, Islamists
do have a clear-cut theory and the old question
of freedom, i.e. metaphysical or ontological
freedom – is not their only concern. Freedom
of opinion – one of “the external, societal
freedoms – features prominently in the debate
between Islamists and their adversaries, who
question how far the latter tolerate such free-
dom among those who disagree with them and
how far Islam guarantees freedom of opinion
and belief for non-Muslims.
This challenge led to intensive efforts by
Islamic thinkers to “defend” and “justify”
their thesis that Islam guarantees freedom of
opinion. They asserted that “freedom is in-
stinctive” and that the “life of all the prophets”
is an affirmation of the freedom of opinion.
They insisted that both the Qur’an and the
Sunna “recognize freedom of opinion” and
that “political freedom is but a branch of
a bigger, more general origin”, namely “the
freedom of man that stems from the fact that
he is a man, as recognized in unequivocal texts
of the Book and the Sunna (Mohammed Selim
al-Awwa, in Arabic, 1989, 211-216; Hassan
al-Turabi, in Arabic, 2003,162-174). At the
same time, Islamists also stressed that “this
freedom of the mind or freedom of opinion”,
recognized by Islam and guaranteed by the
Qur’an, is subject to one limitation: commit-
ment to Islamic law. An opinion expressed by
a Muslim, in exercising this freedom, must not
Freedom of opinion
...features prominently
in the debate between
Islamists and their
adversaries who
question how far the
latter tolerate such
freedom among those
who disagree with
them.
Islamists stressed
that “freedom of
opinion” or “freedom
of the mind”,
recognized by Islam
and guaranteed by
the Qu’ran, is subject
to one limitation:
commitment to
Islamic law.
57 THE INTELLECTUAL BASIS AND CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND GOOD GOVERNANCE
cast doubt on Islam or break its rules. That
was considered as contrary to public order in
the Islamic State, for which a person was liable
to be declared incompetent and for which, in
certain circumstances, he could be subjected
to punishment (Mohammed Selim al-Awwa,
in Arabic, 1989, 216). Such a position, which
is held by the majority in Islamic literature,
does not offer an Islamic theory concerning
freedom; it would more fittingly come under
“rights of freedom”. This does not, however,
mean that contemporary Islamic writings
are devoid of any profound theory “defining
freedom”. Prominent representatives of the
Islamic movement have indeed formulated
such a theory despite their differences, such
as Youssef al-Qaradawi, Allal al-Fasi, Hassan
Saab, Hassan al-Turabi, Hassan Hanafi and
Rashed al-Ghanoushi. “Emancipated Slavery”
may well reflect their theory which signifies
“slavery to God alone” and emancipation
from slavery to any other but God (Radwan
al-Sayyid, in Arabic, 2002, 565).
For these thinkers, the theory of Islamic
freedom stems from their critique of the liberal
concept of freedom. According to Youssef al-
Qaradawi, this concept is based on a number
of “extraneous” elements, such as secularism,
the nationalist movement, capitalist economics
and personal freedom as defined in the West,
including women’s freedom to wear practical
modern clothing and mix with men, the imple-
mentation of foreign laws and a parliamentary
system. Its major defect, in their view, is that
it contains no “spiritual” element, which it de-
liberately neglects by “turning away from God
and refusing to follow His guidance” (Youssef
al-Qaradawi, in Arabic, 1977, 121).
Allal al-Fasi, an independent Moroccan
political thinker, seems to be both more precise
and profound, and more adept at developing
theory on the question of freedom, than any
other Islamic thinker. The concept of freedom,
for Allal al-Fasi, starts with the will for the total
liberation of the national personality from all
constraints, whether external, such as coloni-
alism, or internal such as social relations that
negate freedom or certain remaining traditions
that hamper people’s freedom. The substance
of his theory is political and aims at liberating
humankind from all kinds and levels of aliena-
tion (Muhammad Waqidi, in Arabic, 1990,
146-148; Mostafa Hanafi, in Arabic, 2002, 336-
337). The more restricted framework within
which al-Fasi raises the problem of freedom
remains, however, a religious Islamic one gov-
erned by the concepts of absolute divine free-
dom, and God’s injunctions to human beings,
His heirs on Earth, responsible for populating
it and for ensuring justice and freedom. For
him, freedom is part of humankind’s personal
nature, since human beings were not created
free but were created to become free; freedom
not being just a right but also an obligation
that comes second to the interest of the society
(Allal al-Fasi, in Arabic, 1997, 2-14; Muham-
mad Waqidi, in Arabic, 1990, 149-161). The
essence of Al-Fasi’s perception of freedom is
that belief in God is the path to freedom, for
God is absolute freedom or “true freedom” the
belief in whom is the path towards the freedom
of humankind.
The writings of the Lebanese intellectual,
Hassan Saab, reflect precisely the same percep-
tion. He argues that the monotheistic Islamic
creed is “synonymous with the process of
liberation” (Hassan Saab, in Arabic, 1981, 28).
Monotheism is “slavery to God alone”. Such
‘slavery’ is humankind’s emancipation from
natural, historical and political constraints. It is
emancipation from everything that is not God,
it is what releases a person from the universe
of necessity into the realm of freedom, away
from all modern ideologies which are only
new forms of slavery: economic liberalism,
materialistic communism, natural scientism,
Nietzsche’s nihilism, Freudian sexualism, etc.
(ibid, 10-11).
That is also the school of thought adopted
by the leading Islamists, Hassan al-Turabi and
Rashed al-Ghanoushi, who believe freedom
to be a breaking free from mortal constraints,
emancipation and slavery to God. Al-Gh-
anoushi quotes from a lecture by Al-Turabi
on ‘freedom and unity’ to the effect that
“Freedom is humankind’s destiny, that which
differentiates human beings from all other
creatures, so he knelt to God voluntarily since
God when He created mortals did not include
any element that would force them to believe.
Freedom is not an end but a means to worship
God ... If freedom in its legal manifestation is
(For Allal al-Fasi),
freedom is part of
humankind’s personal
nature, since human
beings were not
created free: they
were created to
become free.
The essence of this
perception… is that
belief in God is the
path to freedom.
58 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
licence, in its religious manifestation it is the
path towards the worship of God. It is human-
kind’s duty to emancipate itself for God and to
be faithful in forming opinions and positions.
From the Islamic viewpoint, such a freedom is
absolute because it is an endless striving for
the Absolute. The more faithful people are in
their slavery to God, the greater will be their
emancipation from all other creations in na-
ture ... and the higher will be the levels of their
achievement of human perfection” (Rashed
al-Ghanoushi, in Arabic, 1993, 38).
This is how Islamic writings promote and
consecrate the concept of freedom as being a
voluntary human action, but also an emanci-
patory action, thus reconciling Islam with the
“emancipation” movement and, ultimately,
considering it to be synonymous with “slavery
to God”, i.e. removing it from human to divine
space.
FREEDOM AND LIBERATION
In the 1950s the notion of Arab nationalism
came to be embodied in political movements
and regimes, as in Ba’thism in Syria and sev-
eral neighbouring countries, and Nasserism in
Egypt. These movements made freedom one
of their basic tenets. In fact, it is one of the
three cornerstones of the Ba’thist credo (unity,
socialism, freedom), and a major element of
democracy in Nasserism. Yet, the “revolution-
ary” nature of these movements and the sur-
rounding conditions of international, regional
and local struggle and conflict made the lead-
ers of those movements postpone implement-
ing the principle of freedom in favour of other
principles: Arab unity in the party’s ideology
(Ba’thism) and socialism in Nasserism. They
even justified certain formulations that cur-
tailed freedom throughout “the revolutionary
stage”. This view was, however, linked to their
concept of “liberation” and to defending the
idea that the liberation of the Arab human
being or individual was a pre-requisite for
the establishment of complete freedom. All
seemed to agree that “liberation” meant the
liberation of the Arab individual from all kinds
of exploitation, oppression, poverty, need,
sickness, capitalism, feudalism, and everything
that represents a “constraint” limiting man’s
actions, and obstacles to the individual’s real
freedom. In other words, economic, political
and social liberation were basic conditions for
the real freedom of the people and citizens.
(Munif al-Razzaz, in Arabic, 1985, 491, 583,
594).
One cannot approach the issues of free-
dom, emancipation and liberation without ref-
erence to what has, since the early 1950s, been
termed “the Arab liberation movement”. This
was the name given to “progressive” political
organizations and parties in the Arab arena, the
organizations that were struggling for freedom,
unity, development and progress. Despite the
lofty aims, slogans and values espoused by the
movement to justify its existence – liberation,
unity, justice and development – in reality it
was in a state of crisis and bitter failure. The
explanation given by Kamal Abdel Latif and
others is salient: “The historical awareness
behind the Arab liberation movement, that
reached the threshold of power, was unable to
come to terms with the liberal gains achieved
in the Mashriq between the two wars. All the
intellectual and political values that arose in the
first quarter of the 20th century were ignored,
hence civil society was not established, and the
State was unable to acquire legal, secular legiti-
macy. It donned the cape of charismatic power
and resorted to masked tyranny” (Kamal
Abdel Latif, in Arabic, 75).
From the foregoing analysis of the con-
cepts of freedom, emancipation and liberation
it would seem that ontological freedom was
not considered to be a gateway to emancipa-
tion and liberation. Indeed, intellectuals con-
cerned with emancipation openly criticized the
old definition of freedom in terms of personal
will, individual awareness and independence
from external factors. While many realized
that the attainment of freedom requires relent-
less struggle and effort, most of their ideas of
emancipation and liberation revolved around
issues of economic and social exploitation as
well as political tyranny.
The experience of the Palestinian struggle,
however, offered the Palestinian intellectual
Sari Nusaiba an unusual philosophical oppor-
tunity, which enabled him to combine freedom
in its ontological sense and liberation in its
political sense. What is freedom? Freedom is
Islamic writings
promote and
consecrate the
concept of freedom
as being a voluntary
human action, but
also an emancipatory
one.
The state was unable
to acquire legal,
secular legitimacy. It
donned the cape of
charismatic power and
resorted to masked
tyranny.
59 THE INTELLECTUAL BASIS AND CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND GOOD GOVERNANCE
the absence of bonds or the removal of bonds
or the emancipation from bonds (Sari Nusaiba,
in Arabic, 1995, 33 onwards). Freedom means
“the capacity for growth and development
towards the better” and “the breaking of the
fetters preventing such growth and develop-
ment” (ibid., 85). Such a capacity is achieved
at the level of the “self” or at the level of the
“will”, i.e. at the level of the inner interaction
within the self that engenders the victory of the
positive over the negative by the determination
to undertake a certain action, or the refusal
to submit to undertaking it”. This interaction
“includes elements such as self-awareness,
awareness of the reality outside the self and,
most important, the clash or interconnection
of the first and the second, leading to the
domination of the self over the action so that
a human being’s action is in harmony with
what he believes in” (ibid, 117). Sari Nusaiba
illustrates his interpretation with the case of an
imprisoned Palestinian militant subjected to
questioning and torture. The militant’s abso-
lute determination, awareness of his personal
identity, capacity to overcome inner bonds
and unwavering resolve which embodies the
collective resolve, enables him to overcome the
external enemy’s will that binds him, and to
achieve freedom and independence for himself
and for his people (ibid, 118-127).
THE RIGHTS OF FREEDOM
Ever since “freedom” acquired its right of citi-
zenship as one of the values within the modern
Arab cultural cluster, its proponents’ main in-
tention was not to adopt an abstract, absolute
concept of freedom, but rather a concept that
has practical, intellectual, political, social, reli-
gious and economic facets. It is true that those
facets were considered forms of freedom, but
in reality they were also the “rights” of every
free human being. Freedom did not only mean
freedom of action and behaviour, the lifting of
constraints within the boundaries of law and
of Islamic law; it also meant the free citizen’s
entitlement to enjoy a number of rights origi-
nally linked to freedom. Rifaa al-Tahtawy rec-
ognized this when he considered that freedoms
- natural, behavioural, religious, political and
economic - were in fact the rights of citizenship
(Wajih Kawtharany, in Arabic, 2002, 427-430).
Khayr al-Din al-Tounsi stressed a person’s
right to free disposal of himself and his belong-
ings – that is personal freedom – and the right
of the constituency to “intervene in royal poli-
cies and to debate what is for the best”. He also
referred to the right to freedom of expression
or what he termed “freedom of the printing
press” (ibid., 433).
The leading thinkers of the Arab age of
renaissance followed suit. Throughout the
20th century, all political and social movements
came to agree on the “necessity of freedom” as
a slogan, a claim, a supreme value and a right.
While they focused on different forms of free-
dom - national, political, social, economic and
intellectual “freedom of opinion” - they were
all in agreement that these were human rights
for the citizen and for society (Muhammad
Waqidi, in Arabic, 1990, 164-165). The fact
remains, however, as Burhan Ghalioun notes,
that such clear recognition of the rights and
freedoms of the individual has been linked
to the call for democracy which has become
a concrete reality at more than one level, as
well as “the uppermost value among political
values and the first among Arab social claims”
(Burhan Ghalioun, in Arabic, 1994,109). More
recently, this recognition also became linked to
the claims of those seeking to promote respect
for human rights and to encourage backward
societies along the path of democracy. As long
as the task of the democratic political regime
is to guarantee freedoms and as long as such
freedoms represent vital demands for citizens,
they end up by becoming rights, not to say ob-
ligations, to quote Allal al-Fasi.
In Arab culture, fundamental freedoms
have in recent times become linked inextri-
cably to the question of human rights and to
an acute awareness of the oppressive nature
of political regimes, particularly where po-
litical freedoms are concerned. Prominent
Arab human rights advocates stressed the
importance of human rights and fundamental
freedoms. Munther Anabtawy, one of the
foremost pioneering human rights activists,
said that all the Arab military and political ca-
tastrophes, cataclysms and defeats were due to
“the continuing deprivation of the Arab citizen
Throughout the 20th
century, all political
and social movements
came to agree on
the “necessity of
freedom” as a slogan,
a claim, a supreme
value and a right.
In Arab culture,
fundamental freedoms
have become linked
inextricably to the
question of human
rights and to an acute
awareness of the
oppressive nature of
political regimes.
60 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
of his fundamental rights and freedoms”. He
believed that it had become imperative for in-
tellectual élites to contribute to promoting the
human rights of Arabs, that being one of the
necessary conditions for the revival of the Arab
national project and for overcoming the social,
political and economic problems confronting
Arab citizens and Arab countries today (Bur-
han Ghalioun, ibid., 395-397).
The general call to respect human rights
and to guarantee the fundamental freedoms of
the Arab citizen is no longer voiced for its own
sake in Arab intellectual circles; these prin-
ciples have become the two vital conditions
for an Arab renaissance. Arab nationalists,
liberals, Islamists, Marxists and independents,
unanimously proclaim the call. Not all agree
on the limits of such freedoms and rights or on
their scope and particular manifestations: some
speak of personal freedom and freedom of be-
lief, others speak of economic, social, political
and other freedoms. There are differences,
sometimes fundamental, in how the various
groups perceive these issues.
For example, the liberal and the Islamist
are unlikely to agree on the scope of personal
and moral freedom, though they may be in
agreement over freedom of ownership and
work. The liberal, the nationalist and the
Islamist want to see freedom implemented,
while the Marxist’s priorities are revolution,
the struggle against capitalism and the victory
of socialism before true freedom can be at-
tained. Many criticize bourgeois liberalism for
its superficiality, insignificance and lack of au-
thenticity. Yet they also question whether the
Islamists, if they ever came to power, would
respect the human rights and freedoms of
those with whom they disagree. Most remain
sceptical about this despite the Islamists’ as-
surances and reassurances to the contrary, and
the recent efforts made by some to justify the
right to differ (Fahmy Jadaan, in Arabic, 2002)
and despite the guarantees provided in Islamic
human rights declarations and charters elabo-
rated over the past two decades.
THE ARAB RENAISSANCE AND THE
CHALLENGE OF FREEDOM
No Arab thinker today doubts that freedom is
a vital and necessary condition for a new Arab
renaissance, nor that the Arab world’s capacity
to face up to the problems and risks of globali-
zation depends on ending tyranny and secur-
ing fundamental rights and freedoms.
Freedom is not the only, nor is it a suf-
ficient, condition for this renaissance to take
place, but it is a condition sine qua non. It is
counterproductive to debate the prioritisa-
tion of values needed for such a renaissance:
freedom, or development or justice. All are
essential; the renaissance cannot work in the
absence of any one of them; they are an inter-
connected and interrelated whole.
With the prevailing situation in the Arab
world and with recent global developments, it
is vital to think about freedom and the form
it can take to embody the specificities of Arab
societies, and the fundamental social and po-
litical aspirations of their people.
Reflecting on this subject, Naseef Nassar
turns to liberalism as a social system based
on the principle of individual freedom, noting
BOX 1-5
Naseef Nassar: The Reconstruction of Liberalism
The power of liberalism is not only that
it raises the banner of individual freedom
and counteracts the tendency to dis-
solve the individual within the group,
but also that it claims freedom for all
human beings without exception, men
and women alike. History, however,
teaches us that to organize social life in a
practical, liberal manner is far from the
mere application of a ready-made and
final view, or a pleasant walk in a rose
garden. It is an open process of strug-
gle, one that requires an ever-developing
awareness of the dimensions of freedom
and of its problems, in the light of direct
experience and in all the areas freedom
touches. It also requires an associated
theoretical understanding of the liberal
orientation itself and a critical review of
its achievements.
As a result of the principle of free-
dom of thought and belief, the liberal
society does not lean towards a compre-
hensive and complete unity of thought,
but rather towards a plurality of beliefs,
or towards variety within one single be-
lief. Taken to extremes, such a tendency
leads to the exact opposite of dogmatic
unity of belief, i.e. to a kind of chaos that
is no less dangerous than its opposite
where human relations, understanding
and development are concerned. That is
why for a liberal society to remain viable
and to progress, it needs to organize the
processes of intellectual understanding
among its members.
It also needs to set up mechanisms
for sifting, comparing and selecting in
order to make room for truths to surface,
to agree on common truths and their link
to the right institutions for them.
It goes without saying that the truths
in question are not the ones related to the
absolute and the eternal alone, but rather
the social, the cultural, political, eco-
nomic and moral truths on which hang
the history of individuals as well as their
destiny in this fleeting world. Despite its
individualistic premises, the liberal soci-
ety in the West has never ceased to try
developing a response to this need, yet
the challenge now imposes itself in new
forms amid the rising tide of globalisa-
tion which requires a reconstruction of
liberalism.
Source: Naseef Nassar, in Arabic, 2004, 77-78 and 107.
No Arab thinker today
doubts that freedom is
a vital and necessary
condition for a new
Arab renaissance.
61 THE INTELLECTUAL BASIS AND CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND GOOD GOVERNANCE
that liberalism is not limited to the forms it has
taken in Western societies up to the present
day; and that other countries – among them
Arab countries – can seek “the form they deem
best to promote freedom depending on their
position on the map of civilization and without
excluding the experiences of Western coun-
tries” (ibid., 150-155).
Nassar believes that liberalism should be
reconstructed, which requires “the assimila-
tion of the principle of individual freedom
within a new concept of the sociability of
man”, one that links reason to justice and to
authority. Along the same lines, individualis-
tic globalized liberalism should be excluded
– since it neglects freedom of will in favour
of unbridled capitalistic power. A new phi-
losophy must be devised, based on a “social
liberalism” which can be called “the liberal-
ism of social solidarity”, a liberalism founded
on social reason, social justice and a political
authority that establishes the frameworks and
organizations conducive to protecting and
safeguarding freedom (ibid. 158-159). Starting
with this “liberalism of social solidarity” and
within its space, the issues of unity, pluralism,
stability, labour, social wealth, political system,
knowledge, faith and education can all be
reconstructed, along with the institutions and
organizations they require, in a manner no less
flexible or efficient than that followed by Euro-
pean states in their transition from the Europe
we know to a new Europe that will give a new
face to globalization (ibid.167). The great free-
dom we seek resides in this system based on
“the liberalism of social solidarity” and not in
“neo-liberalism”.
The majority of Arab thinkers today are
moving in the direction of a renaissance which
combines the principles of freedom and justice
with the additional principle of social and eco-
nomic development, although they may differ
as to which principle should come first. This
trend should be entirely compatible with an
Arab order of good governance of a humane
nature, based on freedom, creativity, justice,
welfare, dignity, fairness and the public good.
THE CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND
GOOD GOVERNANCE IN THIS
REPORT
Freedom is one of the principal human goals
and highest human values. It is cherished in
itself and sought for its own sake.
The concept of freedom accommodates
two senses, negative and positive. The first
concerns the domain in which an individual
(or group) is able to exist and to act as s/he
(or it) wishes without interference by others;
it entails lifting any restrictions placed on the
individual. The second, positive sense has to
do with the source of interference or control
over the being or action of the individual (or
group), or the manners in which individual
freedom is regulated for the purpose of avoid-
ing chaos, (Berlin, 1969).
The importance of the second sense of
freedom is that some freedoms can be incom-
patible with higher human goals. An oft-cited
example is the “liberty” of someone to inflict
pain on another by committing the crime of
torture. Moreover, the natural, unimpeded
spread of total freedom may on the one hand
block the satisfaction of the basic needs of peo-
ple at large; and, on the other, allow the strong
to tyrannize the weak.
However, the individual’s consent to the
principle that freedom must be subject to
control raises the possibility of oppression by
a ruling individual or majority. Hence, the
inseparability of freedom and good govern-
ance, defined in a specific societal context,
constitutes the ideal position between absolute
freedom (chaos) and oppression. For this rea-
son, the present Report takes a broad purview
that encompasses the negative and the positive
dimensions of freedom.
BOX 1-6
Freedom for its own sake
A person’s freedom can be seen as
being valuable in addition to his or her
achievements. A person’s options and
opportunities can be seen as counting in a
normative evaluation, in addition to what
the person ends up achieving or secur-
ing. Freedom may be valued not merely
because it assists achievement, but also
because of its own importance, going
beyond the value of the state of existence
actually achieved. If, for example, all
the alternatives other than the one actu-
ally chosen were to be eliminated, this
need not affect achievement (since the
chosen alternative can be still chosen),
but the person clearly has less freedom,
and this may be seen as a loss of some
importance.
Amartya Sen, 1988, 60
Freedom is one of the
principal human goals
and highest human
values. It is cherished
in itself and sought for
its own sake.
62 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
The scope of the concept of freedom
ranges between two extremes. The first is a
narrow one that restricts freedom to civil and
political rights and freedoms, linking it to citi-
zenship and democracy, and to the emergence
of liberalism in Western thought since the 17th
century. The second is comprehensive, and has
been adopted in this Report. This compre-
hensive scope incorporates not only civil and
political freedoms (in other words, liberation
from oppression) but also the liberation of the
individual from all factors that are inconsistent
with human dignity, such as hunger, disease,
ignorance, poverty, and fear. In human rights
terms, the understanding of freedom in the
present Report covers all realms of human
rights, that is, economic, social, cultural and
environmental rights as well as civil and politi-
cal rights.
In this comprehensive definition, freedom
is an ideal and persistently broadening goal. It
is thus true to say that freedom is a goal ever
sought but never reached.
As is the case with civil and political
freedoms, the other freedoms are valued in
themselves as human aspirations. A citizen
who enjoys civil and political freedoms will
still seek to avoid hunger or disease. While
some may think that adversity or insecurity
may distract people from such issues as, for ex-
ample, freedom of expression and association,
lack of these other freedoms may often spur
demand for freedom and good governance.
Ultimately, these other freedoms complement
and complete civil and political freedoms, to
form the core of human well-being. This core
constitutes true freedom: the absence of even
one of these other freedoms detracts from the
value of civil and political freedoms. What, for
instance, is the point of a person having the
legal right to buy basic commodities, i.e. the
right to economic transactions, if poverty pre-
cludes the effective exercise of that right?
In this comprehensive sense, freedom is
considered both the ultimate goal of human
development and its foundation.
Freedom, however, is one of those supe-
rior human culmination outcomes that must
be guaranteed, sustained and promoted by
effective societal structures and processes.
These societal guarantees are summed up in
the order of good governance embodied in
synergy between the state, civil society, and the
private sector as depicted in the first Report in
our series. Such an order:
• Safeguards freedom to ensure the expan-
sion of people’s choices (the core of human
development)
• Rests upon effective popular participation
and full representation of the public at large.
• Is buttressed by first-rate institutions (in
contrast to the tyranny of the individual),
BOX 1-7
The Charter of Medina
One of the most important acts with
which the Messenger of God (the
Prophet Muhammad) began his life in
Medina was the writing of a missive in
which he formally set out the relationship
between Muslims and others in Medinan
society. He referred to the groups col-
lectively as “the people of this document
[lit., page, sahifah],” that is, the missive
he had written. This document is consid-
ered the equivalent to the constitution of
the emergent Islamic state in Medina,
and indeed many modern scholars refer
to it as the “Constitution of Medina”
or “Charter of Medina”. Nearly a mil-
lennium and a half ago, this document
articulated and established the principles
of citizenship, equality and justice (com-
bating oppression), and of freedom of
belief, in a written pact.
This is possibly one of the earliest
documents in history to appraise the
relationship between governance and
people on the basis of citizenship, rather
than on any discriminatory basis (religion
in this case)
Ibn Ishaq reported: The Messenger
of God drew up a written document
among the Emigrants
4
and the Medinans
(Ansar) in which he made a pact with the
Jews [in Medina], establishing their right
to practice their religion and retain their
property, and in which he made and ac-
cepted conditions of mutual co-existence
in the city.
From the Text of the Charter:
“In the name of God the Beneficent and
Merciful, this is a document from Mu-
hammad the Prophet [to govern the rela-
tions] between the believers and Muslims
of Quraysh and Yathrib
5
and those who
followed and joined and strove with
them. They are one community (umma),
exclusive of all other people….
“The pious believers will stand
against rebellious elements or those who
promote oppression or injustice, enmity
or sin and corruption, among believers.
Every person’s hand will be against such
a one even if that one is the offspring of
any one of him or her….
“The Jews have their religion, and
the Muslims have theirs, and this ap-
plies to their freedmen as well as to
themselves, except for the one who acts
wrongly or unjustly. That person hurts
none but himself and his family. The
Jews of Bani Najjar will have the same
rights as the Jews of Bani Awf, and the
Jews of Bani Harth will be as the Jews of
Bani Awf….
The Jews of al-Aws, both their freed-
men and themselves, will have the same
standing as the people of this document,
in good and pure loyalty from the people
of this document.”
Sources: Abi Muhammad Abdulmalik ibn Hashim al-Mu’afari, in Arabic, 1998;
Abd al-Rahman Ahmad Salim, in Arabic, 1999; Muhammad Salim al-‘Awa, in Arabic, 1989
4
Emigrants: those who had emigrated with the Messenger of Gods from Mecca to Medina to found a community of Muslims. The Ansar (“support-
ers,” “helpers”) were the Muslims of Medina who invited the Messenger of Gods to settle there.
5
Quraysh: The Meccan clan from which Muhammad, the Messenger of God, came. Yathrib: the name of Medina before it became Medinat al-Nabi,
“City of the Prophet,” shortened form, Medina.
Freedom is an ideal
and persistently
broadening goal.
63 THE INTELLECTUAL BASIS AND CONCEPT OF FREEDOM AND GOOD GOVERNANCE
which operate efficiently and with complete
transparency. These institutions are subject
to effective accountability among themselves,
protected by the government’s separation of
powers, and by a balance among those powers;
they are also directly accountable to the popu-
lace through popular selection processes that
are regular, free, and scrupulously fair.
• Upholds the rule of law; and ensures that
the law itself is fair, protective of freedom, and
applies equally to all;
• Ensures that an efficient, fair and inde-
pendent judiciary applies the law impartially
and that the executive branch duly implements
judicial rulings.
A society distinguished by freedom and
good governance requires an institutional ar-
chitecture based on the synergy of three social
sectors:
• The State, incorporating government, rep-
resentative bodies, and the judiciary;
• Civil society, in the broadest sense, which
embraces non-governmental organizations,
professional associations and syndicates, mass
media, and political parties;
• The (profit-seeking) private sector.
Good governance requires each sector to pos-
sess the following two characteristics:
• Respect for freedom and human rights,
and adherence to the legal architecture that
protects them.
• Observance of the principles of rational
public administration. This calls for stable
institutional structures in place of supreme
individual authorities, and adherence to key
principles: efficiency, separation of powers,
transparency, disclosure, and accountability.
Beyond these general criteria for the in-
stitutional structure in a society of freedom
and good governance, there are particular
requisites for each of the three sectors, in the
following respects:
• Judiciary: impartiality
• Representational bodies: efficacy of legisla-
tion and oversight
• Government: leadership directly selected
by, and accountable to the people
• Private sector: creativity, efficiency and
social responsibility
• Civil society: effectiveness, self-sustainabil-
ity and social responsibility.
Undoubtedly, the institutional architec-
ture, especially the legal and political architec-
ture, occupies the pre-eminent position, as this
is the foundation on which all else must build.
Thus, the present Report puts the spotlight on
these two cornerstones.
Similarly, the concept emphasises civil so-
ciety, as characterized above, because the latter
has a pivotal role to play in achieving a deep
political alternation in society as countries
make the transition from a status quo inimical
to freedom, to the regime of good governance
described here.
BOX 1-8
Setting the deviant ruler straight
Omar Ibn al-Khattab: Should a person
see in me a deviation [from that which is
right], let him make it straight.
Man: If we saw in you a deviation,
we would make it straight by the blade
of our swords.
Omar Ibn al-Khattab: Praise be to
God that in the community of Omar
exist those who would straighten Omar’s
deviation with the sword.
BOX 1-9
Al-Kawakibi: Importance of holding the ruling
authority accountable
In sum, we have said that government,
of any sort, is not absolved of being de-
scribed as oppressive as long as it escapes
rigorous oversight and is not made to
answer for its actions without fail.
It is a well established fact that there
is no just government that feels safe from
responsibility and blame because in some
way the nation’s people are inattentive or
negligent, or simply disregard it, but that
it hastens to clothe itself in the attribute
of tyranny; and, once this is achieved, it
will not abandon it as long as it is served
by a modicum of those two enormous
and dreadful powers, the ignorance of
the people and organized troops.
Source: Abdul Rahman al-Kawakibi, in Arabic, 8-9
Economic and
social freedoms
are underpinned
by efficient and
sustainable economic
growth in which
corporate governance
plays a major role.
BOX 1-10
Corporate governance
Economic and social freedoms are un-
derpinned by efficient and sustainable
economic growth in which corporate
governance plays a major role.
Three major principles of corporate
governance are underscored: transpar-
ency, accountability and inclusiveness.
It is not only important to uphold each
of these principles in its own right; since
they are mutually reinforcing, it is even
more important to adhere to them as
a whole so that none of them is com-
promised. As such, transparency in cor-
porate governance is critical not only in
terms of providing quality disclosure of
information so that investors may make
informed financial decisions, but also
because it helps ensure the accountabil-
ity of corporate institutions, which rests
on public knowledge and information.
Furthermore, individual investors’ basic
right to be included in decision-making
may deliberately be poorly defined and
weakly protected when corporate ac-
countability is lacking and no deterrents
or recourse are available for those whose
rights are breached.
Particular attention needs to be
paid to stock markets, one of the most
important drivers of economic growth.
It is crucial to implement corporate
governance within them to enhance their
efficiency and to harness their develop-
mental potential.
64 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Under such a system of good governance, it
is virtually impossible to destroy freedom. On
the other hand, freedom remains at risk, and
the mode of government can become oppres-
sive, where any of these cornerstones of good
governance are absent or deficient.
It needs to be underlined, however, that
the individual is free only in a free society
within a free nation. Distinguishing between
society and nation allows for an analysis of
the freedoms of different groups in that social
space between the individual and the nation.
It thus facilitates consideration of minorities,
whether ethnic or religious, and the important
question of respect for their rights.
The paradigm of “good governance” dis-
cussed here and the collective societal process
for its advancement are especially relevant
because they enable different societies to rep-
resent their own particularities. This provides
Arab countries with an opportunity to think
creatively about how to achieve the best and
most representative system of good govern-
ance in their respective contexts.
In the Arab region, national liberation is of
particular importance because of the Israeli oc-
cupation of Palestinian Arab territories, which
impedes human development in the area, and
threatens peace and security in the region.
There is also the more recent dimension posed
by the US-led occupation of Iraq, along with
the increasing foreign military presence and
other external influences in many Arab coun-
tries.
Governance in Arab countries is undergo-
ing a process of reform. We hope that these
Reports will help to plant the seeds of good
governance in the region by inspiring a soci-
ety-wide process of creative thinking, innova-
tion and collective work in which all dynamic
societal forces in Arab countries will take part.
And this includes, of course, governments of
the day.
The pivotal question is: can the present
Arab society accomnodate this concept of
freedom and good governance?. An answer is
attempted in Chapter 2. The concept adopted
raises another question of a historical nature:
can the future unfold along a trajectory that
will lead the Arab world to a society of free-
dom and good governance?.
BOX 1-11
Taha Hussein(1938): Freedom and Independence
We live in an era among whose more
special attributes is the fact that freedom
and independence are not so much a
goal towards which peoples look and to
which nations strive, as they are a means
to achieve higher and more lasting goals,
beyond freedom and independence in
themselves—ends that are more broadly
beneficial and more widely advanta-
geous.
Many groups of people in many
parts of the world once lived free and
independent. Yet freedom availed them
of nothing, and they found no further
benefit in independence. Their own free-
dom and independence did not protect
them from encroachment by other peo-
ples who had freedom and independence
but were not content to make these alone
suffice and did not regard them as their
only long-term goal, but instead supple-
mented them with the civilization that
is based on culture and knowledge, the
strength that emerges from culture and
knowledge, and the wealth that is pro-
duced out of culture and knowledge.
We want to be free people in our
country, free of foreigners such that they
cannot oppress us or treat us unjustly;
and free with respect to ourselves, such
that no one of us can oppress or treat
another unjustly.
We want internal domestic freedom,
and its foundation, the democratic order.
We also want external freedom, and
what it is based on, true independence
and the strength that surrounds this
independence.
Source: Taha Hussein, in Arabic, 1996, 15, 41
The individual is free
only in a free society
within a free nation.
CHAPTER TWO
Freedom and Governance in
Arab Countries at the Beginning
of the Third Millennium: Some
Problematic Issues.
FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES AT THE BEGINNING OF THE THIRD MILLENNIUM: SOME PROBLEMATIC ISSUES 65
Introduction
In Arab countries, the model of comprehen-
sive freedom and the model of good govern-
ance guaranteeing such freedom both face
significant conceptual and practical chal-
lenges. A combination of global, regional
and local circumstances accounts for this.
Based on the adopted understanding of free-
dom, the present chapter briefly discusses
some of these issues, examined in more
detail in subsequent chapters. The first issue
is the tension between freedom and demo-
cratic institutions as they exist today in the
Arab world. The second concerns how the
interests of dominant global powers in the
region affect freedom and good governance
in Arab countries. This chapter also exam-
ines claims that Islam and Arab culture are
inherently incompatible with freedom and
good governance. That scrutiny is followed
by a discussion of international human
rights law as a basic reference for good
governance in Arab countries. The chapter
concludes with a section on peaceful transi-
tion towards a society of freedom and good
governance in the Arab region, addressed in
more depth in Chapter 7.
THE TENSION BETWEEN
FREEDOM AND DEMOCRATIC
INSTITUTIONS IN THE ARAB
WORLD
In Arab countries today, there seems to be a
contradiction between freedom and democracy
because many democratic institutions that exist
have been stripped of their original purpose to
uphold freedom, in its comprehensive sense.
Moreover, such institutions are subordinate to
the executive authority as part of a governance
apparatus that does not protect freedom.
This contradiction, which varies in degree
from one country to another, takes various
forms: laws that actually violate rights and
freedoms; parliamentary “representatives”
who bend to the executive authority, instead
of scrutinizing its performance and holding it
accountable; non-governmental organizations
that are run directly or indirectly by the gov-
ernment, or reflect corrupt governance; and
“trade unions” that defend governmental or
business interests, with little regard for those
they are supposed to represent. Then there are
some media outlets that are little more than
mouthpieces for government propaganda,
promoting freedom of speech only if it does
not turn into political activity. Such captive
outlets fail to stimulate intelligent and objec-
tive debate, enhance knowledge acquisition
and advance human development among the
public at large.
This is not to deny that, within such insti-
tutions, there are many sincere and committed
parliamentarians, journalists and civil society
representatives actively working for the good
of the people.
A more recent form of this contradiction is
the move towards the hereditary transmission
of power in republican systems of govern-
ance. By portending dynastic trends, this new
formula invalidates the very essence of the
republican system.
THE CONTRADICTION BETWEEN
FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
AND THE INTERESTS OF
DOMINANT GLOBAL POWERS
Arab states grew up in the shadow of, and in
some cases even because of, colonial arrange-
ments such as the Sykes-Picot Agreement
between the two Great Powers of that day,
Britain and France, after World War I. Many
In Arab countries
today…democratic
institutions that exist
have been stripped of
their original purpose
to uphold freedom.
Arab states grew up
in the shadow of,
and in some cases
because of, colonial
arrangements.
66 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
were subjected to a protracted period of colo-
nialism, which, as in the case of Egypt in 1882,
aided authoritarian regimes to start curbing
national opposition.
Certain restrictions of freedom in Arab
countries have their origins in the colonial
period when the authorities handled popular
resistance to occupation by introducing sys-
tems, laws and practices that curbed freedom.
Both the British and French set up exceptional
courts to try the opponents of colonial rule. In
Egypt, for example, martial law was imposed
for the first time under the British adminis-
tration. Although by the mid 20th century
occupation had come to an end, some of the
legal structures and practices limiting freedom
under occupation were to be adopted in the
political and legal architecture of the newly
independent Arab states.
In the internal-external equation in Arab
countries, two factors emerged which were
fated to have a far-reaching impact on the at-
titudes of the major powers towards freedom
in the Arab region: the discovery of oil and
the establishment of the state of Israel. The
discovery of large reserves of oil in the region,
combined with the dominant role that oil has
come to play in the advanced economies, made
the Arab region of crucial strategic value to the
industrialized countries whose main interest
was to ensure continuing oil supplies at reason-
able prices. The second factor was the creation
of Israel in 1948. Any Arab country’s attitude
toward Israel and its practices has become one
of the most important yardsticks by which that
country is judged by some global powers, espe-
cially the US.
It was inevitable that a contradiction
would arise between such interests and le-
gitimate Arab aspirations for freedom and
self-determination. It was generally feared that
if freedom and democracy ever prospered in
the Arab world, enabling the majority to freely
express their will, this might not help, and
could actively conflict with narrow interests
in the region.
When expedient, global powers intervened
in the affairs of Arab states, even if at times this
involved suppressing freedom movements.
This was sometimes achieved through direct
military intervention, such as when Britain
re-occupied Iraq in 1941 (Khalidi, 2004, 24),
or else through intervening to destabilize any
Arab State that presumed to oppose their in-
terests or to resist Israel as was the case with
the tripartite aggression against Egypt in 1956.
To that end, the global powers set up alliances,
sometimes with other Arab partners, to encir-
cle and pressure the “upstarts”.
Newly independent Arab states emerged
weak and fragile. On a tense global bat-
tleground, the majority of them had to find
a place for themselves, usually by associating
themselves with one or the other of the two
competing Cold War super-powers. Freedom
in Arab countries thus succumbed to a polar-
ized world. While one camp did not adopt
freedom in its comprehensive sense, the other,
while publicly proclaiming freedom, some-
times took pains to prevent it from spreading
in Arab countries.
Consequently, major world powers tended
to gloss over human rights violations in their
Arab client states so long as the regimes con-
cerned continued to serve their interests. Thus
indulged, the Arab despots of the day ruled
oppressively, postponing their countries’ tran-
sition to democracy.
BOX 2-1
The Reasons behind the Failure of Democracy in
Arab Countries: Perceptions of a Western Scholar
Seven reasons are suggested in this ac-
count: oil wealth, levels of income, the
nature of the Arab state, the Arab-Israeli
conflict, geography, outside support for
friendly tyrants, and Islamism. Three can
be tied to the context of this Report:
“Arab-Israeli tension: The creation
of the state of Israel on Palestinian soil
came at a time when most Arab states
themselves were just gaining their own
independence. The swift Arab rejection
of the new Israeli State, and subsequent
wars and Arab defeats have encouraged
the development of military regimes and
security-focused states that are readily
exploited by dictators.
Geography: The location of the
Arab world on a central East-West axis
and the geopolitical reality of holding
over half of the world’s oil reserves made
the Middle East a key focus of European
colonialism in the nineteenth and twen-
tieth centuries. Struggles between Arab
states and colonial powers for control
over their oil and its pricing have led to
frequent Western military intervention
that is still ongoing. These conditions
and continuing regional tensions have
not been conducive to democratic de-
velopments.
Long-standing Western Support
for “Friendly Tyrants” in the Middle
East: This phenomenon began with the
Cold War and systematically weakened
democratic forces within the region.
After the end of the Cold War, the emer-
gence of international terrorism and the
Bush Administration’s war on terror have
continued to favour the maintenance of
“friendly” authoritarian regimes. The
Bush administration’s call for democra-
tization invariably takes a back seat to
security considerations, perpetuating
tolerance of cooperative dictators who
support the war on terror”.
Source: Fuller, G.E., Islamists in the Arab World, the Dance around Democracy, Carnegie Endowment for
International Peace, Washington DC, September 2004, p.6.
When expedient,
global powers
intervened in the
affairs of Arab states,
even if at times this
involved crushing
freedom movements.
67 FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES AT THE BEGINNING OF THE THIRD MILLENNIUM: SOME PROBLEMATIC ISSUES
THE CRISIS OF DEMOCRACY
AFTER SEPTEMBER 11
The events of September 11 have added an-
other dimension to this tension between the
interests of global powers and freedom in
Arab countries. Western countries, especially
the US, were considered by many democratic
movements in the world to be premier exam-
ples of mature, free democracies. Relations with
democratic Western societies stirred moves
towards democratic change in many countries
struggling for freedom. However, this stimulus
began to wane after the events following 9/11
when the US administration moved to curtail
civil and political rights, especially those of
Arabs and Muslims, in the fight against “ter-
rorism” as the former defined it.
According to some US citizens’ groups
and lawyers’ associations, probably the most
significant sign of the erosion of civil and po-
litical rights in the US is the Patriot Act issued
in the wake of those events. To put this Act in
a historical context, we refer again to The Bill
of Rights, which restricts the authority of the
federal government in matters of surveillance
and the pre-emptive arrests of citizens. Under
the provisions of the Patriot Act, the govern-
ment obtained broader powers for tapping
telephone conversations, screening private
electronic mail and searching databases. Many
immigrant rights, including those of legal im-
migrants, have been curbed. One example is
the subjection of immigrants to “preventive
administrative detention”, on the order of the
Attorney General, even when no charges have
been proffered and the individual cannot be
legally deported.
1
Many of these new laws are the subject of
vigorous internal debate and are being chal-
lenged in the courts. Nevertheless, the fact that
some Western countries which Arab reformers
had long held up as models have taken steps
widely perceived to be discriminatory and re-
pressive, especially with regard to foreigners,
has weakened the position of those reformers
calling for Arab governments undertaking
similar actions to change their course.
FREEDOM BEREFT OF
ORGANIZED SUPPORT
In Arab political life, the cause of freedom fal-
tered in the absence of effective, broad-based
political movements capable of rallying people
to the struggle and building systems of good
governance. In most Arab countries, freedom
thus remained a disembodied ideal.
Popular political forces, such as the Arab
nationalist and, later on, the Islamist move-
ments, did not make comprehensive freedom
their priority. When they did turn to the ques-
tion, their more limited goal, understandably,
was national freedom, which they made their
public rallying point in the struggle against
colonial powers.
Meanwhile, advocates of larger theories
of freedom refrained from practical political
organization and consequently the struggle
for freedom remained on paper, in books that
were seldom read.
1
It is significant to note here that hundreds of town councils in the US adopted resolutions opposing this law.
Relations with
democratic Western
states stirred moves
towards democratic
change in many
countries struggling
for freedom.
BOX 2-2
Abdallah al-Arawy: Freedom and Liberalism in the Arab Context
Whenever we speak of freedom, we have
to take a stand vis-à-vis the intellectual
system, which includes the word freedom
in its very title, i.e. liberalism.
Liberalism considers freedom the
principle and the ultimate, the source
and the goal, the origin and the result in
the life of the human being. Liberalism
is the only intellectual system that aspires
to nothing but to describe, explain and
comment on aspects of free human
activity.
Consequently, it is natural for mod-
ern Arab thinkers to have acquired the
concept of freedom through their knowl-
edge of liberalism. Yet the difficulty
facing the political historian and analyst
is that of determining the characteristics
of liberal thought or, more precisely,
diagnosing the components that were
previously incomplete, and which later
merged with other ideas that led to the
loss of its specificity.
I reject the notion that Western lib-
eralism automatically engendered Arab
liberalism, and that the call for freedom
in the Arab Islamic world is an exact rep-
lica of the European call for freedom, that
the very word freedom is the translation
of a foreign word. I say that the call for
freedom is born, first and foremost, from
a need within Arab society, a need felt
by a number of people. The fact that the
expression of this need benefited from
similar foreign experiences, that Arab
authors rushed to embrace the liberal
system because it adequately expressed
what they felt does not mean that it was
foreign influence itself that triggered
the need. The proof lies in the fact that
Arab writers did not faithfully copy the
European liberalism of their time; rather,
they disregarded its awareness of its own
contradictions. What they needed was an
optimistic, firm and self-assured liberal-
ism, so they projected their own wishes
on the pale and pessimistic liberalism of
which they were contemporaries.
Source: Abdullah al-Arawy, in Arabic, 1981, 36, 39, 59.
68 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
“ORIENTAL DESPOTISM” AND
THE ARAB SOCIETAL CONTEXT
Some historians hold that, from the fall of
Baghdad in the mid-13th century to the col-
lapse of the Ottoman State, freedom left the
Arab scene and an intellectual culture of
reason receded before one that emphasized
the metaphysical and the mythical. A state of
intellectual inflexibility ensued, “closing the
door on independent reasoning and (ijtihad)
or interpretive scholarship (ijtihad)”.
In the context of the fraught and ambigu-
ous relationship between “East” and “West,”
presented as a stark split, the first pole was
usually associated with “despotism” as a sup-
posedly inherent characteristic of “the East”
and “Eastern” civilization, while the second
was linked with freedom, purportedly a funda-
mental quality of “Western” civilization.
Thus despotism came to be considered the
principal factor in explaining slow progress or
underdevelopment in “the East.” This expla-
nation was reinforced by the suffering imposed
on the Arab East by despotic rulers and gov-
ernors, by the dominant influence of obsolete
customs and practices on people’s lives, and by
the lack of freedom. At the same time, freedom
was spreading, to varying degrees, among
countries of the West. As a result, we now face
the dichotomies of “despotism/backwardness”
and “freedom/progress”, metonyms for the
“East/West” duality (Mahir Hanandah, in
Arabic, 2002).
The notion that “the East” is innately
severed from freedom (or democracy) gained
new currency with “the clash of civilizations”
(Huntington, 1996), and efforts to play up and
magnify this distinction after the catastrophic
events of September 11 and the “war on terror-
ism.” Many observed that Arab and Muslim
states are not democratic, and one can hardly
take issue with that. But altogether more
questionably, a few claimed that Arabs and
Muslims are not capable of being democrats,
for the very reason of being Arab (“the Arab
mind”) or Muslims.
International studies such as the World
Values Survey (WVS)
2
have exposed the false-
ness of these claims by demonstrating that
there is a rational and understandable thirst
among Arabs to be rid of despots and to enjoy
democratic governance. That survey clearly
showed that Arab attitudes and values strongly
support knowledge and good governance.
Among the nine surveyed regions, which in-
cluded the advanced Western countries, Arab
countries topped the list of those agreeing that
“democracy is better that any other form of
governance”. A substantially high percentage
also rejected authoritarian rule (defined as
a strong ruler who disregards parliament or
elections). These results are quite logical in
comparative terms, since those who bear the
scars of despotism and harsh rule naturally
look forward to freedom and good governance
more than others.
Erroneous and mechanical connections
between Islam and despotism are similar to
those that were sometimes made between
Catholicism and oppression in certain Latin
American countries, in Eastern Europe and in
East Asia some thirty years ago. It is as wrong
to link Islam and oppression now as it was to
bracket Catholicism with oppression then.
DEMOCRACY AND RELIGION
In democratic thinking, institutions must be
able to formulate policies freely and independ-
ently, within the boundaries set by the consti-
tution and human rights. Specifically, there
should be no privileged position for religious
institutions that would permit them to dictate
policy to a democratically elected government.
By the same token, individuals and reli-
gious groups must be guaranteed independ-
ence vis-a-vis both the government and other
religious groups. This independent arena must
protect the right of people and groups not only
to worship as they wish, in private; but also to
promote their values publicly in civil society.
2
An extensive international study, the World Values Survey provides an opportunity to assess the relative preferences of Arab people, in comparison
with people of other regions and cultures, on issues of freedom and governance.
The results presented in this study are based on field surveys in a large number of countries in the world, including five in the Arab region (Jordan,
Algeria, Morocco, Egypt, and Saudi Arabia). The results cover approximately half the population of Arab countries. In addition to the Arab countries,
the surveys provide data concerning eight other country groups: other Islamic countries (non-Arab), sub-Saharan Africa, Eastern Europe, South Asia,
the US and Canada and Australia and New Zealand, Latin America, East Asia, and Western Europe.
Erroneous and
mechanical
connections between
Islam and despotism
are similar to those
that were made
between Catholicism
and oppression
in Latin American
countries, in Eastern
Europe and in East
Asia thirty years ago.
That some Western
countries which Arab
reformers had long
held up as models
have taken steps
widely perceived to
be discriminatory…
has weakened the
position of those
reformers calling for
Arab governments
undertaking similar
actions to change
their course.
69 FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES AT THE BEGINNING OF THE THIRD MILLENNIUM: SOME PROBLEMATIC ISSUES
They must be free to create organizations or
movements within political society for the
same purpose, provided that such activity has
no negative impact on the freedom of other
citizens or democratic rules and principles.
These institutional principles of democ-
racy mean that it is unacceptable to prevent
any societal group, including religious groups,
from forming a political party. However, these
groups should agree and adhere to all the guar-
antees of democratic practice in society (Chap-
ter One) even when faced with the “tyranny of
the majority”, so that democratic principles
remain the standard for correcting departures
from democratic practice. It is only permissible
to impose restrictions on political parties once
their actual conduct has led to acts inimical to
democracy, and where it is the judiciary, and
not the ruling party, that makes the ruling
(Stepan, 2001, 216-217).
Interestingly, in advanced Western
countries that are incontestably democratic,
religion is not distant from political society.
Indeed, some theorists argue that no existing
Western democracy can claim a hard-and-fast
separation between Church and State, having
reached the point where “freedom of faith”
does not end with practicing religious rites in
private life, but extends to the right to organ-
ize in civil and political society. Indeed, some
theorists maintain that neither “secularism”
nor “the separation of ‘Church’ from State”
constitutes an essential property of democracy
(e.g. Stepan, 2001, 223). What is always neces-
sary is to assure the State’s impartiality towards
the beliefs of its citizens.
DEMOCRACY AND ISLAM:
POTENTIAL FOR HARMONY
Our starting point here is that Islam, in the
prevailing Sunni sects, has no “clergy” and no
“church,” and consequently the concept of re-
ligious authority or rule does not arise. Even
in Shi’ism, contemporary ijtihad or interpre-
tive scholarship favours “the authority of the
umma (nation),” rather than “the authority of
the faqih (jurisprudent).” Such is the opinion
of Ayatollah Muhammad Mahdi Shamseddin,
Head of the Shi’ite Supreme Council of
Lebanon, who ruled that “During the period of
occultation, the umma, or nation of Muslims,
reclaims governance authority (wilaya), and
appoints the ruler or rulers by means of choice
and election. Through its will the nation grants
the ruler(s) authority whose duration or sub-
stance is limited” (Muhammad Selim al-Awwa,
in Arabic, 1998, 61-63; Muhammad al-Mahdi
Shamseddin, as quoted in Muhammad Selim
al-Awwa, 1989).
Islam may not set out a detailed and com-
prehensive system for good governance in its
sacred text. Yet that text (“bearer of multiple
perspectives”), its interpretation (which is
multiple), and Islamic history (which reflects
great variety) all embody the core principles
that sustain freedom and good governance
as we understand them. These principles
include obligatory consultation, respect for
freedoms, questioning rulers and holding them
accountable.
3
The dominant trend in Islamic
jurisprudence supports obligatory consultation
and freedom, without prejudice to the rights
of others. Specifically, enlightened Islamic in-
terpretations find that the tools of democracy
- when used properly – offer one possible prac-
tical arrangement for applying the principle of
consultation (al-shura).
These fundamental principles (from which
governance systems and detailed regulations
may be derived) provide for the realization
of justice and equality, the assurance of public
freedoms, the right of the nation to appoint
and dismiss rulers, and guarantees of all public
BOX 2-3
Ibn al-Qayim al-Jawziya: On welfare
This is a difficult subject, so much so
that some have given it up, asserting
that the sacred law is deficient and is
not concerned with human welfare. But
those who hold this to be the case have
excluded themselves and humanity at
large from many right and beneficial
courses of action, which in their opinion
are incompatible with the law. By the life
of the Almighty! Those courses of action
are incompatible, not with the law, but
with those individuals’ understanding
of the law. They have been led astray
by a kind of defect in their knowledge
of truth and their knowledge of reality,
and the error of regarding the one as less
important than the other.
Know that the law is all justice, all
equity and all mercy. Every matter that
deviates from justice toward injustice,
and from equity toward oppression,
and from mercy toward lack of mercy,
is not of the law, though it may have
been incorporated into the law through
interpretation.
Source: Ibn al-Qayim al-Jawziya, Kitab al-turuq wa al-hikma
Islam, in the prevailing
Sunni rite, has no
“clergy” and no
“church”.
3
This does not conflict with the fact that much of the traditional heritage leans towards “establishing the legitimacy of the existing state, even when
it is one of oppression and tyranny” (Kamal Abdel-Latif, in Arabic, 1999, 67).
70 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
and private rights for non-Muslims and Mus-
lims alike, including the right to hold public
office (Muhammad Selim al-Awwa, in Arabic,
1998, 58-59, 72).
Even in the Prophet’s saying (hadith) on
obedience to rulers, the utterance “Obey the
person in charge,” which is often exploited to
support existing rule no matter how oppres-
sive, and to illustrate “the Arab/Muslim men-
tality” on governance, is in fact only one part of
the hadith. The text stipulates obedience only
“in what accords with the truth”
4
and indeed
goes beyond that to fault the bad ruler.
Notwithstanding these key theological
and philosophical nuances, political forces,
both those in power and in opposition, have
selectively appropriated Islam to support and
perpetuate their oppressive rule.
This underlines the importance of estab-
lishing political freedom in the public space
and promoting enlightened explanations of
Islam much more widely, as mutually support-
ive pillars of freedom and good governance in
Arab countries.
BOX 2-4
Imam Muhammad Abdu: The Legitimacy of Elections
“States that have built their power on the
basis of consultation, entrust the nation
to elect trustworthy people who will
establish the public laws of the kingdom
and monitor their implementation by the
government. Such elections cannot be
legitimate unless the nation has the full
freedom to choose, without any pressure
from the government or from others,
with no temptation and no intimida-
tion. Thus, the nation must be aware of
its rights and their purpose. If different
people are elected under the influence of
the government or others, this is legally
null and void and the chosen ones have
not the authority to be in charge and,
consequently, to obey them is not a legal
obligation as ordained in the Qur’an,
but enforced obedience. For example,
if a man were forced to elect a so-called
deputy of the nation to what is known as
the legislative power, he would be like
one who was forced to marry or to buy;
he would be legally entitled to neither
wife nor goods”.
Source: Farid Abdel Khaleq, in Arabic, 1998, 47
4
For example: Hisham ibn Arwa related on the authority of Abu Salih who had it from Abu Hurayra that the Messenger of God, said, “Others will
rule you after me. The pious will rule you piously and the impious impiously. Hearken to them and obey them in all that accords with the Truth. If they
do good, the credit will be yours and theirs, and if they do bad, the credit will be yours and the discredit theirs.” (Ali ibn Muhammad Habib al-Basri
al-Mawardi, in Arabic, 1983, 5).
BOX 2-5
Ayatollah al-Mohaqiq al-Naeeny: An Opinion Concerning Conditionality or Constitutionality
The conduct of the ruler is bounded by the
limitations of his prerogatives … it is condi-
tioned not to exceed them, the people are
his partners in all that concerns the destiny
of the country to which they all belong on an
equal footing Those in charge are but loyal
trust bearers of the people, not owners nor
servants. Like other trust bearers, they are re-
sponsible to each and every individual of the
nation, they are accountable for any trespass
they commit, and every single person has the
right to question and to object in an environ-
ment of security and freedom, without being
bound by the Sultan’s will or preferences.
Power of this kind is known as limited,
bound, just, conditioned, accountable,
constitutional; the reason for so naming it is
obvious, and the person in charge of such
power is called a protector and a guardian, a
dispenser of justice, the responsible, the just.
The nation enjoying such bounty is known as a
nation that is worthy of reward in the hereaf-
ter, a nation proud, free and vital; the reason
for such attributes is also clear!
This type of power is based on responsi-
bility and honesty; that is why, like all other
responsibilities and honest charges it is con-
ditioned by the absence of excess and bound
by the absence of waste. The one element that
preserves this type of power and prevents it
from turning into absolute power and from
excesses is supervision, accountability and
full responsibility.
That is why we of the Imamiyya school
of thought consider virtuousness a condition
of power; it is the highest imaginable degree
of loyalty to one’s charge and a safeguard
against tyranny and subservience to one’s
desires. The most that can be reached as a
natural, human substitute for such a virtuous
custody – even by imposition – is a solution
that is an approximation, a shadow of that
perfect image.
Such a solution depends on two matters:
a constitution that fully contains the above-
mentioned limitations, so as to differentiate
between the functions that the Sultan is com-
mitted to perform, and those wherein he has
no right to intervene or act. The constitution
must also state how such functions are to be
performed, to what degree the Sultan may
rule, the freedom of the nation and the rights
of its different groups and classes in a way
that is concomitant with the rulings of the
doctrine and the requirements of law. In such
a case, to exceed those functions and to put
the trust to waste would be a betrayal – like all
kinds of betrayal of confidence – necessitating
removal from power, officially and forever,
with all the sanctions entailed by betrayal.
Scrutiny and accountability are neces-
sary. These functions are to be entrusted to a
body composed of the wise and learned mem-
bers of the nation, experts in international
rights, well versed in the requirements and
characteristics of the age. They are to moni-
tor and call to account the persons in charge
of the nation so as to ensure that there is no
excess or waste. They are the representatives
and spokespersons of the nation, the embodi-
ment of its learned power. The people’s as-
sembly is but the official council composed of
these persons. Their functions of supervising,
calling to account, maintaining the limitations
of power to prevent it from becoming abso-
lute, can only be performed if all the state
employees – as the country’s executive power
– are under the supervision of that body,
which is in turn responsible to each and every
member of the nation.
Both the Sunni and Ja’afari doctrines
justify the legitimacy of the supervisory
function of the nation’s representatives and
their right to intervene in matters of politics.
According to the former, wherein matters are
entrusted to decision-makers, election of rep-
resentatives achieves the desired purpose and
nothing else is required to confer legitimacy.
According to our own doctrine, we believe
that matters and politics of the nation are the
responsibility of the public representatives,
the desired legitimacy requires only that the
elected body be composed of just people who
strive to interpret or who have been entrusted
to act. To correct expressed opinions and to
approve their implementation is sufficient to
confer legitimacy upon the supervisory func-
tion of the body of representatives.
Source: Al-Mohaqiq al- Naeeny, in Arabic, 1909
71 FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES AT THE BEGINNING OF THE THIRD MILLENNIUM: SOME PROBLEMATIC ISSUES
DEMOCRACY AND THE ARAB
REGION: THE TRAP OF THE ONE-
OFF ELECTION
The “trap of the one-off election” refers to
a ploy used in relation to Islamic societies to
alarm those apprehensive about the accession
to power of fundamentalist Islamic groups. It
has also been cited to justify foreign interfer-
ence to prop up authoritarian Arab regimes. It
is contended that opening up the public sphere
to all societal forces - among the most active of
which is the Islamic movement - will end with
these forces assuming power, followed by op-
pression, such that democratic competition be-
comes history after the one and only election.
Fear of this “trap” is undoubtedly real, and in-
deed finds some justification in contemporary
Arab experience. For this reason, some schools
of thought and some political forces in Arab
countries have opposed the freedom of Islamic
political movements to organize publicly, fear-
ing that, if these forces ever came to power
through elections, that would put an end to
any chances for peaceful political alternation.
In line with the previous discussion on de-
mocracy and religion, we believe that the best
insurance against this risk is to strengthen con-
stitutional principles and clauses to safeguard
society from abuses of majority power, and to
secure at the outset the commitment of all po-
litical movements to respect those measures.
FREEDOM AND HUMAN RIGHTS
Freedom is a human being’s primary right. It
is a right conferred at birth, and because of
this all human beings possess this right on an
equal footing. This primary human right is the
foundation on which human rights as a whole
are built.
The human rights system in its present
form developed through a number of stages
and expanded to ever wider spheres, to the
point where international human rights law
is virtually a reference framework for human
development and a criterion by which to judge
the quality of life in societies.
THE IMPORTANCE OF THE
HUMAN RIGHTS SYSTEM
The human rights system enjoys worldwide re-
spect to an unprecedented degree - a respect
that has grown steadily, especially as the con-
cept of human rights has advanced over the
years to comprise increasingly comprehensive
standards for human well-being.
Strengthening and protecting human rights
has thus become a defining quest of our time.
This quest gains additional legitimacy, and
BOX 2-6
Boasting about human rights while destroying them
In the 1980s, there was an Arab country
that was able to make rapid strides on
the road to democracy. It was striving
to achieve a society without great dispari-
ties, and it did not suffer from any great
class differences. It was characterized
by a civil society that included a strong
human-rights movement, promising
young opposition parties and a bold, re-
sponsible press.
However, developments during the
last decade have brought this country
under scrutiny by Arab and international
human rights movements and it has re-
peatedly been condemned for its use
of torture, unfair trials, persecution of
human rights activists, denial of freedom
of opinion, and fraudulent elections.
The importance of this situation does
not derive from the gravity of the abuses,
for, by comparison with what occurs in
other Arab countries, they are less sig-
nificant numerically and result in essence
from the regime’s successful destruction
of the opposition. What is striking is that
some democrats, following the regime’s
cosmetic adoption of their programmes,
accorded it, at the outset, a degree of le-
gitimacy, acceptance, and collaboration.
This regime however duped civil society,
causing a deep split between those naïve
enough to believe promises whose emp-
tiness became daily more apparent and
those who refused to continue to col-
laborate with the regime that was fast
transforming itself into a police state.
More dangerous still, this regime
started a wide destructive operation
against democracy and human rights
concealed by cosmetics. At time when
torture was common practice, the regime
was posting up the Universal Declaration
in police stations. Even as it moved to
muzzle the press, it claimed that it sup-
ported freedom of opinion. And as it
undercut popular freedoms by interfer-
ing at times in elections, it would speak
fulsomely about the sovereignty of the
people.
Arab and international organizations
have published dozens of reports criticiz-
ing the regime. They emphasize not only
such abuses but also the regime’s facade
of democracy and human rights now
manifest to all.
BOX 2-7
Declaration on the Right to Development Adopted by General
Assembly Resolution 41/128 of 4 December 1986(excerpts)
Recalling the right of peoples to self-de-
termination, by virtue of which they have
the right freely to determine their politi-
cal status and to pursue their economic,
social and cultural development.
Article 1
1. The right to development is an inal-
ienable human right by virtue of which
every human person and all peoples are
entitled to participate in, contribute to,
and enjoy economic, social, cultural
and political development, in which all
human rights and fundamental freedoms
can be fully realized.
2. The human right to development also
implies the full realization of the right
of peoples to self-determination, which
includes, subject to the relevant provi-
sions of both International Covenants
on Human Rights, the exercise of their
inalienable right to full sovereignty over
all their natural wealth and resources.
72 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
is the more urgent, in those developing coun-
tries where human rights are seriously violated
even as the peoples of these societies aspire to
a better and more humane life. Respect for
human rights has now become a key compo-
nent in defining the concept of Arab human
development and freedom.
In contemporary jurisprudence human
rights constitute the collection of rights in-
corporated in international agreements and
treaties that guarantee all people, irrespective
of their nationality, ethnicity, language, sex, re-
ligion, ideology and abilities, the fundamental
rights to which they are entitled by virtue of
being human. The importance of the human
rights system is that it guarantees the individ-
ual a collection of rights that cannot be surren-
dered. Human rights codified in international
covenants and laws transcend national regula-
tion and practices. They constitute supreme
standards of a compelling legal nature against
which other regulations and practices may
be weighed. The contemporary international
legal regulation of human rights originates in
the Universal Declaration of Human Rights
(UDHR) adopted by the UN General Assem-
bly in 1948. However, such rights are the com-
mon inheritance of humanity and can be traced
back to the religious and cultural norms, values
and practices of many societies.
Human rights are generally classified into
two groups, civil and political rights, and
economic and social rights. The first group
includes freedom of opinion and expression,
religious freedom, freedom of assembly and as-
sociation, the right to form political parties, the
right of participation in public decision-mak-
ing and the right to self-determination, among
others. This group also covers legal rights such
as equality before the law, the right to trial and
defence, the right to presumption of innocence
and impartial due process. Civil rights further
uphold the independence of the judiciary and
the right to protection from torture.
Economic and social rights include the
individual’s right to work, education, health
care, adequate housing and to join a trade
union. In addition, a new generation of col-
lective rights has emerged relating to the
right to development and the right to a clean
environment. Moreover, several international
organizations are engaged in promoting the
rights of vulnerable groups such as children,
women and minorities.
The relationship between human rights
and human development was underlined in
the first AHDR (Chapter One). Put simply,
the two reinforce each other and their com-
mon denominator is human freedom. Human
development, by enhancing people’s capabili-
ties, gives them the ability to exercise freedom.
Human rights, by providing the necessary
legal framework, guarantee the opportunity
to exercise that freedom. This instrumental
relationship defines the renaissance movement
advanced through these Reports and under-
standing it is crucial for Arab countries where
first, the human rights situation is deteriorating
and may well grow worse, and second, work to
promote and safeguard human rights is as yet
under-developed.
The latter situation can be attributed to
several factors. First, awareness of human
rights principles is limited; such rights are not
deeply rooted in the Arab cultural environ-
ment. Second, civil society is generally weak;
and third, human rights organizations, such
as the Arab Organization for Human Rights
and the Arab Institute for Human Rights, are
relatively new, with limited popular support
and resources.
INTERNATIONAL HUMAN RIGHTS
LAW
Perhaps no international document enjoys as
much consensus as the Universal Declaration of
Human Rights. The UDHR starts by affirming
that “recognition of the inherent dignity and
of the equal and inalienable rights of all mem-
bers of the human family is the foundation of
freedom, justice and peace in the world”; and,
in adopting the Declaration, the UN General
Assembly proclaimed it “a common standard
of achievement for all peoples and all nations,”
(integral text, Annex 3)
The UDHR came about following the
recognition of four international agreements,
concerning slavery (1926), forced labour
(1930), freedom to join unions and protection
of the right to union organization (1948), and
prohibition of the crime of genocide (1948).
Respect for human
rights has now
become a key
component in defining
the concept of Arab
human development.
Human rights
and human
development…
reinforce each other
and their common
denominator is human
freedom.
73 FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES AT THE BEGINNING OF THE THIRD MILLENNIUM: SOME PROBLEMATIC ISSUES
The Declaration stimulated a growing body of
international standards that seek to strengthen
and protect human rights. From the date of
its adoption through to 1986, more than 60
international human rights standards were
developed, covering the range of declara-
tions, conventions and protocols as well as UN
General Assembly resolutions. Over time, in-
ternational human rights treaties became more
focused and specialized concerning both the
issue addressed and the social group(s) identi-
fied as requiring protection; thus, such docu-
ments were defined more comprehensively and
in greater detail.
But at the core of international accords on
human rights remains what is termed the Inter-
national Bill of Human Rights, (IBHR) consist-
ing of the UDHR, the International Covenant
on Economic, Social, and Cultural Rights
(ICESCR), and the International Covenant on
Civil and Political Rights (ICCPR), concluded
in 1966, as well as the Optional Protocols.
International human rights law, or the
IBHR in its widest sense, embraces not only
BOX 2-8
Muhammad Shahrour: A Word About Freedom
Sometimes words fall short of expressing one’s
intention, of explaining an emotion or a mean-
ing or of defining something that one feels but
cannot describe. Language, as a spoken, heard,
written and read instrument for human com-
munication and for the transfer of knowledge,
more easily describes material objects. No two
persons will disagree in defining dress or table
for example. It is however not as efficient in the
area of abstract things and meanings. The rea-
son, as I see it, is simple. Language is a container
and a container, however large, is limited, while
meaning is absolute and infinite, however nar-
row or small; never will the limited contain the
absolute, nor can the infinite be stuffed into the
finite; the equation is basically impossible! Free-
dom – like a multi-faceted polished diamond
– represents the most outstanding of those dif-
ficult to describe and define abstracts. For the
Greek Aesop, freedom means liberation from
slavery, for Schopenhauer it means liberation
in the Sufi sense – of the fetters of earthly flesh,
only achieved through death, a meaning shared
by the Egyptian poet Salah Jahin who says in one
of his quatrains:
The ducks have lifted to cross deserts and seas
Oh how I wish to go, to roam with birds and
bees
Please God, by all that’s dear, when I die one day
Send me not to heaven, it too has locks and keys!
Therefore, he who says that freedom is de-
velopment is right, he who says that it is some-
thing within a human being that pushes him to
refuse oppression, repression and tyranny is also
right.
Freedom, in my view, is choice and the ca-
pacity to make a choice. A human being’s capac-
ity to choose his actions is what differentiates
him from angels (“they do what they are ordered
to do”), without it, accountability on judgment
day has no meaning. That is why I have reserva-
tions when I hear someone say: “An individual
can only be free in a free society/nation”, be-
cause a free human being makes a free nation,
not the opposite.
Freedom for me is destiny and divine de-
cree; destiny is what the Almighty explained by
saying “We have created all things as they were
destined to be” (Al-Qamar, 49), divine decree
is a human being’s ability to deal voluntarily
with what was decreed, the relation between the
two is knowledge. The greater a human being’s
knowledge with what was decreed, the wider the
margin of his freedom to deal with what is. That
is why I consider the spreading of education and
knowledge as a first priority in preparing a free
individual, for he who knows nothing, chooses
nothing.
There are limits to freedom that regulate
and control it, be it at the level of the individual,
society or the ruling power. If an individual
exceeds the limits of his freedom, he falls into
chaos (the freedom of your finger ends where
the freedom of the other person’s eye begins).
If society exceeds these limits, it becomes oc-
cupied and colonized; if the ruling power does
so, then it is repression and tyranny; even if that
power is a paragon of faith and morality and
came to power by a legitimate and democratic
process, since it controls money, weapons, the
media and the fora of science and learning. The
situation is even worse if the rulers have not
come to power through a democratic process!
Napoleon said: “Injustice is inherent in the soul,
only power brings it to the surface”, and the
Arab poet said:
“Injustice is one of the soul’s realities
If a virtuous man you find
He may be just, but for a cause unknown”.
They both meant absolute freedom that ex-
ceeds its limits, rather than injustice since prac-
ticing freedom requires constant observation
and control at the level of the individual of the
community in general and of the ruler in par-
ticular. The Almighty said: “Let there be from
among you a nation that calls for good, enjoining
what is good and forbidding wrong” (AI-Imran,
104), and went so far as to consider the latter
as coming before faith in God by saying: “You
were the best nation given unto people, enjoin-
ing what is right, forbidding wrong and having
faith in God”. (Al-Imran, 110).
In the light of knowledge prevailing today,
little reflection is required to see that the
Qur’anic verse refers to supervisory groups over
which the State has no power. These are groups
that enjoy freedom of expression and opinion
within a framework of free information, freely
supervising and regulating freedoms in society
in general and, in particular, those of the ruling
power, at the level of thought as well as at the
political and economic levels.
But still we see some Muslim Arabs who
understand freedom as being solely the opposite
of slavery. We sometimes see Arab and Islamic
thought governed by the principle that “a Sultan
feared by his subjects is better than a Sultan who
fears his subjects”, and by the principle that “an
informative consultative opinion is not one that
is binding”. We see that ordaining what is good
and prohibiting what is evil can lead to an insti-
tution ruled by the State, one whose sole task
is to consecrate what was and what is (the sta-
tus quo), one that sees in “tomorrow” an image
of “yesterday” and to whom ordaining what is
good means no more than herding people to
prayers with a stick. And we see educational
curricula established on the basis of dictating
knowledge, thus killing creativity and producing
people who are educated but who have no opin-
ion of their own, who will obey the ruler were
he to beat them or take away their money. Yet
even when all of this prevails, you will still find
freedom firmly rooted in the collective psyche
of the Arabs and Muslims. I say: Give me one
single individual who understands freedom and
believes in it, I shall then give you a community
where there is no place for a tyrannical ruler.
At the core of
international
accords on human
rights remains the
International Bill on
Human Rights.
74 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
all the above core instruments but also treaties,
conventions, declarations, codes and princi-
ples, which deepen and elaborate the elements
of the IBHR. Among the notable additional
constituents of international human rights law
are the following instruments: The Convention
against Torture and Other Cruel, Inhuman or
Degrading Treatment or Punishment (CAT),
The Convention on the Elimination of All
Forms of Racial Discrimination (CERD), The
Convention on The Elimination of All Forms
Of Discrimination against Women (CEDAW),
The Convention on the Rights of the Child
(CRC), and the International Convention on
the Protection of the Rights of All Migrant
Workers and Members of Their Families.
THE APPLICABILITY OF
INTERNATIONAL HUMAN RIGHTS
LAW TO ARAB COUNTRIES
In many developing countries, the question of
whether a global or a local approach to vari-
ous aspects of life is more appropriate is often
a controversial issue. Human rights are no ex-
ception. In general, we incline towards the local
or the particular, a context that is conducive to
supporting and encouraging an Arab identity,
but with the caveat that we should not isolate
ourselves or ignore the global environment of
which we are a part. In other words, we sup-
port taking the local or particular approach in
the context of a creative interaction with the
achievements of human civilization, within the
framework of a project to stimulate an Arab
renaissance. Yet the encounter between the
global and the particular is especially sensitive
when it comes to human rights.
It is regrettable that in Arab countries
‘specificity’ is frequently raised with the aim
of weakening international human rights law.
Nevertheless we remain hopeful that consid-
erations of Arab specificity will combine with
universal human rights to enrich international
human rights law from an Arab perspective,
rather than to detract from it.
Human rights constitute a universal or
global issue par excellence. After all, specific
rights are assigned to a person purely because
s/he is a human being, without regard to any
special characteristics, because equality is the
basic principle that organizes the concept of
human rights. Some however maintain that ap-
plying existing universal definitions of human
rights principles as embodied in international
human rights law is unacceptable since these
definitions were not shaped as a result of ef-
fective participation of all countries as equal
partners in the endeavour. Rather, Western
industrial countries held the upper hand in
their development.
The UDHR was formulated immediately
after the end of the Second World War under
the aegis of the UN, which was dominated by
the five permanent members of the Security
Council. Up to the time when the two fun-
BOX 2-9
The Pact of the Virtuous (Hilf al-fudul)
The first public treaty on human rights,
the Pact of the Virtuous
5
was concluded
by Arab tribes sometime around 590
AD. The purpose was to defend any in-
dividual who had suffered injustice at the
hands of another, regardless of the origin
or position of either individual, until the
wrongdoing was stopped and the wrong
redressed. The Pact had been preceded
by numerous treaties among the Arab
tribes, especially those of Mecca, which
had set up mutual assistance schemes to
help the needy.
This Pact was ratified twenty years
before God made Muhammad His Mes-
senger. The Messenger of God witnessed
its ratification, and later said of it: “I
witnessed in the house of ‘Abdallah ibn
Jad’an the making of a pact dearer to me
than the most abundant material bless-
ings. If someone were to invoke it under
Islam, I would respond, [honouring it].”
The content of this pact, as transmitted
by ‘Ibn Hisham’ from ‘Ibn Ishaq’, was as
follows: “They agreed on and concluded
this pact that said that any individual in
Mecca, whether a native of Mecca or
someone from elsewhere, would receive
their support; they would stand with
him until the one who had wronged
him gave him redress for the injustice.”
They named it the Pact of the Virtuous
“because they made a pact that rights be
honoured, and in order that a wrongdoer
not assail or be victorious over one who
had been wronged.” It is said also that
it resembled a pact that was ratified by
“Jurhum” in earlier times in which three
of its men made an accord: ‘al-Fadl ibn
Fadala’, ‘al-Fadl ibn Wadi’, and ‘al-Fadil
ibn al-Harith’, and it became known as
the Pact of the Fadls
6

Source: Ahmed Sidqi al-Dajani, in Arabic, 1988, 19-20.
BOX 2-10
Human rights: universality and specificity
The General Assembly session on the
Millennium, resulting from the World
Conference on Human Rights held in
Vienna on 25 June 1993, agreed that:
All human rights are universal,
indivisible and interdependent and in-
terrelated. The international community
must treat human rights globally in a fair
and equal manner, on the same footing,
and with the same emphasis. While the
significance of national and regional
particularities and various historical,
cultural and religious backgrounds must
be borne in mind, it is the duty of states,
regardless of their political, economic
and cultural systems, to promote and
protect all human rights and fundamen-
tal freedoms.
Source: Office of the United Nations High Commissioner for Human Rights, in Arabic, 2002, 61
5
This has also been translated as “the Alliance of Excellence.”
6
fadl, pl. fudul: virtue, favour, kindness, excellence, superiority.
The encounter
between the global
and the particular is
especially sensitive
when it comes to
human rights.
75 FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES AT THE BEGINNING OF THE THIRD MILLENNIUM: SOME PROBLEMATIC ISSUES
damental international instruments of 1966
were in final form, only a small number of
developing countries were members of the UN
— and their influence was extremely limited.
Some objectors observe that the representa-
tion of developing countries in the UN came
about, in any case, through national élites who
were not the most reliable representatives of
their people. Thus, the argument goes, the
circumstances surrounding the formation of
human rights principles ensured that these
instruments reflected Western values, values
that were hegemonic with respect to the inter-
national order especially at the time when the
UDHR was formulated. In this view, the In-
ternational Bill of Human Rights contained the
seeds of contradiction between certain cultural
values prevailing in different regions of the
world, and the particularities of these regions
and the aspirations of their peoples.
Yet this point of view underestimates the
extent of the Arab contribution, whether on
the part of the Arab states that actively and
effectively participated in debates on the sub-
stantive elements of human rights standards,
or in the persons of distinguished Arab experts
who helped shape international human rights
law.
In any case, the Arab world remains in
need of an Arab Bill of Human Rights that
is acceptable to all in the region and that can
draw on the values of the Arab-Islamic culture.
This effort to assimilate both dimensions is all
the more urgent in light of the cultural par-
ticularities of Arab societies and because of
the complex and problematic nature of human
rights in this part of the world.
Some think that it is crucial to acknowl-
edge a disparity between human rights princi-
ples, according to international human rights
law, and traditional interpretations of Islamic
law (Shari’a) in some areas, such as capital
punishment, total equality between men and
women, and the treatment of religious minori-
ties. International law considers the right to
life the premier civil right; hence the global
human rights movement seeks abolition of the
death penalty, and pending abolition, seeks
to set in place stringent limits. Likewise, the
principle of complete gender equality means
that international human rights law prohibits
discrimination against women (for example, on
inheritance) and minorities (for instance, ac-
ceding to the position of Head of State). Some
argue that international human rights law and
Islam can be harmonized only by applying the
logic of ijtihad (interpretive reasoning) starting
from the principle of the welfare of the Muslim
nation, even if this transcends the current logic
of jurisprudence (fiqh). In fact some such in-
terpretations have already established congru-
ence between international human rights law
and Islamic law.
It may be appropriate to work towards
a concept of human rights in the Arab con-
text, that respects international human rights
law in its entirety, while recognizing the Arab
national identity and its aspirations as an his-
torical legacy of critical importance in defining
Arab reality, and in shaping the Arab future.
BOX 2-11
The Contribution of Arab States to the Universal Declaration of
Human Rights and the Two International Covenants
Omar Lutfi, Mahmoud ‘Azmi (both
Egyptian) and Charles Malik (Lebanese)
were all involved in the different stages in
the preparation of the Universal Declara-
tion of Human Rights.
Omar Lutfi was responsible (despite
opposition by some powerful states)
for the inclusion of what Susan Waltz
considers to be the strongest statement
on universality, contained in article 2,
paragraph 2:
“No distinction shall be made on
the basis of the political, jurisdictional or
international status of the country or ter-
ritory to which a person belongs, whether
it be independent, trust, non-self-gov-
erning or under any other limitation of
sovereignty.”
Throughout the 20-year process of
developing the Universal Declaration of
Human Rights and the two Covenants,
at no stage did any Arab state withdraw
from the debate.
The two Covenants were adopted
at the General Assembly by unanimous
vote. Arab states participating at the time
were: Algeria, Iraq, Jordan, Libya, Mau-
ritania, Morocco, Saudi Arabia, Somalia,
Syria, Tunisia, the United Arab Republic
(Egypt) and Yemen.
In the development of the two Cov-
enants Badia Afnan, representing Iraq,
was insistent that gender equality should
be explicitly guaranteed in both Cov-
enants at a time when such a provision
was not favoured by several Western and
other states. In the first drafts of the Cov-
enants gender equality was absent. Afnan
objected and fought for the inclusion
of the present article 3 (ICCPR): “The
States Parties to the present Covenant
undertake to ensure the equal rights of
men and women to the enjoyment of all
civil and political rights set forth in the
present Covenant.”
Arab states, notably Syria and Saudi
Arabia led the movement to include the
right to self-determination in the legally
binding Covenants.
In the long-standing debates on the
development of the two Covenants both
Egypt and Syria are on record as support-
ing effective measures of implementa-
tion. Syria proposed a UN investigation
mechanism, and Egypt supported the
rights of individuals, groups and non-
governmental organizations to refer com-
plaints of human rights violations directly
to the UN. In 1950, for example, the
Egyptian representative stated that the
delegation of Egypt was “ready to accept
the establishment of a permanent human
rights committee, a court to sanction the
committee’s findings, or any other provi-
sion that might seem necessary”.
Source: Susan Waltz, 2004
The Arab world
remains in need of an
Arab Bill of Human
Rights.
76 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Foremost among the rights of the Arab
people is the legitimate desire to achieve
such goals as national liberation and self-de-
termination, unity, human development, and
national security. These are intersecting goals
that a project for an Arab renaissance must
regard as necessarily integrated within a firmly
conceived structure. The goals of national lib-
eration and self-determination lead directly to
that of liberating Arab territory--and liberating
the agency of the Arab people. Specifically
this means obtaining the guaranteed right of
the people to determine what political forms
and entities will constitute the Arab region; to
conceive and achieve a desired cultural, social,
political and economic blueprint for the home-
land; and to formulate the means by which this
can be achieved. This goal includes the specific
guarantee of effective popular participation in
determining people’s futures, with the caveat
that addressing these demands should not in
any way conflict with the global human rights
system.
There was an important initiative to adapt
international human rights law in order to ar-
rive at an Arab Human Rights Charter. The
document in question is the Draft Charter for
Human Rights in the Arab Homeland, the
outcome of a conference of Arab experts held
at the International Institute of Higher Studies
in Criminal Sciences in Siracusa, Italy, in 1986
(Mahmud Cherif Bassiouni et. al., in Arabic,
1989).
This draft was based on the idea of Arab
specificity, represented as an ideological foun-
dation governed by the general framework of
the Shari’a, but within the framework of the
global human rights movement. Its origina-
tors took as their mandate the formulation of
a Charter that would represent the situation of
the Arab people in today’s global context. This
is apparent in the nomenclature adopted. The
draft organizes rights on the basis of a perspec-
tive that sees people as individuals first, mem-
bers of society second, then thirdly as members
of a political entity, and finally as Arabs be-
longing to the larger homeland (watan). Thus,
the draft provides for civil rights, followed by
social, political, and cultural rights, and then
political rights, concluding with the collective
rights of the Arab people. Beyond this, the
draft made considerable advances with respect
to human rights on the global level in that it
included elements of a “third generation” of
human rights, such as the right to a just distri-
bution of income.
The rights included in that draft framework
form an integrated platform of interlocking
and coherent elements. They also constitute
an Arab concept of development, as their ele-
ments provide criteria for judging the progress
of human development in Arab countries, over
time and across geographical space. Elements
of this concept can be divided into two parts:
the first global and the second devoted to the
specific characteristics of the Arab region
(Nader Fergany, in Arabic, 1992, 55-58).
A similar approach is to be found in the
report of a group of Arab experts mandated to
review an updated draft of the Arab Charter
for Human Rights, (Annex 2) under the aus-
pices of the Arab League.
While the updated draft of the Charter
corrects many of the defects contained in the
BOX 2-12
Haytham Manna’a: The Books of Tribulations
The books of tribulations and ordeals
were the first expression of the suffering
entailed by affiliation to a religion, doc-
trine or political opposition party. They
followed a methodology born of the era
to which they belonged, which differs
from contemporary approaches. Some-
times their topic was general, so that the
book included political assassination,
pursuit, arrest, abduction, murder and
physical or psychological injury. Other
books would deal solely with those who
were killed and not touch on imprison-
ment or injury.
There were also books that dealt
exclusively with certain families, such
as “The Victims of Murder Among the
Talibites” by Abul Farag al-Asfahany,
which he devoted to the descendants of
Ali Ibn Abi Talib who were murdered.
Other works dealt with famous person-
alities and descendants of the Prophet
(or nobles), while some researchers con-
centrated on poets, prophets or doctors.
Some devoted a whole book to one single
case, such as Imam Ali Ibn Abi Talib and
his son, Hussein, or Ahmed Ibn Hanbal
(for example, we have found six books
on the ordeal of Ibn Hanbal).
The book on tribulation by Abul
Arab Mohammad Ibn Ahmad Ibn
Tamim Al Tamimi, verified by Dr. Yehia
Wahib al Jabbouri in 1983, is the best
illustration of this important phenom-
enon, wherein he identified 48 books
on tribulations and ordeals. He goes to
considerable lengths to introduce the
book, and explain its style and purpose.
What is important in his writing this
comprehensive book of almost 500 pages
is that Abul Arab himself experienced
imprisonment, fear and threats. Here he
explains his purpose in writing the book:
“I speak hereafter of those who suffered
from among the best of the nation, men
of learning and noble men, those who
were imprisoned, beaten, threatened
or were tried in other ways. It is meant
as a consolation for those who have un-
dergone the same ordeals as the virtuous
men of the early days of this nation.” This
explanation is to be found in most books
on tribulations that suggest, in more
ways than one, that the best of the best
are those who suffer the most. For their
authors, such books go beyond merely
relating history or giving information,
they serve to sow the seeds of a culture of
resistance and opposition to injustice and
arbitrary treatment.
The goals of national
liberation and self-
determination lead
directly to that of
liberating Arab
territory.
77 FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES AT THE BEGINNING OF THE THIRD MILLENNIUM: SOME PROBLEMATIC ISSUES
previous version, it still falls short of providing
for the comprehensive protections contained in
international human rights law, particularly of
freedom of expression, belief and association.
It also omits specific texts on the elimination
of all forms of discrimination against women
and the rights of the child. The revised Charter
further contains provisions to be defined by
the law, which could allow laws to be used to
curtail freedoms in Arab countries.
THE CHALLENGE OF PEACEFUL
TRANSITION TO A SOCIETY
OF FREEDOM AND GOOD
GOVERNANCE IN THE ARAB
COUNTRIES
Chapter One describes free societies, in their
normative dimension, as fundamental con-
trasts with present-day Arab countries. The
enormous gap that separates today’s reality
and what many in the region hope for, is a
source of widespread frustration and despair
among Arabs about their countries’ prospects
for a peaceful transition to societies enjoying
freedom and good governance. Moreover,
persisting tendencies in Arab social structures
could well lead to spiralling social, economic,
and political crises. Each further stage of crisis
would impose itself as a new reality, producing
injustices eventually beyond control.
Moreover, the Arab societal environment
persistently reinforces individual inertia and
resistance to change insofar as progress toward
freedom and good governance would inevita-
bly harm the interests of the minority that at
present influences the shape of things to come
in Arab countries.
Another concern relates to the many vic-
tims of injustice who are denied peaceful and
effective political means to seek redress. This
denial could become an invitation to resort to
social conflict and perhaps violence. When the
prospects of effective political action in Arab
countries are foreclosed, this is effective warn-
ing of a period of social strife that could well
prove destructive. While some believe that vio-
lence may be historically necessary to change a
reality that has long suppressed the capabilities
of these countries, freedom could well be its
first victim. This is a fate that all of those who
care about the future of the Arab region must
strive to avert.
If the Arab people are to have true socie-
ties of freedom and good governance, they will
need to be socially innovative. Their challenge
is to create a viable mode of transition from
a situation where liberty is curtailed and op-
pression the rule to one of freedom and good
governance that minimises social upheaval and
human costs, to the fullest extent possible,.
History will judge this a transcendent achieve-
ment through which the region finally attained
its well-deserved freedom.
This challenge concerns, first and fore-
most, the intellectual and political vanguards
of the region, those who have until now seem-
ingly neglected to take up their societal role
as the conscience and leaders of the nation,
hesitating to play their inescapable part in
steering their people towards human progress.
Facing this challenge squarely requires a new
kind of thought and a new discourse consistent
with that thought. For, to cast off oppression
requires a new language far removed from the
vocabulary of oppression and the moulds into
which it forces reality. It also demands innova-
tive societal action.
The foregoing discussion indicates the
falsity of claims that Arab culture and freedom
are incompatible. Impediments to freedom
do exist in the Arab reality and in the global
and regional coutext, but these are not insur-
mountable.
We hope that the coming pages offer new
beginnings for moving purposefully and peace-
fully in these directions.
BOX 2-13
Freedom and Emancipation
“To be free is nothing, to become free is heaven itself”.
Fichte
Persisting tendencies
in Arab social
structures could well
lead to spiralling
social, economic and
political crises.
This challenge
concerns, first
and foremost, the
intellectual and
political vanguards of
the region.
BOX 2-14
Timing the call for freedom
“It seems that the poems and the songs of protest and liberation are always too late or
too early: memory or dream. Their time is not the present; they preserve their truth in
their hope, in their refusal of the actual”.
Herbert Marcuse (1969)
79
Part II
Part II: Reinforcing Freedom and
Establishing Good Governance
Section 2: The State of Freedom and
Governance in Arab Countries
This section presents a brief assessment of the state of freedom and
governance in the Arab countries at the beginning of the third millen-
nium.
CHAPTER THREE
The State of Freedoms and
Rights
THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS 81
Introduction
This chapter attempts a response to the ques-
tion posed in Chapter One about how far the
current Arab situation corresponds to the
ideal of freedom and good governance. It
provides a summary account of the violations
of civil and political rights and freedoms in
Arab countries at the beginning of the 21st
century. The chapter next diagnoses the fail-
ure to realize social and economic rights in a
human development perspective, in terms of
the acquisition and employment of human
capabilities. It concludes with the findings of
the Freedom survey, which was an integral
input in preparing this Report. The survey
samples public opinion in five Arab coun-
tries on the components of people’s concept
of freedom and on how far those components
of freedom were enjoyed by the public at the
time of the survey. It also asked respondents
to assess changes in the level of such enjoy-
ment over the previous five years.
FREEDOMS AND HUMAN RIGHTS
While it is customary to classify human rights,
including freedom, according to the categories
set out in Chapter 1, they are complementary,
interrelated, unlimited and mutually reinforc-
ing, forming an indivisible whole.
When discussing freedom and human
rights, or the self and society, the most widely
used classification is that between individual
and collective freedoms, i.e. private and public
freedoms. Individual freedoms exercised in
the private sphere include freedom of thought
and belief among others. Individual and col-
lective freedoms exercised in the public sphere
include freedom of opinion and expression,
freedom of peaceful assembly, freedom to
form associations and parties, and freedom to
participate in the range of activities that make
up the public sphere. Freedom is limited only
in the framework of public order, which all
citizens participate in shaping. Yet this classifi-
cation is open to the criticism that it subdivides
freedom, whereas it is of the nature of freedom
that it cannot be divided. To restrict any part
of it would be to negate its dynamic essence
and its potential for development. Similarly,
where even basic rights are not assured, such as
the right to life and personal security, freedom
is bound to remain theoretical.
Yet however we classify rights and
freedoms, the level to which they are actually
enjoyed in Arab countries remains poor, with
some variations, as a result of complex defects,
discussed briefly below.
BOX 3-1
Ali Ibn Al Hussein: The Epistle on Rights
Imam Ali Ibn Al Hussein, who died in
the year 95 of the Hijra, wrote this let-
ter in the early 8th century A.D., the last
third of the first century of the Hijra. To
our knowledge, it is the first epistle that
sets out the main rights as perceived by
the age and the first attempt that does
not approach the concept of rights in its
negative dimension. For the concept of
a ‘right’, as we know, came into human
cultures to confine entitlements to one
race, or one group, or a circle of close
family, or members of a given faith or
a given nation. In this sense, it led to
discrimination, for example, between
men and women, kin and strangers,
citizens and aliens, believers and athe-
ists, etc. The prevailing view was that the
positive concept of rights appeared with
the European Age of Enlightenment and
the rise of the concept of natural rights
which gave back to all human beings
incontrovertible rights which they are
meant to enjoy as a gift of God or of Na-
ture. Modern international studies how-
ever, indicate that the concept preceded
European civilization and took several
forms, some resulting from a direct
conflict between presumptive knowledge
and religious knowledge, others from at-
tempts to reconcile the two.
The epistle goes on to list these
rights (50 of them) methodically. They
are, in spirit, anchored to the early Is-
lamic precepts.
Source: Haytham Manna’a, based on Abu Muhammad al Hassan Ibn Ali Ibn al Hussein Ibn Shuba al-Harrani (al-
Halabi), in Arabic, 4th century A.H., 184).
Where basic rights are
not assured, such as
the right to life and
personal security,
freedom is bound to
remain theoretical.
82 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
STRUCTURAL CONSTRAINTS ON
FREEDOM
Flawed structure of Arab nation-states
Arab nation-states, particularly those of the
Mashriq, took shape, in most cases, under the
pressure of historical events on which the will
of Arabs themselves had very little effect. The
people were not the source of sovereignty. As
the Ottoman Empire began to collapse, for-
eign economic interests were able, under the
Sykes-Picot Agreement, to divide up the Arab
region into states without taking the interests
of the peoples of that region into account, and
regardless of their relationship to the land in
which they lived. This created pockets of ten-
sion within the borders of most Arab coun-
tries, especially in the Mashriq. Nor was the
will of the people heeded in the establishment
of political systems. The social contract was ar-
bitrary and devoid of legitimacy. In Arab coun-
tries, the notion of a “contract” in the political
sphere is not commonly found. The majority of
the Arab people are persuaded that the politi-
cal authority in place is their fate, is inevitable
and that there is nothing to be done to restrain
or change it. The modern Arab states as such
suffer as a result of the way in which they came
about. They did not emerge from the collective
agency of the people, unlike nation-states in
the West, which developed their own political
and constitutional way of life.
The Arab-Islamic heritage is one that
values consultation and justice, but to under-
stand the nature of Arab political power, it
is important to make a distinction between
religion and faith on the one side, and his-
tory on the other. While religion undoubtedly
prized these values, history shows that they
were not sufficiently prevalent in society to
foster a culture based on a political contract,
and allow for the legitimacy of differences of
opinion, dialogue and the transfer of power. It
is significant that most Arab constitutions did
not come about as a result of the kind of par-
ticipatory process normally due. Most emerged
either as a consequence of the individual rul-
er’s wishes, inscribed in a document bestowed
on the people, or through a popular “yes-no”
referendum (despite the obvious reservations
as to the credibility of the results) drafted in
such a way as to preclude any discussion. In
any event, Arab states were often strangers
to their environment from birth and, with
a few exceptions, promulgated constitutions
without extensive participation of the people
concerned, even though most constitutions
declare that the sovereignty of the state rests
with the people or the nation.
As a consequence of the weak notion of po-
litical contract in Arab societies, the principle
of constitutional legitimacy is similarly fragile,
especially in all that relates to the requirement
that laws, institutions and people must respect
the constitution as a binding document, as well
as the provisions it contains. Worse, citizen
participation in government is weak. Feeble
electoral mechanisms, and marginalized leg-
islative assemblies, which tend to be tools
of the executive power, as epitomised in the
person of the Head of State, account for this
low participation. Consequently, since the law
does not represent the sovereignty and power
of the community, it is ineffectual as an author-
ity for structuring relations among people
and between them and state power, and has
not served as a tool for maintaining freedom.
Moreover, state power, especially where it
is corrupt, can manipulate the law to suit its
interests, and through the means of coercion
at its disposal, can efficiently create a situation
in which it cannot be challenged or held to ac-
count. As a result, the state based on the rule
of law, which guarantees human rights and
freedom, has not come into being.
Political constraints on the authority of the
human rights system
Acceptance of the legally valid nature of
human rights, and enactment of human rights
principles in the context of the nation-state by
the nation-state, together determine whether
a State can be said to show a minimum of
respect for human freedom and human rights.
Civil and political rights are the cornerstones
of a system in which democracy and social jus-
tice, i.e. good governance in both its political
and social aspects can be realized.
However, a number of serious obstacles
prevent the Arab individual from benefiting
Citizen participation in
government is weak.
The state based on the
rule of law… has not
come into being.
83 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
from this human rights system. In the first
place, the system presupposes that states enjoy
sovereignty, and this is not the case with all
Arab states, as some remain subject to foreign
occupation. In states that do enjoy sovereignty,
even if defective, the human rights system is
confronted by undemocratic regimes, which
block the adoption of human rights in order
to preserve the privileges which they enjoy at
the expense of their own peoples. Moreover,
the system has had difficulty in accommodat-
ing an Arab cultural attribute of stasis under
repressive political regimes, social forces that
fear freedom, and entrenched traditions that
preserve the tribal–based status quo and deny
creativity.
Opportunities for the human rights system
to achieve its noble goals are also not enhanced
by the current state of global governance. The
international order that allows a few countries
to override the will of a majority of other na-
tions and gives them the power to negate just
resolutions that run counter to their interests,
seriously undermines many of the principles on
which international law is based.
All this has weakened the hope that peo-
ple will be able to enjoy freedom, justice and
peace. Nonetheless, the human rights system
remains a starting-point and an authority. De-
spite the climate that limits its effectiveness, it
nevertheless represents a gleam of hope.
The crisis of citizenship
What is the actual situation with respect to
the civil and political freedoms of the ordinary
Arab individual, caught between official dec-
larations of principle that recognize some of
them and practical restrictions on the exercise
of most of them? Why does the ordinary good
citizen not show more initiative?
Even disregarding the factor of foreign
intervention, freedoms in Arab countries are
threatened by two kinds of power: that of
undemocratic regimes oblivious to the welfare
of their peoples, and that of tradition and trib-
alism, sometimes under the cover of religion.
These twin forces have combined to curtail
freedoms and fundamental rights and have
weakened the good citizen’s strength and abil-
ity to advance. Freedom in the public sphere
is, in the main, a prerogative of power, and
the model citizen, in the view of the regime,
is an unquestioning creature, not participating
in political life and, in particular, not asking
questions or holding his rulers accountable.
Meanwhile, power in the domestic and private
sphere is mostly a prerogative of the man, given
the prevalence of paternalism, especially in the
family, and the corresponding duty of obedi-
ence is incumbent upon women and children.
This produces, as a result, the model citizen as
the regime wants her or him to be.
In between these two spheres stand civil
society institutions, which originate in the de-
sire of citizens to express their views and their
interests and activities freely. These institutions
are the key to a free civil society that includes
all citizens. A citizen is good insofar as (s)he
participates in all situations, and insofar as
(s)he asks questions and holds rulers account-
able. Yet civil society institutions themselves
are in conflict with the culture of violence and
oppression that the regime exploits to crush
every dynamic initiative, targeting in particular
free individuals who are active in the human
rights field.
Such challenges will be hard to overcome,
partly because of the inhibiting effect of in-
ternalized constraints and partly because of
national constraints that paralyse institutions
or divert them from their proper ends, owing
to the absence of an overarching regional
structure. These constraints are exacerbated
because of foreign occupation.
NATIONAL FREEDOM
The foreign occupation of Arab countries
brings the pursuit of freedom back to the ques-
tion of liberation from foreign domination, an
issue that the world left behind decades ago
with the end of colonialism. Today, that issue
is almost entirely restricted to the Arab region
to the exclusion of others.
Arab countries under foreign occupation
endure serious violations of human rights: The
Palestinian people are suffering under an Israeli
occupation that seeks to displace them and
deny their legitimate, inalienable rights that are
recognized in international law, including reso-
lutions on the right of return for refugees, and
Freedoms in Arab
countries are
threatened by two
kinds of power: that
of undemocratic
regimes…and that
of tradition and
tribalism.
The foreign
occupation of Arab
countries brings the
pursuit of freedom
back to the question
of liberation from
foreign domination.
84 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
the right to freely establish their own political
system. The occupation also systematically vio-
lates all civil and political freedoms and denies
Palestinians the protection to which they are
entitled under the Geneva Convention’s provi-
sions for the Protection of Civilian Persons in
Time of War.
Meanwhile the US-led occupation of Iraq
has created a tragic situation in Iraq, Part I.
CIVIL AND POLITICAL FREEDOMS
IN ARAB STATES
The official positions of Arab states on civil
and political freedoms vary depending on the
democratic margins permitted. However, with
some limited exceptions in some countries or
some areas, the state of those freedoms ranges
from deficient to seriously deficient.
Freedom of opinion, expression and
creativity
An authoritarian regime fears, above all, that
freedom of opinion and freedom of expression
may give rise to alternative viewpoints or op-
position. Accordingly, the regime frequently
tightens its grip on publication and the media,
and those working in these fields; it imposes
censorship, and redoubles measures for in-
timidation. But the more ruthless censorship
becomes, the more the people resist, especially
journalists, media institutions and intellectu-
als, who stubbornly continue to exercise and
defend their rights.
During the three-year period 2001-2003,
journalists in Algeria, Egypt, Jordan, Morocco,
the Sudan, Syria, Tunisia, Yemen and other
Arab countries were repeatedly targeted for
prosecution on the grounds of opinions they
had expressed. Some of them were convicted
and given harsh sentences, while in Jordan,
Morocco, Tunisia and Yemen, journalists were
assaulted or detained.
Many newspapers that were self-financing
have come under pressure by the authorities,
which have reduced their share of advertising
and blocked distribution, even to subscribers.
The head offices of newspapers have been sub-
ject to police raids in many Arab countries, and
Arab television networks have been subjected
to particularly heavy pressure. Arab satellite
broadcasters have come under foreign pres-
sure to change their reporting of events.
While many Arab states adopt a public
discourse supporting press freedom and open-
ness towards the privatisation of public space,
in reality, the situation is only becoming worse.
International organizations working for press
freedom have published reports packed with
references to violations. In its 2002 report,
Reporters sans frontiers, for example, stated
The more ruthless
censorship becomes,
the more the people
resist.
BOX 3-2
Marwan al-Barghouti (from his prison cell): I will
overcome the cell and the occupiers
He was arrested on charges of resisting
the Israeli occupation in 1978 while in
the 10th grade, but was determined to
complete his studies in prison, and suc-
ceeded in obtaining his secondary school
certificate. Leaving prison in 1983, he
went to Bir Zeit University to study
political science, and joined the student
movement where he assumed a leading
role in the youth and student movement
affiliated to the Palestine National Lib-
eration Movement (Fatah).
Al-Barghouti believed the Oslo Ac-
cords could lead to an end to occupation
and the establishment of a Palestinian
State within the 1967 borders. It was this
that drove him to turn from the political
struggle to work for the peace process.
In 1996 he stood for the Palestinian
legislative council elections and won
the Ramallah seat, establishing himself
as a member of the first elected Palestin-
ian Parliament. He was among the most
fervent opponents of corruption and
supporters of human rights, and social
and economic justice. The Palestinian
women’s movement considers him to be
one of their closest allies in the struggle
for equality.
Israel’s continuing and relentless
appropriation of more Palestinian ter-
ritory and creation of more settlements
in different areas following the Oslo
Accords was the most decisive factor in
al-Barghouti’s change of view.
“We have lived through seven years
of the intifada without negotiations, and
then seven years of negotiations without
the intifada. Perhaps the time has come
to try them both at the same time.”
Marwan al-Barghouti sums up
Palestinians’ demands in the following
way: Israel must accept independ-
ence for the Palestinians. Negotiations
between masters and slaves will lead
nowhere without resistance and without
expressing the Palestinian national will.
Al-Barghouti went on to become a char-
ismatic spokesman and leader, calling for
total resistance to occupation. With the
new intifada he came to be known as its
leader, not only as a leader and activist
in the field but also in endeavouring to
provide political direction and shape the
intifada’s goals.
Marwan al-Barghouti miraculously
survived an assassination attempt by
Israeli helicopter gun ships in August
2001, but he continued to call for the
intifada, despite repeated calls for his
assassination. After the Israeli incursion
of Ramallah, al-Barghouti was at the top
of the Israeli security forces’ wanted list,
and he was arrested on the afternoon of
Monday, 15 April 2002.
In detention, al-Barghouti was sub-
jected to both psychological and physical
pressure. As a result of these conditions
his health has deteriorated and he now
suffers from chest pains and respiratory
difficulties, in addition to back pains as
a result of his cramped quarters (his cell,
including the lavatory, is three square
metres.) The Israeli occupation authori-
ties have also prevented al-Barghouti
from seeking hospital treatment, in con-
travention of the Geneva Conventions,
particularly the Third and Fourth.
Even from his prison cell Marwan
al-Barghouti still affirms that the Pal-
estinian will for freedom will never be
crushed, and that the only alternative
is to end the 57 year-old occupation.
Despite his fury at Israel’s continuing
tyranny and profound sorrow for the
many Palestinian martyrs, Marwan al-
Barghouti holds firm in his belief in the
fundamental principle of securing a just
peace through the establishment of two
States for two peoples.
Excerpts from a letter to his wife: “I
will overcome the cell and the occupi-
ers…they will never break my will.”
Source: Lead author, based on communications with Bargouthi’s wife and lawyers.
85 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
that the region was the second largest prison
for journalists in the world.
A phenomenon unique to the Arab region
consists of organized attempts that were suc-
cessful until recently, to suppress the freedom
of the media, and prevent it from harnessing
the potential of linguistic and cultural unity
to launch a media renaissance. Taking place
in stages, these attempts started with rivalry
between radical and traditional Arab regimes
in the 1960s to influence the free Arab media
in countries such as Lebanon. Following the
Lebanese war, the action moved to Europe.
Not only did the regimes lavish large sums of
money on buying or neutralizing information
media; some resorted to assassinating journal-
ists and blowing up press offices (Abdelwahab
el-Affendi, 1993). That stage ended with an
almost total clampdown on media freedom in
the Arab diaspora. The trend was reinforced
by the increasing influence of oil countries
and a rapprochement among Arab regimes
after radical countries changed their position
towards “moderation”.
There was also the temporary setback with
the invasion of Kuwait in 1990; but this stage
ended in 1995 with the opening of Arab satel-
lite stations offering programmes that were
remarkable for their relative freedom and
frankness. Criticism and dialogue started to
revive in the Arab press.
With the information revolution and the
expanded use of the Internet, the region en-
tered a new era and it was no longer feasible
to muzzle information as a tool for political
control and manipulation. With the rising
level of education among young people and
increased access to world information sources,
the Arab citizen is no longer convinced by old
propaganda methods.
Nevertheless, early in 2003, Arab Ministers
of Information and Ministers of the Interior
agreed to an anti-terrorism strategy, leading to
further restrictions on freedom of opinion and
expression and indeed on other human rights,
and to the potential expansion of provisions of
the Arab Anti-Terrorism Agreement to cover
the media. This would greatly increase the
danger of continued misuse of the Agreement
to punish individuals for non-violent activities
since the terms “terrorism”, “legitimate resist-
ance to occupation”, “violence”, “terrorist
purposes” and “terrorist attacks” still lack
clear-cut and agreed upon technical definitions
in law. The terminology of freedom of expres-
sion also remains vague, especially as regards
the Internet.
Since the events of 11 September 2001, the
Internet has been subjected to direct interfer-
ence and censorship, disrupting the flow of
information.
Since 2001, the penal codes of a number of
Arab countries have been amended to provide
for longer prison terms and heavier fines for
publishing-related offences. This situation is
reflected in greater pressure on journalists and
a narrower margin of freedom of opinion and
expression. Violations of freedom of opinion
and freedom of expression have included at-
tacks on political activists and human rights
advocates who had expressed their views
openly.
Curtailment of freedom of opinion and
expression in the form of officially imposed
censorship extends also to literary and artistic
creativity, exacerbated in some countries by
unofficial censorship by influential political or
social forces of society. Some Arab states have
gone to such extremes to monopolize “intellec-
tual activity” that they have banned circulation
of some of the most treasured works in the
Arab literary heritage, such as The Prophet,
by Gibran Kahlil Gibran, and A Thousand
and One Nights. There has, however, been
a noticeable increase in the number of books
and publications appearing on the Internet,
or published in the West, but which the Arab
reader can only obtain as smuggled copies.
Stifling creativity
Freedom is an essential dimension of, and an
incentive for creative work, whether in the do-
main of language in the form of essays, poetry,
short stories, novels, drama and criticism, or in
the plastic arts such as painting, photography
and sculpture. Freedom is also a basic condi-
tion for intellectual creativity in works dealing
with history, politics, society and beliefs.
While Arab poets, novelists and dramatists
remain prolific, the “freedom” to write and
freedom of expression have often been chal-
With the rising level
of education among
young people, and
increased access to
world information
sources, the Arab
citizen is no longer
convinced by old
propaganda methods.
Since the events of
11 September 2001,
the Internet has been
subjected to direct
interference and
censorship.
86 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
lenged by political authority and by certain
traditional interpretations of religion. Public
reactions to this freedom range from violent
criticism, to misdirection and misguidance, to
the referral of writers and their works to the
courts and the imposition on them of harsh
sentences. Some writers have been victims of
violence and even of assassination or execu-
tion.
For example, legal measures were taken
against Taha Hussein for his book Fi al- Shi’r
al-Jahili, 1926 (On Pre-Islamic Poetry), against
Sadeq Jalal Al Azem for his Naqd Al Fikr Al
Dini, 3rd edition, 1927 (A Critique of Reli-
gious Thought) and Nasr Hamed Abu Zeid
for a number of his controversial writings.
Naguib Mahfouz was the victim of an assault
due to a misinterpretation of his novel Awlad
Haritna (The People of our Alley). The Islamic
thinker Sayyed Qotb was executed in 1966
for opinions expressed in Ma’alem fi-Tariq,
1964 (Landmarks Along the Road) and so was
Mahmoud Mohammed Taha in the Sudan for
expressing religious opinions to which the po-
litical regime objected. Farag Foda’s writings,
which were critical and somewhat sarcastic in
their treatment of Islamists, led to his assassi-
nation. There are also contemporary cases of
authors whose writings have provoked strong
religious antagonism, which has landed them
in court.
Certain ideological and cultural groups
have also been responsible for censoring or
curtailing creative work. These groups are
usually dominated by party dogmatists seeking
to impose a preconceived mode of expression,
production and commitment on creative art-
ists, which militates completely against the
freedom required for creativity. In some in-
stances, considerable tension exists between
creative authors and the political parties to
which they originally belonged, as was the case
with Badr Shakir al-Sayyab.
The suppression of creativity in the Arab
world does not stem exclusively from the strict
religious discourse. It also originates with po-
litical authorities. Cartoons lampooning Arab
rulers are frequently suppressed, and their
artists persecuted. In the case of Palestine, the
assassination of Naji al-Ali marks one of the
most savage examples of the suppression of an
opposition cartoonist’s freedom of expression.
Cultural associations (associations of writ-
ers, artists and dramatists) have also suffered
from the intervention of the state and its laws,
or the party. They have been subjected to
enquiries into their nature and purposes and
to interference in their scope and freedom of
expression and action. This is true of all Arab
countries. Ibrahim Abdullah Ghaloum’s study
of laws governing cultural associations in his
country may well serve as an example for any
study of equivalent laws in other Arab coun-
tries. It testifies clearly to the disappearance
of the legal personality of cultural associations
and the suppression or curtailment of their
freedoms. Such laws reflect the controlling
spirit of state security laws, which, in the realm
of culture, can only limit freedom and creativ-
ity (ibid, 313-341).
BOX 3-3
Al-Manfaluti: The value of freedom that has been stolen
“The birds fly in the air, the fish swim
in the sea, the wild beasts roam in the
valleys and mountains, but man lives in
two prisons, the prison of his own soul
and the prison of his government, from
cradle to grave.
The strong have forged chains and
fetters for the weak and called them
law, to oppress the weak in the name
of justice and to dispossess them of the
jewel of their freedom in the name of law
and order.
This fearsome weapon has left the
weak apprehensive and wary, with ter-
ror in their hearts and trembling in every
limb … Is there any torture in the world
that is worse than the torture to which
one is being subjected oneself, or any
more confining prison than the prison in
which one is being held?
If a man knew the value of the
freedom that has been stolen from him,
and understood the reality of the bonds
holding his body and mind, he would
kill himself like the nightingale that has
been caught by a hunter and confined in a
cage, for that would be preferable to a life
in which he could see not a single ray of
freedom, nor any breath of freedom come
to him…
The only way to achieve happiness
in life is to live in absolute freedom, with
nothing to dominate one’s body, mind,
soul, emotions and thoughts but one’s
own self-discipline…” (Mustafa Lutfi
al-Manfaluti, in Arabic, 1984)
Al-Manfaluti concludes his reflec-
tions on freedom with the following
words, which have long been praised and
committed to memory by students of the
Arabic language, including the writer of
these lines, when he was a primary-school
pupil in Egypt:
“Freedom is a sun that shines within
every soul. Anyone who is deprived of it
lives in deepest darkness, unbroken from
the darkness of the womb to the dark-
ness of the grave … Freedom in human
history is not a novelty, nor a fortuitous
occurrence; rather, it is an innate qual-
ity with which human beings have been
endowed ever since they were wild crea-
tures scrambling over rocks and swinging
from the branches of trees.
A man who stretches out his hands to
ask for freedom is not begging; he is seek-
ing a right that has been stolen from him
by human greed. If he obtains it, it will
not be as a favour from anyone, and he
will not be beholden to anyone.” (ibid)
Source: Fuad Megally, in Arabic, 2002, 1169.
The suppression of
creativity in the Arab
world does not stem
exclusively from
the strict religious
discourse. It also
originates with
political authorities.
87 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
Freedom of association: civil society
institutions
Arab authorities limit popular movements
and expressions of popular sovereignty in the
public sphere in order to prevent them from
becoming sources of pressure. As far as possi-
ble, they try to keep them outside the political
sphere. The regime can be assured of continu-
ing to hold power only so long as it can keep
the public space for itself, prevent democratic
political forces from emerging, and weaken any
institutions and mechanisms that might lead to
political alternation.
Freedom to form political parties
Arab countries lack mechanisms for demo-
cratic participation. States either outlaw or
marginalize political parties by encouraging
traditional social structures, such as the clan,
tribe or sect, which, with their pyramidal struc-
tures, are easier for the state to deal with.
In some Arab countries, legal reform
has led to official recognition of multi-party
politics. Even so, the freedom to form par-
ties is subject to numerous legal restrictions
that seriously impede its exercise. This has
caused parties to adopt undemocratic prac-
tices, becoming authoritarian themselves,
characterized by ideological, and, in some
cases, religious fanaticism. In numerous par-
ties, individual members are offered no role
in developing party policy or manifestos. The
parties rarely allow space for criticism, which
could enrich diversity within their ranks.
Freedom to form associations and
surveillance of their activities
In Arab countries, the freedom to form asso-
ciations is restricted in varying degrees by law.
Under the legislation of most Arab countries,
associations are subject to various forms of
oversight and surveillance. The most severe
forms of state interference lie in the power
to suspend associations or dissolve them by
executive order. In some countries (for exam-
ple Syria) any judicial review of such orders is
prohibited. Offenders under these various laws
are usually liable to imprisonment, although in
some instances only monetary fines are im-
posed.
The freedom to form associations has been
violated by many marginally democratic gov-
ernments, including those of Algeria, Egypt,
Jordan, Mauritania and Tunisia. Would-be
founders of organizations have been denied
permission to proceed, and existing organi-
zations have been dissolved. Most of these
adverse measures have been directed against
grassroots human rights organizations. Arab
authorities have sought to drown the voices of
voluntary civil society organizations by setting
up what they claim to be non-governmental or-
ganizations, (NGOs.) These sham groups are
in fact governmental entities (GNGOs) which
work for, and are financed by the regime,
whose discourse they echo and whose interests
they pursue.
Since 2001, the global “war on terror” has
seen a new development in the region: Arab
governments have begun to monitor Islamic
charitable organizations closely, sometimes
cracking down on their activities on the basis
of US lists, with their political bias.
Historically speaking, civil associations are
progressive forces that prepare the way for civil
society to emerge and help to create the kind of
public sphere required for freedom (Chapter
1). It is thus of great concern that the many
restrictions imposed on them may leave Arab
citizens with only the traditional, narrower
options of tribal or clan-based action, which
in turn will strengthen the grip of “clannism”
(al-‘asabiya) on Arab society (Chapter 6).
Nonetheless, associations continue to
spring up and pursue their activities, even
without the blessing of the law, finding alterna-
tive legal formulae such as styling themselves
BOX 3-4
Khalida Said: Creativity - Between Consciousness and Dreams
Creativity is a free action oriented
towards freedom. It is a movement,
in essence, between consciousness, in
the sense of acquired knowledge and
memory, and dream, in the sense of
the aspiration, striving, discovery and
endeavour that elevate knowledge to its
utmost. It is a movement whose very na-
ture is freedom both in its inception and
its social destination, wherein those that
it addresses are to be found. Creativity is
an impulse that transcends its inner psy-
chological level as an aspiration to seek
embodiment or crystallization in some
palpable form addressed to a receiver.
This nexus of movement and freedom
is an innate human characteristic, and
a natural human right, it is the right
declared by contemporary creators, one
for which they claim the dual freedom to
both send and receive.
(Khalida Said, background paper for
this Report).
The freedom to form
parties is subject
to numerous legal
restrictions that
seriously impede its
exercise.
The freedom to form
associations has been
violated by many
marginally democratic
governments.
88 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
as companies, which are lawful in most Arab
states, to protect their members. Significantly,
while poorly represented in political party
activity, women are very much in evidence
in civil and cooperative associations, holding
leadership positions in some Arab countries.
Trade unions and professional associations
The status of Arab trade unions ranges consid-
erably: they are numerous and enjoy varying
degrees of freedom. In some countries, state
interference in the essential and defining dem-
ocratic processes of trade unions, has driven
them into political activism and opposition,
which has brought them harsher restrictions
still.
Workers in countries that approve the
plurality of unions, such as Morocco and
Lebanon, are free to choose which body to
join, in contrast to states where only one union
is allowed. In general, workers in many sectors
are still outside union bodies.
Experience in some Arab countries has
shown that support for unionized labour
usually leads to stronger and more effective
unions, and that this, in turn, helps create
a competitive democratic climate marked by
activism, respect for human rights and a flour-
ishing civil society.
In contrast, where there is no competition
between unions, the regime can contain and
control the single union, which becomes a tool
for enforcing government policy. This is the
case in most Arab countries, especially since
the advent of economic liberalization, which
has had the effect of weakening unions and,
therefore, reducing public trust in them. Un-
ions have thus become unable to protect their
members or defend their interests. In response
to this situation, new non-governmental or-
ganizations have begun to emerge to support
workers. The Union and Labour Services
House in Egypt, for example, was founded in
1990 as an independent organization for that
purpose. It may be noted, however, that Arab,
and more especially Asian, migrant workers
enjoy very little protection in any Arab state,
especially the Gulf States.
The right to participation:
Participation in elections, by running for of-
fice or by voting, is how citizens and groups
express their political preferences and hold
officials accountable for their performance.
Participation is a step towards political alterna-
tion. Consequently, regimes take advantage of
their position to nullify the outcome of voting
through various legal mechanisms, or simply
to disregard it, thereby keeping themselves in
power.
While the Arab world has exhibited a
broad array of electoral processes at all levels,
the right to political participation has remained
little more than a ritual representing a purely
formal application of a constitutional entitle-
ment. In most cases elections have resulted in
misrepresenting the will of the electorate and
in low levels of representation for the opposi-
tion and women.
With a few exceptions, some of which are
purely cosmetic, presidential elections do not
take place freely in Arab countries in the sense
of involving more than one candidate compet-
ing in a general election. In only three Arab
countries (Algeria, Sudan and Yemen), and in a
fourth under occupation (palestine), are presi-
dents elected through direct elections with
more than one candidate and with presidential
term limits. While direct presidential elections
take place in Tunisia and Djibouti, no term
limits are set. Syria and Egypt (and previously
Iraq) depended on referendums where the
president is nominated by the parliament, after
which a national referendum is held. In presi-
dential referenda the outcome varies between
an absolutely majority and total unanimity.
Except in two countries - Saudi Arabia
and United Arab Emirates – parliaments in
the region are either totally or partially elected.
However, parliamentary elections have not
played their designated role in balancing
power, or holding the government account-
able or even in reflecting public opinion. These
elections have generally reproduced the same
ruling elites. Legislative elections routinely suf-
fer low turnout rates. Opposition candidates
have charged that electoral laws are rigged to
suit the interests of the regime and that the alli-
ances put together by the existing government
State interference
in the essential and
defining democratic
processes of trade
unions has driven
them into political
activism.
In most cases,
elections have resulted
in misrepresenting the
will of the electorate
and in low levels of
representation for
the opposition and
women.
89 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
block all chances of winning. Consequently,
they have frequently boycotted elections or
denounced their outcomes as travesties of due
process.
INDIVIDUAL FREEDOMS
Individual freedoms constitute the most cher-
ished component of freedom, because they are
closest to the individual and to her/his status
as a unique human being. The legal regime
governing freedoms applies with particular
force to freedoms in this category. The func-
tion of law in the matter of the right to freedom
is simply to acknowledge that right by creating
a space in which the free individual can exer-
cise choice; all that is required of the law is to
ensure that this space is not violated by oth-
ers. Such law is known as passive law. Within
that space, freedom is entire, subject only to
restrictions for the sake of public order. But
the sphere of individual freedom affords only
limited potential for affecting public order,
and none at all in the case of private individual
freedoms. Those freedoms serve as the frame-
work within which the individual constructs
a stable identity and consolidates the bases of
personality and action, and they have a major
impact in unleashing the dynamic potential of
individual and collective freedoms alike.
Freedom of opinion and belief:
These are private individual freedoms that are
inviolable and recognized as such by all the
monotheistic religions. Perhaps the Qur’an
sums up the matter most succinctly: “Whoever
so wishes, let him believe, and whoever so
wishes, let him prefer unbelief.”
Freedom of opinion and belief are among
the civil rights that are enshrined in the Inter-
national Covenant on Civil and Political Rights
(ICCPR), and in the constitutions of some Arab
states. But Arab authorities, both civil and re-
ligious, usually join forces to curtail this right
in law and in practice, speaking with one voice
in terms reminiscent of a tribal social system.
They uphold a uniform pattern of behaviour
characterized by obedience and submission
that makes any departure from that pattern
unlawful or sinful so as to contain society by
homogenising its constituent individuals. Arab
countries have witnessed several abuses of the
freedom of social groups on religious, sectarian
or ideological grounds.
Official models of belief that bolster tradi-
tion and traditional values and negate freedom
of opinion, treat those who do not conform to
them as enemies, as in the case of the conflicts
between the Islamists and the various Sufi
orders. Those who think are proscribed, even
though they may be faithful believers. As a re-
sult, the polity breaks up into politico-religious
factions that are more easily contained, and
society loses its vitality.
Freedom of privacy and personal life:
Personal life constitutes a free zone for the
individual to enjoy and which the state is not
entitled to infringe or curtail. Yet in Arab
countries political authorities at times appro-
priate this space, breaching the inviolability of
the home at any hour of the day or night, moni-
toring private correspondence and tapping
telephones; religious authorities or particular
social groups similarly usurp the personal free-
dom of citizens.
Women suffer acutely in this respect, as
they are also subject to surveillance by male
members of their family, or even of the local
community. A woman is at risk of violence, to
the point of being killed in a so-called “crime
of honour”, which constitutes lawful grounds
in some Arab countries and an extenuating
circumstance in others. It is generally recog-
nized, however, that in many cases “crimes of
BOX 3-5
Declaration on the Right and Responsibility of Individuals,
Groups and Organs of Society to Promote and Protect
Universally Recognized Human Rights and Fundamental
Freedoms, 1999 (excerpts)
Article 1.
Everyone has the right, individually and
in association with others, to promote
and to strive for the protection and
realization of human rights and fun-
damental freedoms at the national and
international levels.
Article 2.
1. Each State has a primary responsibil-
ity and duty to protect, promote and
implement all human rights and funda-
mental freedoms, inter alia, by adopting
such steps as may be necessary to create
all conditions necessary in the social,
economic, political and other fields, as
well as the legal guarantees required to
ensure that all persons under its jurisdic-
tion, individually and in association with
others, are able to enjoy all those rights
and freedoms in practice.
2. Each State shall adopt such legislative,
administrative and other steps as may be
necessary to ensure that the rights and
freedoms referred to in the present Dec-
laration are effectively guaranteed.
Source: UN General Assembly resolution 53/144.
Arab countries have
witnessed several
abuses of the freedom
of social groups on
religious, sectarian or
ideological grounds.
Official models of
belief that bolster
tradition and
traditional values and
negate freedom of
opinion, treat those
who do not conform
to them as enemies.
90 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
honour” are committed on nothing more than
unfounded suspicion, or to cover up a situa-
tion where a girl has been raped by a member
of her own family.
Female genital mutilation, despite its
known harmful effects, continues to be prac-
ticed in some Arab countries, in some cases by
traditional methods devoid of even the most
rudimentary safety precautions, with the result
that girls die from the operation.
DENIAL OF FUNDAMENTAL
INDIVIDUAL FREEDOMS
Violation of basic rights
The human rights system is founded on a col-
lection of rights at the very heart of the system,
which are considered totally inviolable. Yet in
Arab countries these sacred and basic rights
are frequently violated.
The right to life
Violations of the right to life in Arab countries
have taken multiple forms. The most conspicu-
ous examples are Israel’s military aggression
against the Palestinian people, at the cost of
civilian lives, in addition to the physical liqui-
dation of leaders and cadres of the resistance.
Tens are killed daily in Iraq by occupation
forces or terrorist groups. Internal conflict
continues to rage in the Sudan and Somalia,
representing a further source of violation of
this right, while the global anti-terrorism cam-
paign has added a new dimension to the issue.
Capital punishment is an infringement of
the right to life.
1
Yet certain Arab states remain
untouched by the human rights system’s posi-
tion on the death penalty, which confines its
use to the most serious crimes, imposes proce-
dural and judicial safeguards, and prohibits its
use in political cases. Capital punishment has
been retained in all Arab countries, although
in certain countries (such as Bahrain, Algeria,
Lebanon
2
, Morocco and Tunisia) it is rarely
applied.
Some Arab governments also violate the
right to life extra-legally and extra-judicially.
Human rights organizations have observed
that official reports on killings tend to be short
on facts. In most Arab states the names of
the victims are not mentioned, and no public
investigation is conducted, giving rise to sus-
picions of the possibility of “liquidation” or
extrajudicial execution of suspects. In most
cases of disappearance or abduction in Arab
countries it is feared that the victim has been
executed outside the law. According to the
files of the UN there were 11,000 cases of un-
known disappearances in the Arab countries in
1993 (Arab Organization for Human Rights).
The right to life is often violated in cases
when people are expelled or arrested, and in
prisons, especially those run by security and
intelligence services, where torture is used or
health care neglected.
Extremist groups who perpetrate assas-
sinations and bombings and espouse the use
of violence also violate the right to life. Armed
confrontations between security forces and
armed groups may result in civilian casual-
ties; in some instances, civilian victims have
outnumbered victims in the ranks of the com-
batants.
Lastly, the repression of peaceful demon-
strations by security forces in Arab countries
has been yet another source of violation of the
right to life.
The right to liberty and personal safety
This right is massively and consistently vio-
lated. Since the global “war on terror” cam-
paign began, there have been unprecedented
numbers of arrests. Legal safeguards have been
violated, and people have been deprived of
their liberty and, in many instances, tortured
and ill-treated in prisons, camps and detention
centres where their personal safety is uncer-
tain. The disappearance of a family member in
prison is a tragedy that often haunts Arab citi-
zens. Following the disappearance of Kuwaiti
prisoners in Iraq, it emerged that hundreds
had disappeared in some Arab jails.
1
This position has been emphasised in Resolution 2857 –XXVI, December 20, 1971 of the UN General Assembly and in two resolutions of the UN
Economic and Social Council, on May 20, 1971 and May 9, 1971 respectively.
2
It is important to note that the former Prime Minister of Lebanon adduced reasons of conscience for refusing to sign execution orders for those
sentenced to death.
The disappearance
of a family member
in prison is a tragedy
that often haunts Arab
citizens.
Certain Arab states
remain untouched
by the human rights
system’s position on
the death penalty.
91 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
Following the September 11 attacks, lists
of suspects were circulated by the US security
services, requesting their detention on sight,
giving human rights organizations cause for
concern.
The right to a fair and impartial trial
Most Arab regimes do not respect the prin-
ciple of the separation of powers, with the
result that the judiciary comes under political
pressure, especially from the executive power,
and loses credibility. The risk to the judiciary
has recently grown as some of the finest judges
have become exposed to violence and prosecu-
tion; indeed, judges have been murdered in
their own courtrooms (in Sidon, Lebanon).
Yet while the institutional structure of the judi-
ciary has come under assault from politicians,
it may still fairly be said that many judges in
most Arab countries are reliable, learned and
upright.
Safeguards surrounding the right to a fair
trial are being eroded. This is happening
mainly outside the regular judicial system.
Contributing to this erosion are such practices
as referring civilians for trial by military courts
(as in Egypt, Jordan, Lebanon and Tunisia,)
and the use of various exceptional procedures.
The latter include emergency courts in Egypt
and the Sudan, state security courts in Iraq
(until the recent fall of the regime) Jordan and
Syria, special courts in Iraq, Libya, and the
Sudan, and martial law tribunals in Somalia.
In Algeria, Mauritania and Tunisia, the regular
courts have been little better, especially in se-
curity and political cases, and trials of civilians
in cases of terrorism in the past two years have
met with strong criticism.
Exclusion from citizenship
Deprivation of citizenship
The withdrawal of nationality from an Arab
citizen, as permitted under certain legislation
through an administrative decision by a gov-
ernment official of less than ministerial rank,
is one the most extreme forms of exclusion
from citizenship. This is closely followed by
the deprivation of certain categories of citizens
of their right to obtain nationality in their own
country.
Abusing the rights of minority groups.
National legal systems do not protect members
of groups outside the mainstream, which are
often marginalized. For example, Article 27 of
the ICCPR is still the mainstay of the protection
of such persons, despite the 1992 Declaration
on the Rights of Persons Belonging to National
or Ethnic, Religious and Linguistic Minorities.
Individuals belonging to such groups are
citizens as well and entitled, in principle, to
enjoy all the rights of citizenship, yet those
rights are frequently violated along with the
rights of citizens in general. These individu-
als may also suffer additional violations at the
hands of the law or the administration or as
a result of entrenched social practices, simply
because of their background.
Violations of human rights in Arab coun-
tries are more pronounced when cultural,
religious or ethnic dimensions are present,
particularly since marginalized groups have
fewer opportunities to protest their rights.
Repression directed specifically at such groups
reflects an odious “minority mentality” in parts
of society and in oppressive regimes alike.
In areas of protracted conflict in northern
Iraq and the southern Sudan, some cultural,
ethnic or tribal groups, especially the Kurds in
Iraq, have suffered overt or covert persecution.
Government policy has fluctuated between
recognizing the principle of autonomy and
responding to dissidence as insurrection. In
both cases, however, the outcome has been a
solution along federalist lines. The southern
Sudan is unique in that an agreement was
reached based on recognition of the right to
self-determination following a specified period
of time. However, a complete settlement has
not yet been achieved in either case, and some
local conflicts continue, as with the case of
Arab and Turkmen citizens in northern Iraq,
and in border regions of southern and western
Sudan. Recently the Qamishli events in Syria
have brought to light the suffering endured
by Kurds seeking their most basic legitimate
rights, namely the right to citizenship.
The Kabylie regions of Algeria have ex-
Most Arab regimes
do not respect the
principle of the
separation of powers,
with the result that
the judiciary comes
under political
pressure.
Violations of human
rights in Arab
countries are more
pronounced when
cultural, religious or
ethnic dimensions are
present.
92 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
perienced many disturbances since 2001.
Demonstrations in 2002 resulted in dozens of
victims. Democratic developments in Algeria
have helped to resolve Berber demands and
the Amazigh language was recognized as a na-
tional language. The authorities subsequently
moved towards making it an official language,
after ending the debate on whether this would
require a popular referendum.
Christians in some Arab countries also suf-
fer from restrictions on their freedoms.
This kind of double subjugation affects a
number of other social groups, notably bidun
and naturalized citizens in Arab Gulf coun-
tries. The former are regarded as foreigners,
while the latter, being stateless, have nowhere
to go and are treated as second-class citizens;
they are denied the right to stand for election
to representative bodies or to vote. A similar
prejudice affected Iraqi citizens whom the
previous government designated “Iranian na-
tionals”; their status as citizens of Iraq was not
recognized, and some of them were expelled to
Iran, while others remained as an under-class.
“Card holders” in the border areas of Saudi
Arabia, Kurds deprived of citizenship follow-
ing the 1962 census in Syria, and akhdam in
Yemen are in much the same boat.
Migrant workers in oil producing Arab
states, including Arabs, suffer certain forms
of discrimination according to international
standards, the most notorious being the “guar-
antor system” and the abuse of domestic serv-
ants, chiefly women.
Socio-economic and military circum-
stances are creating bizarre situations in Mau-
ritania and the Sudan. In the former, members
of the group known as haratin (emancipated
slaves) are hardly better off than when they
were slaves. Since the legal abolition of slavery
in 1980, the Government has been unable to
provide them with sources of income, while
social prejudices have prevented their integra-
tion into society. Consequently, many haratin
have been compelled to return to the families
for which they formerly worked, and their
condition is similar to slavery. In the Sudan,
different tribes involved in the military con-
flict have abducted one other’s women and
children; here again, the victims’ condition is
tantamount to slavery. This situation has given
rise to international accusations that the Sudan
tolerates slavery, and those accusations have
been enlarged by propaganda. Despite the
Government’s efforts to solve the problem,
thousands of people are still in this wretched
condition, and the Government of the Sudan
continues to endure the odium of this charge.
The affirmative action of allocating a “quota”
in the parliament for Christians, and Chechans
in Jordan is positively noted.
The Arab people cannot be satisfied as long
as the dilemma of the Palestinian diaspora con-
tinues. Its members are deprived of their right
to return, in addition to being denied many of
their other fundamental rights – even in Arab
countries. The Palestinians have been left
alone to bear the consequences of expulsion
by Israel, in which it enjoyed outside support,
while those expelled suffered. This double in-
justice calls for the international community to
come together to guarantee the right to return
and, in the meantime, to secure the other basic
human rights of Palestinians.
The legal rights of Arabs living in some in-
dustrialized countries have deteriorated lately
following the “war on terror”.
Women doubly excluded
Arab women find themselves in different
situations, depending on their respective
circumstances, and depending on the extent
to which democracy is practiced both within
their families and by the national system. But
nowhere in the Arab world do women enjoy
equality with men, even though equality is a
fundamental human right. Women are subject
to discrimination both at law and in practice,
and as a result they tend not to participate very
extensively in the public sphere, and relatively
little in decision-making within the family.
To be sure, concern for the status of
women has increased in recent years, as may be
seen from various developments. Governmen-
tal structures have been established expressly
to address women’s issues, both at the regional
level, with the establishment of the Arab
Women’s Organization, and at the national
level, with the founding of national councils
and commissions on the status of women in a
number of Arab countries. Political discourse
Nowhere in the Arab
world do women
enjoy equality with
men.
The legal rights
of Arabs living in
some industrialized
countries have
deteriorated lately
following the “war on
terror”.
93 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
regularly addresses the issue of equality,
and governments have adopted a number of
programmes aimed at promoting it. There
has been an exponential growth in NGOs
concerned with women’s rights. Despite all
this, in most Arab countries women are still
subject to numerous forms of discrimination.
Perhaps education marks the sole exception
to the rule, where girls comprise the majority
at certain levels in some Arab countries, with
an academic record superior to that of their
male peers.
Statistics point to a generalized gender gap
in various areas, including education, employ-
ment, property ownership, public office, deci-
sion-making posts, and leadership positions
in political parties and trade unions. There
have been laudable efforts to promote the
status of women in some areas, but others have
been largely neglected both by governments
and by society in general. Little progress has
been made regarding political participation by
women, changes to personal status laws, inte-
gration of women in the development process,
the right of a woman married to a foreign
husband to transmit her citizenship to her chil-
dren, and the inability of existing legislation
to protect women from domestic violence or
violence on the part of the state and society.
Discrimination is becoming more acute
in the Gulf countries and, in particular, in
Saudi Arabia. Violence against women is most
prevalent in areas of armed conflict, notably in
Sudan, Somalia and Iraq.
As regards women’s rights, Kuwaiti soci-
ety has been less progressive than some Arab
governments. The National Assembly has
more than once voted against an enlightened
decree of the Emir that would have allowed
women to participate in political life. In the
more democratic Arab countries, where such
participation is lawful, voters tend not to elect
women candidates: there are legislatures that
do not have a single woman member, while
the legislatures of some other countries, such
as Egypt and Yemen, have no more than
token numbers of women members. However,
a trend to introduce such quotas has developed
in the past two years, as in Morocco, Jordan,
Qatar and Oman.
It is important to stress here that positions
on gender equality have emerged in a multi-
layered and complex societal context which
must be taken into careful consideration when
examining both the issue of equality and the
respective society’s shaping of ways to achieve
it. These issues will be fully discussed and
analysed in the fourth AHDR on the “Rise of
Women” in Arab countries.
As indicated in Annex 1 of AHDR 2, the
World Values Survey found that the Arab
people are reluctant to accept total equality
between women and men (see also the results
of the Freedom Survey in Annex 1 of this
Report). While gender equality in education
was almost universally supported, there was
noticeably less support for equality in employ-
ment and politics, particularly in Jordan and
Morocco (figure 3-1).
SOCIAL AND ECONOMIC RIGHTS
This section concludes with a review of eco-
nomic and social rights, which, according to
the definition of human development, are
embodied within two fundamental human ca-
pabilities: leading a long and healthy life, and
knowledge acquisition.
The first AHDR documented various ways
In most Arab
countries, women
are still subject to
numerous forms of
discrimination.
Figure 3-1
Percentage agreeing that women should have equal rights, five Arab countries,
Freedom Survey, 2003
94 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
in which, first, these two fundamental human
capabilities are not realized in Arab countries,
second, the weakest social groups, notably
women and the destitute, are especially dis-
advantaged in that respect, and third, these
capabilities are inappropriately or under-uti-
lized in terms of activity within society. This
unsatisfactory situation intersects with the
issues of freedom and good governance on two
levels. To begin with, the absence of freedom
and good governance itself aggravates the im-
poverishment and under-utilization of human
faculties, as under those conditions decision-
making serves the interest of the ruling elite
rather than the public interest in general. In
addition, experts agree that a situation of sub-
jugation produces adverse effects on health,
including the individual’s physical health.
From that standpoint, the impoverishment and
under-utilization of human capabilities are not
only disabling for human development, they
also reflect a disregard for economic and so-
cial rights that are recognized in international
human rights law.
Moreover, the impoverishment and under-
utilization of human capabilities in Arab coun-
tries amount to a basis for perpetuating the
status quo. Such deprivation blunts the critical
sense and fosters passivity and inertia, thereby
sapping the individual and societal vitality that
is essential to any meaningful renaissance in
Arab countries.
According to the Freedom Survey, Annex
1, interviewees were of the opinion that, at the
beginning of the third millennium, more than
10% of Arabs still suffer from hunger, disease,
ignorance or poverty, whether in terms of
low income or deprivation of human capa-
bilities. In one country covered by the survey
interviewees estimated that almost 25% of the
population suffered from low income, while in
three of the five countries surveyed the level of
poverty was estimated at around one quarter
of the population, using the deprivation of
human capabilities indicator, figure 3-2.
THE RIGHT TO LEAD A LONG,
HEALTHY LIFE
The right to food and adequate nutrition:
Hunger is an outcome of inadequate food and
micronutrient intake, and it can be measured
in terms of arrested physical and mental
growth, impaired health, early death, low life
expectancy at birth, learning disabilities and ir-
Figure 3-2
Estimate of the extent of deprivation of human capabilities, five Arab countries, Freedom
Survey, 2003
The impoverishment
and under-utilization
of human capabilities
in Arab countries
amount to a basis
for perpetuating the
status quo.
95 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
regular school attendance. Hunger also weak-
ens the immune system, and thus is reflected
in epidemics, infection and HIV, and in low
productivity at work and in social activity.
Children are among those most seriously
affected by food insecurity, since malnutri-
tion in early life has a serious, frequently ir-
reversible impact, even when the immediate
life environment of the person concerned
subsequently improves. Malnutrition stunts
the child’s growth and affects her/his weight.
It also has an adverse impact on physical and
psychological performance, making the child
dull and impairing her/his mental faculties if
continued into adulthood.
Results of a study of 15 Arab countries
found that 32 million people suffer from mal-
nutrition. This figure represents nearly 12 per
cent of the total population of the countries
concerned. The same studies found that even
in some of the wealthiest Arab states, such
as Kuwait and the United Arab Emirates,
certain population groups are not adequately
nourished.
Between 1990-1992 and 1998-2000, i.e. in
the first stages of the hunger eradication policy
adopted at the Rome Conference, the absolute
numbers of hungry people in the Arab world
increased by more than six million. The worst
results were observed in Iraq and Somalia
(Rafia Ghobash, background paper for this
Report).
The right to a healthy life
The World Health Organization defines health
as “a state of complete physical, mental and so-
cial well-being.”
Physical health
Arab countries have made great strides in
reducing mortality rates, especially infant
mortality rates, but the goal of health, in the
comprehensive and positive sense of the above
definition, has not yet been attained.
Progress in reducing mortality rates is
generally reflected in improved life expectancy
at birth. Over time this indicator has risen at
varying rates in Arab countries and in some
“wealthy” ones it has now reached a level ap-
proximating that in industrialised countries.
However, physical illness still takes years off
the life of the ordinary Arab individual, as may
be seen from a comparison of the standard
formula used to estimate life expectancy at
birth with a modified version of that formula
developed by the World Health Organization.
The latter is known as “HALE”, for “health-
adjusted life expectancy at birth”, which
excludes years of illness from the estimate.
Applying the HALE formula in Arab countries
for which data are available, we see that illness
reduces average healthy life expectancy at birth
by ten years or more. Noticeably, in all those
countries, the reduction is greater for women
than for men by a matter of two years or more.
This shows that women suffer a relatively
greater health deprivation. Clearly, according
to available data, reductions in life expectancy
at birth in Arab countries are higher than in all
the comparator countries featured, particularly
for women. The gap between men and women
is larger in most Arab countries than in the ma-
jority of comparator countries, figure 3-3.
Between 1990-1992
and 1998-2000…the
absolute numbers of
hungry people in the
Arab world increased
by more than six
million.
Figure 3-3
Years of life expectancy lost to disease, by gender, Arab countries and compara-
tor countries, 2002
Source: The World Health Organization Report, 2003
96 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
The fact that years of life are lost to ill-
ness reflects relatively low levels of human
development in Arab countries. A broad
stratum of the population of any given Arab
country lives in difficult socio-economic con-
ditions with respect to employment, housing
and living standards; people are under heavy
pressure in economic terms. In social terms,
the relationship of the individual to the state
and the society to which he or she belongs is
characterised by a feeling of lack of esteem,
exclusion and marginalization, resulting in
constant psychological pressure. Research has
shown that psychological pressure of this kind,
arising from social, economic and political fac-
tors, brings about biological changes, which
in turn may cause physical and psychological
infirmity. Studies have found that a person
who lives under such circumstances is at risk
of hormonal imbalance, nervous breakdown
and even immune system failure.
Psychological health
Individuals who are continuously subjugated,
insecure and marginalized bottle up various
forms of violence. As authoritarian pressure
grows, quietism and withdrawal become more
pronounced, along with a sense of fatalism and
submissiveness. Many studies in the field of
psychology have found a growing incidence of
anxiety and tension among Arab people, giv-
ing rise to unpredictable, despairing forms of
behaviour as the individual involved attempts
to relieve the tension, unaware that its causes
are rooted in deprivation and the fact that his/
her basic needs, most notably the need for se-
curity, are unsatisfied. There is undoubtedly a
connection between fully achieving one’s per-
sonal potential through participating in devel-
opment on the one hand, and feeling secure on
the other. Accordingly, the Arab individual’s
feeling of security may be expected to dete-
riorate in line with his/her increasingly acute
awareness of deprivation at many levels, and
this explains the prevalence of anxiety disor-
ders, tension and inability to achieve self-fulfil-
ment (Rafia Ghobash, background paper for
this Report).
The right to acquire knowledge
A prerequisite for fulfilment of the right to
acquire knowledge is an active, vital system
for spreading knowledge through four social
processes: upbringing, education, media and
translation. The second AHDR documented
various inadequacies in those processes in
Arab countries and proposed ways of address-
ing the situation. Accordingly, we shall not go
into the issue in detail here. In general, the
profile of deprivation of the right to acquire
knowledge in Arab countries is similar to that
outlined above in the case of health. This, too,
is a distinctive feature of the state of human
development in Arab countries.
Consider education, for example. There
has been appreciable quantitative progress
in access to education in Arab countries,
although the significance of that accomplish-
ment is marred by the persistence of unac-
ceptable levels of illiteracy (approximately one
third of the men and half the women in 2002),
and the fact that some Arab children, albeit
only a small percentage, are still denied their
fundamental right to basic education.
However, education in Arab countries is
essentially flawed by its poor quality. People
who have been to school often lack the cogni-
tive skills of learning, criticism and analysis,
while their creativity has not been encouraged.
These are indispensable for the acquisition
of knowledge, and even more indispensable
for producing it. Moreover, little emphasis is
placed on science and technology in curricula.
Consequently, as with deprivation of the right
to health (in the comprehensive sense), dep-
rivation of the right to acquire knowledge,
quantitatively and qualitatively, reflects a social
profile that discriminates against the most dis-
advantaged social groups, especially women
and the poor.
The quality of education and health
services in Arab countries
According to the results of the Freedom
Survey, Annex 1, education services were
considered satisfactory to a large degree and
public education services were adjudged of
higher quality than the private counterpart,
in Jordan, Morocco and Algeria. Nevertheless,
Education in Arab
countries is essentially
flawed by its poor
quality.
As authoritarian
pressure grows,
quietism and
withdrawal become
more pronounced,
along with a sense
of fatalism and
submissiveness.
97 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
the cost of private education was considered
less satisfactory compared to public education
(figure 3-4). The quality of health care services
provided by the government was considered
lower than that of private providers, with in-
terviewees consistently complaining of rising
costs of private health care. Thus the poorest
and most vulnerable sectors of society, in ad-
dition to being financially disadvantaged, are
further penalized in acquiring the two basic
human capabilities, particularly health.
PERCEIVED ENJOYMENT OF
FREEDOM IN CONTEMPORARY
ARAB OPINION, FREEDOM
SURVEY 2003
THE PERCEPTION OF FREEDOM
AMONG CONTEMPORARY ARABS
This section utilizes the results of the Freedom
Survey, Annex 1, to profile perceptions of
freedom among contemporary Arabs. The
survey questionnaire included a section where
interviewees were asked whether any of a large
number (35 elements) of components of free-
dom, derived from the concept presented in
Chapter 1, formed part of their perception of
freedom.
Figure 3-5 summarizes the results of this
aspect of the Freedom Survey.
3

Survey interviewees agreed that their
concept of freedom incorporated the majority
of these elements. In one case, interviewees
favoured a majority of the elements by a very
large margin (75% or more).
Interviewees perceived liberation from for-
eign occupation and the freedoms of opinion,
expression and movement as the most impor-
tant components of freedom. They gave least
importance to the right of ‘minorities’ to self-
rule. A lower level of importance was attached
to having a significant political opposition able
Figure 3-4
Extent of satisfaction with the level and cost of education and health services by sector (public/private), five Arab countries,
Freedom Survey, 2003
3
Ratios are calculated relative to the total number of interviewees (including missing observations), and arranged in figure 3-5b in descending order
according to their relative importance in the Palestine survey.
Interviewees perceived
liberation from foreign
occupation and the
freedoms of opinion,
expression and
movement as the most
important components
of freedom.
98 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
BOX 3-6
Freedom Survey, Arab Human Development Report
In an effort to overcome the deficient meas-
urement of freedom in Arab countries em-
ployed in AHDR 1 and 2, and to better serve
the rich concept of freedom adopted in this
report, the Report team, in collaboration
with Arab institutions specializing in polls
and surveys, designed a special field survey.
It set out to gauge Arab attitudes towards
freedom, and seek people’s views on the ex-
tent to which various freedoms are enjoyed
in their countries. The design called for poll-
ing nationally representative samples of Arab
citizens, aged 18 years and older, selected to
ensure proportional representation of both
men and women.
While it was hoped to conduct the survey
in a large number of Arab countries, this was
likely unrealistic given the constraints facing
field research in the region. Restrictions on
freedom of research and knowledge acqui-
sition on the one hand, and scarce data and
information on human development on the
other, remain real challenges in the region.
Yet what information can be drawn from the
survey still augments current knowledge.
Chastened by previous experience, the
Survey team did not try to implement the sur-
vey in some Arab countries. At least one Arab
country (Egypt) refused to grant a permit for
the survey.
At the time of writing, survey results were
available only for five Arab countries (Alge-
ria, Jordan, Lebanon, Morocco, Palestine)
comprising about one quarter of the Arab
population, more than 70 million, in both the
Arab East and West. Annex 1 contains details
of the survey and its findings.
Undoubtedly, the scope of this survey
falls short of a comprehensive representation
of the Arab public. On a more positive note,
its findings on perceptions of freedom among
the sample countries are nonetheless instruc-
tive. Hopefully, the time will come when such
studies are much easier to conduct, to the
benefit of both knowledge and freedom.
Note: Ratios presented in the graphs derived from survey results are calculated relative to the total number of interviewees (including missing
observations).
Figure 3-5a
Percentage of interviewees considering the elements of freedom part of their concept of freedom (%)
Average of five Arab countries (weighted by population), Freedom Survey, 2003
99 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
to influence decision-making; and to the right
to form opposition groups. This may indicate
rather conservative attitudes or frustration
with the present political situation.
There were noticeable differences in the
results obtained among the five countries,
whether in the degree to which interviewees
considered the elements of freedom as pre-
sented part of their concept of freedom, or in
the relative preferences given to some elements
over others. The Lebanese, followed by the
Palestinians and then by the Algerians, were
more strongly inclined to see almost all these
elements as part of their own notion of free-
dom. One might therefore say that the concept
of freedom in Lebanon, Palestine, and Algeria
is broader and also more intensely in evidence
than in Morocco and Jordan.
Citizens of the five countries were clearly
of one mind regarding the priority they give to
national liberation from occupation, military
bases, and foreign influence; to freedom of
thought, belief, opinion and expression; to
freedom from hunger, poverty and ignorance;
to equality before the law and between the
sexes, and to combating corruption. They
considered all these to be important elements
in their concept of freedom.
Freedom and independence of the media
and civil society organizations emerged as a
priority in Algeria, Palestine and Lebanon.
All these are fundamental elements of the
concept of freedom and good governance, as
adopted by the AHDR.
There were noticeable
differences in the
results obtained
among the five
countries.
Figure 3-5b
Percentage of interviewees considering the elements of freedom constituents of their concept of freedom
Five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
100 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
EXTENT OF ENJOYMENT OF
FREEDOM AT THE TIME OF THE
SURVEY (2003)
Interviewees in all five countries indicated
that, in their view, the level of enjoyment of
individual freedoms was comparatively high,
whereas the enjoyment of ‘public’ freedoms
was relatively low, especially as regards good
governance.
Freedoms of movement, marriage and
ownership of property, and the freedom of
‘minorities’ to practice their own culture
headed the list of elements of freedom enjoyed
in the five countries. The existence of effective
opposition, the independence of the media and
the judiciary, transparency and accountability
of governance, and combating corruption were
put at the low end of the scale of enjoyment.
These results can be viewed as constituting
a set of priorities for the reform of freedom and
governance in Arab countries.
Interviewees’ opinions varied among the
five countries, reflecting their respective char-
acteristics and situations (figure 3-6b).
PERCEIVED CHANGE IN THE
ENJOYMENT OF FREEDOM IN
CONTEMPORARY ARAB OPINION
The Freedom Survey questionnaire, Annex 1,
contains questions on the interviewees’ percep-
tion of the extent of change (improvement or
deterioration) in the enjoyment of the elements
of freedom during the five years preceding the
survey.
In the interviewees’ estimation, the state of
freedom in Arab countries has generally dete-
riorated during that period. They considered
that enjoyment of most elements of freedom
deteriorated in the five years preceding the
survey with some improvements in individual
Figure 3-6a
Extent of enjoyment of the elements of freedom (%), average of five Arab countries (weighted by population), Freedom Survey, 2003
…the level of
enjoyment of
individual freedoms
was comparatively
high, whereas the
enjoyment of ‘public’
freedoms was
relatively low.
101 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
freedoms. The results of this aspect of the
study are given in figures 3-7a and 3.7b.
4
Interviewees considered that the greatest
improvement had been achieved in the enjoy-
ment of individual freedoms regarding gender
equality and marriage, freedom of thought,
freedom from ignorance and disease, freedom
of ‘minorities’ to practice own culture, and
freedom of civil and co-operative organisa-
tions. However, interviewees perceived the
greatest deterioration in five areas reflecting
bad governance -- corruption, lack of transpar-
ency and accountability in governance, lack
of independence of the judiciary, inequality
before the law and mounting poverty, figure
3-7a.
Some of the results reflect the distinctive
characteristics of the various countries in
which the survey was conducted (figure 3-7b).
In general, the percentage of interviewees who
4
Ratios are calculated relative to the total number of interviewees (including missing observations), and arranged in figure 3-7b in descending order
according to the relative importance in the Palestine survey.
Some of the results
reflect the distinctive
characteristics of the
various countries in
which the survey was
conducted .
Figure 3-6b
Extent of enjoyment of the elements of freedom (%), average of five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
102 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
considered that the enjoyment of freedom had
deteriorated was greater than the percentage
of those who considered that it had improved.
This was especially marked among Palestin-
ian interviewees, whose answers reflected the
deterioration of their plight with respect to
occupation and foreign influence and freedom
of movement within their country. In con-
trast, most Lebanese interviewees indicated
that in their view, there had been a relative
improvement in their situation with respect
to occupation and foreign influence, prob-
ably because of the Israeli withdrawal from
southern Lebanon. Lebanese and Palestinian
interviewees alike complained of deterioration
in the components of good governance citing
weaker opposition, less transparency, and little
possibility of holding authorities accountable
or of combating corruption.
Algerian interviewees, for their part,
perceived some gains in the freedom of mi-
norities to use their language, while Lebanese
interviewees considered the situation had im-
proved with respect to freedom of movement
within the country, equality between men and
women, and freedom of marriage. Moroccans
alone considered that there had been some
improvement in the effort to combat poverty.
They also stated that in their view, gender
equality had improved.
Figure 3-7a
Perceived change in the enjoyment of elements of freedom (net %) during the five years preceding the survey, average of five Arab
countries (weighted by population), Freedom Survey, 2003
Palestinian
interviewees’
answers reflected the
deterioration of their
plight.
103 THE STATE OF FREEDOMS AND RIGHTS
Figure 3-7b
Perceived change in the enjoyment of elements of freedom (net %) during the five years preceding the survey, average of five
Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
105
Part II
Reinforcing Freedom and Establishing
Good Governance
Section 3: The Societal Context of
Freedom and Governance
This section aims at explaining the deficit in freedom and good govern-
ance in Arab countries at present through an analysis of the determi-
nants of the state of freedom and governance covering the institutional
(legal and political) structure and the societal context, including the ex-
ternal environment.
CHAPTER FOUR
The Legal Architecture
THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE 107
Introduction
Among the institutional prerequisites of free-
dom and good governance, respect for the
fair enforcement of a legal structure that pro-
tects liberties takes decisive precedence. An
analysis of the legal structure of freedom and
governance is therefore key in explaining the
current deterioration in the status of freedom
and governance in Arab countries. Chapter
Four traces and illustrates the origins of re-
strictions on freedom that are embedded in
the legal provisions of constitutions, and
which impact the autonomy of legal institu-
tions.
This chapter explores two basic questions:
What are the salient features of Arab legisla-
tion on public freedoms and human rights?
What key variations exist between different
legal standards?
The concept of freedoms and rights applied
here is that of the various human rights instru-
ments, including the UDHR, the ICCPR, the
ICESCR and numerous conventions and dec-
larations relating to different human rights.
In discussing Arab legal systems, we shall ex-
amine different levels of legislation beginning
with international rules by which the Arab
states are bound, followed by the rules of con-
stitutional law, ordinary legislation, regula-
tory rules and finally the practices of various
State authorities, in particular the executive.
THE INSTITUTIONAL
ARCHITECTURE OF FREEDOM
AND GOVERNANCE
Two sets of discrepancies commonly mar Arab
legislation concerned with different levels of
freedom and human rights. The first set re-
flects a gap between international norms and
national constitutions and one between those
national constitutions and national laws. The
second set reflects a breach between interna-
tional norms, national constitutions and na-
tional laws on the one side, and actual practice
on the other.
By no means all of the international human
rights commitments of Arab states are incor-
porated in domestic legislation or applied in
practice. Some Arab regimes seek to exonerate
themselves on the international stage and to
conceal violations of citizens’ rights by embrac-
ing international human rights standards and
signing the appropriate treaties. In addition,
many Arab constitutions contain safeguards
for citizens’ freedoms and fundamental rights,
which are rarely fully reflected in ordinary leg-
islation. Finally, many safeguards prescribed
by ordinary legislation may not be respected in
practice and are violated in the absence of any
legal sanction or effective monitoring mecha-
nisms. This is discussed in detail below.
ARAB STATES AND
INTERNATIONAL HUMAN RIGHTS
STANDARDS
Arab states are bound by a number of the
principal international human rights instru-
ments, some having ratified or signed two such
key instruments, namely the ICCPR and the
ICESCR. The United Arab Emirates, Bahrain,
Saudi Arabia, Oman and Qatar, however, have
ratified neither, and the First Optional Protocol
to the first Covenant
1
, providing additional
rights for individuals, has been signed only
by Algeria, Djibouti, Somalia and Libya. The
majority of Arab states have ratified the CAT,
apart from the United Arab Emirates, Syria,
1
The Protocols to human rights treaties are important in that they provide effective mechanisms to monitor human rights violations within the State,
enabling individual victims to submit complaints of violations committed by the State directly to the specialized Committee.
Some Arab regimes
seek to exonerate
themselves on the
international stage
and to conceal
violations of citizens’
rights by embracing
international human
rights standards.
108 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Iraq, Mauritania and the Sudan, which has,
however, signed it. Neither the Sudan, Somalia,
Oman nor Qatar has signed the CEDAW. No
Arab State has signed its Optional Protocol.
Only Jordan and Djibouti have ratified the
Statute of the International Criminal Court, al-
though nine states have signed it, table 4-1.
By and large, Arab states have paid scant
regard to International Labour Organization
(ILO) conventions relating to trade unions,
the freedom of trade union organization and
the protection of trade union rights, other than
in a few cases, and then mostly in connection
with a limited number of conventions. Arab
states seem content to ratify certain interna-
tional human rights treaties, but do not go
so far as to recognize the role of international
mechanisms in making human rights effective.
The proof lies in their position towards the
rights enshrined in the ICCPR. While most
have ratified the Covenant, they have not rati-
fied its first Optional Protocol. This impedes
the work of the Human Rights Committee
established under the Covenant, as it is thus
confined to considering the official reports
of states on their implementation of the Cov-
enant’s provisions and has no opportunity to
receive complaints of violations from citizens,
whether directly or through non-governmental
organizations (NGOs), when rights are vio-
lated by an Arab state which has not ratified
the Protocol. Furthermore, most Arab states
have shown no interest in acceding to the in-
ternational conventions relating to union rights
and freedoms.
Country
International
Covenant on
Economic,
Social and
Cultural
Rights
(CESCR)
International
Covenant
on Civil and
Political
Rights
(CCPR)
Optional
Protocol
to the
International
Covenant
on Civil and
Political
Rights
(CCPR-OP1)
Second
Optional
Protocol
to the
International
Covenant
on Civil and
Political
Rights
(CCPR-OP2)
International
Convention
on the
Elimination
of All Forms
of Racial
Discrimination
(CERD)
Convention
on the
Elimination of
All Forms of
Discrimination
against
Women
(CEDAW)
Optional
Protocol to the
Convention
on the
Elimination of
All Forms of
Discrimination
against
Women
(CEDAW-OP)
Convention
against
Torture and
Other Cruel,
Inhuman or
Degrading
Treatment
or
Punishment
(CAT)
Optional
Protocol
to the
Convention
against
Torture and
Other Cruel,
Inhuman or
Degrading
Treatment
or
Punishment
(CAT-OP)
Convention
on the
Rights of
the Child
(CRC)
Optional
Protocol
to the
Convention
on the
Rights of the
Child-
the involve-
ment of
children
in armed
conflict
(CRC-OP-AC)
Optional
Protocol
to the
Convention
on the
Rights of the
Child-
the sale of
children,
child prosti-
tution and
child por-
nography
(CRC-OP-SC)
International
Convention
on the
Protection of
the Rights of
All Migrant
Workers and
Members
of Their
Families
(MWC)
Algeria 12 Sep 89* 12 Sep 89 12 Sep 89* 14 Feb 72 22 May 96* 12 Sep 89 16 Apr 93
Bahrain 27 Mar 90* 18 Jun 02* 06 Mar 98* 13 Feb 92* 21 Sep 04* 21 Sep 04*
Comoros 27 Sep 04** 31 Oct 94* 22 Sep 00** 22 Jun 93 22 Sep 00**
Djibouti 05 Nov 02* 05 Nov 02* 05 Nov 02* 05 Nov 02* 02 Dec 98* 05 Nov 02* 06 Dec 90
Egypt 14 Jan 82 14 Jan 82 01 May 67 18 Sep 81 25 Jun 86* 06 Jul 90 12 Jul 02* 19 Feb 93*
Iraq 25 Jan 71 25 Jan 71 14 Jan 70 13 Aug 86* 15 Jun 94
Jordan 28 May 75 28 May 75 30 May 74 01 Jul 92 13 Nov 91* 24 May 91 06 Sep 00** 06 Sep 00**
Kuwait 21 May 96* 21 May 96* 15 Oct 68* 02 Sep 94* 08 Mar 96* 21 Oct 91 26 Aug 04* 26 Aug 04*
Lebanon 03 Nov 72* 03 Nov 72* 12 Nov 71* 21 Apr 97* 05 Oct 00* 14 May 91 11 Feb 02* 10 Oct 01
Libya 15 May 70* 15 May 70* 16 May 89* 03 Jul 68* 16 May 89* 18 Jun 04* 16 May 89* 15 Apr 93* 29 Oct 04* 18 Jun 04* 18 Jun 04*
Mauritania 17 Nov 04* 13 Dec 88 10 May 01* 17 Nov 04* 16 May 91
Morocco 03 May 79 03 May 79 18 Dec 70 21 Jun 93* 21 Jun 93 21 Jun 93 22 May 02 02 Oct 01 21 Jun 93
Oman 02 Jan 03* 09 Dec 96* 17 Sep 04* 17 Sep 04*
Qatar 21 Aug 76a 10 Feb 00a 03 May 95 25 Aug 02a 18 Jan 02a
Saudi Arabia 23 Sep 97* 07 Sep 00 22 May 02* 26 Jan 96*
Somalia 24 Jan 90* 24 Jan 90* 24 Jan 90* 26 Aug 75 24 Jan 90* 09 May 02**
Sudan 18 Mar 86* 18 Mar 76* 21 Mar 77* 04 Jun 86** 03 Aug 90 09 May 02* 02 Nov 04*
Syria 21 Apr 69* 21 Apr 69* 21 Apr 69* 28 Mar 03* 19 Aug 04 15 Jul 93 17 Oct 03 15 May 03
Tunisia 18 Mar 69 18 Mar 69 13 Jan 67 20 Sep 85 23 Sep 88 30 Jan 92 02 Jan 03 13 Sep 02
UAE 20 Jun 74* 06 Oct 04* 03 Jan 97*
Yemen 09 Feb 87* 09 Feb 87* 18 Oct 72* 30 May 84* 05 Nov 91* 01 May 91 15 Dec 04
TABLE 4-1
Status of Ratifications of the Principal International Human Rights Treaties, January 2005
Notes:
The dates listed refer to the date of ratification, unless followed by: “*” signifies accession, “**” signifies signature only.
Source: (Office of the United Nations High Commissioner For Human Rights).
Most Arab states have
shown no interest in
acceding to international
conventions relating
to union rights and
freedoms.
109 THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE
LEGISLATIVE REGULATION
OF FREEDOMS IN ARAB
CONSTITUTIONS
LAW AND JUSTICE, PUBLIC ORDER
AND NATIONAL SECURITY AS
EXCUSES TO LIMIT FREEDOM
People do not allow legislators to pass whatever
laws they please, especially laws contradicting
freedom, unless they live under a harsh or des-
potic governance regime. Indeed, justice, as a
standard for evaluating legislation, occupies a
clear and important place in public affairs and
has been the subject of considerable philo-
sophical, religious, moral and legal discussion
down the ages.
The standards and instruments of justice
and freedom, as enshrined in the international
legal and human rights system, have evolved
from the laborious endeavours of humanity to
develop a normative framework that controls
the national legislator. The latter is not at lib-
erty to bend the law to serve autocrats and vio-
late human rights and public freedoms. Right
is always above the legislative authority.
Nevertheless, many national legal systems
twist various concepts to circumvent freedom
and justice. These systems often invoke higher
national considerations, which are held up
as sacrosanct even if they affect the rights
and freedoms of the public and individuals.
Both the concept of public order and that of
national security lend themselves to abuse, if
interpreted wilfully. Invoking public order, the
State can limit civil and commercial freedoms.
By citing national security, it can justify any
action it wishes, even those that infringe indi-
vidual freedoms.
OVERVIEW OF ARAB
CONSTITUTIONS
The move to adopt constitutions as high-level
legal instruments to which all state authorities
are subject and by which state legislation is
governed has extended to all Arab countries,
though some such as Saudi Arabia (1992), and
Oman (1996) were slower to do so. All pro-
vide for the protection of public freedoms and
human rights. Measures taken to include certain
rights and freedoms in constitutions and har-
monize them with relevant international instru-
ments are a welcome development, but more
important is that they should be safeguarded
in ordinary legislation, together with the condi-
tions that secure them in actual practice.
Arab constitutions generally regard the
people as the source and holder of sovereignty,
apart from the Constitutions of Kuwait, Jordan
and Morocco, which employ the term “nation”,
which requires extending the circle of partici-
pation and strengthening accountability and
oversight. Popular sovereignty theoretically
increases opportunities for the people to have a
say in the management of public affairs.
Arab constitutions refer to the principle of
equal rights and public duties before the law
and to the protection and assurance of fun-
damental rights and freedoms. The substance
of those rights, however, varies along with the
scope of freedom and protection in accordance
with each state’s cultural and liberal heritage,
the extent to which it adopts the principles of
democracy and civil and political freedoms,
and the overall religious or secular influence
on the state’s system of governance. The provi-
sion for freedoms in national constitutions is
an essential stage in the ascent of freedom to
the point where it is constitutionally regulated,
the constitution being the primary legal instru-
ment in the hierarchy of legal rules.
Arab constitutions commonly prioritize
rights and freedoms, placing them after the
preamble and the initial section on fundamen-
tal provisions and principles. Some countries,
however, have gone further and, have explicitly
declared their commitment to the rights con-
tained in international instruments, as decreed
in article 5 of the Constitution of Yemen and
the preamble to the Constitution of Morocco.
FREEDOM OF OPINION AND
EXPRESSION
Many Arab constitutions
2
include special pro-
visions on freedom of thought, opinion and
2
The Constitutions of Tunisia (article 8), Algeria (article 30), Morocco (section 9), the Sudan (section 1), Jordan (article 15), Kuwait (article 36), Yemen
(article 26), Mauritania (article 10), the United Arab Emirates (article 30), Egypt (article 47), Bahrain (article 23) and Lebanon (article 13).
Both the concept of
public order and that
of national security
lend themselves to
abuse, if interpreted
wilfully.
Arab constitutions
generally regard
the people as the
source and holder of
sovereignty.
110 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
belief, varying from concise to detailed refer-
ences, according to the general style of the con-
stitution itself. Few constitutions contain no
reference to freedom of thought and opinion,
although the Interim Constitution of Qatar,
(article 13) simply states: “Freedom of publica-
tion and the press is guaranteed in accordance
with the law.” The Saudi Arabian Basic Law
adopts an extremely conservative approach
to freedom of opinion and expression, stipu-
lating, in article 39, that the information and
publishing media, as well as all other means of
expression, shall employ courteous language
and comply with state regulations.
FREEDOM TO FORM
ASSOCIATIONS AND FREEDOM OF
PEACEFUL ASSEMBLY
Arab constitutions contain special provisions
on freedom of peaceful assembly, association
and affiliation. The overall concept of associa-
tion also includes political associations (par-
ties) and professional associations (unions).
The right to form and join associations is
essential to the exercise of freedom of opinion
and expression, as well as to other freedoms
and rights which people sharing the same opin-
ions or interests cannot fully exercise without
joint efforts. A study of the relevant Arab con-
stitutional texts, however, reveals discrepancies
between the provisions which encompass those
rights; some constitutions provide for the right
of association, without mentioning parties or
trade unions, as in article 33 of the Constitution
of the United Arab Emirates. Others elaborate
in more detail on the freedom to form associa-
tions and unions but remain silent about the
freedom to form political parties, as in article
27 of the Constitution of Bahrain.
Arab constitutions assign regulation of
the right of association to ordinary legislation,
which tends to restrict the right under the guise
of regulation.
The constitution may also stipulate numer-
ous restrictions on the right of association in
order to safeguard national security or national
unity. The Egyptian Constitution thus recog-
nizes citizens’ right to form associations in the
manner prescribed by law and prohibits the
establishment of associations that are inimi-
cal to the order of society, secret or military in
nature. The Tunisian Constitution guarantees
the freedom to establish associations, pro-
vided it is exercised as regulated by law, and
also recognizes trade union rights. The Syrian
Constitution guarantees citizens’ right of as-
sociation and peaceful demonstration within
the framework of its principles, provided that
the exercise of that right is regulated by law.
The Bahraini Constitution provides that: “The
freedom to form associations and trade unions
on national principles, for legitimate objec-
tives and by peaceful means, is guaranteed in
accordance with the terms and conditions pre-
scribed by law, provided that the foundation of
religion and public order is not undermined…”
Other Arab constitutions, however, make no
provision for the right to form associations
(and trade unions), despite providing for most
political freedoms, as in the Constitutions of
Oman, Qatar and Saudi Arabia.
FREEDOM TO FORM POLITICAL
PARTIES
The right to form political parties is permitted
in 14 Arab countries. Libya and the member
states of the Gulf Cooperation Council (Saudi
Arabia, the United Arab Emirates, Qatar,
Bahrain, Kuwait and Oman) prohibit the for-
mation of political parties. Some states, which,
for many decades, adhered to the one-party
system have moved towards establishing the
multiparty system in their constitutions. While
this is an advance towards democracy and plu-
ralism, it is hampered by lingering traces from
the restrictive one-party phase, which detract
from these constitutions.
Some regimes, forced to abandon the one-
party system for pluralism at the end of the
1980s, also took care to place restrictions on
the exercise of such freedoms, with the result
that pluralism was in fact a continuation of the
BOX 4-1
The right to form political parties
Setting up a political party is not fun-
damentally contingent on a permit being
issued by the [executive] authority when
and as it wishes and withdrawing the
permit when the party falls from favour.
It is a fundamental right deriving directly
from the Constitution and other legal
texts defining the conditions. In this re-
spect the law has no function other than
to regulate the exercise of this right and
to provide it with the necessary elements
and conditions.
Extract from the Administrative
Court judgement in Case no 115, judicial
year 38, New Wafd Party v. the Govern-
ment, Egypt.
The Saudi Arabian
Basic Law adopts
an extremely
conservative approach
to freedom of opinion
and expression.
Some regimes, forced
to abandon the one-
party system for
pluralism…took care
to place restrictions on
the exercise of such
freedoms.
111 THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE
one-party system, as in Tunisia after 7 Novem-
ber 1987. In some constitutions, moreover,
the provisions relating to pluralism were
ambiguous and open to interpretation, as in
the Permanent Constitution of Egypt of 1971.
Although amendments made in 1980 to article
5 stipulated that “the political system in the
Arab Republic of Egypt shall be established on
a multiparty basis”, the Constitution continued
to refer to the coalition of the people’s work
force, representing the theoretical basis of the
sole political organization (the Arab Socialist
Union). This type of constitutional ambiguity
is clearly attributable to the changes that oc-
curred in the political and economic spheres,
but with no accompanying amendment of
constitutional values to reflect those changes.
Certain constitutional provisions therefore fail
to reflect the current reality.
THE HUMAN RIGHT TO
LITIGATION AND THE PRINCIPLE
OF THE INDEPENDENCE OF THE
JUDICIARY
The international perspective and the Arab
constitutional reality
Heading the list of civil rights is the human
right to litigation, together with the associated
guarantee of the independence of the judiciary
and assurance of the necessary procedural safe-
guards that secure the right to a fair trial, in ac-
cordance with articles 8 and 10 of the UDHR.
(Annex 3)
Similarly, article 14 of the ICCPR sets out
in some detail the elements of the human right
to litigation and the safeguards of that right in
terms of the principle of equality before courts
and tribunals, the right to a public hearing, the
impartiality and independence of the judiciary,
the right of defence and legal assistance, pre-
sumption of innocence and other principles re-
quired to make the right to fair trial operative.
Fair trial safeguards can generally be di-
vided into three closely related and interde-
pendent categories: institutional safeguards
embodied in the principle of the independence
of the judiciary, procedural safeguards set down
in a body of procedural principles essential to
protect the rights of litigants and the fairness of
trial, and objective safeguards embodied in the
requirement to respect a number of objective
principles during trial.
Recognizing that the independence of the
judiciary is an important institutional safe-
guard to protect freedom, the international
community has devoted considerable attention
to the principle. The 1983 World Conference
on the Independence of Justice, in Montreal
produced the Universal Declaration of the In-
dependence of Justice, which sets out detailed
requirements for the independence of the ju-
diciary. The most important elements include
that judges shall be free to decide matters im-
partially in accordance with their assessment
of the facts and their understanding of the law
without any restrictions, pressures, threats or
interference, direct or indirect, from any quar-
ter; and the judiciary shall be independent of
the executive and the legislature.
The Seventh United Nations Congress on
the Prevention of Crime and the Treatment of
Offenders (Milan, 1985) also adopted the Basic
Principles on the Independence of the Judici-
ary and called for them to be implemented at
the national and regional levels. These Princi-
ples are similar to those of the Montreal Decla-
ration, most importantly the principle that the
judiciary shall have exclusive authority to de-
cide whether a case submitted for its decision
is within its jurisdiction as defined by law. The
fifth principle also provides that everyone shall
have the right to be tried by ordinary courts
or tribunals using fair legal procedures and
that no tribunals shall be created that do not
apply the duly established procedures of the
legal process. The seventh principle calls for
the provision of adequate resources to enable
the judiciary to properly perform its functions.
Principles guaranteeing the independence
of the judiciary can generally be divided into
those relating to the independence of the ju-
dicial authority and those relating to judges as
individuals. As an independent authority, the
judiciary’s affairs are managed by a supreme
council composed of judges, which has exclu-
sive authority over all matters relating to the
budget, determining judges’ remuneration, the
appointment, discipline and transfer of judges,
allocation of work and all other matters relat-
ing to the administration of justice, without
The independence
of the judiciary is an
important institutional
safeguard to protect
freedom.
Judges shall be free
to decide matters
impartially…without
any restrictions,
pressures, threats or
interference, direct
or indirect, from any
quarter.
112 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
interference from the executive. The judicial
authority is embodied in the natural judici-
ary, which alone has jurisdiction to examine
lawsuits. Consequently, no form of exceptional
judiciary that displaces the jurisdiction belong-
ing to the judiciary can be created.
Judges as individuals are independent in
discharging their duties, which may under
no circumstances be subject to any form of
interference or influence. They may not be
intimidated by punishment or induced by
reward to settle disputes in a certain manner.
Consequently, judicial office may not be com-
bined with any executive and political office,
to ensure that judges are removed from any
context of partiality and bias. Judges cannot be
dismissed for reasons other than disciplinary;
additional safeguards are as indicated above.
The independence of the judiciary should
not be seen as an end in itself. It is a prereq-
uisite for ensuring the right to fair trial, a right
that obtains in no other way, even if other con-
ditions for a fair trial are satisfied.
Procedural safeguards for the right to
fair trial can be summed up in a number of
principles: there shall be no criminal punish-
ment unless a final judgement is rendered by a
properly constituted judicial court; crime and
punishment are personal; trials shall be con-
ducted without undue delay; no one may be
tried or punished twice for the same act; trials
shall be heard in public; the principle of oral
proceedings and the right of litigants to attend
trial proceedings (the principle of appearing in
person); trial proceedings shall be recorded;
and shall be restricted by the boundaries of
the case, whether in terms of the persons con-
cerned or its subject matter; the right to appeal
against judgements before a higher court; and
the principle that the appellant shall not be
prejudiced by her/his appeal.
The most important objective principles
guaranteeing the right to a fair trial, include:
presumption of innocence, or, in other words,
innocence as the rule; there shall be no crime
and no punishment other than in accordance
with a pre-existing law (nullum crimen, nulla
poena sine lege) that clearly and unquestion-
ably covers the conduct which is the subject
of the criminal offence; penal law shall be
non-retroactive; the right of the accused to ap-
plication of the most appropriate law; freedom
of defence and the guaranteed right to defence;
punishment shall fit the crime; and the opera-
tion of all such principles within the overall
framework of human rights principles, in par-
ticular equality and the sovereignty of the law.
On paper, Arab constitutions encompass
most of these principles and rules, following
a consistent line on the independence and
inviolability of the judiciary, that judges are
independent and, in their administration of
justice, subject to no authority other than
the law. Some constitutions even elaborate at
length, highlighting the status of judges, the
importance of their independence and the
rights of litigants, as in the Egyptian Constitu-
tion, which devotes the whole of chapter IV,
consisting of nine articles (articles 64-72), to
the subject. Article 147 of the Yemeni Consti-
tution provides for the independence of both
the judiciary as an authority and judges as
individuals, stipulating that: “The judiciary is
an independent judicial, financial and admin-
istrative authority and the Office of the Public
Prosecutor is one of its organs. The courts shall
assume responsibility for the settlement of all
disputes and offences and judges shall be inde-
pendent and subject to no authority other than
the law in their administration of justice. No
party may in any way interfere in lawsuits or
in any affair of justice. Such interference shall
be regarded as an offence punishable by law
and legal proceedings relating to such offences
shall not lapse by statute of limitation.”
It is interesting to note that while a number
of Arab constitutions refer to the independ-
ence of judges and not to the independence
of the judiciary, others
3
do refer to the inde-
pendence of the judiciary. Such variations are,
however, of little significance, since all Arab
judicial systems have lost their independence
to some degree or other by virtue of the execu-
tive’s historical domination over Arab society
3
The Yemeni Constitution, the Saudi Arabian Basic Law and the Syrian Constitution, do refer to the independence of the judiciary (compare, for
example, article 97 of the Jordanian Constitution, article 96 of the Tunisian Constitution, article 82 of the Moroccan Constitution, article 94 of the
Constitution of the United Arab Emirates and article 104 of the Constitution of Bahrain, which refer to the independence of judges or the judiciary,
with article 46 of the Saudi Arabian Basic Law, which provides that the judiciary is an independent authority and that judges shall be subject to no
authority in their administration of justice other than that of Islamic law (Shari’a), article 165 of the Egyptian Constitution, which provides that the
judiciary is independent, and article 131 of the Syrian Constitution, which also provides that the judiciary is independent and that this is guaranteed
by the President of the Republic).
The independence of
the judiciary should
not be seen as an
end in itself. It is
a prerequisite for
ensuring the right to
fair trial.
All Arab judicial
systems have lost
their independence
to some degree or
other by virtue of the
executive’s historical
domination over Arab
society.
113 THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE
and its sway over both the legislature and the
judiciary.
While they may contain significant
provisions establishing the principle of the
independence of judges, Arab constitutions
nevertheless maintain the executive pres-
ence within the judiciary and its institutions.
Hence, not only are judgements delivered
and enforced in the name of the head of state
(of whatever designation or title), but also the
head of state is additionally vested with the
right to preside over the constitutional bod-
ies that oversee the judiciary. Morocco is an
instance: article 86 of the Constitution (1996)
provides that: “The King shall preside over
the Supreme Council of the Judiciary…”. The
King also appoints judges by royal decree at
the proposal of the Supreme Council of the
Judiciary (article 84). Meanwhile, article 173
of the Egyptian Constitution provides that
the President of the Republic shall preside
over the Supreme Council of Judicial Organs.
Article 100 of the Sudanese Constitution also
provides that the judiciary is responsible for its
actions before the President of the Republic
and article 132 of the Syrian Constitution
provides that the President of the Republic
shall preside over the Supreme Council of the
Judiciary. Other examples of the unbalanced
relationship favouring the executive over the
judiciary will be discussed when we examine
legislative violations and the social reality of
the independence of the judiciary.
Many Arab constitutions also stipulate
safeguards for fair trial, such as the principles
of criminal legitimacy in particular and the fair-
ness of trial in general. In the absence of either,
a trial is rendered unlawful and unfair, in addi-
tion to which any completed trial proceedings
are invalid and both procedures and any judge-
ments handed down are void. They are also
rendered ineffective, if delivered pursuant to
procedures incompatible with the principles of
the rights system stipulated in the constitution,
and they are regarded as a violation of human
rights before the judiciary.
The legal profession and public freedoms
Independent, proficient lawyers give substance
to the legal profession’s obvious concern with
protection of public freedoms, human rights
and guarantees for the rights of defence. The
independence of the legal profession and the
freedom of lawyers has been a subject of signifi-
cant interest to the international community; as
early as 1955, the International Commission of
Jurists organized a conference in Athens to ad-
dress key issues on the rule of law, and which
issued a declaration that: “Lawyers of the world
should preserve the independence of their pro-
fession, assert the rights of the individual under
the Rule of Law…”. In Oslo, the Congress of
the Union Internationale des Avocats adopted
a resolution introduced by the Arab Lawyers’
Union, urging international organizations to
launch a wide-ranging campaign to defend the
independence of the legal profession and the
freedom of lawyers. The Universal Declaration
on the Independence of Judges (Montreal,
1983), the third section of which is devoted
to principles guaranteeing the independence
of the legal profession and the freedom, safe-
guards and rights of lawyers was a major inter-
national achievement for the legal profession.
The Seventh United Nations Congress on
the Prevention of Crime and the Treatment
of Offenders (Milan, 1985) produced recom-
mendations relating to the legal profession that
called for lawyers’ protection from restrictions
and controls that could influence their defence
of their clients. They also called for greater at-
tention to lawyers’ training and strengthening
professional skills.
Independence of the legal profession is
generally understood to include independence
of the professional institution and lawyers as
professional practitioners of the right of de-
fence. The independence of the professional
institution guarantees lawyers the right to form
an independent professional union free from
State interference. The independence of the
lawyer in exercising her/his profession requires
a body of legal safeguards to enable her/him to
fulfil the duty of defence.
Some Arab states still do not permit
lawyers’ unions or associations to be set up.
Historically, certain Arab regimes were hostile
to lawyers’ unions, a position not unrelated to
their hostility towards freedoms in general.
One example is the Egyptian Government’s
intervention in the 1980s to dissolve the Bar
Arab constitutions
nevertheless maintain
the executive’s
presence within
the judiciary and its
institutions.
Historically, certain
Arab regimes were
hostile to lawyers’
unions, a position
not unrelated to their
hostility towards
freedoms in general.
114 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Council of the Egyptian Bar Association and
form a council to manage the Union’s affairs
(under Act No. 125 of 1981). Libya had al-
ready abolished the legal profession as such,
eliminating the Bar Association under Act
No. 3 of 1981, while the Syrian authorities had
promulgated Legislative Decree No. 39 of 21
August 1981 regulating the legal profession so
as to place it under excessive constraints.
In Arab legislation the presence of a lawyer
at the preliminary investigation is not consid-
ered mandatory, other than for a number of
major criminal offences (felonies). The dif-
ferent forms of exceptional judiciary impose
restrictions on lawyers’ exercise of the right to
defence as well as on the right of appeal.
Some Arab legal and judicial systems suf-
fer structural defects, with poor standards of
education in law faculties given the massive
increase in the number of students, so that
many who join the legal profession lack pro-
ficiency. Other defects include corruption in
the administrative apparatus supporting the
courts, all of which contributes to denying the
Arab citizen’s right to litigation and appropri-
ate legal advice to permit the full exercise of
the right of defence.
Most Arab states have no effective systems
of legal aid for the needy, even if guaranteed
under constitutional or legislative provisions.
In reality, the least financially able are also the
least able to enjoy the right of defence or ben-
efit from appropriate legal advice.
RIGHT OF NATIONALITY
Nationality is one of the more complex areas of
civil rights. It gives a person the legal status that
confers rights and duties and helps her/him to
acquire full citizenship. International instru-
ments therefore prescribe that: “everyone has
the right to a nationality” and that “no one
shall be arbitrarily deprived of his nationality
nor denied the right to change his nationality.”
There is a noticeable difference between the
status of this right and the situation of those
who benefit from it in Arab countries; some
constitutions remain silent on the subject,
while others refer the matter of its regulation to
the law, as in Egypt (article 6), Lebanon (article
6), Jordan (article 5), Saudi Arabia (article 35)
and Algeria (article 30). In addition, some con-
stitutions allow for its forfeiture and provide
the conditions required, as in Qatar (article 4),
Oman (article 15), the United Arab Emirates
(article 8) and Kuwait (article 27).
It is generally recognized that standards
for conferring the original nationality vary
between the right based on blood relations
(i.e. with either parent holding the nationality
of the state) or on the basis of the actual place
of birth. A new trend is emerging in some Arab
countries of granting original nationality to the
children of a mother bearing the nationality of
the state. This is commendable as it recognizes
the principle of equality between mother and
father in securing the nationality of their chil-
dren and ends the misery that arises from the
state denying nationality to the children, where
the mother is married to a foreign national.
PERSONAL RIGHTS
Civil rights also include those affecting the per-
son, private life and dignity of the individual.
International standards emphasize respect for
these rights, as in article 17 of the ICCPR, which
states that: “No one shall be subjected to arbi-
trary or unlawful interference with his privacy,
family, home or correspondence, nor to unlaw-
ful attacks on his honour and reputation.”
Arab constitutions variously address these
rights in brief or in detail. All agree on the need
to safeguard the inviolability of the home and
the freedom of different types of correspond-
ence, but matters other than honour are not
encompassed within their protection. Some,
like the Egyptian Constitution (articles 41-45)
and, to a lesser degree, those of Algeria and So-
malia, contain more detailed safeguards, pro-
viding that homes shall not be searched other
than with the occupants’ consent or in cases of
utmost necessity as designated by law or with
a written warrant by the competent judicial
authority. They also contain special provisions
on freedom of movement and choice of place
of residence, although most invest the legisla-
tor with considerable authority to restrict the
exercise of such freedom by means of the law.
In rare exceptions, the judiciary is empowered
to consider and rule on the lawfulness of the
authorized grounds for restriction.
Many who join the
legal profession lack
proficiency.
Most Arab states have
no effective systems
of legal aid for the
needy.
115 THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE
Other rights, no less important, include the
right to establish a family: the right of men and
women to marry without discrimination, to
enjoy the entitlements of marriage and to own
and inherit property. A number of Arab con-
stitutions accord the family a distinct status, re-
garding it as the basis of society, and emphasize
the duty to ensure its preservation, safeguard it
from disintegration and breakdown, secure the
conditions for its survival and for its harmony
with public order and the system of civilized
and moral values.
CONSTITUTIONAL VIOLATIONS
OF HUMAN RIGHTS
A number of Arab constitutions contain pro-
visions that conflict with international human
rights principles by assuming an ideological
or religious character that removes public
rights and freedoms or permits their removal.
The amendments to the Yemeni Constitution
of 1994 illustrate this. They strike at the very
core of the principle of the legality of crimes
and punishments and the right to fair trial. As
an example Article 46 was introduced to re-
place article 31, which originally provided that
“there shall be no crime and no punishment
other than as stipulated by law”, the new pro-
vision stipulates that “there shall be no crime
and no punishment other than on the basis of a
provision of religious law (Shari’a) or law.”
There is no objection here to the principle
that provisions of Shari’a should be a source of
legislation prescribing crime and punishment,
but rather that the discourse is directed to
the judge, instead of the legislator. Investing
discretionary powers in the judge to interpret
the Shari’a text and choose among the multiple
opinions of jurisprudence, entails a lack of
legal precision. It is imperative, therefore, that
the constitution of those states which adopt the
Shari’a, stipulate the principle that there is no
crime or punishment other than prescribed by
law. Thus the legal text will be in harmony with
the Shari’a, given that the constitution has pro-
vided that Shari’a is a source of legislation.
Furthermore, article 33 of the Yemeni
constitution, which originally provided that
“repugnant and inhuman methods of enforc-
ing punishments shall not be permitted, nor
shall the enactment of laws which so permit”,
was replaced with article 49 which provides
that “punishments may not be enforced by un-
lawful means and the matter shall be regulated
by law.” This essentially undermines the prin-
ciples of the legality of crime and punishment,
and equality before the law, since criminaliza-
tion and punishment become dependent on
subjective interpretations of Shari’a.
A further example is provided by article
26 of the Saudi Arabian Constitution (Basic
Law), which provides that the state protects
human rights in accordance with religious law
(Shari’a), without specifying what is meant by
religious law. Does this mean those Islamic
schools of law that promote justice, equality,
reason and respect for human dignity? Or
does it refer to the doctrines of Islamic ju-
risprudence, which may be understood only
within their cultural and historical context
and which give rise to various forms of conflict
between them and present-day human rights
principles?
The above observation on the amendment
to the Yemeni Constitution applies equally
to article 38 of the Saudi Arabian Basic Law,
which provides that there shall be no crime
and no punishment other than in accordance
with a provision of religious law (Shari’a) or
statutory law, without specifying what is meant
by a provision of religious law.
The confusion between religion and state is
nowhere more clearly demonstrated than in ar-
ticles 4 and 18 of the Sudanese Constitution of
1998. Article 4 provides that God, the Creator
of humankind, holds supremacy over the State,
without specifying the meaning of supremacy.
Governance practice apparently sanctioned by
God is likely to be immune to criticism and op-
position (Box 4-2).
BOX 4-2
Constitutional restrictions on rights
The citizen pledges his allegiance to the King on the Book of God Almighty and the
Custom of His Prophet, to obey his least command in destitution and in prosperity
and under any adverse circumstances.
(Article 6 of the Basic Law of Saudi Arabia)
Workers for the State and in public life shall observe at all times the subservience of
the latter to the worship of God, Muslims adhering in this regard to the Book [of God]
and the Custom [of the Prophet], and all workers preserving an intention for godliness
and maintaining this spirit in their conduct of plans, laws, policies, and official busi-
ness. This is applicable to the political, economic, social, and cultural spheres.
(Article 18 of the Sudanese Constitution)
A number of Arab
constitutions contain
provisions that conflict
with international
human rights
principles.
The confusion
between religion and
state is nowhere more
clearly demonstrated
than in articles 4 and
18 of the Sudanese
Constitution of 1998.
116 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Where certain Arab states consider Shari’a
as a source of legislation, this does not con-
stitute in itself a violation of human rights
principles, provided that those principles,
intentions and interpretations of the Shari’a
that favour freedom and equality (of which
there are many), are those employed. Oppres-
sive rulers should be prevented from making
use of the Shari’a as a pretext to conceal their
tyranny, as various other pretexts have been
exploited in different historical contexts. Ac-
cording to contemporary scholarship (ijtihad)
on this issue there is no contradiction between
Shari’a and human rights, as the intentions of
the Shari’a are in harmony with international
human rights law.
The constitutional violation of human
rights may assume a confessional shape, as il-
lustrated by article 24 of the Lebanese law,
which provides that parliamentary seats in the
Council of Deputies shall be divided on a reli-
gious and confessional basis. Article 95 of the
Constitution adopts the same criterion dealing
with the highest positions (among citizens) of
the State This situation arises from the legacy
of historical and political circumstances ex-
perienced by the Lebanese legislator and the
various sectors of the people of Lebanon at a
particular stage in their history. With the Con-
stitution of 1990 the legislator took the com-
mendable course, with the intent of putting an
end to sectarianism.
Constitutional violations of human rights
can also take the form of an ideological bias,
which excludes differing opinions or political
affiliations. For example, article 8 of the Syr-
ian Constitution, affirms the Ba’th party as the
leadership of society and the state, meaning
that the multiparty system has no consti-
tutional legality. The same applies to those
constitutions where freedom of expression
and criticism, contingent on criticism being
constructive and that it guarantees the integ-
rity of the national and pan-Arab structure and
promotes the socialist system.
Constitutional provisions for the crea-
tion of exceptional courts further illustrate
the constitutional violation of liberties and
human rights. Examples include article 171
of the Egyptian Constitution, which provides
for state security courts, article 179, on the
Socialist Public Prosecutor, and article 183,
on military courts, referring their regulation
and the definition of its jurisdiction to the
law, without stipulating further details. This
contrasts with the Constitution of Bahrain, Ar-
ticle 105b, which states that the jurisdiction of
the military courts is limited to military crimes
committed by members of the Defence Force,
the National Guard, and the Public Security
forces and does not extend to others except
on the declaration of martial law. Article 122/3
of the Sudanese Constitution is similar to the
Egyptian Constitution.
LEGISLATIVE RESTRICTIONS
ON HUMAN RIGHTS IN ARAB
LEGISLATION
Clearly, Arab constitutional provisions for
rights and freedoms do not reflect the same
comprehensive and effective level typical of
international instruments. The Arab consti-
tutional legislator is always careful to leave a
loophole by referring regulation of rights and
freedoms to ordinary legislation so that the na-
tional legislator may violate these same rights
and public freedoms. In fact the legislative text
frequently goes far beyond regulating rights
and freedoms to the extent of restricting them,
if not removing them altogether. Where the
constitutional text therefore provides rights
and freedoms - notwithstanding that they may
at times be inadequate – it simultaneously de-
prives them of much of their worth, turning
them into a mere facade before the interna-
tional community in a display that is empty of
any real substance. In other words, the consti-
tution becomes a front for the legislative viola-
tion of freedoms and human rights.
LEGISLATIVE RESTRICTIONS
ON THE RIGHT OF PEACEFUL
ASSEMBLY
Arab countries provide many examples of
legislative violations of human rights, some of
which are reviewed here.
Examples include provisions which pro-
hibit or restrict exercise of the right to strike,
demonstrate, hold mass gatherings or assemble
peacefully and which clearly show that Arab
Constitutional
provisions for
the creation of
exceptional courts
further illustrate
the constitutional
violation of liberties
and human rights.
The Arab
constitutional
legislator is always
careful to leave
a loophole… so that
the national legislator
may violate rights and
public freedoms.
117 THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE
authorities live in fear of the Arab street. In
Egypt, the Assembly Act No. 10 of 1914 penal-
izes gatherings of five or more persons (Box
4-3).
The Meetings and Demonstrations Act
No. 14 of 1923 requires advance notifica-
tion to the police of any meeting. The police
are empowered to ban a meeting from taking
place and always have the right to be present
at a meeting, choose the venue and disperse a
meeting. Electoral meetings are confined by
law to a brief period extending from the day
when voters are called to the day of election,
thus diminishing the importance of such meet-
ings. The police also have the right to ban an
electoral meeting from taking place and to dis-
perse it if it is convened. In Jordan, the Interim
Public Meetings Act No. 45 of 2001 regulates
public meetings and marches, for which prior
authorization is required from the competent
administrative governor, whose decision on
the matter is not subject to any judicial author-
ity. The police also have the right to be present
at and disperse meetings, as well as break up
marches. The Jordanian Penal Code similarly
provides for the offence of assembly (articles
164 and 165). Other Arab legislation is similar,
with varying details regarding bans on public
meetings, requirements of prior authorization
for public meetings and demonstrations and
the powers of the executive to disperse such
events and impose penalties for violations (see
Royal Decree No. 377 of 1958 in Morocco, Act
No. 18 of 1973 in Bahrain, Act No. 65 of 1979
in Kuwait, section 13 of the Qatari Penal Code,
Act No. 29 of 2003 in Yemen and article 335 of
the Syrian Penal Code, pursuant to which any
meeting of a non-private nature is deemed by
law to be a form of stirring up unrest).
LEGISLATIVE RESTRICTIONS
ON THE RIGHT OF POLITICAL
ORGANIZATION
In addition to those constitutions which ban or
place restrictions on the right to form political
parties, as illustrated above, we find legislative
restrictions limiting this right even in countries
whose constitutions prescribe the multiparty
system. In Egypt, the law requires prior au-
thorization from the Party Affairs Committee,
predominantly governmental in its composi-
tion, before any party can be established. The
committee’s decisions may be appealed before
the Supreme Administrative Court, which, ex-
ceptionally, consists of both judicial and non-
judicial members, and its rulings final and not
subject to any appeal.
To establish a political party in Jordan
the law requires prior authorization from the
Interior Minister, who has the right to refuse,
and party founders have the right of judicial
appeal against such refusal. The party may not
publicly declare itself or pursue its activities
until either the Minister has approved it or
the court has ruled to revoke the Minister’s
refusal. In Yemen, prior authorization must
be obtained from the Committee on Party
Affairs and Political Organizations, largely an
administrative body, which may oppose the
establishment of the party. In such case the
party founders are entitled to appeal by all
legal means. The Moroccan legislator adopts a
more liberal approach: part IV, sections 15-20,
of the law in question regulates political parties
and politically oriented associations, requiring
only notification of a political party being es-
tablished (section 15).
In Syria, maximum restrictions apply, with
no recognition of party pluralism. Act No. 53
of 1979 regulates the protection of the Arab
Socialist Ba’th Party, the only political party
for which the Constitution makes provision.
The Arab Socialist Ba’th Party is the leading
party for society and State (Article 1). Any
party member who belongs to another political
organization is punished by imprisonment of
five to ten years (Article 5/a). Any person who
infiltrates the party ranks with intent to work
BOX 4-3
Restrictions on the rights to assembly and association
Anyone who is present in a gathering on the public highway consisting of at least five
persons shall be punished, even if no crime is committed, if a representative of the Pub-
lic Authority believes that public peace may as a result be endangered and if he orders
the members of the gathering to disperse and they do not comply.
(Article 2, Public Assembly Law No. 10, 1914, Egypt).
The holding or organization of a public meeting is not permitted without previously
obtaining a permit for that purpose from the Governor in whose area of authority the
meeting will take place, and all public meetings that are held without a permit will be
prevented and dispersed.
(Article 4, Decree Law concerning the holding of public meetings and assemblies, Kuwait)
Arab authorities live in
fear of the Arab street.
The police have the
right to be present
at and disperse
meetings, as well as
break up marches.
118 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
for the benefit of any other political or party
organ receives the same punishment (article
5/b). Under Law No. 49 of 8 July 1980, any
person belonging to the Muslim Brotherhood
is a criminal and punished by the death pen-
alty. Act No. 263 of 19 July 1960, disbands
Baha’i assemblies and Legislative Decree No.
47 of 9 May 1967 disbands the Association of
Islamic Guidance.
Political parties in Tunisia are regulated by
Basic Law No. 32 of 1988, which requires prior
authorization by the Interior Minister, who is
entitled to object (Article 8). Appeals against
a refusal are permissible before a special divi-
sion of the administrative court, composed
of judicial and non-judicial members, whose
decisions are final and not liable to any form of
appeal (Article 10).
There is no legal regulation of the freedom
to form political parties in Arab Gulf states,
since parties are illegal. In most Arab states,
the law imposes restrictions on political party
financing, either proscribing or setting heavy
restrictions and controls over acceptance of
donations from any foreign person or public
bodies corporate, (Egypt, Jordan, Morocco,
Tunisia and Yemen). Other laws contain
vaguely worded conditions concerning party
activity, permitting the state to exercise its
power to dissolve a party whenever it considers
the conditions have been breached. (Yemeni
law, for example, stipulates that parties must
not undermine the people’s Islamic faith or
engage in any activity opposed to the aims of
the Yemeni revolution). Most legislation con-
tains provisions empowering the executive to
seek the dissolution of a party through a court
ruling.
Given that most courts considering party
affairs can hardly be said to be independent, it
is safe to say that the power to dissolve a party
rests with the executive.
LEGISLATIVE RESTRICTIONS
ON FREEDOM TO FORM
ASSOCIATIONS
In imposing restrictions on the freedom to
form and establish associations, Arab legisla-
tion makes a distinction between charitable
associations and other associations. All Arab
legislation requires advance notice of public
benefit associations and that they be licensed.
All Arab legislation, apart from Moroccan and
Lebanese, requires private associations to have a
prior licence with many imposing stiff penalties
on those carrying out activities without licence.
Restrictions are imposed on associations’ right
to receive donations, particularly from foreign
entities, where prior approval from the execu-
tive is mandatory. Affiliation with foreign as-
sociations is also forbidden without executive
approval. In most Arab countries, associations
are subject to daily monitoring of their activi-
ties, and in some cases the executive can object
to decisions taken by associations. Most legisla-
tion permits the administrative dissolution of
associations or management structures or pro-
vides for a temporary board of management to
be imposed, while in other cases the judiciary
may dissolve an association at the executive’s
request. Clearly then, both the establishment
of civil associations and their activities are
heavily circumscribed and subject to rigorous
control in Arab countries, with few exceptions,
such as Morocco and Lebanon.
RESTRICTIONS ON FREEDOM OF
OPINION, EXPRESSION AND THE
PRESS IN ARAB LEGISLATION
Press freedom is blocked or curtailed in Arab
countries under the guise of regulating laws
that permit prior or other newspaper censor-
ship. Laws impose restrictions on the right
to publish newspapers by requiring a licence
whose withdrawal or threat of withdrawal
is used by the executive to deter newspapers
from crossing the set boundaries of freedom of
expression (articles 24 and 32 of the relevant
legislation in the United Arab Emirates, arti-
cle 13 of the legislation in Kuwait, article 44
of the legislation in Bahrain; similar provisions
are contained in other Arab legislation). Not
a single Arab regime can be said to have a lib-
eral approach towards newspaper publication:
in 15 Arab states the law requires prior licence
or authorization and also restricts the freedom
to publish newspapers. The following obser-
vations concern laws regulating freedom of
expression, publication and the press in Arab
countries:
There is no legal
regulation of the
freedom to form
parties in Arab Gulf
states since parties
are illegal.
Both the
establishment of civil
associations and their
activities are heavily
circumscribed and
subject to rigorous
control in Arab
countries.
119 THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE
Pre-censorship and suspension by
administrative decision
The Arab legislator believes that media of
expression and information transfer can be
substantially controlled by public authority
agencies and has yet to grasp that, thanks to
modern technology, the potential to control
freedom of opinion and expression is steadily
diminishing. A survey of legislation in 19 Arab
states reveals that pre-censorship of newspa-
pers is imposed in 11 cases (Algeria, Bahrain,
Iraq, Kuwait, Libya, Oman, Qatar, Saudi
Arabia, Syria, Tunisia, and the United Arab
Emirates). It finds its actual implementation
through the legislation giving the executive the
authority to control national newspapers and
impose administrative bans on them.
The study showed that all Arab legislation
concerning the media with the exception of
Jordan (subsequent to amendments by Act No.
30 of 1999), empower the executive, whether
the Ministry of Information, the Interior Min-
istry or the Council of Ministers, to ban the
circulation of newspapers, and exercise admin-
istrative impoundment. In Kuwait, Morocco,
Oman, Qatar, Saudi Arabia and the United
Arab Emirates, the executive can suspend
newspapers by administrative decision. All
states adopting the system of licence or prior
authorization also provide for newspapers’
suspension by administrative decision if they
publish without licence or authorization. Arab
legislation is therefore consistent in broaden-
ing executive powers to exercise administrative
control, including suspension, over newspa-
pers. In most cases the executive is similarly
empowered to abolish a newspaper adminis-
tratively providing legislative conditions are
met. The study of 19 Arab states plainly shows
that, of these, 10 give the executive free rein
to revoke a licence with no judicial oversight.
There is a striking similarity among the legisla-
tive provisions in this respect.
Curtailment of freedom on the pretext of
security
When regulating freedom of opinion and ex-
pression, including the media and mass com-
munications, the Arab legislator prioritizes
what s/he perceives as security and public in-
terest considerations above freedom, diversity
and respect for human rights. The result is
that Arab legislation is full of provisions which
regard newspaper publication, audio-visual
broadcasting and the free exercise of expres-
sion in general as highly dangerous activities
warranting a panoply of bans, restrictions and
deterrent sanctions, all to preserve what the leg-
islator believes to be in the public interest, for
national security, doctrinal purity or the ideo-
logical or sacrosanct constants of the nation.
In Arab legislation, the fine balance be-
tween freedom and security/order is clearly
weighted in the latter’s favour. According to
the study of legislation, the Arab legislator
has enormous leeway to criminalize media
activities given the broad scope for prohibit-
ing media content. We shall therefore present
here only the most salient features of this
policy. The most obvious are the infringement
of the principles that punishment is personal
and the presumption of innocence. Given that
the legislator has a free hand in providing for
ambiguously worded offences, the principle of
rule of law has become meaningless. Scrutiny
of the body of Arab laws concerning freedom
of opinion, expression and the press reveals
that it is virtually identical, particularly regard-
ing criminalization and prohibition. It would
seem that the Arab legislator surpassed himself
by copying the most draconian provisions en-
forced by despotic regimes around the world
in specific historical circumstances, which,
elsewhere, were eliminated with the passage of
time. In the Arab world, however, they were
to remain and even proliferate as part of the
permanent legal system. The Arab legislator is
clearly not inspired by the vision of democracy
as, when it comes to setting down laws relat-
ing to opinion, s/he is at pains to seek out and
apply any measures to the individual that in-
volve tightening up, clampdown and excess.
Denying the right to obtain information
The principle of free circulation of informa-
tion and the rights of journalists and citizens in
general to obtain information are viewed with
extreme scepticism by the Arab legislator. The
overriding principles here seem to be prohibi-
tion and restriction rather than permission and
A survey of
legislation in 19
Arab states reveals
that pre-censorship
of newspapers is
imposed in 11 cases.
In Arab legislation,
the fine balance
between freedom
and security/order is
clearly weighted in the
latter’s favour.
120 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
opportunity. Journalists’ right to obtain infor-
mation and news is assured in law in only five
Arab states: Algeria, Egypt, Jordan, the Sudan
and Yemen. Circulation of information how-
ever, is heavily circumscribed under all Arab
legislation. For instance, imported foreign
newspapers and magazines are subject to cen-
sorship, control, and confiscation. Some Arab
countries even forbid Internet access to shut
out the electronic press, and even when per-
mitted, access may be under surveillance.
Harsher conditions for newspaper
publication
Arab legislation consistently applies stringent
restrictions on newspaper publication and
ownership and facilitates arbitrary clamp-
downs. A total of 17 Arab states prohibit
newspaper publication without licence or prior
authorization and in some states the licence is
conditional upon payment of a large deposit
and sometimes a minimum level of capital.
While many Arab states have a system of
public or mixed ownership of newspapers, all
prohibit foreign ownership and any form of
foreign involvement.
During states of emergency and other ex-
ceptional situations the clampdown on news-
papers is even more acute.
LEGAL RESTRICTIONS ON PUBLIC
FREEDOMS DURING A STATE OF
EMERGENCY
One of the most serious legislative violations
of human rights in the Arab world is where the
Arab legislator permits the executive to declare
a state of emergency and abuse all safeguards
for individual rights and liberties. The state of
emergency is a legislative weapon prescribed
by constitutions and laws alike that enables the
executive to confront unforeseen emergencies
that endanger the homeland and threaten its
integrity. In some Arab countries, however, the
state of emergency has exceeded these bound-
aries to become permanent and ongoing, with
none of the dangers to warrant it. What was
the exception has now become the rule (e.g. in
Egypt, Syria and Sudan).
Article 4 of the ICCPR states explicitly: “In
time of public emergency which threatens the
life of the nation and the existence of which is
officially proclaimed, the States Parties to the
present Covenant may take measures to the
extent strictly required by the exigencies of the
situation, provided that such measures are not
inconsistent with their other obligations under
international law and do not involve discrimi-
nation solely on the ground of race, colour,
sex, language, religion or social origin.”
Most Arab constitutions lay down rules
for declaring a state of emergency, though
in some states it is no longer regarded as
such, having acquired semi-permanent status.
Human rights and freedoms are commonly
violated under a state of emergency (or rules
of martial law), as it strips the citizen of many
constitutional rights, such as inviolability of
the home, personal liberty, freedom of opin-
ion, expression and the press, confidentiality
of correspondence, rights of movement and
assembly. It removes certain legislative powers
from the elected parliament and transfers them
to the executive or military governor (emer-
gency authority); and it bars the natural judge
from impartially and independently exercising
her/his full authority, where judicial entities
lacking independence are appointed to the
judiciary, who are more concerned with giving
a ruling than with neutrality, independence
and the right to fair trial. Despite the adverse
effects on public rights and freedoms, politi-
cians and jurists loyal to the regimes vigorously
defend the state of emergency on a number of
pretexts. In this regard, perhaps the most com-
monly repeated argument is the need to fight
terrorism, meaning that the state is in no posi-
tion to combat terrorism by individuals unless
it engages in intimidation through measures
authorized under emergency measures.
Yet repugnant terrorist crimes have oc-
curred in a number of Arab states during a de-
clared state of emergency. The usual scenario
is that the executive is swift to declare and
extend a state of emergency, even without the
backing of parliament, which is usually merely a
pawn in the hands of the executive to carry out
its orders. So it is that the executive can cement
its control over legislative, executive and judi-
cial matters and sweep aside the safeguards for
individual rights, unfettered by the procedural
and objective rule of law.
Arab legislation
consistently applies
stringent restrictions
on newspaper
publication and
ownership.
One of the most
serious legislative
violations of human
rights…is where
the Arab legislator
permits the executive
to declare a state of
emergency and abuse
all safeguards for
individual rights and
liberties.
121 THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE
LEGISLATIVE REGULATION OF
THE ROLE OF THE JUDICIARY IN
PROTECTING HUMAN RIGHTS
AND FREEDOMS
The justice system, with its two branches of an
independent judiciary and a free legal profes-
sion, represents an institutional safeguard that
is indispensable to human rights protection in
a free democratic society. International instru-
ments recognize this and set down elaborate
criteria and prerequisites to ensure such inde-
pendence.
Independence of the judiciary (legislative
regulation and practice)
Our earlier discussion of this topic considered
the international perspective and various pro-
visions in Arab constitutions. International
literature considers the independence of the
judiciary to apply to both the institutional au-
thority and the individual judge.
However, independence of the judiciary
is assured not merely through constitutional
and legislative guarantees and a body of
related safeguards, nor does it come about
only through the institutions with oversight of
judicial affairs. Independence of the judiciary
relates to more universal and profound con-
siderations; for instance, the extent to which
the political system embraces democracy as a
value and respect for the law as a framework
governing the whole of society. Accordingly, in
an undemocratic society, neither the judiciary
nor judges enjoy independence, regardless of
constitutional and legislative guarantees. It
relates also to the judge as individual, the level
of training, the nature of her/his education and
qualifications, and the value system govern-
ing her/his conduct, or, professional ethics in
general.
While the independence of the judiciary is
a prerequisite for justice, it does not guarantee
a credible justice that wins trust and enjoys
the respect of litigants unless the conditions
to promote it are in place. Hence, for the in-
dividual judge, independence demands moral
and intellectual probity on her/his part, since
the judge’s role does not acquire the profound
connotations desired unless the judge is neu-
tral, impartial and upright, both morally and
intellectually. Essentially, this calls for a system
to be set up to monitor professional ethics
and conduct to ensure that the independence
of the judiciary remains intact, while also
guaranteeing judges their right to progress
by increment and benefit, as they are entitled
to, and so maintain their distance from entice-
ments by the state or society. Credible justice
also calls for judicial and procedural regulation
to make it effective, since judicial rulings are
not the work of the judge alone, but are the
outcome of concerted efforts by lawyers, ex-
perts, judicial assistants and others. Just as the
system must be rigorous on judges’ neutrality,
in accordance with professional ethics, the law
must similarly guarantee an effective system
that ensures the right of defence, lawyers’
rights and duties, and the availability of highly
skilled experts and judicial assistants. Without
this the ills afflicting the legal profession or the
performance of judicial assistants are bound to
undermine credible justice in society.
Arab constitutions refer regulation of
the judiciary to ordinary legislation. How-
ever, when the Arab legislator steps outside
that framework and imposes restrictions on
freedoms and human rights in breach of inter-
national standards and national constitutional
provisions, s/he is inhibiting the human right
to litigation and invalidates the principle of the
independence of the judiciary, turning consti-
tutional texts into facades to conceal flaws in
substance.
Despite constitutional and legislative guar-
antees for the independence of the judiciary
and fair trial safeguards, scholars and human
rights activists note a disparity between the
texts and reality. Legal experts, for instance,
hold that constitutional and legislative provi-
sions on the independence of the judiciary and
the right to fair trial are not applied in their
countries, for mainly political reasons, while
others point to the traditional kinship struc-
ture in certain countries, which also makes it
difficult to apply such legal provisions.
Where there is conflict between a political
regime unfettered by legal controls and the
judiciary, whose independence is upheld in the
constitution and law, the Arab regime swiftly
sweeps aside the independence of the judiciary
without any hesitation (Source: Ahmad Makki,
In an undemocratic
society, neither the
judiciary nor judges
enjoy independence,
regardless of
constitutional and
legislative guarantees.
Where there is conflict
between a political
regime unfettered
by legal controls and
the judiciary…the
Arab regime swiftly
sweeps aside the
independence of the
judiciary.
122 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
1990), as numerous historical examples in
Arab countries show.
Independence of the judiciary as an insti-
tution and of judges as individuals is jeopard-
ized on two counts in the Arab world. First,
ideological and autocratic regimes frequently
interfere, using the pretext of “protecting the
ideological foundations” of their authoritarian
regimes. Second, the decline in living standards
among those of fixed income, including judges,
opens the profession to corrupting enticements
from certain sectors of the nouveau riche.
As regards the separation and balance
of powers, the authority accorded to justice
ministries to inspect courts and control the ju-
diciary’s budget clearly constitute a restriction
on the independence of the judiciary as an in-
stitution. This situation, in which the executive
controls their finances and intervenes in the
appointment, transfer and dismissal of judges,
means that, in practice, judges in many Arab
countries are not independent. Indeed, many
are sometimes fearful in delivering their judge-
ments, particularly when the State has a direct
or indirect interest in the case in question.
In some Arab countries, judges are
tempted with material and moral inducements
to make them pliable instruments in the hands
of the executive particular in cases where the
executive has a special interest, This may
take the form of a part-time appointment to
conduct legal business for the executive for
additional remuneration, and/or appointment
to high executive and political office on leaving
the judiciary. These are all too persuasive and
can cause judges to discharge their functions
less than impartially in return for short or
longer-term reward.
The vast increase in the number of cases
brought to court in some Arab countries
obstructs the administration of justice and
exercise of the human right to litigation to a
considerable degree. Inevitably, in Arab coun-
tries where there are millions of lawsuits and
no more than several thousand sitting judges,
court cases are delayed for years before they
are settled. Meanwhile litigants’ rights are set
aside, particularly the rights of defence and
to prompt and consummate justice. This slow
pace of litigation harms both the economy
and society; in such an environment rights
are delivered only with the greatest difficulty,
with the judicial system seen as an obstacle to
the growth of national and foreign investment.
The absence of an authority capable of enforc-
ing the law, and within a reasonable time, can
encourage recourse to violence and individual
reprisals, and make people less willing to go to
court to seek a solution (figure 4-1).
According to the Freedom Survey, Annex
1, willingness to go to court to settle disputes
barely exceeded 50%. This percentage showed
a relative decrease in cases related to freedoms,
and in Palestine and Morocco in general
Corruption within the auxiliary apparatus
of the judiciary, including secretaries, clerks
and experts, has an adverse impact on the jus-
tice system in a number of Arab societies. Civil
servants who eke out a living by breaching the
law and justice every day are scarcely fitted
to help apply them. Ultimately, the situation
resembles a farce in which justice is trampled
underfoot and rights degraded, with little
standing in the way.
Various forms of exceptional courts under-
mine the jurisdiction of the natural judiciary,
primarily State security courts and military
tribunals, which diminish fair trial safeguards,
as demonstrated below.
Figure 4-1
Extent of willingness to go to court, Five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
Inevitably, in Arab
countries where
there are millions of
lawsuits and no more
than several thousand
sitting judges, court
cases are delayed for
years.
123 THE LEGAL ARCHITECTURE
Exceptional courts
The Arab legislator has learned through expe-
rience that direct clashes with judges and the
judiciary may bring public odium, with judges
portrayed as martyrs of freedom in an auto-
cratic regime. Many Arab regimes therefore
prefer other methods of dealing with the judici-
ary that cause less public outcry and also more
effectively strip the judiciary of its independ-
ence and ensure it complies with the regime’s
wishes. The regime’s first method is to create
an exceptional judiciary under the executive’s
direct influence, to which it refers politically
sensitive cases and major security cases. This
tradition descends from the time of foreign
occupation when the British and French occu-
pying powers created emergency courts to try
their opponents.
In the Arab world, the exceptional ju-
diciary that is most threatening for human
rights is the military. The military judicial
system exists in a number of states, includ-
ing democratic ones. Its existence alone does
not breach public freedoms or human rights,
provided that stringent controls are in place to
safeguard against the military judiciary aiding
the ruling authority to encroach on liberties,
human rights and safeguards. The first control
is that judges in military tribunals must be le-
gally qualified. Secondly, the tribunals’ rulings
must be subject to appeal before the ordinary
judiciary. Thirdly, their jurisdiction should be
confined to military offences committed by in-
dividual members of the military in the course
of duty within their military units. Fourthly,
legal guarantees for the neutrality and imparti-
ality of military judges must be effective.
Most of these guarantees are lacking in
Arab military tribunals. The most blatant
example is provided by Egypt’s Act No. 25
of 1966, where article 6 greatly expands the
jurisdiction of the military judiciary, particu-
larly during a state of emergency, when it may
consider any offence in the Penal Code and
referred to it by the President of the Republic.
Cases in which Islamic movements are accused
of violence are commonly referred to military
courts. In fact recourse to the military judiciary
(even though properly a type of professional
judiciary with a narrowly defined jurisdiction)
is encouraged by Arab constitutions which
make explicit provisions for it, (article 183 of
the Egyptian Constitution, for example). Other
forms of exceptional judiciary lacking fair trial
safeguards include state security courts, courts
of values, revolutionary courts, people’s courts
and tribunals dealing with economic and judi-
cial matters, such as revolutionary committees
and so on, that are run by popular communi-
ties loyal to the regimes. State security courts
exist in several Arab countries in the Near East
and North Africa. In Egypt, for example, the
State security court provided for under emer-
gency law continues to exercise jurisdiction
even after the permanent state security courts
have been abolished. State security courts were
established in Jordan pursuant to Act No. 17
of 1959, as amended, which can consider of-
fences relating to internal and external State
security and drug offences. Article 7 (a) of the
Syrian State Security Court Act states: “The
State security courts shall not be bound by the
usual procedures stipulated in the legislation in
force during any of the stages or procedures of
prosecution, investigation and trial.” Their ses-
sions are held in camera and their rulings are
not subject to appeal.
Another model exists in Arab countries
with a traditional liberal heritage influenced
by practices and methods of foreign occupa-
tion. One example is the Justice Council in
Lebanon, which, although composed of ordi-
nary judges, lacks independence and does not
offer litigants recognized guarantees for fair
trial, since its decisions may not be reviewed
or appealed before a higher court. More im-
portantly, its jurisdiction to examine cases is
determined by political decision of the Cabi-
net. This Council was set up during the French
mandate pursuant to Decree No. 1905 of 12
May 1923, which has been amended several
times, and it now considers offences against
external state security.
THE IMPACT OF AUTHORITARIAN
POWER RELATIONS ON FREEDOM
AND HUMAN RIGHTS
One of the principal reasons that violations of
freedoms and human rights, both in law and
practice, are widespread in the Arab region
The Arab legislator
has learned through
experience that direct
clashes with judges
and the judiciary may
bring public odium…
In the Arab world,
the exceptional
judiciary that is most
threatening for human
rights is the military.
124 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
lies in the nature of the political authority and
its relationship with society. Consequently,
the way to approach the question of legisla-
tion that violates freedom is to deal with the
issue of power in the Arab world. Distribution
of power should be based on genuine respect
for the principle of separation of powers; the
principle of political alternation should be set
down and this, together with ending the mo-
nopoly of power, should be assigned to the
ballot box alone for decision. Sound laws that
are supportive of freedom can only come about
where the Arab political regime as a whole is
supportive of the values of democracy and
people’s right to participate in political life.
The monopoly of power, which renders the
regime untouchable in terms of accountability,
is at the heart of the deteriorating state of free-
dom and human rights in the Arab world.
The way to approach
the question of
legislation is to deal
with the issue of
power.
CHAPTER FIVE
The Political Architecture
THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE 125
Introduction
Chapter Five looks at another pivotal area
that explains the current and critical dete-
rioration in the state of freedom in Arab
countries, namely in the political structure of
governance. The crisis of the current politi-
cal structure is manifested most clearly in the
generally authoritarian nature of the execu-
tive, often reduced to the person of the head
of state, and in the role played by the security
forces of the state. It is also reflected in the
severe restriction of freedom, particularly
freedom of expression and association in
civil and political societies. The chapter con-
siders the features of corruption drawn from
the Freedom Survey and highlights the state
of Arab corporate governance. It concludes
with an evaluation of the relative situation
in the Arab region in comparison to other
world regions, with respect to a number
of governance indicators derived from the
World Bank’s database on this subject.
THE CRISIS OF GOVERNANCE IN
ARAB COUNTRIES
There is near consensus in the Arab world
today concerning the serious flaws in the state
of Arab affairs; it is a rare consensus among
rulers and ruled in which class distinctions
disappear and regional, sectarian and even eth-
nic differences fade. There is also consensus,
as demonstrated by the agreement at the May
2004 Arab summit meeting in Tunis which fo-
cused on political reform, that the heart of the
failing lies in the political sphere, specifically
the architecture of the Arab State, and that
reform must begin there. Agreement, however,
stops here, as differences emerge, particularly
over where the malaise starts and which is the
most appropriate prescription for cure.
This consensus is the result of living
together with the widespread crisis which
overshadows the Arab world and points to
a collective failure among Arab states to ad-
dress major issues, such as the Palestinian
question, Arab cooperation, foreign interfer-
ence, and human development. It also points
to the failure to provide citizens with a decent
life, whether in terms of the basic requisites of
daily life, or human rights or both, which has
created an atmosphere of oppression, suffering
and instability. This sentiment intensified with
the occurrence of major disasters such as the
invasion of Kuwait in 1990 and the consequent
foreign intervention and Arab disintegration.
More recently, the foreign invasion of Iraq and
the escalating conflict in Palestine have simi-
larly affected Arab public opinion, particularly
since, as a result of the information revolution,
the Arab citizen lives these tragedies by the
moment and feels tormented by helplessness.
The information revolution and globaliza-
tion, accompanied by the fall of ideologies and
rise of awareness and education in the Arab
world, also intensified the crisis of legitimacy
of Arab regimes, whether they were based
on tradition (religious/tribal), revolution
(national/liberationist) or patriarchy. This in
turn deepened feelings of crisis and created a
vicious circle of frustration, grass-roots disen-
chantment and a general lack of confidence in
governments, which in turn saw the need for
further repression and the consolidation of
barriers between them and the people.
CHARACTERISTICS OF
AUTHORITARIAN GOVERNANCE
The modern-day Arab state monopolizes the
public space, insisting on controlling all things,
from personal religious belief to international
The modern-day Arab
state monopolizes the
public space.
There is near
consensus in the
Arab world today
concerning the serious
flaws in the state
of Arab affairs; it is a
rare consensus among
rulers and ruled.
126 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
relations, and allowing little leeway for initia-
tives from outside its space or without its bless-
ing. At first glance, it may seem difficult to talk
about the common features of governance in
the Arab world owing to the wide diversity of
its regimes, ranging from absolute monarchies
to revolutionary republics and radical Islamic
states. Closer scrutiny, however, reveals an in-
teresting affinity in the architecture and meth-
ods of Arab systems of governance and brings
out features of an interwoven regional archi-
tecture comprising an Arab “integral whole”
in which the systems are mutually reinforcing.
It is therefore possible to speak of an “Arab
model” of governance with specific traits com-
mon to most systems and in turn based on an
Arab regional system that constitutes its politi-
cal infrastructure.
THE “BLACK-HOLE” STATE
The general features of this Arab model, which
some have named the “authoritarian state”
(Khaldoun Hassan al-Naqib, in Arabic, 1996)
and which has been described at length in a
number of studies (Ghassan Salameh, in Ara-
bic, 1995; Ghassan Salameh et al, in Arabic,
1989, 28-40, 89; Hopkins and Ibrahim, 1997,
24; Roger Owen, 1992), are captured in the
recent comments of an Arab journalist and
activist. The latter describes governance in his
country as a system in which there are no free
and transparent parliamentary elections, re-
sulting in a “monochrome” parliament. Under
that particular system, press freedom is also
restricted, as is political and human rights ac-
tivity, the judiciary is used to make an example
of opponents and the constitution establishes
a regime that is “unlimited by time and not
subject to the control of parliament or the
judiciary.” In such a regime, even the ruling
party becomes a mere piece of administrative
apparatus run by “civil servants with neither
enterprise nor efficiency” (Rashid Khashana,
in Arabic, 2003).
We can call this the model of the “black-
hole State”, likening it to the astronomical
phenomenon of extinguished stars which
gather into a ball and are converted into giant
magnetic fields from which even light cannot
escape. The modern Arab state, in the political
sense, runs close to this model, the executive
apparatus resembling a “black hole” which
converts its surrounding social environment
into a setting in which nothing moves and from
which nothing escapes. Like the astronomical
black hole, this apparatus in turn forms into
a tight ball around which the space is so con-
stricted as to paralyze all movement.
This increasing centralization of the execu-
tive is guaranteed in the constitutional texts of
certain states, which enshrine the right of the
king, the president or the emir (or the Revo-
lutionary Command Council) to legislate and
vest wide powers in the head of state. The lat-
ter becomes the supreme leader of the execu-
tive, the council of ministers, the armed forces,
the judiciary and public services, for it is he
who appoints and has the power to dismiss
ministers, members of the judiciary, senior of-
ficials and officers, and it is he who convenes
and has the authority to dissolve parliament
(where one exists). The laws also prescribe the
central control of local authorities, since the
ruler appoints governors and prefects, who are
responsible to him and not to citizens (Ayoubi,
1995, 322-323).
The centralization of the executive also
shows in bureaucratic expansion, greater
state interference in the economy and higher
government spending of national resources,
particularly on security and military organs.
This trend is evident, both in radical states
with planned economies and in conservative
states which, from the outset, declared their
adherence to the market economy (Khaldoun
Hassan al-Naqib, in Arabic, 1996, 181-207;
Ayoubi, 1995, Chapter 9).
Many governments are nevertheless not
content with these wide constitutional and
administrative powers. They thus turn to emer-
gency laws, which, in some countries, have re-
mained in force for over 40 years. When other
countries, which have been governed without a
constitution since their establishment, decided
to enact basic laws, they not only laid down the
absolute powers enjoyed by the ruler in the
absence of the rule of law but also vested him
with powers previously unavailable to him,
such as the power to choose and remove his
successor. The ruler did not uniquely enjoy
such powers before.
We can call this Arab
system of governance
the model of the
“black-hole State”.
This increasing
centralization of
the executive is
guaranteed in the
constitutional texts of
certain states.
127 THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
EXTRA-JUDICIAL CONTROLS
In addition to the absolute central powers
in the hands of the executive (and, in prac-
tice, in the hands of the president, king or
ruler), which are not subject to normal legal
restraints, there are, for instance, additional
mechanisms that increase the centralization of
power in the executive. For example, the so-
called ruling parties (where they exist) are, in
reality, simply institutions attached to the ex-
ecutive, since party officials (or electoral can-
didates) are designated by the president, who
is also regarded as the party leader (Ibrahim, in
Arabic, 1996, 194-195). In practice, this means
that parliament is a bureaucratic adjunct of the
executive that does not represent the people
whose mistrust in it continues to grow. The
World Values Survey shows that confidence in
the legislative assembly (theoretically elected)
is less than 50% when averaged over four Arab
countries (figure 5-2).
Furthermore, the executive uses the ordi-
nary and exceptional judiciary to eliminate and
tame opponents, rivals and even supporters
who step out of line. This is linked with what is
known as “unspoken corruption” or corruption
which is hushed up (Ayoubi, 1996, 321), where
close supporters are allowed to exploit their
positions for unlawful gain, while “enforcement
of the law” against them remains a weapon to
ensure that their total loyalty will continue.
The key support buttressing the power
of the executive is the intelligence apparatus;
each Arab state has multiple intelligence agen-
cies that differ from their counterparts in dem-
ocratic countries insofar as they enjoy powers
over and above their authority to gather intelli-
gence information. Nor are they responsible to
the legislature or to public opinion. The intel-
ligence services are regarded as the essence of
the ruling apparatus in almost all Arab states.
They are directly under the control of the
president or king and possess powers greater
than those of any other organ. The security ap-
paratus has enormous resources and intervenes
in all the powers of the executive, particularly
in regard to appointment decisions and the
legal regulation of associations, to the point
where the modern-day Arab state is frequently
dubbed “the intelligence state” (cf. Ayoubi,
1995, 449; Khaldoun Hassan al-Naqib, in Ara-
bic, 1996, 185).
Arab states vary in their embodiment of
these general traits, particularly in the margin
of freedom permitted without being regarded
as a threat. However, what they have in com-
mon is that power is concentrated at the tip of
the executive pyramid and that the margin of
freedom permitted (which can swiftly be re-
duced as required) has no effect on the state’s
firm and absolute grip on power. The margins
of freedom are relatively wide in countries like
Jordan and Morocco, where there is greater
freedom to form political parties and freedom
of political participation than in the other Arab
states. Three Arab republics, namely Lebanon,
the Sudan and Yemen, are in a special posi-
tion in that the central state finds it difficult to
impose unilateral centralization owing to its
religious and ethnic diversity and the strength
of the solidarity and loyalty that characterise
such groups. As a result, a margin of freedom
exists by default.
For some states, the situation looks promis-
ing: Algeria, for example, has moved towards
greater political openness and national rec-
onciliation, with competitive elections having
recently taken place, to the satisfaction of
broad sectors of the populace, despite some
flaws. In the Sudan too, there has been a step
forward following the conclusion of a Frame-
work Agreement in May 2004 between the
Government of Sudan and the Sudan Peo-
ple’s Liberation Movement/Army (SPLM/A).
Nevertheless, the overall picture in the Arab
world indicates a similarity in the architecture
of regimes, which “indeed makes it possible
to speak about a single unified, integrated
Arab system for tyranny and control” (Burhan
Ghalioun, in Arabic, 2001). These are systems
based on maximizing the focus of power at the
top of the executive, so that the license of a cer-
tain margin of freedom is part of the strategy of
consolidating power rather than reducing it.
It is therefore not surprising that around
a quarter of the respondents to the Freedom
Survey, Annex 1, said there was a lack of
freedom of opinion and expression in their
countries, with a higher ratio saying there was
no way to hold the government accountable
(figure 5-1).
The key support
buttressing the power
of the executive is the
intelligence apparatus.
Arab states vary in
their embodiment of
these general traits…
what they have in
common is that power
is concentrated at the
tip of the executive
pyramid.
128 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
In the same context, the results of certain
international studies (World Values Survey,
2004) indicated a strong preference in the
Arab countries covered for democratic gov-
ernance, and against authoritarian rule. They
also stated a preference for a government of
experts, and objected to rule by the army.
TRACING THE FLAW
Analysts look for common structural factors
to explain why, politically speaking, the Arab
states have contracted while the rest of the
world has moved towards democratic open-
ness. Some point at the cultural heritage,
particularly its religious dimension, arguing
that Islam and democracy do not go together
(Chapter 2). Others see the problem as the
tribal and patriarchal nature of Arab society
(Sharabi, 1990), or the absence of a tradi-
tion of social contracts recognizing freedom,
individualism and civil society (Gilner, 1994;
Ayoubi, 1995: 398). Still others fault the eco-
nomic structure of Arab societies, specifically
their rentier basis, which characterizes most
Arab countries (Chapter 6). Islamic move-
ments are sometimes cited as a major emerging
factor insofar as some of them have adopted an
anti-democratic discourse, creating deep cleav-
ages among forces opposed to the despotic
State and giving regimes additional excuses to
disrupt democratic transformation (Ghalioun,
2001; Al-Afendi et al, 2002).
No doubt, these factors have all contrib-
uted, in varying degrees, to shaping the current
political environment in Arab countries yet
they do not sufficiently explain the concentra-
tion of power at the top of the authoritarian
pyramid. For example, there is evidence that
it is the central state that reinforces tribal and
clan formations, rather than the other way
around (Ibrahim, in Arabic, 1996, 294-296).
Political factors may ultimately be more
important. It may be argued that “the real flaw
causing the delay of democracy in the region is
not cultural, but lies in the convergence of po-
litical, social and cultural structures that have
suppressed or eliminated organized social and
political forces capable of turning the crisis of
authoritarian and totalitarian regimes to their
advantage. The elimination of such forces has
led to the of loss any real forward momentum”
(Ghalioun, in Arabic, 2001).
We can conclude that at the root of the
problem lies the political architecture and the
“strategic marginalization” by the state of all
institutions and social forces, including state
institutions, together with the all-pervading
reality of state appropriation. In other words,
while preventing most social forces from
having any effective influence over it, the
state intervenes in all matters and permits no
independent social initiative to threaten its
monopoly of power. Because the state controls
the economy and intimidates those who might
otherwise use their economic clout against it,
the ruler is not obliged to bargain with the
bourgeoisie or others in order to sustain his
rule, particularly since the bourgeoisie is usu-
ally a dependent client of the state (Hopkins
and Ibrahim, 1997, 382-384). As regards the
élites, the state proffers the choice between
being loyal and hence richly rewarded and
being a dissenter and hence suppressed. In
such circumstances the position of the majority
is easily understood.
Figure 5-1
Perceived absence of government accountability and lack of freedom of opinion
and expression, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
“The real flaw
causing the delay
of democracy in
the region is not
cultural, but lies in
the convergence of
political, social and
cultural structures that
have suppressed or
eliminated organized
social and political
forces.”
129 THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
THE CRISIS OF LEGITIMACY
The current situation of Arab governance,
with its associated weakness in terms of ef-
fective representation of societal forces means
that Arab states are facing a chronic crisis of
legitimacy, often relying on inducement and
intimidation in dealing with their citizens.
When the Arab states were newly inde-
pendent, their regimes depended on traditional
forms of legitimacy (religious-tribal), or won
legitimacy through fighting for independence
or building the State. But traditional regimes
were soon challenged by a revolutionary élite
espousing Arab nationalist or leftwing ideolo-
gies, and regimes bolstering their legitimacy by
mobilizing the people around calls for unity,
liberation, justice and development. These also
relied on their leaders’ charismatic popular ap-
peal. Several regimes developed the concept of
“the eternal mission” (unity, liberation, mod-
ernization, Islamization, development, social-
ist transformation, etc.) to justify a legitimacy
built on the custodianship of the people and
not its representation (Waterbury, 1995, 81).
The successive setbacks encountered by
the new so-called revolutionary regimes (de-
feats by Israel, the failure of development
projects, unity and modernization, the failure
in combating corruption) played to the interest
of traditional regimes boosting their legitimacy
centred on religion and Islamic traditions.
However, these regimes, which acquired and
strengthened their regional influence on the
back of the oil boom and the subsequent eco-
nomic successes, today find themselves chal-
lenged by new representatives of the Islamic
movement and the fresh ambitions of rising
generations, who are no longer persuaded of
their developmental achievements (cf. Ibra-
him, in Arabic, 1996, 330-332; Luciani, in Ara-
bic, 1995).
Most Arab states have now turned away
from the populist course that characterized
the revolutionary regimes of the past; instead,
they have chosen to promote the ruler’s person
who, more often than not, lacks charisma, un-
like some of the leaders of the revolutionary-
populist era. To a certain extent, most regimes
also avoid demagoguery, unless they are caught
in an ‘impasse’, as was the former Iraqi regime
after the war with Iran. In addressing the mass
of people, they concentrate on the legitimacy
of their achievements (or promises thereof)
in specific areas such as the economy, peace,
prosperity, stability, or safeguarding values and
traditions. Sometimes the mere preservation of
the state entity in the face of external threats is
considered an achievement sufficient to confer
legitimacy. Perhaps paradoxically, some re-
gimes have recently resorted to the discourse
of democratic legitimacy and the language of
civil society and human rights. According to
one Arab thinker, democratic discourse has
become a new “salvation myth” (Tarabishi, in
Arabic, 1999, 71) though the deeds do not yet
match the words.
Most regimes, nowadays, bolster their
legitimacy by adopting a simplified and ef-
ficient formula to justify their continuation in
power. They style themselves as the lesser of
two evils, or the last line of defence against
fundamentalist tyranny or, even more dra-
matically, against chaos and the collapse of
the state. This formula is what Ibrahim and
his colleagues have dubbed “the legitimacy
of blackmail” (Ibrahim, in Arabic, 1996, 324-
325). To a certain extent, it can be considered
an implicit admission of the bankruptcy of the
claims of positive legitimacy on which official
propaganda still insists, with growing despair.
Sometimes this political blackmail is pitched in
idealistic terms as in claims that modernization
stands up to fundamentalism or terrorism, or
that a strong state counters a passive course
of drift and resignation. The predominant
approach can be described as pragmatic, char-
acterized by its flexibility in selecting bases of
legitimacy that fit the moment. Many a regime
has converted from socialism to capitalism, or
from secularism to Islamic discourse and vice-
versa, whenever such a move seemed likely to
protect its survival. Some regimes, such as the
“reformist” monarchies, may rely on mixed al-
liances, based on their traditional influence (in
alliance with the rural and traditional forces
of society) on the one hand, and on an almost
radical modernization programme developed
through close ties with the new élite, the local
bourgeoisie and some global forces, on the
other.
The “legitimacy of blackmail” has been
Arab states are facing
a chronic crisis of
legitimacy.
Most regimes,
nowadays, bolster
their legitimacy by
adopting a simplified
and efficient
formula…dubbed
the “legitimacy of
blackmail”.
130 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
eroded by the growing realization that the
absence of any effective alternative in itself is
one of the outcomes of the policies of regimes
that block all avenues for political and civil
activity, and so prevent any other alternatives
from materializing. Even so, the survival of
“the black-hole State” depends essentially
on control and propaganda; on marginalizing
the elites through scare-and-promise tactics;
on striking bargains with dominant global or
regional powers; and on mutually supportive
regional blocs to reinforce one another against
emerging forces.
BOX 5-1
Muhammad Al-Charfi: Arab democracy - form without substance
Since the beginning of the Arab renaissance,
élites have demanded an end to the system of
absolute rule and its replacement with the
rule of law and institutions that respect the
individual and collective freedoms of citizens,
uphold the separation of powers and use
elected structures as their basis. These de-
mands were so enthusiastically supported by
the popular masses that rulers had no choice
but to display a response to such aspirations.
In so doing, however, they laid down condi-
tions on the pretext of following a policy of
achieving social and political development in
gradual stages. In practice, these conditions
produced results that clearly conflicted with
the official message and of which examples
abound.
• Arab countries are run largely on the basis
of the republican system or the system of the
constitutional monarchy.
• In the constitutional monarchy, however,
the monarch retains such wide-ranging pow-
ers that he effectively has the final say on
major issues and the full freedom to choose
ministers and those who oversee the adminis-
tration.
• Hitherto, the republican systems have
all consisted of officially declared presiden-
cies for life or automatic re-election on the
strength of improbable percentages that are
frequently as high as 99 %. Worse still, in
some cases the presidency is now hereditary,
meaning that the republic is devoid of any
substance.
• The Arab state works on the principle
of the separation of powers in that the state
president retains the executive power, the
parliament exercises the legislative power
and the courts exercise the judicial power.
The actual state of affairs, however, differs
radically from this model.
• The party of the president holds all the
seats in parliament or at least controls the
parliament by a wide majority. The president
himself or one of his delegates appoints can-
didates from his party to elect the members
of parliament in what is usually a sham, given
the bias of the administration, the excesses of
the police and the falsification of the election
results. It is thus clear that the state president
can adopt such laws as he pleases. The true
legislative authority therefore rests with him.
• In the days of absolute rule, the state
president would place his signature to a new
law on the day on which he decreed its adop-
tion. The only change has been to introduce
a procedural stage in which the president is
required to propose the bill to parliament and
wait a few days until it has been discussed and
ratified.
• As regards the judiciary, despite its inde-
pendence as prescribed in the constitution,
it hands down only those judgements which
meet with the approval of the state president;
given that he is the person responsible for
the independence of the judiciary, he has the
upper hand in the appointment, promotion
and, where necessary, disciplining of judges.
A judge may take the heroic route and pass
sentence following his conscience, regardless
of what the Government expects of him. In
so doing, however, he jeopardizes his future,
notwithstanding that he is a citizen like any
other and is entitled not to forget about his
own livelihood and fate as well as that of
his family. A judge is guaranteed genuine
independence when he is able to pass fair
sentence without the need for heroics.
• The change which has taken place is that,
previously, an absolute ruler would order
the punishment of one of his subjects and
his order would be immediately enforced,
without further procedure; now, the order
is similarly enforceable - in other words,
instantly – by way of a trial that follows
specific procedures, including a preliminary
judgement against which an appeal may then
be lodged and also including open sessions
during which the public prosecution and
defence are heard. A judgement satisfactory
to the Government then follows. Each party
performs the assigned role and the outcome
is known in advance, just as when an audi-
ence reads the novel before seeing the play.
Legislative and presidential elections follow
the same script.
Freedom of the press and publication is
guaranteed, as provided for by the constitu-
tion or law. Although censorship is outlawed,
publishers must provide pre-distribution
copies of any newspaper or book so that the
administration is informed of its content and
can apply to the court for an order of seizure
if it finds that a work violates public order or
offends decency. In essence, this is the dem-
ocratic system at work. The administration,
however, refrains from giving the required
receipt for copies provided whenever it is un-
happy with a text to be published. Freedom
of the press and publication therefore lacks
any substance.
• The right to demonstrate and organize
public meetings is subject to administrative
practices of the same nature, as is the right
to establish political parties and civil and
humanitarian associations. The guarantee of
such rights by constitutions and laws is there-
fore merely ink on paper.
• A citizen no longer has any guaranteed
right unless s/he wishes to cheer the ruler,
voice gratitude for his accomplishments and
extol his qualities and wisdom.
Over time, as such practices recurred,
the mask has slipped and no longer is anyone
deceived; citizens and foreign observers alike
are aware that the current form of democracy
is nothing more than a cumbersome and tedi-
ous piece of theatre.
There are statesmen who contend that
they resort to such practices in order to stem
the tide of religious fanaticism. The fact is
that the popular masses never applauded
such fanaticism; if a move back to funda-
mentalism shows signs of emerging, it is more
the result of disillusionment after a deceiving
experiment in modernism and with a formal
democracy without substance.
The survival of the
“black-hole State”
depends essentially
on control and
propaganda.
131 THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
REPRESSION AND POLITICAL
IMPOVERISHMENT
WEAKENING OF POLITICAL
PARTIES
The current crisis came about with the col-
lapse of the Arab liberal experiment. This was
an ideological, political reformist movement
that emerged towards the end of the 19th and
in the early 20th century, which led to the ap-
pearance of populist parties and independence
movements, and parliamentary systems in such
countries as Syria, Iraq, Egypt, Morocco and
the Sudan. But these movements encountered
difficulties: internal tensions within society,
an unsettled regional climate, and internal/
external challenges, in addition to foreign
intervention (Youssef al-Shuweiri, in Arabic,
2003, 87-114).
As a result, Arab “political society” suf-
fered a major setback, reflected in the fragmen-
tation of popular liberal parties, and the failure
of governments to rise to the new challenges
of development, modernization and independ-
ence. The political arena was invaded by ide-
ologies and parties that deprecated democracy
either believing that Arab societies were back-
ward and did not know what was for their own
good, or that they were not sufficiently Islamic
or revolutionary. With time, however, radical
governments became “conservative” govern-
ments and revolutionary parties became ruling
or dominant parties. The ban on free party
activity was nevertheless maintained on the
pretext that societies had become too Islamic
or too radical.
The Arab political scene today is quite
varied. Some states categorically prohibit
any political organization. Other states allow
conditional political pluralism and, as a rule,
ban the strongest and most important op-
position party, while favouring the party of
the ruling authority. States which allow party
activity nonetheless try to trip up the opposi-
tion parties, by depriving them of resources
and media exposure, controlling nomination
and election procedures, using the judiciary,
the army and security services to curtail their
activities, hounding their leaders and activists
while tampering with election polls.
Some States have witnessed a massive
rise in the number of political parties (27 in
Algeria, 26 in Morocco, 31 in Jordan and 22
in Yemen). Some see this as a reflection of the
divisions among political and cultural élites, or
of the ruling regime’s manœuvres to divide the
opposition, rather than a sign of democratic
vitality. Fragmented as they are, these parties
are incapable of rallying popular support to
achieve the objectives for which they were cre-
ated. Indeed, this proliferation has engendered
an aversion to political activity among citizens,
a fact evident in their obvious reluctance to
take part in the electoral process. On the other
side, Governments deliberately freeze and ban
parties that rally popular support: in Egypt
7 out of 17 licensed parties have been frozen,
in Mauritania 6 out of 17 and in Tunisia 3 out
of 11.
In addition to official repression, opposi-
tion parties suffer from internal problems
that are no less serious. Despite theoretical
references to democracy in their charters, their
practice shows that the influential political élite
holds sway in most of these parties, resulting in
immovable leaderships who, with rare excep-
tions, only leave their posts when they die,
casting doubt on their claims to modernity and
democracy. To a great extent, official policy
contributes to the situation, since the laws
authorizing parties turn them into monopolies,
or “franchises”, given to certain persons in
particular, while those who disagree with the
‘leader’ are not allowed to form another party.
Yet if a ‘leader’ crosses the line, the judiciary is
used so as to transfer the party authorization
to another person more inclined to respect the
rules of the game.
Beyond all that, there is the acute “sectar-
ian split” in the political community between
the Islamic parties on the one hand and the lib-
eral and nationalist secular parties on the other
(not to mention other sectarian divisions along
doctrinal, ethnic, tribal and regional lines). As
a result of this sectarian fragmentation some
parties and political forces have preferred to
co-operate with undemocratic governments
rather than work with their rivals to lay the
groundwork for a democratic rule open to all.
Such constriction, in addition to hobbling
The current crisis
came about with the
collapse of the Arab
liberal experiment.
The laws authorizing
parties turn them
into monopolies or
“franchises”.
132 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
opposition, has led to the marginalization
of some parties and hastened their demise.
Restrictions on opposition parties have made
it impossible for them to accede to power
and form governments through elections.
Citizens, perceiving such parties to be inef-
fectual, choose either not to support them or
to work through clandestine political activities.
Constraints on political space have led some
activists and scholars to rely on civil society
organizations, especially trade unions and
professional organizations, on the grounds that
they are better equipped than Arab political
parties to lead Arab society towards develop-
ment and democracy (Saadeddin Ibrahim, in
Arabic, 1991, 18).
According to the World Values Survey,
political parties rated the lowest among soci-
etal institutions enjoying people’s confidence
in all five countries covered (figure 5-2).
THE MARGINALIZATION OF CIVIL
SOCIETY
The closure of the political sphere has con-
vinced activists and scholars to turn to civil
society organizations, especially trade unions
and professional associations, as actors more
capable of leading Arab society towards de-
velopment and democracy than Arab political
parties (Ibrahim, 1991, 18).
There is consensus around a definition of
civil society as “a realm of life institutionally
separated from the territorial state institu-
tions”, one that “describes and envisages
a complex and dynamic ensemble of legally
protected non-governmental institutions that
tend to be non-violent, self-organizing [and]
self-reflexive” (Keane, 1998, 6).
Many hopes were pinned on civil society
and its role in helping “to endow republican
regimes with the true meaning of republican-
ism by liberating them from their autocratic
content, their oligarchic form and their
absolute monarchic streaks, thus rendering
them genuinely republican regimes.” It was
also hoped that civil society would help “to
transform absolute monarchies into constitu-
tional monarchies, liberate princedoms from
their closed family contexts by exposing them
to social and economic dynamism and free
military republican regimes from dictatorial
militarism.” (Belqazir, 2001,144-145).
The status of Arab civil society
As detailed in Part 1, civil society organi-
zations (CSOs) have intensified their change
and reform initiatives despite the many obsta-
cles they face, These include, on the one hand,
state constraints on civic activities and, on the
other, the dependence of many CSOs on po-
litical parties that use them as fronts through
which to expand their political influence at
the popular level - which limits their initiative
and independence of action. As a result they
lose their capacity for initiative and self-moti-
Figure 5-2
Extent of confidence in political institutions, five Arab countries
Percentage of missing observations
Egypt 3.03%, Jordan 11.80%, Saudi Arabia 5.75%, Algeria 8.53%, Morocco 17.57%.
Note:
- No results were available for the questions concerning the extent of confidence in
labour unions, the political parties and the parliament in Saudi Arabia.
Source: World Values Survey, Annex 1
The closure of the
political sphere has
convinced activists
and scholars to
turn to civil society
organizations.
133 THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
vation, which robs them of their most distinc-
tive feature, independence and non-political
action. Civil society organizations lose their
core function when they become mere fronts
for political parties; they lose their usefulness
if they become part of the government appara-
tus. To give but one example, some civil, trade
union or human rights associations controlled
by the Islamists do not devote as much effort
to defending non-Islamist victims of oppres-
sion. Conversely, organizations controlled by
secularists do not recognize organizations of
an Islamic nature as part of civil society and
agree with the repressive state on the need to
ban them and contain their activists.
In addition, civil society faces the same
problems as the political community vis-à-vis
those authorities who seek to control civil
organizations, directly or indirectly, by using
a dual strategy of containment and repression.
On the one hand, such authorities interfere
with the establishment, financing and focus
of the organizations; some even speak the
language of civil society as a strategy to at-
tack their rivals, particularly if they belong
to the Islamic opposition; they then resort
to establishing semi-official organizations to
undertake functions that stay in line with,
and defend the authorities’ positions. On the
other hand, the authorities constrain the work
of these organizations, denying them the right
to legal existence and financing, in addition to
pursuing and repressing those who are actively
involved in them.
Consequently, civil society organizations
have not been significant actors in resolving the
existing political crisis, as they, too, have been
caught up in its vortex. Although there are
tens of thousands of civil society organizations
in Arab states (the estimated number in 2003
was more than 130,000), their impact remains
very limited. They tend to be concentrated in
certain countries (18,000 in Egypt, 25,000 in
Algeria, 7,000 in Tunisia). Some states limit the
presence of civil society organizations to almost
insignificant levels; there are no more than one
hundred non-governmental organizations in
Kuwait and almost the same number in the
Emirates. There is more scope for civil activity
in countries such as Bahrain (400 associations),
Jordan (1,500), and Lebanon (4,600).
The solidarity and democratic potential of
civil society thus depend on active consensus
among all its actors, starting with agreement on
a non-exclusionist definition of their member-
ship and beneficiaries, away from ineffectual
definitions that link the concept to a Western,
liberal definition and ending with a minimum
agreement among all parties to respect one
another’s freedoms.
THE STATE OF CORPORATE
GOVERNANCE IN THE ARAB
WORLD
Some governments in the Arab region have
shown gross disregard for Article 17 of the
UDHR which clearly states that: (1) Everyone
has the right to own property alone as well as
in association with others; (2) No one shall be
arbitrarily deprived of his property. In addi-
tion, the body of laws adopted by governments
of the region has not effectively defined titles
to property. These historic limitations and the
lack of enforcement of individual property
rights protection have significantly stalled the
development of the region by restricting the ef-
ficient interchange of titles between the public
and private sector and among individuals.
TRANSPARENCY
Lack of transparency in Arab markets is
severely hindering economic prospects. Not
only are transparency and disclosure keys to
the efficient operation of the market, enabling
traders and economic agents to make informed
decisions, but they are also important in terms
of attracting foreign investment. Closed,
opaque systems do not instil confidence in the
economic and investment environment and
this reduces the attractiveness of doing busi-
ness in such markets.
Yet some positive steps aimed at improv-
ing transparency and disclosure have been
taken in many Arab countries. For instance,
the scope of information and data disclosed
has widened and disclosure has become man-
datory. Moreover, most Arab markets have
signed agreements with world class companies
specialized in automated instant reporting on
trading, including Reuters and Bloomberg.
Civil society
organizations have
not been significant
actors in resolving the
existing political crisis
as they, too, have
been caught up in its
vortex.
Lack of transparency
in Arab markets is
severely hindering
economic prospects.
134 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
However, the quality of disclosure remains
sub-standard because the information pro-
vided is incomplete and/or not timely. One
of the consequences of insufficient disclosure
and lack of transparency is inadequate risk as-
sessment, since it follows that if the financial
information available is incomplete, the finan-
cial analysis based on that information will be
inaccurate and ineffective.
ACCOUNTABILITY
The accountability of private sector enterprises
in the Arab region is constrained. Arab secu-
rities markets for instance used to be either
regulated by a committee constituted from
the board of the exchange or not regulated at
all. So for the most part, the exchanges con-
trolled both the regulatory functions and the
operational functions. However, in the 80’s
Arab markets experienced transformations in
their governance, and reforms took the form
of separation of regulatory functions from the
exchanges and establishing governmental au-
thorities or securities commissions to regulate
and monitor the markets.
Among factors that hinder enforcement of
rules and regulations are overlapping regula-
tory functions among authorities that monitor
listed companies (for example in Egypt and
Jordan), which hinders their effectiveness.
Also, where transgressions are discovered, the
high costs of seeking legal recourse and lengthy
court procedures place major barriers before
shareholders. Add to that the lack of skilled
judges knowledgeable about financial market
issues, and there are evidently some real prob-
lems in the enforcement of laws relating to
securities markets and companies.
INCLUSIVENESS
Most of the rules and regulations in the Arab
world that preserve shareholder rights are
stated clearly in the laws and by-laws of securi-
ties markets and companies’ laws. However, as
is the case in many world markets, there is a gap
between laws and regulations and the effective-
ness of enforcement and implementation. The
size of this gap varies across the region. The
rules and regulations in Arab markets have
clearly identified shareholders’ rights, yet
there is a gap between the letter of the law
and practice. Morocco, Egypt, Jordan and
Lebanon’s Company and Securities Laws have
provisions that specifically address the issue of
minority shareholder protection. Within these
economies, it is the job of the security market’s
regulating agencies to enforce these laws.
Much of the recent corporate governance
debate has focused on the “principal-agent”
problem between shareholders (principals)
and managers (agents) owing to the separation
of ownership and management in companies
with widely dispersed “public” ownership of
shares. It is argued that the purpose of corpo-
rate governance is to protect the interests of
shareholders, because the interests of other
investors can be protected through contractual
relations with the company.
What prevails in Arab economies is the
corporation with concentrated ownership i.e.
dominant shareholders who directly control
managers. Hence, the key conflict of interest
tends to arise not between managers and share-
holders, but between controlling shareholders
on one hand and minority shareholders and
other investors, on the other. This conflict
of interest is referred to as the expropriation
problem, because of the tendency for domi-
nant owner-managers to take advantage of
their effective control over corporate resources
to expropriate/divert resources from their
corporation in ways that deprive minority
shareholders and other investors.
Unfortunately governance systems within
the Arab region are mostly insider systems
characterized by concentrated ownership by
interested parties. Controlling shareholders’
interests may conflict with those of minority
shareholders, such as when controlling share-
holders abuse the firm’s resources for personal
gain. The dilution of major shareholders’ vot-
ing rights has been recommended to the extent
that it provides room for other stakeholders’
rights. Complete separation of ownership and
control may not be realistic given the preva-
lence of family firms and because that might
hinder the business environment.
Furthermore, the lack of a strong share-
holder culture and ignorance as to the rights of
The accountability
of private sector
enterprises in the Arab
region is constrained .
(Corporate)
governance
institutions within
the Arab region
are mostly insider
systems characterized
by concentrated
ownership by
interested parties.
135 THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
investors has meant that shareholders’ partici-
pation in corporate decision-making has been
rather limited. Encouraging proxy voting by
approving the concept of registered and bene-
ficial ownership (as in Jordan and Egypt) could
promote further participation. However, tech-
nological differences between markets have
meant that this is not a viable means for voting
in all markets – electronic voting is either not
practiced or not permitted.
Corporate governance and Arab stock
markets
Particular focus needs to be paid to corporate
governance within stock markets given the cru-
cial role the latter play in mobilizing resources
and attracting foreign direct investment in
Arab countries. The Arab region compares
very poorly with other regions in terms of its
ability to attract capital flows, which goes some
way towards explaining its weak growth per-
formance.
There are several reasons for the sluggish
performance of stock markets in the Arab
world. For one thing, the supply of equities is
limited because public enterprises continue to
dominate a broad range of economic activities
(although privatization efforts have improved
in the region over the last decade). Moreover,
poor corporate governance standards (such as
inadequate accounting standards, insufficient
transparency and a poor regulatory environ-
ment) have discouraged capital movement to
the Arab countries and have resulted in a lack
of inclusiveness in the regional market. In addi-
tion, the family-owned structures of most firms
constrain the demand and supply of equities.
Some countries in the region have taken
several steps to increase their markets’ depth
and liquidity, as well as to limit transaction
costs and technical risks. Specific measures
have also been adopted which target the stock
markets in particular.
THE VICIOUS CIRCLE OF
REPRESSION AND CORRUPTION
Government measures to curtail the develop-
ment of political and civil society by applying
a battery of laws (some dating back to the
beginning of the last century), in turn require
complex bureaucratic structures to perform
the tasks of prohibition and curtailment.
In addition to the police and the Ministries
of Interior and Justice (and paradoxically some
new government structures created especially
to monitor non-governmental activity), the
security apparatus spearheads the control
strategy of some contemporary Arab states.
With control as an end in itself and the law
as its tool, the prevailing trend is to turn legis-
lation into support for the trusted arm of the
executive apparatus, i.e. the security branches.
With the authority of the law weakened, secu-
rity and enforcement agencies are free to dis-
regard or manipulate the most stringent laws,
as happens when emergency laws are used to
set aside all other law, or to fabricate criminal
charges against members of the opposition and
civil society activists. In this environment po-
litical prisoners may be rearrested on the day
they are due for release, sometimes even before
leaving prison, while others can be re-arrested
on trumped-up charges such as refusal to com-
ply with arbitrary orders like reporting daily to
a police station.
Manipulation of the law also opens the way
for economic corruption, the natural result of
political corruption. Those who falsify election
results and tamper with the law acquire tempt-
ing tools for forgery and their own personal
gain.
BOX 5-2
Capital market legal reforms
With the increased realization that
higher standards of development may be
achieved through efficient financial mar-
kets, many Arab countries have passed
new legislative reforms:
- In Jordan, laws and regulations govern-
ing the securities markets and joint stock
companies’ activities have undergone a
series of improvements and amendments
since their issuance in 1997.
- In 2000, the United Arab Emirates is-
sued a Federal Securities Law regulating
the securities markets for the first time
since the 1970’s.
- In 2003, by Royal Decree a law in Saudi
Arabia was passed that, by separating
regulatory activities from operational
activities, resulted in major changes in
the architecture of the market.
- The Egyptian and Kuwaiti securities
markets have been regulated for over
a decade. In Kuwait, an Amiri decree
had been issued in 1983 to regulate the
Kuwaiti securities market as a response
to the collapse of the unofficial Kuwaiti
market, Suq Al-Manakh, in 1982.
- In mid-2002 Oman was the first in the
region to issue the “Code of Corporate
Governance of Muscat Securities Market
listed companies”.
- By end-2002, supervisory and executive
roles were separated in the following
seven Arab capital markets: Jordan,
Egypt, Oman, Tunisia, Morocco, the
United Arab Emirates and Algeria. The
two roles remained combined in the
hands of the capital market itself in the
rest of the Arab countries.
With the authority of
the law weakened,
security and
enforcement agencies
are free to disregard
or manipulate even
the most stringent
laws.
136 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
International scales for a “common per-
ception of corruption” in business are avail-
able from surveys carried out by Transparency
International, whose 2003 survey included 133
countries of the world, 18 of them Arab (figure
5-3).
The Arab countries span a wide range in
terms of the ‘spread of corruption’ with no
Arab country exhibiting a total absence of cor-
ruption (grade 10 on the score).
International criteria, however, may not
fully account for the specific nature of the
Arab situation. The politico-legal structure of
some Arab states makes it difficult to differ-
entiate between corruption in its conventional
form (abuse of public office for personal gain),
and an inherent failing (rigged rules) in the
system itself. For example, in some states both
law and custom decree that the land and its
natural resources belong to the ruler, and fail
to distinguish at this level between the private
and public life of the ruler, while the private
property of the ordinary citizen becomes a
grant from the ruler. In such a situation, it is
difficult to talk of corruption in governance,
for whatever the ruler does, he is disposing
of his own property. Some regimes set up
economic institutions attached to their military
or security apparatus, to finance their activi-
ties. Here again matters become confused; it
becomes difficult to draw the line between the
exercise of an official function (since individual
corruption may be but a reflection of the cor-
ruption of the whole situation) and what can be
described as personal corruption. In addition,
there are ways to manipulate laws that, in many
Arab countries, do not allow senior officials to
carry out private business while they occupy an
official post. Many officials circumvent the law
by allowing members of their families to set up
companies and enterprises that often benefit
from the official’s position and relations.
There does appear to be a real need to
re-examine the question of corruption and its
relationship to the political set-up. Corruption
exists, the governments themselves admit as
much, by periodically launching their anti-cor-
ruption campaigns.
Aspects of corruption are also clearly
visible to citizens, particularly those in the
business sector who complain that the people
in power monopolize the main areas of the
economy, either directly or as “partners” of
successful businessmen. Moreover, persons
in power and their close circle receive huge
commissions for contracts concluded between
the state and international or local companies,
including armament contracts (Ayoubi, 1995,
227-243; Ibrahim, in Arabic, 1996, 283-286).
It is, nevertheless, necessary to differenti-
ate between corruption as part of a systematic
state policy and corruption as indicative of the
failure of the state; a distinction should also be
drawn between different levels of corruption.
Corruption may not be widely spread among
the lower ranks in oil states where employees
are well paid. Yet even in these countries many
such practices (such as obtaining commissions
for government deals) are frequently carried
out with the knowledge and blessing of the
highest échelons of power.
This type of corruption may be termed
“structural corruption”, since personal abuse
of public office and misuse of public finances
are considered normal according to prevailing
custom, or even necessary for the regime to
endure. It is distinct from conventional cor-
ruption where the perpetrator acts behind the
Figure 5-3
Corruption Perception Index, World and Arab Countries, 2003
Source: Transparency International, 2003
It is necessary to
differentiate between
corruption as part of
a systematic state
policy and corruption
as indicative of the
failure of the state.
137 THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
back of officialdom, in fear of the law.
If ending corruption entails, among other
measures, deep economic reform, active laws
and mechanisms of accountability, and trans-
parent governance, “structural corruption”
can be overcome only by radical reform of the
political architecture. “Structural corruption”
is one of the biggest obstacles to reform since
it is systematically used to sabotage political
and civil activity through its containment of
the élites and by creating classes with vested
interests in the status quo who are ready to
defend it at all costs.
CONTOURS OF CORRUPTION IN
ARAB COUNTRIES
The Freedom Survey, Annex 1, incorporates
detailed measures of corruption in five Arab
countries, which were used in carrying out a
field survey on the subject. Some of the results
are given below.
The perceived spread of corruption (the
ratio of participants in the survey who believe
that corruption is pervasive) exceeded 90% in
the five participating Arab countries. It is not
expected to be less widespread in those coun-
tries that were not part of the survey.
Respondents believed that corruption is
more pervasive in politics. Corruption is con-
sidered prevalent in the economy and social
relations. Neither parliaments nor the judiciary
escaped the perception of corruption (Figure
5-4).
In general politicians, businessmen and
high-ranking officials head the list in the
spread of corruption in the surveyed countries.
The comparative rank of each country varies.
In some countries, respondents complained
more about corruption at the lower levels of
the civil service (Figure 5-5).
PETTY CORRUPTION
Petty corruption refers to situations where
Arab citizens have to rely on personal contacts
(wasta) or pay a bribe to obtain services that
are legitimate and to which they are entitled,
or to avert a punishment by the authorities.
The majority of respondents said that they
were aware of a bribe paid or favours rendered
Figure 5-4
Areas in which corruption is perceived to be widespread, five Arab countries,
Freedom Survey, 2003
Figure 5-5
Extent to which different societal groups are believed to be involved in the spread
of corruption, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
138 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
through personal contacts during the year
preceding the survey. Of the two, wasta is the
more widespread occurrence (Figure 5-6).
Respondents thought that the most impor-
tant reason for resorting to wasta and bribery
was to obtain a service. This underscores that
often it is not possible to obtain a satisfactory
service in these countries without such prac-
tices. In a few cases, wasta and bribery were
used to escape a punishment (Figure 5-7).
Respondents thought that it was less use-
ful to take their cases up in the media or with
the authorities in order to obtain a service or
avert punishment and that the two most effec-
tive resorts remained paying a bribe or wasta
(Figure 5-8).
THE ARAB COUNTRIES IN
THE GLOBAL CONTEXT OF
GOVERNANCE, 2002
The World Bank publishes an international
database on indicators of governance and
corruption
1
(Kaufmann, Kraay and Mastruzzi,
2003). In this section, we utilize this database
to indicate the position of the Arab region rela-
tive to other country groupings, on five major
groups of indicators:
• Voice and accountability: a cluster of in-
dicators measuring various aspects of civil and
political rights and the political process;
• Political stability and absence of vio-
lence: the indicators cover the likelihood of the
government being destabilized or overthrown
via unconstitutional or violent means, includ-
ing terrorism;
• Government effectiveness: this describes
the quality of services provided by the public
sector; efficiency of the civil service and the
extent to which it is independent and free of
political pressure; and the credibility of gov-
ernment policies;
• Rule of Law: this measures the extent to
which legal provisions enjoy confidence and
are adhered to, particularly as regards the ex-
tent to which crime is widespread; efficiency of
the judiciary, and the fulfilment of contractual
obligations;
• Control of Corruption: this indicator
measures the extent to which corruption is
perceived to be widespread, bearing in mind
that this is “an abuse of public power for pri-
vate benefit.”
Figure 5-6
Knowledge of acts of bribery or "favouritism" (wasta*) during the 12 months
preceding the survey, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
* Use of personal influence or connections.
The majority of
respondents said that
they were aware of
a bribe paid or favours
rendered during the
year preceding the
survey.
1
Based on a few hundred variables measuring perceptions of governance derived from 25 sources provided by 18 different organizations.
139 THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
Figure 5-8
The best way to obtain a favour or to avoid a penalty, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
Figure 5-7
Reason for paying a bribe or using wasta during the 12 months preceding the survey, five Arab
countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
140 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Figures 5-9 - 5-13 contain graphical repre-
sentations of the position of the Arab region
with respect to other regions of the world on
each of these indicators.
The figures show that the average of Arab
countries falls close to the lower end of the
indicator value.
In this quantitative perspective then, the
features of poor governance in Arab countries
and the need for radical reform are once again
confirmed.
This section compares the average among
Arab countries (which vary from one to an-
other): table a1-8 provides the breakdown on
a country by country basis. A study of these
results shows that Arab countries rate worst
in the cluster of indicators relating to repre-
sentation and accountability. All Arab coun-
tries scored less than 0, as measured by this
indicator. Arab countries exhibit a wider range
of ratings on the scale where other indicator
clusters are concerned.
THE DEBATE ON HOW TO
REFORM
In view of the Arab and international consen-
sus on the need to reform the Arab political
scene and build good governance, there are
essential requirements to be fulfilled. The
first challenge is to reduce the centralized
role of the executive in favour of other state
institutions, civil society and local government
in order to expand freedoms and guarantee
fundamental human rights. However, this does
not seem possible without the co-operation of
the executive, which controls the underpin-
nings of the state. For this reason there is acute
disagreement and even polarization among the
Arab élites about the right way to reform. The
debate revolves around whether to reform
from the top-down (from the state), or from
the bottom-up (civil society); whether change
should spring from inside or through outside
assistance and, ultimately, what values such
a reform seeks to instil: traditional values, in-
cluding religious ones, or modern, democratic
and secular values along Western lines.
Figure 5-10
Political stability, the Arab region compared to other world regions, 2002
Figure 5-11
Government effectiveness, the Arab region compared to other world regions,
2002
Figure 5-9
Voice and accountability, the Arab region compared to other world regions,
2002
141 THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
THE DISCOURSE ON REFORM
Change from the top or at grass-roots?
Advocates of Arab political reform, backed by
international organizations and donor states,
tend to opt for gradual reform from the “bot-
tom-up”, through civil society activity. This
position has several justifications, among them
the deep-seated belief that Arab societies are
not yet sufficiently mature for democracy and
that the Arab political community is not ready
to assume the responsibilities of change. In this
view, civil society can bridge the gap on the
one hand, and pave the way for change on the
other, through education and culture-building
for democracy. There is also a belief that the
regimes may be more inclined to accept civil
activity, which poses no direct challenge to
their authority, than direct political activity.
By contrast, there are those who believe
in the priority of political reform, particularly
because civil society cannot exist without a
state respectful of a minimum of freedoms; this
makes the situation more of a vicious circle.
It is their view that direct pressure should be
exerted on governments to make them accept
reform. Undoubtedly, voluntary reform by
regimes that have come to realize that reform
is inevitable, either under foreign pressure or
owing to a rift in the ruling élite, would, if
genuine, be the shortest route to good gov-
ernance and the least costly; that all remains,
nevertheless, in the realm of promises. Regimes
apparently want to apply a policy of “escaping
forward” and manœuvering, making changes
that are mere formalities and do not represent
any true reform. Those effected and even
those proposed remain limited. Some observ-
ers believe that Arab regimes have developed
a unique model of “liberalized autocracy”, one
that the limited powers of civil society cannot
gradually change in the absence of an effective
political community (Brumberg, 2003, 43).
These two perspectives can be reconciled
if we bear in mind that these reforms, how-
ever limited their impact, have created space
for movement in both the social and political
arenas that can be exploited to change and
develop the political situation, as we shall see
below.
External versus internal
The critical Arab political situation has led
some to pin their hopes on foreign action. To
them this seems, practically speaking, the only
available solution to bring about change, ei-
ther by using the military to bring the regime
to an end as in Iraq, or by exerting pressure
on the regime while offering compromise solu-
tions as in the Sudan. This situation has led to
a heated debate in Arab élite circles about the
usefulness of associating external factors with
change. Many object on principle, while others
Figure 5-13
Control of corruption, the Arab region compared to other world regions, 2002
Figure 5-12
The rule of law, the Arab region compared to other world regions, 2002
Voluntary reform by
regimes…would,
if genuine, be the
shortest route to good
governance and the
least costly.
142 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
justify it as a necessity and others still warn that
foreign intervention will become inevitable if
those concerned do not hasten to take the ini-
tiative from inside (Dorgham, in Arabic, 2003,
Ibrahim, in Arabic, 2003, al Zayyat, in Arabic,
2003).
By way of contrast, certain groups hold
that the ideal form of foreign intervention to
promote democracy would be to stop sup-
porting dictatorial regimes in the Arab world
(Sadiqi, 2004, 320).
The Optimum Choice
This brings us to the alternative possibility,
that of change stemming from within and led
by dynamic social forces with a clear stake in
such change. Past experience in Eastern Eu-
rope and Latin America (and in some Arab
states like the Sudan) point to the importance
of a move that can come from civil society or-
ganizations, trade unions, voluntary associa-
tions and religious movements, a move to end
the state’s monopoly over political activity; a
move to strengthen society’s ability to resist the
mechanisms of systematic repression used by
the State to immobilize social forces.
Methods of repression and state terrorism
are for tyrannical regimes “like bank reserves”,
to quote Waterbury “effective only if the cli-
ents do not rush in droves to withdraw their
money. If most citizens defy the regime, the lat-
ter fails to find enough terror, jails and savage
cruelty to meet the requirements of domina-
BOX 5-3
Moncef Al-Marzouqi: Giving democracy every chance
The idea of democracy has penetrated minds
among the élites, politicians and ever widen-
ing groups of society following a slow evolu-
tion begun by the few “reconnaissance units”
which, at the beginning of the last century,
took it upon themselves to start consider-
ing democracy as a possible alternative and
begin thinking about its adaptation and
Arabization. This small band of intellectuals
and politicians was fiercely opposed by the
autocratic system in intellectual and political
battles over contrived problems, such as the
priority of economic progress over freedoms,
cultural specificity, the suitability or other-
wise of democracy for Arabs and the need for
a slow transition to democracy so as not to
make it indigestible.
The collapse of such ideas, however,
does not mean that the Arabs collectively
have come close to harvesting this crop or
that they can plant it in a wasteland which
still requires a lot of preparation. They have
taken only their first steps along the road, and
few can say where that road is truly heading.
Even the “forward reconnaissance units” of
political pioneers have difficulty picturing
the phases of transition from their former
political system to democracy. Will it hap-
pen gradually, peacefully or violently, with
or against the West? With the Islamists, or
on condition of their elimination? To this I
would add that few are interested in examin-
ing the actual mechanisms of democracy with
a critical eye. The common denominator
among advocates of democracy is their blind
faith in it as the ideal prescription for curing
the ills of the political system with a magic
wand. Let us not forget that we once believed
in “the homeland” and in socialism and unity;
in embracing democracy, we are today adopt-
ing the same uncritical mental attitude we had
then. It is crucial that we should listen care-
fully to its enemies, since:
He who is content is blind to every flaw
He who is discontent sees nought but failings
If, in the 1930s, the communists had
listened to the enemies of communism and
understood that discontent is like a magnifier
that enlarges any intrinsic flaws, and if they
had promptly addressed these flaws, history
might have taken a different course.
This passing observation underscores
that the corrosive flaws which ate into na-
tionalism, pan-Arabism and socialism were
present in the mechanisms, institutions, ideas
and values on which they were based and that
they simply surfaced when they were able to
do so. This is a general rule and we believe
democracy to be no exception. We should
therefore ask ourselves about the negative as-
pects of democracy to which we are blind and
which may render all our sacrifices in vain, as
occurred with many of the aspirations nur-
tured by socialists, whose socialism betrayed
them before the world did.
We should be extremely wary of any
democracy that manifests any or all of the
following characteristics in which:
- It is unaware that its essential function is
to expand economic and social rights;
- It fails to remember that its development
and even its survival are dependent on the
expansion of citizenship through the genuine
participation of each person at her/his own
level;
- It focuses narrowly on representation
(bearing in mind that the word must also be
understood in its theatrical sense), meaning
that its mechanisms are built on electoral
rites dominated and exploited by hidden
aristocracies using private finance, their vir-
tual monopoly of the media which they own,
and elected officials with neither power nor
strength that ultimately resign in frustration
and angrily exit the stage in search of another
solution to their problems;
- It puts the reins of power in the hands of
campaigners carrying out programmes mar-
keted through publicity methods designed to
ensure that politics and politicians have the
lowest status among the people, as is often the
case in liberal countries.
As advocates of democracy, we therefore
demand a three-pronged campaign to break
down the defences of the autocratic system;
drive the democratic venture forward into
people’s hearts and minds, and deep into the
political arena; and generate serious thinking
about alternatives that use the experience of
different peoples to advantage, without ap-
plying ready-made prescriptions, particularly
at the institutional level. The aim of this war
is to avoid making rash ideological statements
along the lines of “democracy is the solu-
tion”. Such slogans might one day bring us to
grieve over its remains, repeating meaningless
phrases such as “democracy is so very attrac-
tive and its advocates are so very repellent.”
Certain groups hold
that the ideal form of
foreign intervention to
promote democracy
would be to stop
supporting dictatorial
regimes in the Arab
world.
143 THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
tion” (Waterbury 1995, 82).
The next step, namely transition to direct
political action, requires a consensus among
the élites. After all, one of the main reasons
why current circumstances do not change
is that the regime has succeeded in dividing
society’s vanguards, even convincing some
that it is in their interest to resist democratic
change while also encouraging sectarian, tribal
and other divisive trends. Such a consensus is
of great importance, first because it represents
the very essence of the democratic process
and what distinguishes it from popularism,
which is, basically, the outcome of negotiations
among parties to an as-yet-unresolved conflict
(Przeworski, 1988; Waterbury, 1995, 91-102).
Secondly, because the expected popular up-
risings against the state of affairs will, in the
absence of such consensus, inevitably turn into
civil wars, as in Algeria and Somalia.
Bridging the gap between political forces
If consensus among the political forces is a pre-
requisite for positive transformation of the po-
litical arena, formulas for its achievement are
needed. There are, in the Arab world, several
splits dividing the political forces into sectar-
ian, racial, regional and tribal groups.
The biggest divide, however, is that
separating the Islamists on one side and the
secularists, liberals and nationalists, on the
other. In fact, this rift has come to replace the
traditionalist/radical one which dominated the
political arena in past years. To bring about a
consensus among all these forces undoubtedly
requires creative thinking out of the box. We
would add that the matter must go beyond tac-
tical and phased agreements (without underes-
timating their importance, since democracy is
the outcome of a series of successful bargains
and agreements). Rather, it must result in in-
tellectual and methodological reconsideration
by the parties concerned. Some reviews have
already begun and these should be encouraged
and built upon. They should include a re-ex-
amination by the Islamists of their views on
democracy, human rights and the question of
citizenship. Other movements should review
their exclusionist and dictatorial tendencies,
their condemnation of past mistakes and re-
pressive actions. For all, the goal is to develop
a new way of thinking, more in keeping with
the requirements of democracy and peaceful
co-existence with competing movements.
“If most citizens defy
the regime, the latter
fails to find enough
terror, jails and
savage cruelty to meet
the requirements of
domination.”
CHAPTER SIX
Arab Societal Structures and
the Regional and International
Environments
ARAB SOCIETAL STRUCTURES AND THE REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL ENVIRONMENTS 145
Introduction
The societal context in Arab countries is the
third key factor in explaining the currently
deteriorating state of freedom and govern-
ance in the region. This chapter looks at
both the internal and external dimensions
of that context. The first dimension includes
the characteristics of societal structures in
Arab countries and of the dominant (rentier)
mode of production. The second dimension
relates to the impacts of the regional and
global environments surrounding the Arab
world, which have recently had a stronger
influence in detracting from freedom in
Arab countries, particularly in terms of na-
tional liberation.
SOCIETAL STRUCTURES
THE CHAIN THAT STIFLES
INDIVIDUAL FREEDOM
A number of interrelated factors constricting
freedom are embedded in Arab societal struc-
tures. Despite their diversity and complexity,
1
each of these factors is a link in an intercon-
nected chain. Starting with the child’s up-
bringing within the family, passing through
educational institutions, the world of work,
and societal formation, and ending with poli-
tics - both internal and external - each link in
the chain takes its portion of freedom from the
individual and delivers her or him to the next,
which, in turn, steals a further share. These
links reinforce one another in a highly efficient
coercive system.
Clannism (al-‘asabiya) in Arab Society—the
Authoritarian Paternalist System and the
Family
Clannism, in all its forms, (tribal, clan-based,
communal, and ethnic) (Mohammad Abed al-
Jabiri, in Arabic, 1995) tightly shackles its fol-
lowers through the power of the authoritarian
patriarchal system. This phenomenon, amply
discussed in the literature (Hisham Sharabi,
in Arabic, 1990), represents a two-way street
in which obedience and loyalty are offered in
return for protection, sponsorship, and a share
of the spoils.
Clannism implants submission, parasitic
dependence and compliance in return for
protection and benefits. More damagingly still,
clannism is the enemy of personal independ-
ence, intellectual daring, and the flowering of
a unique and authentic human entity. It blocks
the energies that lead to growth and a mature,
self-reliant intellect. It must do this to ensure
its own smooth functioning and to guarantee
its sway. The reproduction of this phenom-
enon across society turns it into an array of
suffocating institutions that reward loyalty and
discount performance. One is good so long as
one’s loyalty is guaranteed; it does not matter,
naturally, if one’s performance is poor; and
woe betide clan members whose loyalty falters,
however good their performance.
The worst effect of clannism is that it eats
into the cohesive force of citizenship and its in-
stitutional manifestations. Yet clannism is not
an unalloyed evil.
2
Its positive aspects include
a sense of belonging to a community and the
desire to put its interests first. This can amount
to a total dedication, or self-abnegation, for
1
A sustained and careful research effort is called for in order to deconstruct the Arab societal order, especially in terms of its relation to freedom and
good governance.
2
It has been handed down that the Prophet said that “A man’s love for his people” is not clannism, but “it is clannism when a man supports his
people in injustice” (Farid Abdel Khaliq, in Arabic, 1998, 213)
Each link in the chain
takes its portion of
freedom from the
individual and delivers
her or him to the next,
which, in turn, steals a
further share.
Clannism implants
submission, parasitic
dependence and
compliance in return
for protection and
benefits.
146 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
the sake of the community that bespeaks an
impressive sense of common purpose, one
often stronger than that found in some modern
forms of societal organization.
The problem with clannism in Arab coun-
tries is that it produces types of societal organi-
sation that are modern in form but objectively
backward. Class structure is an example.
In East Asia, for instance, traditional family
capitalism is responsible for important modern
achievements, but in the Arab environment
it is associated with a rent-based economic
model, with all that that suggests by way of
exalting the values of obligation, favouritism,
and inefficiency. Consequently, family capital-
ism in the Arab world has failed to realize the
advances of “the Asian miracle.”
A creative – and difficult – challenge for
the future is to find ways to blend such positive
aspects of clannism with the concept of citizen-
ship in order to develop a basis for freedom
and good governance.
Clannism pervades a large number of Arab
societal structures, which it transforms into
centres of influence. There are political, mili-
tary, regional, and administrative allegiances,
and Arab citizens cannot avoid becoming
ensnared in their nets if they wish to preserve
their status in society, their livelihoods, and
their personal security.
Clannism flourishes, and its negative im-
pact on freedom and society becomes stronger,
wherever civil or political institutions that pro-
tect rights and freedoms are weak or absent.
Without institutional supports, individuals are
driven to seek refuge in narrowly based loyal-
ties that provide security and protection, thus
further aggravating the phenomenon. Partisan
allegiances also develop when the judiciary is
ineffective or the executive authority is reluc-
tant to implement its rulings, circumstances
that make citizens unsure of their ability to
realize their rights without the allegiances of
the clan.
In varying degrees, the family, the primary
unit of Arab society, is based on clannism. The
dosage is larger in clan-based societal groups
and lower in modern urban families, especially
affluent ones.
The Arab family started as an extended
(tribal or clan-based) unit and has ended up as a
nuclear one. It has however retained at its heart
a power structure in which a “pure form” of
authority remains. This consists of a father (or
other male in the absence of the natural father)
who often tends to be authoritarian, bestowing
and withholding favours; a mother, usually ten-
der-hearted, submissive, and resigned, who has
no say in important matters except behind the
scenes; and children who are the objects of the
father’s instructions and the mother’s tender-
ness. These children are referred to in everyday
language as “ignorant kids” and “scroungers”
and are barred from any say in their dealings
with adults, or any confrontation with them,
whatever the Convention on the Rights of the
Child may provide for on that score.
Obviously, in such male-oriented struc-
tures girls are subject to a double dose of
freedom-denying authority.
Yet this traditional picture of the authori-
tarian Arab family is starting to break up as a
result of the increased pace of social change,
the influence of modernity, including informa-
tion and communication technologies, and
changes of a political nature.
Contributing powerfully to the erosion
of clannism in Arab households is the rise of
women within the family, sometimes at its head.
There are several reasons for this: increased
education for girls and their aptitude for, and
excellence in educational achievement; wom-
en’s increasing contributions to family earnings
as a result of their growing participation in the
labour market, -especially amid economic
slumps and rising poverty- and particularly in
the informal sector, where working conditions
are both flexible and difficult. Another factor
is that more families are breaking up through
increasing marital separation of various kinds,
arrangements that often lead to the woman’s
shouldering of responsibility for the children.
Women in the occupied Arab territories and
those in theatres of war have also come to
shoulder increased familial responsibilities
because men are frequently disabled, lost or
detained as a result of the conflict.
Another force eroding clannism is the rise
of a younger generation inclined, for various
reasons, to rebel against the clannish practices
of its forebears.
Clannism flourishes,
and its negative
impact on freedom
and society becomes
stronger, wherever
civil or political
institutions are weak
or absent.
Contributing
powerfully to the
erosion of clannism in
Arab households is the
rise of women within
the family, sometimes
at its head.
147 ARAB SOCIETAL STRUCTURES AND THE REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL ENVIRONMENTS
Education
The second AHDR (2003) analysed the status
of knowledge acquisition and diffusion in the
Arab world and identified a growing knowl-
edge gap. It underlined that the largest chal-
lenge facing Arab education was its declining
quality. In Arab educational institutions, cur-
ricula, teaching and evaluation methods tend
to rely on dictation and instil submissiveness.
They do not permit free dialogue and active,
exploratory learning and consequently do not
open the doors to freedom of thought and criti-
cism. On the contrary, they weaken the capac-
ity to hold opposing viewpoints and to think
outside the box. Their societal role focuses on
the reproduction of control in Arab societies.
However, the educational system is not
uniform in Arab countries. In addition to the
predominant government-provided education
sector, there are at least two other sectors that
are at odds with public education from one or
more perspectives. The first is private educa-
tion mainly serving the affluent, a sector that
is expanding exponentially as a result of the
deterioration of public education. Privately
educated students may gain a better level of
knowledge and skills and may perhaps pre-
serve a greater measure of freedom. This is so,
however, mostly in an individual sense. Educa-
tion in this sector is often tied to foreign cur-
ricula or to foreign educational institutions and
lessons are taught in a foreign language. This
type of education is thus faulted at times for
instilling in its students a measure of detach-
ment from their own societies, and especially
from their culture, since they are acquiring a
different culture - manifested in their curricula
as well as in the language and style of their
education. In many cases, their detachment
can prevent students from communicating ef-
fectively with their societies and from transfer-
ring to it whatever knowledge and skills they
may acquire.
The second sector is the religious educa-
tion system found in some Arab countries,
which attracts those who do not find a place in
either public or private education. Teaching in
these places is more restrictive of freedom and
more reinforcing of traditional loyalties than in
either of the two alternatives.
The subdivision of the educational system
into three mutually exclusive sectors leads to
the weakening of the social fabric and the
narrowing of opportunities for the growth of
a shared space whose common denominator is
citizenship.
The suppression of freedom in the educa-
tional system is not reserved for students but
rather encompasses the totality of the system.
Thus teachers, “oppressors” of their pupils,
are in turn subject to oppression by the edu-
cational administration whether at the teacher-
training institute, or local, or central levels.
And this is to say nothing of the oppression of
BOX 6-1
Education and Human Rights in Arab Countries
Basic Conclusions:
From the study of the contents of school-
books and courses in terms of their
substance, goals, and directives, it is clear
that they fail to reflect any clear strategy
for the teaching of human rights prin-
ciples and values. Because the general
principles used in their preparation show
little awareness of human rights at that
level, the presentation of these principles
and values is random and unsystematic.
Since course components were not con-
ceived as parts of a strategy to acquaint
students with such rights, their content,
goals and objectives offer little food for
thought or training.
Though the books did refer to some
human rights principles, these references
were scattered and based on a methodol-
ogy that, for the most part, aimed at cre-
ating a “faith-based” mentality reliant on
passive acceptance, or even on instilling
fear. This pedagogical approach contra-
dicts the right to the development of the
personality and of a critical mind and
inhibits creativity and innovation.
It is significant that while teacher
training institutes and training sessions
are intended to prepare the teacher pro-
fessionally, equip them with methodolo-
gies and information and knowledge in
various fields, nowhere do human rights
feature among the subjects in which they
receive training
School text books and human rights
principles
From the study and analysis of courses
and text-books in basic education, i.e. at
primary and preparatory levels, the main
conclusions are as follows:
• Among the great quantity of books
analysed, few, if any, texts and objectives
clearly express an awareness of human
rights.
• There are indications in some cases
that initial steps have been taken to ad-
vance human rights education. However,
this does not apply equally to all Arab
countries, and there are no common
standards among these measures in
terms of their level, pace or methodol-
ogy. Moreover, they do not apply to all
academic subjects or school years.
• Contents of text-books are geared
towards other goals: social, economic,
ideological or religious, which makes
it difficult to say that the provision
of human rights principles is an aim
in itself in most Arab schools. More
often than not, they are a factor within
a different context: in praise of the Arab
homeland, or of the Islamic or Christian
religion, or else as a factor in criticizing
and condemning the practices of other
peoples. Human rights are therefore
used to advance other aims, rather than
to teach and educate young people about
the principles themselves.
Thus, in the majority of Arab coun-
tries covered by the study, school-books
and courses reflect obvious contradic-
tions with human rights principles as
universally accepted.
Source: Arab Institute for Human Rights, 2001
The subdivision of the
educational system
into three mutually
exclusive sectors leads
to the weakening of
the social fabric.
148 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
teachers as a group within society as a whole,
a trend that reflects the decline in the material
and moral status of the majority of teachers.
What of those who never attend school
or do not go on to complete its upper stages,
most of whom are the children of the weaker
social strata? Usually, this group joins the
labour market early, and so receives training
via the apprenticeship system, which imparts
useful practical skills, at least in terms of those
required by the labour market. To that extent,
the labour market may substitute for the lack
of education, even if only in part.
3
This group
may, then, be more fortunate in acquiring skills
that translate into a higher level of earnings, as
studies in certain Arab countries have shown
(Nader Fergany, 1998). From a freedom per-
spective, early school-leavers escape the loss
of freedom that the educational system exacts
but often do not preserve their freedom in full,
since the apprenticeship system, especially in
the manual and technical professions, is itself a
rigid and authoritarian pyramid.
For all its deficiencies and flaws, educa-
tion, particularly at the higher levels, remains a
vital source of knowledge, enlightenment and
leavening for the forces of change. Perhaps
the most eloquent and dynamic expression of
that vitality is the vigour of university students’
protests, despite the political intimidation
characteristic of Arab societies.
Included in the educational apparatus in
its broad sense are the media, which are char-
acterised by one-sided views and a tendency to
puff imagined achievements and glorify “the
one leader”. Many also serve up forms of cheap
entertainment aimed at gratifying the senses
rather than edifying the mind.
4
As a result, the
public mind is not opened to opportunities for
self-development, knowledge acquisition or
new thinking, let alone to criticism of contem-
porary events and to creative ways of changing
it. More recent generations of Arabs may well
be more strongly influenced by the media than
by educational institutions.
Not all media channels are mediocre. For
those able to access them, the “new wave”
media, such as the Arab satellite television sta-
tions and some newspapers and their web sites,
have started to provide avenues for knowledge
acquisition and for freedom of expression and
opinion that were previously unattainable.
Freedom in the content of education in
three Maghreb countries
A study carried out in three Maghreb countries
— Morocco, Algeria, and Tunisia — focusing
on curricula for the subjects Arabic Language
and Civic Education at the preparatory or in-
termediate level, reached the following con-
clusions (Lemrini and Marwazi, background
paper for this Report):
The way the concept of freedom figures in
schoolbooks confirms a deficiency, not only in
relation to the concept itself, but also to values
related to human rights as a whole. Omitting
freedom, which is one of the fundamental
principles and values on which other values
rest, can only lead to omissions in the concepts
of personal dignity, equality, justice, and as-
sociated civil, political, economic, social, and
cultural rights.
• Given how thin Arab freedom is in reality,
references to it in these texts relate to a free-
dom indistinguishable from homeland and re-
ligion. The source from which freedom is said
to derive its authority fluctuates between these
two. In practical terms, this influences the
choice of texts, which, for the most part, are set
either in the recent past (the colonial and/or
independence period) or the distant past (the
initial stages of Islam). This invites the learner
to live in the past more than the present, and
this basic feature of the texts determines the
development of knowledge and personality in
the following ways:
- A disjunction between text and reality.
- Double standards in the way things are
viewed (“our actual situation is poor and its
parameters are set by defeat on a number of
levels, but we are the best of nations in exist-
ence”).
- The propagation of illusion (“regardless of
the givens of our current situation, we shall be
3
The other side to the equation is of course that the education system’s poor outcome in terms of skills valued by the labour market is one aspect of
the deteriorating quality of education.
4
Recently many have contrasted the surfeit of short video clips in the Arab media, which are aimed at sensual arousal, with the paucity of nourishing
intellectual content.
More recent
generations of Arabs
may well be more
strongly influenced
by the media than
by educational
institutions.
The way the concept
of freedom figures in
schoolbooks confirms
a deficiency, not only
in relation to the
concept itself, but also
to values related to
human rights.
149 ARAB SOCIETAL STRUCTURES AND THE REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL ENVIRONMENTS
victorious, if only because we were victorious
in the past.” What is not specified is that vic-
tory here refers to the current battles against
poverty, ignorance, or despotism… Thus the
point of departure is religion and the point of
arrival is the homeland, which supports the
point of departure while failing to evoke the
present reality by examining society).
Taking the past as the starting point intro-
duces a self-justifying logic into the lesson, be-
cause the present, which does not bear out the
opinion proffered, is not allowed to challenge
it. Hence the lesson becomes mere pretence,
divorced from reality.
• The existence of individual and collective
freedoms is acknowledged in Civic/National
Education classes dealing with citizenship, but
the appearance of the same freedoms varies
from rare to nil in Arabic Language classes. The
fact that individual and collective freedoms are
interrelated and mutually reinforcing and that
both rest on such freedoms as the law may
guarantee (e.g. freedom of opinion) is relevant
for students; but this point is not addressed at
the level of the Arabic Language texts. Instead,
these texts analyse particular freedoms via nar-
ratives relying on suggestion, explicit direction,
and manipulation of the language. What does
the guarantee of the individual’s right to own
property, cited in the Civic Education books,
mean to a citizen who is unemployed and thus
unable to exercise that right in the simplest of
the forms described in the books used in the
Arabic Language class? And what do guar-
antees of freedom of opinion and expression
(mentioned in the same books) mean when
people’s thinking is restricted to one school
of religious law or the ideology of one ruling
party? What, above all, does freedom of choice
mean when the Arabic Language texts deal
with everything connected with marriage and
the family in the language of command, prohi-
bition, submission, tutelage, and obedience?
• The reality of the freedoms depicted in
school-books (the Arabic Language texts, for
example) is the reality of their absence. They
are not available and cannot be enjoyed. They
are present only to the extent that prohibitions
and restrictions, which negatively imply that
they exist, abound and because many are de-
prived of them.
• Given the distinguished status of training
as a basic pillar in the process of qualification,
its evaluation provides a mirror that reflects the
defining vision and background of the authors
of schoolbooks. If these books themselves show
scant regard for the concept of freedom and its
associated principles, values and human rights
(Arabic Language texts) or for its legal basis
(Civic Education), the questions and activities
in the accompanying exercises reveal much
about the trends that determine the pedagogi-
cal imagination. Whenever the texts incline,
in context or meaning, to overlook rights and
freedoms, it should be insistently required that
training correct this deficiency by deconstruct-
ing those values that are not compatible with
rights and freedoms and by introducing the
values that would reinforce them. Thus the
texts that touch on slavery could serve a ben-
eficial purpose if the exercises provided an af-
firmation of equality, the right to life, freedom,
and personal dignity. Texts themselves could
build a framework and opportunity for review-
ing and enacting outcomes of Civic Education
at this level.
• The standardized nature of exercise ques-
tions does not allow the learner to discover,
absorb, or assimilate the values that reinforce
freedoms and human rights. On the contrary,
learners are limited to a few set illustrations
that are maintained rigidly through an inter-
pretation that is linked to the text, memoriza-
tion and the language. As a result, the material
becomes a mere vehicle for itself (language),
disassociated from its subject (values).
• The different levels of exercises not only
fail to provide the learner with information
related to freedom; they also fail to make him
or her aware of its value. Discussion, opinion,
expression, and understanding are all circum-
scribed by the text and are converted through
it into mere footnotes or marginalia that take a
proper understanding of the text for granted.
Learning comes to be governed by dictation,
without the learner being educated in, or prac-
ticing, freedom.
The World of Work
After completing their higher education, chil-
dren of the middle class usually seek a job of
What does freedom
of choice mean when
the Arabic Language
texts deal with
everything connected
with marriage
and the family in
the language of
command, prohibition,
submission, tutelage
and obedience?
Learning comes to be
governed by dictation
without the learner
being educated in, or
practicing, freedom.
150 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
some note (according to prevailing criteria).
This generally comes after a period of unem-
ployment whose length depends, in the ab-
sence of efficient labour market mechanisms,
on the capacity of the family to mobilize what-
ever money and power they may be blessed
with. While awaiting their release, the gradu-
ates return to the bosoms of their families,
where their dependence on patriarchal bounty
increases in proportion to their expanding
needs as they get older and in the absence of
the independent resources that would enable
them to act freely.
When fate or chance ends the period of
unemployment, the graduate steps onto the
lowest rung of a rigid, restrictive hierarchy,
especially if the job is with the civil service.
The graduate’s lowly status in this hierarchy is
compounded by the poor work skills he or she
has acquired, as a result of the declining quality
of education. Only a small minority of young
people, usually the children of the influential
few with money or political authority, emerges
from the attrition of the work world with a por-
tion of individual and personal freedom intact.

The Political Realm
For those that are impelled to take an active
interest in current affairs and political trends
and to express that interest publicly, or that try
and organize to achieve some social goal, soci-
ety has several risks in store. Such people meet,
at the hands of the authorities and their instru-
ments, enough troubles to guarantee that, in
most cases, their appetite for social action will
be short-lived. At this point, the grip of the
social chain on freedom in Arab countries be-
comes intense.
The Arab public space is small and con-
stricted. Its limited dimensions do not enable
civil society institutions to provide effective
group protection to citizens who are vulner-
able to oppression as individuals. This weak-
ness increases the oppressive impact of politics
on the individual in Arab countries and allows
overt and covert powers to curtail the fragile
freedoms of society’s atomised members. As
discussed in the second section of this chapter,
violations from the outside world compound
this situation.
Poverty and the Class Structure
Poverty is the antithesis of human develop-
ment, depriving people of the opportunity
to acquire capabilities and to utilise them ef-
ficiently to achieve a decent life. Poverty also
prevents people from participating effectively,
as families and individuals, in civil and politi-
cal society. It thus robs the public sphere of its
vitality and contributes to the impoverishment
of politics.
Thus, champions of freedom and good
governance tend to emerge more strongly
higher up the social structure, to the extent
that the upper echelons are sympathetic to the
cause of freedom and support the organiza-
tions of civil and political society. Nonetheless,
an aversion to involvement in public life, and
especially in political activity, continues among
those in the better-off social groups who are
concerned with protecting their possessions
and special social status. Eliminating poverty
in coercive societies where citizens are striving
for freedom is especially important because
poverty tends to force people to focus on meet-
ing their basic needs and thus prevents them
BOX 6-2
Educational Development in Tunisia
In the early 1990s, Tunisia launched
an educational reform programme
aimed at nurturing in students the key
values of freedom, equality and non-dis-
crimination, especially between men and
women. Its objectives included instilling
an appreciation of rational methods of
thinking and of dealing with others, and
of the value of opening up to other cul-
tures and to the wealth of ideas humanity
has produced in various fields including
technology, science and the humanities.
The reform necessitated a review of
educational programmes, curricula and
school textbooks and the organization of
teacher-training courses. This pioneering
experience would repay close study and
evaluation.
BOX 6-3
Omar ibn Abd al-Aziz: Justice and the law, not the
sword and the whip
Ibn Asakir, quoting al-Saib ibn Mu-
hammad, said: Al-Jarrah ibn Abdullah
wrote to Omar ibn Abd al-Aziz, “The
people of Khurasan are an unruly mob,
and the only way of persuading them to
mend their ways is by means of the sword
and the whip, if the Commander of the
Faithful will give me permission to adopt
that method.” Omar wrote back, “I have
received your letter describing the people
of Khurasan as an unruly mob who can
be persuaded to mend their ways only by
means of the sword and the whip. That
is quite untrue; the way to persuade them
to mend their ways is by means of justice
and the law, and that is the method you
must apply.”
Jalal al-Din al-Suyuti, 194
Source: Farid Abdel Khaliq, in Arabic, 1998, 24
The Arab public
space is small and
constricted.
151 ARAB SOCIETAL STRUCTURES AND THE REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL ENVIRONMENTS
from contributing to the public space, more so
than in other types of societies.
There is a perception that poverty in Arab
countries is higher than levels indicated in in-
ternational databases. Insofar as inequalities in
income and wealth distribution are increasing,
the numbers of the weaker social groups are
growing. It is feared that the class structure
in Arab countries does not support a free and
well-governed society. Indeed, it may impede
the societal transformation required to bring
that about.
Is This Stranglehold Eternal?
As they tighten and grow, the constrictions
of the chain on freedom become internal
constraints on the self. Suppression leads
individuals to become their own censors and
to contain every urge to speak or act. Depriva-
tion succeeds most when people feel hostility
towards themselves and rein in normal human
aspirations and rebellions. At that point, the
individual is transformed into a complaisant
subject “more royalist than the king”.
This complicated structure has led Arab
citizens, including some among the intelligent-
sia, to a state of submission fed by fear and
marked by denial of their subjugation. This
state is manifested in acts of self-censorship and
in an evident retreat from public engagement
that sometimes amounts to “resigning from
politics”, a pattern that is reaffirmed among
younger generations (for example: Nader Fer-
gany, 1995). Yet there are signs, even among
segments traditionally considered pillars of the
establishment, that this state of affairs cannot
continue and that the natural urge of human
beings to claim their freedom will re-surface.
The stifling of freedom also pushes Arab
individuals to retreat into a preoccupation with
the basic needs of security and livelihood, for
they are neither master of their own persons nor
master in their own countries. Their citizen-
ship becomes a kind of gift conceded to them
on condition that they remain docile. The very
fabric of a free and open society is thus eroded.
As the individual enters into a state of learned
impotence (Westin, 1999) and society lapses
into a state of historical stagnation, custom and
repetition become the desiderata rather than
change, transformation, and growth (Mustafa
Hijazi, in Arabic, 2001).
Yet beneath the layers of submission and
stagnation there remains a frustration that
could explode in ways seriously detrimental
to human development if ever the container
grows weak. This kind of violent outcome
would be destructive of both people and civili-
sation and the antithesis of those vital energies
that drive a purposeful being and existence.
Such frustration, however, could be chan-
nelled in a positive developmental direction
if appropriate civil and political frameworks
were in place.
Such a transformation would spearhead a
transition from oppression and waste to revi-
talised human capacity by nurturing total com-
petence in the individual and creating capacity
and competence in institutions. These are the
components of psychological and institutional
health that guarantee growth and strength in
society. It would be a transition from a mor-
bid state of chronically weakened human and
institutional resources and flagging societal
resilience, to one of social efficacy that would
be capable of creating a role for Arab society
and raising its status. Strengthening any one of
these three dimensions (of psychological, insti-
tutional, and societal health) will trigger growth
and a new dynamic with a mutually reinforcing
effect on the other dimensions. It is this that
will bring about a change of orientation from
silence and historical stagnation or retreat to
development and progress (Mustafa Hijazi, in
Arabic, background paper for this Report).
A MODE OF PRODUCTION THAT
REINFORCES AUTHORITARIANISM
A society’s mode of production is the
method by which its economic surplus is
derived, distributed and invested, particularly
in developing and improving the productive
system itself through investment in human
and physical assets. The mode of production,
however, produces a mixture of societal ar-
rangements, notably in the form of political
structures and a societal system of incentives
that preserve and reproduce the main charac-
teristics of the mode.
Chapter 7 of the second AHDR discussed
how the Arab countries’ prevailing rentier
Suppression leads
individuals to become
their own censors and
to contain every urge
to speak or act.
Yet beneath the
layers of submission
and stagnation there
remains a frustration
that could explode.
152 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
mode of production weakens incentives for
knowledge acquisition. Here we discuss the
consequences of this mode of production for
freedom and governance.
In essence, the rentier mode of production
provides an economic foundation supportive
of authoritarian governance or at least fails to
provide the foundation of good governance,
particularly with regard to representation and
accountability (George Abed, 2004).
The basic source of rent in Arab countries
comes from the extraction of mostly unproc-
essed natural resources, primarily crude oil.
The direct benefit of oil rents is not confined to
Arab Gulf countries; in an increasing number
of other Arab countries, oil is also the main
source of public revenue. Oil rents flow into
non-oil Arab countries by way of financial
remittances, whether official or sent by their
citizens working in the oil countries.
Arab states also receive other rents, some of
which are derived from geographical location
such as the income of the Suez Canal. A small
number of Arab states that are positioned for
an influential role obtain rent on the strategic
position of the region and the challenges which
that position brings. They receive such inflows
principally in the form of aid.
As many studies have indicated, the
rentier mode of production opens cracks in
the fundamental relationship between citizens
as a source of public tax revenue and govern-
ment. Where a government relies on financing
from the tax base represented by its citizens,
it is subject to questioning about how it al-
locates state resources. In a rentier mode of
production, however, the government can act
as a generous provider that demands no taxes
or duties in return. This hand that gives can
also take away, and the government is there-
fore entitled to require loyalty from its citizens
invoking the mentality of the clan. In Arab oil
countries, such generosity has taken the form
of the “welfare State” particularly in times of
affluence. This form of governance has been
distinguished by the absence of taxation.
In the rentier State, therefore, government
is absolved of any periodic accountability, not
to mention representation. As long as the rent
continues to flow, there is no need for citizens
to finance government and thus expect it to
be accountable to them. On the contrary,
when the flow of rent depends on the good
will of influential outside forces, as in the case
of some Arab countries, the right of account-
ability passes to those who control the flow of
rent, instead of remaining with citizens, who
are turned into subjects.
By contrast, in countries where there is
representation and concomitant accountability
government revenue comes from taxes paid by
citizens. The latter therefore have the right to
hold the ruling bodies accountable about what
is being done with funds that they provide for
the public good and which they authorise the
government to manage on their behalf. Repre-
sentative institutions play a pivotal role in this
regard. A social mentality is firmly established
and patterns of behaviour are generally con-
sistent with the social contract that goes with
this political economy model.
In the Arab countries, taxes account for
only a small percentage of public revenue,
(Figure 6-1), with an even smaller percentage
than the average in Arab oil countries. In 2002
taxes in non-oil Arab countries accounted for
17% of GDP, and for around just 5% in Arab
oil countries (Arab Joint Economic Report,
in Arabic, 2003). This can be compared, for
example, to around 23% in Germany, 24% in
Italy, and 28% in UK. Thus taxes in themselves
provide no major stimulus for Arab citizens to
call the government to account for what it does
with their money.
This type of tax structure also minimizes
the opportunity for citizens to protest against
their government. Direct taxes, in particular
income tax, are viewed as the category of tax
that gives citizens most proof that they are con-
tributing to the public purse. In Arab coun-
tries, the majority of tax receipts are derived
from indirect sales and customs taxes hidden
in the price. In addition to falling more heav-
ily on the most vulnerable groups in society,
these types of tax typically conceal the direct
link between tax payments and funding of the
public purse, thus weakening public pressure
for accountability. At the same time, income
tax revenue is negligible and tax evasion is on
the rise, particularly among influential social
groups, which, in principle, should shoulder
the greatest burden in funding the public
Taxes in themselves
provide no major
stimulus for Arab
citizens to call the
government to
account for what
it does with their
money.
In the rentier
state, government
is absolved of
any periodic
accountability,
not to mention
representation.
153 ARAB SOCIETAL STRUCTURES AND THE REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL ENVIRONMENTS
purse, if only as fair return for their greater
share of power and wealth.
Moreover, in Arab countries, the share
of direct taxes appears to have dropped over
time, as a result of increasing resort to indirect
taxes (Figure 6-1).
In addition, this rentier mode of produc-
tion gives rise to specific arrangements for
reinforcing authoritarian rule through the
generous financing of agencies of organized re-
pression and the mass media, invariably owned
or monopolized by the regime. Such financing
can even be extended to the judiciary and rep-
resentative councils. As a result, the dominant
few can utilize these channels to sustain their
rule and facilitate and ensure the effective
exercise of oppression, especially by restricting
civil and political society (Chapter 5).
THE LONGING FOR FREEDOM AND
JUSTICE IN POPULAR CULTURE
Despite the repressive chain that stifles free-
dom in Arab societies and the negative effect
of the rentier state on political participation,
there remains a longing for freedom in the
Arab world expressed in popular culture. No
discussion of freedom in Arab culture would
be complete if it confined itself to formal cul-
ture, or the culture of the “elite”. In fact, the
horizons of popular or folk culture are often
broader than those of thinkers, philosophers,
intellectuals and scientists, notwithstanding
the latter’s great impact on the life and destiny
of peoples. In its own way, the “collective con-
sciousness”, with its mythological, symbolic
heritage, its folklore, tales, oral tradition, scien-
tific knowledge or “pre-scientific” knowledge,
folk poetry and epics, national songs and so on
– also shapes the history of peoples.
In Arab cultural history, folk culture may,
at first glance, seem out of sorts with freedom.
It is a culture characterized by images, beliefs
and legends that came from a distant past
steeped in magic, and in fables and tales that
defy imagination. Such beliefs have remained
alive since pre-Islamic times, into the Islamic
age and up to the modern day. They reached
their peak at the time of Ibn Khaldoun, con-
sidered the symbol of the age of “magic, of
talismans, of Zodiac signs and of astrology”.
It is well known that Ibn Khaldoun’s project,
in one of its original multiple facets, was “the
positive, realistic opposite” of the spirit of that
age, the mists of which he aimed to dispel. Yet
that heritage of the “absurd” “with its belief
in magic, astrology, genies, spirits, divination,
the miracles and powers of holy men, dreams,
fables devils, ghosts, winds, etc. (Muhammad
al-Gohary, in Arabic, 1981, 2: 163-233, 411-
440; Shawqi Abdel Hakim, in Arabic, 1994, 1,
87-120), has not disappeared from the Arab in-
dividual and collective memory. It only began
to ebb slowly in “the age of Arab enlighten-
ment” in the mid-nineteenth century. It is no
secret that this folk heritage, where people re-
linquish their will and determination to act in
the real world, submitting instead to the magic
forces of the unknown, is a superstitious state
contrary to freedom.
Such categories of folk culture are only
a limited part of the Arab folk heritage and
oral tradition. The greatest literary manifesta-
tions of that tradition – folk epics and siras
(life stories) – are glowing examples of the
elevation of the “dream of freedom”. They
confirm that this heritage venerated national-
ist and social causes and aspired to social and
national liberation. When those epics and life
stories were being created, such aspirations
belonged to the category of “what remained
unsaid”, and they expressed a popular desire
Figure 6-1
The share of taxes in public revenues and the share of income taxes in total
tax revenues (%), Arab countries, 1992-2002
Source: Data from the Joint Arab Economic Report for 1998-2003,in Arabic.
There remains a
longing for freedom
in the Arab world,
expressed in popular
culture.
154 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
for freedom in the face of internal tyranny,
oppression and external dangers. Apart from
their entertainment, educational and aesthetic
value, they also served to compensate people
for adversity and provoke a desire for change
(Mohammad Rajab al-Najjar, in Arabic, 1995,
1, 226-243). The Lives of Antara, of Hamza of
the Arabs, of Seif Ibn thi Yazan, of Al Amira
that al- Himma, of Bani Hilal and of Al Zaher
Bibars are not what the champions of formal
culture made them out to be: i.e. adulterations
of Arab history or fabrications to be dismissed
as tales of myth and magic. (Some even advised
the “men of the hisba” to prohibit the copy-
ing and exchange of such works). In fact, such
works were creative historical literature inspir-
ing “the spirit of struggle and resistance against
the enemies of creed and religion”. As such,
they played a social and nationalist role which
was not limited to confronting the armies of
the Crusaders and Abyssinians, but contin-
ued into the modern age to help encourage
the nationalist spirit of resistance to British,
French and Italian occupation in Egypt and, in
the Maghreb, the Algerian struggle, beginning
with the uprising of Abdel Qader and extend-
ing to the armed liberation revolution (Ibid,
228-229).
Their compensatory function resided in
their epic significance which, for ordinary
people in the Arab dark ages of disintegration
and weakness, profoundly expressed popular
anger against injustice, oppression and tyr-
anny. In calling for unity and liberation of the
land, in voicing the dream of a better world,
in nourishing the popular spirit by creating
popular or epic heroes capable of overcoming
adversity, they lifted people’s souls and minds
above the trials of their time (Ibid. 233). The
aspiration for freedom is clear in those epics.
In The Life of Antara, the central issue is the
emancipation of the individual self from class
injustice and of the public self at the social
level. In Hamza of the Arabs, the anonymous
narrator considers true national liberation to
be not only a political but a “social liberation
first and foremost, particularly during periods
of historical transition in the life of peoples
– transition from a nomadic tribal society to an
urban national one”. In The Life of Seif Ibn
thi Yazan, the popular narrator raises an issue
aimed at emancipating popular culture, from
the circle of magic, idolatry and other inherited
myths. In Al Amira that Al Himma (“The
Story of Palestinian Genealogies”) which cov-
ers almost five thousand pages, some of the
main events revolve around a central social
issue, “the emancipation of Arab women” in
a backward time when a relapse into Jahiliyya
was under way. The epic narrator exposes the
society of traditions and the harem. He then
replaces it with “a society of free women”,
making an epic heroine of its central figure
of Palestinian descent (That Al Himma) who
becomes a national heroine, the equal of men
in the making of history and life, despite what
befalls her at the end because of the ‘caliph’s
politics”. These are all social issues symboliz-
ing freedom, emancipation and national libera-
tion (Ibid., 261-282; Shawqi Abdel Hakim, in
Arabic, 1994, different passages).
Contemporary Arab popular culture
continues to draw upon the sources of this
freedom-affirming heritage. This culture too,
under the pressure of its own present realities,
is full of different popular aspirations for free-
dom, particularly the myriad folk songs and
poetry about Arab struggles in Morocco, Al-
geria and Egypt on the eve of independence or
revolution. Freedom is also very much present
in the revolutionary popular Palestinian poetry
of today. Arab popular culture, despite some
freedom-inhibiting aspects, represents for the
most part, a living treasury of freedom’s sym-
bols and one of its rich and boundless spaces.
THE GLOBAL AND REGIONAL
CONTEXT
It is not possible to understand the problem
of freedom in Arab society without also con-
sidering the effects of regional factors and of
influences coming from outside the region,
particularly those related to globalization and
global governance.
GLOBALIZATION AND FREEDOM
Globalization has the potential to buttress the
freedom of the individual as a result of mini-
mising the State’s capacity to repress people,
particularly their ideas and aspirations. Also,
It is not possible
to understand the
problem of freedom in
Arab society without
also considering the
effects of regional
factors and influences
coming from outside
the region.
(Epics), apart from
their entertainment,
educational and
aesthetic value, also
served to compensate
people for adversity
and to provoke a
desire for change.
155 ARAB SOCIETAL STRUCTURES AND THE REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL ENVIRONMENTS
globalization can expand people’s opportuni-
ties to acquire knowledge and broaden their
horizons by facilitating communication and the
circulation of ideas. Indeed, some argue that
globalization constitutes an extension of the
concept of freedom, and “a chance to renew
the fundamental rights of the individual,” after
the 20th century witnessed further expan-
sion of the State’s powers over the individual
(Micklethwait and Wooldridge, 2003).
In particular, globalization can support
freedom by strengthening civil society through
wider networking among its actors, using
modern information and communication
technology. This is of particular importance in
Arab countries. The task of building regional
civil society networks and establishing links
between them and civil society institutions
outside the Arab world remains essential.
There has been direct and important in-
teraction at the international level, particularly
between industrialized and developing coun-
tries, in the areas of freedom and good govern-
ance. Historically, relations with democratic
countries in the West played an important role
in spurring democratic transition in regions
that were struggling to be free. One thinks spe-
cifically here of Eastern Europe as the former
Soviet Union was breaking up.
Yet globalization also entails the selective
restriction of certain liberties worldwide when
it comes to the free flow of knowledge. Use-
ful knowledge is not easily accessible – even
on the Internet - under the rigid, often one-
sided intellectual property protection regimes
favoured by the industrialized nations. The
negative impacts of this “selective” restriction
of knowledge flows are evident in areas vital
to developing countries. An example is the
restricted flow of cheap medicine, particularly
in the case of deadly and widespread diseases
from which large numbers of poor people in
the world suffer.
Restrictions on freedoms, also apply to
the free movement of people. The industrial-
ized nations do not usually permit entry to
individuals unless this serves those nations’
interests; yet, at the same time, they call for the
removal of barriers to the movement of goods
and capital globally. This selective freedom,
enforced by developed countries, has favoured
the highly qualified in patterns of migration
from less developed countries. In the case of
the Arab world, the resulting drain of talents
and capabilities severely limits opportunities
to acquire knowledge in the region, one of
the most important cornerstones of human
development.
At a time when good governance—in the
sense of rational public administration—is
considered important to attract foreign invest-
ment, experience with global capital shows
that investors might not be concerned about
establishing good governance except as it per-
tains to guaranteeing capital, transferring prof-
its, and settling labour disputes. Sometimes it
is feared that the overseas investor might well
prefer societies and governments that neglect
certain freedoms, especially those concerning
workers’ rights to strike or institute work stop-
pages, for instance. Thus, while foreign invest-
ment is beneficial for development, it does not
necessarily advance good governance.
The influence of the global environment on
developing countries in knowledge, economics
and politics, is growing both negatively and
positively. Yet Arab countries, like other devel-
oping countries, have little or no control of that
environment. This underscores the importance
of working to reform global governance in
order to serve the goals of security, peace, and
human development throughout the world.
GOVERNANCE AT THE GLOBAL
LEVEL
After the collapse of the Soviet Union and
the end of the Cold War; and as economic
globalization accelerated, bringing worldwide
social and political change in its train, govern-
ance throughout the world underwent pivotal
changes. Arab countries, in particular, have
been affected by the global environment,
which has had important effects on freedom
and governance in the region.
In particular, globalization led to deep
changes in the role and functions of the State,
which lost part of its sovereignty to interna-
tional actors, such as trans-national corpora-
tions and international organizations, notably
in the areas of economic activity and media.
Consequently, the destinies of states and their
Some argue that
globalization
constitutes an
extension of the
concept of freedom.
Yet globalization also
entails the selective
restriction of certain
liberties worldwide.
156 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
citizens are now influenced more closely than
ever before by the nature of governance at the
global level. As states have given up a portion
of their sovereignty, it has become essential to
strengthen global governance, as embodied in
the United Nations, by transferring some of the
powers relinquished by states to a global body
committed to the values of justice, freedom
and equality. However, this has yet to come
about. The end of the equilibrium between the
two great powers and the advent of a uni-polar
world has resulted at times in the weakening
and marginalization of the world organization
(Ghalioun, in Arabic, 2003, b, 68-69).
This has limited the effectiveness of the
Security Council in establishing peace in the
region. Such marginalization has been among
factors contributing to continued or increased
human suffering and to the creation of new
facts on the ground, which militate against
a just and lasting peace in Palestine. The US’
use, or threat of veto has made it possible
for Israel to establish new settlements in the
Occupied Territories, and to start construc-
tion of the separation wall that incorporates
additional Palestinian land. Silence regarding
Israel’s defiance of international legitimacy
has undoubtedly pushed many people in the
region to lose hope of obtaining justice from
global governance and may have exacerbated
extremism.
As many in the Arab world have had their
confidence in the impartiality of the US as
an honest broker weakened, reformers have
found themselves lacking what they had hoped
would be a critical ally (Barry, 2002).
It is thus essential that international law is
upheld, and that international collective action
and UN reform are implemented in that con-
text. International public opinion ought to be
encouraged to provide checks and balances in
international behaviour, to help minimize the
negative impacts of globalization and influence
Israeli-American relations for the sake of a just
peace. This should be complemented by the
creation of a regional system that is able to in-
teract with global changes, deal appropriately
with aspects of globalization and inspire Arab
citizens with confidence in its identity.
THE IMPACT OF THE “WAR ON
TERROR” ON FREEDOM
The events of September 11, 2001 in the United
States led to a substantial measure of interna-
tional consensus around the proposition that
terrorism has become one of the greatest perils
of the age. That is why the entire world demon-
strated solidarity with the United States after
the attacks, and then again with countries from
Turkey to Morocco to Spain to Saudi Arabia
that have suffered their own terrorist attacks in
recent years. In this context, nobody disputes
the right and responsibility of Governments
to take strong actions to ensure the security
BOX 6-4
Counsellor Yahya al-Rifai: Justice Above Might
Different points of view, incompatible
interests, even human conflict are part
of God’s way with His creation. The
Qur’an says, “They continue in their
disagreement… It was for that that He
created them.” The Qur’an also says,
“Had God not set mankind against one
another, the earth would have gone to
rack and ruin.”
There are two, and only two, ways
of settling disputes: with the bludgeon
of force or the justice of law, there is no
third possibility. With force, a person’s
life, honour and property are never safe;
he lives like a wild animal, hunting his
prey without ever being sure that he will
be able to keep any of it, never planting
a crop because the harvest will go to the
strongest, never building a house because
there is no certainty that he will be able
to live in it, and, indeed, afraid to settle
anywhere.
On the day when God guided man-
kind to law, by His permission, the first
time that two antagonists decided not to
fight, but instead to seek the arbitration
of a third party, not deeming it unbecom-
ing to submit to his judgement, despite
their strength—on that day the first step
on the road to civilization was taken.
Man realized that he had rights that were
protected by the law, and consequently
he could be assured of being able to
enjoy the fruits of his labour. He learned
to keep livestock, to cultivate the land,
and to build.
Protected by the principle of arbitra-
tion, the law grew and developed, serving
to safeguard individuals’ lives, property
and honour. The State grew and devel-
oped to secure their right to litigate. That
right was entrusted to a particular group
of their number, namely their arbitrators,
not so that the latter could use force as
they saw fit for their own ends, but rather
so that they could use it to safeguard the
community as a whole. It was a weapon
that they wielded on behalf of all mem-
bers of the community to safeguard the
rule of the community’s law, under the
community’s supervision.
Litigation enables an individual to go
to a judge—who is an individual like the
litigant—and ask for redress in an abuse
of power, or initiate a prosecution or seek
restoration of a right that has been de-
nied. In the courtroom, the litigant and
adversary stand on a footing of equality,
out of the reach of all manifestations of
power, whether in the form of money,
weapons or the pressure of public opin-
ion, and the judge can harness the power
of the State to protect the law.
On this basis, all humanity adopts
a charter proclaiming the principles of
human rights, inspired from the concepts
of natural law and the principles of jus-
tice, give that charter pre-eminence over
national constitutions, and seek periodi-
cally to broaden its scope. The only way
to make it effective will be to establish
international courts in which individu-
als can bring suit against their own States
and all their institutions, constitutions
and laws. It has consistently been the
hope of humankind that the competence
of these courts will extend to all indi-
viduals and all States, so that all will be
subject to law and enjoy peace, which can
only be based on justice.
Source: Ahmed Makki, in Arabic, 1990
The advent of a uni-
polar world has
resulted at times in
the weakening and
marginalization of the
world organization.
157 ARAB SOCIETAL STRUCTURES AND THE REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL ENVIRONMENTS
of their citizens. In practice, however, some
aspects of the way in which the “war on terror”
has been conducted, have come to pose real
threats to civil liberties and reform in the Arab
region and beyond.
While Western leaders have strongly
asserted their support for freedom and de-
mocracy as the best long-term solution to
terrorism, in practice many have also under-
standably sought to tighten their own security
legislation, providing new power to monitor
and detain terror suspects at home and abroad.
While some successes have been achieved, an
unfortunate by-product in some countries has
been that Arabs are increasingly the victims of
stereotyping, and disproportionately harassed
or detained without cause under new restric-
tions. At the same time, in the Arab world, sev-
eral Governments have cited fear of terrorism
as justification for steps to impose even tighter
restrictions on their citizens.
It is essential to rebuild a new climate
of understanding, confidence and trust that
rejects the indiscriminate grouping of all vio-
lent actions as “terror” and breaks the unfair
and deeply damaging association of terror-
ism with Arabs and Muslims, or indeed any
group or faith. Such an approach also needs
to include a clearer definition of terrorism that
distinguishes between terrorist organizations
and acts of legitimate resistance, including the
fight “against colonial domination and alien
occupation and against racist regimes”, which
is protected by Protocol I Additional to the
Geneva Conventions relating to the Protection
of Victims of International Armed Conflicts.
For their part, Arabs need to resist strongly
any temptation to surrender to the very real
frustration and anger felt by many at the
damaging impact of the “war on terror” on
their own aspirations for reform and freedom.
On the contrary, terrorism and war crimes,
whoever commits them, should be resolutely
condemned. Instead, Arabs everywhere
should make a renewed commitment to make
the Arab world a place where all citizens are
fully secure from state-sponsored and other
forms of violence.
The only lasting way to achieve that goal
and uproot terrorism is to pursue equitable
development and to establish systems of good
governance, both in Arab countries and on
the global level, under which injustices can
be confronted through channels that are both
peaceful and effective. In a word, the ultimate
antidote to terrorism is freedom, based on re-
spect for international human rights law and
respect for the rights and dignity of individu-
als. Such a political environment, underpinned
by a genuine regard for cultural diversity both
in Arab countries and Western countries in
which Arabs and Muslims live, will, in the long
run, dry up the wellsprings of terrorism.
GOVERNANCE AT THE REGIONAL
LEVEL
A good governance system at the regional level
could potentially have a positive impact on
freedoms and good governance at the national
level. Regional governance institutions – as
supra-national bodies - would provide norms
and points of reference for national systems of
good governance. An example of this would
It is essential to
rebuild a new climate
of understanding,
confidence and
trust that rejects
the indiscriminate
grouping of all violent
actions as “terror”
and breaks the unfair
and deeply damaging
association of terrorism
with Arabs and
Muslims, or indeed any
group or faith.
BOX 6-5
The UN Special Rapporteur on Terrorism and Human Rights:
The Root Causes of Terrorism
Addressing the root causes of terrorism
has now become a rather highly con-
tentious area, with a number of States
and scholars insisting that, as there is
no justification whatever for terrorism,
there should be no effort made to try to
understand its root causes. Instead, they
argue, there should be ever more militant
action against terrorists and terrorist
groups, with the goal of wiping them out.
This position is met with dismay by the
majority, who insist that it is foolhardy to
ignore review of root causes, which are,
in some situations, directly or indirectly
related to the non-realisation of human
rights. The Special Rapporteur sides with
those who support study of root causes
in order to fashion more rational means
of eliminating terrorism.
Some of the actions undertaken in the
cause of the global war against terrorism
have been the cause of consternation also
for the highest officials in the UN system.
For instance, the UN Secretary-General
has pleaded on a number of occasions
for States to uphold all human rights,
stressing that greater respect for human
rights, not their curtailment, is the best
means of preventing terrorism. Address-
ing recently the Commission on Human
Rights, he stated, “Let us ensure that our
security measures are firmly founded in
law. In defending the rule of law, we
must ourselves be bound by law
.

(a)
. He
has also pointed out that the Council
and the Counter-Terrorism Committee
“must… be sensitive to human rights as
they pursue their work.”
(b)

Attention has already been drawn to
the concerns of the UN High Commis-
sioner for Human Rights, also expressed
in a number of statements and comments
throughout the period. The UN High
Commissioner for Refugees also has
repeatedly voiced his own consterna-
tion about some measures, which, even
though adopted in good faith, have vic-
timized people in need of international
protection
(c)
.
Source: Commission on Human Rights, Sub-Commission on the Promotion and Protection of Human Rights, 2002,
Terrorism and Human Rights, second progress report prepared by Ms. Kalliopi K. Koufa, Special Rapporteur.
(a) See SG/SM/8196-HR/CN/989 of 12 April 2002.
(b) Ibid.
(c) See, for instance, statement by Ruud Lubbers, UN High Commissioner for Refugees, to the Third Committee of
the General Assembly, New York, 19 November 2001; UN News Centre, 20 February 2002.
158 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
be the establishment of an Arab human rights
court for delivering justice to all Arab citizens
and for counteracting any government’s in-
fringement of its citizens’ rights and freedoms.
A stronger and more effective Arab
regional system would enhance freedom in
Arab countries in at least two important ways:
first, it would reverse the deterioration of
the pan-Arab liberation movement brought
about by its division and weakness, and by
some of its members’ vulnerability to external
pressures. Second, it would help seize the op-
portunity currently being missed to establish
the knowledge society in the Arab countries.
This requires close and effective inter-Arab co-
ordination the elements of which are present
except for the political will and commitment.
What can be said about regional co-or-
dination and the knowledge society in Arab
countries can be said about most human de-
velopment issues in the region. Acquiring and
using human capabilities at the national levels
is enhanced through regional complementarity.
For example, the challenge of unemployment
facing Arab countries could be dealt with more
effectively with a freer regional labour market
responding to supply and demand across
countries, promoting the full use of human
capabilities and ensuring the rights of work-
ers. Such a regional market by itself would
push the economic growth wheel in most Arab
countries. In economic terms, some important
aspects of freedom in the Arab world are first
class “regional public goods”.
Unfortunately, repression at the national
level and distractions created by animosity
among ruling regimes has led to squandering
the possibilities of Arab complementarity in
securing freedom in the Arab states.
Despite various attempts at Arab unity,
at least in the economic sphere, the chief pat-
tern, ever since the founding of the League of
Arab States (LAS) in 1945, has been the loose
arrangement for co-operation that leaves mat-
ters in the hands of national governments with
equal voting rights. Regional decisions are
reached by consensus. The regional co-ordi-
nation structure is multifaceted, with several
specialized organs. There is the Council, which
convenes at the level of Foreign Ministers and,
more recently, once a year at the level of Heads
of State. There is also an Economic and Social
Council that addresses matters determined by
the governments of member states. Essentially
this is an economic council that was established
pursuant to article 7 of the Common Defence
Pact, which called for economic cooperation
without further clarification.
This superficial, non-binding formula has
been useful in fostering participation by all
Arab states, despite differences in their socio-
economic systems. At the same time, however,
it has led to a weakening of the regional struc-
ture and a decline in its credibility (figure 6-2).
Figure 6-2
Credibility of the Arab League and the United Nations
Estimates by five Arab states and comparator countries
Percentage of missing observations:
Egypt 4.10%, Jordan 13.79%, Saudi Arabia 12.05%, Algeria
12.71%, Morocco 40.77%, comparator countries 21.76%.
Source: World Values Survey, Annex 1.
Lack of credibility of the United Nations Lack of credibility of the Arab League
Comparator countries:
Simple arithmetic average of the results of South Africa,
Argentina, South Korea, Brazil, Nigeria, Pakistan, Turkey,
Bangladesh and Indonesia.
Percentage of missing observations:
Egypt 4.60%, Jordan 17.04%, Saudi Arabia 10.99%, Algeria
14.04%, Morocco 39.88%, comparator countries 11.34%.
This superficial, non-
binding formula…has
led to a weakening of
the regional structure
and a decline in its
credibility.
159 ARAB SOCIETAL STRUCTURES AND THE REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL ENVIRONMENTS
The credibility of the League of Arab
States is quite low, especially in Algeria, with
relatively higher credibility in Egypt and Jor-
dan. The credibility of the UN is also low,
especially in Algeria and Saudi Arabia.
The second LAS Summit in Alexandria in
1964 resolved that an Arab Court of Justice
should be established. Today, forty years later,
the Court has still not seen the light of day.
There have been repeated calls for an Arab
Parliament, but owing to differences in par-
liamentary representation among the respec-
tive Arab states, that institution has not been
established either.
There are a number of institutions that
work at the regional level outside the official
framework. These include various profes-
sional groups, among them parliamentarians,
workers, lawyers, economists, businessmen,
investors, contractors, farmers and academics.
Many of them have campaigned effectively on
behalf of popular demands for freedom, good
governance and development.
Within the official regional framework,
agreements have been reached that could
have advanced freedoms and people’s rights
at the regional level. However, these agree-
ments have not been implemented as foreseen
because national governments have insisted on
retaining their right to approve or refuse to ap-
prove regional decisions, with the result that
all agreements must be ratified in accordance
with the constitutional procedures in force in
the various states. For example, a number of
agreements in the field of labour were reached
in the 1960s. The Arab Agreement on Labour
Standards was designed to raise standards and
improve working conditions in the Arab world.
The Arab Regional Labour Force Mobility
Agreement was designed to facilitate the flow
of Arab workers and ensure that they enjoyed
hiring preference and obtained the same rights
and benefits as nationals of the country in
which they were employed. The Agreement on
Basic Social Insurance Levels allowed workers
to retain entitlements earned in one country
when they took jobs in another country; while
under the Reciprocity Agreement on Social
Insurance Plans workers could accumulate
insurance periods entitling them to benefits
in accordance with the legislation in force in
the contracting states. In the main, however,
countries that were suppliers of labour rati-
fied those agreements, but not countries that
employed labour from abroad. As a result the
agreements have remained largely ineffective.
Despite large-scale labour force migration
within the Arab region, workers are generally
denied many of their rights when they migrate,
and in addition they are likely to find them-
selves excluded when a political crisis results
in strained relations between their host coun-
try and their home country. Under the terms
of the Economic Unity Agreement, individuals
are supposed to enjoy freedom of movement
between Arab states, but efforts to develop a
unified identity card have ended in failure, and
the process of abolishing entry visas is subject
to the vagaries of political relations. On the
other hand, the Agreements on Arab Capital
Investment in Arab States are designed to
protect investors from nationalization or con-
fiscation, and to ensure their right to repatriate
their capital and profits from their investments.
Those agreements also give investors the right
to travel to, and reside in countries in which
they have invested. The Unified Agreement on
Investment (1980) makes provision for an Arab
Investment Court, pending the establishment
of an Arab Court of Justice. Lastly, with a view
to stimulating economic activity in Arab states,
CAEU has approved an agreement aimed at
avoiding double taxation and preventing in-
come and capital tax evasion between states
that are members of the Council. This agree-
ment has recently been amended.
In sum, current institutional arrangements
for regional co-ordination have failed to give
substantive support to Arab development, to
maintain security and peace in the Arab world
and to end occupation. Inter-Arab cooperation
has not contributed to enhancing freedom and
good governance. Symbolizing this failure, the
best example of successful cooperation remains
the Council of Arab Ministers of Interior.
Unsurprisingly, people in the Arab region
feel that co-operation at the pan-Arab level is
poor (figure 6-3).
According to the Freedom Survey, Annex
1, the vast majority of respondents said they
were dissatisfied with the level of Arab coop-
eration.
The credibility of the
League of Arab States
is quite low…the
credibility of the UN is
also low.
Current institutional
arrangements for
regional coordination
have failed to give
substantive support
to Arab development,
to maintain security
and peace in the Arab
world and to end
occupation.
160 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Figure 6-3
Extent of satisfaction with the current level of Arab cooperation, five Arab countries, Freedom
Survey, 2003
BOX 6-6
Adib al-Jadir: Hussein Jamil, An Iraqi Arab Activist Who Pursued Freedom
Hussein Jamil is among the outstanding Iraqi figures
of the 20th century, whose pursuit of freedom began
in 1927 and continued until his death in 2002.
He graduated from the Damascus College of
Law in 1930 and began to practice as a lawyer the
following year in Baghdad. Together with Muham-
mad Hadid, Abdulfattah Ibrahim and Abdulqadir
Ismail he worked in what later came to be known
as “The League of People” (Jama’at al-Ahali) to
develop Iraqi civil society based on social, economic,
and political tenets appropriate for that momentous
period of Iraq’s history. In 1932 they published
a newspaper “The People” (al-Ahali) in which he
wrote “this newspaper is produced by a group of
young people; Hussein Jamil is the proprietor and
director”. The newspaper stated that “ national
liberation and freedom for the citizen are not won
simply by ending foreign rule or influence over Iraq.
The nation and the citizens must be free from any
form of exploitation from whatever provenance,
whether foreign or Iraqi.”
From the outset Al Ahali called for democracy,
and the Jama’at al-Ahali went on to set up the Na-
tional Democratic Party in 1946. Hussein Jamil was
one of the founding members and became the long-
standing Secretary General of the Party.
In early 1959 he was named Minister of Cul-
ture and Guidance, a post which he resigned after
just one day in office, in protest against Abdulkarim
Qassim’s interference in his ministry’s affairs. From
then on he refused any ministerial role, and returned
instead to his law practice, research, giving lectures
in national and regional fora on a range of politi-
cal, constitutional and legal themes, in addition to
human rights.
He published a study entitled “Establishing
an Arab Court for Arab Human Rights” in the
magazine “al-Mustaqbal al-‘Arabi” (issue no.50/
April 1983) calling on the League of Arab States to
conclude an “Arab Charter for Human Rights and
Fundamental Freedoms”, envisaging an Arab Court
for Human Rights as an integral part of the League’s
institutional structure, to implement guarantees for
human rights at the regional level. He promoted the
view that regional human rights treaties would serve
to enhance their protection worldwide.
In 1983 he wrote: “The way to change is
through democracy. Democracy provides the means
to address the dangers. Through democracy, and
democratic concepts and institutions, people can
exercise their rights and freedoms, complete their
humanity and develop their gifts”.
161
Part II
Reinforcing Freedom and Establishing
Good Governance
Section 4: Towards Reinforcing Freedom
and Establishing Good Governance in
the Arab Countries
Our assessment of the state of freedom and governance, coupled with
the advanced explanation of the deficit in freedom and good govern-
ance (chapters 3-6) enable us to attempt answering the historic ques-
tion raised at the end of chapter1: could the future bear out a trajectory
that would lead Arab societies to enjoy freedom and good governance
traversing the required process of historical struggle.
CHAPTER SEVEN
A Strategic Vision of Freedom
and Governance in Arab
Countries – Alternative Futures
A STRATEGIC VISION OF FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES – ALTERNATIVE FUTURES 163
Introduction
This chapter offers a general view of the sub-
stance of societal and institutional reform
needed to establish a society of freedom and
good governance in the Arab region. It starts
by underlining the need for the periodic
alternation of power in Arab countries. It
next discusses three alternative futures that
could define the course of freedom and gov-
ernance in the Arab world: the first is to be
avoided; the second would be ideal, but may
be difficult to attain quickly; and the third
may be more realistic and could potentially
contribute to the preferred alternative, if
properly managed. The chapter and the Re-
port conclude by highlighting the main fea-
tures of the preferred alternative future. This
scenario is named the “izdihar
1
alternative ”,
using the Arabic word that denotes the full
flourishing of individuals and societies.
As in previous Reports, recommenda-
tions made in this chapter are presented
as broad guidelines. They are offered to all
dynamic forces of Arab society, regardless of
their position within the prevailing power
structure, for consideration in defining their
own path towards a society of freedom and
good governance. Such recommendations
may also be helpful to those outsiders who
are genuinely interested in supporting an
Arab renaissance.
GROUNDS FOR PEACEFUL AND
DEEP POLITICAL ALTERNATION,
ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
REASONS FOR CHANGE
Modernization in Arab countries has yielded
notable achievements, especially in combat-
ing morbidity and mortality - particularly
among children – in building infrastructure,
in the quantitative expansion of education,
particularly among females, and in increasing
the integration of women in society. Yet by
21
st
century standards, Arab countries have
not met the Arab people’s aspirations for
development, security and liberation despite
variations between one country and another
in this regard.
As the AHDRs of 2002 and 2003 showed,
the vast majority of the Arab people do not
enjoy the higher forms of human development,
notably in relation to knowledge, freedom and
good governance, and women’s empowerment.
“Bread before freedom” is a common
dictum in the Arab region. Yet putting the sat-
isfaction of basic human needs before people’s
essential liberty has in practice meant that most
Arabs
2
have risked losing out on both.
The previous chapters of this Report has
provided a detailed analysis of the freedom
and governance problem in the Arab world.
Central to that problem is the fact that at the
political level, decision-making has remained
in the hands of a minority that monopolises the
two spheres of power - financial resources and
political authority - and has hence focused on
1
Individual and collective flourishing. English borrows from French the term ‘épanouissement’ to fill a lexical gap in denoting this phenomenon.
However, the Arabic word “izdihar” captures the intended sense closely. Thus, rather than use a French term, which has to be explained in English,
to describe something which most people in the region will recognize from the Arabic, we have opted for the Arabic word, with this explanation for
non-Arab readers.
2
Idiomatically, the word “Arab’’ is used to denote all citizens of Arab countries, inclusively
By 21st century
standards, Arab
countries have not
met the Arab people’s
aspirations for
development, security
and liberation.
Putting the
satisfaction of basic
human needs before
people’s essential
liberty has in practice
meant that most Arab
have lost out on both.
164 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
serving its own interests. The vast majority of
people are excluded, and thus left to impover-
ishment and marginalization. The results of the
World Values Survey (annex 1) indicate that
nearly 70% of the public in five Arab countries
believe that “ the country is run for the benefit
of the influential few”.
Nor have Arab regimes been able to pro-
tect Arab interests in the international arena.
Arab lands remain occupied, with the occupa-
tion of Iraq having recently been added to that
of Palestine. About 10 per cent of Arabs now
live under occupation and, after several dec-
ades, foreign military forces have reappeared
in the region. This provokes an extremely high
level of discontent in the region, as indicated in
the Freedom Survey (Annex 1 and figure 7.1)
Finally, present-day regimes have not
achieved fundamental reform from within
which would correct their course and enhance
hopes for a better future.
ALTERNATIVE ARAB FUTURES
Given current trends, and looking into the fu-
ture, several scenarios can be envisioned. We
focus here on the three most relevant to the
subject of this report.
The Impending Disaster Scenario:
Maintaining the ‘Status Quo’
If the situation in Arab countries today con-
tinues, intensified societal conflict is likely to
follow.
Under the skewed distribution of power in
its two spheres - wealth and political authority
– and escalating foreign encroachment, Arabs
suffer multiple injustices and see little hope for
a better future. Anger combined with despair
is an explosive mixture that pushes some to-
wards violence, with undesirable consequences
that threaten social cohesion and debilitate na-
tional structures and institutions.
Simply branding violent protesters as
“terrorists” or further tightening the security
restrictions already in place will not provide
an answer. The way of strict security alone
is ultimately ineffective, even if it buys a brief
respite.
Contemporary history shows that continu-
ation of the status quo might lead to destruc-
tive upheavals that could force a transfer of
power in Arab countries. However, such a
transfer could well involve armed violence and
human losses that would be unacceptable how-
ever small. Nor would this transfer of power
through violence guarantee that successor gov-
ernance regimes would be any more desirable.
If this should materialize, the future for
Arab countries holds more failures in the arena
of human development. We label this prospect
the “impending disaster” scenario.
The Ideal Scenario: The “Izdihar”
Alternative
Disaster can be averted. The alternative is to
pursue an historic, peaceful and deep process
of negotiated political alternation adopted by all
pro-reform segments of Arab society, whether
they are in power or not, on all fronts and by
all democratic means, to guarantee rights and
freedoms. A process of peaceful negotiation on
the redistribution of power in Arab countries
represents the optimum approach for a tran-
sitional phase towards good governance. The
desired outcome is a redistribution of power
Figure 7-1
Extent of dissatisfaction over the presence of foreign military bases, five Arab
countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
About 10 per cent of
Arabs now live under
occupation and, after
several decades,
foreign military forces
have reappeared in
the region.
The way of strict
security alone is
ultimately ineffective,
even if it buys a brief
respite.
165 A STRATEGIC VISION OF FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES – ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
within Arab societies, restoring power to its
rightful owners, the vast majority of people in
the Arab world. The process would also estab-
lish good governance as a solid foundation for
a human renaissance. We call this alternative
the “izdihar” scenario.
Unlike a continuation of the status quo,
good governance will help to address social in-
justice properly, by means that are both peace-
ful and effective, thus removing the sources of
disaster.
The “Half Way House” Scenario: the
Accommodation of External Reform
A third alternative is gathering momentum
within the region and across the globe: a West-
ern-supported project of gradual and moderate
reform aiming at liberalization in Arab coun-
tries but falling short of real democratization.
An example of this project of cautious reform is
the “Broader Middle East Initiative”, adopted
by the G8 summit (see Part I). This and simi-
lar plans might well lead to a series of internal
reforms in Arab countries. Arab regimes are,
in general, susceptible to foreign pressure and
will try to respond positively to some external
demands for reform. At the same time, most of
these regimes will try to contain the impact of
reform measures and stop short of the desired
political reform and the equitable redistribu-
tion of power, which constitute the core of the
“izdihar”” alternative.
This third or “half way” alternative, falls
short of the “ideal” scenario in two crucial
respects. First, measures imposed from out-
side according to the vision of foreign powers
are not fully consistent with the concepts of
freedom and good governance advocated by
successive AHDRs, especially in relation to
liberation and independence. Second, such
reforms will not benefit from the dynamics of
change driven from within. Indeed, they main-
tain the tradition of accepting that the destinies
of Arab states have to be shaped from outside.
Despite the serious shortcomings of this
alternative, it has to be acknowledged that
although the historical project of renewal of
the Arab region started two centuries ago, it
has not succeeded yet in fulfilling Arab aspi-
rations for freedom and dignity; and that this
less-than-perfect “half-way house” alternative
does contain at least some elements of the pre-
ferred option.
The challenge facing the advocates of ren-
aissance in the Arab world is how to manage
this alternative – which is expected to grow in
significance - and maximize its contribution
to advancing the “izdihar” alternative. This
would allow those outside initiatives for reform
adopted by Arab regimes to be led from the
inside and would minimize the impact of their
most critical defects.
Dealing with this challenge successfully
will be an important milestone for renaissance
advocates and will test their ability to shape the
future of the Arab region from the perspective
of human development.
HOW TO DEAL WITH REFORM
INITIATIVES FROM OUTSIDE?
Arab countries cannot ignore the fact that the
world, especially the powerful players in the
global arena, will continue actively to safeguard
their interests in the region. Their call for re-
form in Arab countries falls within this context.
But external pressures cannot be disregarded,
no matter why they are applied. Arabs cannot
afford the luxury of isolation from develop-
ments in the outside world. The extent of inter-
connection between those external forces and
Arab governing and social structures is strong
enough to warrant a positive approach towards
external reform initiatives, but strictly from the
perspective of building societies of freedom
and good governance in the Arab world.
In addition, there are active international
NGOs that can provide significant support to
the forces of reform in the Arab world if the
latter were willing to work with them.
Co-operation with external forces can be
rewarding if all parties respect the following
principles:
• Freedom for all and complete respect for
international human rights law, in particular
the right to national liberation. Furthermore,
deeds must be consistent with words in order
to end the double standards that have char-
acterized some Western policies towards the
Arab region. Also, the violation of human
rights must be proscribed, and no impunity
permitted, irrespective of the perpetrator.
Arab regimes are, in
general, susceptible
to foreign pressure
and will try to respond
positively to some
external demands for
reform.
Co-operation with
external forces can be
rewarding if all parties
respect principles (of
good governance).
166 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
• Absolute respect for the tenet that Arabs
should find their own way to freedom and good
governance through innovation by Arab social
forces, without pressure to adopt ready-made
models, as the firm guarantee of a successful
and sustainable historic transformation.
• Inclusion of all societal forces in Arab
countries in a system of good governance to
ensure popular representation instead of the
trend towards exclusion that has marred the
Arab political landscape, sometimes prompted
by external forces. All societal forces must have
the right to organize and be active in both civil
and political society as long as they abide by
democratic principles and respect the rights of
others. This includes:
• Full respect for the outcomes freely chosen
by the people through a good governance
regime. The free will of the people, and not
foreign interests or designs, should be the ul-
timate arbiter in determining the Arab future.
• Dealing with the Arab people through a
partnership of equals anchored in mutual re-
spect and deep understanding, rather than pa-
tronage.
UNIVERSAL FEATURES AND AIMS
OF THE DESIRED SYSTEM OF
GOVERNANCE
The political alternation desired in the Arab
world should lead to establishing good govern-
ance based on the following principles:
• Preservation of freedom in order to ex-
pand people’s choices; i.e. protect the essence
of human development.
• Effective popular participation, with uni-
versal popular representation of all the people.
• Efficient, transparent and accountable in-
stitutions as counterweights to the monopoly
of power by individuals. These institutions
work among themselves under the separation
and balance of powers, and are accountable to
each other and the people directly through free
and fair choice exercised periodically.
• The rule of law, as the protector of free-
dom, applied fairly to all people.
• Laws administered by an efficient, impar-
tial and completely independent judiciary,
whose judgments are upheld and applied by
the Executive Authority.
This good governance regime should
guarantee the rights of citizenship, in full, to
all citizens, and unequivocally end all forms of
exclusion outside of the frame of “citizenship”,
regardless of all pretexts or justification.
This governance system should balance
freedom with correct mechanisms of good gov-
ernance. In particular, through free and cred-
ible elections, such a system should guarantee
peaceful political alternation in the future.
REFORMING ARAB SOCIETAL
STRUCTURES TO GUARANTEE
FREEDOM
No matter which reform scenario unfolds in
the coming years, or whether Arab reformers
seek to take advantage of external pressure to
advance their cause, freedom and good govern-
ance will not materialize fully until three sets of
problems are addressed: the domestic problem
of governance; the regional crisis that affects all
Arab countries, including the problem of oc-
cupation; and the problems of governance that
affect the entire international system, putting
Arab countries at a serious disadvantage.
THE INTERNAL CHALLENGE
Enhancing the Legal and Institutional
Foundations that Underpin Freedom
There is an urgent and compelling need to
modernize Arab legal systems, to make them
compatible with international human rights
standards and effective in protecting human
BOX 7-1
Mahdi Bunduq, Post-Bourgeois Society
“As Tragedy announces the demise of
one world (and thus implicitly the birth
of a new one), the seed of post-bourgeois
society should be thought of as being
formed (in the womb of time) from the
elements and structures of civil society:
parties without tutelage, a press beyond
the reach of confiscation, unions inde-
pendent of government authority, clubs
and cultural associations practicing the
free study of all intellectual, artistic and
literary schools and movements with-
out criminalization or moral terrorism,
and a cinema and theatre answering to
the moral needs of the people without
patriarchal censorship from anyone. All
this would come under the framework
of a constitution whose articles do not
conflict with human rights and under
the aegis of a modern State that does
not discriminate between one school
of thought and another, between one
idea and another, between a man and a
woman; a modern State that makes a dis-
tinction between itself and religion (as a
practice of authority) but makes no such
distinction between religion and society,
as one of its heartbeats or spiritual aspi-
rations.”
Source: Mahdi Bunduq, in Arabic, 2003, 114
This good governance
regime should
guarantee the rights
of citizenship, in full,
to all citizens.
167 A STRATEGIC VISION OF FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES – ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
rights and freedoms in practice.
To that end, intensive efforts are called for
to develop sound legislation and competent in-
stitutions to better safeguard, protect and sup-
port freedoms and human rights in the Arab
world.
Adherence to International Human Rights
Law
Arab states must take steps to ratify the com-
ponent elements of international human rights
law to include all major human rights treaties,
particularly the ICCPR, the ICESCR, CAT,
CEDAW and the CRC. These are considered
the minimum requirements in terms of Arab
ratification. Ideally, states should go consid-
erably beyond this to embrace all elements of
international human rights law, including the
Optional Protocols.
Arab legislatures ought to take steps to
revise legislation currently in force to bring
it into conformity with international human
rights standards and constitutional provisions
that safeguard these rights.
Binding the Ruling Authority to the Rule
of Law
The reform of Arab constitutions is essential
to achieve the following four goals: a) Political
power should be subject to a defined, reason-
able time frame, ending permanency of power.
b) Political power should not be absolute. The
ruling authority should be responsible for its
actions before the judiciary and elected repre-
sentational bodies. c) Political pluralism should
be guaranteed by an effective system based on
the principle of equality in law and practice,
with equal access to rights and opportunities
and equal responsibilities. d) Arab citizens
must be able to exercise their right to political
participation in the fullest sense and to enjoy
their fundamental rights.
The ruling authority in Arab countries,
should be defined and bound by the law, and
hence the law should be above all and not sub-
ject to the will of individuals. This is the case
with the system of constitutional monarchy
where the king or queen rules but does not
govern. Under the republican system, which
is parliamentary-based, it can be achieved
through a clearly defined separation of powers
and where the free will of the electorate is the
sole arbiter in determining the choice of parlia-
ment and government. In all cases, authority
and responsibility stay with an elected indi-
vidual in free and fair elections.
Guaranteeing freedoms and rights at the
heart of the constitution
Arab constitutions must guarantee fundamental
rights and freedoms. The constitution should
clearly provide that it is unlawful to enact any
legislation that restricts rights and freedoms.
All Arab constitutions should provide that in-
ternational human rights treaties by which they
are legally bound take precedence over ordi-
nary law. These measures all serve to expand
the legal framework to protect freedoms and
human rights in the Arab world, which would
be strengthened further by setting up a consti-
tutional judicial body to monitor the constitu-
tionality of legislation, and prevent the passage
of legislation which infringes the freedoms or
rights prescribed under the constitution or
international treaties. World experience has
highlighted the importance of a constitutional
judicial body to establish general principles
in law, making freedom, justice and fair treat-
ment governing principles for ordinary legisla-
tion, even when they are not stated explicitly in
the constitution. This would undoubtedly help
to free Arab legislation from arbitrary control
by the executive.
BOX 7-2
Perpetuating power in the name of democracy and the people
1- The Tunisian Constitution formerly
stated that the President of the Republic
is elected for a five-year term, and that an
incumbent cannot hold office for more
than three consecutive terms. But on
March 18, 1975, the National Assembly
elected President Bourquiba as Presi-
dent-for-Life and, by a unanimous vote,
amended Article 40 of the Constitution
to provide for this.
2- Article 77 of the Egyptian Constitu-
tion of 1971 confines the maximum term
in office of the President of the Republic
to two consecutive terms, stating that
“The term of office for the presidency is
six years, from the date on which the ref-
erendum results are declared. The Presi-
dent of the Republic may be re-elected
for an additional consecutive term.”
As the end of President Sadat’s
second term of office approached, the
constitutional provision was amended,
on 30 April 1980, to permit the Presi-
dent of the Republic to be re-elected for
further terms of office (with no upper
limit prescribed). The reasons for seek-
ing this constitutional amendment were
explained as follows:
“President Sadat’s term of of-
fice began before the Constitution was
promulgated, and in accordance with
article 190 and article 77, his term of of-
fice concludes in November 1983. This
outcome, resulting from the application
of this provision, is not consistent with
the democratic principles which our
society safeguards and seeks to further
entrench …more importantly, this re-
sult is one which the steadfast people
of Egypt rejects with their hearts, minds
and souls…”
The ruling authority in
Arab countries should
be defined and bound
by the law.
All Arab constitutions
should provide that
international human
rights treaties by
which they are
legally bound take
precedence over
ordinary law.
168 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Strengthening Civil and Political Rights in
Law
Arab legislation in most urgent need of a thor-
ough review includes laws regulating the ex-
ercise of political rights, the legislature and its
electoral processes, the right to set up civil so-
ciety organizations, including political parties,
and their activities, and laws on the judicial
authority.
Laws regulating political rights should
elaborate on the principle of gender equality
BOX 7-3
Ten Principles for a Constitution of Freedom and Good Governance
1. Freedom from any ideological stamp; political
orientations are decided at the ballot box that repre-
sents the will of the people.
2. Adoption of the multi-party system, so that polit-
ical parties may be established by mere notification,
within the limits of public order, and the affirmation
of the principle of equality among political parties
in terms of benefiting from State services. The Con-
stitution should stipulate a separation between the
ruling party and the State.
3. Adoption of the principle of binding power
with responsibility, and separating the symbol of
sovereignty from the authority of government.
Sovereignty belongs to the nation or the people, as
symbolized by the king or president, while govern-
ment (i.e., the tasks undertaken by the executive
authority) is carried out by a cabinet formed by the
party with the parliamentary majority or a coalition
of constituent parties in a legislative assembly that
represents the majority. Accordingly, the king or
the president is not responsible before parliament
except in specified situations, while the cabinet
bears joint responsibility before parliament since it
practices authority. There should be no authority
without responsibility and no responsibility without
authority.
4. Adoption of the principle of the non-perma-
nence of the elected authority. Limiting the mandate
of the head of State and to four years, for example,
and under no circumstances beyond two terms,
would achieve this. The principle of direct election
of the head of State from among multiple candidates
should be adopted.
5. Formation of a neutral, independent body to
supervise all elections, this body to be in charge of
all procedures relating to, and supplementing the
electoral process.
6. Prohibition of declarations of a state of emer-
gency other than in accordance with the strictest
limits, with severe constraints and for a set period,
with majority agreement, especially in the legislative
assembly. Creation of a system of judicial oversight,
to review the legality of the declaration of emergency
as well as of decrees issued by the emergency author-
ity.
7. Establishment of a Supreme Constitutional
Court responsible for overseeing the constitutional-
ity of laws and for facilitating procedures to allow
individuals to bring their grievances before it, es-
pecially cases related to legislative abuses of human
rights. The Supreme Judicial Council of the Court
alone should appoint Judges of the Court.
8. Explicit stipulation of the principle of the inde-
pendence of the judicial authority and the judges
in content and guarantees, so that the judiciary is
a completely independent authority from the other
two. Judges should be immune from any influence
on them in their work. The regular judiciary should
look into all disputes. No-one may be tried before
any but the regular judiciary. Special or exceptional
courts should be prohibited as should the trial of
civilians before military courts. All matters relating
to the appointment, promotion and disciplining
of judges should fall within the competence of the
Supreme Judicial Council, composed of judges, with
a senior judge presiding. The text should stipulate
immunity of judges. Members of the Public Pros-
ecutor’s Office should enjoy the same guarantees
and immunity as judges.
9. Stipulation of all civil, political, economic, so-
cial, and cultural rights and liberties, with explicit
prohibition of the restriction of these rights by any
lower legislative instrument. The text should state
unequivocally that freedoms of opinion, expres-
sion and association must be fully respected, with
explicit reference to the media, which should be
free from restrictions or censorship, or any form
of interference with its activity or ownership. There
must be no punishment of imprisonment in relation
to publication or the expression of opinions.
10. Affirmation of the principle of the individual’s
right to compensation for damages done to her/him
as a result of being deprived of their liberty through
imprisonment or preventive detention, having been
charged with offences of which they have been
proven innocent.
BOX 7-4
The Supreme Constitutional Court in Egypt
The Supreme Constitutional Court in
Egypt has had an extremely positive im-
pact in supporting freedoms and human
rights vigorously, playing a vital role in
removing provisions from the statute
books that conflicted with them. While
the law establishing the Court came
under criticism because of restrictions
imposed on the right to bring individual
grievances related to the Constitution
before the Court, it has succeeded none-
theless in playing an influential role in
support of democracy and freedom.
The Supreme
Constitutional Court
in Egypt has had an
extremely positive
impact in supporting
freedoms and human
rights.
169 A STRATEGIC VISION OF FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES – ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
to ensure that it is applied in practice. They
should also ensure that the principles of citi-
zenship and equality apply to all constituent
elements of national society.
Legislation should introduce effective
mechanisms to ensure fair elections. Legal
provisions must assure total impartiality for
the body charged with election oversight and
guard against the state or its apparatus resort-
ing to any form of electoral malpractice. Total
neutrality of the official media should also be
assured. Election-related offences should be
addressed seriously and effectively. Electoral
rolls should be updated to ensure they cor-
respond with those entitled to vote, together
with a fair delineation of constituencies.
Legislation must guarantee that citizens are
free to set up their parties without requiring the
executive’s authorization and with no supervi-
sion other than that required to protect the
values of freedom and good governance. The
law should proscribe racist parties or military
organizations, for example, but this should not
lead to the imposition of increased restrictions.
Freedom to form political parties should be as-
sured under conditions of political pluralism.
It should protect the right of parties to carry
out peaceful political activities, publicize their
programmes, and mobilise their members by
all available means, without restriction other
than that required to maintain public order in
a democratic state. There should be a clear dis-
tinction in both law and practice between the
state apparatus and the party in power, so that
the party concerned does not enjoy the pre-
rogative of using state services to strengthen its
presence, in breach of the principle of equality
before the law.
Legislation regulating civil society organi-
zations should also be revised to embody the
following principles: freedom to set up civil so-
ciety organizations, removing the requirement
for state or other official forms of authorization
where the simple notification of the legal exist-
ence of the organization should suffice; the
activities of civil society organizations should
not be subject to restrictions, surveillance or
administrative control and the freedom and
independence of these organizations should
be guaranteed; no organization should be dis-
solved as a result of an administrative decision,
and such measures should apply only after a
court ruling that all necessary conditions are
satisfied.
Guaranteeing the Independence of the
Judiciary
An independent judiciary is a basic pre-requi-
site for any society if individuals are to enjoy
their rights and freedoms. However, the syn-
ergy between the independence of the judici-
ary and a free political environment is a matter
for some consideration. However exemplary
the laws regulating the judiciary may be, the
judiciary will never play an effective role in an
environment where rights and freedoms are
suppressed and where the law and its institu-
tions are sidelined. Similarly, a state system that
makes no provision for an effective judicial sys-
tem is inherently weak. Progress towards good
governance, on the one hand, and towards
guaranteeing the independence of the judici-
ary and the efficient and equitable discharge of
its duties, on the other, must be made side-by-
side. International standards that provide for
the independence of the judiciary as an institu-
tion (independence of the judicial authority) as
well as the independence of judges as individu-
als should be adopted.
Abolishing the State of Emergency.
Special attention should be given to abolishing
the state of emergency in Arab countries where
the conditions defined by international stand-
ards and the constitution for declaring a state of
emergency are not met. Combating “terrorism”
should not be used as a pretext to maintain a
state of emergency, given that terrorism thrives
whenever freedoms are quashed, and never
more so than under a state of emergency.
In particular Arab states must desist from
abusing the declaration of a state of emergency
and the disastrous effect this has on freedoms
and human rights.
Guarantees for Personal Freedom
Arab legislation must be amended urgently to
guarantee the individual’s protection from at-
tacks on personal freedom, such as unlawful ar-
rest, torture, administrative detention, enforced
disappearance, and to provide in law for deter-
Freedom to form
political parties should
be assured under
conditions of political
pluralism.
Combating
“terrorism” should
not be used as a
pretext to maintain a
state of emergency.
170 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
rent penalties for public servants responsible.
Effective mechanisms should be established to
end these practices and provide victims with
avenues to obtain fair compensation.
Ending discrimination against societal
groups
The second AHDR emphasized that the fa-
cilitation, encouragement and celebration of
cultural diversity in every Arab country was an
important factor in establishing the knowledge
society. To that, we may now add freedom in
the Arab world as well.
That the extension of citizenship rights
to all citizens of Arab countries inclusively
necessarily involves ending all forms of
discrimination against any societal group is
beyond dispute. In a society of freedom and
good governance, no group remains deprived
of citizenship rights. To emphasize this spirit
of inclusiveness, we stress here again that the
word ‘Arab’ is used in this Report, for brevity,
to denote all citizens of Arab countries.
But even before attaining that ideal, there
are no grounds for maintaining any form of
discrimination against various societal groups
in Arab countries. Administrative decrees,
which can readily be issued and swiftly imple-
mented, can speedily resolve persistent issues
of citizenship among unjustly treated groups.
Such action would repair the national fabric,
which has been torn by arbitrary measures in
the past. The first step in this direction is to
repeal all executive orders turning citizens into
‘minorities’ whose rights are violated.
THE POLITICAL ARCHITECTURE
Problematic issues in guaranteeing sound
democratic arrangements
For the most part, political institutions in the
Arab world, even those that are superficially
democratic, such as elected parliaments, in re-
ality do little to further the cause of freedom
in the region because they lack substance, as
argued in Chapter 2. As a result, the political
architecture of Arab countries needs much re-
structuring.
We referred earlier to the necessity of hav-
ing an extensive public sphere in place, one in-
dependent of the current ruling power, even in
the event that it represents the popular majority.
This public sphere would enable individuals to
form their opinions and express them freely as
well as work for their implementation.
It would also help to impose constitutional
regulations on majority decisions in order to
prevent legislation or policies that could restrict
freedoms; and to delegate to the judiciary, and
ombudsmen, the power to review decisions of
the legislative body and, if necessary, correct
them (Chapter 1).
It is crucial to ensure that the ruling author-
ities are appointed as a result of direct popular
choice, and that good governance practices
are implemented down to the lowest levels of
local governance. This not only extends and
reinforces good governance throughout the
country, but is also important given that future
leaders of central government start out and
hone their experience in local government.
The way to achieve good governance in
the Arab region is thus through fundamen-
tal reform of its architecture. This means, in
particular, ending the executive’s monopoly
of power, and marginalization of other state
organs, which obstructs the free and healthy
development of society’s capabilities and
potential. This task is however made difficult
by the fact that the very structural factors that
concentrate power at the top of the executive
branch also prevent civil society from advanc-
ing political reform.
This can, however, lead indirectly to con-
ditions that are conducive to reform, since
excessive concentration of power at the apex
of society isolates an authoritarian regime from
people and unifies political and social opposi-
tion groups behind a common goal.
At this stage of transition needs differ from
one country to another. The various achieve-
ments made to date need to be defended,
alliances set up, and appropriate demands
articulated. It follows then that the nature of
working for governance reform will vary ac-
cording to the issues and means appropriate
to each case.
In effecting the transformation, perhaps
the heaviest responsibility lies with the élites:
intellectuals and political and civil society
In a society of
freedom and good
governance, no group
remains deprived of
citizenship rights.
Excessive
concentration of
power at the apex
of society isolates
an authoritarian
regime from people
and unifies political
and social opposition
groups behind a
common goal.
171 A STRATEGIC VISION OF FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES – ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
activists who will need to forge a middle way
for themselves and the Arab world, neither
bowing to the influence of the powerful and
wealthy, nor following the route to despair and
violence to which many angry young people,
whose peaceful and effective avenues for ac-
tion have been blocked, are drawn. This calls
for considerable wisdom, genuine solidarity
across national borders, and many sacrifices.
The role of the élites is thus crucial in se-
curing an Arab renaissance, but which élites?
These are all groups supportive of freedom
and good governance inside and outside the
existing power structure, whose members are
committed to a renaissance and will work as-
siduously to bring it about.
CODE OF CONDUCT FOR
SOCIETAL FORCES ON THE PATH
TO REFORM
Reform confers duties and responsibilities on
the state and all societal forces, starting with
committed elites. It falls to the latter to set an
example through their own ethical and fair
conduct, by acting in ways beyond reproach
and avoiding the traps of corruption, entice-
ment or manipulation by ambitious foreign
powers. The duties that are required to effect
genuine reform might be seen as follows:
Obligations of the State:
1. Allowing freedom of expression and or-
ganization as a first step towards agreement
with political forces on reforms of the electoral
and legal systems and guaranteeing the fairness
and independence of the judiciary.
2. Starting a direct and immediate dialogue
with all active forces in the society, whether
they are opposition political movements or ac-
tive civil society institutions. Dialogue must be
serious and produce concrete results.
3. Assuring institutional stability without
encouraging stagnation.
4. Safeguarding the independence and integ-
rity of governance institutions so that they fulfil
their role at the service of the people in the best
possible way.
5. Carrying out comprehensive structural
and functional reform of the security services.
All service branches must obey the law, and
should be at the service of the people and the
nation, and not the ruler, party, sect or tribe.
Obligations of the Political Élites:
1. The élites of political society, leaders and
activists need to develop a constructive dis-
course and reject policies of exclusion. They
must also strive to find common ground among
all political forces and create a new mould for
the political scene, clearly distinct from past
trends of polarization and fragmentation which
could seriously hamper genuine democratic
transformation in the Arab region.
2. The political élites must demonstrate ad-
herence to their principles, seeking democratic
solutions to settle differences, rejecting any
form of compromise which could make them
tools of authoritarian regimes and articulating
clearly the demands for freedom for all. They
must never associate themselves with repres-
sion or seek ways to justify its use.
3. Political forces should strive to build
democratic alliances, and openly demonstrate
solidarity in the face of despotism, repression,
corruption and election-rigging.
Obligations of Civil Society:
1. Developing appropriate methodologies
and conceptual frameworks to adapt civil and
human rights work to the local Arab environ-
ment, involving the widest possible spectrum
of different sectors of society at large.
2. Securing internal resources to support and
finance voluntary and civil work
3. Seeking to safeguard the independence of
civil society organizations both from the State
and from competing political associations. This
does not imply that the organizations have no
political role to play, since their role is clearly
set within the political space, particularly when
it comes to defending freedoms, human rights
and the disadvantaged.
4. Setting up networks of associations and
organizations with similar goals, or broader-
based networks to strengthen solidarity and
consolidate the capabilities of the forces of
civil society.
5. Expanding Arab networks and initiatives.
6. Exploiting to the full attained rights and
The role of the élites is
crucial in securing an
Arab renaissance, but
which élites?
It falls to the élites
to set an example
through their own
ethical and fair
conduct.
172 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
freedoms and insisting that they are enjoyed
in their most complete sense; optimizing all
opportunities for action, all available space for
freedom, including opportunities provided by
information and communication technology.
Parliamentary representation:
With roles assigned respectively to the state
and the political and civil society élites, there
remains a crucial need to reform parliamentary
representation in Arab countries. Good gov-
ernance is unattainable without free and fair
parliamentary representation, which is both in-
dependent and effective, particularly in giving
voice to matters of public interest. Public rep-
resentation should afford effective scrutiny of
the executive and hold it to account. Improv-
ing parliamentary representation should not
prove too great a challenge given the current
lamentable state of affairs. In addition, in the
transitional phase towards the society of free-
dom and good governance, improved parlia-
mentary representation helps both to facilitate
the process itself and to root out the various
forms of corruption in Arab countries.
To ensure effective and fair parliamentary
representation, it is essential to:
1. Establish the principle of total equality
among citizens, especially as regards expres-
sion and association, voting and standing
for election, and related procedures; provide
safeguards against disqualifying from parlia-
mentary representation on the basis of gender,
social status, culture, religion or other discrimi-
natory feature.
2. Adopt the principle of consensual democ-
racy as a basis for forming the government, so
that other parties participate in addition to the
party that wins the elections, under a formula
and standards to be agreed on. This principle
is particularly important in states with sub-
groups, as it avoids ethnic or sectarian divisions
between government and opposition. This also
provides opportunities for smaller opposition
parties, which would not otherwise have the
means to access power.
3. Adopt policies based on affirmative ac-
tion, at least in the initial transitional stages,
which will lead to more democratic conditions.
This can take various forms, such as allocat-
ing a quota of posts in government and the
legislature, but still maintaining the principle
of competition within quotas. Within the leg-
islature this would be a matter for the parties
themselves to agree upon, such as setting a spe-
cific quota or a minimum ratio of candidates
representing these groups.
4. Where a bi-cameral system is in place, au-
thorize the lower, elected assembly to monitor
government performance and hold it to ac-
count.
5. Establish ethics committees for fairness in
parliaments to prevent the deputies from using
their political influence for private interests
and to call deputies to account for their unfair
conduct.
REFORMING ARAB
INSTITUTIONAL PERFORMANCE
The institutions of the three sectors of society
(the state comprising the government, legisla-
ture and judiciary; civil society; and the private
sector) should be reformed through applying
the principles of rational public administration.
Reform would be based on the restriction of
authority – public or private - by law and on
efficiency, transparency, disclosure, and ac-
countability (in the case of the state, to other
institutions and to civil society including the
media; and, in the case of government institu-
tions and the legislature, to the general public).
From the perspective of building and utiliz-
ing human capabilities, it is evident that insti-
tutions providing public services, particularly
in education and health care, should function
well. Applying the principles of rational public
administration in the context of legal reform,
as just described, should serve to root out ad-
ministrative and financial corruption.
The most important reforms for guarantee-
ing freedom need to be implemented in the
educational institutions. A mix of measures
relating to administration, curricula, pedagogy
and student evaluation methods is required
to open the door to freedom, as an ultimate
value in itself, and as a means to knowledge
acquisition leading to the attainment of human
dignity. These reforms should work together to
create a mentality of freedom and respect for
human rights, and implant the values and tools
of good governance in the minds of learners.
Good governance
is unattainable
without free and
fair parliamentary
representation, which
is both independent
and effective.
The most important
reforms for
guaranteeing
freedom need to
be implemented
in the educational
institutions.
173 A STRATEGIC VISION OF FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES – ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
The family can make concerted efforts to
nurture freedom and encourage enlightened
education; and thus prevent any subsequent
stages of social development from impairing
individual freedoms established at the family
levels and enhanced by the school (Chapter 6).
Reform of these two fundamental institu-
tions of society should be complemented by
the creation of a social structure supportive
of freedom and good governance. First: by
combating poverty, the antithesis of human
development, by ending the poor acquisition
and under-utilization of human capabilities;
and second: through the redistribution of
income and wealth on a more equitable basis
through taxation. These steps would clearly re-
quire deep changes in the path of development
in the Arab countries.
CORRECTING THE ARAB
DEVELOPMENT TRAJECTORY
In Arab countries, especially the wealthier
states, the concept of development may be
associated with a high standard of living and
consumer prosperity, rather than with the es-
tablishment of a strong, advanced production
system capable of steady growth that provides
individuals and society with income, security,
vitality and the strength to face the challenges
of the time and the world.
The metamorphosis to freedom and good
governance in Arab countries requires a quali-
tative change in development thinking and its
dynamics, to secure an economic basis for the
progress society desires. It also calls for struc-
tural institutional transformation to good gov-
ernance, which is the safeguard of a rational
economic system.
Mobilizing resources, providing incen-
tives for productive investment in human and
physical assets, especially those that support
knowledge-based production (the second
AHDR) and steadily increasing productivity
can bring about such a change. Creating a vig-
orous economic system calls for the acquisition
of fundamental human capabilities, the institu-
tion of lifelong learning, societal incentives
and models that value knowledge and other
social changes aimed at rewarding productive
work, rather than relying on rents or access to
influential groups. It also entails changes to en-
hance competitiveness and efficiency in Arab
economies, and implies an obligation on Arab
states to work for distributive justice.
THE REFORM OF CORPORATE
GOVERNANCE
The challenge is how to move successfully from
institutions of corporate governance that tend
to be centralized and heavily relationship-based
to those that are more effectively rule-based.
Sound corporate governance also requires
the establishment of appropriate laws to
protect property rights, enable competitive
market forces, foster entrepreneurship and
provide an efficient market infrastructure
that ensures transparency and accountability.
This includes transparency of public tenders,
efficient third-party auditing, anti-trust
legislation, strict anti-corruption legislation,
and eliminating all forms of extra-legal
transactions. The development of the region
will be hobbled if free enterprise and efficient
competition are withheld by a limited or weak
legislative structure.
As noted in Chapter 5, three major princi-
ples of corporate governance are vital: trans-
parency, accountability, and inclusiveness,
which are mutually reinforcing and need to be
upheld together.
Transparency is not only an earnest of cor-
porate probity. It also ensures the disclosure
of financial information on which corporate
accountability to stakeholders rests.
Decision-makers in the private sector need
to be held accountable to the public as well as
to institutional stakeholders. Accountability is
an important deterrent against legal and ethi-
cal transgressions, and it is only through swiftly
redressing such misdeeds that confidence can
be built within a market. Effective supervisory
and regulatory boards are one of the means by
which firms may be held accountable.
Inclusiveness is one of the core values of
good governance everywhere. Inclusiveness
means ensuring the equal participation and
equal treatment of anyone who has a stake in
the governance process and wants to partici-
pate in that process. Individuals’ basic rights
must be defined and protected by creating
The metamorphosis
to freedom and good
governance in Arab
countries requires a
qualitative change in
development thinking
and its dynamics, to
secure an economic
basis for the progress
society desires.
The challenge is how
to move successfully
from institutions of
corporate governance
that tend to be
centralized and
heavily relationship-
based to those that
are more effectively
rule-based.
174 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
governance mechanisms for that purpose in
addition to providing remedies and recourse
guaranteed by rule of law. Within the corpo-
rate sector, an area where inclusiveness needs
substantial strengthening pertains to the rights
of shareholders.
AT THE PAN-ARAB LEVEL
Establishing good governance at the pan-Arab
level means replacing the fragmented and
change-resistant regional set-up of the present
day (Chapter 6) with structural arrangements
aiming at integration and based on a new level
of political will and commitment. Regional in-
tegration would bring its constituent members
together in an economic, and possibly also
political, union. This would call for more con-
sistency and common standards in social and
economic systems as well as the enhancement
of general awareness, solidarity and collective
thinking among citizens themselves.
The results of the Freedom Survey, (see
Figure 7-2), demonstrate the Arab people’s
aspirations for stronger Arab cooperation, in-
cluding support for the “Arab Free Citizenship
Area” as called for in the AHDRs, and even
“complete political unity”.
The leading model of this kind is the EU,
which recently became an economic and mon-
etary union and is making moves in the political
and defence spheres. This experience is distin-
guished as it has enhanced the effectiveness of
the regional organization in two ways: first by
giving the regional structure precedence over
national structures, empowering it to take de-
cisions which are binding on member states;
and second, by providing a broader space for
citizens and the social sectors to participate in
decision-making processes and scrutiny of its
performance. This presupposes that: citizens
are entitled to participate in government at
the national level; representational bodies are
already equipped with extensive legislative
powers; there is a partnership between the gov-
ernment, civil society organizations and mar-
ket institutions; while the judiciary protects the
rights of all parties.
The binding nature of decisions taken by
the regional organization leads to the adoption
of the founding agreement, with the force of
law. On this foundation, the regional judicial
institution bases its interpretation and rulings
on disputes over implementation, whether
between citizens and their governments or
agencies of the regional body on matters
within their competence. The regional body
must work transparently. It should publish its
decisions in the media and engage citizens in
dialogue using information and communica-
Figure 7-2
Preferred forms of stronger Arab cooperation, five Arab countries, Freedom Survey, 2003
Establishing good
governance at the
pan-Arab level
means replacing
the fragmented and
change-resistant
regional set-up of the
present day.
The regional
body must work
transparently.
175 A STRATEGIC VISION OF FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES – ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
tion technology. It can set up advisory bodies
to include representatives of special interest
groups and involve parliamentary assemblies
in decision-making where the regional author-
ity is involved in implementing the decision. It
can also address the people directly through
the Internet to create greater awareness and
invite their views on regional issues.
As at the international level, regional
mechanisms are set up to settle disputes or
support preventive diplomacy between states
and prepare draft regional agreements for
state ratification, which are then integrated
by states’ into their respective national laws.
Treaties may deal, for example, with human
rights in general, or matters relating to specific
disadvantaged social sectors, such as women,
children or people with special needs. The
regional body also sets up multi-faceted part-
nerships with regional civil and economic in-
stitutions as well as networks that link national
and local institutions and individual citizens
directly with regional activities. Networking
of this kind is among the most effective tools
that information and communications tech-
nology can provide to increase participation.
Given the significant variations in standards
of living both within countries and between
states, committees and funds should to be set
up to help raise the standard of living of, and
enhance the community spirit for the less for-
tunate social sectors and regions. Finally, the
regional organization offers opportunities for
treaties or joint measures on common defence
and security issues, as well as the potential to
negotiate collectively with international bodies
and in international forums, which reinforces
the capabilities of individual member states.
In particular, it has become necessary for
Arab countries to conclude a new Arab Human
Rights Convention, fully conforming to the
human rights system as a whole as represented
by all the components of international human
rights law. This treaty should start where other
protected rights conventions end and add to,
rather than diminish them. The new conven-
tion should provide all necessary mechanisms
to stop violations at the country and pan-Arab
levels. Perhaps the most important of these
mechanisms would be an Arab Council of
Human Rights and an Arab Court of Human
Rights, which would allow individuals to bring
action directly against governments if the na-
tional system failed to give them justice. These
bodies should be empowered to adopt manda-
tory resolutions.
The European example however leaves
room for innovation in creating an Arab model
with broader scope for integration. While the
Europeans have succeeded in achieving unity
among diverse nationalities, the Arabs have the
opportunity to explore the horizons of a single
nation, which is still in disarray despite shar-
ing a common culture, language, history and
future.
LIBERATION FROM OCCUPATION
Governance reform at the national and pan-
Arab levels would guarantee policy consistency
BOX 7-5
Recommended Good Governance Institutions at the
Pan-Arab Level
1. The Arab Court of Justice or Arab
Court of Human Rights: to protect human
rights throughout the Arab region, and
not merely as a dispute settlement mecha-
nism among governments as is the case
now, and as proposed in the governmen-
tal initiatives to reform the Arab League.
To attain its objective it is imperative that
the Arab Court of Justice admits cases
brought by Arab citizens against their
governments especially if the judiciary in
their own countries fails to protect their
rights.
2. The Arab Parliament: to be formed
ultimately through open, direct and fair
elections among representatives of soci-
etal forces in Arab countries.
Figure 7-3
Perception of just solutions to the Palestinian question, five Arab countries,
Freedom Survey, 2003
It has become
necessary for Arab
countries to conclude
a new Arab Human
Rights Convention.
176 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
between the aspirations of the Arab people for
liberation from occupation, particularly Pales-
tine, figure 7-3, on the one hand, and the objec-
tives and actions of the Arab good governance
regime, at the national, pan-Arab and global
levels on the other. A good regional govern-
ance order would also enhance the prospects
of liberation from occupation. This could take
the form of support for resistance to occupa-
tion or collective bargaining to restore and
safeguard Arab rights in international arenas
and to act towards their realization. Undoubt-
edly, the prospect of protecting the legitimate
rights of the Arabs improves with the reform of
governance at the global level.
As such, governance reform at all three
levels: the national, pan-Arab and global, is of
crucial importance. Even more important per-
haps is that synergy in good governance at all
three levels could shield Arabs from the pain-
ful experience of occupation in the future.
According to the results of the Freedom
Survey, Annex 1, interviewees, particularly
those in Palestine, do not expect the current
state of affairs to result in a just solution to
the Palestinian question. The just solution is
represented either by setting up a Palestinian
State on the 1967 borders, the preferred option
of Palestinians in particular, or by “setting up a
democratic State in Palestine”.
GOVERNANCE AT THE GLOBAL
LEVEL
The Arab region continues to be labelled as
volatile and to suffer occupation by outside
forces and internal and cross-border conflicts
that deprive people of their basic, inalienable
rights and impede human development in af-
fected areas. While much of the responsibility
for ending such conflicts lies with the parties
themselves, the failure of global governance to
address and help resolve such conflicts can-
not be ignored. This system will need to be
reformed to provide effective and peaceful
channels for settling disputes and a framework
of fair rules that are subscribed to, and imple-
mented by all. The system has to uphold the
rule of law on the weak and the strong alike.
The first priority must be reform within the
UN to make it the model for good governance
at the global level and an effective instrument
for protecting peace, security and prosper-
ity throughout the world. This is the faithful
translation of the society of freedom and good
governance at the global level.
Many ideas have been advanced in this re-
spect, ranging from changing the composition
of the United Nations Security Council and
limiting the dominance of certain members, to
expanding the enforcement authority of Gen-
eral Assembly resolutions.
The prospect of
protecting the
legitimate rights of
the Arabs improves
with the reform of
governance at the
global level.
BOX 7-6:
Excerpts from the Address by the UN Secretary General, Kofi Annan, at the Opening Session of the General
Assembly, New York, 21 September 2004.
The prevalence of suffering faced by people
around the world and acts of violence reflect
our collective failure to uphold the rule of
law, and instill respect for it in our fellow
men and women. We all have a duty to do
whatever we can to restore that respect. To
do so, we must start from the principle that
no one is above the law, and no one should be
denied its protection. Every nation that pro-
claims the rule of law at home must respect
it abroad; and every nation that insists on it
abroad must enforce it at home.
At the international level, all states
– strong and weak, big and small – need a
framework of fair rules, which each can be
confident that others will obey. Fortunately,
such a framework exists… And yet this
framework is riddled with gaps and weak-
nesses. Too often it is applied selectively, and
enforced arbitrarily. It lacks the teeth that
turn a body of laws into an effective legal sys-
tem…Those who seek to bestow legitimacy
must themselves embody it; and those who
invoke international law must themselves
submit to it. Just as, within a country, respect
for the law depends on the sense that all have
a say in making and implementing it, so it is
in our global community. No nation must feel
excluded. All must feel that international law
belongs to them, and protects their legitimate
interests.
Rule of law as a mere concept is not
enough. Laws must be put into practice, and
permeate the fabric of our lives… It is by
reintroducing the rule of law, and confidence
in its impartial application, that we can hope
to resuscitate societies shattered by con-
flict…And it is by rigorously upholding inter-
national law that we can, and must, fulfill our
responsibility to protect innocent civilians
from genocide, crimes against humanity and
war crimes. As I warned this Assembly five
years ago, history will judge us very harshly if
we let ourselves be deflected from this task, or
think we are excused from it, by invocations
of national sovereignty.
I believe we can restore and extend the
rule of law throughout the world. But ulti-
mately, that will depend on the hold that the
law has on our consciences… Each genera-
tion has its part to play in the age-old struggle
to strengthen the rule of law for all – which
alone can guarantee freedom for all. Let our
generation not be found wanting.
177 A STRATEGIC VISION OF FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES – ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
What concerns us from the perspective of
Arab human development is the establishment
of an impartial and effective international au-
thority, which guarantees humanity security,
peace and prosperity on a solid basis of human
rights and justice for all. The transitional target
towards that can be the achievement of “the
Millennium Development Goals”, which were
adopted by an extraordinary international
consensus.
A ROLE FOR THE UN AND OTHER
INTERNATIONAL AGENCIES
The UN enjoys widespread credibility, par-
ticularly among the people, a credential not
associated with any other international pres-
ence, although this standing fluctuates in some
political situations. This credibility can be ex-
pected to increase as good governance at the
global level advances in the directions men-
tioned above.
The UN’s credibility centres on its fair,
constructive and positive role, which is widely
accepted, to help peoples and States overcome
difficult periods in their history especially in
the context of political reform. The UN can
play a crucial role in the process of transforma-
tion towards good governance and freedom in
Arab countries. It can help assure the comple-
tion of initial legal reforms guaranteeing civil
society organizations the freedom to exist and
carry out their activities; it can guarantee that
conditions are met for holding free and fair
elections and it can provide observers to moni-
tor elections during transitional periods when
the electoral system first becomes operational.
This role for the UN should be comple-
mented by stronger co-operative links among
global civil society groups, in particular those
working for human rights worldwide.
ACHIEVING PEACEFUL
POLITICAL ALTERNATION IN
ARAB COUNTRIES IN ORDER TO
BUILD FREEDOM AND GOOD
GOVERNANCE: THE ‘IZDIHAR’
SCENARIO.
As has become the tradition with the Arab
Human Development Reports, what we
present here are only the broad outlines of
our preferred scenario: first, for Arab society
to discuss them, second, to place them within
their respective context, and third, to work for
them after they are adopted.
In Max Weber’s terminology, what is pro-
posed here is a “pure” or ideal type for desired
change. If adopted, such a type would most
certainly be adapted and modified by each
Arab country to reflect its respective character-
istics and capabilities.
We formulate here one of the possible tra-
jectories for attaining the “izdihar” scenario.
Societal innovation could generate many more,
around a sequence of acts leading towards a so-
ciety of freedom and good governance in Arab
countries. In our scenario, the completion of
each act leads to the emergence of the next.
The sequence of events leading to this historic
metamorphosis in the Arab world, according
to this one possible trajectory passes through
two major stages. The first is total respect for
the key freedoms of opinion, expression and
association. The second is a historic and peace-
ful process of negotiation among all dynamic
societal forces in Arab countries, including
authorities currently in power, aimed at redis-
tributing power in favour of the people at large
and establishing the institutional structures of
good governance.
Vision dims the further one peers into the
future, and prospects for alternatives multiply.
We therefore focus on the first opening act of
this sequence, it being the closest to us, and the
most accessible to reflection. Since this opening
act initiates the historic leap towards freedom
and good governance in the region, it merits
close attention. Indeed, in this light, this first
act is so crucial that it represents, in our view,
the yardstick by which to judge the seriousness
of governance reform in Arab countries.
The opening act is then presented in
enough detail to appreciate its dimensions and
how it subsequently leads to a sequence of acts
representing variations on the trajectory suf-
ficient to launch the region towards freedom
and good governance. The formulation of pos-
sible sequences of acts, leading to the society
of freedom and good governance, is left to the
creativity of reform forces in Arab societies,
each acting within their own circumstances.
The UN’s credibility
centres on its fair,
constructive and
positive role.
This first act is
so crucial that it
represents, in our
view, the yardstick
by which to judge
the seriousness of
governance reform in
Arab countries.
178 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
ACT 1: LIBERATION OF
CIVIL SOCIETY, LAYING
THE FOUNDATION FOR
COMPREHENSIVE LEGAL AND
POLITICAL REFORM
The curtain rises, so to speak, on a historic
process of transformation towards freedom
and good governance in the Arab countries
through the unleashing of societal forces in
order to ensure the emergence of a societal
movement for change in service to an Arab
renaissance.
The theatrical analogy implies that this
historic transformation can only start with
such an opening act and will unfold only on
its completion. That ending will be marked
by the total respect of the key freedoms of
opinion, expression and association in Arab
countries
3
. These key freedoms must coexist,
because freedom of expression, for example, is
ineffective if not complemented by freedom of
association in both civil and political society,
and other rights and freedoms usually follow
thereon.
In this opening act, civil society institu-
tions, in particular, acquire autonomy. Their
situation changes from one where the ex-
ecutive branch of government licenses them to
exist, subject to supervision, intervention and
control, to one of absolute freedom to organize
and operate under the protection of the rule of
law and an independent judiciary.
Present-day civil society has its own flaws,
brought on by a climate of corruption and
restricted freedom. Legal and organizational
reform in this act will therefore incorporate
measures to guarantee good governance in
those institutions themselves, notably to elimi-
nate financial and administrative corruption
and safeguard the public interest.
Initial conditions for this first act to ma-
terialize include, in addition to the above, the
elimination of all types of marginalization and
discrimination against societal groups and an
end to all types of exceptional legal arrange-
ments such as emergency laws and exceptional
courts. Foundations also need to be set down
for the principles of transparency and dis-
closure in all organizations throughout Arab
societies.
As such, this act requires an initial far-
reaching legal and organizational reform the
crux of which is the guarantee of key freedoms
and independence of the judiciary and changes
that limit the role of security forces to their
original mandate in protecting the security of
citizens and the nation.
In this sense, this initial reform is the indis-
pensable prerequisite for the historic process
of change, aiming at ensuring freedom and
“izdihar” in Arab societies.
The successful enactment of this stage
is assured by the development of a public
attitude supportive of change and progress;
and by the emergence of a societal movement
that includes all societal forces that support
freedom and good governance. Participants
in this movement come from both within and
outside the government and particularly from
civil society institutions, and are eligible to lead
the struggle for freedom and good governance.
The realization of this opening act will signifi-
cantly contribute to the achievement of these
two goals.
The successful emergence of this opening
act in political alternation is assisted by and
guaranteed – particularly in preparation for
subsequent acts - by the formation of dynamic
pan-Arab networks, with active country-level
nodes. These networks would agree on the
minimum level of social reconstruction in
Arab countries required to ensure an Arab
consensus on the previously described historic
negotiation and on renaissance objectives, and
they would call for it in an effective manner.
This would require the mobilization of popular
forces and the creation of a climate of change
towards the society of freedom and good gov-
ernance. This in turn would set the stage for
3
We recall that this was the first pillar of the strategic vision for building the knowledge society in Arab countries, AHDR2.
Present-day civil
society has its own
flaws, brought on by
a climate of corruption
and restricted
freedom.
BOX 7-7
Guaranteeing freedom for civil society
Current status: Desired status:
Civil society organizations must be au-
thorized and supervised, with executive
authority intervention in their activities.
The law, upheld fairly by an independ-
ent judiciary, guarantees freedom of or-
ganization and expression for all.
179 A STRATEGIC VISION OF FREEDOM AND GOVERNANCE IN ARAB COUNTRIES – ALTERNATIVE FUTURES
subsequent acts of the “izdihar” scenario to
unfold. The chances of the first act succeed-
ing would be enhanced if an “Arab renaissance
network” established its own media outlets
that would call for these goals, independently
of both ruling governments and the profit-
seeking sector.
This first act depends as well on an ena-
bling regional and global environment amid
the plethora of initiatives and plans compet-
ing to influence the Arab future. Perhaps
the potential partnership between internally
generated and externally motivated reform
initiatives, currently under exploration, could
foster such a climate.
At the pan-Arab level, a solid Arab consen-
sus on the required legal and institutional re-
forms would widen the path forward through
the first act. This consensus can take the form
of an Arab version of the Helsinki Accords.
4
It
would centre on a convention to be concluded
among Arabs in an Arab city (so to become
for example the “Fez Accords” or the “Dubai
Accords”) that officially opens up the public
sphere in Arab countries.
The climate of freedom created by unleash-
ing the key freedoms can be expected to secure
the remaining conditions for systemic change:
high quality institutions within civil and politi-
cal societies at the national and regional levels;
and to prepare for subsequent acts in the “iz-
dihar” scenario.
EPILOGUE: THE FURTHEST LOTUS
TREE
5
The foregoing pages have made it clear that
formidable obstacles stand in the way of a so-
ciety of freedom and good governance in Arab
countries.
But hopefully, they also show that, at the
end of this difficult journey, there lies a noble
goal, worthy of the hardships endured by those
who seek it. That goal is nothing less than
a society of freedom. In that place, human
dignity is respected and people’s basic needs
- material, emotional and spiritual - are met.
A society that is always open to the potentials
of human progress through the acquisition
and effective use of capabilities in the various
spheres of human activity, with none subject to
unjust force or coercion; a society in which an
individual is secure against all adversities. That
society is the outcome of human development,
the goal which this series of Reports is dedi-
cated to achieving in the Arab world in honour
of its entire peoples.
There is a not inconsiderable distance
between the present point of departure in
Arab countries and this noble destination; and
pitfalls and obstacles at the national, regional
and global level line the way forward. Perhaps
we Arabs have long been reluctant to engage
in the social struggle that offers freedom and
establishes the society of good governance. It
may be that we have been too lenient and that
this has invited usurpation by those greedy for
what our region has to offer. The cost of our
reluctance and passivity is the burdensome
legacy that we are left with.
The time has come to make up for the
missed opportunities of the past. It is to be
hoped that the Arab people will not again fail
to take the historic road leading it to its appro-
priate place in a better, fairer and freer world,
one that it will have contributed to bring into
being, and in whose benefits it will share.
The Arab world is at a decisive point that
does not admit compromise or complacency.
Let each rise to the challenge.

This (regional)
consensus can take
the form of an Arab
version of the Helsinki
accords.
The time has come
to make up for the
missed opportunities
of the past.
4
In 1975 representatives of 35 States met in Helsinki, capital of Finland, at a conference on security and cooperation in Europe. Negotiations led
to the “Helsinki Accords” guaranteeing the principles for freedom and human rights. Participating states undertook to respect human rights for all,
without discrimination. They also undertook to encourage and support the effective exercise of civil, political, economic, social and cultural freedoms
and rights inherent in the dignity of the human person and necessary at the same time to attain her/his enjoyment of freedom.
5
A tree in Paradise
In English and French
Abed, G.T., 2004
Personal communication with N Fergany
Ahram Hebdo, 2003.
“Réforme ou réformette”, Ahram Hebdo, 3-9
décembre 2003.
Al-Ash’al, Abdallah, 2001.
“La mise en oeuvre des mesures coercitives
prises par le Conseil de sécurité dans le droit
international et le droit interne”, Thèse, Paris
II, Assas, Paris.

Amnesty International, 2004
International Secretariat, London, website:
www.amnesty.org
Ayoubi, Nazih N., 1995.
“Overstating the Arab State: Politics and
Society in the Middle East”, I.B. Tauris,
London.
Barry, Robin, 2002.
“The real roots of Arab anti-Americanism,”
Foreign Affairs, November-December 2002.
Berlin, Isaiah, 1969.
Four essays on liberty, Oxford University
Press, New York.
Brumberg, Daniel, 2003.
“The Trap of Liberalized Autocracy,” in:
Diamond, Larry et. al., eds., Islam and
Democracy in the Middle East, The Johns
Hopkins University Press, Baltimore, 2003,
pp. 35-47.
Dahl, R. A., 1971.
Polyarchy, Participation and Opposition, Yale
University Press, New Haven.
Department of State-Office of Research, 2003
“Iraqi public has wide ranging preferences
for a future political system”, Washington
Document, 21 October 2003.
El-Affendi, Abdelwahab, 1993.
“The Eclipse of Reason: The Media in the
Muslim World,” Journal of International
Affairs, vol. 46, no. 2, Winter 1993.
Fergany, Nader, 1998
Human capital and economic preference in
Egypt, Almishkat, Cairo, August 1998.
------------------, 1994
Urban women, work and poverty alleviation
in Egypt, Almishkat, Cairo, February 1994
Fuller, G. E., 2004
Islamists in the Arab World, the Dance
around Democracy, Carnegie Endowment
for International Peace, Washington DC,
September 2004.
Gellner, Ernest, 1994.
Conditions of Liberty, Civil Society and its
Rivals, Hamish Hamilton, London.
Hayek. F. A., 1978.
The Constitution of Liberty, the University of
Chicago Press, Chicago.
Health, Development, Information and Policy
Institute, 2004.
“Health and Segregation”
Hook Sidney, 1987.
Paradoxes of Freedom, Prometheus Books,
Buffalo, New York.
Hopkins, Nicholas S. and Sadd Eddin
Ibrahim, eds., 1997.
Arab Society: Class, Gender, Power and
REFERENCES 181
References
Development, American University Press,
Cairo.
Human Rights Watch, 2003.
“Iraq; Civilians Deaths Needs US
Investigation”, Human Rights Watch, New
York, 21 October 2003 (http://hrw.org/
press/2003/10/Iraq102103.htm).
Huntington, Samuel P., 1996
The Clash of Civilisations and the Remaking
of the Modern World. Simon & Schuster,
New York.
Inglehart, R. (Ed.), 2003
“Human values and social change, findings
from the world values surveys”. International
studies in Sociology and Social Anthropology,
Brill, Leiden. Boston.
Kaufmann, Daniel, Aart Kraay and Massimo
Mastruzzi, 2003
“Governance Matters III: Governance
Indicators for 1996-2002.”
The World Bank Policy Research Department
Working Papers, First Draft, World Bank,
Washington, 30 June 2003; Revised Version,
5 April 2004.
Keane, John, 1998.
Civil Society: Old Challenges, New Visions,
Polity Press, Cambridge.
-----------------, 1988.
Civil Society and the State: New European
Perspectives, Verso, London.
Keddie, Nikki R, and Sayyid Jamal ad-Din,
1972. Sayyid Jamal ad-Din “Al-Afghani”: A
Political Biography, University of California
Press, Berkeley, California.
Kennedy, M. D. and B. Porter, 2000
Negotiating Radical Change, Understanding
and extending the lessons of the Polish
Round Table Talks, U-M Center for Russian
and Eastern European Studies, Ann Arbor,
Michigan.
Khalidi, Rashid, 2004,
Resurrecting Empire, Beacon Press, Boston,
Massachusetts.
Linz, J. J. and A. Stepan, 1996.
Problems of Democratic Transition and
Consolidation: Southern Europe, South
America and Post-communist Europe, Johns
Hopkins University Press, Baltimore.
Lubbers, Ruud, 2002.
“Statement by Ruud Lubbers- United Nations
High Commissioner for Refugees”, the Third
Committee of the General Assembly, New
York, 19 November 2001; UN News Center,
20 February 2002:
Marcuse, Herbert, 1969.
An Essay on Liberation, a Pelican book,
Penguin, London.
MEDACT, 2003.
“Continuing collateral damage: the health
and environmental costs of war of Iraq”,
MEDACT, London, November 2003.
Micklethwait, J. and A. Wooldridge, 2003.
A Future Perfect, The Challenge and Promise
of Globalization, Random House Trade
Paperbacks, New York.
Mill, John Stuart, 1978.
On Liberty, edited with an Introduction
by Elizabeth Rapaport, Hackett Publishing
Company, Inc., Indianapolis/Cambridge
(Originally published in 1859).
Oman, C., 2001
“Corporate Governance and National
Development”. OECD Development Centre,
Technical papers No. 180, September 2001.
Owen, 1992.
Przeworski, Adam, 1988.
“Democracy as a Contingent Outcome of
Conflicts,” in: Jon Elster and Rune Slagstad
(eds.) Constitutionalism and Democracy,
Cambridge University Press, Cambridge,
182 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2003
Sadiqi, Larbi, 2004
The Search for Arab Democracy: Discourses
and Counter-Discourses. Hurst & Company,
London.
Sen, Amartya, 2002.
Rationality and Freedom, The Belknap
Press of Harvard University Press, Harvard,
Massachusetts.
----------------, 1999.
Development as Freedom, Anchor Books, A
Division of Random House, Inc., New York.
----------------, 1988.
On Ethics and Economics, Blackwell publish-
ers, Malden, Massachusetts.
Stepan, Alfred, 2001.
In Arguing Comparative Politics, Oxford
University Press.
Transparency International, 2003.
Transparency International Corruption
Perceptions Index 2003, Transparency
International Website (www.transparency.
org).
UN Department of Economic and Social
Affairs, 2000.
Building Partnerships for Good Governance:
The Spirit and the Reality of South-South
Cooperation, United Nations, New York, ST/
ESA/PAD/SER. E/6.
UNDP, 1990.
‘1990 Human Development Report’, Oxford
University Press, New York.
Waltz, Susan, 2004
Muslim States’ Contributions to International
Human Rights Instruments, in Human Rights
Quarterly, Vol. 26, Johns Hopkins University
Press, Baltimore, November 2004
Waterbury, 1995.
Wiston, 1999.
World Bank, 2003.
Better Governance for Development in the
Middle East and North Africa: Enhancing
Inclusiveness and Accountability, The World
Bank, Washington DC.,
-----------------, 2004.
West Bank and Gaza Update, March 2004.
World Health Organization, 2003.
The World Health Report, 2003, WHO,
Geneva.
World Values Survey Association, 2004.
World Values Survey, 1995-2001, World
Values Survey Association (WVSA),
Stockholm. website: www.worldvaluessurvey.
org.
Zakaria, F., 2003.
The Future of Freedom, Illiberal Democracy
at Home and Abroad, Norton, New York.
Zogby J.J., 2002
What Arabs Think: Values, Beliefs and
Concerns, Zogby International/the Arab
Thought Foundation. September 2002.
Palestinian Red Crescent Society website,
www.palestinercs.org, September 2004.
B’Tselem website, www.btselem.org,
September 2004.
Office for the Coordination of Humanitarian
affairs. occupied Palestinian territory.
Humanitarian Information Fact Sheet January
2005. www.Humanitarianinfo.org/opt/
OCHA
UNICEF, At a glance: occupied Palestinian
territory.www.unicef.org/infobycountry/opt_
1535.html.
UNDP: Millennium Development Goals
Report - Palestine,2002.
REFERENCES 183
184 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
In Arabic
‘Abd al-Khaliq, Farid, 1998/1319.
Mabadi’ Dusturiyya fi al-Fiqh al-Islamiyya
[Constitutional Principles in Islamic
Jurisprudence]. Dar al-Shuruq, 1st ed.,Cairo.
‘Abd al-Latif, Kamal, 1999.
Fi Tashrih Usul al-Istibdad: Qira’a fi Nizam al-
Adab al-Sultaniyya [On Dissecting the Origins
of Despotism: A Reading in the System of
Sultanic Letters]. Dar al-Tabi’a, Beirut.
--------------------------, 1992.
Harakat al-Taharrur al-‘Arabi: al-Mafhum
wal-Ahdaf al-Mumkina [The Arab Liberation
Movement: Concept and Achievable Goals].
Abd al-Hakim, Shawqi, 1994.
Turath Sha’bi [Popular Cultural Heritage].
Part 1, Al-Hay’a al-Misriyya al-‘Amma lil-
Kitab, Cairo.
Al Najjar, Muhammad Rajab, 1995.
Al-Turath al-Qisasi fi al-Adab al-‘Arabi [The
Narrative Heritage in Arab Literature]. Vol.
1, Dar Al-Salasil, Kuwait.
Al-‘Aqqad, ‘Abbas Mahmud, 2002
‘Abqariyyat ‘Umar [The Genius of ‘Umar].
Dar Nahdat Misr lil-Tiba’a wal-Nashr, Cairo,
February 2002.
Al-‘Arawy, Abdallah, 1993.
Mafhum al-Hurriyya [The Concept of
Freedom]. Arab Cultural Center, 5th edition,
Beirut.
--------------------------, 1988.
Mafhum al-Dawla [The Concept of the State].
Al-Markaz al-Thaqafi al-‘Arabi, Beirut.
--------------------------, 1981.
Mafhum al-Hurriyya [The Concept of
Freedom]. Arab Cultural Center, 1st edition,
Casablanca.
Al-‘Awwa, Muhammad Salim, 1998.
Al-Fiqh al-Islami fi Tariq al-Tajdid [Islamic
Jurisprudence on the Road to Renewal]. Al-
Maktab al-Islami, 2nd ed.
-------------------------------------, 1989.
Fi al-Nizam al-Siyasi lil-Dawla al-Islamiyya
[The Political System in the Islamic State].
Dar Al-Shuruq, Cairo.
Al-Afandi, ‘Abd al-Wahhab and others,
2002.
Al-Haraka al-Islamiyya wa-Atharuha ‘ala al-
Istiqrar al-Siyasi fi al-‘Alam al-‘Arabi [The
Islamic Movement and Its Impact on Political
Stability in the Arab World]. Markaz al-Imarat
lil-Dirasat al-Istiratijiyya, Abu Dhabi.
Al-Ansari, Muhammad Jabir, 1994.
Takwin al-‘Arab al-Siyasi wa-Maghza al-
Dawla al-Qutriyya [Arab Political Formation
and the National State]. Center for Arab Unity
Studies, Beirut.
Al-Dajani, Ahmad Sidqi, 1988.
Madrasa ‘Arabiyya fi ‘Ilm al-Siyasa, [An Arab
School of Political Science]. 1st ed., Dar al-
Mustaqbal al-‘Arabi, Cairo.
Al-Fasi, ‘Allal, 1977.
Al- Hurriyya [Freedom]. Matba’at al-Risala,
Rabat.
-----------------, 1963/1382.
Maqasid al-Shari’a al-Islamiyya wa-Makarimuha
[Islamic Law: Intentions and Qualities].
Maktabat al-Wahda al-‘Arabiyya, Casablanca.
Al-Ghanushi, Rashid, 1993.
Al-Hurriyat al-‘Amma fi al-Dawla al-Islamiyya
[Public Freedoms in the Islamic State]. Center
for Arab Unity Studies, Beirut.
Al-Habbabi, Muhammad Aziz, 1972.
Min al-Hurriyyat ila Al-Taharrur [From
Freedoms to Emancipation]. Dar al- Ma’arif,
Cairo.
Al-Harrani (al-Halabi), Abu Muhammad Al-
Hasan ibn ‘Ali ibn al-Husayn ibn Shu’ba (4th
cent. AH).
Tuhaf al-‘Uqul ‘an Al ar-Rasul [The Gems
of the Minds Concerning the Clan of the
Prophet].
REFERENCES 185
Al-Jabiri, Muhammad ‘Abid, 1993.
“Ishkaliyyat al-Dimuqratiyya wal-Mujtama’
al-Madani fi al-Watan al-‘Arabi” [The
Problematics of Democracy and Civil Society
in the Arab Homeland] in Al-Mustaqbal al-
‘Arabi, Issue 167, 1993.
--------------------------------------, 1992.
Fikr Ibn Khaldon: al-’Asabia wa al-Dawla
[Ibn Khaldoun’s Thought: Clannism and the
State] Center for Arab Unity Studies, Beirut.
Al-Jawhary, Muhammad, 1981.
‘Ilm Al-Fulklur [The Science of Folklore]. Part
2, Dar Al-Ma’rifa al-Jami’iyya, Alexandria.
Al-Kandahlawi, Muhammad Yusuf, 1997.
Hayat al-Sahaba [The Life of the Companions].
Ed. By, Muhammad al-Tahir Abd al-Bari and
Ahmad Abd al-Fattah Tammam. Vol. 2, Dar
al-Salam lil-Tiba’a wal-Nashr, 1st edition,
Cairo.
Al-Kawakibi, Abd al-Rahman, 1984.
Taba’i’ al-Istibdad wa-Masari’ al-Istibdad
[The Characteristics of Tyranny and the
Killing Grounds of Enslavement]. Dar Al-
Nafa’is, Beirut.
--------------------------------- (“Rahhala K”), n.d.
Taba’i’ al-Istibdad wa-Masari’ al-Istibdad
[The Characteristics of Tyranny and the
Killing Grounds of Enslavement]. Matba’at
al-Jamaliyya, Cairo.
Al-Ma’afiri, Abu Muhammad ‘Abd al-Malik
ibn Hisham, 1418 AH/1998 AD
Sirat Ibn Hisham [Ibn Hisham’s Life of the
Prophet], edited and annotated by ‘Adil
Ahmad ‘Abd al-Mawjud and ‘Ali Muhammad
Mu’awwad in Al-Sira al-Nabawiyya [The Life
of the Prophet], Vol.2, Maktabat al-‘Abikan,
1st ed., Riyadh.
Al-Manfaluti, Mustafa Lutfi, 1984.
Mu’allafat Mustafa Lutfi al-Manfaluti al-
Kamila Al-Juz’ al-Awwal [The Complete
Works of Mustafa Lutfi al-Manfaluti. Part I].
2 vols.. Darf al-Jil, Beirut.
Al-Mawardi, ‘Ali ibn Muhammad Habib al-
Basri, 1983/1404.
Al-Ahkam al-Sultaniyya [The Rules of
Government]. Dar al-Fikr lil-Tiba’a wal-
Nashr, Cairo.
Al-Na’ini, al-Muhaqqiq, 1909.
Tanbih al-Umam wa-Tanzih al-Milla [Alerting
the Nation and Exoneration of the Sect].
Al-Naqib, Khaldun Hasan, 1996.
Al-Dawla al-Tasallutiyya fi al-Mashriq al-
‘Arabi [The Autocratic State in the Arab
East]. Center for Arab Unity Studies, 2nd edi-
tion, Beirut.
Al-Nasiri, Ahmad ibn Khalid, 1956.
Al-Istiqsa’ li-Akhbar Duwal al-Maghrib al-
Aqsa, [Exploring the News of the Maghrib].
Dar al-Kitab, Casablanca.
Al-Qaradawi, Yusuf, 1977a.
Al-Hulul al-Mustawrada wa-Kayf Janat ‘ala
Ummatina – Hatmiyyat al-Hall al-Islami
[Imported Solutions and Their Impact on
Our Community: the Dire Need for an Islamic
Solution]. Maktabat Wahba, 3rd ed., Cairo.
-------------------------, 1977b.
Al-Khasa’is al-‘Amma lil-Islam [The General
Characteristics of Islam]. Dar Ghurayyib lil-
Tiba’a, Cairo.
Al-Razzaz, Munif, 1985.
Al-A’mal al-Fikriyya al-Kamila [Complete
Philosophical Works]. Dar al-Mutawassit,
Munif al-Razzaz Foundation for National
Studies, 1st edition.
Al-Sayyid, Ahmad Lutfi, 1963.
Mabadi’ fi al-Siyasa wal-Adab wal-Ijtima’
[Principles of Politics, Literature and
Sociology]. Dar al-Hilal, Cairo.
Al-Sayyid, Radwan, 2002.
Mas’alit Huquq al-Insan fi al-Fikr al-Islami
al-Mu’asir [Human Rights in Contemporary
Islamic Thinking] in Huquq al Insan fi al-Fikr
al-‘Arabi – Dirasat fi al-Nusus [Human Rights
in Arab Thinking, Study of the Texts]. Ed. by
Salma al-Khadra’ al-Juyusi, Center for Arab
Unity Studies, Beirut.
186 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Al-Shuwayri, Yusuf, 2003.
“Al-Shura wal-Libiraliyya wal-Dimuqratiyya
fi al-Watan al-‘Arabi: Aliyyat al-Intiqal” in Al-
Mustaqbal al-‘Arabi, Issue 286, Beirut, March
2003.
Al-Suyuti, al-Hafiz Jalal al-Din,
Tarikh al-Khulafa’ [The History of the
Caliphs]. Dar al-Kutub al-‘Ilmiyya, ?.
Al-Tahtawi, Rifa’a, 1872.
Al-Murshid al-Amin lil-Banat wal-Banin [The
Honest Guide for Girls and Boys]. Cairo (also
the Complete Works, edited by Muhammad
‘Imara, Arab Foundation for Studies and
Publication, Beirut, 1973).
-----------------------, 1840.
Takhlis al-Ibriz fi Talkhis Bariz [The Golden
Summary of Paris]. 2nd edition, Cairo (also the
Complete Works, ed. Muhammad ‘Imara, The
Arab Foundation for Studies and Publication,
Beirut, 1973).
Al-Turabi, Hassan, 2003.
Al-Siyasa wal-Hukm [Politics and
Governance]. Dar Al Saqi, Beirut-London.
Al-Zayyat, Muntasir, 2003.
“Al-Taghyir bi-Yadina wa-Lan Naqbilhu
Abadan min al-Kharij” [Change is in Our
Own Hands and We Shall Never Accept
Change Imposed from Outside] in Al-Hayat,
28 August 2003.
Arab Institute for Human Rights, 2001.
Dawr al-Tarbiya wal-Ta’lim fi Ta’ziz Huquq
al-Insan fi al-‘Alam al-Arabi [The Role of
Upbringing and Education in Strengthening
Human Rights in the Arab World]. Tunis.
Basyuni, Mahmud Sharif, Muhammad Sa’id
al-Daqqaq and ‘Abd al-‘Azim Wazir, 1989.
Huquq al-Insan [Human Rights]. Dar al-‘Ilm
lil-Malayin, Beirut.
Bishara, ‘Azmi, 1998.
Al-Mujtama’ al-Madani: Dirasat Naqdiyya
[Civil Society: Critical Studies]. Center for
Arab Unity Studies, Beirut.
Bunduq, Mahdi, 2003.
Tafkik al-Thaqafa al-‘Arabiyya [The
Disintegration of Arab Culture]. Supreme
Council for Culture, Cairo.
Dirgham, Raghida, 2003.
Al-Taghyirat Ta’ti min Al-Kharij Idha Lam
Tanbathiq min Hayawiyya fi al-Dakhil
[Changes Come from the Outside If They Do
Not Emerge from Internal Dynamism] in Al-
Hayat, 1 August 2003.
Fekri, Fathi, 2000
Al-Qanoon Al-Destouri, Al-Ketab Al-Thani,
Al- Nezam Al-Hezbi- Solotat Al-Hokm Fi
Destour 1971 [Constitutional Law, Book
Two, Party System- Governance Authoroties
in the 1971 Constitution]. Dar Al-Nahda Al-
’Arabia, Cairo.
Fergany, Nader, 1995.
Al-Misriyyun wal-Siyasa [Egyptians and
Politics]. Almishkat and Dar al-Mustaqbal al-
‘Arabi, Cairo.
-------------------, 1992.
‘An Naw’iyyat al-Hayat fi al-Watan al-
‘Arabi [On the Quality of Life in the Arab
Homeland]. Center for Arab Unity Studies,
Beirut.
General Secretariat, League of Arab States/
Office of the High Commissioner for Human
Rights, 2003.
Mashru’ Tahdith al-Mithaq al-‘Arabi li-
Huqouq al-Insan [Updating the Arab Human
Rights Charter, a report prepared by the team
of Arab expert members of UN human rights
bodies charged with revising the draft Arab
Human Rights Charter]. December 2003.
Ghalyun, Burhan, 2003a.
Al-Dimuqratiyya al-Mafruda wal-
Dimuqratiyya al-Mukhtara: al-Khiyarat
al-‘Arabiyya al-Rahina fi al-Intiqal ila al-
Dimuqratiyya [“Imposed Democracy and
Voluntary Democracy: Current Arab Options
in the Shift to Democracy”] in Al-Mustaqbal
al-‘Arabi, no.286, Beirut, March 2003.
REFERENCES 187
---------------------, 2003b.
Al-‘Arab wa-Tahawwulat al-‘Alam, Min Suqut
Jidar Birlin ila Suqut Baghdad [The Arabs and
World Change, from the fall of the Berlin Wall
to the fall of Baghdad]. Al-Markaz al-Thaqafi
al-‘Arabi, Casablanca.
---------------------, 2002.
Huquq al-Insan fi al-Fikr al-Arabi al-Mu’asir
[Human Rights in Contemporary Arab
Thought] in Huquq al-Insan fi al-Fikr al-
‘Arabi-Dirasat fi al-Nusus [Human Rights
in Arab Thought, Studies of Texts]. Ed. by
Salma al-Khadra’ al-Juyusi, Centre for Arab
Unity Studies, Beirut.
---------------------, 2001.
Mu’awwaqat al-Dimuqratiyya fi al-Watan al-
‘Arabi. Al Jazeera website.
---------------------, 1994.
Al-Dimuqratiyya al-‘Arabiyya – Judhur al-
Azma wa-Afaq al-Numuww [Arab Democracy
– The Roots of the Crisis and Horizons for
Development] in Burhan Ghalyun, ‘Azmi
Bishara, Gurj Jaqman, Sa’id Zaydan, Musa
al-Budayri: Hawla al-Khiyar Al-Dimuqrati
– Dirasat Naqdiyya [The Democratic Option
- Critical Studies], 1st edition, Beirut.
Ghulum, Ibrahim Abdallah, 2002
Al-Thaqafa wa-Intaj al-Dimuqratiyya,
[Culture and the Production of Democracy].
Arab Foundation for Studies and Publishing,
Beirut.
Hanafi, Mustafa, 2002.
“Al-Fikr al-Falsafi fi al-Maghrib: Su’al al-
Hurriyya fi Kitabat ‘Alal Al-Fasi Al- Falsafiyya”
[Philosophical Thought in Morocco: The
Question of Freedom in the Writings of ‘Allal
al-Fasi] in Al-Falsafa fi al-Watan al-‘Arabi fi
Mi’at ‘Amm [A Hundred Years of Philosophy
in the Arab Homeland]. Center for Arab
Unity Studies, Beirut.
Hananda, Mahir, 2002.
Mafhum al-Hurriyya fi al-Fikr al-Falsafi al-
‘Arabi al-Mu’asir [The Concept of Freedom in
Contemporary Arab Philosophical Thought].
Al-Mustaqbal al-‘Arabi, October 2002.
Hijazi, Mustafa, 2001.
Al-Takhalluf al-Ijtima’i: Madkhal ila
Sikulujiyyat al-Insan al-Maqhur [Social
Backwardness: Point of Entry to the
Psychology of the Oppressed Person]. Al-
Markaz al-Thaqafi al-‘Arabi, 8th ed.
Husayn, Taha, 1996.
Mustaqbal al-Thaqafa fi Misr [The Future of
Culture in Egypt]. Dar al-Ma’arif, 2nd edition,
Cairo.
Ibrahim, Sa’d al-Din, 2003.
“Na’m bi Yad ‘Amr…In Lam Tusari’ Aydina
ila al-Taghyir” [Yes to the Hand of the
Other…As Long As Our Hands Do Not
Hasten to Change] in Al-Hayat, 13 August
2003.
------------------------- (ed.), 1996.
Al-Mujtama’ wal-Dawla fi al-Watan al-‘Arabi
[Society and State in the Arab Homeland].
Center for Arab Unity Studies, 2nd edition,
Beirut.
-------------------------, 1991.
Al-Mujtama’ al-Madani wal-Tahawwul al-
Dimuqrati fi al-Watan al-‘Arabi [Civil Society
and Democratic Transformation in the Arab
Homeland]. Matabi’ al-Ahram al-Tijariyya,
Qalyoub.
Ibrahim, Zakariyya, 1957.
Mushkilat al-Hurriyya [The Problem of
Freedom]. Maktabat Misr, 3rd edition.
Jid’an, Fahmi, 2002.
“Al-Ta’a wal-Ikhtilaf fi Daw’ Huquq al-Insan
fi al-Islam” [Obedience and Disagreement in
the Light of Human Rights in Islam] in Huquq
al-Insan fi al-Fikr al-‘Arabi – Dirasat Al-Nusus
[Human Rights in Arab Thought] ed. Salma
al-Khadra’ al-Juyusi, Center for Arab Unity
Studies, Beirut.
----------------, 1988.
Usus al-Taqaddum ‘ind Mufakkiri al-Islam fi
al-‘Alam al-‘Arabi al-Hadith [The Foundations
of Progress according to Islamic Thinkers
in the Contemporary Arab World]. Dar Al-
Shuruq, 3rd edition, Amman.
188 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Kawtharani, Wajih, 2002.
Min al-Tanzimat ila al-Dustur – Huquq al-
Insan fi Nusus Kuttab al-Nahda, [From the
Tanzimat to the Constitution: Human Rights
in the Writers of the Renaissance] in Huquq
al-Insan fi al-Fikr al-‘Arabi [Human Rights in
Arab Thought]. Ed. by Salma al-Khadra’ al-
Juyusi, Center for Arab Unity Studies, Beirut.
Khashana, Rashid, 2003.
Tunis ba’d 16 ‘Amm [Tunisia after 16 years]
in Al-Hayat, 3 November 2003
Khayr al-Din (al-Tunusi), 1972.
Aqwam al-Masalik fi Ma’rifat Ahwal al-
Mamalik [The Straightest Path to Knowledge
of the Conditons of Nations]. Matba’at al-
Dawla, 1st ed., Tunis, 1284 A.H. (also: Al-Dar
al-Tunusiyya, ed. by Monsif al-Shinufi, 1972).
League of Arab States, Arab Fund for
Economic and Social Development, The
Arab Monetary Fund, The Organization of
Arab Petroleum Exporting Countries, various
dates.
Al-Taqrir al-Iqtisadi al-‘Arabi al-Muwahhad
[The Consolidated Arab Economic Report]
1998-2003. www.amf.ae.org.
Luciani, Giacomo, 1995.
“Al-Ri’ al-Nafti wal-Azma al-Maliyya lil-Dawla
wal-Taharrauk nahwa al-Dimuqratiyya” [Oil
Revenue, the Financial Crisis of the State and
the Move Towards Democracy] in Salama,
Ghassan Dimuqratiyya bi-dun Dimuqratiyyin
[Democracy without Democrats]. Center for
Arab Unity Studies, Beirut, p 175-206.
Majalli, Fu’ad, 2002.
“Huquq al-Insan fi al-Maqala al-Ibda’iyya al-
‘Arabiyya hatta ‘Am 1950” [Human Rights
in Creative Writings in Arabic to 1950] in
Huquq al-Insan fi al-Fikr al-‘Arabi – Dirasat
Al-Nusus [Human Rights in Arab Thought].
Ed. Salma al-Khadra’ al-Juyusi, Center for
Arab Unity Studies, Beirut.
Makki, Ahmad, 1990.
Al-Dimuqratiyya, Tatabiq al-Tawari’ wa-
Ifsad al-Taba’i’: Ru’ya Tarikhiyya li-Haqq
al-Tafawud wa-‘Ilaqatihi bil-Tawari’
[Democracry, the Application of Emergencies
and the Corrupting of Characters : A
Historical View of the Right to Negotiation
and Its Relationship to Emergencies].
Murqus, Ilyas, 1997.
Naqd al-‘Aqlaniyya al-‘Arabiyya [A Critique of
Arab Rationalism]. Dar al-Hisad, Damascus.
Nassar, Nasif, 2004.
Bab al-Hurriyya, Inbithaq al-Wujud bil-Fi’l
[Gateway to Freedom, the Eruption of Existence
Through Action]. Dar Al-Tali’a, Beirut.
-----------------, 2000.
“Al-Nahda al-‘Arabiyya al-Thaniya wa-
Tahaddi al-Hurriyya” [The Second Arab
Renaissance and the Challenge of Freedom]
in Al-Nahda al-‘Arabiyya al- Thaniya [The
Second Arab Renaissance]. Edited and in-
troduced by Ghassan Abd al-Khaliq, Abd
al-Hamid Shuman Foundation, Al-Mu’assasa
al–‘Arabiyya lil-Dirasat wal-Nashr, Amman–
Beirut.
Nusayba, Sari, 1995.
Al-Hurriya bayn al-Hadd wal-Mutlaq
[Freedom, Limited or Absolute?]. Dar al-
Saqi, Beirut–London.
Palestinian submission to the International
Court of Justice, 88-89, in Arabic.
Sa’b, Hasan, 1981.
Al-Islam wal-Insan [Islam and Mankind]. Dar
al-‘Ilm lil-Malayin, Beirut.
---------------, 1975.
Islam al-Hurriyya La Islam al-‘Ubudiyya
[Islam as Freedom Not as Slavery]. Dar al-
‘Ilm lil-Malayin, Beirut.
Salama, Ghassan (ed.), 1995.
Dimuqratiyya bi-dun Dimuqratiyyin
[Democracy without Democrats]. Center for
Arab Unity Studies, Beirut.
Salama, Ghassan et al. (ed.s), 1989.
Al-Umma wal-Dawla wal-Indimaj fi al-Watan
REFERENCES 189
al-‘Arabi [The Community, The State and
Integration in the Arab Homeland]. Center
for Arab Unity Studies, Beirut.
Salama, Yusuf, 2002.
“Ishkaliyyat al-Hurriyya wa-Huquq al-Insan
fi al-Fikr al-‘Arabi al-Islami al-Hadith” [The
Problematic of Freedom and Human Rights
in Modern Islamic Arab Thought] in Huquq
al-Insan fi al-Fikr al-‘Arabi [Human Rights in
Arab Thought]. Ed. by Salma al-Khadra’ al-
Juyusi, Center for Arab Unity Studies, Beirut.
Salim, Abd al-Rahman, 1999/1420.
Al-Rasul: Hayatuh wa-Tatawwur al-Da’wa
al-Islamiyya fi ‘Asrih [The Prophet: His Life
and the Development of Islamic Propaganda
in His Epoch]. Dar al-Fikr al-‘Arabi, 1st ed.,
Cairo.
Sha’ban, Abd al-Husayn, 2004.
Mu’anat al-Mujtama’ al-Madani al-‘Iraqi min
al-Istibdad al-Muzmin ila Fawda al-Ihtilal
[The Sufferings of Iraqi Civil Society: from
Chronic Tyranny to the Chaos of Occupation].
International and Regional Conference
on Democracy and Human Rights, Sanaa,
January 2004.
Shams al-Din, Muhammad Mahdi, n.d.
Nizam al-Hukm wal-Idara fi al-Islam [The
System of Governance and Administration in
Islam].
Sharabi, Hisham, 1992.
Al-Mujtama’ al-Abawi wa-Ishkaliyyat Takhalluf
al-Mujtama’ al-‘Arabi [Patriarchal Society
and the Problematic of the Backwardness of
Arab Society]. Center for Arab Unity Studies,
Beirut.
--------------------, 1990.
“Al-Naqd al-Hadari lil-Mugtama’ al-’Arabi
fi al-Qarn al-’eshreen” [Cultural Critique
of Arab Society in the Twentiteh Century]
Center for Arab Unity Studies, Beirut.
Tarabishi, George, 2004.
“Limadha Inhasar al-‘Unf fi al-Mujtama’at al-
Dimuqratiyya wa-fi ma baynaha?” [Why Has
Violence Been Contained Within and Among
Democratic Societies?] in Al-Hayat, 30 May,
2004.
---------------------, 1999.
“Al-Idiyulujiyya al-Thawriyya wa-Istihalat
al-Dimuqratiyya” [Revolutionary Ideology
and the Impossibility of Democracy] in
Al-Dimuqratiyya wal-Ahzab fi al-Buldan
al-‘Arabiyya: al-Mawaqif wal-Makhawif al-
Mutabadila [Democracy and Parties in Arab
Countries: stands and mutual fears]. Ed. by
‘Ali Khalifa al-Kawwari, Center for Arab
Unity Studies, Beirut.
United Nations High Commission for Human
Rights, 2002.
“Huquq al-Insan: Majmu’at Sukuk Duwaliyya”
[Human Rights: a Collection of International
Legal Instruments] in Sukuk ‘Alamiyya
[Global Legal Instruments] Vol.I, Part I, New
York, Summer 2002.
Waqidi, Muhammad, 1990.
Bina’ al-Nazariyya al-Falsafiyya – Dirasat fi al-
Falsafa al-‘Arabiyya al- Mu’asira [Constructing
Philosophical Theory – Studies in
Contemporary Arab Philosophy]. Dar Al-
Tali’a, Beirut.
Zurayq, Kustantin, 1981.
Fi Ma’rakat al-Hadara [On the Battle for
Civilization]. Dar al-‘Ilm lil- Malayin, 4th ed.,
Beirut.
ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES 191
INTRODUCTION
In general, the measurement of freedom and
governance in Arab countries suffers from
weak databases, subjectivity in the identi-
fication of indicators, and a scarcity of in-
dicators derived from solid empirical field
studies that capture a representative range of
popular opinions.
Starting from the planning stage, the
AHDR team aimed to address these measure-
ment problems by adopting two approaches.
The first was to conduct a secondary analysis
of the results of the World Values Survey 2003
(WVS). This extensive international study,
which includes 96 countries throughout the
world, provides an opportunity to compare
Arab and other countries in the world with re-
spect to elements of freedom and governance.
The AHDR team’s secondary analysis focused
on comparing the Arab countries included in
this large international study (five at the time of
writing) with a number of non-Arab countries,
all enjoying acceptable levels of democratic
governance but varying in location. Results of
this approach are relayed throughout this Re-
port.
This analysis was based on field surveys
carried out in a number of countries including
five Arab (Algeria, Egypt, Jordan, Morocco,
and Saudi Arabia
1
) comprising more than half
of the Arab population. For comparison pur-
poses, indicators on the Arab countries are
contrasted with those on nine non-Arab coun-
tries from Latin America, Africa and Asia that
are considered to enjoy acceptable levels of
democracy (Argentina, Bangladesh, Brazil, In-
donesia, Nigeria, Pakistan, South Korea, South
Africa and Turkey).
2

It is important to note that the perspective
from which the WVS was designed differs from
that of this report and its concepts. In addi-
tion, its field studies have some data limitations
when it comes to Arab countries for essentially
the same reasons that constrain other surveys
in the Arab region.
The second approach consisted of striv-
ing to enrich knowledge on the measurement
of freedom and governance in Arab countries
through conducting controlled field surveys on
opinions relating to the concept of freedom,
the level of enjoyment of freedom and change
therein over time, and means of expanding
freedom.
FREEDOM SURVEY, ARAB HUMAN
DEVELOPMENT REPORT
To overcome the deficient measurement
of freedom used in the previous AHDRs to
raise the issue of freedom in Arab countries,
and to better serve the rich concept of freedom
adopted in the present Report (chapter one),
the Report team, in collaboration with reputa-
ble survey firms in Arab countries, designed a
field survey to gauge the opinion of Arab pop-
ulations with regard to the definition of free-
dom and the extent of enjoyment of freedom
in their respective countries. The design called
for polling weighted representative samples of
Arab citizens, 18 years of age and above, se-
lected to ensure gender balance.
The original hope was that the survey could
be conducted in a large number of Arab coun-
tries. This hope, however, was frustrated by
the general constraints faced by empirical re-
search in Arab countries. It reflects restrictions
on freedom of research and on the generation
of knowledge in the region. The problem was
compounded, no doubt, by the sensitive nature
ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF
FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
1
Differences among Arab States in terms of elements of the questionnaire are to be noted.
2
Presented results in the graphs included in the Report represent simple arithmetic averages of these nine countries.
192 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
of the subject of this report. These constraints
compound the paucity of data and information
in these areas compared to other developmen-
tal spheres in Arab countries.
Based on previous experience, the field
survey team did not entertain the possibility of
implementing the survey in some Arab coun-
tries where the conduct of field surveys was
clearly not possible. Among those countries
approached, at least one Arab country (Egypt)
refused to grant the permit required to conduct
a field survey. In another country (Morocco),
questionnaire items relating to corruption in
the police and the army were excluded from
the survey.
At the time of preparing this analysis, sur-
vey results were available for only five Arab
countries (Algeria, Jordan, Lebanon, Morocco
and Palestine), comprising about one quarter
of the Arab population (more than 70 million
people), located in both eastern and western
Arab countries.
In terms of coverage, the survey sample is
below the ambition of representing the total-
ity of Arab peoples. However, and despite
restriction on freedom and scientific research
and lack of knowledge about measurements
of freedom in the Arab countries, one is com-
forted that information made available by the
limited sample is still a useful contribution. We
hope that a day will come when such a research
is easily conducted towards enriching freedom
and knowledge alike.
MAJOR CHARACTERISTICS OF THE
SURVEY SAMPLES
The survey included at least 1,000 cases provid-
ing a representative sample of the population in
each of the five Arab countries (table AI.3).
According to the original design, survey
samples were divided equally between women
and men and provided for strong representa-
tion (no fewer than 250 respondents) of two
generations, the older and the younger, with a
gap of 35 years (figure AI.1).
The distribution of the survey samples by
residence (rural/urban) and educational level
as well as by age and gender is shown in table
AI.3.
QUALITY INDICATORS OF SURVEY
RESULTS
Percentage of Missing Observations
In less developed countries, opinion sur-
veys face considerable problems that are ex-
acerbated when the topic is thorny from one
perspective or another. In these countries, such
surveys are hampered by the fact that respond-
ents might lack the knowledge or intellectual
ability to comprehend the issues raised and
form an opinion about them. This is normally
reflected in a “do not know” response. When
the respondent does have these two elements,
knowledge and ability, and formulates an opin-
ion, s/he might lack the courage to express it
to avert a real or perceived punishment. This
is reflected in survey results in the form of re-
sponses such as “no opinion” or “refused to
answer”.
Procedurally, “do not know” and “no
opinion” and “refused to reply” responses are
considered as missing observations. The effec-
tive impact of missing observations is that it
reduces the sample size proportionally in rela-
tion to each of the survey items with variations
from one item to the other. The impact of this
loss is minimized when the sample size is ini-
tially large, as in our case, since the number of
responses remains reasonably high despite the
missing data. Conceptually, the high rate of
missing observations indicates the sensitivity
of the relevant survey elements. Technically
Figure AI.1
Freedom Survery, 2003 Sample distribution, by age and gender in Arab countries (%)
193 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
speaking, a large proportion of missing obser-
vations, especially with respect to non-contro-
versial issues, indicates the low quality of a field
survey and its conduct.
The average share of missing observations
in the results of the Freedom Survey in the
five countries about 15 per cent. If we take
into consideration the rather high percentage
of missing observations for some of the more
sensitive items of the questionnaire in the Arab
context, the percentage of missing observations
declines to levels that are generally acceptable
in opinion surveys.
It is to be noted that the survey results pre-
sented in the report refer to the responses of
the total number of those interviewed during
the survey, including the missing observations.
There are a number of the “opinion explor-
ing” elements in the freedom survey in which
missing observations rose to a great extent. This
reflects, in our opinion, the extreme sensitivity
of the issues raised in the Arab context or in
specific Arab countries. These issues include:
• liberation from occupation, foreign mili-
tary bases and foreign influence; particularly in
Jordan, Morocco, and Algeria.
• minority freedoms, especially in Algeria,
Jordan and Morocco;
• prevalence of corruption in the judiciary,
police and army, especially in Morocco (where
all observations were lost) and Algeria.
Strangely, however, this sensitivity extended to
issues that are relatively non-controversial such
as:
• freedom of thought and belief, especially in
Algeria and Jordan;
• freedom of opinion, expression, associa-
tion, and organization especially in Jordan;
• freedom of property, movement, marriage
and economic activity, especially in Jordan and
Morocco.
These results could mean that these
freedoms are rather fragile in the countries
concerned, or that the sensitivity of the con-
troversial issues extended to responses to other
elements.
SIGNIFICANCE OF THE
AVAILABLE RESULTS
The results of the AHDR Freedom Survey
are quite strongly consistent with known and
expected information on freedom and gov-
ernance in Arab countries, as shown by the
evidence presented throughout the present
Report. They also reflect some of the known
characteristics of the five countries/territory
covered. These factors raise the level of con-
fidence in the results of the surveys. Needless
to say, as Arab countries embark on the his-
toric transformation towards a society of free-
dom and good governance, the day will come
in which such surveys can be conducted freely
and regularly. Such a development would in
itself surely accelerate the pace of the progress
towards freedom and good governance.
The results of the surveys did not differ sig-
nificantly by gender or generation, especially
with respect to the three major dimensions:
definition of freedom, extent of enjoyment
thereof and change therein during the five
years preceding the survey. This can be taken
as an indication of a broad societal consensus
on the main results of the AHDR 2004 Free-
dom Survey.
BOX AI-1
Description of survey samples
Jordan
Sampling areas: All governorates were
covered. The country was divided into
strata based on the results of the census
of population and housing that was con-
ducted by the Department of Statistics
in 1994. The rural and urban segments
of each governorate and each of the five
main cities (Amman, Ar-Rossifa, Irbid,
Wadi Sir and Zarqa) were considered a
separate sector.
Sample selection method
Multistage stratified cluster sampling:
Sectors were divided into clusters, each
containing about a number of house-
holds (about 80 households on average
in each cluster). Samples were drawn
from clusters in each sector, proportion-
ate to size, within each stratum. Finally,
systematic sampling was adopted to se-
lect 10 households from each cluster.
Lebanon
Sampling areas: Administrative Beirut,
Mount Lebanon, North, Beqaa, and the
South.
Sampling units selection criteria: Resi-
dence (urban/rural), gender (male/fe-
male) and social status (household: rich,
middle class, and poor).
Sampling selection method: Cluster
sampling.
Weighting: Self-weighted.
Morocco
Sampling areas: Casablanca, Fez, Keni-
tra, Meknes, Marrakesh, Rabat and Set-
tat.
Sampling units selection criteria: Re-
gion, residence (urban/ rural) and socio-
economic status.
Sampling selection method: Quota
sampling with reference to a predeter-
mined itinerary.
Weighting: Self-weighted.
Palestine
Sampling areas: West Bank and Gaza;
cities, villages and refugee camps.
Sampling units selection criteria:
Residence (urban/ rural/ camps) and
gender.
Sampling selection method: Probabil-
ity sampling with reference to a prede-
termined itinerary.
Weighting: Self-weighted sample.
Algeria
Sampling units selection criteria: Re-
gion, residence (urban/ rural) and socio-
economic status.
Sampling selection method: Quota
sampling with reference to a predeter-
mined itinerary.
Weighting: Self-weighted.
194 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
OPINION POLL QUESTIONNAIRE
The questionnaire used in the opinion poll for the survey follows.
Confidential Data
QUESTIONNAIRE
Public Opinion Poll
(November ) 2003
Country of Study
Jordan
Egypt
Lebanon
Palestine
1
2
3
4
|__|
Introductory Data
1. Governorate:
|__||__| 6. Block No.:
|__||__||__||__
||__|
2. District:
|__| 7. Cluster No: |__||__||__||__|
3. Sub-District:
|__| 8. Bldg. No.: |__||__||__|
4. Township :
|__| 9. House No.: |__||__||__|
5. Community:
|__||__| 10. Household Serial No.: |__||__||__|
11. Number of Household Members: |__||__|
Household Visit Result First Visit Household Visit Result First Visit
Occupied 1 Interview completed 1
Permanently closed 2 Required person is out 2
Empty 3 No qualified person 3
Used for non residence purposes 4 Travelling away 4
No longer exists 5 Sick / invalid / elderly 5
Refused interview 6 Refused interview 6
Other (Specify): _________ 7 Other (Specify): ___________ 7
Interviewer Supervisor Coder Data Entry Operator
Name: Name: Name: Name:
Date: / / 2003 Date: / /2003 Date: / /2003 Date: / / 2003
Introduction
Good morning/ Good evening. I am -------------- from --------------------, an independent organization specialized in the field
of studies carried out by talking to people and obtaining their opinions on specific issues.
The organization is now conducting a survey on the issue of freedoms, and I would like you to give me some of your time
to answer some questions. I assure you that the information will remain confidential and will be used only for professional
research purposes.
(If the respondent is not a national of the survey country and has been living there for less than five years, end the interview).
Use the second column in the table below to record the ages of all family members who are 18 years old and above,
starting with the eldest, and specify the sex in the table).
The intersection of the number of the youngest family member with the serial number of the household visit in the
block specifies the person eligible for the interview.
Questionnaire No.
Questionnaire Number
5
6
Original 1
Substitute 2
Interview completed
Work Progress
195 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
101
102
103
To what extent do you think that (freedom from occupation) relates to your total concept of freedom? Does it relate to a
large extent, a moderate extent, a small extent or not at all?
To what extent do you think that (freedom from occupation) is secured in -------------- (state the name of the survey country)?
(Interviewer: If the answer was “to a large extent”, move to second item in the table below.)
Do you think that (freedom from occupation) in ------------- (state the name of the survey country) has improved, has stayed at
the same level or has deteriorated over the last five years?
Question 101 Question 102 Question 103
Extent to which it is related to
the concept of total freedom:
Freedom from ------- secured to
this extent:
State of freedom from (----
--) over the last five years:
L
a
r
g
e
M
o
d
e
r
a
t
e
S
m
a
l
l
N
o
t

r
e
l
a
t
e
d

a
t

a
l
l
D
o
n

t

k
n
o
w
R
e
f
u
s
e
d

t
o

a
n
s
w
e
r
L
a
r
g
e
M
o
d
e
r
a
t
e
S
m
a
l
l
N
o
t

r
e
l
a
t
e
d

a
t

a
l
l
D
o
n

t

k
n
o
w
R
e
f
u
s
e
d

t
o

a
n
s
w
e
r
I
m
p
r
o
v
e
d
S
t
a
y
e
d

a
t

s
a
m
e

l
e
v
e
l
D
e
t
e
r
i
o
r
a
t
e
d
D
o
n

t

k
n
o
w
R
e
f
u
s
e
d

t
o

a
n
s
w
e
r
1. Freedom from occupation 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
2. Freedom from military bases 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
3. Freedom from foreign influence 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
4. Freedom from hunger 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
5. Freedom from sickness 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
6. Freedom from ignorance 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
7. Freedom from lack of income 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
8. Freedom from poverty (lack of
basic human capabilities: health,
education, social and political par-
ticipation)
1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
SECTION ONE
Please tell me about the family members (males/ females) who are 18 years old and above.
Respondent’s Selection Table
Sex: 1 - Male 2 - Female |__|
Household
member
number
Household members 18
years old and above, start-
ing with the eldest
Serial Number of the Household
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
2 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 1 1 2 1 2
3 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1
4 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 4 3 2
5 5 4 3 2 1 5 4 3 2 1 5 4 5 2 1
6 6 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4
Note to the interviewer: Please circle the corresponding response.
100 Are you willing to take part in this poll?
Yes
No
1
2 End interview

|__|
(Interviewer: Ask questions 104/105/106 for each of the items listed in the table below.)
196 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004

Question 104
Extent to which it is related
to the concept
of total freedom:
Question 105
(Freedom of thought) se-
cured without considerable
obstacles to this extent in
------- (survey country):
Question 106
State of freedom
of (-----) over the
last five years:
L
a
r
g
e
M
o
d
e
r
a
t
e
S
m
a
l
l
N
o
t

r
e
l
a
t
e
d

a
t

a
l
l
D
o
n

t

k
n
o
w
R
e
f
u
s
e
d

t
o

a
n
s
w
e
r
L
a
r
g
e
M
o
d
e
r
a
t
e
S
m
a
l
l
N
o
t

r
e
l
a
t
e
d

a
t

a
l
l
D
o
n

t

k
n
o
w
R
e
f
u
s
e
d

t
o

a
n
s
w
e
r
I
m
p
r
o
v
e
d
S
t
a
y
e
d

a
t

s
a
m
e

l
e
v
e
l

D
e
t
e
r
i
o
r
a
t
e
d
D
o
n

t

k
n
o
w
R
e
f
u
s
e
d

t
o

a
n
s
w
e
r
1. Freedom of thought 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
2. Freedom of faith 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
3. Freedom of opinion and expression 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
4. Freedom of gathering and organization 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
5. Independence of the media (from authority and money) 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
6. Freedom of union and professional organizations 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
7. Freedom of civil and cooperative associations 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
8. Freedom of religious organizations 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
9. Freedom of property 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
10. Freedom of movement within the country 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
11. Freedom of marriage 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
12. Freedom of economic transactions 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
13. Equality before the law 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
14. Gender equality 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
(Interviewer: Ask questions 104/105/106 for each of the items listed in the table below.)
104
105
106
To what extent do you think that (freedom of thought) relates to your total concept of freedom? Does it relate to a large
extent, a moderate extent, a small extent or not at all?
To what extent do you think that (freedom of thought) is secured in -------------- (state the name of the survey country)
without considerable obstacles?
(Interviewer: If the answer was “to a large extent”, move to second item in the table below).
Do you think that (freedom of thought) in ------------- (state the name of the survey country) has improved, has stayed at the
same level or has deteriorated over the last five years?
15. Freedom of minorities – if available – to use their
language
1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
16. Freedom of minori-ties – if available – to practise their
own culture
1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
17. Freedom of minorities – if available – to practise their
own religious rites
1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
18. Right to organize opposing political communities 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
19. Presence of significant opposition that has the
opportunity to influence decisions
1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
20. Complete indepen-dence of the courts 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
21. Fighting corruption 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
22. Transparent government 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
23. Government accountability 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
24. Freedom of minorities – if available – to self-govern 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
25. Electing leaders of central government through free
and honest elections
1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
26. Electing leaders of local government through free and
honest elections
1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
27. Electing powerful representatives to the legislative
through free and honest elections
1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |_| 1 2 3 8 9 |_|
197 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
Section Two
A. Women and Society
I will read to you a number of statements. Please tell me the extent to which you agree or disagree with
201 To what extent do you agree that (girls have the same right to education as boys)? (Interviewer: Ask about all the items in the table below.)
I agree
to this extent :
I

d
o
n

t

a
g
r
e
e
I

d
o
n

t

k
n
o
w
R
e
f
u
s
e
d

t
o

a
n
s
w
e
r
L
a
r
g
e
M
o
d
e
r
a
t
e
S
m
a
l
l
1. Girls have the same right to education as boys. 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
2. Women have the same right to work as men. 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
3. Women have the same right to political action as men. 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
4. A woman’s children have the right to acquire her nationality the
same as a man’s children have the right to acquire his nationality.
1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
5. A woman has the right to assume a judiciary position. 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
6. A woman has the right to assume the position of Minister. 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
7. A woman has the right to assume the position of Prime Minister. 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
8. A woman has the right to assume the position of Head of State. 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
B. Activities of the Council of Deputies/ Parliament
202 To what extent do you think that the parliament (performs its legislative role effectively)? (Interviewer: Ask about all the items in the table below.)
Parliament performs its legis-
lative role to this extent:
Does not perform
this role at all
I don’t
know
Refused to
answer
Large Moderate Small
1. Performs its legislative role effectively 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
2. Controls the Government’s work effectively 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
3. Holds the Government accountable effectively 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
203 Do you have confidence in going to the courts (read):
Constantly Occasionally Rarely I don’t know Refused to answer
1. In civil disputes 1 2 3 8 9 |__|
2. In financial and economic disputes 1 2 3 8 9 |__|
3. In disputes relating to freedoms 1 2 3 8 9 |__|
C. Courts
D. The media
I will read to you a number of statements. Please tell me the extent to which you agree or disagree with
Extent
Not / does not
(-----) at all
I don’t know Refused to an-
swer
Large Moderate Small
1. Honest 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
2. Presents the opinion and the other opinion 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
3. Contributes to the acquisition of knowledge 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
204 To what extent do you think that the (government) media in ------------- are (Interviewer: State the name of survey country, then read and
describe the extent.):
198 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
205 To what extent do you think that the (non-government) media in ------------- are (Interviewer: State the name of survey country,
then read and describe the extent):
Extent Not/ does not
(-----) at all
I don’t know Refused to an-
swer
Large Moderate Small
1. Honest 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
2. Presents the opinion and the other opinion 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
3. Contributes to the acquisition of knowledge 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
206 To what extent do you think that (corruption) in ------------ (Interviewer: State the name of survey country.) is common (read):
Common to a large extent
Common to a moderate extent
Common to a small extent
Not common at all
I don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
3
4
8
9
|__|
207 In which of the following areas do you think that corruption is the most common in ----------- (State name of survey country) (read):
(Interviewer: Only one response)
Politics
Economy
Courts
Social relations
I don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
3
4
8
9
|__|
208 To what extent do you think that corruption is common in the (Courts/ Judiciary) (read):
(Interviewer: Ask about all the items in the table below.)
Corruption is common to
this extent:
Not com-
mon at all
Don’t
know
Refused to
answer
Large Moderate Small
1. Courts/ Judiciary 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
2. Army/ Armed Forces 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
3. Police/ Security Forces 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
4. Traffic police 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
5. Education 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
6. Customs 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
7. Tax 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
8. Business community 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
9. Central government departments 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
10. Local government departments 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
11. Parliament 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
E. Corruption
move to Q 211
199 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
209 Which of the following groups contributes the most to the spread of corruption (read):
(Interviewer: Only one response)
Politicians
Businessmen
Low-ranking employees
High-ranking employees
Don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
3
4
8
9
|__|
210 To which of the following reasons do you attribute the spread of corruption --------- (State the name of study country)
(read): (Interviewer: Only one response)
Poverty
Lack of the rule of law
Weak government transparency
Lack of effective government accountability
Weak court system and inadequate law enforcement
Don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
3
4
5
8
9
|__|
211 Do you know of anyone who has paid a bribe to facilitate business over the last twelve months?
Yes
No
Don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
8
9
|__|
212 Was this bribe offered (read):
To secure a service or benefit
To avoid punishment
Other (specify): --------------------------------
Don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
3
8
9
|__|
213 Do you know of anyone who has used favouritism (mediation/ special connection) to expedite a certain business or trans-
action over the last twelve months?
214 Was this wasta used (read):
To secure a service or benefit
To avoid punishment
Other (specify): --------------------------------
Don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
3
8
9
|__|
Yes
No
Don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
8
9
|__|
move to Q 213
move to Q 215
200 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
215 In your view, what is the best way to obtain a service (benefit)? (read):
(Interviewer: One response only)
Bribe
Favouritism
Complaint to official authorities
Resort to the media
Other (specify): --------------------------------
Don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
3
4
5
8
9
|__|
216 In your view, what is the most successful way to avoid punishment? (read):
(Interviewer: One response only)
Bribe
Favouritism
Complaint to official authorities
Resort to the media
Other (specify): --------------------------------
Don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
3
4
5
8
9
|__|
217 To what extent do you think that (establishing institutional governance system /the rule of law) contributes to fighting
corruption? Would establishing the rule of institutional governance system contributes to fight corruption to a large,
moderate, or small extent, or does it not fight corruption at all? (Interviewer: Ask about all the items in the table below.)
Contributes to this
extent:
D
o
e
s

n
o
t


g
h
t

a
t

a
l
l
D
o
n

t

k
n
o
w
R
e
f
u
s
e
d

t
o

a
n
s
w
e
r
L
a
r
g
e
M
o
d
e
r
a
t
e
S
m
a
l
l
1. Establishing the institutional governance system/ rule of law 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
2. Strengthening government transparency 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
3. Enforcing effective government accountability 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
4. Elimination of poverty 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
5. Ensuring the independence of the courts 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
6. Strengthening and rigorous enforcement of the sanctions against corrupt people 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
F. Efficiency of Public Services
(Interviewer: Ask questions 218/ 219 for each of the items in the table below.)
218
219
To what extent do you think that (government health services) are satisfactory in ------------- (State the name of the survey
country)? Are they satisfactory to a large, moderate or small extent or are they unsatisfactory?
To what extent do you think that the cost of (government health services) is satisfactory in ------------- (State the name of
the survey country)? Is it satisfactory to a large, moderate or small extent or is it unsatisfactory?
Question 218 Question 219
To what extent do you think that
government health services are
satisfactory:
To what extent do you think that
the cost of government health
services is satisfactory:
L
a
r
g
e
M
o
d
e
r
a
t
e
S
m
a
l
l
U
n
s
a
t
i
s
f
a
c
t
o
r
y
D
o
n

t

k
n
o
w
R
e
f
u
s
e
d

t
o

a
n
s
w
e
r
L
a
r
g
e
M
o
d
e
r
a
t
e
S
m
a
l
l
U
n
s
a
t
i
s
f
a
c
t
o
r
y

D
o
n

t

k
n
o
w
R
e
f
u
s
e
d

t
o

a
n
s
w
e
r
1. Government health services 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
2. Private health services 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
3. Government education 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
4. Private education 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__| 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
201 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
301 Do you approve of/ accept (read):
Yes No Don’t know Refused to answer
1. Foreign military bases in your country 1 2 8 9 |__|
2. Foreign military bases in an Arab country 1 2 8 9 |__|
302 What, in your opinion, represents a just solution to the Palestinian problem? (read):
(Interviewer: One response only)
Setting up a democratic State in Palestine
Ending the Israeli occupation of the Palestinian territories occupied in 1967 and establishing two States,
Palestinian and Israeli, based on a peace agreement between them
Concluding a peace agreement between Israel and the Palestinian authority, based on whatever Palestinian
land can be liberated through negotiation
Don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
3
8
9
|__|
303 Are you generally satisfied with the current level of Arab cooperation?
Yes
No
Don’t know
Refused to answer
1
2
8
9
|__|
304 To what extent do you think that introducing a (unified Arab currency) will reflect your ambition for a better level of Arab
cooperation? (Interviewer: Ask about all the items in the table below.)
Reflects to this degree:
Does not
reflect at all
Don’t
know
Refused to
answer
Large Moderate Small
1. Unified Arab currency 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
2. An Arab free trade zone (movement of goods between Arab
States without customs limitations)
1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
3. An Arab free citizenship area (free mobility of individuals,
ideas, commodities and capital among all Arab countries)
1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
4. Complete political unity 1 2 3 4 8 9 |__|
Section Three
Other Topics
305 In your opinion, what are the three most important methods that, if implemented, may result in enhancing the scope of
freedoms in ---------------- (State the name of the survey country)?
1. _______________________________________________________________________
2. _______________________________________________________________________
3. _______________________________________________________________________
|__||__|
|__||__|
|__||__|
202 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
401 Living Area: 406 Occupation:
403 Sex: 407 Household members
Male
Female
1
2
|__|
_________________ Persons |__||__|
Jordanian
Egyptian
Palestinian
Lebanese
Other (specify) ___________________
1
2
3
4
5
|__||__|
_________________ Rooms |__||__|
405 Educational level (highest level successfully completed): 409 Does the family have one car
or more?
One
More
Does not haveð End interview
1
2
3
|__|
Section Four
Demographic Data
Urban
Rural
1
2
|__|
______________________________ |__||__|
A. Respondent’s work
Not working
Working (specify) _____________
B. Father’s work
Not working
Working (specify) _____________
C. Mother’s work
Not working
Working (specify) _____________
1
2
1
2
1
2
|__|
|__|
|__|
402 Age:
404 Nationality : 408 Number of rooms in the house:
(A.Respondent) (B.Father) (C.Mother)
No education (illiterate/ reads
and writes)
Primary (6 years)
Basic (10 years)
Secondary (12 years)
College or university student
Completed first university
degree
Higher studies (post-graduate)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
|__|
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
|__|
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
|__|
410 What type is the most expensive car you have Ê
__________________________ |__||__|
Interviewer:
Thank the respondents and tell them that you might visit them again.
203 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria Total
Average percentage of “do not know” 14.68 1.73 4.08 10.74 7.01 7.68
Average percentage of “refused to answer” 0.30 0.54 1.00 2.38 2.34 1.32
Average percentage of “missing observations” 11.01 5.46 3.65 11.39 7.15 7.74
Average percentage of total missing observations 26.18 7.73 8.72 24.50 16.49 16.74
Table A-1 Average percentage of “do not know”, “refused to answer” and “missing observation” responses, five
Arab countries/, Freedom Survey, 2003
Table A-2 Percentage of “missing observations”, by question, five Arab countries/, Freedom Survey, 2003
Question Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria Total
Q 101 related to the comprehensive concept of freedom
Freedom from occupation 6.90 0.00 0.40 1.48 1.61 2.07
Freedom from military bases 11.90 0.70 3.68 12.11 5.76 6.83
Freedom from foreign influence 9.80 0.30 3.08 14.37 6.89 6.91
Freedom from hunger 6.50 0.50 0.70 2.07 2.46 2.44
Freedom from sickness 6.60 0.60 1.49 2.07 2.27 2.60
Freedom from ignorance 6.20 0.30 1.09 0.69 3.49 2.36
Freedom from lack of income 7.10 0.40 1.69 14.17 2.36 5.14
Freedom from poverty 7.00 0.70 1.99 0.89 1.04 2.30
Q 102 Elements of freedom secured
Freedom from occupation 13.10 1.30 1.59 5.71 1.61 4.63
Freedom from military bases 21.30 1.90 5.17 18.90 7.18 10.87
Freedom from foreign influence 16.10 2.60 6.87 17.52 7.84 10.18
Freedom from hunger 8.10 1.40 2.29 4.03 3.97 3.96
Freedom from sickness 9.50 1.70 2.69 4.82 2.83 4.29
Freedom from ignorance 8.00 1.30 1.89 2.56 4.15 3.58
Freedom from lack of income 8.70 1.00 1.59 21.36 3.02 7.13
Freedom from poverty 8.40 1.10 2.79 3.54 2.36 3.62
Q 103 State of enjoying freedom over the last five years
Freedom from occupation 60.90 18.30 11.24 74.80 59.68 45.22
Freedom from military bases 62.70 20.00 18.11 69.39 71.77 48.7
Freedom from foreign influence 57.50 17.20 19.11 45.18 55.34 39.06
Freedom from hunger 38.30 11.20 9.75 52.46 45.23 31.00
Freedom from sickness 40.70 12.70 12.64 35.53 40.51 28.56
Freedom from ignorance 49.50 22.50 17.81 36.91 49.67 35.43
Freedom from lack of income 32.30 9.70 10.75 33.96 42.30 26.00
Freedom from poverty 33.20 12.00 13.040 24.61 39.66 24.67
Q 104 Elements of freedom as constituents of respondents’ concept of freedom
Freedom of thought 7.90 0.20 1.89 3.44 1.51 2.97
Freedom of faith 6.80 0.60 1.89 8.86 3.49 4.33
Freedom of opinion and expression 5.50 0.30 0.80 4.04 1.51 2.42
Freedom of gathering and organization 24.40 0.70 4.08 24.61 6.89 12.11
Independence of the media 23.20 0.50 3.28 29.04 6.14 12.4
Freedom of unions and professional organizations 28.90 1.60 4.88 27.46 10.67 14.69
Freedom of civil and cooperative associations 30.60 2.30 6.27 23.03 13.98 15.24
204 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Question Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria Total
Q 104 Elements of freedom as constituents of respondents’ concept of freedom
Freedom of religious organizations 19.6 0.80 3.78 16.14 7.37 9.53
Freedom of property 7.00 1.50 3.08 6.50 3.68 4.35
Freedom of movement within the country 5.60 0.70 2.29 5.31 1.04 2.97
Freedom of marriage 5.10 0.60 1.99 1.58 2.17 2.28
Freedom of economic transactions 16.2 0.90 2.99 22.04 10.10 10.47
Equality before the law 8.30 0.50 1.49 9.45 1.61 4.25
Gender equality 7.00 0.70 1.49 4.33 1.89 3.07
Freedom of minorities – if available – to use their language 19.50 1.20 10.05 3.64 2.55 7.32
Freedom of minorities – if available– to practise their own culture 20.90 0.80 10.45 4.23 1.79 7.56
Freedom of minorities – if available – to practise their own religious
rites
19.80 0.80 7.96 9.35 4.06 8.35
Right to organize opposing political communities 32.80 2.70 3.88 40.85 8.50 17.7
Presence of significant opposition that has the opportunity to influ-
ence decisions
31.80 2.40 5.37 44.00 10.39 18.76
Complete independence of the courts 19.00 1.00 3.68 31.89 4.91 12.07
Fighting corruption 10.00 0.70 2.59 5.91 2.27 4.27
Transparent government 21.30 1.30 3.88 20.96 4.25 10.3
Government accountability 21.40 1.10 4.18 36.71 4.91 13.62
Freedom of minorities – if available – to self-govern 33.20 3.00 10.25 31.10 14.16 18.33
Electing leaders of central government through free and honest
elections
19.80 2.20 5.97 8.86 5.19 8.37
Electing leaders of local government through free and honest elec-
tions
18.50 2.40 4.58 8.76 6.52 8.13
Electing powerful representatives to the legislative through free and
honest elections
15.90 2.00 4.98 9.06 6.89 7.76
Q 105 Elements of freedom secured
Freedom of thought 11.10 0.40 2.29 5.51 1.32 4.09
Freedom of faith 8.90 0.80 2.09 10.93 6.04 5.77
Freedom of opinion and expression 9.10 0.50 2.19 6.79 2.36 4.17
Freedom of gathering and organization 27.00 1.60 4.58 28.05 9.44 14.11
Independence of the media 26.60 0.50 3.38 34.15 7.55 14.41
Freedom of union and professional organizations 32.60 1.60 6.67 33.17 15.96 18.01
Freedom of civil and cooperative associations 35.00 2.50 6.47 25.49 20.02 17.93
Freedom of religious organizations 21.80 1.10 3.88 19.78 11.24 11.57
Freedom of property 7.90 1.00 3.58 8.07 6.04 5.33
Freedom of movement within the country 6.00 0.50 1.49 5.70 1.79 3.09
Freedom of marriage 5.90 0.60 1.69 3.05 3.12 2.87
Freedom of economic transactions 18.60 1.40 2.89 25.00 16.71 12.99
Equality before the law 9.70 0.70 3.18 12.01 3.97 5.91
Gender equality 7.20 0.50 3.38 5.42 3.49 4.00
Freedom of minorities – if available – to use their language 23.40 3.20 13.43 3.84 2.74 9.23
Freedom of minorities – if available – to practise their own
culture
24.20 3.10 13.23 4.72 2.55 9.47
Freedom of minorities – if available – to practise their own
religious rites
22.80 2.50 10.65 10.73 6.89 10.67
Right to organize opposing political communities 38.10 4.60 5.97 43.50 10.86 20.55
205 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
Question Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria Total
105 Elements of freedom secured
Presence of significant opposition that has the opportunity to
influence decisions
38.50 4.30 6.37 47.24 13.98 22.05
Complete independence of the courts 23.00 1.80 3.98 35.43 8.22 14.47
Fighting corruption 11.80 1.30 2.49 9.94 5.95 6.30
Transparent government 24.30 2.50 4.68 23.43 9.16 12.80
Government accountability 24.70 1.20 6.07 38.29 9.63 15.96
Freedom of minorities – if available –
to self-govern
41.00 5.90 14.63 32.97 18.41 22.56
Electing leaders of central government through free and hon-
est elections
23.70 4.00 7.56 12.40 9.63 11.44
Electing leaders of local government through free and honest
elections
21.40 3.90 6.27 12.50 10.48 10.91
Electing powerful representatives to the legislative through
free and honest elections
18.70 3.50 5.57 11.52 11.71 10.22
Q (106) State of elements of freedom over the last five years
Freedom of thought 51.00 31.90 15.42 64.47 47.78 42.22
Freedom of faith 71.20 38.90 28.76 65.85 48.44 50.63
Freedom of opinion and expression 46.60 25.20 9.95 45.18 28.42 31.06
Freedom of gathering and organization 55.20 23.80 11.64 61.32 33.90 37.19
Independence of the media 51.90 14.70 10.05 48.33 26.25 30.24
Freedom of union and professional organizations 61.10 29.50 17.51 61.71 39.75 41.93
Freedom of civil and cooperative associations 63.70 33.60 19.30 71.56 51.46 48.01
Freedom of religious organizations 62.90 43.20 19.20 53.05 37.96 43.21
Freedom of property 77.00 45.80 29.15 74.02 50.05 55.18
Freedom of movement within the country 83.30 45.20 14.13 83.76 53.45 55.98
Freedom of marriage 80.80 46.70 33.33 73.13 56.28 58.05
Freedom of economic transactions 67.70 36.30 17.41 69.88 47.69 47.83
Equality before the law 54.90 17.10 10.85 37.70 19.26 27.87
Gender equality 58.80 26.00 16.22 48.62 35.98 37.13
Freedom of minorities- if available - to use their language 79.50 60.70 35.92 87.50 53.45 63.35
Freedom of minorities - if available - to practise their own culture 79.10 61.90 35.02 85.53 63.64 65.06
Freedom of minorities - if available - to practise their own religious
rites
80.50 61.50 37.01 79.13 53.35 62.22
Right to organize opposing political communities 57.30 24.60 15.12 62.89 39.09 39.84
Presence of significant opposition that has the opportunity to influ-
ence decisions
55.10 20.40 15.02 58.66 32.67 36.38
Complete independence of the courts 65.10 16.20 14.13 51.77 23.42 34.04
Fighting corruption 48.90 13.30 13.13 23.52 20.30 23.78
Transparent government 59.20 13.50 12.94 45.67 25.87 31.40
Government accountability 53.10 13.90 13.93 48.82 26.63 31.26
Freedom of minorities - if available - to self-govern 64.50 25.10 28.36 48.03 40.42 41.28
Electing leaders of central government through free and honest
elections
56.70 17.10 15.72 36.12 27.86 30.67
Electing leaders of local government through free and honest elec-
tions
56.20 21.00 16.52 35.43 26.91 31.16
Electing powerful representatives to the legislative through free and
honest elections
60.20 17.50 16.32 32.38 29.75 31.20
206 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Question Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria Total
Q 201 Women and society
Girls have the same right to education as boys. 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.79 0.19 0.37
Women have the same right to work as men. 0.60 0.30 0.80 0.98 0.28 0.59
Women have the same right to political action as men. 2.10 0.20 1.39 3.54 0.66 1.57
A woman’s children have the right to acquire her nationality that
same as men’s children have the right to acquire his nationality.
3.10 0.70 2.89 9.06 5.95 4.37
A woman has the right to assume a judiciary position. 1.80 0.30 1.69 2.66 2.27 1.75
A woman has the right to assume the position of Minister. 1.30 0.20 1.69 3.15 1.98 1.67
A woman has the right to assume the position of Prime Minister. 1.50 0.40 2.19 3.84 2.64 2.13
A woman has the right to assume the position of Head of State. 2.20 0.50 1.69 6.00 3.21 2.74
Q 202 Activities of the Council of Deputies/Parliament
Perform its legislative role effectively 12.30 1.70 3.68 15.85 12.94 9.35
Controls the Government’s work effectively 14.20 1.70 4.28 19.59 15.58 11.14
Holds the Government accountable effectively 14.00 1.60 4.78 20.57 18.41 11.97
Q 203 Confidence in going to the courts
In civil disputes 7.40 3.70 12.74 19.09 8.12 10.22
In financial and economic disputes 7.30 3.10 14.23 21.46 14.73 12.22
In disputes relating to freedoms 11.60 5.10 20.20 24.11 14.73 15.18
Q 204-205 media
Honest government media 8.40 1.50 5.67 11.61 9.73 7.42
Government media Presents the opinion and the other opinion 10.60 2.40 5.87 13.68 11.05 8.76
Government media Contributes to the acquisition of knowledge 7.60 1.40 5.57 11.42 11.43 7.54
Non-government media Honest 15.90 1.10 6.47 14.76 11.90 10.06
Non-government media Presents the opinion and the other opinion 16.40 0.70 6.57 14.96 12.84 10.33
Non-government media Contributes to the acquisition of knowl-
edge
14.90 0.40 6.17 14.27 14.92 10.20
Corruption
Q 206 Corruption is common 11.00 1.40 4.88 8.76 3.59 5.91
Q 207 Areas where corruption is the most common 24.00 4.50 10.75 12.40 8.88 12.07
Q 208 Institutions where corruption is the most common
Courts/Judiciary 34.70 5.10 10.25 16.24 9.35 15.06
Army/Armed forces 40.70 4.30 12.14 100.00 77.62 47.44
Police/Security forces 39.30 4.00 11.34 100.00 82.44 47.95
Traffic police 36.30 3.80 10.05 100.00 81.02 46.77
Education 24.40 3.90 9.05 18.60 12.28 13.64
Customs 36.10 6.40 11.94 100.00 6.61 32.11
Tax 34.60 3.40 12.54 24.41 8.88 16.69
Business community 36.20 7.30 13.73 24.51 10.10 18.29
Central government departments 37.30 7.30 13.53 28.64 25.31 22.46
Local government departments 35.70 6.40 13.13 21.36 18.13 18.94
Parliament 37.50 6.70 15.32 32.19 31.82 24.80
Q 209 Group that contributes the most to the
spread of corruption
31.50 6.50 11.44 13.19 10.95 14.67
Q 210 Reasons for the spread of corruption 22.10 5.30 11.14 10.63 8.40 11.48
Q 211 Know of anyone who paid a bribe 6.60 5.80 10.85 4.43 10.95 7.76
207 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
Question Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria Total
Q 212 Reason for paying a bribe 79.20 41.00 59.10 29.53 49.10 51.50
Q 213 Know of anyone who used favouritism 5.50 4.20 9.85 4.33 9.35 6.67
Q 214 Reasons for using favouritism 58.10 27.60 45.97 31.10 35.32 39.55
Q 215 Best way to obtain a service 8.10 1.70 6.57 6.20 17.75 8.17
Q 216 Most successful way of avoiding punishment 8.80 2.00 6.37 9.35 20.49 9.53
Q 217 To what extent do you think that …………….. contributes to fighting corruption?
Establishing the rule of law 30.30 2.90 5.07 11.02 2.36 10.24
Strengthening government transparency 27.30 2.10 4.58 19.09 3.78 11.30
Enforcing effective government accountability 24.50 1.80 5.17 21.75 5.00 11.59
Elimination of poverty 13.60 0.90 2.59 6.99 2.46 5.28
Ensuring the independence of courts 19.70 1.70 3.58 27.66 4.63 11.42
Strengthening and rigorous enforcement of the sanctions against
corrupt people
14.30 1.30 3.28 13.88 2.64 7.05
Q 218 Satisfaction with level of health services
Government health services 1.00 1.30 0.80 1.18 1.32 1.12
Private health services 9.10 0.30 1.29 8.96 7.55 5.47
Cost of government health services 4.10 0.60 1.29 5.12 3.12 2.85
Cost of private health services 14.30 0.10 3.48 16.83 27.76 12.68
Q 219 Satisfaction with level of education services
Government education 2.40 2.90 0.90 2.36 3.59 2.44
Private education 8.40 0.90 1.99 8.66 8.97 5.83
Cost of government education 4.70 1.40 1.69 5.02 5.10 3.60
Cost of private education 14.60 0.70 4.88 16.54 27.67 13.05
Q 301 Do you approve (accept) the presence of foreign military bases in
Your country 3.10 3.30 2.29 3.25 6.23 3.66
Any Arab country 3.50 6.90 3.58 5.02 8.97 5.63
Q 302 Fair solution to the Palestinian problem 13.4 11.90 15.52 4.73 23.32 13.86
Q 303 Satisfaction with the current level of Arab
cooperation
8.50 5.40 2.59 5.02 13.98 7.17
Q 304 Ambition for a better level of Arab cooperation
United Arab currency 9.00 1.40 3.78 10.73 11.90 7.42
A Arab free trade zone 6.80 1.60 2.59 12.11 10.48 6.77
A Arab free citizenship area 7.80 1.50 3.18 11.92 11.24 7.19
Complete political unity 10.40 1.90 2.59 18.70 15.58 9.92
Q 305 Methods which, if implemented, may result in enhancing the scope of freedom
First method 25.50 1.10 13.73 2.85 1.51 8.84
Second method 51.70 6.70 16.42 5.41 5.48 16.97
Third method 75.30 21.50 25.47 14.27 13.22 29.70
208 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Table A-3 Respondent characteristics, Freedom Survey, 2003 (%)
Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria
Residence
Urban 80.9 67.0 72.0 61.6 70.9
Rural 19.2 33.0 28.0 38.4 29.1
Age
18-34 49.1 67.2 56.3 62 53.3
35+ 50.9 32.8 43.7 38 46.7
Gender
Male 50.1 51.0 49.5 48.7 50.5
Female 49.9 49.0 50.5 51.3 49.5
Educational level
Illiterate/read and write 10.5 2.1 2.9 55.2 -
Primary 10.8 5.9 5.9 16.1 -
Basic education 20.5 17.3 12.2 2.1 -
Secondary 35.1 24.7 35.2 21.2 -
College or university student 15.2 22.2 20.8 1.4 -
Completed first university degree 7.0 20.9 19.9 3.5 -
Higher studies 0.9 6.9 3.2 0.6 -
Table A-4 Extent to which respondents considered the elements of freedom as constituents of their concept of freedom,five Arab
countries, Freedom Survey, 2003 (%)
Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria
Freedom element
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
Individual freedoms
Freedom from hunger 69.53 88.59 11.41 56.18 91.96 8.04 52.00 95.98 4.01 83.12 95.58 4.42 72.80 91.97 8.03
Freedom from disease 62.75 85.33 14.67 52.21 89.43 10.56 45.05 94.44 5.56 78.39 95.07 4.92 71.98 90.92 9.08
Freedom from ignorance 76.15 93.42 6.58 69.11 96.09 3.91 60.16 96.27 3.72 87.41 97.22 2.78 79.94 95.30 4.70
Freedom from inadequate
income
68.30 91.49 8.50 55.72 94.17 5.82 58.50 96.66 3.34 71.90 92.66 7.34 76.60 94.50 5.51
Freedom from poverty 69.69 92.98 7.02 64.35 94.66 5.34 60.30 97.76 2.23 79.74 91.85 8.14 75.10 93.99 6.01
Social freedoms
Freedom of thought 76.63 98.37 1.63 79.26 97.79 2.20 70.49 95.54 4.46 88.99 98.57 1.43 86.77 98.28 1.73
Freedom of belief 82.45 95.67 4.33 73.84 98.08 1.91 66.84 95.54 4.46 88.66 96.01 4.00 77.89 94.04 5.97
Freedom of opinion and
expression
78.67 99.13 0.88 84.95 97.99 2.01 65.90 97.10 2.91 84.62 96.72 3.28 85.91 99.05 0.96
Freedom of association
and organization
61.70 95.17 4.83 63.14 97.38 2.62 46.89 95.65 4.36 66.84 90.08 9.92 68.76 94.12 5.88
Freedom to own property 81.90 97.60 2.40 63.55 92.99 7.01 47.95 95.90 4.11 84.32 95.90 4.11 80.00 97.36 2.65
209 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
Freedom of movement
within the country
86.43 98.06 1.94 68.18 92.96 7.05 64.26 97.87 2.14 92.83 98.44 1.56 86.45 98.57 1.43
Freedom of marriage 83.64 96.80 3.20 61.47 92.15 7.85 49.95 94.01 5.99 85.40 94.80 5.20 81.95 95.85 4.15
Freedom to engage in
economic transactions
72.81 97.18 2.83 53.99 94.05 5.95 51.59 96.10 3.90 71.97 91.41 8.59 73.32 95.28 4.73
Equality before the law 79.61 97.85 2.15 74.67 94.57 5.43 65.76 97.48 2.53 87.28 96.63 3.37 88.39 98.66 1.34
Gender equality 73.51 93.81 6.19 65.56 94.06 5.94 44.34 95.25 4.75 79.73 95.16 4.84 71.80 91.25 8.76
Freedom of organizations and minorities
Independence of the
media
63.32 93.41 6.59 60.10 96.58 3.42 51.03 95.98 4.01 66.85 89.18 10.82 77.26 97.38 2.62
Freedom for trade unions
and professional associa-
tions
58.43 94.00 6.01 57.11 96.44 3.56 41.21 94.45 5.54 68.52 91.45 8.55 71.14 94.72 5.29
Freedom for civil and
cooperative organizations
56.42 93.90 6.10 49.33 96.31 3.68 40.76 94.69 5.31 76.60 91.69 8.31 65.09 92.20 7.79
Freedom for religious
organizations
69.71 96.86 3.14 55.75 95.47 4.54 49.74 95.14 4.86 66.78 86.62 13.38 55.25 91.85 8.15
Freedom for minorities to
use their language
65.35 90.74 9.26 48.18 93.42 6.58 32.30 89.94 10.07 78.96 86.42 13.59 73.06 93.11 6.88
Freedom for minorities to
practise their distinctive
culture
66.73 92.16 7.83 51.61 94.86 5.14 32.00 89.11 10.89 78.11 85.82 14.18 75.96 94.04 5.96
Freedom for minorities
to practise their religious
rites
70.65 93.82 6.18 58.06 94.25 5.75 37.08 90.92 9.08 74.70 83.61 16.40 68.01 90.84 9.15
Autonomy for minorities 51.62 83.65 16.35 36.80 83.30 16.70 35.59 88.37 11.64 51.57 65.28 34.71 59.52 85.81 14.19
Political freedoms
Right to form political
opposition groups
55.21 89.65 10.35 54.88 93.01 6.99 42.86 94.41 5.59 71.05 87.85 12.15 68.83 93.70 6.30
Existence of a significant
opposition able to influ-
ence decision-making
55.39 89.36 10.63 58.91 92.52 7.48 50.89 96.21 3.79 68.01 85.06 14.94 68.07 93.36 6.64
Complete independence
of the judiciary
74.04 95.47 4.54 72.93 97.48 2.53 63.84 96.18 3.82 60.98 80.05 19.94 81.23 97.32 2.68
Combating corruption 76.08 96.09 3.90 74.52 96.47 3.52 72.32 96.43 3.58 79.81 90.06 9.94 82.22 95.56 4.44
Transparency of govern-
ance
72.60 95.89 4.10 66.77 96.06 3.95 66.67 95.97 4.04 80.95 95.52 4.48 82.74 96.45 3.55
Possibility of holding gov-
ernment accountable
73.05 97.34 2.66 72.09 95.85 4.15 64.38 95.84 4.15 69.21 86.94 13.06 85.50 97.02 2.98
Choice of central govern-
ment leaders through free
and fair elections
70.79 93.83 6.17 66.77 96.02 3.99 59.89 94.92 5.08 80.99 95.79 4.21 85.46 98.71 1.29
Choice of local govern-
ment leaders through free
and fair elections
72.01 95.80 4.19 68.44 95.90 4.10 61.00 95.51 4.48 80.15 94.49 5.50 83.23 98.69 1.31
Choice of legislative rep-
resentatives with effective
power through free and
fair elections
75.43 96.72 3.28 69.80 95.93 4.08 61.78 94.97 5.03 81.60 95.56 4.44 82.45 97.36 2.64
Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria
Freedom element
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
210 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Homeland freedoms
Freedom from occupation 80.57 95.65 4.35 76.50 97.50 2.50 82.82 98.61 1.40 87.51 97.70 2.30 84.55 97.79 2.21
Freedom from military
bases
74.82 91.78 8.23 69.49 96.18 3.83 71.28 98.24 1.76 86.90 96.42 3.58 80.36 92.39 7.62
Freedom from foreign
influence
80.25 94.76 5.24 80.74 97.49 2.51 66.12 96.71 3.29 77.70 90.80 9.20 72.01 91.78 8.22
Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria
Freedom element
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
Table A-5 Extent of enjoyment of the elements of freedom, five Arab countries/territory, Freedom Survey, 2003 (%)
Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria
Freedom element
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
Individual freedoms
Freedom from hunger 28.25 86.99 13.01 8.82 80.42 19.57 8.55 80.85 19.14 50.67 90.46 9.54 40.71 90.95 9.05
Freedom from disease 33.15 90.00 10.00 10.07 81.08 18.92 9.51 83.33 16.67 31.95 86.55 13.44 36.25 89.60 10.40
Freedom from igno-
rance
43.77 93.80 6.20 19.55 85.20 14.79 16.13 82.86 17.14 35.45 90.80 9.19 45.62 94.78 5.22
Freedom from inad-
equate income
24.48 83.65 16.35 7.78 76.37 23.64 9.20 78.56 21.44 16.27 77.72 22.28 39.34 93.68 6.33
Freedom from pov-
erty (deprivation
from basic human
capabilities: health,
education, and social
and political participa-
tion)
25.54 84.84 15.16 9.50 75.93 24.06 10.75 79.33 20.68 21.73 77.24 22.76 37.23 92.55 7.45
Social freedoms
Freedom of thought 44.11 95.11 4.89 29.02 84.14 15.86 12.32 71.89 28.11 61.87 89.48 10.52 44.11 89.09 10.91
Freedom of belief 69.25 96.16 3.85 35.79 87.00 13.00 26.22 79.88 20.12 60.22 88.95 11.05 43.52 86.33 13.67
Freedom of opinion
and expression
39.34 93.89 6.11 21.91 76.69 23.32 8.04 72.23 27.77 39.60 74.98 25.03 25.15 84.05 15.96
Freedom of associa-
tion and organization
35.91 88.68 11.31 19.92 83.44 16.57 7.30 75.29 24.71 44.05 86.59 13.41 23.46 85.50 14.49
Freedom to own
property
72.96 96.41 3.59 43.13 93.84 6.16 24.87 87.10 12.90 71.63 95.40 4.60 45.13 93.37 6.63
Freedom of movement
within the country
81.61 98.44 1.56 43.52 95.28 4.72 11.31 69.80 30.20 82.67 98.53 1.46 52.21 95.00 5.00
Freedom of marriage 78.45 97.94 2.07 44.77 95.57 4.43 31.28 90.29 9.72 72.79 95.43 4.57 54.78 93.96 6.04
Freedom to engage in
economic transactions
59.13 97.23 2.76 33.47 91.89 8.11 12.70 80.53 19.47 59.97 95.41 4.59 36.62 92.40 7.60
Equality before the
law
47.41 90.23 9.77 13.19 78.75 21.25 6.37 78.62 21.38 27.52 69.36 30.65 13.37 72.56 27.43
Gender equality 53.60 92.80 7.20 23.72 93.27 6.73 13.08 87.23 12.77 46.31 90.22 9.78 33.27 86.30 13.70
211 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
Freedom of organizations and minorities
Independence of the
media
33.76 88.88 11.12 11.56 74.97 25.03 6.18 73.01 26.98 21.08 70.11 29.90 16.65 78.85 21.14
Freedom for trade
unions and profes-
sional associations
39.70 92.01 7.98 25.51 89.23 10.77 11.09 79.96 20.04 41.09 90.28 9.72 24.61 86.30 13.71
Freedom for civil and
cooperative organiza-
tions
45.00 94.29 5.71 29.74 90.56 9.44 12.87 82.24 17.77 61.03 94.59 5.42 34.12 89.85 10.15
Freedom for religious
organizations
53.15 92.33 7.67 40.24 92.51 7.48 14.49 80.13 19.88 40.37 78.28 21.72 26.06 82.23 17.77
Freedom for minorities
to use their language
73.52 95.96 4.04 58.06 95.87 4.13 23.33 84.94 15.06 87.21 98.88 1.13 50.58 92.81 7.18
Freedom for minori-
ties to practise their
distinctive culture
71.83 97.06 2.93 59.65 96.81 3.20 22.36 84.74 15.25 84.71 98.76 1.24 60.95 94.77 5.23
Freedom for minori-
ties to practise their
religious rites
74.56 97.98 2.02 59.28 96.31 3.69 27.17 85.63 14.37 77.51 96.58 3.42 45.64 91.18 8.82
Autonomy for minori-
ties
37.16 78.46 21.53 14.24 67.80 32.20 10.49 74.25 25.76 12.04 39.94 60.06 17.13 78.36 21.64
Political freedoms
Right to form political
opposition groups
25.03 82.80 17.20 17.51 75.89 24.11 7.20 75.24 24.76 29.97 74.92 25.09 25.85 88.67 11.33
Existence of a signifi-
cant opposition able
to influence decision-
making
24.58 79.35 20.65 13.69 70.95 29.05 7.86 71.62 28.37 16.60 62.30 37.69 15.48 84.09 15.92
Complete independ-
ence of the judiciary
53.21 93.05 6.95 12.73 74.03 25.97 8.08 72.23 27.77 22.41 65.55 34.45 12.14 83.85 16.15
Combating corruption 40.12 89.99 10.01 9.63 67.58 32.42 8.27 68.07 31.94 13.22 60.87 39.13 12.95 82.33 17.67
Transparency of gov-
ernance
43.35 90.57 9.43 9.03 70.77 29.23 5.95 68.58 31.42 28.28 70.95 29.05 13.62 82.65 17.36
Possibility of holding
government account-
able
33.64 86.60 13.40 8.60 67.50 32.49 5.30 63.56 36.44 12.44 50.08 49.92 14.63 85.69 14.32
Choice of central
government leaders
through free and fair
elections
40.29 79.65 20.35 11.25 72.18 27.81 7.53 74.16 25.83 26.29 72.58 27.42 16.30 84.01 15.99
Choice of local
government leaders
through free and fair
elections
43.24 87.23 12.76 15.19 75.44 24.56 8.92 73.89 26.11 25.20 72.90 27.11 14.77 84.50 15.51
Choice of legisla-
tive representatives
with effective power
through free and fair
elections
50.84 91.77 8.23 11.81 72.12 27.88 9.06 73.87 26.13 22.47 73.30 26.70 16.15 84.07 15.94
Homeland freedoms
Freedom from occu-
pation
56.24 92.37 7.62 15.70 78.11 21.88 10.52 50.16 49.85 72.65 94.15 5.85 57.87 95.78 4.22
Freedom from military
bases
50.16 89.33 10.67 15.49 76.96 23.04 12.59 54.14 45.86 58.25 82.27 17.72 64.80 90.23 9.77
Freedom from foreign
influence
48.86 86.70 13.30 13.86 71.56 28.44 11.75 59.94 40.06 32.70 69.33 30.67 46.62 90.26 9.73
Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria
Freedom element
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
To a
large
extent
To
some
extent
Not
at all
212 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Table A-6 Perceived change in the enjoyment of the elements of freedom during the five years preceding the survey, five Arab
countries Freedom Survey, 2003 (net %)
Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria
Freedom
element
Improve-
ment
Deteriora-
tion
Net
change
Improve-
ment
Deteriora-
tion
Net
change
Improve-
ment
Deteriora-
tion
Net
change
Improve-
ment
Deteriora-
tion
Net
change
Improve-
ment
Deteriora-
tion
Net
change
Individual freedoms
Freedom from
hunger
17.79 34.68 -16.89 10.36 46.85 -36.49 7.39 59.54 -52.15 34.37 20.70 13.67 20.69 37.76 -17.07
Freedom from
disease
25.24 24.77 0.47 15.81 33.45 -17.64 3.10 46.01 -42.91 44.27 18.02 26.25 27.94 34.29 -6.35
Freedom from
ignorance
30.01 18.19 11.82 21.29 31.23 -9.94 23.00 40.68 -17.68 51.33 17.94 33.39 35.46 27.95 7.51
Freedom from
inadequate
income
12.59 41.98 -29.39 6.87 52.93 -46.06 6.69 60.87 -54.18 24.89 23.55 1.34 15.22 49.26 -34.04
Freedom from
poverty
12.11 37.79 -25.68 6.59 48.07 -41.48 11.78 54.92 -43.14 34.73 25.07 9.66 12.52 48.51 -35.99
Social freedoms
Freedom of
thought
25.37 14.89 10.48 13.51 30.40 -16.89 19.41 40.59 -21.18 34.90 20.22 14.68 36.17 22.97 13.20
Freedom of belief 21.06 14.63 6.43 7.69 34.21 -26.52 17.32 37.43 -20.11 28.82 21.61 7.21 21.98 21.61 0.37
Freedom of
opinion and
expression
23.81 15.62 8.19 7.75 48.93 -41.18 16.91 40.44 -23.53 31.60 20.29 11.31 30.08 29.82 0.26
Freedom of
association and
organization
20.55 19.81 0.74 7.22 36.88 -29.66 13.40 43.92 -30.52 17.56 29.01 -11.45 23.29 39.43 -16.14
Freedom to own
property
24.75 17.31 7.44 12.18 21.77 -9.59 11.80 32.44 -20.64 14.39 31.06 -16.67 32.89 13.23 19.66
Freedom of move-
ment within the
country
21.51 17.60 3.91 46.53 12.77 33.76 6.49 70.80 -64.31 13.33 19.39 -6.06 25.96 28.60 -2.64
Freedom of mar-
riage
23.75 17.11 6.64 19.32 12.76 6.56 13.73 26.12 -12.39 34.43 29.30 5.13 28.73 17.71 11.02
Freedom to
engage in
economic transac-
tions
23.19 17.00 6.19 11.62 29.36 -17.74 8.80 53.98 -45.18 17.97 22.22 -4.25 33.94 17.15 16.79
Equality before
the law
16.06 26.18 -10.12 7.72 43.06 -35.34 7.03 53.01 -45.98 21.48 19.91 1.57 13.92 34.74 -20.82
Gender equality 28.69 18.46 10.23 22.57 12.84 9.73 13.18 25.30 -12.12 43.68 14.94 28.74 34.22 15.93 18.29
Freedom of organizations and minorities
Independence of
the media
23.10 18.13 4.97 6.92 45.25 -38.33 11.95 46.46 -34.51 19.24 18.86 0.38 24.07 33.93 -9.86
Freedom for
trade unions and
professional asso-
ciations
21.96 18.43 3.53 9.79 32.20 -22.41 16.04 34.14 -18.10 19.02 21.08 -2.06 24.61 29.94 -5.33
Freedom for civil
and cooperative
organizations
21.08 14.24 6.84 11.14 24.40 -13.26 18.25 30.70 -12.45 24.57 17.99 6.58 31.71 20.82 10.89
Freedom for
religious organiza-
tions
19.29 21.73 -2.44 13.73 21.48 -7.75 13.79 43.23 -29.44 19.08 47.59 -28.51 19.48 31.96 -12.48
213 ANNEX I. MEASUREMENT OF FREEDOM IN ARAB COUNTRIES
Freedom for
minorities to use
their language
16.29 12.54 3.75 11.20 9.92 1.28 10.71 26.40 -15.69 31.50 14.17 17.33 58.01 14.00 44.01
Freedom for
minorities to prac-
tise their distinc-
tive culture
19.71 11.36 8.35 13.39 18.11 -4.72 11.64 26.80 -15.16 19.73 19.05 0.68 42.86 10.91 31.95
Freedom for
minorities to prac-
tise their religious
rites
21.11 8.02 13.09 13.51 18.44 -4.93 11.53 29.38 -17.85 19.81 22.64 -2.83 26.92 18.83 8.09
Autonomy for
minorities
14.31 14.06 0.25 5.34 24.43 -19.09 8.19 43.47 -35.28 11.17 16.48 -5.31 18.70 23.93 -5.23
Political freedoms
Right to form
political opposi-
tion groups
11.24 24.37 -13.13 8.89 46.15 -37.26 9.73 51.70 -41.97 16.98 22.02 -5.04 21.71 31.47 -9.76
Existence of a sig-
nificant opposition
able to influence
decision-making
12.70 24.79 -12.09 5.15 48.62 -43.47 8.67 55.74 -47.07 12.62 22.38 -9.76 17.25 28.61 -11.36
Complete inde-
pendence of the
judiciary
17.90 13.31 4.59 5.01 50.60 -45.59 7.07 56.66 -49.59 13.88 19.59 -5.71 14.30 32.68 -18.38
Combating cor-
ruption
16.66 30.56 -13.90 4.96 53.40 -48.44 8.36 65.29 -56.93 22.14 32.56 -10.42 11.49 47.99 -36.50
Transparency of
governance
21.64 16.85 4.79 2.66 53.18 -50.52 6.40 64.80 -58.40 17.57 19.93 -2.36 15.29 33.12 -17.83
Possibility of hold-
ing government
accountable
19.59 22.84 -3.25 3.25 51.68 -48.43 6.13 62.43 -56.30 6.15 22.88 -16.73 19.18 30.24 -11.06
Choice of central
government lead-
ers through free
and fair elections
13.96 17.97 -4.01 3.74 43.18 -39.44 6.61 52.07 -45.46 25.73 27.43 -1.70 15.45 31.81 -16.36
Choice of local
government lead-
ers through free
and fair elections
15.48 24.69 -9.21 6.71 42.78 -36.07 6.56 54.35 -47.79 24.54 28.20 -3.66 14.60 33.07 -18.47
Choice of
legislative repre-
sentatives with
effective power
through free and
fair elections
14.84 23.58 -8.74 4.73 46.91 -42.18 6.66 54.46 -47.80 25.04 26.49 -1.45 13.31 32.66 -19.35
Homeland freedoms
Freedom from
occupation
19.64 29.04 -9.40 42.47 16.89 25.58 7.17 72.87 -65.70 19.53 23.83 -4.30 36.07 22.25 13.82
Freedom from
military bases
16.41 32.78 -16.37 39.87 17.38 22.49 4.25 66.46 -62.21 14.15 21.54 -7.39 20.74 20.74 0.00
Freedom from for-
eign influence
14.99 37.65 -22.66 24.88 28.74 -3.86 3.94 57.07 -53.13 20.83 29.62 -8.79 24.74 29.81 -5.07
Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria
Freedom
element
Improve-
ment
Deteriora-
tion
Net
change
Improve-
ment
Deteriora-
tion
Net
change
Improve-
ment
Deteriora-
tion
Net
change
Improve-
ment
Deteriora-
tion
Net
change
Improve-
ment
Deteriora-
tion
Net
change
214 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Table A-7 Most important means of expanding freedom, five Arab countries/territory, Freedom Survey, 2003 (%)
Means of expanding freedom Jordan Lebanon Palestine Morocco Algeria Total
Combating ignorance 5.05 1.62 4.40 5.29 0.00 3.02
Ending unemployment 8.26 1.29 0.00 11.99 19.61 8.58
Eradicating poverty 14.52 0.96 4.40 13.73 11.61 8.62
Freedom of opinion and expression/media 24.06 14.80 9.58 4.22 4.02 9.81
Equality among citizens/ gender equality 5.84 4.91 0.90 7.02 20.76 8.43
Combating corruption 12.60 5.50 9.61 10.96 0.00 7.08
Good governance 3.56 15.02 5.80 5.43 16.71 10.06
Freedom of homeland 0.71 8.15 17.05 0.00 0.00 5.37
Other 25.41 47.75 48.27 41.36 27.30 39.03
Total 100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00
Table A-8 Governance and corruption indicators, Arab countries and world regions (weighted by population), 2002
Country/Territory/Region
Representation
and
accountability
Political stability
and absence
of violence
Government
effectiveness Rule of law
Control of
corruption
Algeria -0.96 -1.54 -0.59 -0.54 -0.70
Bahrain -0.74 0.31 0.78 0.92 0.95
Comoros -0.51 -0.19 -0.84 -0.84 -0.73
Djibouti -0.69 -0.69 -0.88 -0.51 -0.73
Egypt -0.87 -0.35 -0.32 0.09 -0.29
Iraq -2.12 -1.75 -1.64 -1.70 -1.43
Jordan -0.41 -0.44 0.36 0.33 0.00
Kuwait -0.29 0.14 0.16 0.81 1.06
Lebanon -0.54 -0.59 -0.41 -0.27 -0.34
Libya -1.70 -0.43 -0.87 -0.91 -0.82
Mauritania -0.67 0.43 -0.16 -0.33 0.23
Morocco -0.30 -0.14 0.07 0.11 -0.04
Oman -0.55 0.98 0.69 0.83 1.03
Qatar -0.52 0.82 0.69 0.84 0.92
Saudi Arabia -1.40 0.05 -0.05 0.44 0.57
Somalia -1.51 -1.95 -1.97 -2.05 -1.19
Sudan -1.71 -1.94 -1.11 -1.36 -1.09
Syria -1.56 -0.14 -0.57 -0.41 -0.29
Tunisia -0.83 0.24 0.65 0.27 0.35
United Arab Emirates -0.47 0.95 0.83 0.95 1.19
West Bank -1.08 -1.69 -1.04 -0.31 -0.99
Yemen -0.88 -1.36 -0.87 -1.23 -0.69
Arab countries -1.10 -0.78 -0.53 -0.44 -0.42
Africa (exc. Arab countries) -0.70 -0.98 -0.78 -0.86 -0.81
Asia (exc. Arab countries) -0.56 -0.33 -0.07 -0.20 -0.42
Europe 0.99 0.77 1.05 0.95 0.97
North America 1.34 0.41 1.72 1.71 1.80
Latin America & the Caribbean 0.11 -0.19 -0.25 -0.40 -0.26
Oceania 1.16 0.84 1.27 1.27 1.35
World -0.28 -0.26 0.03 -0.08 -0.19
ANNEX II. SELECTED DOCUMENTS 215
1
Adopted and proclaimed by General Assembly resolution 217A (III) of 10 December 1948.
ANNEX II. SELECTED DOCUMENTS
I. Universal Declaration of Human Rights
1
II. United Nations Commission on Human Rights Resolution on
the Question of the violation of human rights in the occupied
Arab territories, including Palestine (E/CN.4/2004/L.6)
III. Draft revised Arab Charter on Human Rights (excerpts)
IV. United Nations Convention against Corruption (excerpts)
V. Charter for Reform of the Arab Situation (Saudi Arabia)
VI. Project for Developing the Joint Arab Action Mechanism
(Yemen)
VII. Initiative for Developing the League of Arab States (LAS) and
Activation of the Joint Arab Action Mechanism (Egypt)
VIII. Sana’a Declaration on Democracy, Human Rights and the Role
of the International Criminal Court
IX. Alexandria Charter
X. Arab Regional Conference on Education for All: Arab Vision
for the Future (excerpts)
XI. Tunis Declaration (excerpts)
216 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
I. UNIVERSAL DECLARATION OF
HUMAN RIGHTS
2
PREAMBLE
Whereas recognition of the inherent dignity
and of the equal and inalienable rights of all
members of the human family is the foundation
of freedom, justice and peace in the world,
Whereas disregard and contempt for
human rights have resulted in barbarous acts
which have outraged the conscience of man-
kind, and the advent of a world in which
human beings shall enjoy freedom of speech
and belief and freedom from fear and want has
been proclaimed as the highest aspiration of
the common people,
Whereas it is essential, if man is not to be
compelled to have recourse, as a last resort, to
rebellion against tyranny and oppression, that
human rights should be protected by the rule
of law,
Whereas it is essential to promote the de-
velopment of friendly relations between na-
tions,
Whereas the peoples of the United Nations
have in the Charter reaffirmed their faith in
fundamental human rights, in the dignity and
worth of the human person and in the equal
rights of men and women and have determined
to promote social progress and better stand-
ards of life in larger freedom,
Whereas Member States have pledged
themselves to achieve, in cooperation with the
United Nations, the promotion of universal re-
spect for and observance of human rights and
fundamental freedoms,
Whereas a common understanding of these
rights and freedoms is of the greatest impor-
tance for the full realization of this pledge,
Now, therefore,
The General Assembly
Proclaims this Universal Declaration of Human
Rights as a common standard of achievement
for all peoples and all nations, to the end that
every individual and every organ of society,
keeping this Declaration constantly in mind,
shall strive by teaching and education to pro-
mote respect for these rights and freedoms and
by progressive measures, national and inter-
national, to secure their universal and effec-
tive recognition and observance, both among
the peoples of Member States themselves and
among the peoples of territories under their
jurisdiction.
Article 1
All human beings are born free and equal in
dignity and rights. They are endowed with
reason and conscience and should act towards
one another in a spirit of brotherhood.
Article 2
Everyone is entitled to all the rights and
freedoms set forth in this Declaration, without
distinction of any kind, such as race, colour,
sex, language, religion, political or other opin-
ion, national or social origin, property, birth or
other status.
Furthermore, no distinction shall be made
on the basis of the political, jurisdictional or
international status of the country or territory
to which a person belongs, whether it be in-
dependent, trust, non-self-governing or under
any other limitation of sovereignty.
Article 3
Everyone has the right to life, liberty and secu-
rity of person.
Article 4
No one shall be held in slavery or servitude;
slavery and the slave trade shall be prohibited
in all their forms.
Article 5
No one shall be subjected to torture or to
cruel, inhuman or degrading treatment or pun-
ishment.
Article 6
Everyone has the right to recognition every-
where as a person before the law.
Article 7
All are equal before the law and are entitled
without any discrimination to equal protection
of the law. All are entitled to equal protection
against any discrimination in violation of this
Declaration and against any incitement to such
discrimination.
Article 8
Everyone has the right to an effective remedy
2
Adopted and proclaimed by General Assembly resolution 217A (III) of 10 December 1948.
217 ANNEX II. SELECTED DOCUMENTS
by the competent national tribunals for acts
violating the fundamental rights granted him
by the constitution or by law.
Article 9
No one shall be subjected to arbitrary arrest,
detention or exile.
Article 10
Everyone is entitled in full equality to a fair and
public hearing by an independent and impar-
tial tribunal, in the determination of his rights
and obligations and of any criminal charge
against him.
Article 11
1. Everyone charged with a penal offence has
the right to be presumed innocent until proved
guilty according to law in a public trial at which
he has had all the guarantees necessary for his
defence.
2. No one shall be held guilty of any penal of-
fence on account of any act or omission which
did not constitute a penal offence, under na-
tional or international law, at the time when it
was committed. Nor shall a heavier penalty be
imposed than the one that was applicable at
the time the penal offence was committed.
Article 12
No one shall be subjected to arbitrary inter-
ference with his privacy, family, home or cor-
respondence, nor to attacks upon his honour
and reputation. Everyone has the right to the
protection of the law against such interference
or attacks.
Article 13
1. Everyone has the right to freedom of move-
ment and residence within the borders of each
State.
2. Everyone has the right to leave any coun-
try, including his own, and to return to his
country.
Article 14
1. Everyone has the right to seek and to enjoy
in other countries asylum from persecution.
2. This right may not be invoked in the case
of prosecutions genuinely arising from non-po-
litical crimes or from acts contrary to the pur-
poses and principles of the United Nations.
Article 15
1. Everyone has the right to a nationality.
2. No one shall be arbitrarily deprived of his
nationality nor denied the right to change his
nationality.
Article 16
1. Men and women of full age, without any
limitation due to race, nationality or religion,
have the right to marry and to found a family.
They are entitled to equal rights as to marriage,
during marriage and at its dissolution.
2. Marriage shall be entered into only with the
free and full consent of the intending spouses.
3. The family is the natural and fundamental
group unit of society and is entitled to protec-
tion by society and the State.
Article 17
1. Everyone has the right to own property
alone as well as in association with others.
2. No one shall be arbitrarily deprived of his
property.
Article 18
Everyone has the right to freedom of thought,
conscience and religion; this right includes
freedom to change his religion or belief, and
freedom, either alone or in community with
others and in public or private, to manifest his
religion or belief in teaching, practice, worship
and observance.
Article 19
Everyone has the right to freedom of opinion
and expression; this right includes freedom
to hold opinions without interference and to
seek, receive and impart information and ideas
through any media and regardless of frontiers.
Article 20
1. Everyone has the right to freedom of peace-
ful assembly and association.
2. No one may be compelled to belong to an
association.
Article 21
1. Everyone has the right to take part in the
government of his country, directly or through
freely chosen representatives.
2. Everyone has the right to equal access to
public service in his country.
3. The will of the people shall be the basis of
218 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
the authority of government; this will shall be
expressed in periodic and genuine elections
which shall be by universal and equal suffrage
and shall be held by secret vote or by equiva-
lent free voting procedures.
Article 22
Everyone, as a member of society, has the right
to social security and is entitled to realiza-
tion, through national effort and international
co-operation and in accordance with the or-
ganization and resources of each State, of the
economic, social and cultural rights indispen-
sable for his dignity and the free development
of his personality.
Article 23
1. Everyone has the right to work, to free
choice of employment, to just and favourable
conditions of work and to protection against
unemployment.
2. Everyone, without any discrimination, has
the right to equal pay for equal work.
3. Everyone who works has the right to just
and favourable remuneration ensuring for
himself and his family an existence worthy of
human dignity, and supplemented, if neces-
sary, by other means of social protection.
4. Everyone has the right to form and to join
trade unions for the protection of his interests.
Article 24
Everyone has the right to rest and leisure, in-
cluding reasonable limitation of working hours
and periodic holidays with pay.
Article 25
1. Everyone has the right to a standard of
living adequate for the health and well-being
of himself and of his family, including food,
clothing, housing and medical care and neces-
sary social services, and the right to security in
the event of unemployment, sickness, disabil-
ity, widowhood, old age or other lack of liveli-
hood in circumstances beyond his control.
2. Motherhood and childhood are entitled
to special care and assistance. All children,
whether born in or out of wedlock, shall enjoy
the same social protection.
Article 26
1. Everyone has the right to education. Edu-
cation shall be free, at least in the elementary
and fundamental stages. Elementary educa-
tion shall be compulsory. Technical and pro-
fessional education shall be made generally
available and higher education shall be equally
accessible to all on the basis of merit.
2. Education shall be directed to the full de-
velopment of the human personality and to the
strengthening of respect for human rights and
fundamental freedoms. It shall promote un-
derstanding, tolerance and friendship among
all nations, racial or religious groups, and shall
further the activities of the United Nations for
the maintenance of peace.
3. Parents have a prior right to choose the
kind of education that shall be given to their
children.
Article 27
1. Everyone has the right freely to participate
in the cultural life of the community, to enjoy
the arts and to share in scientific advancement
and its benefits.
2. Everyone has the right to the protection of
the moral and material interests resulting from
any scientific, literary or artistic production of
which he is the author.
Article 28
Everyone is entitled to a social and international
order in which the rights and freedoms set forth
in this Declaration can be fully realized.
Article 29
1. Everyone has duties to the community in
which alone the free and full development of
his personality is possible.
2. In the exercise of his rights and freedoms,
everyone shall be subject only to such limita-
tions as are determined by law solely for the
purpose of securing due recognition and re-
spect for the rights and freedoms of others and
of meeting the just requirements of morality,
public order and the general welfare in a dem-
ocratic society.
3. These rights and freedoms may in no case
be exercised contrary to the purposes and
principles of the United Nations.
Article 30
Nothing in this Declaration may be interpreted
as implying for any State, group or person any
right to engage in any activity or to perform
any act aimed at the destruction of any of the
rights and freedoms set forth herein.
219 ANNEX II. SELECTED DOCUMENTS
II. UN COMMISSION ON HUMAN
RIGHTS RESOLUTION ON THE
QUESTION OF THE VIOLATION
OF HUMAN RIGHTS IN THE
OCCUPIED ARAB TERRITORIES,
INCLUDING PALESTINE (E/CN.4/
2004/L.6)
COMMISSION ON HUMAN RIGHTS
SIXTIETH SESSION
AGENDA ITEM 8
The Commission on Human Rights,
Guided by the purposes and principles of the
Charter of the United Nations and by the pro-
visions of the Universal Declaration of Human
Rights,
Recalling Security Council resolutions 242
(1967) of 22 November 1967, 338 (1973) of 22
October 1973, 1397 (2002) of 12 March 2002,
1402 (2002) of 30 March 2002 and 1403 (2002)
of 4 April 2002 that called upon both parties to
move immediately to a meaningful ceasefire,
for withdrawal of Israeli troops and for an im-
mediate cessation of all acts of violence, includ-
ing all acts of terror, provocation, incitement
and destruction,
Guided by the provisions of the
International Covenant on Economic, Social
and Cultural Rights and the International
Covenant on Civil and Political Rights,
Taking into consideration the provisions
of the Geneva Convention relative to the
Protection of Civilian Persons in Time of War,
of 12 August 1949, the provisions of Additional
Protocol I thereto of 1977 and the Hague
Convention of 18 October 1907, and Annexed
Regulations concerning the Laws and Customs
of War on Land,
Recalling resolutions of the Security
Council, the General Assembly and the
Commission on Human Rights relating to the
applicability of the Fourth Geneva Convention
to the Occupied Palestinian Territory, includ-
ing East Jerusalem, since the 5 June 1967 war,
Reaffirming the applicability of the Fourth
Geneva Convention to the Palestinian territo-
ries occupied since the June 1967 war, includ-
ing East Jerusalem,
Recalling General Assembly resolutions
on Israeli violations of human rights in the
Palestinian territories occupied since 1967, in-
cluding East Jerusalem,
Recalling in particular General Assembly
resolution 37/43 of 3 December 1982 reaffirm-
ing the legitimacy of the struggle of peoples for
independence from foreign domination and
foreign occupation and for self-determination,
by all available means,
Recalling the Vienna Declaration and
Programme of Action, adopted in June 1993
by the World Conference on Human Rights
(A/CONF.157/23),
Welcoming the report of the Special
Rapporteur on the situation of human rights in
the Palestinian territories occupied since 1967,
Mr. John Dugard (E/CN.4/2004/6 and Add.1),
and the report of the Special Rapporteur on
the right to food, Mr. Jean Ziegler (E/CN.4/
2004/10/Add.2),
Expressing its deep concern at the failure
of the Government of Israel to cooperate with
the Human Rights Inquiry Commission es-
tablished pursuant to Commission resolution
S-5/1 of 19 October 2000 and its failure to
cooperate with other relevant special rappor-
teurs, particularly Mr. John Dugard,
Gravely concerned at the continued de-
terioration of the situation in the Occupied
Palestinian Territory and at the gross violations
of human rights and international humanitar-
ian law, in particular, acts of extrajudicial
killing, closures, collective punishments, the
persistence in establishing settlements, arbi-
trary detentions, siege of Palestinian towns and
villages, the shelling of Palestinian residen-
tial neighbourhoods by warplanes, tanks and
Israeli battleships, and incursions into towns,
villages and camps to kill innocent men, women
and children, as was the case in Jenin, Balata,
Khan Younis, Rafah, Ramallah, Gaza, Nablus,
Al-Birah, Al-Amari, Jabalia, Bethlehem and
Dheisheh and in the Al-Daraj and Al-Zaitoun
neighbourhoods in the city of Gaza, and also
during recent months in the Rafah and in
Al-Shajai’ia neighbourhood in Gaza, as well
as during the last Israeli massacres in the Al-
Nusseirat and Al-Burreij refugee camps in the
centre of the Gaza Strip on 7 March 2004,
Expressing its grave concern at the con-
tinued Israeli aggression and the resulting
deaths and injuries, mostly among Palestinians,
the toll of casualties having increased to
over 2,800 martyrs and over 25,000 wounded
220 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
since 28 September 2000,
Taking note of the reports of the Special
Committee to Investigate Israeli Practices
Affecting the Human Rights of the Palestinian
People and Other Arabs of the Occupied
Territories submitted to the General Assembly
since 1968, the last of which was A/58/311,
Expressing its grave concern at the contin-
ued Israeli refusal to abide by the resolutions
of the Security Council, the General Assembly
and the Commission on Human Rights call-
ing upon Israel to put an end to the violations
of human rights and affirming the applicabil-
ity of the Fourth Geneva Convention to the
Palestinian territories occupied by Israel since
1967, including East Jerusalem,
Convinced that the basis of negotiations
and of achieving a just and lasting peace should
be Security Council resolutions 242 (1967),
338 (1973) and other relevant United Nations
resolutions, including the principle of the in-
admissibility of acquisition of territory by war,
the need for every State in the area to be able
to live in security and the principle of land for
peace,
Recalling all its previous resolutions in this re-
spect, the latest of which is resolution 2003/6
of 15 April 2003,
Recalling also the inadmissibility of the ac-
quisition of others’ land by force, which consti-
tutes a jus cogens in international law,
Gravely concerned at the construction of
the Israeli wall inside the Occupied Palestinian
Territory, aimed at expropriating further
Palestinian lands by force, with all the drastic
consequences that this wall will have on the
Palestinian community, namely on its social,
economic, educational, health and psychologi-
cal aspects, and which is destroying any pos-
sibility of achieving a genuine peace based on
the two-State solution, with an independent
Palestinian State and an Israeli State,
Affirming that the construction of this wall
on the Palestinian territories constitutes a vio-
lation of the right of the Palestinian people to
self-determination and hinders the exercise by
the Palestinian people of this right,
Recalling in this respect General Assembly
resolution ES-10/13 of 21 October 2003,
Recalling also the report of the Secretary-
General (A/ES-10/248), which concluded that
Israel is not in compliance with the Assembly’s
demand that “it stop and reverse the construc-
tion of the wall in the Occupied Palestinian
Territory”,
1. Reaffirms the legitimate right of the Pales-
tinian people to resist the Israeli occupation in
order to free its land and be able to exercise its
right to self-determination, in conformity with
the goals and purposes stipulated by the Char-
ter of the United Nations;
2. Strongly condemns once more the human
rights violations of the Israeli occupation au-
thorities in the Occupied Palestinian Territory,
including East Jerusalem, since 1967;
3. Also strongly condemns the Israeli occupa-
tion of the Palestinian territories as being an
aggression and an offence against humanity
and a flagrant violation of human rights;
4. Further strongly condemns the war
launched by the Israeli army, particularly since
October 2000, against Palestinian towns and
camps, which has resulted so far in the death
of hundreds of Palestinian civilians, including
women and children;
5. Strongly condemns anew the practice of
“liquidation” or “extrajudicial executions”
carried out by the Israeli army against Pales-
tinians, a practice which not only constitutes
a violation of human rights norms, a flagrant
violation of article 3 of the Universal Declara-
tion of Human Rights and of the rule of law,
but which is also damaging for the relationship
between the parties and therefore constitutes
an obstacle to peace, and urges the Govern-
ment of Israel to respect international law and
immediately to put an end to such practices;
6. Strongly condemns once again the es-
tablishment of Israeli settlements and other
related activities in the Occupied Palestinian
Territory, including East Jerusalem, such as the
construction of new settlements and the expan-
sion of the existing ones, land confiscation, bi-
ased administration of water resources and the
construction of bypass roads, which not only
constitute grave violations of human rights and
international humanitarian law, especially ar-
ticle 49 of the Geneva Convention relative to
the Protection of Civilian Persons in Time of
War, of 12 August 1949 (the Fourth Geneva
Convention) and Additional Protocol I thereto
of 1977, according to which such violations are
categorized as war crimes, but are also major
obstacles to peace, urges the Government of
Israel to implement the relevant United Na-
tions resolutions as well as the resolutions of
221 ANNEX II. SELECTED DOCUMENTS
the Commission on Human Rights relative to
the Israeli settlements, and affirms that the
dismantling of Israeli settlements constitutes
an essential factor for achieving a just, compre-
hensive and lasting peace in the region;
7. Condemns once again the expropriation of
Palestinian homes in Jerusalem, Hebron and
the rest of the Occupied Palestinian Territory,
the revocation of the identity cards of the resi-
dents of East Jerusalem and the policy of im-
posing fabricated and exorbitant taxes with the
aim of forcing Palestinians living in Jerusalem,
who cannot afford to pay these high taxes, out
of their homes and out of their city, with the
aim of Judaizing Jerusalem, and calls upon the
Government of Israel to put an end immedi-
ately to these practices;
8. Also condemns once again the use of tor-
ture against Palestinians during interrogation,
as it constitutes a grave violation of the princi-
ples of international humanitarian law, of the
Convention against Torture and Other Cruel,
Inhuman or Degrading Treatment or Punish-
ment and also of article 5 of the Universal Dec-
laration of Human Rights, and calls upon the
Government of Israel to immediately put an
end to such practices and to bring the perpe-
trators of these violations to justice;
9. Strongly condemns once more the offen-
sives of the Israeli army of occupation against
hospitals and sick persons and the use of Pales-
tinian citizens as human shields during Israeli
incursions into Palestinian areas;
10. Also strongly condemns once more the Is-
raeli army of occupation’s practices of opening
fire on ambulances and paramedical personnel
and preventing ambulances and vehicles of the
International Committee of the Red Cross from
reaching the wounded and the dead in order
to transport them to hospital, thus leaving the
wounded bleeding to death in the streets;
11. Strongly condemns acts of mass killing of
Palestinians at the hands of the Israeli occupa-
tion authorities, including the killing of chil-
dren, such as recently took place in Nablus,
Gaza, Rafah, Al-Nusseirat and Al-Burreij and
which persist to this day;
12. Also strongly condemns acts that consist of
imposing collective punishments, military siege
of Palestinian territories, isolating Palestinian
towns and villages from each other by military
roadblocks used as a trap to kill Palestinians,
demolishing houses and levelling agricultural
lands, as these practices contribute, together
with other factors, to the acts of violence that
have prevailed in the region for over three and
a half years, and calls upon the Government of
Israel immediately to put an end to these prac-
tices and to lift its military siege of Palestinian
towns and villages and its military roadblocks,
and affirms anew that such collective punish-
ments are prohibited under international law,
as they constitute grave violations of the pro-
visions of the Fourth Geneva Convention and
Additional Protocol I thereto, and also are
war crimes;
13. Expresses its grave concern once again at
the restriction of the freedom of movement
imposed by the Israeli occupation authorities
on Yasser Arafat, the democratically elected
Palestinian President, in violation of articles 9
and 13 of the Universal Declaration of Human
Rights;
14. Strongly condemns campaigns of massive
arrests conducted by the Israeli occupation
authorities to detain thousands of Palestinians
without trial and without any criminal charges
having been brought against them, in viola-
tion of article 9 of the Universal Declaration
of Human Rights and of the provisions of the
Fourth Geneva Convention in this respect;
15. Affirms anew that the demolitions carried
out by the Israeli occupying forces of at least
thirty thousand Palestinian houses, facilities
and property constitute grave violations of
articles 33 and 53 of the Fourth Geneva Con-
vention and that acts of levelling farmlands,
uprooting trees and destroying what is left of
the Palestinian infrastructure constitute a form
of collective punishment to which Palestinians
are subjected, grave violations of the provi-
sions of international humanitarian law and
war crimes according to international law;
16. Affirms anew that the Fourth Geneva Con-
vention is applicable to the Palestinian territo-
ries occupied by Israel since 1967, including
East Jerusalem, and considers any change in
the geographical, demographic and institu-
tional status of the city of East Jerusalem from
its status prior to the June 1967 war to be il-
legal and void;
17. Calls once again upon Israel, the occupy-
ing Power, to desist from all forms of human
rights violations in the Occupied Palestinian
Territory, including East Jerusalem, and other
occupied Arab territories, and to respect the
222 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
principles of international law, international
humanitarian law, the Universal Declaration of
Human Rights, its international commitments
and its signed agreements with the Palestine
Liberation Organization;
18. Also calls once again upon Israel to with-
draw from the Palestinian territories occu-
pied since 1967, including East Jerusalem, in
accordance with the relevant resolutions of
the United Nations and the Commission on
Human Rights, as a basic condition for achiev-
ing a just, lasting and comprehensive peace in
the Middle East;
19. Strongly condemns the construction of the
Israeli wall inside the Occupied Palestinian
Territory, in the West Bank, as it constitutes
a new Israeli pretext for the forcible confisca-
tion of further Palestinian lands, it endangers
the social, economic, cultural, educational,
health and psychological aspects of the lives of
hundreds of thousands of Palestinians as well
as their familial unity, it prevents Palestinians
from having access to their natural resources
and it constitutes a major obstacle to achieving
a just and lasting peace on the basis of the two-
State solution, with an independent Palestinian
State and Israeli State, the only solution which
guarantees peace and stability in the region,
and it also prevents Palestinians from exercis-
ing their right to self-determination; and calls
on Israel immediately to stop the construction
of the said wall and to erase what it has already
built of this wall inside the Palestinian territo-
ries occupied since 1967;
20. Requests the Special Rapporteur on the
situation of human rights in the Palestinian
territories occupied by Israel since 1967, to
investigate Israel’s violations of the principles
and bases of international law, international
humanitarian law and the Geneva Convention
relative to the Protection of Civilian Persons in
Time of War, of 12 August 1949, and, in his
capacity as a monitoring mechanism, to follow
up on the implementation of these recommen-
dations and to report thereon to the General
Assembly at its fifty-ninth session and to the
Commission on Human Rights at its sixty-first
session, until the end of the mandate of the
Special Rapporteur as established in Commis-
sion resolution 1993/2 A of 1993;
21. Calls upon the relevant United Nations or-
gans urgently to consider the best ways to pro-
vide the necessary international protection for
the Palestinian people until the end of the Is-
raeli occupation of the Palestinian territories;
22. Requests the Secretary-General to bring
the present resolution to the attention of the
Government of Israel and all other Govern-
ments, the competent United Nations organs,
the specialized agencies, regional intergovern-
mental organizations and international human-
itarian organizations, to disseminate it on the
widest possible scale and to report on its im-
plementation by the Government of Israel to
the Commission on Human Rights at its sixty-
first session;
23. Also requests the Secretary-General to
provide the Commission with all United Na-
tions reports issued between the sessions of
the Commission that deal with the conditions
in which the populations of the Palestinian
and other occupied Arab territories are living
under the Israeli occupation;
24. Decides to consider this question at its
sixty-first session under the same agenda item,
as a matter of high priority.
III. DRAFT REVISED ARAB
CHARTER ON HUMAN RIGHTS
(EXCERPTS)
Article 1 (new article)
In the framework of the national identity of the
Arab States and sentiments of belonging to a
shared civilization, the present Charter aims to
realize the following goals:
a) To place human rights in the Arab States
among the most important national interests,
such that human rights come to constitute a su-
preme and fundamental paradigm and exem-
plar that guides human will in the Arab States,
and allows individuals to improve the realities
of their lives in accordance with noble human
goals.
b) Energizing individuals in the Arab States
to strengthen their sense of identity and loyalty
to their nation, territorially, historically and
in terms of shared interests, together with the
dissemination of the culture of human broth-
erhood, tolerance, and mutual openness to
the other, in accordance with the demands of
universal principles and values proclaimed in
international human rights treaties.
c) Preparing coming generations in the Arab
223 ANNEX II. SELECTED DOCUMENTS
States to live free and responsible lives in a civil
society that is inclusive and based on linking
awareness of rights and commitment to duties,
governed by the values of equality, tolerance,
and justice.
d) Firmly establishing the judicial principle
that all human rights are universal, indivisible,
inter-related and inter-dependent.
Article 2 (revised Article 1)
a) All peoples have the right to self-determi-
nation and control over their own wealth and
resources, and have the right to determine
through freedom of choice, the type of political
system that will govern them, and to maintain
freedom of economic and social and cultural
development.
b) All peoples have the right to live under na-
tional sovereignty and territorial unity.
c) All forms of racism, Zionism, occupation,
and foreign control threaten human dignity
and constitute fundamental obstacles to the
existence of the basic rights of peoples, and it
is necessary to condemn all such practices and
to work for their eradication.
Article 3 (revised Article 2)
a) Every State Party to this Charter binds itself
to guarantee to all individuals under its author-
ity the right to enjoy the rights and freedoms
stipulated in this Charter, without discrimi-
nation on the basis of origin, colour, sex,
language, religious belief, opinion, thought,
national origin, social origin, wealth, place of
birth, disability, or any other circumstance.
b) The State shall take appropriate steps to
guarantee protection from all forms of dis-
crimination on any of the bases stipulated in
the preceding paragraph. Likewise it will make
all necessary arrangements to realize the aim of
securing real independence to enjoy all rights
and freedoms stipulated in this Convention.
c) States Parties to the present Convention
commit themselves to a course of action that,
with all appropriate means and without politi-
cal suppression, will put an end to discrimina-
tion against women; and to take all necessary
steps to guarantee and secure the equality of
men and women to enjoy all the rights stipu-
lated in this Convention.
Article 4 (revised Article 3)
(a) In exceptional emergency situations that
threaten the life of the nation, and which are
proclaimed officially, States Parties to this
Charter are permitted to take, in the narrowest
limits possible given the particular situation,
steps in which they are not bound by the ob-
ligations pertinent to that situation and stipu-
lated in this Charter, on condition that these
arrangements do not contravene the other ob-
ligations by which that State is bound under
international law, and as long as these arrange-
ments are not of a discriminatory nature, based
on origin, colour, sex, language, religion, or
social origin.
(b) It is impermissible in any circumstances
whatsoever to transgress the following rights
which are not subject to derogation or sus-
pension: Article 5 (the right to life); Article
8 (prohibition of torture or cruel, inhuman or
degrading treatment or punishment); Article 9
(prohibition of enforced medical or scientific
experiment without consent); Article 10 (the
banning of any form of enslavement); Article
13 (minimum standards for fair trial); Arti-
cle 14 paragraph (h) (the right to challenge
the legality of arrest or detention); Article 15
(legal definition of crimes and punishments,
and non-retroactivity of the law, application
of the most appropriate law to the accused);
Article 18 (prohibition of imprisonment for
non-payment of debts); Article 19 (prohibi-
tion on double jeopardy); Article 31 (freedom
of thought, identity, and religion); Article 20
(humane treatment of all those deprived of
their freedom); Article 22 (recognition of the
individual’s legal person); Article 27 (the right
to return to the homeland); Article 28 (political
refugee status); Article 29 (right to citizenship);
as it is impermissible to suspend legal guaran-
tees required to protect those rights.
(c) Any State Party to this Charter that imple-
ments the right of derogation must inform the
other States Parties to the Charter immediately,
through the Secretary General of the League of
Arab States and the UN Secretary-General, of
the specific provisions that it is suspending and
the reasons for doing so. And on the date that
this suspension ends, it must inform the other
States through the same channels.
Source: General secretariat, League of Arab
States – United Nations Office of the High
Commissioner for Human Rights, 2003.
224 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
IV. UNITED NATIONS
CONVENTION AGAINST
CORRUPTION (EXCERPTS)
PREAMBLE
Concerned about the seriousness of problems
and threats posed by corruption to the stabil-
ity and security of societies, undermining the
institutions and values of democracy, ethical
values and justice and jeopardizing sustainable
development and the rule of law,
Concerned also about the links between
corruption and other forms of crime, in par-
ticular organized crime and economic crime,
including money-laundering, …
Convinced that corruption is no longer a
local matter but a transnational phenomenon
that affects all societies and economies, making
international cooperation to prevent and con-
trol it essential, …
Convinced that the illicit acquisition of
personal wealth can be particularly damaging
to democratic institutions, national economies
and the rule of law, …
Article 1
Statement of purpose
The purposes of this Convention are:
(a) To promote and strengthen measures to
prevent and combat corruption more effi-
ciently and effectively;
(b) To promote, facilitate and support interna-
tional cooperation and technical assistance in
the prevention of and fight against corruption,
including in asset recovery;
(c) To promote integrity, accountability and
proper management of public affairs and pub-
lic property.
Article 5
Preventive anti-corruption policies and
practices
1. Each State Party shall, in accordance with
the fundamental principles of its legal system,
develop and implement or maintain effective,
coordinated anti-corruption policies that pro-
mote the participation of society and reflect
the principles of the rule of law, proper man-
agement of public affairs and public property,
integrity, transparency and accountability.
2. Each State Party shall endeavour to estab-
lish and promote effective practices aimed at
the prevention of corruption. …
Article 6
Preventive anti-corruption body or bodies
1. Each State Party shall, in accordance with
the fundamental principles of its legal system,
ensure the existence of a body or bodies, as ap-
propriate, that prevent corruption…
Article 7
Public sector
1. Each State Party shall, where appropriate
and in accordance with the fundamental prin-
ciples of its legal system, endeavour to adopt,
maintain and strengthen systems for the re-
cruitment, hiring, retention, promotion and
retirement of civil servants and, where appro-
priate, other non-elected public officials:
(a) That are based on principles of efficiency,
transparency and objective criteria such as
merit, equity and aptitude; ….
Article 12
Private sector
1. Each State Party shall take measures, in ac-
cordance with the fundamental principles of
its domestic law, to prevent corruption involv-
ing the private sector enhance accounting and
auditing standards in the private sector and,
where appropriate, provide effective, propor-
tionate and dissuasive civil, administrative or
criminal penalties for failure to comply with
such measures. …
Article 13
Participation of society
1. Each State Party shall take appropriate
measures, within its means and in accordance
with fundamental principles of its domestic
law, to promote the active participation of in-
dividuals and groups outside the public sector,
such as civil society, non-governmental organi-
zations and community-based organizations,
in the prevention of and the fight against cor-
ruption and to raise public awareness regard-
ing the existence, causes and gravity of and the
threat posed by corruption. This participation
should be strengthened by such measures as:
(a) Enhancing the transparency of and pro-
moting the contribution of the public to deci-
225 ANNEX II. SELECTED DOCUMENTS
sion-making processes;
(b) Ensuring that the public has effective ac-
cess to information; …
Article 16
Bribery of foreign public officials
and officials of public international
organizations
1. Each State Party shall adopt such legisla-
tive and other measures as may be necessary
to establish as a criminal offence, when com-
mitted intentionally, the promise, offering or
giving to a foreign public official or an official
of a public international organization, directly
or indirectly, of an undue advantage, for the
official himself or herself or another person or
entity, in order that the official act or refrain
from acting in the exercise of his or her official
duties, …
Article 18
Trading in influence
Each State Party shall consider adopting such
legislative and other measures as may be nec-
essary to establish as criminal offences, when
committed intentionally:
(a) The promise, offering or giving to a pub-
lic official or any other person, directly or in-
directly, of an undue advantage in order that
the public official or the person abuse his or
her real or supposed influence with a view to
obtaining from an administration or public au-
thority of the State Party an undue advantage
for the original instigator of the act or for any
other person; ….
V. CHARTER FOR REFORM OF THE
ARAB SITUATION (SAUDI ARABIA)
The Arab Kings and Presidents, after review-
ing the present Arab situation, and having
observed a protracted silence and a nearly in-
comprehensible acquiescence in events occur-
ring in the Arab region that give an impression
of powerlessness and lack of control, impelling
some to think little of attacking the Arab na-
tion, thereby damaging its legitimate interests,
Consider that the time has come to rouse
the soul of that nation to wakefulness and
stimulate its zeal to demonstrate Arabs’ capaci-
ties, their determination to fortify the vitality
of their community and their ability to con-
front the challenges and dangers arising from
current developments, evolving as they are at
a rapid rate, by joining forces to change the bit-
ter situation now being endured by the Arab
nation, thereby confirming the words of the
Qur’an, “God brings change to a people only
when that people changes itself.”
In view of the fact that the Joint Arab
Action mechanism is in need of seriousness,
credibility and commitment to the implemen-
tation of duly adopted resolutions, which have
been sorely lacking in recent years, the Arab
Kings and Presidents recognize the timeliness
of a new Arab charter to safeguard the legiti-
mate interests and attain the just objectives of
the Arab nation, to build joint Arab action on
the strongest and most secure of foundations,
rather than on the weakest and most unreliable
of foundations as heretofore, and to organize
relations between Arab States and guide rela-
tions with the States of the world, these aims
to be realized through the establishment of
clearly defined mechanisms and programmes
designed to ensure that resolutions adopted
at Arab summit meetings will be duly imple-
mented.
Accordingly, they swear by Almighty God
and pledge to their peoples that they will strive
firmly and resolutely to safeguard the sover-
eignty and security of Arab States and the unity
of their lands and to build Arab defensive ca-
pability, and they affirm that they are prepared
to back the Palestinian Authority and support
the endurance of the Palestinian people in its
occupied homeland, subjected as it is to Israeli
policies of oppression, occupation and encir-
clement.
They renew their adoption of the option of
a just, comprehensive peace based on legitimate
Arab rights, and they proclaim their resolve to
strive for the implementation of the Arab peace
initiative together with all the world’s peace-
loving peoples, deeming that clearly to be the
way to a just, comprehensive and lasting peace
in the region, which can be attained only by
Israel’s withdrawal from all the Arab territories
occupied in 1967, enabling the Palestinian peo-
ple to exercise its legitimate and internationally
recognized right to establish an independent
State on its occupied land, with the holy city of
Jerusalem as its capital. They declare that the
elements of the Arab peace initiative are the
minimum acceptable conditions for entering
into normal relations with Israel on the basis
226 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
of the relevant UN resolutions and pursuant
to the authority of the Madrid Conference and
the principle of land for peace.
They are persuaded that self-reform and the
development of political participation within
Arab States are the fundamental starting-
points for Arab capacity-building and action
to generate the conditions for a comprehensive
Arab renaissance, meet the requirements for
positive involvement in all areas of the compet-
itive global marketplace, achieve sustainable
development, create programmes to encour-
age innovation and creative thinking, and deal
objectively and realistically with rapidly evolv-
ing processes of innovation and change in the
global economic space, especially as regards
the emergence of large economic blocs, the
steady growth of globalization, with the chal-
lenges and opportunities that it brings in its
train, and the constantly accelerating pace of
technological progress and the development of
information and communication technologies.
The Arab world is an important contributor to
the process of human cultural development in
all its aspects.
They proclaim their categorical rejection
of any illegitimate external aggression against
any Arab State, their commitment to the reso-
lution of all Arab disputes by peaceful means
and the illegitimacy of the use of force between
Arab States, and their united opposition to any
Arab State that commits aggression against any
other Arab State on any pretext and under any
circumstances. They harbour enmity toward
none; their aim and purpose is to defend their
interests and harness their energies in the serv-
ice of international security and peace.
In view of the fact that a sound economy
is the foundation-stone underpinning the
strength and prosperity of States, whereas the
efforts of Arab States to promote economic
cooperation among themselves have lacked
seriousness and credibility to date, it is essen-
tial to develop a practical plan to complete the
final implementation of the Greater Arab Free
Trade Area by the end of 2005, with no excep-
tions or administrative or technical restrictions,
and to endeavour to develop a trade policy
based on a unified tariff structure with a view
to creating a customs union within a period of
not more than ten years, as a step toward the
establishment of an Arab common market.
VI. PROJECT FOR DEVELOPING
THE JOINT ARAB ACTION
MECHANISM (YEMEN)
The Republic of Yemen considers that the cir-
cumstances surrounding the Arab nation and
the Joint Arab Action mechanism imperatively
require reformulation of the basis and aims of
that mechanism. In the light of more than fifty
years of experience of both the positive and the
negative aspects of the League of Arab States,
we suggest that it is time to transform the
League, with all its constituent bodies and in-
stitutions, into a new Arab entity to be known
as the Union of Arab States, in response to re-
gional and international changes and develop-
ments in all areas of politics, economics, social
organization, defence, security and culture and
in order to enhance regional security in the
face of the challenges and dangers imperilling
the present and the future of the Arab nation,
impeding its progress and preventing it from
realizing its aspirations, with a view to achiev-
ing the unity of that nation.
PRINCIPLES:
The Republic of Yemen considers that the
“Union of Arab States” must be based on a
number of essential principles, viz.:
• Respect for the sovereignty of every Arab
State and respect for its territorial boundaries
and the unity of its national land.
• The right of every State to choose its sys-
tem of governance.
• Non-interference in the internal affairs of
Member States.
• Encouragement for democratic practices,
the promotion of democratic institutions and
respect for human rights.
• Non-recognition of the seizure of power by
force or by extralegal means in any Arab State.
Suspension of any such State from member-
ship until such time as legality is restored.
• Establishment of an Arab regional system
of security to protect Member States and en-
able them to participate more effectively in the
realization of international security and peace.
• A commitment by Member States to re-
solve their differences by peaceful means, and
to eschew the use of force for settling disputes.
• A commitment to the UN Charter and
bilateral treaties between Member States, the
227 ANNEX II. SELECTED DOCUMENTS
maintenance of international security and sta-
bility, and anti-terrorism.
OBJECTIVES:
The Union of Arab States seeks to achieve re-
gional economic integration, considering that
development of Member States’ shared inter-
ests and economic convergence are the true
key to political unification, taking into account
the importance of a gradual approach in order
to enable the Arab nation to bring the Union
into being.
ORGANIZATIONAL STRUCTURES
AND FRAMEWORK OF THE UNION
Supreme Council of the Union:
The Supreme Council of the Union shall be
made up of the Kings, Presidents and Emirs
of Arab countries, and shall be the Union’s su-
preme power. It shall be competent to set and
adopt general policies, issue executive orders
and validate recommendations and resolutions
submitted to it by lower councils. The office
of President of the High Council of the Union
shall be held on a rotating basis for a term of
one year.
People’s Assembly:
The People’s Assembly shall comprise two
bodies:
• The Chamber of Deputies;
• The Consultative Council.
The People’s Assembly shall be the legisla-
tive arm of the Union, enshrining the princi-
ple of the right of the Arab peoples to oversee
and monitor the institutions of the Union.
It shall be formed gradually from existing
Parliaments and any other representative bod-
ies in States. Ultimately, it shall be made up
of members elected in accordance with agreed
standards and conditions. The regulations of
the Chamber of Deputies and the Consultative
Council shall determine each State’s repre-
sentation and the areas of competence, head-
quarters site, term and working methods of the
body in question.
Council of Heads of Government:
The Council of Heads of Government shall be
the executive arm of the Union, and it shall be
made up of the Heads of Government of the
States of the Union.
Ministerial Councils:
These shall comprise:
• The Council of Ministers for Foreign Af-
fairs of Member States;
• The Council of Ministers of Development,
Economic Affairs and Trade (Economic Coun-
cil);
• The Defence and Security Council;
• Any other Councils that it shall be deemed
expedient to add.
The function of these Councils shall be
to propose, each in its own area of compe-
tence, integrated policies in the framework of
more general Union policies, and to monitor
the implementation of those policies through
executive mechanisms and measures to be
established, together with their membership
procedures and working methods, by their re-
spective regulations.
Arab Court of Justice
The function of the Court shall be to settle dis-
putes between Member States, and to rule on
any matters referred to it in accordance with
its regulations, which shall be laid down by the
Supreme Council of the Union.
• Commission
• Chamber of Permanent Representatives
• Secretariat of the Union
VOTING
New voting rules have been adopted with a
view to achieving the interests of a majority of
Member States and the interests of the Arab
nation, based on the following principles:
• Acceptance of a new member: unanimous
approval required;
• Fundamental issues: a three-quarters ma-
jority required;
• Substantive matters: a two-thirds majority
required;
• Procedural matters: a simple majority will
suffice.
As regards the drafting of the Constitution
of the proposed Union of Arab States on the
basis of the objectives, principles and work-
ing mechanisms outlined above, the Republic
of Yemen recommends the establishment of
228 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
a Ministerial Committee from seven Arab
States, to be entrusted with responsibility
for preparing the Constitution of the Union.
The Committee may enlist the assistance of
legal, economic and political experts from the
League of Arab States and Member States. The
draft Constitution shall be prepared within six
months, and shall be submitted to Member
States for consideration. It shall subsequently
be submitted to the Council of Ministers for
Foreign Affairs for approval, and subsequently
to a periodic or special summit meeting for
signing.
VII. INITIATIVE FOR
DEVELOPING THE LEAGUE
OF ARAB STATES (LAS) AND
ACTIVATION OF THE JOINT ARAB
ACTION MECHANISM (EGYPT)
1. Action to clear the air and remove
impediments from inter-Arab relations
2. Assumption by the LAS of its role as
a primary instrument of the Joint Arab
Action mechanism
This would be accomplished through the
establishment of a new mechanism within the
context of the LAS aimed at achieving the
necessary degree of coordination among Joint
Arab Action institutions and agencies, includ-
ing those institutions and agencies that do not
come under the LAS umbrella.
3. Containment and resolution of inter-
Arab disputes
Means to this end would include:
(a) A dispute prevention, management and
settlement mechanism;
(b) Establishment of an Arab Court of Jus-
tice.
An Arab Court of Justice would serve as a
legal mechanism for resolving inter-Arab dis-
putes, clearing the air and relieving member
States of the burden of crisis management,
which is incompatible with the logic of Arab
solidarity. Its efforts would ease some of the
friction in inter-Arab relations and make it
easier for Arab States to combine their efforts
in dealing with the current Arab situation.
4. Economic projects aimed at achieving
Arab integration and fostering private-
sector participation
5. Establishment of an Arab Parliament
• With a view to broadening the scope of
public participation, enhancing political stabil-
ity, promoting the concept of the rule of law
and strengthening respect for fundamental
human rights and democratic values, an Arab
Parliament would be established in an effort to
put the LAS and the Joint Arab Action mecha-
nism back on track.
• The Arab Parliament might be established
through existing Arab representative bodies,
directly elected by the people of the member
States, or brought into being by some combi-
nation of those approaches.
• The main function of the Arab Parliament
would be to monitor the work of the organs
of the LAS from a political standpoint and to
contribute to the drafting of general LAS poli-
cies covering all aspects of its work. The Par-
liament would devise mechanisms, ways and
means of performing this political oversight
function.
• The Parliament would also monitor the
legislative and financial operations of the LAS.
6. Establishment of an Arab regional
security system
There are two possible alternatives, or it might
be feasible to combine them under an agreed
formula:
(a) An Arab Security Council;
(b) An Arab National Security Forum, as an
institutional framework for the discussion of
all matters which in the view of Arab States
might usefully contribute, at a later stage, to
the building of a new Arab regional security
system.
7. Support for Arab specialized
institutions
More active links between those institutions
and the LAS would be developed, subject to
the condition that the former would retain full
jurisdiction in their respective areas of compe-
tence and would lose none of their financial or
administrative autonomy.
8. Creation of links between the LAS and
civil-society institutions
Civil-society institutions would thereby be
229 ANNEX II. SELECTED DOCUMENTS
enlisted as contributors to the outlook and vi-
sion that guide the Joint Arab Action initiative,
helping to keep it on track and ensure that it
is aware of the fears, aspirations and hopes of
ordinary Arab people.
9. Changes to the voting system in organs
of the LAS
The system of consensus, which at present is the
basis of the voting system in the LAS Council,
is regarded as outmoded and inappropriate for
the contemporary situation.
10. Use of a method of collective diplomacy
in implementing LAS decisions, especially
decisions with a bearing on regional and
international relations
11. Development of and support for the
LAS secretariat
Source: Al-Ahram, Cairo, in Arabic, 8
March 2004.
VIII. SANA’A DECLARATION
ON DEMOCRACY, HUMAN
RIGHTS AND THE ROLE OF THE
INTERNATIONAL CRIMINAL
COURT
(a) The principles of democracy and human
rights are an important source of and are
rooted in beliefs and cultures; these rights are
considered an indivisible whole.
(b) Diversity, difference and cultural, civili-
zational and religious particularities lie at the
heart of recognized universal human rights,
and must be taken into consideration in un-
derstanding the application of democracy
and human rights. This diversity should not
constitute a source of conflict but, to the con-
trary, a source of enrichment, and the starting
point for dialogue aiming at building bridges
for communication and mutual understanding
between religions and civilizations.
(c) Democratic governance shall guarantee
human rights protection and the welfare of all
without discrimination; in particular, the rights
and welfare of those sectors which are weak,
marginalized or excluded.
(d) Democracy is attained through the estab-
lishment of institutions and laws for the practi-
cal exercise of democratic conduct at different
levels and shall be judged according to the
extent to which its principles, standards and
values are representative of human rights prin-
ciples and respect for human rights.
(e) Among the foundations of democratic gov-
ernance is the existence of a legislature which
is periodically elected, represents the citizens
fairly and on the basis of popular participation;
the constituent bodies of the executive are re-
sponsible to and bound by the rules of sound
judgement, and an independent judiciary shall
guarantee fair trials, protect human rights
and freedoms and prevent/punish those who
violate them. These fundamental principles are
among those that shall guarantee a sound base
for democratic performance which safeguards
human rights.
(f) It is important to support democratic de-
bate, to encourage participation, and political,
democratic development, and to support the
exchange of ideas and experience within and
among participating States.
(g) Strengthening the democratic architecture
and performance, protection of human rights
and development of their substance are de-
pendent on overcoming major challenges and
threats, which include foreign occupation,
defects in the balance between justice and the
State, shortcomings in educational systems,
and the definition of crimes in ways that are
contrary to international law.
(h) The effective application of the rule of law
is vital for protection of democracy and human
rights, and is founded on an independent judi-
ciary and the principle of separation of pow-
ers.
(i) Free and independent media are essential
to buttress and protect democratic principles;
plurality of the media in giving voice to differ-
ent opinions and regarding their ownership is a
vital component contributing to communicat-
ing knowledge and information, achieving par-
ticipation and accountability and enlightening
and forming public opinion, based on appro-
priate standards and regard for the truth. The
media have an important and responsible role
in entrenching democracy, and in spreading
awareness and knowledge about human rights
and their protection.
(j) A soundly based democracy and respect
for human rights require guarantees for the
right to freedom to set up and be a member
of civil-society organizations, providing the
appropriate legal framework and environment
for their work; this is to strengthen partnership
230 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
and participation, to organize effective social
activism, so that civil society can play its role
responsibly within the legal framework and
bound by democratic principles and respect
for human rights.
(k) The private sector is considered a vital
partner in supporting democratic principles
and strengthening human rights and has a
responsibility to work actively with the State
authorities and civil-society institutions in sup-
port of efforts aimed at achieving progress in
these fields.
(l) The change in the climate of international
relations, with increased attention to human
rights and the rule of law, and the serious en-
deavour to put an end to violations of inter-
national law, and international human rights
law, all demand the activation and develop-
ment of mechanisms to punish and bring to
account the perpetrators of grave crimes and
other offences, including war crimes, crimes
against humanity, genocide and aggression; all
of which should be implemented without using
double standards and avoiding their arbitrary
application.
IX. ALEXANDRIA CHARTER
The Charter stressed that internal reform must
not obscure the importance of a just solution
to the Palestinian issue and of the liberation of
occupied Arab territory. It also stressed its af-
firmation of the independence and territorial
integrity of Iraq.
Participants called for Arab constitutions
to be brought into line with the political sys-
tems aspired to by their societies and with
international human rights charters. They
demanded a separation between the legisla-
tive and executive powers and a guarantee of
periodic peaceful change of government, the
organization of regular free elections, the aboli-
tion of imprisonment or detention on grounds
of opinion, and the release of prisoners of con-
science anywhere in the Arab world whether
these have yet to appear before a court or have
been sentenced.
Participants demanded the abolition of all
exceptional laws and emergency laws, freedom
to form political parties and the ratification by
Arab countries of the relevant international and
Arab charters. They also called for freedom of
press and media from government control and
freedom for the institutions of civil society.
Participants presented a 22-point pro-
gramme calling on Arab countries to announce
clear plans and timetables for institutional and
structural reform and the limitation of the pow-
ers of the State as a spur to economic activity
and in order to provide an appropriate envi-
ronment for the work of the private and pub-
lic sectors. Also included in the programme
were calls for the reduction of government bu-
reaucracy, the removal of impediments to in-
vestment, the encouragement of privatization,
the development of programmes to fund small
projects and the adoption of economic policies
capable of creating jobs for the five million an-
nual new entrants into the Arab labour market,
as well as addressing poverty.
In the area of social reform, participants
called for the government to continue to take
responsibility for funding and supporting edu-
cational institutions while guaranteeing the
right of students to practise politics, including
the holding of peaceful organized demonstra-
tions, freedom of opinion and its expression,
and democratic elections for student unions,
plus the implementation of effective policies to
guarantee a just distribution of wealth and the
various returns on production.
X. ARAB REGIONAL CONFERENCE
ON EDUCATION FOR ALL:
ARAB VISION FOR THE FUTURE
(EXCERPTS)
Based on the discussions and exchanges be-
tween conference participants, we affirm:
• That the Arab nation is a responsible part-
ner in world society that is aware of its rights,
obligations and responsibilities. The confer-
ence believes that the violations of interna-
tional law and acts of violence and oppression
committed in Palestine, Iraq and the Golan
and of the threats against Syria by their very
nature hamper educational development.
• That development and modernization of
education rooted in beliefs, values and iden-
tity and responsive to national requirements
should be maintained.
• That development and modernization of
education should come from within, thus af-
firming the nation’s beliefs, principles and
interests while simultaneously taking every
precaution to remain open to world thought,
231 ANNEX II. SELECTED DOCUMENTS
to respect the specificities of other peoples,
and to welcome human experiences of proven
success.
• That development, modernization and
reform must encompass the entire world and
lead finally to the rule of comprehensive and
just peace in accordance with the regulations
of international law, respect for human rights
everywhere, and the acceptance of justice and
law without bias or double stThis vision stresses
the importance of the continuous development
of academic curricula in terms of philosophy,
goals, content and means and styles of teach-
ing and learning. The point of departure for
such work should be an attitude to the cur-
riculum that views it as the entry point for the
cultivation in the learner of a diversity of styles
of thought and for providing him/her with the
skills needed to deal, in full awareness, with the
challenges of the knowledge society, thus ena-
bling him/her to become a citizen capable of
solving problems and contributing effectively
to the progress of his/her society and nation.
It follows that such a curriculum must place
a high value on the role of the learner in the
teaching and learning processes while magni-
fying the importance of the diversification of
educational activities in realizing a learning ex-
perience of high quality.
Adoption of an authentic form of assess-
ment that stresses the necessity of continuous
and comprehensive evaluation of the per-
formance of both students and the teaching
system is a fundamental principle on which
Arab countries place reliance in the context of
the process of education development. Such
evaluation deals with learning outputs accord-
ing to their diverse fields and multiple activities
by recourse to a variety of evaluation methods
and instruments. Special attention is also paid
to talent and to unusually talented students.
Under such conditions, evaluation becomes
a support and reinforcement for students’
capabilities, prescribing treatment for their
problems and guaranteeing them paths to ex-
cellence and distinction.
The vision also ascribes special importance
to model investment in early childhood nurture
and care. Here the point of departure should
be an attitude that views early childhood as
the stage at which children’s multiple forms
of intelligence are given every opportunity to
blossom. This requires that the entire range
of psychological, material and educational
conditions appropriate for the realization of
the unimpeded growth of the child’s innate
faculties to their maximum potential must be
put in place, thus allowing his/her resources,
capabilities and energies to blossom, grow and
express themselves.
The vision regards illiteracy in all its forms
as a grave problem and an impediment to the
realization of the desired leap into the knowl-
edge society. Continuous efforts must there-
fore be devoted to its elimination.
The participation of society at large is con-
sidered to be a basic support for the implemen-
tation of this vision.
XI. TUNIS DECLARATION
(EXCERPTS)
We, the leaders of the Arab States, meeting at
the Summit Conference of the Arab League
Council in its sixteenth ordinary session held in
Tunis, the capital of the Republic of Tunisia;
Committed as we are to the principles upon
which the League of Arab States was founded
and to the objectives enunciated in its Charter,
as well as to the noble universal values spelled
out in the United Nations Charter and to all
the instruments of international legality;
Taking into account the new world changes
and the challenges and stakes they generate;
Determined to pursue efforts in order to
strengthen the solidarity and cohesion of the
Arab Nation, and to consolidate the Arab
ranks, in the service of our primordial causes;
Declare the following:
1. The commitment of all international parties
to materialize the principles of international
legality and the United Nations resolutions
pertaining to the Arab-Israeli conflict, without
excluding any of the legal references of the
peace process, constitutes the basis for a just,
comprehensive and durable settlement to this
conflict, in accordance with the Arab peace
initiative and in implementation of the “road
map”. The international community should
join its efforts so as to provide the necessary
protection for the Palestinian people against
the continuing acts of killing and deportation
they are enduring, and also to put an end to the
policy of assassination perpetrated by Israel
against the Palestinian political leaders, to the
232 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
siege imposed on the Palestinian people and
their leadership, as well as to the aggressions
targeting civilians without distinction. Join-
ing these efforts would pave the way for the
resumption of peace talks and would enable
the brotherly Palestinian people to recover
their legitimate rights, including in particular
the establishment of their independent State
with East Jerusalem as its capital, as well as the
evacuation of all the Arab occupied territories,
including the occupied Syrian Golan and the
Lebanese Shaba Farms.
2. …Convening an international conference
aimed at ridding the Middle East region, in-
cluding Israel, of the weapons of mass destruc-
tion.
3. … Support for Iraq’s territorial integrity
and respect for the sovereignty, independence
and national unity of sisterly Iraq, calling upon
the Security Council to give a central and active
role to the United Nations in Iraq in order to
put an end to the occupation and prepare the
ground for the transfer of power to the Iraqi
people. This will make it possible to establish
peace and stability and to launch the process of
reconstruction in Iraq.
4. …Solidarity with sisterly Syria in the face
of the American sanctions.
We also assert our firm determination:
1. To materialize our common will to develop
the system of joint Arab action, through the
Tunis Summit resolution to amend the Arab
League Charter and to modernize its work
methods and its specialized institutions, based
on the various Arab initiatives and ideas in-
cluded in the proposals put forward by the
Secretary-General as well as on a consensual
and coherent vision.
2. To reaffirm our States’ commitment to the
humanitarian principles and the noble values
of human rights in their comprehensive and in-
terdependent dimensions, to the provisions of
the various international conventions and char-
ters, and to the Arab Human Rights Charter
adopted by the Tunis Summit, as well as to the
reinforcement of the freedom of expression,
thought and belief and to the guarantee of the
independence of the judiciary.
3. To foster the role of all components of civil
society, including non-governmental organi-
zations, in conceiving of the guidelines of the
society of tomorrow, by widening women’s
participation in the political, economic, social,
cultural and educational fields and reinforcing
their rights and status in society, and by pursu-
ing the promotion of the family and the protec-
tion of Arab youth.
4. To consolidate comprehensive develop-
ment programmes and intensify efforts aimed at
promoting educational systems, at disseminat-
ing knowledge and encouraging its acquisition,
and at fighting illiteracy in order to ensure a
better future for the Arab young generations.
5. To achieve economic complementarity
among Arab States on the basis of the exchange
of benefits and the interdependence of inter-
ests, and to endeavour to pursue the upgrading
of the Arab economies by entrusting the Eco-
nomic and Social Council with establishing a
joint Arab economic and social action strategy,
in such a way as to consolidate the competi-
tiveness of the Arab economy and empower it
to establish a solidarity-based partnership with
the various economic groupings in the world.
6. To consecrate the values of solidarity and
mutual assistance among the Arab States, as
part of the Arab anti-poverty strategy adopted
by the Tunis Summit, and to mobilize all
human potential in the Arab countries in sup-
port of their development efforts.
7. To strengthen the bonds of friendship be-
tween Arab countries and other countries of
the world, and to establish a new approach for
solidarity-based cooperation and partnership
with them, based on our determination to con-
secrate dialogue between religions and cultures
and to highlight the civilizational and humanist
mission of Islam, which calls for disseminating
the values of tolerance, concord and peaceful
coexistence among peoples and nations, and
rejects hatred and discrimination.
8. To reaffirm the commitment of Arab States
to pursue their contribution to the interna-
tional efforts to stand against and combat all
forms of terrorism, avoid confusing Islam with
terrorism and differentiate between legitimate
resistance and terrorism.
9. To call for the holding of an international
conference, under the auspices of the United
Nations, in order to establish an international
code of ethics for the fight against terrorism,
while working to tackle the root causes of this
phenomenon.
Source: Al-Ahram, Cairo, in Arabic, 24 May
2004.
233 ANNEX III. LIST OF BACKGROUND PAPERS
ANNEX III. LIST OF BACKGROUND
PAPERS
(Author name, paper title, number of pages)
IN ARABIC
• Abdel-Messih, Marie-Thérèse – Freedom in
Arab Creative Art, 12.
• Al-Asha’al, Abdallah – Reforming
Governance at the International Level and Its
Effect on the Arab World, 10.
• Al-Hamdan, Amna Rashed – The Concept
of Freedom in Arab Folklore, 10.
• Ali, Ali Abdel Gadir – Freedom from Want:
Social Security in Arab Countries, 12.
• Al-Jenhani, Al-Habib – Freedom in Arab
History, 9.
• Al-Moneef, Majid Abdallah – Corruption
and Development in Arab Countries, 25.
• Al-Nowwab, Nabil – Occupation of Iraq, 6.
• Al-Sayyid, Mustapha Kamel – Parliamentary
Governance in Arab Countries, 32.
• Alsowegh, Siham Abdulrahman – Freedom
and Education Systems in the Arab East
Countries, 22.
• Alwahabi, Amina Lemrini and Khadija
Marwazi – Freedom in Educational Curricula,
43.
• Awad, Mohsen – Freedom from Oppression:
Civil and Political Rights in Arab Countries, 26.
• Bishara, Azmi – Occupation and Good
Governance, 17.
• Bishara, Azmi – Invasion and Occupation
of Iraq and the Democratic Political Culture in
Arab Countries, 18.
• Chekir, Hafidha – Civil Society in the Arab
World: Reality and Prospects, 27.
• Corm, George Antoine – Impasse of
Freedom in the Arab World between Foreign
Constraints and Internal Factors, 12.
• El-Ati, Jalila – Freedom from Hunger and
Malnutrition, Food Safety, 12.
• El-Imam, Mohammed Mahmoud –
Reforming Governance at the Pan-Arab Level to
Guarantee the Freedom of the Homeland and
the Citizens, 9.
• Esber, Khalida Sa’id – Freedom in Creative
Arab Literature, 11.
• Farahat, Nour – Freedoms and Human
Rights in the Arab Legal Systems, 36.
• Ghubash, Rafia Obaid – Freedom from
Illness and Health Security in Arab Societies, 24.
• Guessous, Abdel Aziz – Civil Society and
Political Parties in Arab Countries, 27.
• Hafez, Salah El-Din – The Media and Its
Role in Protecting Rights and Freedoms, 10.
• Hijazi, Mustafa – A Prerequisite to Freedom
and Democracy: Acknowledging the Value of
the Human Being, 14.
• Jada’ane, Fehmi – Freedom in the Arab
Formal Culture, 32.
• Kana’an, Taher – Political Economy of
Freedom and Good Governance for Human
Development: Concepts and Analytical Tools,
17.
• Khalil, Abdalla and Mohammad Khalil -
Laws Contraining Civil Rights and Freedoms in
Arab Countries.
• Kuttab, Jonathan – Christians under
Occupation in Palestine, 9.
• Loteh, Mariam Sultan – Political Freedoms
in Contemporary Arab Thought, 18.
• Malki, Mhammed – Legal Architecture for
Freedom in Arab Countries, 34.
• Osman, Abdelwahab El-Affendi – The
Nature of Arab Governance Systems, 10.
• Shaban, Abdel-Hussein – Freedom from
Oppression: Civil and Political Rights, 21.
• Zalzal, Marie Rose – Citizenship Rights, 25.
IN ENGLISH
• Kubursi, Atef – Democracy and
Development: Cruel Choices and Necessary
Conditions, 7.
ANNEX III. LIST OF BACKGROUND
PAPERS
234 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Table -1
Table -2
Table -3
Table -4
Table -5
Table -6
Table -7
Table -8
Table -9
Table -10
Table -11
Table -12
Table -13
Table -14
Table -15
Table -16
Table -17
Table -18
Table -19
Table -20
Table -21
Table -22
Table -23
Table -24
Table -25
Human development index
Human development index trends
Gender-related development index
Human Poverty
Income poverty and inequality in consumption
Population size and distribution
Literacy and enrolment
Public spending on education
Water and sanitation
Child health
Reproductive health
Household and fertility indicators
Nutrition
Other health indicators
Unemployment and child labour
Main economic indicators
External debt ($ millions)
Integration with the global economy
Priorities in public spending
Women’s political participation
Gender inequality in education
Other indicators on women
Press and communications
Energy and the environment
Armaments and refugees
Annex 4: Statistical Tables on Human
Development in the Arab States
Symbols used in the tables
.. Data not available.
(.) Less than half the unit shown.
< Less than.
- Not applicable.
A hyphen “-“ between two years indicates that the data have been collected during one of the years shown. For example, 1997-2001
indicates that the data is collected during one of the years within the period 1997-2001, i. e. during the year 1997 or 1998 or 1999 or
2000 or 2001.
A slash “/” between two years indicates averages for the years shown. For example, 1997/2001 indicates that the data represents the
annual average for the period extending from 1997 till 2001; i.e. the annual average for the years 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000 and 2001.
235 ANNEX 4: STATISTICAL TABLES ON HUMAN DEVELOPMENT IN THE ARAB STATES
Table -1
Table -2
HUMAN DEVELOPMENT INDEX TRENDS
GDP per
capita
(PPP US$)
rank
minus
HDI rank
Human development index (HDI) 2002
GDP
per capita
(PPP US$)
2002
Combined
gross enrolment
ratio for primary,
secondary
and tertiary
schools (%)
2001/02
Adult
literacy
rate
(% ages 15
and above)
2002
Life
expectancy
at birth
(years)
2002 Country
Rank within
Arab countries
(20 countries)
Rank within
all countries
(177 coun-
tries) Value
-25 13 108 0.704 5,760 70 68.9 69.5 Algeria
-4 1 40 0.843 17,170 79 88.5 73.9 Bahrain
4 16 136 0.530 1,690 45 56.2 60.6 Comoros
-21 20 154 0.454 1,990 24 65.5 45.8 Djibouti
-12 14 120 0.653 3,810 76 55.6 68.6 Egypt
.. .. .. .. .. 57 .. 60.7 Iraq
14 9 90 0.750 4,220 77 90.9 70.9 Jordan
-6 2 44 0.838 16,240 76 82.9 76.5 Kuwait
21 8 80 0.758 4,360 78 86.5 73.5 Lebanon
6 5 58 0.794 7,570 97 81.7 72.6 Libyan Arab Jamahiriya
-25 19 152 0.465 2,220 44 41.2 52.3 Mauritania
-17 15 125 0.620 3,810 57 50.7 68.5 Morocco
21 11 102 0.726 .. 79 90.2 72.3 Occupied Palestinian Territories
-32 6 74 0.770 13,340 63 74.4 72.3 Oman
-21 3 47 0.833 19,844 82 84.2 72.0 Qatar
-33 7 77 0.768 12,650 57 77.9 72.1 Saudi Arabia
.. .. .. .. .. .. .. 47.9 Somalia
-3 17 139 0.505 1,820 36 59.9 55.5 Sudan
4 12 106 0.710 3,620 59 82.9 71.7 Syrian Arab Republic
-23 10 92 0.745 6,760 75 73.2 72.7 Tunisia
-26 4 49 0.824 22,420 68 77.3 74.6 United Arab Emirates
16 18 149 0.482 870 53 49.0 59.8 Yemen
Source: Human Development Report 2004
2002 2000 1995 1990 1985 1980 1975 Country
0.704 0.693 0.664 0.642 0.603 0.554 0.504 Algeria
0.843 0.835 0.825 0.808 0.779 0.746 .. Bahrain
0.530 0.521 0.509 0.501 0.498 0.479 .. Comoros
0.454 0.452 0.450 .. .. .. .. Djibouti
0.653 .. 0.608 0.577 0.539 0.487 0.438 Egypt
.. .. .. .. .. .. .. Iraq
0.750 0.741 0.707 0.682 0.663 0.639 .. Jordan
0.838 0.834 0.810 .. 0.778 0.776 0.761 Kuwait
0.758 0.752 0.732 0.673 .. .. .. Lebanon
0.794 .. .. .. .. .. .. Libyan Arab Jamahiriya
0.465 0.449 0.423 0.387 0.382 0.362 0.339 Mauritania
0.620 0.603 0.571 0.542 0.510 0.474 0.429 Morocco
0.726 .. .. .. .. .. .. Occupied Palestinian Territories
0.770 0.761 0.733 0.696 0.640 0.546 0.493 Oman
0.833 .. .. .. .. .. .. Qatar
0.768 0.764 0.741 0.707 0.671 0.656 0.602 Saudi Arabia
.. .. .. .. .. .. .. Somalia
0.505 0.492 0.465 0.427 0.394 0.372 0.344 Sudan
0.710 0.683 0.663 0.635 0.611 0.576 0.534 Syrian Arab Republic
0.745 0.734 0.696 0.656 0.623 0.574 0.516 Tunisia
0.824 .. 0.803 0.805 0.785 0.777 0.744 United Arab Emirates
0.482 0.469 0.435 0.392 .. .. .. Yemen
HUMAN DEVELOPMENT INDEX
Source: Human Development Report 2004
236 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Country
Gender-related
development
index
(GDI)
Life expectancy
at birth
(years)
2002
Adult
literacy rate
(% ages 15
and above)
2002
Combined gross
enrolment ratio for
primary, secondary
and
tertiary level
schools
(%) 2001/02
Estimated
earned income
(PPP US$)
2002
HDI rank
minus
GDI rank
Rank Value Female Male Female Male Female Male Female Male
Algeria 89 0.688 71.1 68.0 59.6 78.0 69 72 2,684 8,794 -2
Bahrain 39 0.832 75.8 72.4 84.2 91.5 82 77 7,961 23,505 -2
Comoros 108 0.510 62.0 59.2 49.1 63.5 41 50 950 1,699 0
Djibouti .. .. 47.0 44.8 55.5 76.1 20 28 .. .. ..
Egypt 99 0.634 70.8 66.6 43.6 67.2 72 80 1,963 5,216 -1
Iraq .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Jordan 76 0.734 72.4 69.6 85.9 95.5 77 76 1,896 6,118 -2
Kuwait 42 0.827 78.9 74.8 81.0 84.7 81 71 7,116 20,979 -1
Lebanon 64 0.755 75.0 71.8 81.0 92.4 79 77 2,552 8,336 2
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya .. .. 75.3 70.7 70.7 91.8 100 93 .. .. ..
Mauritania 124 0.456 53.9 50.7 31.3 51.5 42 46 1,581 2,840 0
Morocco 100 0.604 70.3 66.6 38.3 63.3 52 61 2,153 5,354 0
Occupied Palestinian Terr. .. .. 73.9 70.7 .. .. 81 78 .. .. ..
Oman 68 0.747 74.3 70.9 65.4 82.0 63 62 4,056 18,239 -7
Qatar .. .. 75.3 70.4 82.3 84.9 84 79 .. .. ..
Saudi Arabia 72 0.739 73.6 71.0 69.5 84.1 57 58 3,825 18,616 -9
Somalia .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan 115 0.485 57.0 54.1 49.1 70.8 34 39 867 2,752 -4
Syrian Arab Republic 88 0.689 73.0 70.5 74.2 91.0 57 62 1,549 5,496 -3
Tunisia 77 0.734 74.8 70.7 63.1 83.1 75 74 3,615 9,933 -2
United Arab Emirates .. .. 77.3 73.2 80.7 75.6 72 65 .. .. ..
Yemen 126 0.436 60.9 58.7 28.5 69.5 37 66 387 1,274 -5
Country
Human poverty index
(HPI-1)
Probability
at birth
of not
surviving
to age 40
(% of cohort)
2000-05
Adult
illiteracy
rate
(% ages 15
and above)
2002
Population
without
sustainable
access to an
improved
water source
(%) 2000
Children
under weight
for age
(% under
age 5)
1995-2002
Rank within
95 developing
countries Value (%)
Algeria 43 21.9 9.3 31.1 11 6
Bahrain .. .. 4.0 11.5 .. 9
Comoros 49 31.4 18.1 43.8 4 25
Djibouti 55 34.3 42.9 34.5 0 18
Egypt 47 30.9 8.6 44.4 3 11
Iraq .. .. .. .. .. ..
Jordan 7 7.2 6.6 9.1 4 5
Kuwait .. .. 2.6 17.1 .. 10
Lebanon 14 9.5 4.3 13.5 0 3
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya 29 15.3 4.5 18.3 28 5
Mauritania 87 48.3 30.5 58.8 63 32
Morocco 56 34.5 9.4 49.3 20 9
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. .. 5.2 .. 14 4
Oman 50 31.5 5.0 25.6 61 24
Qatar .. .. 5.1 15.8 .. 6
Saudi Arabia 30 15.8 5.2 22.1 5 14
Somalia .. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan 51 31.6 27.6 40.1 25 17
Syrian Arab Republic 25 13.7 5.7 17.1 20 7
Tunisia 39 19.2 4.9 26.8 20 4
United Arab Emirates .. .. 3.4 22.7 .. 14
Yemen 67 40.3 19.1 51.0 31 46
Table -3
Source: Human Development Report 2004
GENDER-RELATED DEVELOPMENT INDEX
Table -4
HUMAN POVERTY
Source: Human Development Report 2004
237 ANNEX 4: STATISTICAL TABLES ON HUMAN DEVELOPMENT IN THE ARAB STATES
Population below national pov-
erty line 1992-2000
(%)
Population
below
income pov-
erty line $1
a day
1990-2000
(%)
Population
below
income pov-
erty line $2 a
day
1990-2000
(%)
Share of consumption (%)
Gini
index Country National Urban Rural
Poorest
10%
Richgst
10%
Richest 10% to
poorest 10%
Algeria 12.2 7.3 16.6 <2 15.1 2.8 26.8 9.6 35.3
Bahrain 15 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Comoros .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Djibouti 45.1 .. 86.5 .. .. .. .. .. ..
Egypt 22.9 22.5 23.3 3.1 43.9 3.7 29.5 8.0 34.4
Iraq 45 .. .. .. .. .. ..
Jordan 11.7 .. .. <2 7.4 3.3 29.8 9.1 36.4
Kuwait 11 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Lebanon 19 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Mauritania 50.0 30.1 65.5 25.9 63.1 2.5 29.5 12.0 39.0
Morocco 19.0 12.0 27.2 <2 14.3 2.6 30.9 11.7 39.5
Occupied Palestinian Terr. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Oman 17 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Qatar 11 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Saudi Arabia 21 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Somalia .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Syrian Arab Republic 22 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Tunisia 7.4 3.5 13.1 <2 6.6 2.3 31.5 13.4 39.8
United Arab Emirates 3 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Yemen 41.8 30.8 45.0 15.7 45.2 3.0 25.9 8.6 33.4
Table -5
* The Gini index measures inequality over the entire distribution of income or consumption. A value of 0 represents perfect equality, and a value of 100
perfect inequality.
Source:
Human Development Report 2004
World Bank: http://www.worldbank.org/data/wdi2004/pdfs/table2-5.pdf
Mohammed Bakir, Measuring Poverty in the Countries of the Economic and Social Commission for Western Asia, UN ESCWA, Amman, 1996.
INCOME POVERTY AND INEQUALITY IN CONSUMPTION
238 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Country
Estimated popu-
lation
(thousands)
2004
Sex ratio (males
per
100 females)
2004
Average annual
rate of change of
population (%)
2000-2005
Urban popula-
tion
(% of total
population)
2003
Population less
than 15 years
(% of total
population)
2004
Population
density
(people
per sq. km)
2002
Algeria 32,339 102 1.67 59 32 13
Bahrain 739 135 2.17 90 29 983
Comoros 790 101 2.83 35 42 263
Djibouti 712 99 1.58 84 43 30
Egypt 73,389 100 1.99 42 34 67
Iraq 25,856 103 2.68 67 41 55
Jordan 5,613 108 2.66 79 37 58
Kuwait 2,595 151 3.46 96 26 131
Lebanon 3,708 96 1.56 87 28 434
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya 5,659 107 1.93 86 30 3
Mauritania 2,980 98 2.98 62 43 3
Morocco 31,064 100 1.62 57 31 66
Occupied Palestinian Territories 3,685 104 3.57 71 46 ..
Oman 2,935 134 2.93 78 37 8
Qatar 619 172 1.54 92 26 55
Saudi Arabia 24,919 116 2.92 88 39 10
Somalia 10,312 99 4.17 35 48 15
Sudan 34,333 101 2.17 39 39 14
Syrian Arab Republic 18,223 102 2.38 50 37 92
Tunisia 9,937 101 1.07 64 27 63
United Arab Emirates 3,051 185 1.94 85 25 38
Yemen 20,732 103 3.52 26 48 35
Table -6
Source:
UNSD: http://unstats.un.org/unsd/demographic/products/socind/population.htm
UNICEF: http://www.unicef.org/files/Table6_english.xls
World Bank: http://www.worldbank.org/data/wdi2004/tables/table1-1.pdf
POPULATION SIZE AND DISTRIBUTION
239 ANNEX 4: STATISTICAL TABLES ON HUMAN DEVELOPMENT IN THE ARAB STATES
Country
Public expenditure on education Public expenditure on education by level (% of all levels)
As % of GDP
As % of total govern-
ment expenditure
Pre-primary
and primary Secondary Tertiary
1990 1999-2001 1990 1999-2001 1990 1999-2001 1990 1999-2001 1990 1999-2001
Algeria 5.3 .. 21.1 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Bahrain 4.2 .. 14.6 .. .. .. 45.8 .. .. ..
Comoros .. .. .. .. 42.4 .. 28.2 .. 17.3 ..
Djibouti .. .. 10.5 .. 58.0 .. 21.7 .. 11.5 ..
Egypt 3.7 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Iraq .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Jordan 8.4 4.6 17.1 20.6 .. 51.7 62.4 48.3 35.1 ..
Kuwait 4.8 .. 3.4 .. 53.4 .. 13.6 .. 16.0 ..
Lebanon .. 2.9 .. 11.1 .. .. .. .. .. ..
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya .. 2.7 .. .. .. 17.8 .. 14.2 .. 52.7
Mauritania .. 3.6 .. .. 33.3 54.5 37.7 31.4 24.9 14.1
Morocco 5.3 5.1 26.1 .. 34.8 48.0 48.9 51.5 16.2 0.3
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Oman 3.1 4.2 11.1 .. 54.1 36.4 37.0 51.4 7.4 1.8
Qatar 3.5 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Saudi Arabia 6.5 .. 17.8 .. 78.8 .. .. .. 21.2 ..
Somalia .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan 0.9 .. 2.8 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Syrian Arab Republic 4.1 4.0 17.3 11.1 38.5 .. 28.2 39.2 21.3 ..
Tunisia 6.0 6.8 13.5 17.4 39.8 33.3 36.4 45.0 18.5 21.7
United Arab Emirates 1.9 .. 14.6 .. .. 51.9 .. 46.4 .. ..
Yemen .. 10.0 .. 32.8 .. .. .. .. .. ..
Country
Adult literacy rate
(% ages 15 and
above)
Youth literacy rate
(% ages 15-24)
Net primary
enrolment ratio
(%)
Net secondary
enrolment ratio
(%)
Tertiary students
in
science, math &
engineering
(% of all tertiary
students)
1990 2002 1990 2002 1990/1 2001/2 1990/1 2001/2 1994-1997
Algeria 52.9 68.9 77.3 89.9 93 95 54 62 50
Bahrain 82.1 88.5 95.6 98.6 99 91 85 81 ..
Comoros 53.8 56.2 56.7 59.0 57 55 .. .. ..
Djibouti 53.0 .. 73.2 .. 31 34 .. 17 ..
Egypt 47.1 55.6 61.3 73.2 84 90 .. 81 15
Iraq .. .. .. .. .. 91 .. .. ..
Jordan 81.5 90.9 96.7 99.4 94 91 .. 80 27
Kuwait 76.7 82.9 87.5 93.1 49 85 .. 77 23
Lebanon 80.3 .. 92.1 .. 78 90 .. .. 17
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya 68.1 81.7 91.0 97.0 96 .. .. .. ..
Mauritania 34.8 41.2 45.8 49.6 35 67 .. 15 ..
Morocco 38.7 50.7 55.3 69.5 57 88 .. 31 29
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. .. .. .. .. 95 .. 81 10
Oman 54.7 74.4 85.6 98.5 69 75 .. 68 31
Qatar 77.0 84.2 90.3 94.8 89 94 70 78 ..
Saudi Arabia 66.2 77.9 85.4 93.5 59 59 31 53 18
Somalia .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan 45.8 59.9 65.0 79.1 43 46 .. .. ..
Syrian Arab Republic 64.8 82.9 79.9 95.2 92 98 43 39 31
Tunisia 59.1 73.2 84.1 94.3 94 97 .. 68 27
United Arab Emirates 71.0 77.3 84.7 91.4 100 81 58 72 27
Yemen 32.7 49.0 50.0 67.9 52 67 .. 35 6
Table -7
LITERACY AND ENROLMENT
Source:
UNICEF: http://www.unicef.org/files/Table5_english.xls
Human Development Report 2004
Table -8
PUBLIC SPENDING ON EDUCATION
Source: Human Development Report 2004
240 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Under-5 mortality rate
(Per 1000 live births)
Infant mortality rate
(Per 1000 live births)
Immunized one year old children (%)
2002
Country 1960 2002 1960 2002 TB polio3 measles
Algeria 280 49 164 39 98 86 81
Bahrain 160 16 110 13 .. 98 99
Comoros 265 79 200 59 90 98 71
Djibouti 289 143 186 100 52 62 62
Egypt 282 41 189 35 98 97 97
Iraq 171 125 117 102 93 84 90
Jordan 139 33 97 27 .. 95 95
Kuwait 128 10 89 9 .. 94 99
Lebanon 85 32 65 28 .. 92 96
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya 270 19 159 16 99 93 91
Mauritania 310 183 180 120 98 82 81
Morocco 211 43 132 39 90 94 96
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. 25 .. 23 96 97 94
Oman 280 13 164 11 98 99 99
Qatar 140 16 94 11 99 96 99
Saudi Arabia 250 28 170 23 98 95 97
Somalia .. 225 .. 133 60 40 45
Sudan 208 94 123 64 48 40 49
Syrian Arab Republic 201 28 136 23 99 99 98
Tunisia 254 26 170 21 97 96 94
United Arab Emirates 223 9 149 8 98 94 94
Yemen 340 107 220 79 74 69 65
Table -9
WATER AND SANITATION
Source: UNICEF: http://www.unicef.org/files/Table3_english.xls
Country
% of population using improved drinking
water sources 2000
% of population using adequate
sanitation facilities 2000
total urban rural total urban rural
Algeria
89 94 82 92 99 81
Bahrain
.. .. .. .. .. ..
Comoros
96 98 95 98 98 98
Djibouti
100 100 100 91 99 50
Egypt
97 99 96 98 100 96
Iraq
85 96 48 79 93 31
Jordan
96 100 84 99 100 98
Kuwait
.. .. .. .. .. ..
Lebanon
100 100 100 99 100 87
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya
72 72 68 97 97 96
Mauritania
37 34 40 33 44 19
Morocco
80 98 56 68 86 44
Occupied Palestinian Territories
86 97 86 100 100 100
Oman
39 41 30 92 98 61
Qatar
.. .. .. .. .. ..
Saudi Arabia
95 100 64 100 100 100
Somalia
.. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan
75 86 69 62 87 48
Syrian Arab Republic
80 94 64 90 98 81
Tunisia
80 92 58 84 96 62
United Arab Emirates
.. .. .. .. .. ..
Yemen
69 74 68 38 89 21
Table -10
CHILD HEALTH
Source:
UNICEF: http://www.unicef.org/files/Table1_english.xls
UNICEF: http://www.unicef.org/files/Table3_english.xls
241 ANNEX 4: STATISTICAL TABLES ON HUMAN DEVELOPMENT IN THE ARAB STATES
Country
Average house-
hold size
1991-1994
Households
headed by
women
(%)
1991-1994
Contraceptive
prevalence rate
among married
women (%)
1991-2002
Fertility rate
(births per
woman)
1991-1995
Fertility rate
(births per
woman)
2000-2005
Births per 1000
woman for the
age group 15-
19 years
2000-2005
Algeria 7.0 11 52 4.1 2.8 16
Bahrain 5.6 .. 62 3.4 2.7 18
Comoros 6.2 25 21 5.8 4.9 59
Djibouti 6.6 18 .. 6.3 5.7 64
Egypt 4.9 13 56 4.0 3.3 47
Iraq 7.3 .. 14 5.7 4.8 38
Jordan 6.9 .. 53 4.9 3.6 27
Kuwait 6.5 5 50 3.2 2.7 31
Lebanon 4.8* 12.5* 61 2.8 2.2 25
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya .. .. 40 4.1 3.0 7
Mauritania .. .. 8 6.1 5.8 104
Morocco 6.0 15 50 3.6 2.7 25
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. .. .. 6.5 5.6 94
Oman 7.0 .. 24 6.5 5.0 66
Qatar 5.6 .. 43 4.1 3.2 20
Saudi Arabia 7.4 .. 32 5.8 4.5 38
Somalia .. .. 1 7.3 7.3 213
Sudan 6.3 13 8 5.3 4.4 55
Syrian Arab Republic 6.0 .. 36 4.6 3.3 34
Tunisia 5.4 11 60 3.1 2.0 7
United Arab Emirates .. .. 28 3.8 2.8 51
Yemen 5.8 12 21 7.8 7.0 111
Country
People with
HIV/AIDS
(% ages
15-49)
2003
People with HIV/
AIDS
(% women
among
adults)
End of 2001
Pregnant
women who
received
prenatal
care (%)
1996
Deliveries
attended
by skilled
attendant (%)
1996
Maternal
mortality ratio
(per 100,000
live births)
around 2000
Length of
maternity leave
Algeria 0.1 .. 58 77 140 14 weeks
Bahrain 0.2 .. 96 94 28 45 days
Comoros .. .. 69 24 480 14 weeks
Djibouti .. .. 76 79 730 14 weeks
Egypt <0.1 10 53 46 84 50 days
Iraq .. .. 59 54 250 60 days
Jordan .. .. 80 87 41 10 weeks
Kuwait .. .. 99 99 5 70 days
Lebanon 0.1 .. 85 45 150 40 days
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya 0.3 16 100 76 97 50 days
Mauritania 0.6 .. 49 40 1000 14 weeks
Morocco 0.1 15 45 40 220 12 weeks
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. .. .. .. .. ..
Oman 0.1 15 98 92 87 ..
Qatar .. .. 100 97 7 40-60 days
Saudi Arabia .. .. 87 90 23 10 weeks
Somalia .. .. 40 2 1100 14 weeks
Sudan 2.3 56 54 86 590 8 weeks
Syrian Arab Republic <0.1 .. 33 67 160 75 days
Tunisia <0.1 .. 71 90 120 30 days
United Arab Emirates .. .. 95 96 54 45 days
Yemen 0.1 15 26 16 570 60 days
Table -11
REPRODUCTIVE HEALTH
Source:
UNSD: http://unstats.un.org/unsd/demographic/products/indwm/table3b.htm
UNSD: http://unstats.un.org/unsd/demographic/products/indwm/table5c1x.htm
Human Development Report 2004
Table -12
HOUSEHOLD AND FERTILITY INDICATORS
* Data for 1997 according to Household Living Condition Survey 1997.
Source:
UNSD: http://unstats.un.org/unsd/demographic/social/childbr.htm
World Women 2000: http://unstats.un.org/unsd/demographic/ww2000/table2b.htm
Central Administration of Statistics, Household Living Condition Survey 1997, Statistical Studies No. 9, Republic of Lebanon, February 1998.
242 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Country
Infants with
low birth
weight (%)
1998-2002
% of under-fives suffering from
1995-2002
underweight wasting stunting
% of house-
holds consum-
ing iodized salt
1997-2002
Iron defi-
ciency cases
among
women (%)
Under nour-
ished people
(thousand)
1999
Algeria 7 7 3 18 69 2000
Bahrain 8 11 5 10 .. 37 ..
Comoros 25 34 12 42 82 .. ..
Djibouti .. 24 13 26 .. 70 ..
Egypt 12 14 5 21 28 24 2000
Iraq 15 18 6 22 40 51 6000
Jordan 10 6 2 8 88 29 ..
Kuwait 7 13 11 24 .. .. ..
Lebanon 6 3 3 12 87 27 ..
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya 7 6 3 15 90 .. ..
Mauritania 42 42 13 35 2 .. ..
Morocco 11 11 4 24 41 35 2000
Occupied Palestinian Territories 9 5 3 9 37 .. ..
Oman 8 28 13 23 61 38 ..
Qatar 10 .. 2 8 .. .. ..
Saudi Arabia 11 17 11 20 .. .. 1000
Somalia .. 33 17 23 .. .. ..
Sudan 31 24 .. .. 1 .. 7000
Syrian Arab Republic 6 8 4 18 40 .. 1000
Tunisia 7 5 2 12 97 31 ..
United Arab Emirates 15 17 15 17 .. .. ..
Yemen 32 61 13 52 39 .. 6000
Table -13
NUTRITION
Source:
UNICEF: http://www.unicef.org/files/Table2_english.xls
UNICEF, The State of Children and Women in the Middle East and North Africa, 2001
Table -14
OTHER HEALTH INDICATORS
Source:
Human Development Report 2004
WHO, The world health report 2004: http://www.who.int/whr/2004/annex/topic/annex4.xls
Expectation of
lost healthy years
at birth (years)
2002
Tubercul
-osis cases
(per
100,000
people)
2002
Malaria
cases
(Per
100,000
people)
2000
Physicians
(per
100,000
people)
1990-2003
Health
expenditure
per capita
(PPP US$)
2001
Prevalence
of smoking
(% of adults)
2000
Country Male Female Women Men
Algeria 7.9 9.6 51 2 85 169 44 7
Bahrain 7.9 10.1 68 .. 169 664 .. ..
Comoros 7.8 9.6 121 1,930 7 29 .. ..
Djibouti 6.1 7.4 1,161 715 13 90 .. ..
Egypt 7.4 8.8 38 (.) 218 153 35 2
Iraq 10.3 11.6 .. .. .. .. .. ..
Jordan 9.0 10.9 6 3 205 412 48 10
Kuwait 8.2 10.6 53 .. 160 612 30 2
Lebanon 8.4 10.4 15 .. 274 673 46 35
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya 8.1 10.5 20 2 120 239 .. ..
Mauritania 6.9 8.2 437 11,150 14 45 .. ..
Morocco 9.4 11.9 100 (.) 49 199 35 2
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. .. 38 .. 84 .. .. ..
Oman 8.3 11.1 13 27 137 343 16 2
Qatar 8.2 10.0 70 .. 220 782 .. ..
Saudi Arabia 8.6 11.0 59 32 153 591 22 1
Somalia 6.9 8.1 .. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan 7.8 9.4 346 13,934 16 39 24 1
Syrian Arab Republic 8.5 10.5 54 (.) 142 427 51 10
Tunisia 8.2 10.3 26 1 70 463 62 8
United Arab Emirates 7.8 10.9 26 .. 177 921 18 1
Yemen 10.8 11.5 145 15,160 22 69 60 29
243 ANNEX 4: STATISTICAL TABLES ON HUMAN DEVELOPMENT IN THE ARAB STATES
Country
GDP per capita
(PPP US$)
Gross
domestic product
2002
GDP per
capita annual
growth
rate
(%)
2001-2002
Average
annual
change in
consumer
price index
(%) 2002
Official
development
assistance
received
(US$ millions)
2002
Highest value
during
1975-2002
Year of
highest
value
US$
billions
PPP US$
billions
Algeria 6,190 1985 55.9 180.4 2.5 2.2 361
Bahrain 17,170 2002 7.7 12.0 .. -0.5 ..
Comoros 2,140 1985 0.3 1.0 .. .. ..
Djibouti .. .. 0.6 1.4 .. 2.7 ..
Egypt 3,810 2002 89.9 252.6 1.1 .. 1,286
Iraq .. .. .. .. .. 19.3 116
Jordan 5,100 1987 9.3 21.8 2.0 1.8 534
Kuwait 29,180 1975 35.4 37.8 –3.3 0.6 5
Lebanon 4,520 1997 17.3 19.4 –0.3 .. 456
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya .. .. 19.1 .. .. .. 10
Mauritania 2,220 2002 1.0 6.2 0.8 3.9 355
Morocco 3,810 2002 36.1 112.9 1.6 2.8 636
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. .. 3.4 .. .. .. ..
Oman 13,710 2001 20.3 33.8 –2.3 -0.7 41
Qatar .. .. 17.5 .. .. 1.6 ..
Saudi Arabia 23,980 1977 188.5 276.9 –1.8 -0.6 27
Somalia .. .. .. .. .. .. 194
Sudan 1,820 2002 13.5 59.5 3.3 .. 351
Syrian Arab Republic 3,630 1998 20.8 61.5 0.3 1.0 81
Tunisia 6,760 2002 21.0 66.2 0.6 2.8 475
United Arab Emirates 47,790 1975 71.0 .. –5.0 2.9 4
Yemen 870 2002 10.0 16.2 0.5 11.9 584

Country
Unemployment rate (%)
1999-2001 Child labour (5-14 years) 1999-2001 (%)
Total Male Female Total Male Female Urban Rural
Poorest
20%
Mother
with no
education
Algeria 29.8 33.9 29.7 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Bahrain 6.2 4.2 2.0 5 6 3 .. .. .. 5
Comoros .. .. .. 27 27 28 28 27 32 29
Egypt 9.2 5.6 22.6 6 6 5 3 8 12 8
Iraq .. .. .. 8 11 5 6 12 12 9
Jordan 14.5 13.4 20.8 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Kuwait 0.8 0.8 0.6 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Lebanon .. .. .. 6 8 4 .. .. .. 13
Morocco 11.6 11.6 12.5 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Occupied Palestinian Territories 31.3 33.5 17.1 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Saudi Arabia 4.6 3.9 9.1 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Somalia .. .. .. 32 29 36 25 36 38 35
Sudan .. .. .. 13 14 12 7 19 25 16
Syrian Arab Republic 11.7 8.3 24.1 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Tunisia 14.9 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
United Arab Emirates 2.3 2.2 2.6 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Yemen 11.5 12.5 8.2 .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Table -15
UNEMPLOYMENT AND CHILD LABOUR
Source:
UNICEF: http://www.unicef.org/files/table9 english.xls
ILO: http://laborsta.ilo.org/
Department of Statistics, Jordan: http://www.dos.gov.jo/sdb_pop/sdb_pop_a/index_o.htm
Table -16
MAIN ECONOMIC INDICATORS
Source:
World Bank: http://www.worldbank.org/data/wdi2004/tables/table1-1.pdf
ILO: http://laborsta.ilo.org/
Humman Development Report 2004
Iraq Central Statistical Organization, Baghdad.
244 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Country
Trade in goods
(% of GDP)
Ratio of
commercial
service exports
to merchandise
exports (%)
Growth
in real
trade less
growth in
real GDP
% points
Gross private
capital flows
(% of GDP)
Gross
foreign direct
investment
(% of GDP)
1990 2002 1990 2002 1990-2002 1990 2002 1990 2002
Algeria 36.6 53.5 3.7 .. –0.5 2.6 .. 0 ..
Bahrain .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Comoros .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Djibouti .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Egypt 36.8 18.8 138.4 208.3 –2.1 6.8 6.6 1.7 0.8
Iraq 41.2 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Jordan 91.1 82.8 134.4 53.7 –2.6 6.3 7.8 1.7 0.9
Kuwait 59.8 68.9 15 8.9 .. 19.3 18.9 1.3 0.5
Lebanon 106.5 43.3 .. .. –2.5 .. .. .. ..
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya 64.2 87.1 0.6 .. .. 7.3 .. 0.9 ..
Mauritania 84.1 76.8 3.0 .. –1.2 48.8 .. 0.7 ..
Morocco 43.3 54.2 43.9 51.7 2.7 5.5 3.3 0.6 1.4
Occupied Palestinian Terr. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Oman 77.7 84.6 1.2 3.1 .. 3.8 5.0 1.4 0.2
Qatar .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Saudi Arabia 58.6 56.4 6.8 7.0 .. 8.8 13.9 1.6 0.5
Somalia 26.7 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan 4.1 26.5 35.9 2.5 5.8 0.2 7.5 0 4.6
Syrian Arab Republic 53.7 51.8 17.6 26.7 3.6 18.0 16.8 0 1.5
Tunisia 73.5 77.7 44.7 38.3 0.3 9.5 10.6 0.6 3.8
United Arab Emirates 101.8 .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Yemen 46.9 58.4 11.8 4.0 3.1 16.2 3.6 2.7 1.1
Table -17
EXTERNAL DEBT ($ MILLIONS)
Table -18
INTEGRATION WITH THE GLOBAL ECONOMY
Source: Word Bank: http://www.worldbank.org/data/wdi2004/tables/table6-1.pdf

Total external
debt Long-term debt
Public and publicly
guaranteed debt
Private nonguaranteed
external debt
Country 1990 2002 1990 2002 1990 2002 1990 2002
Algeria 28,149 22,800 26,688 21,362 26,688 21,255 0 107
Bahrain .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Comoros .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Djibouti .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Egypt 33,017 30,750 28,438 27,282 27,438 26,624 1,000 658
Iraq .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Jordan 8,333 8,094 7,202 7,076 7,202 7,076 0 0
Kuwait .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Lebanon 1,779 17,077 358 14,530 358 13,829 0 701
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Mauritania 2,113 2,309 1,806 1,984 1,806 1,984 0 0
Morocco 25,017 18,601 23,860 16,913 23,660 15,001 200 1,912
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Oman 2,736 4,639 2,400 3,451 2,400 1,979 0 1,471
Qatar .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Saudi Arabia .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Somalia 2,370 2,688 1,926 1,860 1,926 1,860 0 0
Sudan 14,762 16,389 9,651 9,539 9,155 9,043 496 496
Syrian Arab Republic 17,259 21,504 15,108 15,849 15,108 15,849 0 0
Tunisia .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
United Arab Emirates 7,690 12,625 6,880 12,027 6,662 10,641 218 1,386
Yemen 6,352 5,290 5,160 4,563 5,160 4,563 0 0
Source: World Bank: http://www.worldbank.org/data/wdi2004/pdfs/Table4_16.pdf
245 ANNEX 4: STATISTICAL TABLES ON HUMAN DEVELOPMENT IN THE ARAB STATES
Country
Public expenditure
on education
(% of GDP)
Public expenditure
on health
(% of GDP)
Military expenditure
(% of GDP)
Total debt service
(% of GDP)
1990 1999-2001 1990 2001 1990 2002 1990 2002
Algeria 5.3 .. 3.0 3.1 1.5 3.7 14.2 7.5
Bahrain 4.2 .. .. 2.9 5.1 3.9 .. ..
Comoros .. .. 2.9 1.9 .. .. 0.4 1.9
Djibouti .. .. .. 4.1 6.3 . . 3.6 2.0
Egypt 3.7 .. 1.8 1.9 3.9 2.7 7.1 2.3
Iraq .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Jordan 8.4 4.6 3.6 4.5 9.9 8.4 15.6 6.3
Kuwait 4.8 .. 4.0 3.5 48.5 10.4 .. ..
Lebanon .. 2.9 .. .. 7.6 4.7 3.5 12.7
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya .. 2.7 .. 1.6 .. 2.4 .. ..
Mauritania .. 3.6 .. 2.6 3.8 1.9 14.3 6.6
Morocco 5.3 5.1 0.9 2 4.1 4.3 6.9 10.2
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Oman 3.1 4.2 2.0 2.4 16.5 12.3 7.0 8.6
Qatar 3.5 .. .. 2.2 .. .. .. ..
Saudi Arabia 6.5 .. .. 3.4 12.8 9.8 .. ..
Somalia .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan 0.9 .. 0.7 0.6 3.6 2.8 0.4 0.2
Syrian Arab Republic 4.1 4.0 0.4 2.4 6.9 6.1 9.7 1.2
Tunisia 6.0 6.8 3.0 4.9 2.0 . . 11.6 6.8
United Arab Emirates 1.9 .. 0.8 2.6 6.2 3.7 .. ..
Yemen .. 10.0 1.1 1.5 8.5 7.1 3.5 1.7
Table -19
PRIORITIES IN PUBLIC SPENDING
Source: Human Development Report 2004
Table -20
WOMEN’S POLITICAL PARTICIPATION
Source:
World Women 2000: http://unstats.un.org/unsd/demographic/ww2000/table6a.htm
Inter-Parliamentary Union: http://www.ipu.org/wmn-e/classif.htm
Human Development Report 2004
Human Development Report 2000 (for Iraq when * is used)
Country
Seats in parliament held by
women
(% of total)
1997-2004
Year women
received right
to stand for
election
Year first
woman
elected or
appointed
to parliament
Women in
government at
ministerial level
(% of total)
1998
Women in
government at sub
ministerial level (%
of total) 1998
Lower or
single house
Upper house
or senate
Algeria 6.2 19.4 1962 1962 0 10
Bahrain 0 15 1973 — 0 1
Comoros .. .. 1956 1993 7 0
Djibouti 10.8 .. 1986 2003 0 3
Egypt 2.4 5.7 1956 1957 6 4
Iraq .. .. *1980 *1980 0 0
Jordan 5.5 12.7 1974 1989 2 0
Kuwait 0 .. — — 0 7
Lebanon 2.3 .. 1952 1991 0 0
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya .. .. 1964 .. .. ..
Mauritania 3.7 5.4 1961 1975 4 6
Morocco 10.8 1.1 1963 1993 0 8
Occupied Palestinian Territories .. .. .. .. .. ..
Oman – .. — — 0 4
Qatar – .. — — 0 0
Saudi Arabia 0.0 .. — — 0 0
Somalia .. .. .. .. 0 0
Sudan 9.7 .. 1964 1964 0 0
Syrian Arab Republic 12.0 .. 1953 1973 8 0
Tunisia 11.5 .. 1957,1959 1959 3 10
United Arab Emirates 0 .. — — 0 0
Yemen 0.3 .. 1967 1990 0 0
246 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Whether
national
plan of
action
provided
to the UN
Secretariat
Year of ratifi-
cation of the
Convention on
the Elimination
of All Forms of
Discrimination
against Women
Women among
administrative
and managerial
workers (%)
1985/1997
Self employed
(%)
1995-2002
Economic activity rate (%)
1986-2001
Women Men Female Male country
Yes 1996 6 .. .. 7 47 Algeria
Yes 2002 21 .. .. 24 65 Bahrain
.. 1994 .. .. .. .. .. Comoros
.. 1998 2 16 19 .. .. Djibouti
Yes 1981 16 17 31 20 69 Egypt
Yes 1986 13 .. .. 10 74 Iraq
Yes 1992 .. .. .. 13 73 Jordan
Yes 1994 5 .. .. 43 83 Kuwait
Yes 1997 .. .. .. .. .. Lebanon
.. 1989 .. .. .. .. .. Libyan Arab Jamahiriya
.. 2001 8 .. .. .. .. Mauritania
Yes 1993 .. 5 23 26 78 Morocco
.. .. .. 9 32 10 66 Occupied Palestinian Territ.
Yes .. .. .. .. 13 59 Oman
Yes .. 1 .. .. 28 93 Qatar
.. 2000 .. .. .. 15 80 Saudi Arabia
.. .. .. .. .. .. .. Somalia
Yes .. .. .. .. 29 75 Sudan
Yes 2003 3 6 37 24 82 Syrian Arab Republic
Yes 1985 9 14 25 24 73 Tunisia
Yes .. 2 .. .. 31 92 United Arab Emirates
Yes 1984 .. 63 49 2 81 Yemen
Country
Adult literacy
2002
Youth literacy
2002
Net primary
enrolment
Net secondary
enrolment
Gross tertiary
enrolment
Female
rate (%
ages 15 &
above)
2002
Female
rate as
% of
male rate
2002
Female
rate
(% ages
15-24)
2002
Female
rate as
% of
male rate
2002
Female
ratio
(%)
2000/01
Ratio of
female
to male
2000/01
Female
ratio
(%)
2000/01
Ratio of
female
to male
2000/01
Female
ratio
(%)
2000/01
Ratio of
female
to male
2000/01
Algeria 59.6 76 85.6 91 94 0.97 64 1.06 .. ..
Bahrain 84.2 92 98.9 100 91 1.01 86 1.12 28 1.86
Comoros 49.1 77 52.2 79 50 0.84 .. .. 1 0.73
Djibouti .. .. .. .. 30 0.77 13 0.63 1 0.80
Egypt 43.6 65 66.9 85 88 0.96 79 0.95 .. ..
Iraq .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Jordan 85.9 90 99.5 100 92 1.01 81 1.03 31 1.02
Kuwait 81.0 96 93.9 102 84 0.99 79 1.05 32 2.58
Lebanon .. .. .. .. 89 0.99 .. .. 48 1.14
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya 70.7 77 94.0 94 .. .. .. .. 61 1.09
Mauritania 31.3 61 41.8 73 65 0.96 13 0.83 1 0.27
Morocco 38.3 61 61.3 79 85 0.93 28 0.83 9 0.80
Occupied Palestinian Terr. .. .. .. .. 95 1.01 83 1.06 30 0.98
Oman 65.4 80 97.3 98 75 1.01 68 1.00 10 1.67
Qatar 82.3 97 95.8 102 94 0.98 80 1.06 34 2.69
Saudi Arabia 69.5 83 91.6 96 57 0.92 51 0.93 26 1.49
Somalia .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan 49.1 69 74.2 88 42 0.83 .. .. 6 0.92
Syrian Arab Republic 74.2 82 93.0 96 96 0.95 37 0.91 .. ..
Tunisia 63.1 76 90.6 93 97 0.99 69 1.04 21 0.97
United Arab Emirates 80.7 107 95.0 108 80 0.97 74 1.05 .. ..
Yemen 28.5 41 50.9 60 47 0.66 21 0.46 5 0.28
Table -21
GENDER INEQUALITY IN EDUCATION
Table -22
OTHER INDICATORS ON WOMEN
Source:
UNSD, World Women 2000: http://unstats.un.org/unsd/demographic/ww2000/table5d.htm
UNSD, World Women 2000: http://unstats.un.org/unsd/demographic/ww2000/table5e.htm
Source: Human Development Report 2004
247 ANNEX 4: STATISTICAL TABLES ON HUMAN DEVELOPMENT IN THE ARAB STATES
Table -23
PRESS AND COMMUNICATIONS
* The Press Freedom Barometer has five levels: good situation, satisfactory situation, noticeable problems, difficult situation and very serious situation.
Source:
Reporters Without Borders: http://www.rsf.fr/rubrique.php3?id_rubrique=43
International Federation of Journalists: http://www.ifj.org/pdfs/safetyapp2.pdf.
UNESCO: http://stats.uis.unesco.org/eng/TableViewer/Wdsview/dispviewp.asp?ReportId=27
Human Development Report 2004
Country Press Freedom
Barometer*
Deaths of
journalists and
media workers
1990-2002
Daily news
paper
(per 1000
people)
1998-2000
Telephone
mainlines
(per 1,000
people)
2002
Cellular sub-
scribers
(per 1,000
people)
2002
Internet users
(per 1,000
people)
2001
Algeria Noticeable problems 107 27.3 61 13 16
Bahrain Noticeable problems 0 .. 261 579 246
Comoros Noticeable problems 0 .. 13 0 4
Djibouti Difficult situation 0 .. 15 23 7
Egypt Difficult situation 0 31.2 110 67 28
Iraq Very serious situation 11 .. 30 .. ..
Jordan Noticeable problems 0 75.5 127 229 58
Kuwait Noticeable problems 4 .. 204 519 106
Lebanon Noticeable problems 6 .. 199 227 117
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya Very serious situation 0 .. 118 13 23
Mauritania Difficult situation 0 .. 12 92 4
Morocco Noticeable problems 0 28.3 38 209 24
Occupied Palestinian Territories Noticeable problems 0 .. 87 93 30
Oman Noticeable problems 9 .. 92 183 71
Qatar Noticeable problems 0 .. 286 433 113
Saudi Arabia Very serious situation 0 .. 151 228 65
Somalia Difficult situation 17 .. .. .. ..
Sudan Difficult situation 0 .. 21 6 3
Syrian Arab Republic Very serious situation 0 .. 123 23 13
Tunisia Very serious situation 0 19.0 117 52 52
United Arab Emirates Noticeable problems 0 .. 291 647 313
Yemen Difficult situation 0 .. 28 21 5
248 ARAB HUMAN DEVELOPMENT REPORT 2004
Table -24
ENERGY AND THE ENVIRONMENT
l Ratification, acceptance, approval, accession or succession
m Signature
Source: Human Development Report 2004
Convention
on
Biological
Diversity
Kyoto Protocol to
the Framework
Convention
on Climate
Change
Framework
Convention
on Climate
Change
Carbon dioxide
emissions
per capita
(metric tons)
Electricity
consumption
per capita
(kilowatt-hours)
Country 2000 1980 2001 1980
l l 2.9 3.5 866 381 Algeria
l l 29.1 23.4 10,350 4,784 Bahrain
l l 0.1 0.1 26 26 Comoros
l l l 0.6 1.0 286 416 Djibouti
l m l 2.2 1.1 1,129 433 Egypt
.. .. .. .. .. .. .. Iraq
l l l 3.2 2.2 1,507 366 Jordan
l l 21.9 18.0 15,309 6,849 Kuwait
l l 3.5 2.1 3,025 1,056 Lebanon
l l 10.9 8.8 4,021 1,588 Libyan Arab Jamahiriya
l l 1.2 0.4 61 60 Mauritania
l l l 1.3 0.8 569 254 Morocco
.. .. .. .. Occupied Palestinian Territories
l l 8.2 5.3 5,119 847 Oman
l l 69.5 56.3 16,677 10,616 Qatar
l l 18.1 14.0 6,018 1,969 Saudi Arabia
.. .. .. .. .. .. .. Somalia
l l 0.2 0.2 81 47 Sudan
l l 3.3 2.2 1,528 433 Syrian Arab Republic
l l l 1.9 1.5 1,106 434 Tunisia
l l 21.0 34.8 13,948 6,204 United Arab Emirates
l l 0.5 .. 164 ... Yemen
Table -25
ARMAMENTS AND REFUGEES
Source: Human Development Report 2004
Countries
Conventional arms imports
(US$ millions at
1990 prices)
Total armed forces
2002
Refugees, excluding Palestinian
refugees
(thousands) 2003
1994 2003 Thousands
Index
(1985 = 100)
By country
of asylum
By country
of origin
Algeria 156 513 137 80 169 4
Bahrain 10 (.) 11 382 0 (.)
Comoros .. .. .. .. 0 (.)
Djibouti (.) (.) 10 327 27 (.)
Egypt 1,976 504 443 100 89 1
Iraq .. .. .. .. .. ..
Jordan 5 258 100 143 1 1
Kuwait 37 21 16 129 2 (.)
Lebanon 13 (.) 72 413 3 19
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya (.) (.) 76 104 12 1
Mauritania 27 (.) 16 `185 (.) 26
Morocco 131 (.) 196 132 2 1
Occupied Palestinian Territories 5 (.) .. .. 0 326
Oman 173 14 42 143 0 (.)
Qatar 10 10 12 207 (.) (.)
Saudi Arabia 991 487 200 319 241 (.)
Somalia .. .. .. .. .. ..
Sudan (.) (.) 117 207 328 567
Syrian Arab Republic 44 15 319 79 4 16
Tunisia 32 (.) 35 100 (.) 2
United Arab Emirates 554 922 42 97 (.) (.)
Yemen 4 30 67 104 62 1

Sponsor Documents

Or use your account on DocShare.tips

Hide

Forgot your password?

Or register your new account on DocShare.tips

Hide

Lost your password? Please enter your email address. You will receive a link to create a new password.

Back to log-in

Close